SlideShare a Scribd company logo
Control of machines
Control of machines
THIS PAGE IS
  BLANK
NEW AGE INTERNATIONAL (P) LIMITED, PUBLISHERS
                           New Delhi · Bangalore · Chennai · Cochin · Guwahati · Hyderabad
                           Jalandhar · Kolkata · Lucknow · Mumbai · Ranchi
PUBLISHING FOR ONE WORLD   Visit us at www.newagepublishers.com
Copyright © 2006, 1996 New Age International (P) Ltd., Publishers
Published by New Age International (P) Ltd., Publishers

All rights reserved.
No part of this ebook may be reproduced in any form, by photostat, microfilm,
xerography, or any other means, or incorporated into any information retrieval
system, electronic or mechanical, without the written permission of the publisher.
All inquiries should be emailed to rights@newagepublishers.com



ISBN : 978-81-224-2440-9




PUBLISHING FOR ONE WORLD
NEW AGE INTERNATIONAL (P) LIMITED, PUBLISHERS
4835/24, Ansari Road, Daryaganj, New Delhi - 110002
Visit us at www.newagepublishers.com
Dedicated
                                to
                                Parents
                            Our Parents




dharm
d:N-MachTITLE.pm5   iii
THIS PAGE IS
  BLANK
Preface


The purpose of this book is to present the subject of Control of Machines using electromagnetic
relays, static switching devices and programmable logic controllers. The book has been de-
signed for use as a text in diploma and degree courses. The content of this book may also be
used effectively in conducting industrial training programmes. It will be of immense help to
students who intend to join industry.
       Electrical control of motors and other machinery started with the advent of relays, timers
and contactors. In the 1960s, programmable controllers started being widely used in industry.
In India, however, these technologies were introduced much later. Indian industries are now
fast switching over to programmable controlled machines. All the three types of controls have
been discussed in this book. However, more emphasis has been laid on magnetic control using
relays. This is so because, inspite of the increasing popularity of solid state control and
programmable controllers, relay logic control will continue to be used as far as single motor
control or the control of a machine with few operations is concerned. Thus, study of relay logic
becomes essential for an electrical engineer in order to gain proficiency in the design of control
logic.
       The first section of the book deals with motor control using relays and timers. Here
construction and working of different types of components have been described in detail. It is
recommended here that students support their study of components with catalogues published
by various manufacturers. The symbols followed for control components are as recommended
by the Bureau of Indian standards. Starters for different types of ac and dc motors have been
covered in detail. The main highlight and interesting part of this section is the explanation of a
large number of typical control circuits used in industry.
       Description of machines, various control operations desired and the step by step working
of control circuit have been discussed. Students will find these circuits very interesting. It is
hoped that a careful study of these circuits will generate confidence in the students and enhance
their confidence in handling such control circuitry employed in industry. Besides these there
are chapters devoted to troubleshooting and protection of motors.
       The second portion of the book deals with static control using digital devices. Modern
control systems are designed using integrated circuit elements. These control systems are
particularly useful in adverse environments for complex control situations, and applications
where high speed operation is required. In this section, ladder logic diagram and USAUI symbols
for digital devices have been used, as these are universally used in industry. To make students
familiar, the alternate symbols, other than those specified by BIS, have also been used in the
section for control components. Besides discussing the general approach to development of
circuits, a number of industrial circuits have been discussed.



                                               vii

dharm
d:N-MachTITLE.pm5      iv
viii

       The last section of the book deals with use of programmable logic controllers for control
of machines. PLC architecture and its programming in Ladder Logic Language has been discussed
extensively.
       We hope that this book will be useful to teachers and students of polytechnics and
engineering colleges. Suggestions for the improvement of this book will be thankfully
acknowledged.
       Finally, we would like to thank our colleagues in the institute as well as teachers of
various technical institutes who have encouraged us to make our best efforts in bringing forth
this book. Thanks are also due to the publishers, M/s New Age International Pvt. Ltd. for bringing
out this book in a very presentable manner.



                                                                        Dr. S.K. Bhattacharya
                                                                              Brijinder Singh




dharm
d:N-MachTITLE.pm5      v
Contents


      Preface                                                                  vii

1     INTRODUCTION TO CONTROL OF MACHINES                                       1
      1.1   General Idea of Controls                                            1
      1.2   Disadvantages of Manual Control                                     2
      1.3   Introduction to Magnetic Control                                    2
      1.4   Advantages of Magnetic Control                                      4
      1.5   Semi-automatic and Automatic Control of Modern Machinery            5
      1.6   Development of Control Circuit                                      6
            1.6.1   Development of Two-wire and Three-wire Control              6
            1.6.2   Remote Control Operation of a Motor                         8
            1.6.3   Interlocking of Drives                                      9

2     CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS                                               11
      2.1   Introduction                                                       11
      2.2   Fuses, Switches and Fuse Switch Units                              12
      2.3   Moulded Case Circuit Breaker and Miniature Circuit Breaker
            (MCCB & MCB)                                                       14
      2.4   Contactors                                                         16
            2.4.1   Solenoid Type Contactor                                    16
            2.4.2   Clapper Type Contactor                                     17
            2.4.3   Lock-out Type Contactor                                    19
            2.4.4   Inductive Accelerating Contactors                          20
      2.5   Contactor Ratings                                                  21
      2.6   Relays                                                             22
            2.6.1   Voltage Relays                                             23
            2.6.2   D.C. Series Current Relay                                  24
            2.6.3   Frequency Responsive Relay                                 25
            2.6.4   Latching Relays                                            26
      2.7   Overload Relays                                                    28
            2.7.1   Bimetallic Thermal Overload Relay                          28
            2.7.2   Ratchet Type Eutectic Alloy Relay                          30
            2.7.3   Magnetic Dash Pot Oil Filled Relay                         30
      2.8   Time Delay Relays (Timers)                                         32
            2.8.1   Thermal Timer                                              33
                                          ix

dharm
d:N-MachTITLE.pm5   vi
x

             2.8.2    Pneumatic Timer                                               33
             2.8.3    Motor Driven Timers                                           35
             2.8.4    Electronic Timer                                              36
      2.9    Phase Failure Relay (Single Phasing Preventer)                         37
      2.10   Push Button Switches                                                   39
      2.11   Selector Switches                                                      40
      2.12   Drum Switches                                                          42
      2.13   Limit Switches                                                         42
             2.13.1 A Simple Limit Switch                                           43
             2.13.2 Rotary Cam Type Limit Switches                                  45
             2.13.3 Heavy Duty Limit Switches                                       45
             2.13.4 Speed Actuating Sensing Switches                                46
      2.14   Solenoid Valves                                                        46
      2.15   Pressure Switches                                                      48
      2.16   Pressure Transducer                                                    50
      2.17   Temperature Switches (Thermostats)                                     51
      2.18   Float Switch                                                           52
      2.19   Control Transformer                                                    54
      2.20   Symbols for Various Components                                         55
      2.21   Control Diagrams                                                       56

3     STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR                                      63
      3.1    Introduction                                                           63
             3.1.1   Motor Current at Start and During Acceleration                 64
             3.1.2   No-load Speed and Final Speed of Motor                         65
             3.1.3   Starting of Motor                                              66
      3.2    Primary Resistor Type Starters                                         67
             3.2.1   Manual Primary Resistor Type Starter                           67
             3.2.2   Semi-automatic Stepless Resistance Starter                     69
             3.2.3   Automatic Primary Resistor Type Starter                        70
      3.3    Increment Resistance Starter                                           71
      3.4    Line-reactor Reduced Voltage Starter                                   73
      3.5    Auto-Transformer Reduced Voltage Starters                              75
             3.5.1   Manual Auto-transformer Starter                                76
             3.5.2   Automatic Auto-transformer Starter (Open Circuit Transition)   77
             3.5.3   Auto-transformer Voltage Starter (Closed Circuit Transition)   79
      3.6    Part Winding Motor Starter                                             82
             3.6.1   Two Step Starting                                              83
             3.6.2   Three Step Starting                                            84
      3.7    Star-Delta Starter                                                     85
             3.7.1   Manual Star-delta Starter                                      87
             3.7.2   Push-button Operated Manual Star-delta Starter                 88
             3.7.3   Semi-automatic Star-delta Starter                              89




dharm
d:N-MachTITLE.pm5     vii
xi

             3.7.4   Automatic Star-delta Starter (Open Circuit Transition)         91
             3.7.5   Automatic Star-delta Starter (Closed Circuit Transition)       92
      3.8    Starters for Multi-Speed Motors                                        95
             3.8.1   Starter for Two-speed, Two Winding (Separate Winding) Motor    97
             3.8.2   Two Speed One Winding (Consequent Pole) Motor Starter          99
      3.9    Reversing the Direction of Rotation of Induction Motors               102
      3.10   Plug Stopping of Motor                                                103
      3.11   Dynamic Braking                                                       104

4     STARTERS FOR WOUND ROTOR INDUCTION MOTORS                                    109
      4.1    Introduction                                                          109
      4.2    Motor Acceleration                                                    111
      4.3    Manual Face Plate Starter                                             113
      4.4    Manual Starter Using Master Controllers                               115
      4.5    Automatic Control of Acceleration                                     116
             4.5.1   Definite Time Limit Starter                                   116
             4.5.2   Current Limit Acceleration Starter                            120
             4.5.3   Secondary Frequency Acceleration Starter                      121

5     STARTERS FOR DIRECT CURRENT MOTORS                                           124
      5.1    Types of DC Motors and their Applications                             124
             5.1.1    Shunt Motor                                                  124
             5.1.2    Series Motor                                                 124
             5.1.3    Compound Motor                                               125
      5.2    Principles of DC Motor Acceleration                                   125
      5.3    Manual Starters for DC Motors                                         129
             5.3.1    Two-point Starter                                            129
             5.3.2    Three-point Starter                                          129
             5.3.3    Four-point Starter                                           130
      5.4    Types of Starters for Automatic Acceleration                          131
             5.4.1    Direct-on-line Starter                                       132
             5.4.2    Current Limit Acceleration Starters                          133
             5.4.3    Definite Timer Acceleration Starters                         137
      5.5    Reversing of DC Motors                                                140
      5.6    Jogging Operation of Motor                                            143
      5.7    Dynamic Breaking of Motor                                             144
      5.8    Plugging Circuit for DC Motor                                         146

6     CONTROL OF SINGLE PHASE MOTORS                                               149
      6.1    Types of Single Phase Motors                                          149
      6.2    Universal Series Motors                                               150
             6.2.1   Reversing Direction of Rotation of Universal Motor            150
             6.2.2   Speed Control of Universal Motor                              152



dharm
d:N-MachTITLE.pm5    viii
xii

      6.3   Shaded Pole Motor                                                       153
      6.4   Split Phase Motors                                                      155
            6.4.1   Standard Split Phase Motors                                     155
            6.4.2   Capacitor Type Split Phase Motors                               157
            6.4.3   Starters for Capacitor Type Split Phase Motors                  157
            6.4.4   Starter for Two Value Capacitor Type Split-phase Motors         158
            6.4.5   Starter for a Two Value Capacitor Motor Using a Current Relay
                    and an Auto Transformer                                         159
            6.4.6   Dynamic Breaking of Split Phase Motors                          160
            6.4.7   Plug Reversing of Capacitor Start Motors                        160
            6.4.8   Speed Control of Split Phase Motors                             161
            6.4.9   Speed Control of Permanent Split Capacitor Motors               162

7     CONTROL OF SYNCHRONOUS MOTORS                                                 165
      7.1   Construction and Operation of a Synchronous Motor                       165
      7.2   Manual Push Button Synchronising Starter                                166
      7.3   Timed Semi-automatic Synchronising                                      167
      7.4   Automatic Starter Using Polarised Field Frequency Relay                 167

8     PROTECTION OF MOTORS                                                          171
      8.1   Protection of AC Motors                                                 171
      8.2   Co-Ordination of Fuse, Overload Relay and Contactor/Circuit
            Breaker Operating Characteristics                                       171
      8.3   Overload, Short Circuit, and Over-temperature Protection                172
            8.3.1    Overload and Short Circuit Protection                          172
            8.3.2    Over Temperature Protection                                    175
            8.3.3    Under Voltage Protection                                       176
            8.3.4    Phase Failure and Phase Reversal Protection                    177
      8.4   Protection of DC Motors                                                 178
            8.4.1    Field Failure Protection Circuit for DC Shunt Motors           178
            8.4.2    Field Acceleration Protection Circuit                          179
            8.4.3    Field Deceleration Protection Circuit                          181

9     INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS                                                   184
      9.1   Introduction                                                            184
      9.2   Planer Machine                                                          184
      9.3   Skip Hoist Control                                                      187
      9.4   Automatic Control for a Water Pump                                      189
      9.5   Lifting Magnet                                                          191
      9.6   Control of Electrical Oven                                              193
      9.7   Overhead Crane                                                          196
      9.8   Battery Trolley                                                         202
      9.9   Battery Operated Truck                                                  205



dharm
d:N-MachTITLE.pm5    ix
xiii

      9.10   Air Compressor                                               208
      9.11   Walking Beam                                                 212
      9.12   Conveyor System                                              217
      9.13   Elevator                                                     222

10    TROUBLESHOOTING IN CONTROL CIRCUITS                                 231
      10.1   Introduction                                                 231
      10.2   Trouble Spots                                                232
             10.2.1 Fuses                                                 232
             10.2.2 Loose Connections                                     232
             10.2.3 Faulty Contacts                                       233
             10.2.4 Incorrect Wire Marking                                234
             10.2.5 Combination Problems                                  234
             10.2.6 Low Voltage                                           235
             10.2.7 Grounding                                             235
             10.2.8 Momentary Faults                                      236
             10.2.9 Poor Maintenance                                      237
      10.3   General Procedure for Troubleshooting                        237

11    STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES                                          242
      11.1  Introduction                                                  242
      11.2  Advantages of Static Control Over Magnetic Relay Control      243
      11.3  Disadvantages of Static Control Over Magnetic Relay Control   244
      11.4  Explanation of Different Gates                                245
            11.4.1 AND Gate                                               245
            11.4.2 OR Gate                                                246
            11.4.3 NOT Gate or Inverter                                   248
            11.4.4 NOR Gate                                               248
            11.4.5 NAND Gate                                              249
            11.4.6 Exclusive OR Gate                                      249
      11.5 Solid State Timer                                              250
      11.6 Memory Elements (Off-return Type)                              251
            11.6.1 Clocked RS Flip-Flop                                   253
            11.6.2 JK Flip-Flop                                           253
      11.7 Retentive Memory Element                                       254
      11.8 Development of Logic Circuits                                  255
      11.9 Input Devices for Solid State Logic                            259
            11.9.1 Capacitive Switch Filters                              259
            11.9.2 Bounce Eliminators                                     260
            11.9.3 Signal Converters                                      261
      11.10 Output Devices for Solid State Logic                          263
      11.11 Solenoid Valve Operated Cylinder Piston Assembly              264
      11.12 Control of Three Stage Air Conditioning System                265



dharm
d:N-MachTITLE.pm5    x
xiv

      11.13   Speed Control of Wound Rotor Induction Motor                      267
      11.14   Control of Planer Machine                                         269
      11.15   Control of Three Conveyors                                        272
      11.16   Shift Register                                                    274
      11.17   Conveyor System Using a Shift Register                            275
      11.18   Counter                                                           277
      11.19   Decoder                                                           278
      11.20   Loading of Castings into Annealing Furnace Using Decade Counter
              and Decoder                                                       279
      11.21   Mono Shot                                                         281
      11.22   Clock                                                             282
      11.23   Automatic Filling of Silos Using a Clock and a Mono Shot          283
      11.24   Down Counter                                                      285
      11.25   Encoder                                                           286
      11.26   Product Dispersion Conveyor System Using a Down-counter,
              an Encoder, a Mono Shot and a Timer                               287

12    PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER                                             291
      12.1    Introduction                                                      291
      12.2    Input/Output Section                                              294
              12.2.1 Fixed I/O                                                  294
              12.2.2 Modular I/O                                                295
      12.3    Discrete Input Modules                                            296
              12.3.1 AC Discrete Input Module                                   297
              12.3.2 DC Discrete Input Module                                   298
      12.4    Discrete Output Modules                                           299
              12.4.1 AC Output Module                                           299
              12.4.2 DC Output Modules                                          301
              12.4.3 Rating of Output Modules                                   301
      12.5    Analog I/O Modules                                                302
      12.6    Safety Circuit                                                    303
      12.7    Processor Unit                                                    303
              12.7.1 Internal Self Diagnostic System                            307
              12.7.2 Memory Types                                               307
              12.7.3 Input Image Table                                          308
              12.7.4 Output Image Table                                         308
              12.7.5 User Program Memory                                        309
              12.7.6 Variable Data Memory                                       309
      12.8    Programming Device                                                310
              12.8.1 Dedicated Desktop Programmers                              310
              12.8.2 Hand-held Programmers                                      311
              12.8.3 Computer Programmers                                       311
              12.8.4 Advantages of Using Personal Computers for Programming     312




dharm
d:N-MachTITLE.pm5     xi
xv

            12.8.5  Disadvantages of Using Personal Computer for Programming
                    a PLC                                                          313
      12.9 Fundamental PLC Programming                                             313
            12.9.1 Introduction                                                    313
            12.9.2 Physical Components Versus Program Components                   315
            12.9.3 Examine ON Instruction                                          316
            12.9.4 Examine OFF Instruction                                         317
            12.9.5 Internal Relay Instruction                                      317
            12.9.6 Latching Instruction                                            317
            12.9.7 Output Instruction                                              318
            12.9.8 Programming Stop Push-buttons                                   318
            12.9.9 Logical Holding Instructions Versus Discrete Holding Contacts   320
            12.9.10 Overload Contacts                                              320
            12.9.11 Master Control Relay Instruction                               321
            12.9.12 Branch Open and Branch Close Instructions                      323
            12.9.13 Timer Instruction                                              325
            12.9.14 Counter Instruction                                            327
            12.9.15 Sequencer Instruction                                          329
            12.9.16 Basic Operation of Time Driven Output Sequencer Instruction    331
      12.10 A Simple Programming Example                                           332
            12.10.1 Sand Mixing Machine                                            332
            12.10.2 Relay Ladder Logic Diagram                                     332
            12.10.3 Ladder Logic Program on PLC for Sand Mixing Machine            334
            12.10.4 Explanation for the Ladder Program                             334

      References and Suggestions for Further Study                                 338




dharm
d:N-MachTITLE.pm5   xii
THIS PAGE IS
  BLANK
Introduction to Control of Machines


       1.1 GENERAL IDEA OF CONTROLS
A machine, as we know, is a device consisting of several interconnecting parts which by their
motion, transform/transmit power to do some work. The motion of various parts of a machine
can be obtained by using two types of devices, viz.
       (i) an electrical motor
    (ii) a solenoid valve and cylinder piston assembly operated by a compressor or a pump.
     A constant rotational motion developed by a motor can be converted into linear mechanical
movement through rack and pinion arrangement connected to the motor shaft.
       In solenoid valve and cylinder piston assembly, fluid or air pressure is applied to cylinder
piston through a solenoid valve. Solenoid valve consists of a mechanical valve operated through
an electrical coil. Fig. 1.1 shows how a cylinder piston is used to get linear to and fro motion of
a machine part. A spring returned solenoid valve is also shown in Fig. 1.1.

           Cylinder   Piston                                            Cylinder     Piston




       A         B                                              A        B


       D         C                                             D         C
Coil                       Spring                                                   Spring
                                                              Exhaust
       Exhaust


                         Air                                                          Air
                       Receiver                                                    receiver
                                    Compressor Motor                                          Compressor Motor
                         (a)                                                        (b)

       Fig. 1.1 Operation of a solenoid valve (a) solenoid coil de-energised (b) solenoid coil energised
     In Fig. 1.1 (a) the solenoid coil is de-energised and ports of the valve are connected as
shown by arrows. Port A is connected to exhaust while port B is connected to air receiver in


                                                       1
2                                                                        CONTROL OF MACHINES

which air is stored at a high pressure. The machine part connected to the piston will be in the
position as shown. This is due to air pressure acting on the right-hand side of the piston.
       When the solenoid coil is energised, a spool will get shifted in the valve and now the
ports of the valve will get connected as shown by arrows in Fig. 1.1 (b). Port A gets connected
to pressurised air while port B gets connected to exhaust. The piston will thus move forward to
the extreme end due to air pressure on the left-hand side of the piston. In this arrangement
also, of course a motor is used as drive for the air compressor or the pump (if fluid is used) to
build up air or fluid pressure. Thus it is seen that a motor is the heart of all machinery whether
its output is used directly or indirectly. In this text the main emphasis is on the study of
control of motors. However some control circuits using solenoid valves will also be taken up.
Now we will proceed to discuss methods of control of motors.

   1.2 DISADVANTAGES OF MANUAL CONTROL
When electric motors were first introduced, simple manual switches were used to start and
stop the motor. The only protective device used was the fuse. Progress was subsequently made
along the lines of improving the reliability, flexibility and make-break performance of the
manual switches. In those days one large motor was used to drive a line shaft through a belt
pulley arrangement. Individual machines were then connected to the line shaft through belt
and pulley arrangements. This system of driving a number of individual loads from a common
line shaft and manual switching of motors had many disadvantages as listed below:
     • Starting, stopping and speed control of motor had to be performed by hand every time.
       The operator had to move a manual switching device from one position to another.
       • Switching of large motors required great physical effort.
       • Operator had to remain continuously alert to watch indicators so as to adjust motor
         performance according to drive requirements.
       • Sequence operations of number of motors could not be accomplished in common line
         shaft arrangement.
       • The varied needs of individual machines like frequent starts and stops, periodic reversal
         of direction of rotation, high-starting torque requirement, constant speed, variable speed,
         etc., could not be accomplished in common line shaft arrangement.

   1.3 INTRODUCTION TO MAGNETIC CONTROL
The disadvantages of common line shaft arrangement necessitated the use of small motors on
individual machines instead of one large motor in line shaft arrangement. The use of individual
motors on different machines made the machine shop or factory more flexible.
       Introduction of electromagnetic CONTACTORS AND RELAYS, that is, devices actuated
by electromagnets and requiring only a small power for actuation as compared to the power
switched ON through their main contacts, led to the much desired control of machines possible.
The word control means to govern or regulate. By control of a motor we mean regulation or
governing of its various operations like starting, stopping, acceleration, reversal of direction of
rotation, speed variation, protection etc. Fig. 1.2 shows the connections for manual and magnetic
control of a small squirrel cage induction motor using push buttons.
       In a simple manual control the motor starts when the main switch is closed by the
operator. The motor is protected by fuses as shown in Fig. 1.2 (a). In Fig. 1.2 (b) an
electromagnetic contactor is used to switch on the motor. Before we discuss the working of the
circuit, it is essential to be familiar with the working principle of a contactor. Various types of
contactors, however, will be discussed in detail in the next chapter.




dharm
d:N-MachMac1-1.pm5      2
INTRODUCTION TO CONTROL OF MACHINES                                                             3




             Fig. 1.2 Manual and Magnetic control of a small squirrel cage induction motor
        In Fig. 1.3 it is seen that a coil is wound on the fixed core while the contacts are mounted
on the moveable core, called the armature. The contacts remain in the normal position as
shown in Fig. 1.3 (a) i.e., when the coil remains de-energised. The spring (S) keeps the main
and the auxiliary contacts in the position shown. In Fig. 1.3 (b) the contactor is shown with its
coil in energised condition. As soon as the coil is energised, the armature i.e., the movable core
is attracted towards the fixed core against the pressure of spring (S). The contacts thus change
their positions. The normally open main contacts close. Simultaneously auxiliary contacts also
change their positions. The normally open contacts close and normally close contacts open.
The main contacts are used for switching the power to the motor while auxiliary contacts are
used in the control circuit. When the coil is again de-energised armature comes back to its
original position due to the tension of the spring (S).
        Now let us refer back again to the starting circuit of motor in Fig. 1.2 (b). In this figure
there are two separate circuits, i.e., the power circuit and the control circuit. Supply to the
control circuit is isolated from the main supply using a control transformer T1. Alternatively,
a phase and neutral can also be used for providing supply to the control circuit. The motor can
be switched ON and OFF with the help of push buttons. These push button switches require
small force to actuate their contacts. These contacts remain operated as long as pressure is
applied and they return to their normal position when pressure is released.
        In this circuit when the ON-push button is pressed, contact P2 closes. Supply from
secondary terminal of the control transformer reaches the contactor coil through contacts, P1
(OFF-push button), P2, (ON-push button) and the over-load relay contact OL. The other terminal
of the coil is connected directly to the terminal b1 of the transformer. The coil is thus energised




dharm
d:N-MachMac1-1.pm5     3
4                                                                              CONTROL OF MACHINES


                                                Normally closed

                                                   Auxiliary
                                                   contacts
                                                 Normally open




                                                   Normally
                                                    open
                                                      Main
                                                    contacts




                                                   Armature



                                                    Spring




              Switch                                              Switch
                                                                             I
             Supply                                              Supply



                           (a)                                             (b)
       Fig. 1.3 Operation of an electromagnetic type contactor (a) coil de-energised (b) coil energised
and contactor closes its main contacts M1, M2, M3 and the auxiliary contact M4. Closing of
contact M4 bypasses ON-push button contact P2. Now if pressure on the ON-push button is
released contact P2 will open but supply to contactor coil M would reach through closed contact
M4 connected in parallel with contact P2. This contact M4 is known as holding or sealing contact.
A bimetallic thermal over-load is also shown connected in the power circuit. If motor draws
more current than its rated value, thermal relay contact OL opens and de-energises coil M.
De-energisation of coil opens the contacts M1, M2, M3 and M4. Supply to motor stops and holding
of control supply through M4 is also broken. Motor can also be stopped by pressing the OFF-
push button. When OFF-push button contact P1 opens, coil M is de-energised and thus holding
of supply through contact M4 is broken. Motor can be switched on again by pressing the ON-
push button. This circuit that we have discussed is also known as direct-on-line starting of
motors. This is the simplest control circuit in the field of industrial control.

   1.4 ADVANTAGES OF MAGNETIC CONTROL
Having discussed the starting and stopping of a motor by using control devices like push buttons,
contactors and over-load relays, we are in a position to discuss the advantages of magnetic
control over the manual control. The various advantages are listed as follows:




dharm
d:N-MachMac1-1.pm5        4
INTRODUCTION TO CONTROL OF MACHINES                                                           5

     • Magnetic control permits installation of power contacts close to motor whereas the
       actuating control device i.e., a push button switch could be located away from the motor
       in a position most convenient to the operator.
     • Magnetic control provides safety to the operator as remote operation described above
       minimises the danger to the operator of coming into accidental contact with live parts
       or being exposed to power arc and flashes at the main contacts.
     • The most important advantage of magnetic control is the elimination of dependence on
       operators’ skill for control of motor performance. Current and torque peaks could be
       limited thus resulting in less wear and less maintenance.
     • Magnetic control also makes interlocking (to be discussed later) between various
       operations of a multi motor drive easy. The various operations can be performed in the
       desired sequence automatically.
     • With the demand for more production in industry, it became necessary to automise the
       machinery to meet the challenge. Today in our industrial plants most of the machines
       are automatic. Once the machine is started most of the operations are carried out
       automatically.

   1.5 SEMI-AUTOMATIC AND AUTOMATIC CONTROL OF MODERN
       MACHINERY
Control of a machine can be semi-automatic or fully automatic. There are probably more
machines operated by semi-automatic control than by manual or fully automatic controls.
Consider, for example, an over-head tank which supplies drinking water to a factory.
       If we provide a manual switch near the pump motor and depute an operator to switch it
ON when water level falls, then this is classified as manual control. Here, the operator has to
go to the pump site to fill the tank. For the same pump if a magnetic starter is provided near
the pump motor and for its starting, a switch is provided near foreman’s desk it may be classified
as a semi-automatic control. A lamp indication or a bell can also be provided near the desk to
indicate if the tank is full. The foreman can switch ON the pump from his desk without going
to the pump site. Over-flow can also be avoided by switching OFF the pump when the lamp
glows or the bell rings. If a float switch is provided in the tank to switch ON the pump motor
when water level falls below a certain lower limit, and switch it OFF when water level rises
beyond a certain upper limit, then the control becomes fully automatic. The cost of installation
of an automatic control system will be higher than the other two types of controls. However, an
automatic control arrangement relieves the operator from the task of keeping an eye on the
water level and operate the pump. Also there is no danger of over-flow from the tank. Thus it
is seen that the basic difference in manual, semi-automatic and fully automatic control lies in
the flexibility it provides to the system being controlled.
       The study of control circuits involves study of the construction and principle of operation
of various control components and learning the art of designing control circuits for various
functions of machines. In this text, we have first discussed the various control components and
then control schemes for ac and dc motors. Some important industrial control circuits have
also been discussed.
       Modern machines have large number of operations requiring extensive control circuits
consisting of large number of relays. Thus the control panel occupies a lot of space and control
circuit design also becomes tedious.
       Static control is used for such machines as the control design is easy with static control
devices. The static devices used for design of control circuits are the digital logic gates. With



dharm
d:N-MachMac1-1.pm5    5
6                                                                       CONTROL OF MACHINES

much advancement in the field of computers this static control is also becoming obsolete as
more and more machines are now being controlled by programmable controllers. Inspite of all
these developments as far as single motor control or a machine having few operations is
concerned, the magnetic control using contactor and relay will continue to be in use because it
is the simplest and cheapest method of control for such applications.

   1.6 DEVELOPMENT OF CONTROL CIRCUIT
1.6.1 Development of Two-wire and Three-wire Control
In this section we will explain the various steps of developing a control circuit. A control circuit
is to be drawn in a simple form between two horizontal lines designated by 1, which denotes a
phase and by 0, which denotes the neutral wire. In this section also explained are some control
functions like remote operation, inter-locking of drives etc.
       As shown in Fig. 1.4 a motor is connected to supply through a switch fuse unit, a contactor,
and an overload relay. For developing the control circuit, we take a phase say L1 and neutral
as shown in the figure. A control fuse is connected in phase L1 and outgoing control supply
wire is numbered 1 and neutral is numbered 0.




                               Fig. 1.4 Development of control circuit
      Now we will study how the control circuit for energising a motor is developed. The
motor is energised by closing the contactor and stopped due to opening of the contactor.
        One method of designing of the control circuit is to connect a simple selector switch S
and an overload relay control contact in series with control supply wire no. 1 and then connect
it to contactor coil M as shown in Fig. 1.5. When switch S is open there is no supply at terminal 2




dharm
d:N-MachMac1-1.pm5     6
INTRODUCTION TO CONTROL OF MACHINES                                                            7

and, therefore, M remains de-energised. When the switch, S is closed supply reaches terminal
3 through the normally closed overload relay contact OL and thus the coil M is energised. The
motor gets supply because of closing of the main contacts of the contactor (not shown in the
figure). This control circuit just developed is known as two wire control. In this type of control
circuit, however, the motor would automatically start when power supply to the motor is restored
after a failure. This type of control is only useful for starting of motors at remote places, e.g.,
starting of water pump for filling an over-head tank. Here the advantage is that the operator
is not required to switch on the motor when power supply is restored after a failure. This type
of control may however be dangerous in industries and can cause accidents due to sudden
restarting of motors on restoration of power supply. Thus the control circuit of Fig. 1.5 has
very limited application due to safety reasons.




                                  Fig. 1.5 Two wire control circuit

       Now let us develop a control circuit using push button switches. The normally open
contacts of these push buttons remain closed as long as the button is kept pressed by hand.
Each push button has one normally open (NO) and one normally closed (NC) contact. To use a
push button as stop (OFF) switch, the normally closed (NC) contact is generally used and for
start (ON) operation the normally open contact (NO) is generally used. In Fig. 1.6 the stop and
start push buttons and the over-load relay control contact have been connected in series with
the contactor coil.
       Under normal conditions as the STOP-push button contact is normally closed supply
would reach upto terminal 2. When START-push button is pressed supply would reach the
contactor coil and hence the contactor would get energised. The coil will remain energised as
long as the START-push button is held pressed. As soon as the pressure on the START-push
button is released, the supply is cut off at terminal 3 and the coil is de-energised. To develop
the circuit further i.e., to ensure that the coil remains energised permanently once the push
button is pressed, we connect an auxiliary contact M1 of contactor M in parallel with the push
button as shown in Fig. 1.6 (b). When the coil M is energised, along with the main contacts the
auxiliary contact M1 also closes. The supply from terminal 2 now has two parallel paths i.e.,
one through the closed contact of the START-push button and the other through the closed
contact M1. Thus even when the pressure on the START-push button is released, supply reaches
coil M through closed contact M1. Thus supply to coil M is held (or sealed) through its own




dharm
d:N-MachMac1-1.pm5     7
8                                                                                 CONTROL OF MACHINES

          1                            1                          1



          Stop                        Stop                        Stop                       M2

                     2                         2                             2           5

                                                         M1                         M1
             Start                         Start                     Start

                     3                                                       3
                                                   3



                     4                             4                         4
                                                                                             Indication
                     M                              M                         M                lamp

         0                            0                          0
                     (a)                           (b)                       (c)

                               Fig. 1.6 Development of three wire control circuit

contact M1. When it is desired to stop the motor, the STOP-push button is pressed and therefore
its normally closed contact opens and the coil M gets de-energised. De-energisation of coil M
also opens its sealing contact M1. Thus when the pressure on the STOP-push button is released
the coil does not get energised as both the parallel paths i.e., of the START-push button and
that of contact M1 are open. To start the motor again the START-push button has to be pressed.
It is therefore seen that unlike the control circuit of Fig. 1.5, here the control circuit does not
get energised when the power supply gets restored after a failure. Thus the danger of motors
getting restarted on restoration of power supply is eliminated. In case of over loading of the
motor the over-load relay contact opens and supply is disconnected at terminal 4 thereby de-
energising the contactor and subsequently stopping the motor. Even if the over-load protective
device is of auto reset type i.e., if its contact closes when the bimetallic elements cool down the
motor would not start on its own. However, in the two wire control circuit as in Fig. 1.5, if the
overload relay is of auto reset type the motor would restart automatically. Thus the motor may
get damaged due to repeated on-off on over loading. The control, we have just discussed in Fig.
1.6, is known as three wire control. This designation is given because in this control circuit,
three wires lead from a pilot device to the starter. The term two wire and three wires are used
as they describe the simplest application of the two types. Actually in control circuits any
number of wires can start from a pilot device in a three wire control. The control contact M1
used in parallel with the START-push button is called the holding contact or sealing contact.
The name is so because it holds/seals the contactor coil in the energised condition even when
START-push button switch is released. The step in further development of the circuit is to
have a ‘motor ON’ indication. An auxiliary contact M2 of contactor M is connected in series
with supply wire 1 to feed an indicator lamp terminal. Its other terminal being connected to
the neutral as shown in Fig. 1.6 (c).
1.6.2 Remote Control Operation of a Motor
In further development of circuit of Fig. 1.6 (c) it may be desired that starting and stopping of
the motor should also be possible from a distant place (remote place) while the starter being




dharm
d:N-MachMac1-1.pm5       8
INTRODUCTION TO CONTROL OF MACHINES                                                                                             9

fixed near the motor. In this case, obviously, the
control wire will have to be taken to the remote
START and STOP-push buttons from the starter.
Now, it is to be seen as to how the remote START-
STOP push buttons should be connected to the
circuit of Fig. 1.6 (c). The required connections for
remote control have been shown in Fig. 1.7.
        The remote STOP-push buttons have been
connected in series with local STOP-push button
and the remote START-push button has been
connected in parallel with local START-push
button. The motor can be started and stopped from
any number of locations by making connections
as above i.e., by connecting all the STOP-push
buttons in series and all the START-push buttons
in parallel. If the motor is to be started by some
other pilot device like pressure switch, thermostat
etc., the same may be made by connecting such a
device in parallel with START-push button. If such
a device is to be used for stopping also it is to be                                     Fig. 1.7 Control circuit for remote
connected in series with the STOP-push button.                                                  operation of a motor

1.6.3 Interlocking of Drives
We well now see how the control function of interlocking of drives is incorporated into the
circuits. Let us take motors A and B. It is required that motor B should start only after motor

           1                                                   1

               P1                  P3                                  P1                 P3                  P5


                    2                      5                                2                  5                   9
                                       P4
               P2           A1                     B1                  P2           A1   P4              B1   P6            C1

                    3                      6                                3                  6                   10

                                                                                           A2                  A3
                                                                                                                        11
                                                                                                               B2
                                                                                               7
                                                                                                                        12



                    4                       7                               4                  8                        13
                        A                      B                                A                  B                    C

           0                                                       0
                                 (a)                                                               (b)

                                                        Fig. 1.8 Interlocking of drives




dharm
d:N-MachMac1-1.pm5                   9
10                                                                         CONTROL OF MACHINES

A has started. It should however be possible to stop the motor independently. The first step
would be to develop the starters of motor A and motor B independently as shown in Fig. 1.8.
       In order that contactor B should energise only when contactor A is energised we will
have to insert a normally open contact of contactor A in series with the contactor coil B after
terminal 6 as shown in Fig. 1.8 (b). As shown in the figure a normally open contact A2 has been
connected after wire No. 6. Thus when contactor A is not energised the contact A2 will be open.
If we press the push button P4 the supply will reach upto terminal 6 only. The contactor coil B
can be energised only when contactor A is energised i.e., only when its contact A2 is closed.
       If in the above circuit it is further required that a motor C should run only if both motors
A and B are running, we will be able to get this function by connecting normally open contacts
of contactor A and B in series with the coil of contactor C. This development is also shown in
Fig. 1.8 (b). When push button P6 is pressed the supply will reach coil of contactor C at terminal
13, only if contacts A3 and B2 are closed i.e., only when both contactors A and B are energised.
When either of the two motors is not running motor C can not be started.

                                    REVIEW QUESTIONS
  1.  State the disadvantages of using manual control for control operations of electrical motors.
  2.  Name the devices which led to the use of automatic control for motors.
  3.  State the advantages of magnetic control over manual control.
  4.  What is the difference between semi-automatic and automatic control?
  5.  What will happen if the plunger of a contactor is prevented from completing its stroke?
  6.  When will a contactor coil take maximum current and why?
  7.  Under what conditions static control is preferred against magnetic control?
  8.  Explain why magnetic control is used for control having few operations.
  9.  State the difference between a two wire and a three wire control.
 10.  When the plunger of a contactor is in closed position the coil current is:
     (a) maximum
     (b) minimum
      (c) zero.
 11. When the contactor coil is de-energised:
     (a) the contacts remain closed
     (b) are held closed by mechanical latch
      (c) gravity and spring tension open the contacts.
 12. The purpose of using over load protection in a motor is to protect the motor from:
     (a) sustained overcurrent
     (b) over voltage
      (c) short circuit
     (d) all the above.




dharm
d:N-MachMac1-1.pm5    10
Control Circuit Components


   2.1 INTRODUCTION
All components used in motor control may be classified as either primary control devices or as
pilot control devices. A primary control device is one which connects the load to the device,
such as switch, fuse switch unit, circuit breaker, contactor, overload relay etc. Pilot devices are
those which control the primary control devices. Pilot devices comprise items like selector
switch, push button switch, float switch, pressure switch, limit switch, thermostat etc. Fig. 2.1
shows the control scheme in block diagram form of an induction motor for an air compressor.




                  Fig. 2.1 Block diagram for automatic control of a compressor motor
                                                 11
12                                                                           CONTROL OF MACHINES

     As shown in Fig. 2.1 power to the compressor motor is controlled i.e., switched ON or
OFF through a contactor. Contactor closes its main contacts when its coil is energised. As
shown in the block diagram the contactor coil is controlled through the following:
      (a) Oil lubrication pressure switch: The contactor is switched off if oil lubrication pres-
          sure for compressor falls below a certain limit;
      (b) Cooling water temperature switch: The contactor is switched off if the temperature of
          water being used for cooling the compressor rises above a certain limit;
      (c) Cooling water flow switch: The contactor is switched off if flow of cooling water to the
          compressor stops;
      (d) Air reservoir pressure switch: The contactor is switched off when air pressure in the
          reservoir becomes higher than the set limit;
      (e) ON-push button: The contactor is energised initially through ON-push button when
          all the above mentioned conditions are favourable to run the compressor;
      (f) OFF-push button: Pressing of the OFF-push button at any time will switch off the
          contactor due to the de-energisation of its coil.
      From the block diagram it is clear that control of the compressor motor involves use of
two separate circuits. One is the power circuit which consists of isolator switch, fuse, contactor
and overload relay. The second circuit is control circuit which consists of ON and OFF push
button switches, pressure switches for the lubricating oil of the compressor and for air in the
reservoir, flow switch and temperature switch for cooling water of the compressor. All these
components in the control circuit are pilot devices and provides a means for controlling the
motor.
      In the following sections all these primary control devices and pilot control devices have
been discussed.

   2.2 FUSES, SWITCHES AND FUSE SWITCH UNITS
Both the power circuit and the control circuit of a control scheme are protected against short
circuit faults by means of fuses. Short circuit faults may occur due to mistakes made during
wiring, fault within the motor winding, or due to mechanical injury to the cable and wires.
      A fuse is a calibrated conductor which melts and breaks the circuit when current passing
through it increase beyond its calibrated value. The fuse element melts due to generation of
excessive heat under short circuit condition and thus isolates the circuit from the source of
power supply.
      Figure 2.2 shows the construction of a typical high rupturing capacity (HRC) fuse link.
                        Blade                Body       Filler




                                                 Element
                                Fig. 2.2 Construction of a typical HRC fuse
       The fuse element is surrounded by a filler material such as quartz sand which provides
effective heat transfer. The fuse exhibits inverse time current characteristic to the heat transfer
from the element. The fuse element can sustain small overloads for longer duration but in case




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-1.pm5   12
CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS                                                                                        13

of large overloads and short circuits the small cross-section
of the fuse element melts quickly and opens the circuit. Fig.
2.3 shows the typical time characteristic of a HRC fuse.
       Fuses are provided into the circuit through fuse base
and fuse carriers generally made of bakelite material. Fuse




                                                                     Melting Time
is inserted in the fuse carrier which is then fixed into the
fuse base.
       Figure 2.4 (a) shows the power circuit for a motor. It
includes four necessary elements for the control and
protection of motor. None of the items used can be eliminated                                 Current
as they incorporate four basic functions very different in                                Fig. 2.3 Characteristic of
nature.                                                                                          a HRC fuse
       Switch: To isolate the circuit for repairs and maintenance,
       Fuse/Fuse base: To provide short circuit protection,
       Contactor: To achieve automatic on-off of motor,
      Overload relay: To protect the motor against overloading.
      Development of a new type of switch gear, called fuse switch unit, has led to the use of
a modified power circuit as shown in Fig. 2.4 (b). This fuse switch unit came into existence
when the fuse base was integrated with switch.
       The advantages of using fuse switch unit are that the number of electrical joints becomes
less due to the elimination of one element from the circuit and hence requires less maintenance,
and the space occupied is less as the combination fuse switch occupies less space than fuse/fuse
base and switch when used separately.
            L1                                             L1
            L2                                             L2
            L3                                             L3


                                Switch                                                         Fuse switch
                                                                                                  unit

                                 Fuse



                                        C   Contactor                                               C

                                                                                                Contactor

                                 Overload                                                     Overload
                                  relay                                                        relay




                       M                                                            M
                       3~                                                           3~

                       (a)                                                          (b)
                             Fig. 2.4 Two types of power circuits for motor




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-1.pm5   13
14                                                                            CONTROL OF MACHINES

      Fuse switch units are of two types, namely, (i) where the fuse is stationary and (ii)
where the fuse is mounted on the moving assembly. Both the above types are in use. However,
the one having stationary fuse has the following advantages over the other type.
       — The moving assembly weight is less as it does not carry the fuse, thus it is more
         reliable against mechanical failure.
       — There is less deterioration of electrical joints between fuse and fuse switch.
      Switches and fuse switch units are manufactured upto a rating of 1000 A, 415 V with
breaking capacity of 50 KA. They are manufactured in standard ratings. For example Larsen
 Toubro Ltd. manufacture these in the ratings of 63 A, 100 A, 250 A, 400 A, 630 A and 800 A
while Siemens manufacture in standard ratings of 200 A, 400 A and 600 A. Switches and fuse
switch units are available in three-pole (TP) type and three pole neutral (TPN) type.

   2.3 MOULDED CASE CIRCUIT BREAKER AND MINIATURE CIRCUIT
       BREAKER (MCCB  MCB)
A slow and steady change to moulded case circuit breakers and miniature circuit breaker as an
alternative protection system to fuse switch units and air circuit breakers is taking place in
the Indian industry. As a result, distribution and control system without fuse are being designed
today.
       Miniature circuit breakers are manufactured in 1, 2, 3 and 4 pole versions upto fault
levels of 10 KA. They find applications in protection of lighting circuits, sub-distribution and
control circuits. Moulded case circuit breakers are available in higher ratings. L  T
manufactures MCCBs of rating 100 A, 200 A, 250 A, 450 A, 630 A, 800 A, 500 V, 50 Hz with
fault level withstanding capacity of 50 KA. They cover a wide range of applications in circuit
protection in branch feeders, motor circuits, transformer secondaries, lighting distribution
systems, capacitor switching and DC circuits.
       Figure 2.5 shows a DTH 100 L  T make MCCB.




                       Fig. 2.5 Photographic view of a Moulded Case Circuit Breaker




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-1.pm5     14
CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS                                                                     15

       An MCCB automatically isolates an electrical circuit under sustained overloads or short
circuits. A thermal release consisting of bimetallic elements having inverse time current tripping
characteristic trips the circuit breaker on sustained overload.
      The breaker is opened by an electromagnetic release in case of short circuit faults. When
the current is less than 10 times the setting of the thermal release the breaker trips due to
thermal release and when current exceeds 10 times its value, the breaker is opened by magnetic
release. The main features of a MCCB are:
      • The breaker is switched on by a toggle type switch. The operating mechanism is
          “quick-make, quick-break” and is independent of manual operation. The breaker
          cannot be held closed under fault conditions.
       •    The housing is made of heat resistant insulating material. All parts are enclosed in
            the housing except terminals which are accessible for external connections. Terminals
            have large dimensions to accept links or cable lugs.
       •    All phases are disconnected even when a fault occurs on only one of them. The
            operating switch gives a clear trip indication. It assumes a position midway between
            ON (1) and OFF (0) on tripping.
       • Arc chutes envelope each contact and draw the arc away from the contact tips thus
         quenching it rapidly. Silver alloy contacts having high arc resistance and long
         electrical life are used.
      The magnetic thermal release has three bimetals to provide thermal overload protection
and has an electromagnet for short circuit protection.
      The magnetic thermal release is direct acting. The settings of thermal as well as magnetic
release are adjusted over a wide range.
      MCCBs offer a number of advantages over conventional breakers and fuse switch units.
They are:
       (i) Operating switch is easy to handle. There is no down time and need for replacement
           of fuse. After the breaker trips, it can be switched on again simply by resetting it.
           When the breaker trips, the operating switch occupies mid-position between ON (1)
           and OFF (0). To reset the trip mechanism the operating switch is to be moved to
           OFF-position.
      (ii) In fuse switch units blowing of fuse on one of the phases results in single phasing.
           This problem is eliminated in MCCBs because a common trip bar ensures opening of
           all the phases even when a fault occurs on only one of them.
     (iii) MCCBs are five to ten times smaller in size and weight as compared to conventional
           air circuit breakers and fuse switch units of similar ratings. This results in saving on
           panel space and supporting structures. Table 1 shows range of L  T make DTH type
           MCCBs.
                             Table 1 L  T make standard DTH type MCCBs

      Standard rating               Setting range of thermal relay      Short circuit rating

           DTH-100                         12-100 A                    700 A non-adjustable
           DTH-250                         80-150 A                    375-2000 A adjustable
           DTH-400                         225-400 A                   960-2560 A adjustable
           DTH-630                         360-630 A                   1500-4500 A adjustable
           DTH-800                         600-800 A                   2600-6400 A adjustable




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-1.pm5    15
16                                                                               CONTROL OF MACHINES

   2.4 CONTACTORS
A contactor can be best described as a magnetically closed switch. It is the basic unit upon
which the motor starter is built. Contactors are also used for switching ON and OFF of heavy
loads like furnaces, heaters, capacitors, etc. A contactor consists of an electromagnet, a movable
core, sets of stationary and moving contacts and an arc quenching structure. Contactors can be
broadly classified in to two general types:
       (a) Solenoid type
       (b) Clapper type
       There are other contactors for specific applications such as lock-out type and inductive
accelerating type used in dc motor controls.
2.4.1 Solenoid Type Contactor
In this type the movable contacts are attached to the movable core of a magnet. When the
electromagnet coil is energised, the movable core is pulled to the stationary core, thus closing
the contacts. Fig. 2.6 (a) shows a solenoid type contactor. For better understanding, the contacts
have been shown mounted in vertical plane though actually the contacts are in horizontal
plane.




                                                         Contacts mounted here

                                                                    NO contact
                                                       (Only one contact shown)

                                                                Spring

                                                             Armature

                                                          Shading ring

                                                        Stationary core
                                                        Contactor coil




                                                                                  (b)

              Fig. 2.6 (a) Solenoid type contactor (b) Contactor with E-type magnetic core
        Mounting of contacts in horizontal plane reduces the size of the contactor. The position
of plunger i.e., movable core shown in the figure is for the coil in de-energised state. When the
coil is energised, plunger moves up, moving contacts mounted on plunger also moves up and
closes the normally open contacts. At the same time normally closed contacts open. When the
coil is de-energised contacts are broken and they come back to their normal position by the pull
of gravity.



dharm
d:N-MachMac2-1.pm5   16
CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS                                                                         17

       The pole face of the magnet are provided with shading coil. This creates an out of phase
flux to hold the magnet closed during the zero points of alternating current thus preventing
chatter of the contactor. For contactors of higher ratings where chattering noise is to be avoided,
dc coil is used. The solenoid type of contactors shown in Fig. 2.6 (a) are used for small ratings.
For higher ratings E type construction for the magnetic core is used. A contactor with E type
magnetic core is shown in Fig. 2.6 (b).
      Symbols used for contactor coil, contactor with main and auxiliary contacts, and
photographic view of a contactor have been shown in Fig. 2.7.




  Contactor          Normally open      Normally closed
                      contact (NO)       contact (NC)




       Contactor with normally open
       and normally closed contacts
                               (a)                                                 (b)

        Fig. 2.7 (a) Symbols for contactor coil and contacts (b) Photographic view of a contactor

2.4.2 Clapper Type Contactor
In clapper type dc contactors the movable contacts are mounted on a hinged movable armature.
The hinged armature when pulled by magnetic core moves the movable contact in more or less
in the horizontal direction to make contact with the stationary contact mounted on the vertical
back-plate of the contactor.
       Figure 2.8 shows the general arrangement of the core, coil, contacts etc., of a clapper
type dc contactor. The magnet is shown to consist of a round solid core on which the coil is
mounted and a bent piece on which the moving armature is hinged. All parts of the magnetic
circuit are made from a soft steel having high permeability. The moving armature carries the
movable contacts. When the coil is energised the armature is attracted towards the core causing
the movable contacts to close against the stationary contacts. A movable contact is not rigidly
attached to the armature but is held in place by a spring and bolt. When the armature fully
closes, a spring exerts a force on the movable contact. The amount of force to be applied on the
moving contact can be varied with the help of a bolt on which the spring is fixed. Arcing horns
are provided on both the fixed and movable contacts. Arc shifts towards the arcing horns
during interruption thus saving the main contacts from damage. A blow out coil is also provided
to extinguish the arc. The action of blow out coil is shown in Fig. 2.9.
       A blow out coil is circular strip having an insulated solid core inside. Current flows from
fixed contact through the circular strip to the outlet terminal.




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-1.pm5      17
18                                                                                          CONTROL OF MACHINES

                                                              Arcing horn

                                                                      Blow out coil
                                              Fixed contact

                                                                                      Out going terminal
                                       Moving contact


                                                                                        Insulated iron core


                              Spring
                                                                                       Insulated bakelite
                                                                                             sheet

                       Bolt                                                            Flexible connection



                                                                                          Long bolt




                                                                                        Hinged armature
             Core

              Coil




                                               Incoming terminal




                              Fig. 2.8 Construction of a clapper type contactor




                                                                            Circular strip


                                                                              Solid insulated
                                                                                   core




                                                        Moving contact


                                          Fig. 2.9 Action of blow out coil




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-1.pm5     18
CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS                                                                   19

       When the contacts separate, the magnetic field set up due to current flowing through
the blow out coil exerts a force on the arc. Due to this force arc is elongated between the arcing
horns. The arc chutes provided over the fixed and moving contacts also help in quenching the
arc due to cooling action. Arc chutes also help to confine the arc and help avoid striking other
structural parts. The force exerted by magnetic coil on the arc depends upon the current flowing
through the coil. Force exerted is proportional to the square of the load current.
       A shunt blow out coil is sometimes used in contactors when current to be interrupted is
small. In this arrangment a constant blow out flux is obtained independent of the load current.
A similar effect is sometimes obtained by the use of a permanent blowout magnet.
       AC contactors of large rating are also built in clapper type with dc coil.
2.4.3 Lock-out Type Contactor
This type of contactor was primarily designed for the starting circuit of dc motors. Lock out
contactors are used for cutting the resistance of the armature circuit of a motor in steps. The
contactor is so designed that its contacts normally remain open. They also remain open during
the inrush current on starting of motors. The contactor consists of two coils i.e., a closing coil
and a lock-out coil. The lock-out coil prevents the contactor from closing during the inrush
current of the motor.
       The magnetic circuit of closing coil (A) is made of such magnetic material which gets
saturated easily. The magnetic circuit of the lock-out coil has air gaps and does not get saturated
easily. The pull exerted by the lock-out coil, therefore, varies much more widely with changes
in current than the pull of closing coil. The graph in Fig. 2.11 shows torque versus current
characteristics of both coils.

                                              Fixed contact



                       Moving
                       contact
                                                                   Insulated
                                                                 bakelite sheet


                                                                    Closing coil (A)




                                 Armature


                                                                    Closing coil (B)




                                     Fig. 2.10 Lock-out type contactor




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-1.pm5   19
20                                                                                   CONTROL OF MACHINES




                                                                        B


                              Torque on armature   Closing
                                                     coil


                                                                      Lock out
                                                                        coil




                                                                A        B
                                                             Ampere

                            Fig. 2.11 Torque versus current characteristic of coils

       Both the closing coil and the lock-out coil are connected in series with the motor circuit.
During starting, high inrush current flows which is beyond point B (see graph). For point
beyond B armature pull of lock-out coil is much greater than that of the closing coil (see
graph), thus the contacts remain open due to armature being pulled by lock out coil. As the
current drops below B the pull on armature increases for closing coil (refer point A on the
graph) and therefore the armature is pulled by the closing coil and the contacts close. The
closed contacts shorts the resistance in the armature circuit of the motor. The circuit is so
arranged that when the contactor closes the lock out coil is short-circuited thereby preventing
it from opening the contactor. This ensures that the contactor will remain closed after it has
operated. In some contactors closing coil may be shunt wound connected directly across the
line. This removes the disadvantage of possible opening of the series connected closing coil on
low loads. However, any variations in line voltage would affect the setting at which the contactor
would close.
     At one time lock out accelerating contactors were very popular due to their simplicity.
Now due to development of better and simpler accelerating means they are rarely used.
2.4.4 Inductive Accelerating Contactors
It is similar in appearance to the double coil lock out type contactor. However its lock out coil
(also known as hold out coil) magnetic circuit is highly inductive. The magnetic circuit of the
hold out coil is so designed that a certain fixed duration of time is required for the flux to die
down to a value to permit the closing coil to close the contactor. This time may be varied by
varying the air gap in the hold out magnetic circuit. The relative strengths of the closing coil
and the hold out coil is so adjusted that the contactor remains open with full line voltage on
closing coil and approximately 1 per cent of full line voltage on the holdout coil.
        The closing coil and hold out coil are energised at the same time and then the hold out
coil is short-circuited. The shor circuiting of holding coil will result in slow decay of flux in its
magnetic circuit. The closing coil will close the contacts when flux of hold out coil falls to a
certain low value. This type of contactors are also used in dc motor starting for cutting the
armature resistances in steps.



dharm
d:N-MachMac2-1.pm5   20
Control of machines
22                                                                         CONTROL OF MACHINES

       From the technical details it is also seen that the same contactor can be used with a dc,
control supply also. Resistors are connected in series with the ac standard rating coils for use
on dc supply. The electromagnetic coil picks up positively between 85 and 110 per cent of the
rated coil voltage. The drop off voltage for ac operated models is roughly between 65 and 45 per
cent and for dc operated models it is between 45 and 20 per cent of the rated coil voltage.
     The contact material used is silver alloy so as to avoid welding tendency of pure silver.
Some of the common alloys used are:
     — Silver Nickel
       — Silver Cadmium Oxide
       — Silver Tin Oxide
      Silver Nickel is good for contactors of lower ratings upto about 100 A. For higher size of
contactors, silver cadmium oxide is used as it has superior anti-weld property. The latest
innovation is the use of Silver Tin Oxide (AgSnO2) for contactors of higher ratings. Notable
advantages of Silver Tin Oxide are:
      • Erosion of contacts is very less
     • No toxic effect because of absence of cadmium.
     Table 4 gives standard ratings of contactors manufactured by Larsen  Toubro and
Siemens India Ltd.
                                Table 4 Standard contactor ratings

       L  T Make Type: Nominal Rating at               Siemens Make Type: Nominal Rating at
                 415 V, 50 Hz                                      415 V, 50 Hz

          MM00                      10 A                       0                      10 A
          ML0                       12 A                       1                      16 A
          ML1                       16 A                       2                      32 A
          ML1.5                     16 A                       4                      70 A
          ML2                       32 A                       8                     170 A
          ML3                       40 A
          ML6                     110 A
          ML7                     125 A
          ML10                    200 A
          ML12                    300 A


   2.6 RELAYS
The literary meaning of the word relay is to transmit information. The function of relays in
control circuit is also the same i.e., to sense or accept information from some sensing device
and feed it into control circuit at proper level. The sensing devices used in conjunction with
relays are known as pilot devices. Pilot devices, as described earlier, can sense or detect variables
like current, voltage, overload, frequency, temperature, pressure and many others. Besides
accepting information from pilot devices relays are also used to multiply the contacts available
on pilot devices. Timing relays may be used to count or to insert time delays in a control
circuit. In big machines large number of pilot devices like limit switches, proximity switches,
pressure switches etc., are used to control various operations. Relays are used to locate the
complex wiring in the panel by eliminating interwiring between pilot devices. Though extra




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-1.pm5   22
CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS                                                                    23

expenditure on account of using relays is involved, a lot of time is saved in trouble shooting i.e.,
locating faults in the control circuit. Figs. 2.12 (a) and (b) show how an air compressor motor
control circuit having four pilot devices can be wired with and without relays. The function of
various pilot devices used for control of compressor motor has already been discussed in the
beginning of the chapter (refer introduction to control components).




                            Fig. 2.12 Control diagram for a compressor motor

     Control relays used are similar in construction to a contactor and therefore the same
symbol of contactor coil is also used for ordinary voltage relays employed in control circuits.
       The working of the above circuit will be discussed at a later stage. Here let us observe
only the difference between the two circuits at (a) and (b) respectively. Note that the components
and the wiring enclosed by dotted lines in the figure are located in the control panel. In case of
any fault say, when the motor is not running, in the control circuit of Fig. 2.12 (b) the operator
can find out the condition of any pilot device by inspecting its respective control relay. If
indication lamps are also provided through relay contacts on the panel door he need not even
have to open the panel, indication lamps will indicate the condition of pilot devices. However,
in control circuit of Fig. 2.12 (a), although less number of components are used, it is difficult to
detect which of the pilot devices is not working since they are all connected in series. Thus use
of relays provides multiple contacts for indicating devices and makes fault analysis rather
easy. Some of the important type of relays are discussed as follows:
2.6.1 Voltage Relays
This is just a small contactor which changes its contact positions from normally open to close
and normally close to open when a proper voltage is applied across its coil. These relays come
with as many normally open and close contacts as required.




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-1.pm5   23
24                                                                              CONTROL OF MACHINES

        The voltage level which when applied to the relay coil results in movement of relay
contacts from their normal unoperated position to their operated position is called pick up
voltage. The relay coil is generally designed to pick up at 85 % of its rated coil voltage. The
voltage level at which the already operated relay contacts return to their unoperated position
is called drop out voltage. Drop out voltage is generally less than 65 per cent of the rated coil
voltage. This design characteristic of the relay can advantageously be utilized to provide under
voltage protection. Under voltage protection for two direct-on-line starters of squirrel cage
motors using a simple voltage relay is shown in Fig. 2.13.




                       Fig. 2.13 (a) Control relay used for under voltage protection
                                 (b) Photographic view of a control contactor
      Whenever voltage level falls below the drop out voltage of the control relay, relay contact
C1 and C2 open and supply to contactor coils A and B of motors gets disconnected. Thus contactors
drop and motors also gets disconnected from the supply.
2.6.2 D.C. Series Current Relay
This relay changes its contact position in response to current change in its coil. The relay coil
is connected in series with the circuit in which current change is to be sensed. The armature of
the relay is light thereby making it very fast in action.
       The armature is attracted when the current through the coil reaches a value high enough
to produce the necessary magnetic flux for attraction. When the armature gets attracted, the
closed auxiliary contacts will open. When current through the coil falls below a predertmined
value the spring pulls the armature back and contacts close. The value at which the coil fails to
hold back the attracted armature is determined by the setting of the spring. Some terms used
in connection with a current relay are:
       Pull in current. It is the minimum value of current to close or pull in the relay armature.
       Drop out current. It is the value of current below which the relay no longer remains
closed after having being pulled in.




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-1.pm5    24
CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS                                                                   25

      Differential current. It is the difference in value of pull in and drop out currents. For
example if a relay is energised or pulled in at 5 amps and drops out at 3 amps, then pull out
current is 5 amps, drop out current is 3 amps and the differential current is 2 amps. For
heavier current applications, a current transformer is used and its output is applied to the
current relay coil.
      One of the common applications of current relays is for timing acceleration of dc motors,
which will be discussed at a later stage.




                                                                              Auxiliary
                                                                              contact




                        Spring



                       Series coil




                                      Fig. 2.14 Series type current relay

2.6.3 Frequency Responsive Relay
This type of relay changes its contact position when the frequency of applied voltage to the
relay coil falls below a pre-determined value. The relays are designed differently for different
applications. In one type of construction, voltage is applied to the relay coil with a capacitor in
series through a potentiometer resistor as shown in Fig. 2.15.

                                                           Potentiometer




                                 V                                    Relay
                                                                      coil


                                                                     Capacitor




                                     Fig. 2.15 Frequency responsive relay




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-1.pm5   25
26                                                                          CONTROL OF MACHINES

       The inductance of the relay coil and capacitor form a series resonant circuit through
which a high current flows for a certain frequency range. The band width of the frequency
range can be varied by changing the tapping of the potentiometer resistor. When the frequency
falls below the resonant frequency range, current through the relay coil falls to a low value
and the relay drops and its contacts open.
       In another type of construction two similar coils are arranged for a common armature.
One coil is energised from a reference frequency source and the other is energised from the one
to be sensed. The relay is closed one way when the frequencies are the same or within a
predetermined percentage and is closed the other way when the frequency differs by a given
amount or more.
       The frequency relays are used to apply field excitation to synchronous motors at the
right instant and for acceleration control of wound rotor motors.
2.6.4 Latching Relays
The difference between a conventional voltage relay and latching relay is that the former
drops to its de-energised position when the operating coil is de-energised, whereas a latching
relay remains in energised position even when operating coil is de-energised.
       Latching relay has two coils, an operating coil which is also referred to as latch coil and
an unlatch coil. When the latch coil is energised the relay operates and is held in the energised
position either by a mechanical latch or a permanent magnet. The relay remains in the energised
position even when the latch coil is de-energised. The relay can be brought back to the de-
energised position only when the unlatch coil is energised. The relay construction can be of
two types depending on how the relay is held in the energised position when the latch coil is
de-energised. The construction and working of the two types of latching relays i.e., the mechnical
latched type and the permanent magnet type are described as follows.
       In a mechanical latched relay, when armature is pulled by the operating coil (latch coil)
a mechanical latch engages the armature and holds it in place even when the coil voltage is
removed. The relay can be brought back to the de-energised position when the mechanical
latch is opened by energising the unlatch coil.
       In permanent magnet type latch relay the magnetic circuit material gets permanently
magnetised when current flows through the operating coil (latch coil). Both the latch coil and
the unlatch coil are mounted on the same magnetic core. See Fig. 2.16.
       When supply is given to terminals 1 and neutral, latch coil is energised and current
flows in the direction shown. Relay is actuated and held closed due to magnetisation of the
core even when supply is cut off. The supply to latch coil can also be cut off by using a normally
closed contact of the relay in series with the coil. When relay closes, the contact opens and
disconnects the coil (because the coil is not designed for continuous flow of current). Diodes are
used to allow flow of dc current through the coil. When the relay is to be opened, supply is
given between terminal 2 and neutral. Current in the unlatch coil flows through diode D2 in a
direction so as to demagnetise the core. The current direction is opposite to that of the latch
coil. When the core gets demagnetised the relay opens and supply to unlatch coil is also
disconnected through a normally open contact of the relay.
       Latching relays are often used as memory relays on machines or processes where the
work on machine must start from where it stopped when power had failed. When ordinary
relays are used the machine cycle starts from the beginning when power is restored after a
failure. Latching type relays can also be used where ac hum of the relay is objectionable. Here
the relay coil is cut off once it is energised. A simple application of latching relay can be to start




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-1.pm5   26
CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS                                                                          27

a motor automatically when power is restored after a failure. The control circuit is given in
Fig. 2.17.

                 Latch
                  coil



                                                                       LCR        ULCR NO       NC


                  Unlatch
                   coil


                         2             1                                              Neutral




                                                               Latch coil




                                                              Unlatch coil




                                                  Fig. 2.16 Latching relay

                                  P




                                           ON           OFF                  L1




                                                LCR         ULCR                  C

                                  N
                                            Latch           Unlatch            Motor
                                             coil            coil            contactor

                                      Fig. 2.17 Simple application of a latch relay
       When ON-push button is pressed latching relay LCR is energised and contact L1 closes.
Closing of contact L1 energises motor contactor C. When power fails relay does not drop and
contact L1 remains closed. Therefore when power is restored, contactor C gets energised
automatically and there is no need to push the ON-push button. Whenever it is desired to stop
the motor the OFF-push button is pressed which energises the unlatch coil and thus contact L1
opens.



dharm
d:N-MachMac2-1.pm5         27
28                                                                        CONTROL OF MACHINES

   2.7 OVERLOAD RELAYS
The function of overload relay is to protect a motor against overloading. When a motor is
mechnically overloaded it will draw more current than its rated value. The overload conditions
can also be caused if the supply voltage is low or one of the supply phases is lost. When supply
voltage falls the motor draws excessive current for the same load. In case one of the phases is
lost the motor continues to run but draws excessive current through the remaining two phases.
In both the cases if the excessive current is allowed to flow for a long time the motor windings
will get heated up, resulting in failure of insulation and eventually burnout of the windings.
To protect a motor against flow of excessive current an overload relay is connected in the
power circuit. The relay is set at a certain value of current. When the motor current exceeds
this value the contact of the control relay opens after a time delay depending upon the relay
characteristic. The overload relays have inverse time current characteristic i.e., time for relay
operation decreases as the current increases. It means a small overload will take more time for
the relay to operate whereas the heavy overload will operate the relay almost instan-taneously.
However, the overload relay does not provide short circuit protection as the relay operating
time is still large. In the control circuit the contact of the relay is connected in series with the
contactor coil. Opening of the control contact causes deenergisation of the contactor thus
disconnecting supply to the motor terminal. For large motors the overload relay may be
connected indirectly through current transformers. These relays are built with auto reset or
hand reset facility. In hand reset a knob has to be pressed to reset the relay contact. Different
type of overload relays are discussed as follows.
2.7.1 Bimetallic Thermal Overload Relay
This is the most widely used relay because of its simple construction and minimal cost. The
relay consists of three bimetallic strips with current coils wound on them as shown in Fig. 2.18.
The whole of the assembly is mounted on a bakelite enclosure.
       Bimetallic strips comprising two dissimilar metals having different thermal coefficients
of expansion are used for the three phases. Current flowing through the coils heat the bimetallic
strips. Upper ends of the strips are firmly held while lower ends are free to move. When
temperature of the strips increases due to current flowing through the coils, the strips bend
towards right due to different expansion of metals. When the strips bend towards the right,
the tripping mechanism gets actuated and opens the relay contact (refer Fig. 2.18). More is the
current flowing through the coils, faster will be the action of relay (as more current increases
the temperature quickly resulting in faster bending and in turn faster operation of the relay).
The relay thus has inverse time characteristic. A typical current curve of the relay is also
shown in Fig. 2.18. From the curve we see that at 100% of rated current motor will not trip,
while at 200% of rated current, motor trips in two seconds. For 300% of rated current, the
tripping time of the relay is less than 1 sec. However due to inverse time current characteristic,
tripping of the relay due to momentary high currents during motor starting is avoided.
       As the thermal relays are heat dependent the relay cannot distinguish whether the heat
is from the current flowing through the coil or from the surroundings. Therefore changes in
ambient temperature changes the relay characteristic. To compensate for the ambient
temperature changes, relays are designed with temperature compensating strip. The
compensated overload relays are unaffected by variation in ambient temperature from – 22°C
to 55°C.




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-2.pm5   28
CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS                                                                                                     29
                                                                                                 Strip fixed
                                                                                                 at this end




                 Bimettalic
                   strip

                                                                                                                       Symbol
                   Coil



                                                                                                                     Control
                                                                                                                     contacts

                                                                                                  Tripping
                                                                                                 mechanism
                                                                                  (a)


                                                                  7


                                                                  6
                               Time in seconds required to trip




                                                                  5

                                                                  4


                                                                  3


                                                                  2

                                                                  1

                                                                  0
                                                                      100    200    300 400 500 600            700
                                                                            Percentage rated motor current
                                                                                     (b)




                                                                                           (c)
              Fig. 2.18 Bimetallic overload relay (a) Construction (b) Tripping characteristic
                                          (c) Photographic view




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-2.pm5      29
30                                                                                     CONTROL OF MACHINES

2.7.2 Ratchet Type Eutectic Alloy Relay
It consists of a fixed metallic tube filled with an eutectic alloy in which a closely fitted rotating
shaft is inserted. A heating coil through which the load current flows, surrounds the tube.
Eutectic alloy has the property of instantly changing over from soild state to liquid state when
a particular temperature is reached. A ratchet wheel is attached to one end of the shaft. When
normal current flows through the heating coil, solidified eutectic alloy holds the rotating shaft
and the ratchet firmly. A spring loaded contact actuating assembly is engaged with the ratchet
wheel as shown in Fig. 2.19. Under normal condition the ratchet wheel does not rotate inspite
of spring pressure. When overload takes place, excessive current produces heat to melt the
eutectic alloy. Now the rotating shaft and the ratchet wheel are free and therefore cannot
restrain the spring loaded actuating mechanism from moving from left to the right direction.
The ratchet wheel therefore rotates and the actuating mechanism is released. The spring
pressure causes the mechanism to move towards the right side and the actuating knob actuates
the relay contact. The relay can be reset by hand when the eutectic alloy solidifies. This is done
by engaging the mechanism with the ratchet wheel against the spring pressure.


                                                                     Actuating
                                     Ratchet                        mechanism
                  Spring                                                    Actuating knob




                                                                                             Contact

                                Top view of ratchet contact arrangement




                                     Ratchet
                                Rotating shaft




                                  Heating coil


                                Eutectic alloy


                       Fixed metallic tube



                                 Fig. 2.19 Cross-sectional view of an eutectic relay

2.7.3 Magnetic Dash Pot Oil Filled Relay
This relay consists of a coil through which the motor current can safely flow. Inside the coil is
a plunger which tends to rise up against gravity due to magnetic pull, when motor current
flows through the coil. The relay, for each phase, consists of a coil, a plunger and a piston. One
element for this type of relay is shown in Fig. 2.20.




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-2.pm5       30
CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS                                                                   31

                                    Spring

                             Relay contacts




                                      Coil




                                   Plunger




                         Dash pot up/down
                               adjustment

                                   Dash pot


                                         Oil


                            Piston with holes


                   Fig. 2.20 Cross-sectional view of magnetic dash pot oil filled relay
       The plunger, attached with a piston, is immersed in oil in the dash pot. The piston has
bypass holes of different sizes. When current through the coil increases, the plunger and the
piston move up. As the piston moves up, oil is forced through bypass holes which dampens the
piston movement and provides delay. There is a provision for opening and closing of the bypass
holes of different sizes by turning a valve disc over the piston. Thus by changing the area of
bypass holes the delay characteristic of the relay can be changed. The relay provides inverse
time current characteristics, larger is the overload, faster the plunger will move up and actuate
the contact. Tripping adjustment can be obtained by adjusting the plunger core position with
respect to the relay coil. This magnetic dash pot type of relays are used in controlling large
motors.
       Another form of magnetic type relay is the instantaneous trip magnetic current relay.
        These relays are used to disconnect the motor when a predetermined load condition is
exceeded. The relay does not have inverse time current characteristic, thus the relay cannot be
used in place of an ordinary overload relay. It is a special purpose relay. To avoid tripping of
this relay during starting of motors, the relay contact has to be by-passed during the starting
period. See the control circuit shown in Fig. 2.21. The relay contact is used in parallel with the
ON-push button and in series with the holding contact. As long as the ON-push button is held
pressed the contact of the relay remains by-passed. When the motor accelerates fully the push
button is released. The operating mechanism of the trip relay consists of a solenoid coil through
which the motor current flows and a movable iron core within the coil. An over current causes
the iron core to move up and operate a snap action contact mounted on top of the solenoid
frame. The normal current of the motor does not exert sufficient magnetic pull to lift the core.
The tripping values of the relay can be adjusted by changing the core position in the solenoid
coil. If the iron core is moved down in the coil the relay will operate at a higher value of




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-2.pm5   31
32                                                                                  CONTROL OF MACHINES

current. Moving the core position higher in the coil will operate the relay at a lower value of
current. The important application of the relay is in conveyors where the driving motor is
stopped before mechanical breakage results due to jam-up.

                                   P

                                       OFF push
                                        button



                                       ON push
                                                        C
                                        button



                                                             Instantaneous
                                                             current trip
                                                             relay contact

                                                  C

                                       N

                            Fig. 2.21 Control circuit for instantaneous trip relay

   2.8 TIME DELAY RELAYS (TIMERS)
In time delay relays the relay contacts change over their position after a pre set delay from the
time of energisation or de-energisation of the relay coil. Time delay relays are also commonly
known as Timers. Timer can be of ON-delay or an OFF-delay type. A timer is referred to as an
ON-delay type if the contacts change over after a pre-set delay after energisation. On the other
hand a timer is referred to as OFF-delay type if the contacts change over after a pre-set delay
from the instant of de-energisation. Besides the delayed contacts a timer can also have another
set of contacts which operate as in an ordinary voltage relay. These are known as instantaneous
contacts as they changeover their positions instantaneously when the timer is energised or de-
energised. The representation of ON-delay and OFF-delay contacts of a timer in a control
circuit is as shown in Fig. 2.22.
        We will represent the coil of the timer as the same for both ON- and OFF-delay but
delayed contacts will be represented differently. Normally, most circuits require ON-delay
timers. Applications requiring OFF-delay timers can also be covered by ON-delay timers with
suitable modifications in the circuitry. However, OFF-delay timers can, in few cases, simplify
circuitry and thereby reduce the cost. Though the OFF-delay timer find limited applications,
the reader should however thoroughly understand the contact operation of OFF-delay timer,
to avoid confusion between the two types of timers. The difference of operation becomes clear
from the following explanation.
       ON-delay timer is normally in de-energised condition. The normal position of delayed
contacts is shown in Fig. 2.22. When the timer is energised, after a pre-set delay the contacts
change over their positions. Contact 1 will become closed and contact 2 will open. However,
when the timer is de-energised contacts change over almost instantaneously.
       An OFF-delay timer is normally in energised condition. Thus, normally, contact 3 will
be closed and contact 4 will be open. When the timer is de-energised the counting starts and
after the pre-set delay, contacts 3 will open and contact 4 will close i.e., their positions will be
as shown in Fig. 2.22. In the control circuits the changed over positions of the contacts are




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-2.pm5   32
CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS                                                                    33

shown. As the time delay is only on one side (i.e., OFF-delay only), when timer is energised,
contacts change over almost instantaneously.




                            Fig. 2.22 Symbols for a timer and its contacts
       Timers can also be classified as cyclic and non-cyclic timers. When a timer continues to
repeat its sequence of operation till the supply is switched off, it is called a cycle timer. The
change over contacts would continually switch ON and OFF at intervals as long as operating
voltage is on. The non-cyclic timers operate only for one timing cycle when they are switched
on. The change over contacts get switched over after the set time and stay in that state till they
are reset either manually or by a knob or by switching ON or OFF an electrical signal.
       Majority of applications require ON-delay, non-cyclic, non-manual reset type timers.
There are four different types of timers utilising different operating principles. These timers
are thermal timers, pneumatic timers, electronic timers and motor driven (synchronous) timers.
2.8.1 Thermal Timer
Principle of working of a thermal timer is the same as that of a bimetallic overload relay
discussed earlier. These are available with a limited delay range of 0–20 sec. The timing error
can be very large of the order of ± 10 to 30%. By timing error it is meant that the time variation
(plus or minus) between successive timing operations on the same timer represented as a
percentage of maximum range of the timer. Due to higher timing error thermal timers are
used only in star-delta starters where such error does not matter much.
       Pneumatic and Electronic timers are suitable for delay range of 0–3 minutes. For delays
exceeding 3 minutes, synchronous timers are preferred. Pneumatic timers have a timing error
of ± 10%, electronic timer, ± 5% and synchronous timers have timing error limited to ± 1%.
The construction and working of these timers are discussed as follows.
2.8.2 Pneumatic Timer
It consists of solenoid coil, a plunger assembly, and an air bleed unit consisting of an air chamber
divided into upper chamber and lower chamber by a diaphgram. The diaphragm is attached to
an operating rod and disc D as shown in Fig. 2.23 (a). There is a provision of air bleed (air flow)
from upper chamber to lower chamber through a needle valve. Air flow rate can be changed by
adjustment of needle valve screw. Solenoid coil plunger assembly and air bleed unit are
assembled together as shown in Fig. 2.23 (a) for ON-delay type operation. The contact block is
mounted on the air bleed unit.




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-2.pm5   33
34                                                                              CONTROL OF MACHINES

       Before the coil is energised the diaphragm is in its down position as shown in the figure.
A small orifice at the bottom of the lower air chamber is held closed by the diaphragm and does
not allow air flow from upper air chamber to lower air chamber. Diaphragm is held in the
down position as the plunger is pressing the disc and the operating rod down.




                                                    (b)
      Fig. 2.23 (a) Cross-sectional view of pneumatic timer (b) Photographic view of a pneumatic timer




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-2.pm5     34
CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS                                                                  35

       When the solenoid coil is energised the plunger is attracted and thus pressure on the
disc (D) and the operating rod is released. Now the diaphragm is free. Air from upper chamber
leaks to the lower chamber through the needle valve. The rate of air flow can be adjusted by
the screw of the needle valve. As pressure of air in the lower chamber starts increasing the
diaphragm moves up slowly at a speed which depends upon the rate of air flow through the
needle valve. The diaphragm in turn moves the operating rod and the disc upward. The
diaphragm will move up till air pressure in both the chambers is equal. An actuating lever
attached to the disc, which moves upwards, actuates the timer contacts.
       The delay or time for actuation can be varied by adjustment of the needle valve. Operating
rod, disc and diaphragm remain in up position as long as the coil is energised and therefore
relay contacts remains closed.
       When the coil is de-energised, plunger falls down which in turn presses the diaphragm
down through the disc and the operating rod. The air in the lower chamber is pressurised and
it flows to the upper chamber through the check valves. It may be understood here that check
valves allow air flow only in one direction. In this case this direction is from lower chamber to
upper chamber and air flow is blocked in the reverse direction. On de-energisation the same
position from where we started is reached and the relay is ready for another ON-delay operation.
       In the OFF-delay type of timer the air bleed unit and solenoid assembly are so arranged
that, normally, when the coil is de-energised and the plunger is down the diaphgram is in the
centre position and the contacts are in actuated condition. This is achieved if the whole of air
bleed assembly (refer figure) is inverted and assembled over the solenoid coil assembly so that
the rod of disc (D) enters the hole at the top of the coil assembly (shown dotted).
       When the coil is energised, the diaphragm is pushed by the plunger through the disc
and the operating rod to close the orifice. Therefore the contacts also get de-actuated. When
the coil is de-energised, diaphragm becomes free and starts moving towards the centre due to
bleeding of air. Depending upon the speed of the operating rod and disc (D), the contacts are
actuated after a delay.
2.8.3 Motor Driven Timers
This timer consists of a small motor, usually a synchronous motor, which is engaged with gear
arrangement with the help of electrically operated clutch. Gear arrangement reduces the speed
of motor to a desired low value. Motor thus rotates a contact actuating lever through gear
arrangement. The actuating lever after travelling a pre-set distance operates the timer contacts.
The time delay for actuation of contacts can be changed by a knob which varies the distance
between the actuating lever and the contacts. If the distance between the actuating lever and
the contacts is increased, the timer will take more time to actuate the contacts (as the motor
speed is constant) and vice-versa. In ON-delay timers the motor starts counting time when the
clutch coil is energised and in OFF-delay timers counting starts when the clutch coil is de-
energised. Timer gets reset when the clutch is de-energised in an ON-delay timer and energised
in case of an OFF-delay timer. In an ON-delay timer the motor can be energised along with the
clutch but in an OFF-delay timer the motor has to be kept running continuoulsy.
       Synchronous motor timers are also available in simple version without a clutch. In this
case the timer starts counting time when motor is energised and actuates contacts after the
actuating lever moves through a pre-set distance. The timer gets reset when supply to motor is
disconnected. Another version of motor driven timer makes or breaks a number of contacts
during its timing period with the help of cams mounted on the motor shaft. A cam is a circular
plastic material which is fitted on the motor shaft as shown in Fig. 2.24. Cams are shaped to
produce protruding portions which actuate the contact blocks.




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-2.pm5   35
36                                                                              CONTROL OF MACHINES




                       Fig. 2.24 Simplified representation of a motor driven cam timer
      When the motor is energised the cams start rotating. Protruding portion of the cam
presses the knob of contact block and thus contacts remains actuated as long as the protruding
portion of the cam passes over the contact knob. For the remaining position of the cam the
contact gets de-actuated.
      The time period required for actuation and de-actuation of a particular contact can be
obtained by adjusting the shape of the cam as per requirement.
      These timers are very useful for initiating different processes in sequence. Another
important application is starting of motors in a conveyor system.
       A time switch is another form of a motor driven timer. It offers independent control of
the ON and OFF-duration of the contacts. Any combination of ON-time and OFF-time can be
selected as long as the total of ON-time and OFF-time does not exceed the maximum or full
range-time of the device.
       An important application of time switch is for street lighting control where the full
range-time is 24 hours. Time switch, for this purpose, is provided with battery supply also
which can run the timer in case the main supply fails. Thus interruptions due to supply failure
does not effect the ON and OFF-time of the timer.
2.8.4 Electronic Timer
Electronic timers are widely used in industry for various applications due to their better accuracy
and longer life than the pneumatic timers. They are less expensive than synchronous timers.
Only critical processes which demand very high accuracy require synchronous timers.
       Electronic timers achieve their timing action with an electronic circuit. Electronic timers
are generally of the ON-delay type. When supply to the timer is given it starts counting and
the contacts change over their positions after a pre-set delay. The length of time delay period
is easily adjusted by a variable resistor placed in the electronic circuit. The timer gets reset
when supply to the timer is cut off.
         A very simple electronic timer circuit using a silicon controlled rectifier (SCR) is shown
in Fig. 2.25. The SCR, also generally known as Thyristor, has three terminals Anode, Cathode
and Gate. It conducts when a signal is applied between its Gate and Cathode and continues to
conduct even if signal to the gate is removed after conduction starts. It conducts only when
there is positive supply at the Anode and negative supply at the Cathode. The gate supply
should be positive with respect to the Cathode to cause its conduction.
         In the circuit of Fig. 2.25, control transformer (220/12 V centre tapped) and diodes D1 and
D2 provide 12 V dc supply to the electronic circuit. When the timer switch is closed 12 V dc is
available to the timer circuit. Resistance R1 and capacitor C form the RC charging circuit. The
coil of the timer relay is connected in series with the SCR as shown. The gate of SCR is connected
to the capacitor terminal. When the timer switch is closed, the capacitor C starts charging.
When the voltage of the capacitor is sufficient to send minimum gate current to trigger on the
SCR, the SCR starts conducting. Resistance R2 is there to limit the gate current. When the
SCR starts conducting, relay coil picks up and closes its contacts. The required delay in closing




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-2.pm5     36
CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS                                                                              37

the relay contacts may be obtained by changing the charging rate of capacitor (by varying the
variable resistance R1). A suitable time range of the timer can be designed by using required
values of R1 and C. The timer gets reset automatically when supply to the timer is cut off. The
contacts of the timer then return to the normal position immediately.

                Switch              D1
                                                                                              Timer
                                                                                            relay coil


                                                                  R1
                                                                                              Timer
                                                                                Anode        contacts
        220 V                                              12 V

                                                                             Gate        Cathode
                                                                  C
                                                                                    R2



                                     D2
                                                     (a)




                                                    (b)

      Fig. 2.25 (a) Simple circuit of an electronic timer (b) Photographic view of an electronic timer

   2.9 PHASE FAILURE RELAY (SINGLE PHASING PREVENTER)
In a 3-phase motor, when under running conditions, one of the three fuses blows and power to
the motor is supplied by the remaining two phases, the motor is said to be running on single
phasing condition. To maintain the same power input to the motor during single phasing the
current in the remaining two phases will increase by 1.73 times. If the motor is lightly loaded,
currents in healthy phases will not increase beyond the full rated current setting on the overload
relay. Thus overload relay will not be able to detect single-phasing when the motor is lightly




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-2.pm5     37
38                                                                                  CONTROL OF MACHINES

loaded. For example, consider a 10 hp motor with rated current of 14 A and over-load relay
setting at 10 A. At a particular load, let the motor be drawing a current of 5 A. If one of the
fuses blows out or a conductor breaks, current in the two phases will become 5 × 1.73 = 8.65 A,
which is much below the relay setting of 10 A. Therefore, the motor will continue running
under single phasing.
       Single phasing of the motor results in superpositon of negative sequence of current flow
over the positive sequence through the motor windings. These negative sequence currents are
of double frequency as compared to positive sequence currents and produce a torque which is
opposite to that produced by positive sequence currents. As the iron losses are proportional to
frequency, the negative sequence currents cause higher iron losses and therefore greater heating
of the rotor. Rotor heating is further increased due to skin effect (due to higher frequency).
This undetected heating can damage the rotor and due to convection, stator windings also.
This excessive heat can finally cause burn out of the motor. To avoid failure of the motor due to
single phasing, phase failure relay or commercially known as single phase preventer is used in
the motor circuit as shown in Fig. 2.26.



                                                                    CT


                                                              CT
           Single phase 1       3     5 11
          preventor relay 2     4     6 12                                   1   3    5 11

                                              Normally closed                2   4    6 12
                                              contacts 11-12 in
                                               series with coil
                                             circuit of contactor
                              Contactor                                                In series with
                                                                                       the coil circuit
                                                                                        of contactor

                         Overload relay




                                 M
                                 3–


                              Fig. 2.26 Connection scheme for phase failure relay
      As shown in the figure the relay is connected in the incoming supply phases. The control
contact (11-12) is connected in series with the contactor coil circuit.
      If the starting time of the motor is more, to avoid undesirable tripping, the control
contact should be by-passed during starting.
       Brief description of a relay which works on the basis of detection of negative sequence
current is explained as follows.
       The relay has two built-in current transformers which sense currents of the motor. The
secondary of the CTs feeds a negative sequence filter. The output from this filter is proportional
to the negative sequence component of currents. This output is fed to a sensor which detects
the level of negative sequence components of current and thus trips the motor starter by opening
its control contact. These relays are designed for different ratings of motors upto 20 hp. For



dharm
d:N-MachMac2-2.pm5     38
CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS                                                                      39

motors above 20 hp, a relay rated for a 3 hp motor can be used by using current transformers
on the lines as shown in Fig. 2.26. The CTs should have a secondary current of 5 A, the primary
current should correspond to full rated current of the motor. The two secondaries are connected
to two phases of the relay. The control contact is used as usual in series with the contactor coil.

   2.10 PUSH BUTTON SWITCHES
It is a pilot device which provides control of an equipment by pressing an actuator which looks
like a button. Push button switch can be divided into two parts. One part is the mechanical
actuator or button assembly and the second part is the electrical portion or contact assembly
called the contact block.
       The mechanical actuator or button assembly can be of momentary-contact spring returned
type or of maintained contact type. The momentary-contacts spring returned push button
remains actuated as long as the button is physically held pressed by the human operator.
Under pressed condition the contacts change their positions in the contact block. Once the
button is released the contacts return to their normal position. Maintained contact push buttons
are held actuated by some latching mechanism even when the operator releases the pressure
on the push button. Such units consist of two push buttons, only one remains in actuated
position at a time, when the other button is pressed the first one gets released.
       A spring returned momentary contact push button is shown in Fig. 2.27. The contact
block has two contacts, one normally open (NO) and the other normally closed (NC). When the
push button is pressed, NC contacts opens and NO contact closes. When the push button is
released a spring inside the actuator assembly brings back the push button and a spring inside
the contact block brings the contacts back to their normal position. The symbol for the push
button switch is also shown in Fig. 2.27.
                   Return spring      Front view                          Side view
              Mounting
               screw
                                                               Mounting
                                                                screw
             Normally open
                contact
          Normally closed                                       Contact               Terminal
             contact                                             block




              Actuator


                Actuator
                 spring

                                                            Actuator
              Push button


              Check nut


                       Symbol

                    Fig. 2.27 (a) Cross sectional view and end view of a push button.



dharm
d:N-MachMac2-2.pm5       39
40                                                                            CONTROL OF MACHINES




                                                  (b)

                            Fig. 2.27 (b) Photographic view of a push button
     Push button switches can be of different types depending upon the type of actuator
assembly. They are:
     • Recessed button type
       •   Mushroom head type
       •   Illuminated type
       • Key lock type.
       Colour of the button is also an important factor in push button switches. Standards
have been developed which specify certain colour for a particular function. For example, red
push buttons are used for stop and emergency stop operations, while green push buttons are
used for start operations. When two or three push button switches are mounted on a steel or
plastic enclosure it is known as a push button station. For example, in a three push button
station, one push button may be for running the motor in forward direction, the second for
running the motor in reverse direction, and the third for stopping the motor.

   2.11 SELECTOR SWITCHES
Many machines and process operations are designed so as to function in any one of the several
ways. For example, the three different modes of operation may be Manual, Semi-automatic
and Automatic. A selector switch will enable the operator to predetermine the manner in
which his machine is to operate. As with push-button switches, selector switches also have two
main parts, the mechanical actuator and the contact block. Selector switches are usually of the
maintained position type, although momentary spring return selectors are also available.
Selector switches can have single break contacts or double break contacts. The symbols for
both these type of contacts have been shown in Figs. 2.28 and 2.29.




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-2.pm5   40
CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS                                                                                                          41




       Fig. 2.28 Connection of two position and three position selector switches in a simple circuit

                                                          OFF                                N
                                                   P     1   2

      1      2                                 N
 P

                                                            OFF
                                                        1         2                          N
                                                   P


       1         2                             N
 P

                                                             OFF
                                                                                             N
                                                   P     1         2




      (a) Two position selector switch                 (b) Three position selector switch


                                         (a)                                                                      (b)

          Fig. 2.29 (a) Connection of double break two position and three position selector switches
                  in a simple circuit (b) Photographic view of a three positions selector switch
       The selector switches are generally made for four                                                                Selector switch
                                                                                                                           positions
positions. As the number of positions increase to four,
manufacturer provide charts of tables which display                                              1    2       A         3    4
positions of the selector switch actuator. Fig. 2.30 shows
                                                                                                              B
a four position selector switch. Note the use of × under
the position number. This indicates that the contact in                                                       C
line with × is closed in that position.                                                                       D
     Below position 1 (Fig. 2.30) × is against contact B
and C i.e., in position 1 contact B and C are closed.                                       Fig. 2.30 Symbolic representation of
                                                                                                 four position selector switch




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-2.pm5          41
42                                                                              CONTROL OF MACHINES

In position 2 contacts B and D will close, further in position 3 contact A and D will close and in
position 4 contacts A and C will close.

   2.12 DRUM SWITCHES
Drum switches, also referred to as Master Controllers are identical in function but of a different
type of construction than selector switches. A selector switch uses components similar to a
push-button while a drum switch consists of a shaft attached to the operating lever (actuator),
which has a number of cams mounted on it. Cams actuate their respective contact when the
operating lever is rotated. A single cam can operate two contacts, one mounted on right side
and one on left side of the shaft cam arrangement. The contact ratings can be high depending
upon the application. A Drum switch can be considered as the ‘big brother’ of a selector switch.
       One of the important applications of Drum switches is in overhead cranes for controlling
hoist, long travel, and cross-travel operations. Separate drum switches are used for each of
these operations. Fig. 2.31 shows the symbolic representation of a master controller used for
forward-reverse operation of a motor used in a crane.
                                                     Off
                                 Reverse                                 Forward
                        5    4     3     2   1   A             1     2      3    4   5

                                                 B

                                                 C

                                                 D

                                                 E

                                                 F

                                                 G

                                                 H


        Fig. 2.31 Symbolic representation of master controller used for forward/reverse operation
       Master controller contacts are shown by A, B, C, D, E, F, G, H. When the lever is in OFF
position, contact A remains closed, and opens for any other position of the switch. When the
controller is moved towards right side (forward), contact B and D actuate at position 1 and
these contacts remain actuated till the lever is moved to position 5. Let us co-relate the position,
the × mark under the position, and the contact in line with the ×. Contact C will not actuate in
any position on right side. On further moving the lever to position 2 contact E will close and at
position 3 contact F will close and so on. Similar action takes place when the operating lever is
moved towards left side. At this point one may wonder as to why so many contacts are needed
for forward reverse operation of a motor ! In fact, master controller contacts are used to get
different speeds of the slip-ring motor used in cranes by cutting the rotor resistance in steps.
When we discuss the starter for slip ring induction motor at a later stage, we will again have to
refer to the master controller explained above.

   2.13 LIMIT SWITCHES
Limit switch is an important control element. Limit switch contacts change over their position
when its actuating lever or knob is actuated by the mechanical part of a machine. The mechanical



dharm
d:N-MachMac2-2.pm5   42
CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS                                                                         43

part attached to the machine which actuates the limit switch lever or knob is known as actuator
or dog. Limit switches are used to stop a mechanical movement of a machine and may also be
used to stop a particular movement, and initiate another movement. The simple application of
a limit switch is in producing automatic to and fro movement of a planar machine bed shown
in Fig. 2.32. It must be understood here that a limit switch is not used as a mechanical stop.
A limit switch controls the electrical signal which is responsible for mechanical stop/movement.


                         L.S                                                     L.S
                         (A)                                                     (B)

             (a) Control off-motor standstill, bed at extreme left with limit switch ‘A’ actuated



                         L.S                                                     L.S
                         (A)                                                     (B)

                 (b) Control on-motor runs in clockwise direction and bed moves in right
                           direction due to actuated condition of limit switch ‘A’



                         L.S                                                     L.S
                         (A)                                                     (B)

          (c) Limit switch ‘B’ actuates which stops motor and runs it in anti-clockwise direction



                         L.S                                                     L.S
                         (A)                                                     (B)

                 (d) Motor runs in anticlockwise direction till limit switch ‘A’ is actuated.
              On actuation of limit switch motor stops and again runs in clockwise direction

          Fig. 2.32 Application of limit switch for automatic to and fro movement of planar bed
     Actual control circuit for achieving this to and fro movement with help of limit switches
shown in Fig. 2.32, will be discussed at a later stage.
2.13.1 A Simple Limit Switch
The simplest construction of a limit switch is shown in Fig. 2.33.
       When the knob or pin is pushed the plunger attached to the knob move down against
spring pressure. The moving contacts mounted on the plunger also moves down. Thus the
terminals 1 and 2, which are normally closed, become open and terminals 3 and 4, which are
normally open, get closed. When the pressure on the knob is released the contacts return to
their normal position. Another commonly used limit switch is the lever type. This may be
single side actuation type or double side actuation type, as shown in Figs. 2.33 (b) and (c).
       In a single side actuation type limit switch the contacts operate when the limit switch
arm moves in one direction, either the right or to the left. Movement on the other side does not
actuate the contacts. The arm returns to the normal position when the actuating force is
removed. The limit switch can also be of maintained contact type in which arm has to be brought




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-2.pm5    43
44                                                                               CONTROL OF MACHINES

                                Pin or knob


                                               1         2
                                                                         Symbol
                              Moving                                  NO         NC
                             contacts                               contact    contact
                          Terminals
                                               3         4
                            Plunger
                       Return spring

                                                   (a)




                                                             A




                                                             B



                                    (b)                                (c)

          Fig. 2.33 Inside view of (a) Knob type limit switch (b) Single side actuation lever type
                        limit switch (c) Double side actuation lever type limit switch




                         Fig. 2.34 Photographic view of (a) Knob type limit switch
                                        (b) Lever type limit switch




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-2.pm5    44
CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS                                                                   45

back manually to normal. However this type of limit switches are rarely used. In double side
actuation type limit switch, when the arm is moved in one direction, say towards right, contact
block A operates; and when the arm is moved towards left, contact block B operates. This type
of a limit switch can serve the purpose of two single side actuation limit switches needed in
controlling to and fro movement of a machine.
       If the contacts of the limit switch change-over independent of the speed of operation, the
limit switch is known as snap-action limit switch. At a particular position of the arm, the
contacts change-over. If the contacts also move at the same speed as that of the arm of the
limit switch, it is called a slow-action limit switch. Most limit switches used are the snap-
action type. There are only few applications where slow acting limit switches are preferred.
2.13.2 Rotary Cam Type Limit Switches
In this type of limit switches, the contacts are mounted on the stationary frame. The cams,
which have to actuate the contacts, are mounted on the rotating shaft. The position of the
cams is adjustable. The rotating shaft is coupled to the driving motor of the machinery either
through chain and sprockets or by gear arrangement. The rotation of the driving motor is thus
transmitted to the shaft of the limit switch. The cams mounted on the shaft are shaped and
their position adjusted to actuate the contacts at the desired instant. In the machinery, the
rotary motion of the driving motor is converted into longitudinal motion through mechanical
arrangement. Thus, the cam shaft of the limit switch rotates proportional to the longitudinal
motion of the machine. The limits of travel of the machinery, therefore, can be adjusted by
changing the cam position.
       The advantage of a rotary cam limit switch over an ordinary limit switch is that the
instant of actuation and hence limits of travel can be varied easily over a wide range by changing
the cam positions. In an ordinary limit switch, however, once the limit switch is fixed, only
very little adjustment is possible by adjusting the lever position. The reliability of rotary limit
switch using sprocket and chain is however low and, therefore, wherever these are used a
back-up-protection of ordinary limit switches is generally provided to avoid damage due to
over travel, in case the rotary limit switch fails due to slipping or breaking of chain.
       Rotary limit switches are preferred where frequent adjustment of limits of travel is
required. One of its important application is in over-head cranes for hoisting and lowering
motion. In over-head crane, for hoisting operation, the rotary motion of the motor is converted
into longitudinal motion with the help of a rope wound on the drum attached to the motor
shaft. The rope winds on the drum in one direction giving hoisting (raising) operation and
unwinds in other direction giving lowering motion. The limits of hoisting and lowering can be
easily adjusted by varying the cam positions which have to actuate the hoisting and lowering
limit switch contacts.
2.13.3 Heavy Duty Limit Switches
As the name signifies, these limit switches are used in heavy duty machines such as cranes,
conveyors and heavy material handling equipment. The basic difference between an ordinary
limit switch and a heavy duty limit switch is that the former is used in the control circuit while
the latter is used in the power circuit. Actuation of a heavy duty limit switch cuts off power
supply to the motor. Heavy duty limit switch requires a minimum of two normally closed
contacts because to stop a motor two phases have to be cut off. A heavy duty limit switch may
be either lever type or rotary cam type. They are rugged, and the current rating of their contacts
matches with the motor rating. If the rating is quite high, arc chutes are also provided over the
contacts. These heavy duty limit switches are used in addition to the control limit switches.
They are generally used as back-up-protection for control limit switches. If the control limit




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-2.pm5   45
46                                                                               CONTROL OF MACHINES

switch fails or contactor gets stuck or welded, then the heavy duty limit switch operates to
disconnect power supply to the motor.
       The limit switch contacts are connected in series with the main contactor contacts. These
limit switches therefore avoid damage and accidents due to over-travel of machinary like
overhead crane and other heavy material handling equipment.
2.13.4 Speed Actuating Sensing Switches
These are also commonly known as plugging switches or zero speed switches. These switches
have two sets of contacts, one each for either direction or rotation of the motor. The contacts
for a particular direction of rotation open or close when a predetermined rotational speed in
that direction is achieved. These switches are used in circuits where the motor is to be stopped
quickly (i.e., to be brought to standstill quickly by plugging method of braking). In plugging,
the motor is stopped by reversing its two supply leads till motor comes to standstill. The torque
developed during reversing causes the motor to come to standstill in a short time.
       The most commonly used design of this device is the one which use the effect of induced
magnetic forces. In this type, a shaft having a permanent magnet on it rotates inside a copper
cup. The copper cup can rotate in either direction against spring pressures. The shaft of the
switch is coupled with the motor shaft. As the motor shaft rotates, the permanent magnet on
the switch shaft rotates inside the cup. Magnetic induction due to its rotation causes the cup to
follow the rotation of the shaft. An actuator is connected on the copper cup which can actuate
the contacts in either direction. The speed at which the contacts would operate can be adjusted
by varying the spring tension which restrain the movement of the cup. The contacts get reset
to their original position when the motor speed falls below the value set by the spring tension.
If the contact of the speed switch is so adjusted that contacts operate immediately on rotation
in either direction and reclose only when zero speed is reached the switch is known as zero
speed switch. The plugging switch or zero speed switch is represented in a control circuit as
shown in Fig. 2.35.




              (a) Unactuated position            (b) Actuation at a           (c) Actuation at a
                                                   forward speed                reverse speed
                       Fig. 2.35 Representation of plugging switch or zero speed switch

   2.14 SOLENOID VALVES
Solenoid valves are electromechanical devices like relays and contactors. A solenoid valve is
used to obtain mechanical movement in machinery by utilizing fluid or air pressure. The fluid
or air pressure is applied to the cylinder piston through a valve operated by a cylindrical
electrical coil. The electrical coil along with its frame and plunger is known as the solenoid and
the assembly of solenoid and mechanical valve is known as solenoid valve. The solenoid valve
is thus another important electromechanical device used in control of machines. Solenoid valves
are of two types:
        (i) Single solenoid spring return operating valve,
       (ii) Double solenoid operating valve.



dharm
d:N-MachMac2-2.pm5      46
CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS                                                                                          47

        In Fig. 2.36 (a) is shown a single solenoid spring return valve in its de-energised condition.
The symbol for the solenoid and the valve are also shown. The solenoid valve is shown connected
to the cylinder to help readers understand the solenoid valve action. In the de-energised
condition, the plunger and the valve spool position are as shown in Fig. 2.36 (a). In this position
of spool, port P is connected to port A and port B is connected to tank or exhaust (i.e., atmosphere)
if air is used. Spring pressure (S) keeps the spool in this condition as long as the coil is de-
energised. Fluid pressure from port P through port A is applied to the left side of the cylinder
piston. Thus the cylinder piston moves in the right direction. Now when the solenoid coil is
energised, plunger is attracted and it pushes the spool against spring pressure. The new position
of plunger and spool are shown in Fig. 2.36 (b) In this position of spool, port A gets connected
to tank and port P gets connected to port B. Thus pressure is applied to the cylinder piston
from the right and moves the piston rod to the left. At the same time fluid in the other side is
drained out to the tank. When the solenoid coil is again de-energised, the spring (S) will move
the spool to its original position as shown in Fig. 2.36 (a). Thus normally when the solenoid coil
is de-energised the piston rod remains extended.

                                                                       Cylinder
                                                                                                Piston rod




                                                                                                      Load
      Pressurised
                                                           P
       fluid or air
                                              A                    B


                                                                                  Spring


                                                                                                   A B       A   B
                                Valve spool
                                                        To tank or
                                                         exhaust
                                                  (a)                                              P T P T
                                                                                                   Valve symbol



            Pressurised
            fluid or air                                                                                Solenoid
                                                                                                         symbol

                                              A                P       B
                                                                                  Valve Spool




              Plunger                                    To tank or
              attracted               Solenoid
                                        coil              exhaust
                                             (b)

                                    Fig. 2.36 Single solenoid spring return valve




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-3.pm5       47
48                                                                             CONTROL OF MACHINES

       Fig. 2.37 (a), (b) and (c) shows the double solenoid operating valve in three conditions.
In Fig. 2.37 (a) both the solenoids are de-energised, and, therefore, the centering springs keep
the spool in the position shown. In this position of spool, pressure port P is connected to tank
while port A and B are closed by spool. No pressure is applied to either port A or port B. In
Fig. 2.37 (b) is shown the spool position when solenoid A is energised. Energisation of solenoid
A attracts its plunger and the spool moves in right direction compressing the right side centering
spring. In this condition port P is connected to port A and port B is connected to tank (exhaust
in case of air). Fig. 2.37 (c) shows the valve with solenoid B energised. The plunger is attracted
and in turn spool moves towards the left, compressing the centering spring to the left. Now
pressure port P is connected to port B and port A is connected to tank or exhaust. When the
solenoid is de-energised the spool returns to the original position as shown in Fig. 2.37(a).




                       Fig. 2.37 Double solenoid valve in three operating conditions

   2.15 PRESSURE SWITCHES
Pressure switches are used in the control systems to sense pressure of gas, air or liquid and
feed a signal into the electrical control circuit. Pressure switch can have a normally open or a
normally closed contact or it can have both types of contacts. The contact operation of a pressure
switch is different from the switches we have discussed so far. The extra feature is the differential
setting.
      The cut out point of a pressure switch is that pressure at which its contact opens to de-
energise the associated pump/compressor from raising the pressure further or to stop a machine



dharm
d:N-MachMac2-3.pm5    48
CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS                                                                   49

cycle. Before we take up differential setting, we will see how the control system behaves if the
pressure switch has only the cut-out point setting. For example, if a pump is used to raise
water pressure in a tank to say upto 50 P.S.I. the pressure switch will energise the pump when
pressure falls below 50 P.S.I. and will de-energise it when water pressure rises above 50 P.S.I.
The variation from the above setting is generally only 1% of setting on either side which is
called the accuracy of the pressure switch. When water pressure of the tank is being utilized
the water pressure will fall and therefore opening and closing of the pressure switch contacts
will be very rapid. Consequently the ON-OFF frequency of the pump motor will be high which
will shorten its life. However, the pressure will be maintained very close to the value set on the
pressure switch. To avoid this frequent switching ON-OFF of pump, a differential setting is
provided in the pressure switch. Let us say a differential setting of 10 P.S.I. is provided. Now,
what will happen is that when pressure drops below the cut out value of 50 P.S.I. the pressure
switch contact will not open, it will open only when pressure falls to a lower value known as
low pressure cut in, and this value is given by:
       Low Pressure cut in = High pressure cut out—differential setting.
        In this case the ‘cut in value’ is therefore equal to 40 P.S.I. Thus when water pressure
falls below the cut in value of 40 P.S.I. the contact will again close and energise the pump to
raise the water pressure again to 50 P.S.I. (the cut out value). The differential setting may be
of a fixed value or it may be variable depending upon the provision made. Thus we see that if
the cut out value is fixed and differential setting is varied, the cut in value changes according
to the variation in differential setting.
       In the above example the cut out point referred to as high pressure and cut in point
referred to as low pressure. However, these terms may also refer to as carrying opposite
meanings in other applications. Now, let us consider the case of a machine whose various
operations are done by air pressure. Let us assume that for satisfactory operation of the machine
the air pressure should be more than 80 P.S.I. i.e., the machine should start only if the air
pressure in the reservoir is more than 80 P.S.I. and it should stop if air pressure falls below 70
P.S.I. In this case, therefore, the cut in point is 80 P.S.I. above which the machine starts and
cut out point is 70 P.S.I. below which the machine stops. As the value of cut in pressure is
higher than the cut out pressure, it would be proper to mention these terms as high pressure
cut in and low pressure cut out. Note that here the prefix high pressure and low pressure have
changed their meanings from the previous example.
        The pressure switches basically falls into three general categories depending upon the
manner of operation. The principle of working of one type, called the bellow type, is illustrated
in Fig. 2.38. The actual switches, however, vary considerably in their mechanical design. Further
the differential setting arrangement is also not shown in this figure. The bellow expands or
contracts depending upon the pressure. The movement of the bellow tilts the lever which rests
on the micro switch knob. The thrust of lever on the micro switch knob can be varied by adjusting
the screw. This would change the pressure at which the micro switch contact will change over.
       The second general type of pressure switch uses a diaphragam in place of a bellow, the
other operation being the same. The third type uses a hollow tube of semicircular shape. When
pressure is given to this tube, it tries to straighten up and this action is transformed into a
rotary motion and through a mechanical linkage a micro switch is actuated. Pressure switches
are designed to operate within a certain range. For example a switch of 15-55 P.S.I. range
cannot be used for higher ranges of pressure of say 100-150 P.S.I.




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-3.pm5   49
50                                                                               CONTROL OF MACHINES




                                              Micro switch




                                                                 Pivot


                       Pressure                                             Adjustment
                         inlet                                                screw
                                                             Adjusting
                                                              spring




                                    Fig. 2.38 Bellow type pressure switch

   2.16 PRESSURE TRANSDUCER
A pressure transducer is an important pilot device of modern machines used in industry and
controlled by programmable controllers. A pressure transducer utilizes piezo electric or semi-
conductor strain gauges to measure presssure. Semi-conductor strain gauges are very small,
typical dimension being 0.3 inch overall length, 0.01 inch width and 0.001 inch thick. A strain
gauge changes its resistivity when it is stressed, the change in resistivity being proportional to
the strain produced in the gauge due to external stress. In pressure transducers the strain
gauges are epoxy bounded on the metallic diaphragm of pressure transducers. The four strain
gauges Rsg1, Rsg2, Rsg3 and Rsg4 bonded on the diaphram are connected in the Wheat Stone
bridge as shown in Fig. 2.39. Two strain gauges Rsg2 and Rsg4 are mounted such that increase
of pressure increases their resistance and the other two strain gauges Rsg2 and Rsg3 are so
mounted that increase of pressure decreases their resistance.




                              Fig. 2.39 Pressure transducer using strain gauges




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-3.pm5     50
CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS                                                                   51

      At balance when there is no pressure, there is no output between terminals A and B.
As soon as the pressure is applied, the strain gauges get stretched or compressed accordingly
and the bridge circuit gets unbalanced due to changes in resistance of strain gauges. Thus, a
voltage output becomes available between terminal A and B which is proportional to the pressure
on the diaphragm.

   2.17 TEMPERATURE SWITCHES (THERMOSTATS)
In many industrial processes temperatures have to be maintained within very close limits or
otherwise, the finished product may not come up to the standards. Temperature switches or
thermostats are used for maintaining a prescribed value of temperature.
       There are two general types of temperature switches used in industry. The first one is
bimetallic strip type which works in a similar way to that of an overload relay discussed earlier.
The unequal expansion of two bimetallic strips causes them to bend and this bending movement
is used to actuate a snap switch. The accuracy of this type of thermostats is not of a high order,
it is mostly used where high precision work is not required such as for room heating, air
conditioning and refrigeration. However, it has a compact and rugged construction.
       Another type of thermostat which has wide industrial application uses either a liquid, a
gas or a vapour as the sensing element in a short length of pipe or in a long thin tube called
capillary tube with a bulb at one end. The expansion of the liquid, gas or vapour is utilised to
actuate the switch contact. The temperature ranges for these units are as follows:
       Liquid filled 100°F to 2200°F
       Gas filled 100°F to 1000°F
       Vapour filled 50°F to 700°F.
       Figure 2.40 shows a view of a capillary tube type thermostat.

                             Actuating pin                                Contact block


                                                                          Actuating spring



                   Bulb sensor
                    or probe
                                                                          Operating bellow


                                                                           Housing




                       Capillary




                                    Fig. 2.40 Capillary type thermostat

       The probe is inserted at the location where the temperature is to be measured, the
liquid in the bulb expands and pressure is developed in the bellow which also expands and
moves the actuating pin which operates the contact operating mechanism. This liquid filled
type of thermostat has a very quick response. However if the length of the tube is long the



dharm
d:N-MachMac2-3.pm5    51
52                                                                                    CONTROL OF MACHINES

response becomes a little slower. This thermostat is especially useful where the switch actuating
mechanism has to be kept away from the temperature sensing side. The disadvantage of this
type is that the capillary tube gets easily damaged if it is not carefully handled.

   2.18 FLOAT SWITCH
Float switches are used to maintain liquid levels within a certain range in a tank by energising
a pump when the liquid level falls to a certain lower pre-set height and by de-energising the
pump when liquid level rises above a certain higher pre-set height. This level sensing switches
using a float can be of two types, one using a rod and the other a chain with a counter weight.
A float switch using a rod is shown in Fig. 2.41.


                       Stopper
                                               Lever
                                                       Actuator

                                                                   Contact block

                        Rod




                                                                          Hinge




                                                                     Ft           Ft
                         Float


                                                                  Symbol for float switch

                                 Fig. 2.41 Level sensing using a float and a rod

       A float is attached to the lower end of the rod. The rod passes through a hole of a lever.
Two stoppers fitted on two ends of the rod cannot pass through the hole (see Fig. 2.41). When
the liquid level rises the float also rises and moves the rod up. At a certain level depending
upon the position of lower stopper the lever gets tilted up and it inturn actuates the contact.
When the water level starts falling the float and the rod also moves down. The lever, however,
remains in the same position and keeps the contact actuated. At a certain lower level depending
upon the position of the upper stopper the lever gets tilted down by the stopper and the contact
gets deactuated. When the liquid level starts rising the contact remains unactuated till the
higher level set by stopper position is reached. This actuation and deactuation of the contact
are used to stop and start a pump motor for maintaining the desired liquid level in the tank.
      The other form of float switch uses a chain passing over a pulley with float at one end
and a counter weight at the other end (see Fig. 2.42).
       The stoppers fitted on both sides of the chain tilts the lever. The contact is opened or
closed by the position of mercury placed in a tube. The tube is mounted on the lever and thus




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-3.pm5    52
CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS                                                                   53

tilting of lever causes the contact to open or close. When the liquid level raises the float, the
stopper on the left hand side of the chain tilts the lever in clock-wise direction and thus the
switch contacts open (see Fig. 2.42). When the liquid level drops and the counter weight rises
and at certain limit the stopper fixed on the right hand side of the chain pushes the lever and
tilts it in the anticlockwise direction, the switch contact closes. A float switch may not be
suitable for certain applications, for example, in situation where there is some mounting
difficulty or where ice may form on the surface of the liquid due to low ambient temperature.
When the water level falls the ice layer remains fixed and therefore the decreasing liquid level
below the ice remains undetected by the float. In such cases the liquid level is sensed by
measuring the pressure of the liquid level. For this a special differential switch is used which
compares two pressures from different sources. The switch has differential adjustment instead
of range adjustment. The difference adjustment is used to set the maximum pressure difference
between the two sources to actuate the switch contact. The differential adjustment is used to
get the minimum pressure difference to deactuate the switch contact. In a tank where liquid
level is maintained with the help of a differential pressure switch the top of the tank is filled
with compressed air to maintain constant pressure in the outgoing lines. When water level
falls, more compressed air enters the tank and thus the total pressure in the tank remains
constant. In this case an ordinary pressure switch fitted at the bottom of the tank will therefore
always read the constant pressure in the tank.

                                                        Pulley



                  Lever                    Chain

                Stopper
                                                        Hinge


                           Float
                                              Mercury

                                                                                To control
                                                                                  circuit




                                          Counter
                                          weight




                 Fig. 2.42 Level sensing using a float, chain pulley and counter weight

       The differential pressure switch solves the problem. It measures the difference between
the total pressure in the tank i.e., (air and water) and only the air pressure. This differential
pressure is proportional to the height of water in the tank. One connection of the pressure
switch is placed at the bottom of the tank to measure the total pressure of air and water
column. The other connection is at the top of the tank which measures only the air pressure.
The switch is easily set to control the water level in the tank by setting the maximum and
minimum difference in pressure to actuate and deactuate the switch contact.




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-3.pm5      53
54                                                                           CONTROL OF MACHINES

   2.19 CONTROL TRANSFORMER
The function of a control transformer is to obtain the desired low voltage control supply from
the power supply system. The stepped down control supply voltage may be 220 V or less. There
are two advantages of using a low control voltage.
      (i) Reduced risk to the operator, and
      (ii) Reduced risk of insulation break down and grounding in the control wiring and pilot
devices.
      In India the most commonly used control voltage is 220 V, however in situation where
the operator has to continuously hold the control console in hand such as in small hoist, a
lower voltage of 110 V, 48 V or 24 V is used. Electro-magnetic devices such as contactors,
relays, solenoids etc., are manufactured in these standard control voltage ratings. The
disadvantages of using low control voltage is that the cross-section of control wire increases
and hence the cost also increases.
       The electromagnetic coils of contactors, relays and solenoids pick up above 85% of their
rated coil voltage. This provides a higher safe value of operation as burn out of coils may occur
above 110% of the rated voltage. These devices have inrush currents of nearly 6 to 9 times the
continuous holding current. Both the inrush and holding currents have low power factor. The
control transformer design should be such as to provide good regulation under poor power
factor loads. It should maintain 95% of the rated secondary voltage at all load to avoid
(i) chattering of relays and contactors; (ii) dropping of already energised devices; (iii) failure of
solenoids being closed.

               R

               Y

               B

               N


                           440 V              440 V                 220 V
                   480V

                          380V
                          220V




                          110V                110V                   110V
                               (a)              (b)                   (c)

              Fig. 2.43 Control transformer connections (a) Primary winding with tappings
      (b) Two primary windings connected in series (c) Two primary windings connected in parallel
      Control transformers are generally of two types. First type is the simple one having one
primary winding and one secondary winding with no tappings. To use the transformer at
various supply voltage the primary winding is to have tappings. For example, a typical control
transformer will have tappings at the primary winding at 440, 415, 380, 230, 200 V, while the
secondary may have only one winding giving constant voltage. The number of turns upto 440 V




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-3.pm5      54
CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS                                                                 55

tapping will be double the number than at 220 V tapping, thereby keeping the ratio of voltage
per turn the same whether the tappings are connected to 440 V or 220 V. As the volt/turn
remains same we get constant voltage on secondary side. The second type of control transformer
known as Dual primary type is the most widely used control tansformer. It has got two identical
primary windings and one secondary windings.
       In India we have three phase supply system of 415 V line to line and 240 V line of
neutral (declared voltage by the supply authorities at Consumers’ end) with ± 6% variation.
The primary of a dual transformer can be connected across line to line (415 V) if the two
primary windings are connected in series (see Fig. 2.43 (b)). In series connection the number of
turns on each winding are added together. The transformer primary can be connected across
line and neutral (240 V), if the two primary windings are connected in parallel. The effect of
connecting two windings of equal number of turns in parallel is the same as connecting only
one winding as in Fig. 2.43 (c) because the effective number of turns for determining the turns
ratio remains the same.
Determination of Rating of Control Transformer
       The primary voltage of the transformer depends upon the supply voltage available while
the secondary voltage depends upon the control circuit application. The voltage ampere rating
of the transformer depends upon the continuous holding volt ampere (VA) rating and inrush
current rating of various relays, contactors, solenoids and indication lamps to be connected to
the transformer secondary. The volt ampere rating of the components are available from the
manufacturers literature. The method of finding out the approximatte VA rating of the control
transformer is to:
        (i) Calculate the maximum continuous holding current by adding the holding current of
all the coils that will get energised at the same time and then multiplying this amount by a
factor of 5/4.
       (ii) Calculate the total maximum inrush current by adding the inrush current of all the
coils that will be energised together at any one time and then multiplying this figure by 1/4.
Now taking the larger of the two figures calculated above, multiply this current by the control
voltage. This product is the volt ampere (VA) required by the transformer.
      When it is difficult to find out how many contactors are switched on simultaneously,
take 80% of the holding capacity of all contactors and relays. Another simple method for finding
out approximate VA rating of the transformer is to make calculations using the following
formula:
                                PTR = ΣPh + P1C + ΣPL
where, PTR = The nominal power (VA) of the control transformer.
      ΣPh = The holding apparent power (VA) of all the contactors energised simultaneously.
        P1C = Inrush apparent power (VA) of the contactor of largest size.
       ΣPL = Active power of all signal lamps.

   2.20 SYMBOLS FOR VARIOUS COMPONENTS
Control diagram is the language of control and control circuits. Symbols for various components
are the various alphabets of this language. The symbols for various components have been
standardised by the Bureau of Indian Standards (BIS). In this book symbols recommended by
BIS will be followed. However, in industry one comes across drawings having different symbols
as Indian industry imports lot of machinery from outside the country. To make the students
familiar with these alternate symbols some control circuits will be discussed using the Amercian



dharm
d:N-MachMac2-3.pm5   55
56                                                                       CONTROL OF MACHINES

and British standard symbols. Once an engineer is able to read and interpret the drawings,
difference in symbol representation does not pose much problem as most of the drawings carry
a key to various symbols at the bottom of the drawings in tabular form. We have already
studied symbols for various components while studying about the components. Now all those
symbols for various components have been compiled in a tabular form for ready reference as in
Table 5.

   2.21 CONTROL DIAGRAMS
As discussed earlier the control diagram is the language of controls and control circuits. In a
control diagram is hidden the logic of the control, which can be decoded only if the reader is
familiar with various control symbols and knows how to read the drawing. A good control
diagram is that which any control engineer will be able to read even if he is not associated with
the design of the circuit. To understand the working of control circuit, first one should get
familiar with the various operations required from that control i.e., the machine operations.
The same knowledge is required when one has to design a control circuit for some machine.
Before the various types of control diagram are discussed, the following points which are building
blocks in the development of a control diagram may be gone through.
       (i) All control components like contactors, relays, push buttons, etc., are designated by
some alphabets. The alphabet is generally the first alphabet of the operation obtained by
energisation of that particular contactor or relay. For example in forward and reversing of a
motor the starter has two contactors one for forward motion and another for reverse motion.
In control diagram the contactor responsible for forward motion is designated by letter F i.e.,
the starting letter of the word forward and reverse contactor is designated by the letter R. In
most of the drawings this procedure of designating the components is followed.
      (ii) All contacts of various contactors and relays shown in the diagram are for the coils in
the de-energised state. The normally closed contact of contactor will open and normally open
contact will close when that particular contactor is energised.
      (iii) The various contacts of a particular contactor are designated by numerals. For ex-
ample various contacts of a contactor F will be represented as F1, F2, F3, F4, in the control
circuit.
      (iv) The control wires are also designated with numbers in the diagram. These numbers
are also actually marked on the wires by inserting numbering ferrules on the wires. Numbers
of wires in the drawing makes the initial wiring easy and it also helps in tracing of wires
during trouble shooting. The general trend is to mark the two supply leads from control trans-
former as L1 and L2, L2 is generally grounded and L1 acts as the phase supply for control
circuit. L1 is connected to a control fuse. After the control fuse the supply wire is marked as 1
and the neutral as 0. The other wires following from components and connected to supply wire
no. 1 are marked 2, 3, 4 etc. We will now discuss the three types of control diagrams in general
use. These three types of diagrams are:
       (a) Wiring diagram
       (b) Elementary line diagram or Schematic diagram
       (c) Wireless connection diagram
       In a wiring diagram various components are shown exactly according to their physical
relationship and location in the panel. Components are represented by their standard symbols
along with their terminals on it. A wire between two terminals is represented by a line.




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-3.pm5   56
CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS                                                                          57

                               Table 5 Symbols for Control Components

S.No.     Name of Component           Symbol       S.No.    Name of Component           Symbol

   1      Crossing of                               21      On-Delay Relay
          Conductors                                        Contacts

   2      Joint or Junction of                      22      Off-delay Relay
          Conductors                                        Contacts

   3      Earth / Ground                            23      Contactor or Relay
                                                            Coil

   4      Chassis                                   24      Make Contact
                                                            Normally Open (NO)
   5      Indication Lamp
                                                    25      Break Contact
   6      Resistor                          R               Normally Closed(NC)

   7      Variable Resistor            R            26      Limit Switch


   8      Capacitor                                 27      Selector Switch
                                                            2-Position

   9      Fuse                                      28      Selector Switch
                                                            3-Position

  10      Switch                                    29      Selector Switch
                                                            2-Position Double
                                                            Break
  11      Switch Fuse Unit                          30      Selector Switch              On
                                                                                              Off
                                                                                                    Off
                                                            3-Position Double
                                                            Break
  12      Three Pole Switch
                                                    31      Circuit Breaker

  13      On Push Button                            32      Solenoid Valve Single
                                                                                          A BA B

                                                            Acting                        PT P T
  14      Off push Button
                                                    33      Solenoid Valve          V
                                                                                         AB A B
                                                                                                          V
  15      Pressure Switch                                   Double Acting                PTP TPT
                                        P
          Contact                                   34      Winding
                                                    35      Inductor                       L
  16      Thermostat Contact            T

                                                    36      Solenoid Coil
  17      Flow Switch
                                        F



  18      Thermal Overload
                                                    37      Control Transformer
          Relay
 19.      Control Contact of
          Overload
                                                    38      Induction Motor
  20      Time Delay Relay                                  Single Phase                      M
                                                                                              1~


                                                                                          (Contd...)




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-3.pm5    57
58                                                                                 CONTROL OF MACHINES


 S.No.    Name of Component              Symbol         S.No.     Name of Component           Symbol


  39      Three phase Squirrel
                                                          41      D.C. Shunt Motor                  M
          Cage Induction Motor                                                                      ~
                                           M
                                           3~




  40      Three phase wound                               42      D.C. Series Motor                 M
                                                                                                    ~
          Rotor Induction                  M
          Motor                            3~
                                                          43      Contactor
                                                                  Representation with
                                                                  Contacts

The wiring is represented as it is actually wired in the panel. In other words, a wiring diagram
is a drawing of equipments and wires more or less as they should appear on the panel or on the
machine. A wiring diagram is useful for initial wiring of the control circuit. It is also helpful in
trouble shooting when actual wiring needs to be traced. The wiring diagram of ‘Direct on line
starter’ with motor ‘ON’ indication, for a three phase motor is given in Fig. 2.44.




                            Fig. 2.44 Wiring diagram for a direct on line starter




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-3.pm5   58
CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS                                                                   59

       Let us understand working of the control circuit by tracing the control wires from control
fuse onward. The operation required here is only to run the motor by pressing the START-
push button and when it is desired to be stopped, it should be by pressing the STOP-push
button. This is the simplest control circuit, a little introduction to this direct on line starter
was given at the beginning of the text book. If you can understand the circuit it is well and
good, if not, let us study the circuit diagram shown in Fig. 2.45 which is the elementary line
diagram or more commonly known as the Schematic diagram.




                 Fig. 2.45 Elementary or schematic diagram for a direct on line starter
       This diagram is a representation of the circuit in its proper electrical sequence. Such a
diagram provides easy understanding of working of the circuit. Whenever a control circuit is
designed it is done in the schematic diagram form. A brief explanation of this circuit is as
follows:
       All contact positions in this control diagram are in their normal positions meaning that
when the coil M is de-energised. In normal position the supply reaches upto wire number 3
through the normally closed contact of overload relay and STOP-push button. When the START-
push button is pressed, supply reaches terminal 4 at contactor coil and energises the contactor
coil. The main contacts of the contactor close and the motor starts running. At the same time
auxiliary contacts M1 and M2 also close. Closing of M1 provides a parallel path across the
START-push button. Now, even if START-push button is released, contactor coil remains
energised through the closed contact M1. Closed contact M2 energises the indication lamp
showing that the motor is ON. Referring back to the wiring diagram it will be observed that
the circuit is the same as the schematic diagram but is little difficult to read than the schematic
diagram.




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-3.pm5   59
60                                                                                CONTROL OF MACHINES

       The schematic diagram is simpler as compared to the wiring diagram. As the circuit
here is the simplest one, much difficulty may not be faced in reading the wiring diagram.
However, for more complicated circuits, the wiring diagram becomes very difficult to read due
to large number of wires crossing each other. Another point to observe is that in the schematic
diagram the components and their contacts are placed in the sequence of their operation and
not according to their physical position as is done in case of a wiring diagram. In a schematic
diagram the contacts of a particular contactor or relay will be found scattered in the drawing.
In the rest of this text book all control circuits will be discussed in their schematic diagram
form due to simplicity in understanding and ease in the development of circuits.
      The third type of control diagram is the wireless connection diagram. This kind of a
diagram is not much used but is drawn in situations where the number of wire connections are
large and there is possibility of creating confusion in reading the drawing. Such a wireless
diagram for the same motor starter (DOL starter) is shown in Fig. 2.46.




                       Fig. 2.46 Wireless connection diagram for a direct on line starter

       In this diagram wiring is not shown but the wire numbers are shown on the terminals of
the various components. The location of components in the diagram resembles their physical
location in the panel (as in case of wiring diagrams). Comparing the wireless diagram with the
wiring diagram, it may be observed that a wireless diagram is not at all useful in understanding
the circuit. The drawing may however be used for wiring the control circuit when components
are fixed in the panel as in the diagram.




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-3.pm5      60
CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS                                                                            61

                                       REVIEW QUESTIONS
   1.   State the advantage of using a fuse switch unit over a switch and a fuse in series. Discuss the
        two types of fuse switch units in use.
   2.   What are the main features of moulded case circuit breakers? What are their advantages over
        conventional breakers and fuse switch units?
   3.   Explain with the help of a diagram the working of a solenoid type contactor.
   4.   Make a labelled diagram for clapper type contactor. Explain the function of its blow out coil.
   5.   Explain the working of two types of latching relays. Where are these relays used?
   6.   Discuss the working of a bimetallic type over-load relay.
   7.   Explain the working principle of eutetic type alloy and magnetic over-load type relays.
   8.   What is the difference between a ON-delay and OFF-delay timer? How does the contact changeover
        take place in these timers?
  9.    Explain with the help of a diagram the working of a pneumatic timer.
 10.    Explain various forms of synchronous motor timers.
 11.    Discuss the principle of operation of an electronic timer.
 12.    Explain the working of phase failure relay which operates on negative sequence components of
        currents.
 13.    Explain the function of push button, selector switch, drum switch and limit switch used in con-
        trol circuits.
 14.    Mention the types of control diagrams in general use. Explain the use of each of them.
 15.    Explain why thermal timers are used only in star-delta starters.
 16.    What is a zero speed switch and where is it used?
 17.    State the function of differential setting in pressure and temperature switches ?
 18.    What are the respective temperature ranges for a liquid filled, a gas filled, and a vapour filled
        thermostats?
 19.    Explain how you will measure the liquid level in a tank where ice formation takes place in
        winters.
 20.    When speaking of current relays, what is meant by pull in current, drop out current and differential
        current.
 21.    Explain the purpose of using shading coil on magnetic pole faces of a relay for ac operation.
 22.    Mention the exact situation where a frequency relay is used.
 23.    Draw the symbols for permanent magnet type latch relay, ON-delay timer contacts, pressure
        switch, single acting solenoid valve and three position selector switch.
 24.    The purpose of quartz and fillers in the fuse is to:
        (a) increase voltage rating                    (b) increase current rating
         (c) increase heat transfer                    (d) increase weight.
 25.    Contactor coils are designed to drop the plunger when voltage falls to ______ per cent of rated
        voltage:
        (a) 50%                                        (b) 65%
         (c) 75%                                       (d) 85%
 26.    Which one of the following timers is the most accurate one ?
        (a) Thermal timer                              (b) Electronic timer
         (c) Synchronous motor timer                   (d) Pneumatic timer
 27.    Liquid filled thermostats can measure temperatures in the range of:
        (a) 50 to 700°F                               (b) 100 to 100°F
        (c) 150 to 2200°F




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-3.pm5      61
62                                                                            CONTROL OF MACHINES

  28. A pressure transducer consists of
       (a) pressure switch and a special relay     (b) a low resistance coil
       (c) a semi-conductor strain gauge
  29. Material used for contacts of high rating contactor is
       (a) Copper                                  (b) Silver
       (c) Silver Nickel                           (d) Silver Cadmium Oxide
  30. The error in synchronous timer is in the range of
       (a) ± 10%                                   (b) ± 5%
       (c) ± 3%                                    (d) ± 1%




dharm
d:N-MachMac2-3.pm5   62
!
                  Starters for 3-Phase Squirrel Cage Motor


   3.1 INTRODUCTION
Three phase squirrel cage motors are the most widely used motors in industry. About 80% of
the motors manufactured are squirrel cage motors. Simplicity, ruggedness and reliability of
such a motor make it the standard choice for alternating current, all purpose, constant speed
applications. These motors are less expensive, require less maintenance than dc motors of
equal kilowatt rating and speed.
      Before discussing the various types of starters for this motor, brief description of
characteristics of this type of motor is included as follows:
       A squirrel cage induction motor consists of a frame, a stator and a rotor. The stator or
the stationary portion carries the three stator windings. The rotor consists of cylindrical member
made of steel laminations mounted rigidly on the motor shaft. The rotor winding consists of
copper or aluminium bars fitted into slots in the rotor member. The bars are shorted at each
end by a closed continuous ring. This assembly of bars and end rings looks like a squirrel cage
and this similarity has given the motor its name.
        When a three phase supply is given to the three stator windings a resultant magnetic
field is set up which revolves around the rotor. The resultant magnetic field revolves around at
a speed given by equation,
                                       120 f
                                Ns =
                                         p
where Ns = Speed in revolutions of the magnetic field
         f = Supply frequency
         p = Number of stator poles for which the stator winding is made.
       The minimum number of poles for a winding can be two. Thus, at 50 Hz supply the
maximum speed of revolution of the field is 3000 r.p.m. For a 4 pole machine it would be 1500
r.p.m. This revolving field cuts the rotor bars and induce current in them. The induced current
in the rotor produces its own magnetic field. The stator magnetic field and rotor magnetic field
interact and the rotor magnetic field follows the stator magnetic field thereby establishing a
torque on the motor shaft.
       The current in the rotor is maximum at standstill (when the rotor is stationary, emf
induced in the standstill rotor is maximum). As the motor picks up speed, the rotor current
decreases as the relative speed between the rotating field produced by the stator and rotor

                                               63
64                                                                                    CONTROL OF MACHINES

speed decreases. The torque speed characteristic of a typical squirrel cage motor is shown in
Fig. 3.1.




                                                    2
                                                                1
                       Torque




                                T1




                                                                N3   N2 N1 Ns
                                                    Speed

                 Fig. 3.1 Torque speed characteristic of a three-phase induction motor
      This characteristic remains fixed for a particular rotor design. The characteristic can be
changed by making changes in the rotor resistance and reactance.
3.1.1 Motor Current at Start and During Acceleration
At standstill when voltage is applied to the stator winding, the rotor winding acts like a short
circuited secondary of a transformer. The secondary current and thus in turn the primary
current drawn by stator winding from supply is large. The starting current may be as high as
4.5 to 6 times the full load current of the motor depending upon the motor characteristics. As
the motor accelerates, the current goes on decreasing but at a slow rate. The current decays
sharply when motor reaches near its rated speed. Fig. 3.2 shows the current versus speed
characteristic of an induction motor.




                                               6
                        Current in terms of
                         full load current




                                               4



                                               2
                                              IFL

                                                          50%        80%        100%
                                                        Speed

                Fig. 3.2 Current drawn by a three phase induction motor during starting
      As shown in Fig. 3.2 upto 50% of the rated speed the current drawn remains
approximately 6 times the full load current. When motor reaches about 80% of the rated speed




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5    64
STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR                                                        65

the decline in the current is very fast. The motor heating rate is proportional to I2R (copper-
loss). Thus the rate of heating of the motor is high during acceleration.
3.1.2 No-load Speed and Final Speed of Motor
On no-load motor accelerates until the necessary speed is reached to overcome windage and
friction losses. This speed is very near to the synchronous speed which is the speed of the
revolving magnetic field. The motor, however, never reaches synchronous speed, since then a
current will not be induced in the rotor and the motor will not produce any torque. Refer
Fig. 3.1 for a motor with a particular characteristic designated as 1, the no-load speed is shown
as N1. When the motor is loaded, speed adjusts itself to the point where the force exerted by
the magnetic field on rotor is sufficient to overcome the torque required by the load. In Fig. 3.1
say for torque requirement of T, the motor will run at speed N2. The difference between the
speed of magnetic field (synchronous speed) and rotor is known as slip. The slip in the first
case is Ns – N1 and in the second case it is Ns – N2. The slip is also generally expressed as
percentage of the synchronous speed. the percentage slip for the above two cases then becomes,
                                          N s − N1
                   % slip (No-load) =              × 100
                                             Ns

                                          N s − N2
                   % slip (On-load) =              × 100
                                             Ns
       With the same load requirement if the characteristic of motor is changed to the
characteristic designated as 2 (see Fig. 3.1), it is seen that the motor will run at a speed of N3 .
From the above it follows that the slip necessary to carry the full load depends upon the
characteristic of the motor. As mentioned earlier the characteristic of motor depends on
reactance and resistance of the rotor.
       The slip of the motor varies also with variation in line voltage. An increase in line voltage
causes a decrease in the slip (i.e., motor runs at higher speed) and a decrease in line voltage
causes an increase in the slip. In either case sufficient current is induced in the rotor to carry
the load. For a particular load on motor, when line voltage decreases the rotor current and
hence the line current increases to produce the same torque. This causes increase in the heating


                                                                      At voltage 
                                                                      rated voltage

                                                                         At rated
                                                                         voltage

                                                                           At voltage 
                       Torque




                                                                           rated voltage




                                                                  N3 N2 N1 Ns
                                            Speed

              Fig. 3.3 Variation of slip with variation of line voltage for an induction motor




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5            65
66                                                                       CONTROL OF MACHINES

of the motor. On the other hand increase in line voltage decreases the rotor current and also
the line current and there is decrease in heating. In other words the motors can carry a larger
load. The slip at rated load may vary from 3 per cent to 20 per cent for different types of
motors. The variation of slip at a particular load for different voltages is shown graphically in
Fig. 3.3. Observe that variation in slip is very small.
3.1.3 Starting of Motor
A motor may be required to start on no-load or on full load depending upon the machinery to
which it is connected. Many industrial applications require a machine to be started at no-load,
while some machines may require starting at its full-rated load. In the first case during no-
load starting motor needs only a small torque to overcome the starting inertia. In the second
case the motor starting torque should be enough to start with the normal load against the
starting inertia.
       The most common method of starting of poly-phase squirrel cage motor is to connect the
motor directly to the main supply through a manual or magnetic starter. At starting, the
inrush current is high but due to this high current a high starting torque is developed, which
accelerate the motor quickly to its final speed. As the accelerating rate is fast the I2R heating
time in the motor is small.
      This starting method is however used only for small motors upto 5 hp.
      Higher capacity motors are generally started at a reduced voltage for the following two
reasons:
       (i) The high starting current drawn from the main supply is objectionable to the supply
           authorities as it causes heavy line voltage drops which adversely effects the per-
           formance of other loads connected to the system. The supply authorities, therefore,
           impose restriction on the industries not to start large motors directly from supply.
           Consider a 415 V, 50 hp motor whose full load current is about 70 amps. The motor if
           started direct-from main supply will draw a current of about 6 × 70 = 420 A. Thus it
           is apparent that such a high current will disturb the supply network system. The
           motors are therefore recommended to be started at a lower voltage so that the inrush
           current drawn from supply is lower.
          The voltage, however, can be reduced upto a certain level as, lowering of voltage also
          lowers the starting torque. (as T ∝ V 2). To start a motor from standstill, certain
          minimum starting torque is required depending upon the load on the motor.
          For motors which have to start on full-load the supply authorities allows the direct
          on line starting, provided the peak current is drawn in steps so that the rate of rise of
          current/sec is reduced. The purpose is to enable the automatic voltage regulators
          provided in the supply system to have sufficient time to adjust system voltage due to
          peak currents drawn.
      (ii) The second reason for starting motors on reduced voltage may be to obtain low starting
           torque. This may be desired in certain machinery where full voltage starting torque
           applied suddenly may cause machinery to get damaged due to sudden jerk. The sudden
           application of high torque may cause wear or damage of gears, chains or couplings.
           The belts may slip and the material being processed on conveyors may get damaged.
      It thus follows that squirrel cage motors are usually to be started at a reduced voltage.
The desired result may be either reduced current drawn from supply to avoid disturbance in




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5   66
STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR                                                     67

the supply system or reduced torque to avoid jerk. The reduced voltage at the motor terminals
can be applied by using different types of starters. Different types of reduced voltage starter
used are:
       (i) Resistance reduced voltage starter;
      (ii) Increment resistance starter;
     (iii) Reactance reduced voltage starter;
      (iv) Auto transformer reduced voltage starter;
       (v) Part winding reduced voltage starter;
      (vi) Star delta starter.
       Detailed description on all these starters are included in the next section. It is very
important to understand the behaviour of an induction motor during the start up and
acceleration periods. Such an understanding would enable one to select the proper starting
method to confirm to local supply authorities regulation. Though several starting methods
may appear suitable for a particular motor application, a careful examination of the specific
application will lead to the selection of the best method of starting.

   3.2 PRIMARY RESISTOR TYPE STARTERS
This is a simple and common method of starting a motor at reduced voltage. When motor is
first started, a line resistance is inserted in the motor circuit. Voltage drop takes place across
the resistor and reduced voltage is applied at the motor terminals. As the motor accelerates,
the current drawn by motor reduces and therefore less voltage drop takes place across the
resistor and more voltage is available at the motor terminals. Thus a smooth acceleration is
obtained with gradually increasing voltage and torque. The resistance is disconnected when
the motor reaches near its rated speed and full line voltage appears across the motor terminals.
The purpose of inserting resistance during starting is two fold. On one hand it reduces the
inrush current of the motor which may be objectionable to the supply authorities as it would
cause a high line voltage drop. Secondly, reduced voltage applied to the motor at start provides
a reduced starting torque which prevents damage to the driven machinery, avoiding a sudden
jerk. The value of resistance connected should, however, be so selected that besides limiting
the current inrush the motor should be able to develop sufficient torque to start from standstill.
      The resistance type starters are used for small horse power rating motors where main
consideration is limiting the starting torque to avoid damage to the connected machinery rather
than controlling the line voltage drop. These starters also have a low starting economy because
the starting resistors dissipate electrical energy. Depending upon the equipment and
arrangement, these starters may be manually operated or may be semi-automatic or automatic.
The various types of resistance starters are discussed as follows:
3.2.1 Manual Primary Resistor Type Starter
Manual starters use Master switches or Drum controllers for connecting the motor terminals
to supply. Master switch used for this starter has three positions of the operating handle i.e.,
OFF-START-RUN. In OFF-position all contacts are open. In START-position only start contacts
are closed and in RUN-position both Start and Run contacts are closed. Fig. 3.4 shows the
manual starter scheme for single step resistance.
       In the OFF-position of Master switch all the contacts S1, S2, S3 and R1, R2 and R3 are
open. When the drum controller handle is brought to START-position contacts S1, S2 and S3
close as denoted by × in Fig. 3.4 (b).




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5   67
68                                                                         CONTROL OF MACHINES




                            Fig. 3.4 Manual primary resistor type starter

        The motor starts with resistance in the circuit. When the motor picks up speed the
master switch handle is brought to RUN-position by the operator, contacts R1, R2, R3 also close
and they short circuit the line resistances and the motor gets directly connected to the supply.
Master switch handle is held in the RUN-position by an electro-magnet shown in the diagram
as under-voltage (latch) relay UV. This relay coil is connected through STOP-push button and
over-load relay contact across two supply lines. Whenever the over-load relay trips or power
fails, the coil is de-energised and the Master switch handle is released, which falls back to
OFF-position. The switch is also released when voltage falls below a certain value thus giving
under voltage protection to the motor. The operation of this starter depends upon the skill of
the operator. The time gap between START and RUN-position may be varied by the operator
to suit the particular load requirement of the motor. The motor current versus time characteristic
during starting is shown in Fig. 3.5.
        The motor current versus time characteristic is shown by a dotted line when the motor
is started direct ON-line. The starting current has been taken as six times the full load current
of the motor. The motor current versus time characteristic with resistance in circuit has been
shown through a continuous line as shown in Fig. 3.5. The current has been shown reduced to
four times the full-load current. The motor current follows the path parallel to dotted line but
at a reduced level. At time t1, when motor has reached near its normal speed, the resistance is
cut off from the circuit and full supply voltage gets applied to the motor terminals. At this time
there is sudden inrush of current as shown in the figure. Afterwards, the motor follows the
upper curve and runs at its rated speed.




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5   68
STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR                                                                                     69



                                          6


                       Starting current   4


                                          2

                                                Full load current

                                                                                         t1
                                                                Time

               Fig. 3.5 Motor starting current versus time in primary resistor type starter

3.2.2 Semi-automatic Stepless Resistance Starter
This is another type of line resistance reduced voltage starter which gives stepless decrease of
line resistance. In this, resistors are made up of stacks of specially treated graphite discs
placed in steel tubes. The inside surface of steel tubes are lined with insulating refractory
material. When a mechanical force is applied to the columns of graphite discs through a manually
operated handle the discs are compressed. The compressing of the discs reduces air gap between
the discs and thereby resistance is decreased. As the pressure on the top of discs is increased
the resistance decreases gradually (steplessely). These types of units provide a wide range of
variation of resistance and in addition have good heat dissipating capacity. This type of starter
can therefore be employed for squirrel cage motors upto 200 hp. The starter consists of a steel
cabinet which houses the resistor units, contactors, over-load devices and control contacts
          L1                                                                     P
          L2
                                                                                              Stop
          L3

                                                                                                R1


                                                                                                S1
                                                                       S                                 r
                                                                                               S¢
                                                                       R                                 s

                                                                                                     S                R



                                                                                 N
                                                                                                     (b)
                                                                                     r                       r            r
                                                                            s¢                 s¢                s¢
                                                                                     s                   s                s
                                          M                                Off position       Start position Run position
                                          3~


                                          (a)                                                         (c)
                Fig. 3.6 Semi-automatic stepless resistance starter (a) Power diagram
                      (b) Control diagram (c) Control contacts of operating lever




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5              69
70                                                                     CONTROL OF MACHINES

associated with the operating lever. The operating lever is provided outside the enclosure
which apply varying equalised pressure to the stacks of graphite disc when moved from OFF-
position to RUN-position. Diagram showing wire connections for the starter is shown in Fig. 3.6.
       When the operating lever is in the OFF-position both contactors S and R are de-
energised. To start the motor lever is raised quickly to START-position where pilot control
contacts s′ and s close and contactor S is energised. Its main contacts close and energise
motor terminals through the graphite resistance disc tubes and thus a reduced voltage is
applied to the motor terminals. As the motor accelerates, operating lever (handle) is moved
up from the START-position toward RUN-position. This movement of handle applies equally
increasing pressure on the graphite disc in the tubes and thus resistance gets reduced
uniformly and steplessly. When the lever reaches the end of its travel i.e., to RUN-position,
contact is made between s′ and r. This leads to energisation of contactor R. Contactor R then
gets hold on through its own contact R1. The main contacts of contactor R close and thereby
by-pass the resistors. Once the contactor R is energised, the handle can be dropped down
to the OFF-position which de-energises contactor S. The motor can be stopped by pressing
the STOP-push button. In case of over-loading the over-load relay control contact opens and
de-energises contactor R.
3.2.3 Automatic Primary Resistor Type Starter
This starter also has two contactors marked START and RUN as in the case of semi-automatic
starter. Here, the time gap between closing of start contactor and run contactor is controlled
automatically with the help of an electrical timer. The time can be adjusted as per requirement.
The power and control diagram for the starter is shown in Fig. 3.7.




                                              (a)




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5   70
STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR                                                         71
                                        CR2
                       P

                                                  R1          TR1       R2
                            OFF

                                       CR1
                            ON




                                  CR          S          TR         R

                       N

                                                   (b)
         Fig. 3.7 Automatic primary resistor type starter (a) Power diagram (b) Control diagram
       When ON-push button is pressed the control relay CR gets energised and is held
energised through its contact CR1, the over-load relay contact being in closed condition.
Normally open contact CR2 also closes and energises the rest of control circuit. Closing of
CR2 energises contactor S and the time delay relay TR through normally closed contact R1
of contactor R. Energisation of contactor S causes the main contacts to close and the motor
starts running with resistance connected in series with the supply lines [see Fig. 3.7 (a)].
When the time delay relay TR operates after a pre-set time, its delayed contact TR1 closes
and thereby energises the run contactor R. Contactor R remains energised by getting supply
through its own contact R2. Closing of contactor R short circuits the resistances and the
motor gets supply through the closed contacts of contactor R. The energisation of contactor
R causes switching off of start contactor S and time delay relay TR. De-energisation of
contactor S disconnects resistors from main supply. Also opening of delayed contact TR1 of
time delay relay TR does not effect the working of the run contactor as it is now held
through its own contact. The time set on the time delay relay determines the acceleration
time of the motor with resistors in circuit. This time can be increased or decreased depending
upon the load on the machines.

   3.3 INCREMENT RESISTANCE STARTER
In increment resistance starter the resistance connected in the motor circuit is cut off in steps.
The motor starts only when all the resistances have been cut off and motor gets connected to
full supply voltage and draws the normal direct on line current, which is about six times the
full load current. At this point one may wonder, that what is then the need for inserting
resistance in the circuit and cut it off in increments till the motor again gets connected to
supply ! This starter is used for large motors which require high starting torque to start from
standstill. A reduced inrush current cannot start these motors from standstill. The current
required for starting such motors is the direct on line current. However, if this large current is
drawn by connecting the motor directly to supply, the supply network gets unstable. The voltage
regulators connected in the network cannot correct the voltage drop due to this sudden heavy
current drawn from supply. In order to allow time for the voltage regulators to correct the
system network voltage, the direct on line inrush current from the supply is drawn in two or
three steps with certain fixed time delays. This time delay after each current inrush allows the
voltage regulators to adjust the network voltage. This would become more clear when we look



dharm
d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5   71
72                                                                                         CONTROL OF MACHINES

at the motor current versus time characteristic of this increment resistance starter as shown
in Fig. 3.8.




                                             6                             Third step run
                       Current in terms of
                        full load current




                                             4
                                                                Second step start


                                             2
                                                 First step start



                                                           t1           t2
                                                                     Time

              Fig. 3.8 Current versus time characteristic of an increment resistance starter
       When motor is first switched ON, the current drawn from supply is 2 times the full load
current and the motor does not start up as the starting torque developed is not sufficient to
pull the motor from standstill. After time t1, some resistance is cut out from the motor circuit
and as a consequence another inrush of current takes place. The current drawn becomes 4
times the full load current but even then the motor is not able to pull from standstill. After
another gap of t2 – t1 seconds the rest of the resistance is cut off and the motor gets directly
connected to supply. Now the current inrush reaches 6 times the full load and motor develops
sufficient starting torque to start from standstill. Beyond this time the current time curve
follows the direct on line starting current as shown in Fig. 3.8. Thus it is seen that although
the current drawn from supply is high, rate of rise of current is reduced very much to allow
system voltage regulators to adjust for the increase of current from the network. The power
circuit and the control circuit for this type of a starter are shown in Fig. 3.9.
       Referring to the power circuit it is seen that when contactor 1S closes, the motor gets
connected to supply with full line resistances. When contactor 2S is energised half of the
resistance is by-passed and when the contactor R closes, the whole of the resistances is by-
passed and the motor terminals get connected to full supply voltage. Let us see how this
operation is accomplished through the control circuit. When the ON-push button is pressed,
control relay CR gets energised and is held through its own contact CR1. It’s another contact
CR2 energises the rest of the control circuit. Contactor 1S and timer 1T gets energised
through the normally closed contact R1 of the contactor R. Energisation of contactor 1S
connects motor terminal to supply through the resistance. When timer 1T times out (say in
5 secs), its delayed contact 1T1 closes and energises contactor 2S and the coil of timer 2T.
Energisation of contactor 2S, closes its main contacts and half of the resistance is cut off
from the motor circuit. After 5 secs the timer 2T also operates and its delayed contact 2T1
closes and energises the coil of the run contactor R. Run contactor immediately gets held
through its own contact R2. The normally closed contact R1 of contactor R is now open which
de-energises contactor 1S, 2S and timers 1T and 2T. The RUN contactor R, however, remains
energised through its own contact and the motor runs by getting supply directly from the
mains, the resistances being by-passed.




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5                  72
STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR                                                     73




              Fig. 3.9 Increment resistance starter (a) Power diagram (b) Control diagram

   3.4 LINE-REACTOR REDUCED VOLTAGE STARTER
A line-reactor reduced voltage starter works on the same principle as the line resistance starter,
however, it is used for comparatively high voltage or high current installations where resistors




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5   73
74                                                                                 CONTROL OF MACHINES

become bulky and heat dissipation is a problem. Like a line resistor starter, a reactor starter is
also preferred where emphasis is on getting a lower starting torque than on reduction in starting
current. Where reduction in starting current is the main consideration, autotransformer starters
are preferred.
       The disadvantage of reactor type starter is that the starting power factor is low which
tends to increase the line regulation. Line reactors used consists of coils wound on three legged
core. Standard tappings give 50%, 65% and 80% of the supply voltage at the motor terminals.
Special care has to be taken while designing the core so that core does not saturate during the
period of acceleration. If the core saturates during acceleration period the reactance becomes
                                       dφ
low (reactance, which depends upon        , is small when the core is saturated), and the starting
                                       di
current drawn by the motor becomes high.
       The power circuit for the starter is shown in Fig. 3.10. The control circuit is the same as
that drawn for a line resistor starter as shown in Fig. 3.7 (b).
       In Fig. 3.10, 50% tapping has been used. When contactor S is energised the whole of the
reactor winding gets connected in circuit and thus 50% of the supply voltage gets applied
across the motor terminals. For getting 65% or 80% of the supply voltage the motor terminals
are to be connected at 65% or 80% tapping terminals on the reactor. The working of the control
circuit is the same as that of the resistance starter already explained. As this type of starter is

                        L1
                       L2
                       L3




                                                                                Overload
                                                                                 relay




                       S                S            S
                                                                   S

                                            R            R
                                   R                                       R

                                  80%       80%          80%

                                  65%       65%          65%

                                  50%       50%          50%




                                                M
                                                3~



                       Fig. 3.10 Power circuit for a line-reactor reduced voltage starter




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5         74
STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR                                                      75

used for large motors, the over-load relay is to be connected through current transformer as
has been shown in Fig. 3.10.
      A manual reactor starter will be controlled by a master-switch or a drum controller as
explained in case of a manual primary resistor type starter in section 3.2.1.

   3.5. AUTO-TRANSFORMER REDUCED VOLTAGE STARTERS
This type of starters use an auto-transformer between the motor and the supply lines to reduce
starting current of the motor. Taps are provided on the auto-transformer to select 50%, 65%,
80% of the line voltage for starting. The advantage of this starter is that for the same starting
torque to be developed, the line current drawn from supply is less than that in case of resistance
and reactance starters. For example for starting voltages of 50%, 65% and 80% line currents
will respectively be 25, 42 and 64 per cent of the full-voltage values. Because of high cost of
auto-transformer starters, they are used for large motors only. An auto-transformer being an
inductive load, the power-factor of the total load circuit during starting is low.
       Auto-transformer starters are of two types: (i) open circuit transition type; and (ii) closed
circuit transition type. As observed in the resistance and reactance starters, after the motor
has picked up speed, run contactor is energised and then immediately afterwards start contactor
is de-energised. In this sequence, when motor shifts from start to run mode, the motor terminals
do not get disconnected from supply. This way of energising the contactors is known as closed
circuit transition. The other way of switching the contactors is to ensure that the start contactor
is de-energised first and immediately afterwards the run contactor is energised. In this case,
for a small gap of time between the opening of start contactor and closing of run contactor, the
motor terminals get disconnected from supply, the rotor continues rotating and, therefore, emf
is induced in the motor stator windings due to rotor flux. Now when the stator is energised by
closing the run contactor with full line voltage, in certain conditions, the polarity of generated
voltage and the supply voltage may be additive to give a high inrush current which may be
harmful to the motor. This type of starting is known as open circuit transition.
       Now the question arises if open circuit transition is not desirable then why use it at all !
The reason is that open circuit transition starting for auto-transformer starter and star-delta
starters are widely used due to economical reason. Closed circuit transition in case of auto-
transformer and star-delta starter is not easily obtained as in the case of resistance and reactance
starters. This will become clear when we discuss these two types of starters. Closed circuit
transition starters are used for motors of very large ratings only.
       Auto-transformer power connections for open circuit transition: The usual practice is to
construct a 3-phase auto-transformer with two tapped windings around the outer legs of a
three legged core and connect the coils in open delta as shown in Fig. 3.11 (a). In this connection
however due to internal impedance drops, the voltages at motor terminals are unbalanced and
thus starting torque developed is relatively low. Where relatively high starting torques are
required, auto-transformers with three coil construction are used. The power circuits in Fig.
3.11 (b) shows the three winding auto-transformer connections.
      From Fig. 3.11 (a) it is clear that reduced voltage is applied between terminal T2 – T1
and T2 – T3. In three winding connections, reduced voltage from tapping is applied to all the
three motor terminals.




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5   75
76                                                                          CONTROL OF MACHINES

               L1                 L2         L3         L1            L2            L3




                       T1        T2     T3

                                  M                                 M
                                  3~                                3~

                                  (a)                               (b)

                 Fig. 3.11 Two winding and three winding auto-transformer connections

3.5.1 Manual Auto-transformer Starter
A commonly used manual auto-transformer starter consists of a three legged laminated core
around the outer two legs of which are placed the coils. Each coil is tapped at approximately
50, 65 and 80 per cent from one end.
       As starting torque of a motor is proportional to the square of the applied voltage,
connection at 50, 65 and 80 per cent tapping will therefore yield starting torques of 25, 42 and
64 per cent of the full-voltage starting torque. Thus for a motor which develops starting torque
of 1.5 times the full load torque (1.5 TFL ), the starting torques of 0.38 TFL, 0.63 TFL and 0.96
TFL respectively can be obtained by using the above mentioned tappings. These values of torques
are usually sufficient to start with loads in most of the cases.
       The starter connections are shown in Fig. 3.12. Connections of the motor to the supply
lines are made through two sets of contacts, namely, START (S) and RUN (R). These contacts
belong to the Master Switch which is operated by a handle.
        When the handle of the Master switch is in OFF-position, all the S and R contacts are
open. When the handle is brought up towards START-position, all the five S contacts close.
Contacts S1 to S5 connect the auto-transformer to line in open delta. As contacts R1 to R3 are
open, the voltage across the motor terminals is 50% of the supply voltage as shown in Fig. 3.12.
When the motor picks up sufficient speed the handle is moved over to RUN-position. As the
handle leaves the START-position, first the S contacts will open and after a split of a second
the R contact will close. Closing of contacts R1 to R3 will connect the motor terminals directly
to full supply voltage. The master switch handle is held in the RUN-position by an electromagnet,
the coil of which is shown in the figure as under voltage relay UV. As in the case of primary
resistor type of starter here also the coil is connected in series with a STOP-push button and
an over-load relay contact. When there is over-load or voltage dip or when the STOP-push
button is pressed, the under voltage relay coil is de-energised leading to the release of the
handle. When the handle of the switch is released the switch falls back to the OFF-position.




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5        76
STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR                                                   77
              L1
              L2
              L3


                                                                           Stop


                                                                                     UV



                                 S1              S2        S3


                       R1               R2                         R3



                                 80%                            80%
                                 65%                            65%

                                 50%                            50%



                                         S4           S5




                                                M
                                                3~




                             Fig. 3.12 Manual auto-transformer starter connections

3.5.2 Automatic Auto-transformer Starter (Open Circuit Transition)
In automatic starter, the transition from start to run condition takes place automatically with
the help of a timer. The motor is connected to the lines through contactors as shown in power
diagram shown in Fig. 3.13 (a). The control circuit diagram has been shown in Fig. 3.13 (b).
      Four main contacts of start contactor (S) have been used to connect the auto-transformer
windings in open delta. As the starter shown is for a large motor, motor has been connected to
supply through, circuit breaker and magnetic overload relay.
       When the start contactor is energised, contacts S4 and S5 connect the transformer
windings to neutral points. At the same time closing of contacts S1, S2 and S3 causes supply of
reduced voltage from the transformer taps to the motor terminals. The motor accelerates at
this reduced voltage. After the motor reaches near its final speed, if contactor R is energised
keeping contactor S ON, a circulating current will flow in the auto-transformer windings
between the transformer taps and neutral points, causing severe over heating of the transformer
windings. Heavy mechanical stresses produced will also be harmful to the windings. Thus
the design is such that contactor R cannot be energised unless contactor S is open. This however




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5        77
78                                                                              CONTROL OF MACHINES




            Fig. 3.13 Automatic auto-transformer starter: (a) Power circuit (b) Control circuit

will be an open circuit transition and a transient inrush current may flow into the motor.
Opening of contactor S first and then energisation of contactor R is accomplished with the help
of a control circuit shown in Fig. 3.13 (b). On pressing the ON-push button, the control relay
CR is energised and the contactor S gets energised through normally closed delayed contact




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5    78
STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR                                                               79

TR1 of timer TR. Timer TR coil is energised through closed contact S6 of the contactor S and
gets hold through its own instantaneous contact. The operating time of timer TR determines
the accelerating time for the motor. When after a pre-set time the timer TR operates, its
normally closed contact TR1 opens and normally open contact TR2 closes. Opening of contact
TR1 de-energises contactor S. Due to de-energisation of the contactor its auxiliary contact S6
opens and S7 closes. Opening of S6 has no effect on timer TR while closing of S7 causes
energisation of the run contactor R through the closed contact TR2 of the timer. The motor
runs on full voltage when the run contactor gets energised after a pre-set time from the instant
of starting of the motor. The motor starting current versus time characteristic during the
starting is shown in Fig. 3.14.




                                          6
                       Starting current




                                          4



                                          2



                                                                                  t1 t2
                                                              Time

                                          Fig. 3.14 Motor starting current in open-circuit transition

       The dotted line in Fig. 3.14 shows the direct on line characteristic while the full line
shows the current with auto-transformer in the circuit. At time t1 the start contactor is
opened and at time t2 the run contactor is closed. For a time gap t2 – t1 the motor winding
is disconnected from the supply. During this period a voltage is generated in the motor
winding due to rotor flux. At t2 when run contactor is energised the induced voltage and
supply voltage may get superimposed to give a high transient current of short duration
which may be higher than even the direct on line starting current.
      In case the motor requires a large starting torque, three winding auto-transformer
connection may be used. In this case a start contactor having six main contacts will be required.
The power connection will be as shown in Fig. 3.15 on next page. The control circuit will however
remain same as discussed earlier.
3.5.3 Auto-Transformer Voltage Starter (Closed Circuit Transition)
Closed circuit transition operation requires two starting contactors, both having three poles.
The contacts used are as shown in Fig. 3.16.
       Contacts of contactor 1S are used for the neutral of the auto-transformer windings.
Contactor 2S connects the transformer windings to the supply. When contactors 1S and 2S are
closed, the transformer is energised from the supply. Reduced voltage from the tapping A, B
and C is available at the motor terminals. After the motor picks up sufficient speed contactor
1S is first de-energised. Auto-transformer neutral connection gets disconnected. The motor




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5                      79
80                                                                           CONTROL OF MACHINES

               L1
               L2
               L3




                                    R               R                R
                                                                             R

                                        S                    S
                       S                                                              S




                                S               S                S




                                                        M
                                                        3~



                    Fig. 3.15 Power connection with three winding auto-transformers
remains connected to mains through contacts of contactor 2S and the transformer acts as a
reactance in the motor circuit. Next, the run contactor R is energised which by-passes the
reactance and connects the motor directly to the supply. Thus, it is seen that the motor gets
connected to full supply without getting disconnected from the supply. This avoids the sudden
inrush of current as experienced by motor windings in open circuit transition. The control
circuit for an auto-transformer reduced voltage starter in closed circuit transition is shown in
Fig. 3.17.
       When by pressing ON-push button the control circuit is energised, the contactor 1S gets
energised through normally closed delayed contacts of timer 1TR and simultaneously the coil
of timer 1TR is also energised. Closing of contactor 1S also causes closing of contactor 2S
through its auxiliary contact 1S1 and normally closed delayed contact of timer 2TR. Contactor
2S is held through its auxiliary contact 2S1. When timer 1TR times out, the NC contact 1TR1
opens and NO contact 1TR2 closes. Opening of 1TR1 causes de-energisation of contactor 1S.
      When contactor 1S is open, its auxiliary contact 1S2 closes and thus contactor R gets
energised. Alongwith contactor R, timer 2TR is also energised. When timer 2TR operates, its
delayed contact which is in series with coil of contactor 2S, opens and de-energises the contactor
2S. De-energisation of 2S disconnects the windings of the transformer which were acting as
reactance. The motor now runs directly from the supply. The starting current versus time
characteristic for closed circuit transition is shown in Fig. 3.18.



dharm
d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5       80
STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR                                                       81




             Fig. 3.16 Auto-transformer reduced voltage starter for closed circuit transition

                                CR2
              P

                  OFF               1TR1                  1S1        2S1          1S2




                              CR1
                  ON                                   2TR1                1TR2




                        CR                 1S       1TR         2S                  R   2TR

              N

                              Fig. 3.17 Control circuit for closed circuit transition




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5     81
82                                                                                                  CONTROL OF MACHINES




                                     6
                 Starting current




                                     4



                                     2

                                    IFL


                                                                                       t1   t2
                                                             Time

                                          Fig. 3.18 Motor starting current in closed circuit transition
       As seen from Fig. 3.18, two small inrush of currents take place at time t1 and time t2.
First inrush at t1 takes place when motor gets disconnected from transformer tappings and
runs with reactor in the circuit. Second inrush at t2 takes place when reactor is by-passed due
to energisation of the Run contactor.
       After that, motor characteristic follows the original direct on line current path. When
this characteristic is compared with open circuit transition characteristic of Fig. 3.14, it is
quite evident that high inrush current experienced in the former is eliminated in this circuit.

   3.6 PART WINDING MOTOR STARTER
Part winding starters are used with squirrel cage motors having two separate and parallel
stator windings. Large motors can be built with three parallel windings also. The windings
may be star connected or delta connected depending upon the design of the motor. Part winding
motors are used to drive centrifugal loads such as fans, blowers or centrifugal pumps. These
motors can also be used for other loads requiring low starting torque. In cases where the motor
is started with only one winding, the starting current drawn from line is reduced. When started
on one winding the motor draws approximately two thirds of the normal starting current and
develops approximately one half of the normal direct on line starting torque. It may however
be clearly understood here that if the motor is connected to a heavy inertia load, the starter
would work as incremental starting device. The motor will not begin to accelerate until the
second winding is connected.
       The advantages of the part winding starters are:
       (i) It is less expensive than other reduced voltage starters using resistors, reactors and
           transformers;
       (ii) It requires only two contactors having half the rating of the full-load rating of the
            motor;
      (iii) The starter provides closed circuit transition.
       The disadvantage of part winding starting are:
       (i) The starting torque is fixed and is low;
      (ii) Neither of the two windings has thermal capacity to operate along for more than a
           few seconds. Thus, this type of starting is unsuitable for high inertia loads where
           starting time is long.




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5                      82
STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR                                                         83

      Part-winding starter may be of the following two types, namely:
       (i) Two-step starting, and
      (ii) Three-step starting.
3.6.1 Two Step Starting
In two step starting, two contactors control the two windings of the motor. Refer power and
control circuit diagrams shown in Fig. 3.19.
                   L1
                   L2
                   L3




                                                    S                                         R




                                             OL1                                        OL2

                                         T1                         T4
                                   T2                                     T5
                         T3                                                        T6


                                                        (a)
                                              CR2
                              P

                              OFF




                              ON              CR1                        TR1




                                        CR              S           TR         R

                              N
                                                              (b)

                        Fig. 3.19 Two step starting circuits for induction motors
                         (a) Power circuit diagram; (b) Control circuit diagram




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5    83
84                                                                          CONTROL OF MACHINES

        When the ON-push button is pressed, the control relay, CR is energised which inturn
energises contactor S and timer TR simultaneously. Closing of contactor S connects one winding
of the motor to the lines. After some time, when timer TR operates, Run contactor R gets
closed and therefore the second winding also gets connected to the lines in parallel with the
first winding. Now the motor runs with two windings in parallel. Current drawn by the motor
gets equally divided between the two windings. The over-load relays are connected in both the
windings. Setting of these relays is done according to the current taken by the individual
windings. If current increases in any one of the windings and the corresponding overload relay
trips, both the contactors get de-energised. This happens because both the contacts are connected
in series with the coil of the control relay (CR).
3.6.2 Three Step Starting
In three step starting when first contactor is closed, one of the two windings gets connected to
the lines through resistors in each of the phases. After a time delay of approximately two
seconds, the resistances are cut off and this winding gets connected to the full line voltage
through the closing of the second contactor. After another time delay of two seconds, the Run
contactor is energised to connect the second winding to the lines. The value of resistance can
be so selected that 50% of the line voltage is available at the motor terminals during first step.
Thus the motor starts with three approximately equal increments of the starting current. The
power and control circuit diagrams for three step starting is shown in Fig. 3.20.
               L1
               L2
               L3




                                                S                                R


                                                1S



                                          Resistor




                                         T1                   T4
                                T2                                 T5
                       T3                                               T6


                                              (a)




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5   84
STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR                                                       85
                                CR2
               P

                   OL1
                                                        1T1                  2T1

                   OL2

                   OFF                R1




                   ON          CR1




                         CR              S         1T         1S        2T         R

               N
                                                        (b)

                               Fig. 3.20 Three step starting of an induction motor
                              (a) Power circuit diagram; (b) Control circuit diagram

       Pressing of the ON-push button will energise contactor S and timer 1T. Contactor S
closes to start the motor with resistors in circuit and the supply reaches motor terminals T1,
T2 and T3. When Timer 1T operates after 2 seconds, its delayed contact closes to energise
contactor 1S. Closing of contactor 1S shorts the resistances from the circuit. A timer 2T is
also energised alongwith 1S. When timer 2T operates after 2 second the Run contactor R
is energised, which closes to connect the second winding of the motor also to the lines. Now
both the windings are connected in parallel to the lines through contactors R and 1S.
Contactor S opens when the Run contactor is energised (due to opening of NC contact R1).

   3.7 STAR-DELTA STARTER
Star delta starting is the most commonly used reduced voltage starting method. The stator
windings of the motor are first connected in star and full voltage is connected across its terminals.
As the motor reaches near the rated speed, the windings are disconnected and then re-connected
in delta across the supply terminals. The current drawn by the motor from the lines during
starting is reduced to one third of the value of current the motor would have drawn if connected
in delta. This would become clear when we examine the details given in Fig. 3.21.
       In Fig. 3.21 (a) the windings are connected in delta. The voltage across each winding is
V. Phase current through the winding is say I amps., then the line current, IL =        3 I amp. (as
in delta connection line current is          3 times the phase current).
       Now refer to star connection as shown in Fig. 3.21 (b) the voltage across the windings is
V/ 3 so the current through winding is also reduced proportionately. Thus phase current
Ip = I/ 3 . As in star connection the line current and phase current are the same, thus line
current IL = I/ 3 . A comparison between line current in the two cases shows that:




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5     85
86                                                                          CONTROL OF MACHINES




                  Fig. 3.21 Comparison of current drawn from the lines when windings
                               are delta connected and star connected

                                 IL (Delta) =    3 I
                                                I
                                  IL (Star) =
                                              3
       Thus it is clear that line current drawn from supply in Star connection is reduced to 1/3
times the line current in delta connection.
       From the theory of machines it is known that, starting torque is proportional to square
of voltage applied to the motor windings i.e.,
                                        T ∝ V2
                                                                                              V
       It has been seen that in star connection, the voltage across the motor winding is
                                                                                           3
times the voltage across the winding in delta connection. Thus the starting torque in star
connection will be one third of the starting torque in delta connection. It thus follows that
along with reduction of current in star connection, the starting torque also gets reduced
proportionately.
       Before different types of star-delta starters are discussed, it is necessary to have some
explanations about motor winding connections. The three stator windings of a squirrel cage
motor are designated as A1 – A2, B1 – B2, C1 – C2 where A1, B1, C1 are the starting ends and A2,
B2, C2 are the finishing ends of the respective windings. To connect the windings in star either
the finishing ends or the starting ends of the three windings are connected together to form
the neutral connection. As shown in Fig. 3.22 (a), the finishing ends of three windings i.e., A2,
B2 and C2 are connected together to form the neutral connection, the supply being connected to
terminals A1, B1 and C1.
       When the three windings are to be connected in delta, finishing end of one winding is
connected to starting end of the other winding as shown in Fig. 3.22 (b) where finishing end A2
of first winding (A1 – A2) is connected to starting end B1 of second winding (B1 – B2) and
finishing end B2 of second winding is connected to starting end C1 of third winding (C1 – C2),
and then finishing end of third winding C2 is connected to starting end A1 of first winding.
After these connections are completed supply is given at the junction A1 C2, A2 B1 and B2 C1.




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5   86
STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR                                                                87

The connection of windings in star during starting and then in delta during running is done by
a manual switch in a manual starter while contactors and timers are used in an automatic
starter.

                                        A1
                                                                                A1
                                                                                          C2

                V                       A2                     V
                                 C2          B2

                       C1                          B1              A2                               C1
                                                                         B1                    B2

                V                                              V



                                  (a)                                         (b)

               Fig. 3.22 Connection of three phase motor windings (a) in Star (b) in Delta

3.7.1 Manual Star-delta Starter
A simple manual star delta starter is shown in Fig. 3.23.

                       L1
                       L2
                       L3




                                                                        A1




                                                                        A2
                    (RUN) 2

                    (OFF) 0                                          B2 C2

                    (STAR) 1
                                                          B1                         C1



                                        Fig. 3.23 Manual star-delta starter
      When the starter switch is in 0-position the windings are open. When the switch is
moved to position 1 (STAR-position) the terminals A2, B2 and C2 get shorted, the windings get
connected in star and the motor starts rotating. As the motor reaches near its rated speed the




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5        87
88                                                                        CONTROL OF MACHINES

switch is moved to position 2 and connections are established at A2 B1, B2 C1, C2 A1 as shown in
Fig. 3.23 and the motor continues to run with its stator windings connected in delta. The other
type of star-delta starters discussed in the sections to follow are:
        (i) Push button operated manual star-delta starter
       (ii) Semi-automatic star-delta starter
      (iii) Automatic open circuit transition star-delta starter
      (iv) Automatic closed circuit transition star-delta starter.
3.7.2 Push-button Operated Manual Star-Delta Starter
This starter is constructed using one contactor, two push buttons, an over-load relay and a
four pole-three position switch connected as shown in the wiring diagram as shown in Fig.
3.24. The three poles of the switch have been used in the power circuit to connect the motor to
the supply lines while the fourth one is used in the control circuit. The three positions of the
switch are 0 (OFF)-position, 1 (STAR)-position and 2 (DELTA)-position. The moving contacts
(blades) of the switch have been shown by dotted lines. With the switch in off position, if the
ON-push button is pressed, the contactor cannot be energised and therefore the motor cannot
be started (see Fig. 3.24). Now let us put the switch in RUN or DELTA position and press the
ON-push button. It can be seen that the control circuit does not get supply and therefore the
contactor M cannot be energised. This implies that the motor cannot be started in delta. When
the switch is placed in STAR-position contactor coil can be energised by pressing the ON-push
button. The main contacts now close and the motor runs in star. It thus follows that by pressing
the ON-push button the motor can be started only when the windings are connected in star
i.e., when the switch is in star position. The push button is to be kept pressed till the motor
picks up speed and the switch is changed over to delta. The ON-push button can then be
released as the contactor M will get hold through its own contact M1 and the control contact
(fourth contact) of the switch which is in delta position. It thus follows that the ON-push
button has to be kept pressed as long as we want to run the motor in star-connection. The push
button can only be released when winding connections have been changed to delta by operating
the switch. The schematic diagram for the control is given in Fig. 3.24 (b). The reader is advised
to study the control circuit according to the control requirement described above. The diagram
does not explain the transition from star to delta clearly. However the explanation is as follows:
       In the schematic diagram, Fig. 3.24 (b), it may be observed that initially the switch
contact is in position 1 (STAR). The contactor gets energised when the ON-push button is
pressed. The contactor does not hold as contact C-2 is open. Now when the switch is changed
from position 1 to 2 the contact between C-1 is broken, the contactor M will get de-energised
and contact M1 will open. When contact is established between C-2, the contactor M will remain
de-energised as supply to its coil is disconnected due to opening of contact C-1. Thus the question
that arises is how the operation which we have described earlier holds true i.e., the contactor
M should remain energised till switch is brought to position 2 through pressing of the ON-push
button. The contactor M remains energised during the transition from position 1 to 2 of the
switch due to a special design feature of the switch. The switch is so made that when its handle
is shifted from position 1 to 2 the main contacts open and then change over to their new
position while the control contact i.e., the contact between C-1 is maintained till the contact C-
2 is eatablished. After the closure of contact between C-2 the contact between C-1 is broken.
This way the contactor coil remains energised while the switch is transferred from STAR-to-
DELTA position.




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5   88
STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR                                                                               89
                                      L1
                                      L2
                                      L3
                                                               N
                                                                                OFF                P

                                                                   M                               OFF
                                                                           M1
        A1        B1     C1
                                                                                 ON
                                                                                                   ON
                                                                                                                   M1
                                                                                                                 0 2
                                                                                                            1
        A2        B2     C2
                                                                                                                   C


                                     (RUN) 2
                       Manually                                                                                  M
                       operated      OFF (0)
                                                                       C                           N
                        switch
                                     STAR 1                                                                      (b)


                                Fig. 3.24 Push-button operated manual star-delta starter
                                   (a) Wiring diagram (b) Schematic control diagram

3.7.3 Semi-automatic Star-Delta Starter
Semi-automatic and fully automatic starters require three contactors to connect the motor
windings first in star and then in delta. The power circuit diagram showing the scheme is
given in Fig. 3.25.
             L1
             L2                                                                           A1           C2
             L3



                                                                                A2                               C1

                                                                                     B1                     B2




                                               M                           D                                       S
                                                    1      2       3                 1         2        3
                  A1       B1        C1




                  A2       B2        C2




                                  Fig. 3.25 Power circuit diagram for a star-delta starter




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5            89
90                                                                                 CONTROL OF MACHINES

       Whenever one has to make connections for a star-delta starter it is advantageous to
draw the winding diagram as shown in the right hand side of Fig. 3.25. It helps to remember
that for delta connection, finishing end of one winding is to be connected to starting end of the
other winding as shown in the figure. The three phase supply is then given at the three junctions.
Now let us refer to the power circuit diagam of the starter as given in Fig. 3.25. The sequence
of operation of the contactors is as follows. First the contactor S will close for star connections,
then the main contactor M will close and lastly contactor S will open and contactor D will close
for delta connection. When star contactor is first closed, winding terminals A2, B2, C2 get
connected together through the contacts of contactor S and thus the windings get connected in
star. Now when the main contactor is closed supply reaches terminals A1, B1, C1 and therefore
the motor windings are energised in star-connection.
       For delta connection, first the star contactor should open before the delta contactor is
closed. If delta contactor gets closed while star contactor is still ON, dead short circuit takes
place at the outgoing leads of over-load relay through contactor D and S. This is taken care of
by providing interlocking of auxiliary contacts between contactors S and D. When star contactor
opens and delta contactor closes motor winding terminals A2, B2, C2 get connected to B1, C1, A1
through the closed contacts of contactor M and the motor runs in delta connection.
       In a semi-automatic starter, the motor runs in star connection as long as ON-push button
is kept pressed. When ON-push button is released the motor gets connected in delta and
continues to run till the OFF-push button is actuated or over-load relay trips. The control
diagram for a semi-automatic starter is shown in Fig. 3.26. Explanation of control operation is
as follows:

                              P




                                  OFF
                                                 M1



                                                 S1                   S2
                                  ON


                                        D1


                                             S           M                 D

                              N
                                      Star              Main           Delta
                                    contactor         contactor      contactor

                       Fig. 3.26 Control circuit for a semi-automatic star-delta starter
        When ON-push button is pressed contactor S gets energised and it connects the motor
windings in star connection. (Refer power diagram in Fig. 3.25). Simultaneously the auxiliary
contact S1 closes and S2 opens. Closing of S1 causes energisation of contactor M which is then
kept energised through its own auxiliary contact M1. Opening of contact S2 provides interlocking
i.e., the delta contactor cannot get energised as long as contactor S is energised. Contactor S




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5     90
STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR                                                     91

remains energised as long as the ON-push button is kept pressed because there is no holding
circuit for contactor S. When the ON-push button is released, contactor S gets de-energised,
its auxiliary contacts come back to their original positions as shown in Fig. 3.26. Opening of S1
does not make any difference in operation as the main contactor is now held through its own
contact. However, closing of contact S2 causes energisation of the delta contactor. Thus, now
the main contactor and the delta contactor are energised simultaneously and the motor runs
with its windings connected in delta. Whenever the motor is to be stopped the OFF-push button
is pressed, both the contactors M and D are de-energised (as holding through auxiliary contact
of M is broken). Similar action takes place when the control contact of the overload relay
opens.
3.7.4 Automatic Star-Delta Starter (Open Circuit Transition)
In an automatic star-delta starter, the time required to change from star to delta connection is
obtained with a time delay relay. A knob on the time delay relay can be adjusted at the desired
time setting required for running the motor in star. The time setting is around 10 sec. For
lightly loaded motor time setting is a little less, while for fully loaded motors the time setting
may be a little more than 10 secs. The power circuit diagram for an automatic star-delta starter
is the same as that shown in Fig. 3.25. The control circuit is as shown in Fig. 3.27.

                       P




                            OFF
                                                   M1


                            ON
                                                   S1
                                                                       S2


                                  D1



                              T1


                                       S       T             M           D

                       N
                                   Star      Timer         Main        Delta
                                 contactor 9–30 secs     contactor   contactor

                       Fig. 3.27 Control circuit for an automatic star-delta starter

       When the ON-push button is pressed the star contactor S is energised. Its contact S1
closes and therefore main contactor M gets energised. Contactor M and contactor S get hold
through their own contacts M1 and S1 respectively. A time delay relay T is also energised along
with contactor S. Energisation of contactor S and then M cause the motor to run in star
connection. This continues till timer T operates after a pre-set time of say 10 secs, its delayed
contact T1 opens and causes de-energisation of contactor S. When contactor S is de-energised
its contact S1 opens and S2 closes i.e., they come back to their normal positions. As contact M1
is already closed the delta contactor gets energised and the motor runs with its windings in
delta connection. As soon as the delta contactor is energised its contact D1 opens which provides



dharm
d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5   91
92                                                                                CONTROL OF MACHINES

interlocking avoiding simultaneous energisation of star-contactor. At the same time it also de-
energises timer T. In running condition therefore contactor M and contactor D remain energised
while contactor S and timer T remain de-energised. The circuit just discussed is for open
circuit transition from star to delta i.e., the delta contactor closes only after the opening of
star-contactor. Thus for a small duration of time the motor windings get disconnected from the
supply. During this period voltage is induced in the windings due to rotor flux. When the star
contactor closes, the induced voltage in the windings and the supply voltage get superimposed
and high transient current may be drawn from the supply depending upon the phase relationship
of supply voltage and the induced voltage. The current versus time characteristic of the open
circuit transition starter is shown in Fig. 3.28.




                                            6
                        Starting current




                                            4



                                            2

                                           IFL

                                                                    t1 t2
                                                  Time

         Fig. 3.28 Starting current versus time characteristic for an open circuit transition starter
       The starting current, due to motor starting in star connection, reduces current to one
third of the rated full load current. At time t1 when the motor reaches near its rated speed,
star contactor opens. After a small time gap of t2 – t1 the delta contactor closes. At instant t2 a
transient current may flow, the peak value of which may be even higher than the direct on line
starting current.
       Inspite of these disadvantages, this starter is the most commonly used starter in industry.
3.7.5 Automatic Star-Delta Starter (Closed Circuit Transition)
For most installations the open circuit transition starter discussed in the previous section
works satisfactorily. However, some installations may require closed circuit transition starting
to prevent power line disturbances. Closed circuit transition starting is achieved by adding
one more three pole contactor and resistors in the circuit of an open circuit transition starter.
        In closed circuit transition, the motor windings are kept energised with resistors in the
circuit when the connections of the winding are changed from star to delta. As the windings
remain connected to supply during transition, the incremental current swing during the
transition period is reduced to a low value. The power circuit for a closed circuit transition
starter is shown in Fig. 3.29. The connection scheme is the same as that for open transition
except that a contactor T is connected in parallel with the delta contactor with resistances in
the circuit. Thus when contactor T and M are energised, the windings get connected in delta
with a resistance in series with each winding. The operating sequence of the contactor is that
first the star contactor S and the main contactor M are energised and as the motor picks
up speed contactor T is energised.




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5        92
STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR                                                               93
                       L1
                       L2
                       L3




                            D                    T                         M                        S

                                                      A1    B1    C1

                            Resis-
                            tance

                                                      A2    B2    C2




            Fig. 3.29 Power circuit diagram for closed circuit transition type star-delta starter
Contactor T connects a resistance in parallel with each of the windings. The motor continues
to run in star connection as contactor S is still closed. Connections due to contactor T is not
effective as value of resistances are very high. After a little more delay, contactor S is de-
energised. With de-energisation of contactor S, contactor D closes. During the small time gap
between opening of contactor S and closing of contactor D the windings remain connected to
supply (through contactor T ) in delta connection with resistances in series. After the closure
of contactor D the contactor T becomes open with some time delay. It may be noted that just at
the instant of closing of contactor D, the windings get connected in delta as the contactor D
gets connected in parallel with contactor T and thus by-pass its action. The operating sequence
for star-delta closed circuit transition is shown in Fig. 3.30.
       The control circuit which accomplishes this control sequence is shown in Fig. 3.31.
       The control operations performed by the circuit of Fig. 3.31 are as follows:
       (i) Pressing of the ON-push button energises control relay CR. Its contacts CR1 and
           CR2 close. Closing of contact CR2 energises star contactor S.
      (ii) Energisation of star contactor S leads to closing of its contact S1 and opening of S2.
           Contactor M gets energised through contact S1 and gets hold through its own contact
           M1. Thus the motor runs in star connection [see Fig. 3.30 (a)].
     (iii) Timer A gets energised along with the main contactor M. Timer operates after a pre-
           determined time and its delayed contact A1 closes to energise contactor T.
     (iv) Energisation of contactor T connects a high value resistance in parallel with each of
           the windings, the windings being connected in star and the motor continues to run in
           star connection [see Fig. 3.30 (b)].
       (v) Timer B also gets energised along with contactor T. After some delay the timer oper-
           ates and its contacts B1 opens and thereby de-energises the star contactor S.




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5         93
94                                                                                                          CONTROL OF MACHINES

               L1                             L2                    L3   L1                       L2                    L3

                                         A1                                                  A1




                                         A2 C2                                               A2 C2
                                              B2                                                  B2
                    B1                                         C1                                                 C1
                                          (a)                                                   (b)
                                                                              B1
                            (1) Contactor S and                                     (2) Contactor T closes
                                  M close                                           (S and M also closed)


               L1                             L2                    L3   L1                       L2                    L3
                                                                                             A1
                                                                                                   C2
                                               A1



                                    C2         A2

                                              B2
                                                                          A2                                        C1
                          C1                              B1                   B1                       B2
                                          (c)                                                     (d)
                           (3) Contactor S opens                                    (4) Contactor D closes
                         (While M and T are closed)                                (While M and T are ON)


               L1                             L2                    L3
                                                                                   Operation            Contactor
                                         A1                                                        S     M    T     D
                                                    C2                               Start         X     X
                                                                                   Transition      X     X    X
                                                                                       1
                                                                                   Transition      X     X    X
                                                                                       2
                                                                                      Run          X     X    X     X
                 A2                                            C1                   (Delta)

                            B1                           B2
                                                                              Note: X indicates closed condition
                           (5) Contactor T opens
                         (While M and D are closed)                           (6) Contactor operating sequence

               Fig. 3.30 Operating sequence of a closed circuit transition star-delta starter
      (vi) De-energisation of contactor S leads to closing of the contact S2 and thus the delta
           contactor D is energised. During the gap between opening of star contactor and clos-
           ing of delta contactor, contactor T connects the winding in delta with resistances in
           series [see Fig. 3.30 (c) and (d)].
      (vii) Energisation of contactor D leads to opening of its contacts D1 and D2. Contact D1
            opens to provide interlocking with contactor S while opening of contact D2 de-ener-
            gises contactor T and resets timer A and timer B by de-energising their coils.




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5           94
STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR                                                                   95

    (viii) In the run condition motor runs in delta connection with contactor M and D ener-
           gised [see Fig. 3.30 (d)].

                               CR2
               P


                                      D1         S1          M1

                   OFF
                                 B1


                           CR1                                    D2                             S2
                   ON                                                      A1




                         CR             S             M                A        T         B           D

               N
                    Control on         Star        Main           Timer    Transition   Timer     Delta
                                     contactor   contactor                 contactor            contactor

             Fig. 3.31 Control circuit for closed circuit transition automatic star-delta starter

   3.8 STARTERS FOR MULTI-SPEED MOTORS
A squirrel cage motor is basically a constant speed motor, its speed being determined by the
line frequency and the number of poles of the stator winding. Such motors, however, can be
designed to have different speed by:
       (i) having two separate stator windings wound for different number of poles;
      (ii) having a consequent pole winding which can be reconnected to have two speeds. In
           this type the choice of number of poles is restricted to a two-to-one ratio. For exam-
           ple, a consequent pole winding can be wound for four and eight poles, eight and
           sixteen poles, and so on. Fig. 3.32 shows how poles are doubled by reconnection of
           windings.




              Fig. 3.32 The number of poles are doubled by reversing current through half
                            a phase (connection shown for one phase only)




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5      95
96                                                                                                                                             CONTROL OF MACHINES

       Multi speed motors are divided into three categories according to the torque developed
at various speeds. Before these three types are discussed, let us recall the relationship between
horse-power, torque and speed, which is expressed as:
       Horse-power developed = torque × speed.
       (i) Constant horse-power motors. These motors develop the same horse-power at all
           speeds. Thus the torque varies inversely as the speed according to the above equation.
       (ii) Constant torque motors. These motors develop same torque on all speeds. Horse-
            power rating of the motor varies in proportion to the speed.
      (iii) Variable torque motors. These motors are designed to develop a torque which is
            proportional to the speed. Horse-power rating of these motors is therefore propor-
            tional to the square of the speed.
       Torque speed curves are shown dotted for a typical two-speed motor with a two to one
ratio for constant horse-power, constant torque and variable torque design.

                                                                                          1.0
                                                                                          0.9
                                                                                                Per unit
                                                                                                 speed




                                                                                                                             ed
                                                                                          0.8

                                                                                                                         spe
                                                                                          0.7                          High
                                                                                          0.6


                                                                                          0.4
                                                                                                           ble




                                                                                                                   torq tant




                                                                                          0.3
                                                                                                                       ue
                                                                                                     Varia
                                                                                                   Torque




                                                                                                                                           nt
                                                                                                                      ns




                                                                                          0.2                                           ta
                                                                                                                                      ns P
                                                                                                                   Co




                                                                                          0.1                                       Co H
                        –5.0
                                –4.5
                                       –4.0
                                              –3.5
                                                     –3.0
                                                            –2.5
                                                                   –2.0
                                                                          –1.5
                                                                                 –1.0
                                                                                        –0.5


                                                                                                    0.5
                                                                                                           1.0
                                                                                                                 1.5
                                                                                                                        2.0
                                                                                                                              2.5
                                                                                                                                    3.0
                                                                                                                                          3.5
                                                                                                                                                4.0
                                                                                               0




                                                                           Per unit torque

                       Fig. 3.33 Typical speed-torque curves of two-to-one multispeed
                                       squirrel-cage induction motors

       We can infer from the curves that when the motor is switched from its high speed winding
to the low speed winding the low speed winding develops a considerable amount of retarding
torque which in constant horse-power motor may exceed the maximum torque developed by
the high speed winding. This high retarding torque is accompanied by high stator currents
which can be harmful to the motors. These high currents can be avoided by connecting buffer
resistance in the low winding while switching from high to low speeds.
       Another problem faced while switching from one speed to another is that when the
motor is disconnected from the lines and reconnected with a different number of poles, the
stator windings remain open during transition. The entrapped flux will generate emf in the
winding which may add to the line voltage and a high transient current may flow which may
be harmful to the windings. It is thus desired that sufficient time should be allowed for the
transition from one speed to another in order to permit decaying of flux entrapped in the
magnetic circuit.




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5       96
STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR                                                          97

3.8.1 Starter for Two-Speed, Two Winding (Separate Winding) Motor
The two separate stator windings meant for different speeds may be connected either in star
or in delta. The windings are shown in Fig. 3.34 (a) alongwith their connections for low speed
and high speed in a tabular form.

                              T1                T11
                                                                        Speed L1 L2 L3 Open
                                                                                            All
                                                                         Low T1 T2 T3
                                                                                          others
                                                                                            All
                                                                         High T11 T12 T13
                                                                                          others
                    T3             T2     T13             T12

                              T1                T11
                                                                        Speed L1 L2 L3 Open
                                                                         Low   T 1 T2 T3   All
                                                                                      T4 others
                                        T13
               T3                                                       High T11 T12 T13 All
                                                                                     T14 others
                         T4        T2         T14          T12

                    Fig. 3.34 (a) Winding connections for two-speed, two winding motor

        Refer table for star connection. For low speed, motor terminals T1, T2, T3 have to be
connected to L1, L2 and L3 while terminal T11, T12 and T13 have to be left open. For high speed
T11, T12 and T13 should be connected to L1, L2, L3 while T1, T2 and T3 should be left open.
Similarly for delta connected windings, the connection scheme for two speeds is shown in table
of Fig. 3.34 (a). In the delta winding connections, it is seen that windings get connected in delta
when terminals T3 and T4 are shorted in low speed winding and terminals T13 and T14 are
shorted in high speed winding. This is done because the winding which is idle should remain
open otherwise current will circulate in it when motor is running on the other winding. The
power diagram for star connected winding for two speed operation of motor is given in
Fig. 3.34 (b).
                              L1
                              L2
                              L3




                                                    L                               H




                                                     T1          T11
                                                    T2    M       T12
                                                    T3    3~      T13


        Fig. 3.34 (b) Power diagram for star connected winding for two-speed operation of motor




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5          97
98                                                                            CONTROL OF MACHINES

       It is clear from the power diagram that separate overload relays are required for low
speed and high speed. While making connections proper care should be taken that phases
between high and low speed windings are not reversed. Machines may get damaged if the
direction of rotation is changed. Three types of control circuits for the starter are shown in
Fig. 3.35.




                       Fig. 3.35 Control circuit for two speed, two winding motor




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5   98
STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR                                                   99

      In the control circuit of Fig. 3.35 (a) change over from low to high speed and high to low
speed can be done by pressing the respective push buttons. Push button interlocking as well as
contact interlocking have been incorporated in the control circuit design. This type of control,
however, results in rapid speed transfer which may activate the overload relays.
      To prevent this the control scheme can be equipped with time delay relays that will
provide time lag between the speed changes.
       For some drives the starting torque of the high speed winding is too low, requiring the
motor to run on low speed first before being switched over to high speed. This is achieved
through a control scheme using a compelling relay as shown in Fig. 3.35 (b). It may be observed
that pressing of high speed push button does not have any result. To run the motor at high
speed first the low speed push button is to be pressed which would energise contactor L and
the compelling relay CR. Contactor L gets hold through contacts CR1 and L2 while compelling
relay CR gets hold through its own contacts CR1. Its another contacts CR2 also closes. For
running the motor on high speed, pressing of the high speed push button de-energises the
low speed contactor L while the compelling relay CR remains hold. The de-energisation of L
leads to closing of its normally closed contact L1. Thus high speed contactor H is energised
through the normally closed contact of LOW-push button, contact L1 and closed contact CR2.
Switching back to low speed can be done by pressing the LOW-push button which would de-
energise contactor H and energise contactor L. This control scheme has the disadvantage
that both the push buttons, LOW and HIGH have to be pressed for selecting high speed
operation. This shortcoming can be removed by using a timer as shown in the control scheme
in Fig. 3.35 (c).
       In this circuit, when the high speed push button is pressed the compelling relay CR gets
hold through its contact CR3. Its contact CR1 also closes and energises contactor L through
closed contacts TR1 and H1. This in turn energises timer TR through contact L2. Timer TR gets
hold through its instantaneous contact TR (Inst). Thus even when the high speed push button
is pressed the motor starts in low speed and runs in low speed till timer TR times out and
opens its delayed contact TR1, de-energising contactor L and at the same time closing contact
TR2. When contactor L drops contactor H picks up through closed contact CR3, TR2 and L1.
       When the motor is desired to be run only on low speed, low speed push button is to be
pressed. Contactor L and timer TR would get energised. Both the contactors get hold through
the instantaneous contact of timer TR. When the LOW-speed push button is released, contactor
L gets hold through contact TR (inst), L2 and CR2. The operation of timer TR which leads to
opening of delayed contacts TR1 has no effect on contactor L. The motor can be shifted to high
speed instantaneously by pressing the HIGH-push button.
      It may be noted that when the motor is running on high speed it cannot be brought to
low speed by pressing the LOW speed push button. First the STOP-push button has to be
pressed and only then the motor can be run on low speed by pressing the LOW speed push
button.
3.8.2 Two Speed One Winding (Consequent Pole) Motor Starter
A three phase squirrel cage induction motor can be wound so as to bring out six leads for
external connections. By making suitable connections of these leads (T1, T2, T3, T4, T5, T6) the
three phase windings can be connected either in series delta or in parallel star as shown in
Fig. 3.36.



dharm
d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5   99
100                                                                                                                      CONTROL OF MACHINES

                                             L3
                                                     T4                            L3                                L1
                                                                                        T3                      T1
                                   T3                               T1



                                    T5                         T6                                        T2
                              L2                T2                        L1
                                                                                                    L2
                                    (a) High speed                                                 (b) Low speed

                                         Speed       L1        L2        L3        Open       Together
                                          Low        T1        T2        T3         —         T4, T5, T6
                                          High       T6        T4        T5          All
                                                                                                    —
                                                                                   others
                                             (c) Connection table for two-speed
                                                one winding constant H.P. motor
                Fig. 3.36 Winding connections for one winding, two speed induction motor
                                                                              T4



                                     Constant                  T3                            T1
                                    horse power

                                                          T5
                                                                                   T2             T6

                                          Speed           L1    L2        L3         Open           Together
                                           Low            T1    T2        T3            —          T4, T5, T6
                                           High           T6    T4        T5 All others                  —
                                                                              T4


                                                                     T3                 T1
                                    Constant
                                     torque

                                                                               T2
                                                          T5                                  T6

                                          Speed           L1    L2        L3         Open           Together
                                           Low            T1    T2        T3 All others                  —
                                           High           T6    T4        T5            —          T1, T2, T3
                                                                                   T4


                                        Variable                                     T1
                                         torque                      T3


                                                                                   T2
                                                               T5                                 T6
                                          Speed           L1    L2        L3         Open          Together
                                           Low            T1    T2        T3 All others                  —
                                           High           T6    T4        T5            —          T1, T2, T3

       Fig. 3.37 Typical motor connection arrangement for three phase-two speed one winding motor



dharm
d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5    100
STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR                                                 101

       If the windings are designed such that series delta connection leads to high speed as
shown in Fig. 3.36 (a), then the horse-power rating would be the same for both high as well as
low speeds. On the other hand if series delta connection is designed for low speed and parallel
star connection for high speed then torque rating of the motor would be same at both low as
well as for high speeds. Typical motor terminal connections, for constant horse-power, constant
torque and variable torque are shown in Fig. 3.37.
       The power diagram for a constant horse-power, two speed, one winding motor is shown
in Fig. 3.38.




                       Fig. 3.38 Power diagram for constant horse-power, two speed,
                                       one winding induction motor

       It is clear from Fig. 3.38 that the low speed contactor L requires 5 poles. The control
scheme for the starter may be any of the control circuit discussed in the previous section using
Figs. 3.35 (a), (b) and (c).
      We may have three speed consequent pole motors by having one winding which is
reconnectable and the other an ordinary winding. Four speeds may be obtained by having two
reconnectable windings.




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5     101
102                                                                            CONTROL OF MACHINES

   3.9 REVERSING THE DIRECTION OF ROTATION OF INDUCTION MOTORS
In a three phase induction motor, the rotor tends to rotate in the same direction as the revolving
magnetic field produced by the stator windings. The direction of the revolving field depends
upon the phase sequence of the supply voltage. If the phase sequence of supply to the motor
windings is changed by interchanging two phase leads, the direction of the revolving fields is
reversed. Thus the direction of rotation of a three phase induction motor can be reversed if the
two supply phase leads to the motor terminals are interchanged. This phase reversal to the
motor terminals is accomplished by two contactors.
       The power diagram for reversing the direction of rotation of the motor and the associated
control circuits are shown in Fig. 3.39.




                Fig. 3.39 Reversing direction of rotation of a three phase induction motor
                          (a) Power diagram (b) and (c) Control circuit diagrams




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5   102
STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR                                                        103

        It may be seen from 3.39 (a) that phase reversal to motor terminals has been done by
interchanging phase L2 and phase L3 leads at the upper terminals of the reverse contactor R.
The forward and reverse contactor are mechanically interlocked i.e., if one of them is closed
the other cannot close. This is done to avoid dead short circuit in case both the contactors
closing simultaneously. Electrical interlocking has also been provided, by using control contacts.
Electrical interlocking is essential even if mechanical interlocking of contactors is provided.
This is because, if the coil of contactor which is mechanically interlocked not to close, is energised,
its coil gets burnt. The coil gets burnt as it draws large current due to less reactance in this
case. Reactance of coil is less as reluctance to flux path increases due to large air gap between
the electromagnet and the locked armature of contactor. Forward reverse starters may be
designed for either Forward-Reverse Operation or Forward-Off-Reverse Operation.
       The control diagram in Fig. 3.39 (b) is a simple circuit for Forward-Off-Reverse operation.
The motor can be run in forward or reverse direction by pressing FOR or REV push buttons.
When say the FOR-push button is pressed contactor F gets energised and is held energised
through its auxiliary contact F1. As the interolocking contact F2 is now open the reverse contactor
R can not be energised even if the REV-push button is pressed. When the motor is to be reversed,
the motor is to be stopped first by pressing the STOP-push button which de-energises contactor
F, only then the motor can be run in reverse direction by pressing the REV-push button. Control
circuit in Fig. 3.39 (c) is for direct reversing of the motor. In this circuit, for reversing there is
no need to first press the STOP-push button. Direction of rotation of the motor can be changed
by pressing the respective push button. This is accomplished by using interlocking through
NC contacts of the push button in the coil circuits of the contactors. Assume that motor is
running in forward direction when contactor F is energised through closed contact F1, NC
contact of reverse push button, and normally closed contact R2 of reverse contactor R. When it
is desired to reverse the motor direction, REV-push button is pressed, its NO contact closes
whereas its NC contact which is in series with coil of contactor F opens. Contactor coil of F is
thus de-energised and its holding circuit is also released. De-energisation of F also leads to
closing of its auxiliary contacts F2. The reverse contactor R is thus energised through NO
contact of REV-push button, NC of FOR-push button, and NC contact F2 of contactor F. The
contactor R remains energised through its auxiliary contact R1. Similar action takes place
when the motor is to again run in forward direction by pressing FOR-push button. Induction
motors can be safely reversed by direct reversing method as the inrush current is not
significantly more than when it is started direct from rest. Direct reversing is also used for
bringing a motor to standstill quickly using reverse torque acting as a brake.

   3.10 PLUG STOPPING OF MOTOR
Plug stopping or plugging of a motor means bringing the motor to standstill quickly by applying
reverse torque on the rotor. Reverse torque for plugging of a motor to standstill is obtained by
changing the direction of the revolving magnetic field (interchanging any two stator leads).
When the rotor reaches zero speed and attempts to reverse, supply to the motor is disconnected
with the help of a zero-speed plugging switch.
       Control circuit for plugging a small squirrel cage motor from either direction with zero
speed plugging switches has been discussed in this section. Here two zero speed plugging
switches are required for the control operations. The forward plugging switch contact, FOR-
PS close when the motor runs in forward direction and remains closed till the motor comes to
standstill or zero-speed. Similarly reverse plugging switch contact, REV-PS close when motor
starts in reverse direction. Control diagram of a Forward-Reverse starter with plug-stop facility
has been shown in Fig. 3.40.




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5   103
104                                                                              CONTROL OF MACHINES




            Fig. 3.40 Control circuit for Reversing of an induction motor with plugging facility
       In this control circuit auxiliary contact as well as push-button contact (NC contact)
interlocking have been provided between Forward and Reverse contactors. The operations of
the circuit is as follows.
       When the FOR-push button is pressed, contactor F gets energised and the motor starts
rotating in forward direction. Forward plugging switch contact closes and contactor F gets
hold through closed contact of forward plugging switch and auxiliary contact F2. When the
motor is stopped by pressing STOP-push button contactor F gets de-energised, the holding
circuit breaks due to opening of contact F2. But the contactor R gets energised through forward
plugging switch, back-contact (NC contact) of FOR-push-button, and normally closed contact
F1. Thus a reverse torque acts on the motor to bring it to zero speed quickly. Near zero speed
the forward plugging switch opens and de-energies contactor R. If the motor is to be run in
reverse direction the reverse push-button has to be pressed. Similar action, as described above,
takes place when the motor is stopped from running in the reverse direction.

   3.11 DYNAMIC BRAKING
An induction motor can be brought to rest quickly if ac supply to the motor terminals is removed
and instead a dc supply is applied. The dc current flowing through the stator windings would
produce the same number of stationary poles as the number of poles of the revolving field
produced with ac supply. The rotor would cut the flux of these stationary poles resulting in
induced emf and current flow in the rotor windings. This current flow in the rotor would cause
I2R loss in the winding resistance or in the external resistances in case it is a wound rotor
motor. The rotor would slow down as a result of the mechanical energy of rotation being
converted into electrical energy and dissipated as heat. Energy conversion would be complete
when the rotor would reach zero speed.
       For a quick stop, dc current fed to the stator winding should be six to eight times the
rated current of the motor.




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5   104
STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR                                                  105

        Direct current can be supplied to the 3-phase windings in either of the following two
ways:
        (1) A pair of stator terminals T1 and T2 connected across the dc source and the third
            terminal T3 is left open. The same current would pass through the two windings,
            they being in series.
        (2) In this method two winding terminals, say, T2 and T3, are joined together and supply
            is given between this junction and the third terminal T1. This is more popular ar-
            rangement as it develops less heating for a given braking torque. This connection
            arrangement is shown in Fig. 3.41.




                       Fig. 3.41 Stator winding connections for dynamic braking
       The power diagram and control diagram for dynamic braking of a squirrel cage induction
motor is shown in Fig. 3.42 (a) and (b). It can be seen from the power diagram that dc current
to the motor stator is controlled by a variable resistance R.
       Contactor DB [see Fig. 3.42 (b)] has been used to switch on dc supply to the motor
terminals during braking. In the control circuit an OFF-delay timer has been used for setting
the time for which dc supply is to be given for braking. In an OFF-delay timer, the contact
operates after some time from the instant of switching off of the relay coil. In the circuit NC
contact of the START-push button has been used in series with the coil of contactor DB for
interlocking.
       This interlocking is to avoid simultaneous energisation of contactor M and DB and thereby
mixing of ac and dc supply. The working of the control circuit is as follows: When the START-
push button is pressed, contactor M gets energised and is held through its contact M1. OFF-
delay time TR also gets energised, its delayed contact TR1 closes immediately, and keeps the
circuit ready for dynamic breaking. When the motor is to be stopped, on pressing the STOP-
push button contactor M and timer TR get de-energised. Contactor DB gets energised through
delayed contact TR1 of the timer and the closed contact M2. Closing of contactor DB applies dc
supply to the stator terminals. When the OFF-delay timer operates, its contact opens and de-
energises contactor DB.
       In this type of Dynamic braking, the braking torque varies considerably over the braking
period. Depending upon the magnitude of dc excitation, braking torque may be 50% of rated




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5   105
106                                                                          CONTROL OF MACHINES

motor torque at the instant the dc is applied, rise to a value of 500 to 600 percent at about 3 to
6 percent speed, and then drop rapidly to zero as the motor comes to rest.




                       Fig. 3.42 Dynamic braking of a three phase induction motor
                           (a) Power circuit diagram (b) Control circuit diagram
       The reason for above mentioned variation in the braking torque is explained as follows:
It is known that braking torque is developed due to interaction between the rotor current and
the total flux (TBr = K φ t I r ). The total flux φt in an ac motor during braking has resultant value
that is represented by the constant dc flux and a superimposed flux caused by the rotor emf. It,




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5    106
STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR                                                              107

therefore, becomes clear that the flux-current product (φt Ir) at any instant of time will determine
the torque at that instant. At the start of braking period, the rotor reactance is high, thus the
rotor current has a low-lagging power factor. This current therefore has a large reactive
component that greatly diminishes the dc field. Thus under this condition the braking torque
is low. When the motor slows down, the rotor reactance becomes low, then power factor of the
rotor current increases, and the demagnetising effect on main dc flux reduces. The braking
torque thus rises even though the motor speed drops.

                                       REVIEW QUESTIONS
   1.   Explain why there is a limitation on the use of across the line full voltage starters for starting of
        squirrel cage motors.
   2.   Explain why reduced voltage is applied across the motor terminals during starting of an induc-
        tion motor.
   3.   What are the basic methods used for achieving reduced voltage starting ?
   4.   Discuss the working of a semi-automatic stepless resistance starter.
   5.   How is an increment resistance starter different from other reduced voltage starters ? Draw its
        power and control diagram.
   6.   Name the situation where you will prefer a line resistance reduced voltage starter than a line
        resistance starter.
   7.   Explain the meaning of open circuit transition and closed circuit transition, with respect to
        starting of induction motors.
   8.   Discuss the working of auto-transformer starter (closed circuit transition) with the help of dia-
        grams.
   9.   Mention the advantages of part winding starter as compared to other reduced voltage starters.
        Draw power diagram for three step starting of an induction motor.
 10.    Explain the working of a fully automatic open circuit transition star-delta starter. Also draw its
        starting current versus time characteristic.
 11.    Explain working of a closed circuit transition star-delta starter.
 12.    Discuss the working of two speed one winding (consequent pole) motor starter.
 13.    How will you reverse the direction of rotation of a squirrel cage induction motor ? Draw power
        and control diagram for the forward/reverse starter ?
 14.    Draw diagram for plugging a squirrel cage induction motor to stop from either side using zero
        speed plugging switches.
 15.    Explain the principle of dynamic braking of squirrel cage induction motor and draw power and
        control diagram for the same.
 16.    Starting current of squirrel cage motors is approximately:
        (a) two times the full load current             (b) four times the full load current
        (c) six times the full load current             (d) equal to rated current
 17.    The primary purpose of applying reduced voltage at starting to squirrel cage motor is:
        (a) to reduce losses                            (b) to attain smooth acceleration
        (c) to avoid voltage fluctuation of mains       (d) to obtain high starting torque.
 18.    At 50% of rated speed during acceleration, the current drawn by an induction motor is almost:
        (a) equal to rated current                      (b) twice the rated current
        (c) four times the rated current                (d) six times the rated current.
 19.    The starting current of a 20 h.p. motor is approximately equal to
        (a) 100 A                                       (b) 120 A
        (c) 180 A                                       (d) 250 A.




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5     107
108                                                                         CONTROL OF MACHINES

  20. In Increment resistance starter, the motor starts accelerating at:
      (a) the instant of switching on                  (b) 25% of line voltage
      (c) 60% of the line voltage                      (d) full line voltage.
  21. For a 120 hp motor which one of the following is the most suitable starter ?
      (a) Reactor reduced voltage starter              (b) Auto transformer reduced voltage starter
      (c) Star-delta starter                           (d) Part-winding starter.
  22. Dynamic braking for an ac motor is accomplished by
      (a) reversing the direction of rotation of the motor
      (b) connecting dc voltage to stator
      (c) inserting resistance in series with motor leads
      (d) disconnecting ac power from motor leads and connecting the motor to a load resistor.




dharm
d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5   108
Starters for Wound Rotor Induction Motors


   4.1 INTRODUCTION
The rotor of a wound rotor induction motor is wound with three phase windings. The windings
are star connected, the three terminals are taken out and connected to slip rings mounted on
the shaft. Connections are then tapped through brushes mounted on the slip rings. This motor
is also commonly known as slip ring induction motor. The purpose of taking out the three rotor
terminals is to connect extra resistance in the rotor circuit. Connection of resistance in the
rotor circuit limits the current drawn by motor and also the torque speed characteristic of the
motor changes. Extra resistance in the rotor circuit may be added to obtain high starting
torque and also to control the speed of the motor. To see how variation of rotor circuit resistance
effects the torque slip characteristic, let us assume that for a particular induction motor its
rotor resistance is 1 ohm and rotor reactance is 10 ohm. Let us assume that the rotor resistance
is made 1, 2, 6 and 10 ohm respectively. The rotor standstill reactance x20 = 10 ohm will remain
constant since x20 is fixed by the design of rotor. The torque equation for an induction motor is
given by :
                                           KSR2
                                 T=    2
                                      R2   + S 2 X 20
                                                   2


where K is a constant.
       We assume that value of K = 100 and find magnitude of torque at different values of slip
for (R2 = 1, X20 = 10), (R2 = 2, X20 = 10), (R2 = 6, X20 = 10) and (R2 = 10, X20 = 10), the results are
shown in Table 4.1.
       Torque slip characteristic for different values of rotor circuit resistance are plotted as
per values shown in Table 4.1. Torque slip speed characteristic for four different values of
rotor circuit resistance have been drawn together for the sake of comparison as shown in
Fig. 4.1.




                                                   109
110                                                                                                CONTROL OF MACHINES

       Table 4.1 Calculated values of torque at different slips having variable rotor resistance

     SLIP            Torque for                      Torque for                     Torque for             Torque for
      S            R2 = 1, X20 = 10                R2 = 2, X20 = 10               R2 = 6, X20 = 10      R2 = 10, X20 = 10

       0.01                  0.99                           0.49                       0.16                  0.09
       0.02                  1.92                           0.99                       0.33                  0.199
       0.05                  4.0                            2.35                       0.82                  0.49
       0.1                   5.0                            4.0                        1.62                  0.99
       0.15                  4.6                            4.8                        2.35                  1.46
       0.2                   4.0                            5.0                        3.0                   1.92
       0.3                   3.0                            4.61                       4.0                   2.75
       0.4                   2.35                           4.0                        4.61                  3.45
       0.5                   1.92                           3.45                       4.92                  4.0
       0.6                   1.62                           3.0                        5.0                   4.41
       0.7                   1.40                           2.64                       4.94                  4.69
       0.8                   1.23                           2.35                       4.8                   4.87
       0.9                   1.09                           2.11                       4.61                  4.97
       1.0                   0.99                           1.92                       4.41                  5.0


                                                                       R2 = 10, X20 = 10
                                 5                                 D
                                                                   C
                                                                        R2 = 6, X20 = 10
                                 4
                                                                   B
                                 3                                      R2 = 2, X20 = 10

                                                              A
                        Torque




                                 2
                                                                        R2 = 1, X20 = 10 T1 Load
                                                                                            torque
                                 1


                                 0
                                        .1   .2   .3   .4    .5 .6      .7   .8     .9 1.0
                                     N1 N2 N3                Slip                    (Standstill)

                       Fig. 4.1 Effect of variation of rotor circuit resistance on torque
                                   slip characteristic of an induction motor

       Curve A, B, C and D are plotted by rotor resistance of 1, 2, 6 and 10 ohms. The dotted
line shows the load torque required from the motor. This line intersects the characteristic A,
B, C and D at four different points in the stable region of their characteristic. The following
observations can be made from the above :
       (i) The starting torque for rotor resistance of 1 ohm is less than the torque requirement
           of the load connected on the motor. Therefore the motor will not be able to start from
           standstill (refer curve A).
       (ii) Starting torque increases with increase in value of rotor resistance. Refer curves B,
            C and D.




dharm
d:N-MachMac4-1.pm5     110
STARTERS FOR WOUND ROTOR INDUCTION MOTORS                                                    111

     (iii) The slip at which maximum torque occurs varies with the variation of rotor resist-
           ance. For rotor resistance of 1 ohm maximum torque occurs near synchronous speed,
           while for R2 = 10 ohm i.e., R2 = X20 maximum torque occurs at standstill.
      (iv) The value of the maximum torque developed remains constant but only the slip at
           which it occurs varies with the variation of rotor circuit resistance.
       (v) Torque is maximum when the rotor resistance X2 = SX20 is equal to the rotor resist-
           ance R2. (In graph A for example, maximum torque occurs when S = 0.1 and for
           graph D, where R2 = 10 ohm and X20 = 10 ohm maximum torque occurs when S = 1.
       (vi) The motor can be run at different speed with a particular load connected on the
            motor shaft, say T1 as shown in Fig. 4.1. The motor will run at speed N1 if rotor
            resistance is 2 ohms, at speed N2 if rotor resistance is 6 ohm and at speed N3 if rotor
            resistance is 10 ohm.
        From the last observation, it is seen that if initially, 10 ohm resistance is connected in
the rotor circuit, the motor will develop maximum torque at starting. If the load on the motor
is T1, the motor will quickly accelerate to its final speed N3. If now it is desired to increase the
speed to N2 rotor resistance is decreased to a value of 6 ohms. Further, higher speed N1 is
possible if the rotor resistance is decreased to 2 ohms. Thus it is seen that variable speed is
possible by changing the rotor circuit resistance. The value of resistance to be connected in the
rotor circuit is selected depending upon how much starting torque is required, A starting torque
of 1.5 to 2 times the connected load is generally acceptable for most drives for smooth
acceleration. The resistance to be connected in the rotor circuit should be of continuous rating,
if the motor is desired to be run at intermediate speeds for long duration. Resistance of short
time rating can be used if the rotor resistance is to be used only for starting where the resistance
is cut off rapidly.

   4.2 MOTOR ACCELERATION
To accelerate a slip ring induction motor from standstill to full speed with full load, resistance
connected in the rotor circuit is cut out in steps. During acceleration it is required that current
and torque peaks are restricted to reasonable limit. Limitation of current peaks is necessary to
prevent excessive line voltage drop and also overstressing of the switching devices. Limitation
of torque peaks is required to prevent overstressing of the mechanical parts of the driven
machinery. Figure 4.2 shows connection of a slip-ring induction motor with extra resistance in
the rotor circuit.
       To accelerate the motor smoothly, first the contacts 1 should close and energise the
stator winding with whole of resistance in the rotor circuit. The total value of resistance should
be such as to limit the torque and current to 1.5. to 2.00 times the full-load values. These
values, however, would depend upon the type of load connected and the permissible current
limit. The motor should accelerate according to the torque versus speed curves shown in Fig. 4.3.
       When the main contacts 1 close, starting torque equal to 1.5 times full load, equal to OA
in Fig. 4.3 is developed. The motor will accelerate along curve AB. When motor torque balances
the full load torque at point B the contacts 2 should close and thereby cutting off resistance R1
from the rotor circuit. As the resistance is cut off the motor should again develop higher torque
with resistance (R3 – R1) in circuit and the accelerate along curve CD. At point D, contacts 3
should close to cut off resistance R2 from the rotor circuit. Motor will now accelerate along
curve EF and reach about 80% of Synchronous speed at point F. At this instant contact 4
should close to cut-off the remaining resistance. Now, the whole of resistance R3 is cut-off. The
motor will now develop torque equal to point G and then accelerate along curve GH. Now the




dharm
d:N-MachMac4-1.pm5   111
112                                                                                                     CONTROL OF MACHINES

                            L1
                            L2
                            L3




                                                          1

                                                                                 R3


                                                                                         R2



                                                                                              R1
                                               M
                                               3~

                                                              4        3             2


                                                              4        3             2



                 Fig. 4.2 Connection scheme for starting of wound rotor induction motor



                       1.5 TFL             A                      C              E            G




                                 TFL
                                                              B              D            F        H
                        Torque




                                       0            20%       40%      60%           80%          100%
                                                               Speed

              Fig. 4.3 Torque-speed curves during the period of acceleration of a slip-ring
motor has fully accelerated and only rotor winding resistance is in the circuit. The motor runs
at a speed near synchronous speed. The Motor can be made to run at any intermediate speed,
say at point B, i.e., at 40% of the synchronous speed with resistance R1 cut off, resistance
remaining in the circuit being equal to (R3 – R1). The acceleration of motor according to the
curves in Fig. 4.3, may be obtained perfectly, by using an automatic magnetic controller.
Achievement of acceleration with a drum switch or a face-plate starter should depend upon
the judgement of the operator where the operator would cut off the resistance by judging the




dharm
d:N-MachMac4-1.pm5    112
STARTERS FOR WOUND ROTOR INDUCTION MOTORS                                                          113

speed of the motor. The torque or current versus time characteristic and speed versus time
characteristics during acceleration are shown in Fig. 4.4.



                                            1.5
                        Torque or current
                                            F.L   A             C                E        G


                                            F.L                                                 H
                                                            B                D        F




                                                  0             t1               t2       t3   t4
                                                                       (a)
                                       Speed




                                                  0             t1               t2       t3   t4
                                                      (b)            Time

             Fig. 4.4 (a) Torque/current versus time characteristic during acceleration
                      (b) Speed versus time characteristic during acceleration
       In Fig. 4.4 (a) the torque or current versus time characteristic has been shown. The
motor reaches its final speed in time t4. The exact shape of the curve AB, CD etc. depend upon
the type of load connected to the motor. In Fig. 4.4 (b) the rise of speed with respect to time has
been shown. The speed rises exponentially with respect to time as shown. It must be noted
from Fig. 4.4 that during acceleration, the motor takes comparatively less time to reach full-
load torque from the instant of cutting of a resistance step.

   4.3 MANUAL FACE PLATE STARTER
This is the oldest and simplest type of wound rotor motor controller.The rotor resistance consists
of three legs which are connected to each of the motor phase windings. The spider like contact
arm, also consisting of three legs form the star point (see Fig. 4.5). Turning of the contact arm
moves the star point along the resistor sections and thus varies the amount of resistance in
each of the rotor phases. The extra rotor circuit resistance used may be of either short time
rating or of continuous duty depending upon whether the controller is to be used as a starter
only or also for speed control. In this scheme, the time allowed for the motor to accelerate and
the resulting current peaks depends entirely upon the skill of the operator i.e., how he
manipulates the controller. In this starter the stator winding is energised through a magnetic
contactor and an over-load relay. The starter, thus combines the use of magnetic control and
manual control. Wiring diagram for the starter has been shown in Fig. 4.5 (a) and the control
diagram in schematic form in Fig. 4.5 (b).




dharm
d:N-MachMac4-1.pm5   113
114                                                                          CONTROL OF MACHINES




           Fig. 4.5 Manual face-plate starter (a) Power diagram (b) Schematic control diagram
        Interlocking provided in the starter permits the motor to be started only when whole of
the controller resistance is in the circuit. This is obtained by using an auxiliary contact of
controller in series with the ON-push button. When controller handle is in the position shown
in Fig. 4.5 (a), the whole of controller resistance is in the rotor circuit. At this position the
handle keeps the auxiliary contact closed. When the handle is moved in anti-clockwise direction,
this contact opens. The operation of starter is explained as follows : When the ON-push button
is pressed contactor M will get energised if the auxiliary contact ‘a’ of controller, which is in
series with ON-push button, is closed i.e., if the whole of the controller resistance is in the
rotor circuit. The contactor M remains energised through its auxiliary contact M1 bypassing
the auxiliary contact interlocking [(see Fig. 4.5 (b)]. With the closing of contactor M, the motor
starts with full controller resistance in the circuit. The controller resistance is now gradually
cut out from the three rotor phases by moving the handle in anti-clockwise direction from step
1 to step 4. At step 4, the whole of the resistance is cut out and the motor runs at its final speed.
The time for acceleration depends entirely upon the judgement of the operator. The motor
stops when OFF-push button is pressed or the overload trips causing de-energisation of contactor
M. When the motor is to be started again the controller handle has to be brought to initial
position again as shown in Fig. 4.5 (a). Face plate starters are simple in construction and have
low cost but they lack sturdiness and are unsatisfactory for frequent operations. This
disadvantage is overcome by drun switches. The rotary sliding contact fingers are mounted on
a drum shaft and they make contact with stationary contact fingers when the drum shaft is
rotated. The springs of the moving contacts maintain better and more uniform contact force.
In a drum switch controller the magnetic contactor for the starter can also be eliminated by
having the main contacts on the drum controller itself. Drum switches may be designed for
reversing the motor also. Drum switches, are however, often used in conjunction with a magnetic
contactor which facilitates inclusion of overload protection or any other pilot device for the
control of the motor.




dharm
d:N-MachMac4-1.pm5   114
STARTERS FOR WOUND ROTOR INDUCTION MOTORS                                                  115

   4.4 MANUAL STARTER USING MASTER CONTROLLERS
An important application of slip-ring induction motor controlled by a master controller is in
over-head cranes. A master controller, as discussed earlier while dealing with control
components, is a switch which has got plastic cams on a rotating shaft. The control contacts
are so mounted that cams can activate them. When the shaft containing the cams is rotated by
a lever, either in left or right direction particular set of contacts get actuated at different
positions of the lever. Master controllers will have lever movement in one direction only if the
motor is to be run in only one direction. Figure 4.6 shows in tabular form various positions of
the lever (OFF, 1, 2, 3, 4) in the first column. The corresponding state of the control contacts
(0, 1, 2, 3, 4) are shown by X and O. A X below a contact denotes that the contact is closed and
O denotes that the contact its open.

                                                         Lever         Control contacts
                               OFF 1 2                  position   0     1    2    3    4
                                    3                    OFF       X     0    0    0    0
                                   4
                                                          1        0    X     0    0    0
                                                          2        0    X     X    0    0
                                                          3        0    X     X    X    0
                                                          4        0    X    X     X    X
                                (a)                                     (b)

                       Fig. 4.6 Pictorial view of a master controller and table showing
                              control contact position at various lever positions
       Now, we will examine how this master controller is used to run a slip ring induction
motor at four different speeds. Control contacts 0, 1, 2, 3, 4 will be used to energise contactors
which will ultimately cut off a resistance step from the rotor circuit. The power diagram for the
motor to be controlled and associated control scheme have been shown in Fig. 4.7 (a) and 4.7
(b) respectively. As shown in Fig. 4.7 (b), the control relay CR can be energised by pressing
ON-push button if the lever of the master controller is in OFF-position i.e., contact 0 is closed.
In any other position of the lever this contact is open and therefore the control circuit cannot
be switched ON. After switching on the control circuit when operator moves the lever to position
1 contact 0 opens and contact 1 closes thereby energising the main contactor M. The motor
starts with all the resistance in the rotor circuit. A high starting torque is developed and the
motor reaches a speed which depends upon the value of resistance in the circuit. When lever is
moved further to position 2, contact 2 closes and energises contactor A. Contactor A cuts off
resistance R1 from the rotor circuit and the motor accelerates to a higher speed. At position 3
of master controller, control contact 3 closes and energises contactor B. Closing of contactor B
shorts another step of resistance resulting in resistance R2 out of the rotor circuit and the
motor accelerating to a further higher speed.
       Finally at position 4 master controller contact 4 closes and energises contactor C when
whole of the resistance is cut out from rotor circuit. The motor thus accelerates to its final
speed.
       In actual circuits using Master Controllers, time delay relay contacts are also used in
series with master controller contact so that even if the operator moves the handle directly
from OFF-position to position 4 the resistance shorting contactor A, B and C would get energised
after certain delay of time as set on the time delay relays. The actual control circuit using
master controller and time delay relays for an over-head crane will be discussed in a subsequent
chapter.




dharm
d:N-MachMac4-1.pm5     115
116                                                                                                CONTROL OF MACHINES

             L1
             L2
             L3
                                                                   P



                                      M
                                                    R3
                                                                        0           1       2       3        4
                                                         R2
                                                                   ON       CR1
                       M                                      R1
                       3~                                               CR              M       A       B        C
                                  C       B         A
                                                                    N
                                                                                  0, 1, 2, 3, 4 are master
                                  C       B         A                                controller contacts
                                                                                              (b)
                                              (a)

               Fig. 4.7 Manual starter for slip ring induction motor using master controller
                          (a) Power circuit diagram (b) Control circuit diagram

   4.5 AUTOMATIC CONTROL OF ACCELERATION
In automatic control the resistance steps in the rotor circuit of a slip ring induction motor are
cut off by energising number of contactors in proper sequence, after closing of the line contactor.
As discussed earlier, the accelerating contactor should close when motor has accelerated on
the preceding step to such a speed that closing of contactor does not cause resulting torque and
current peaks to exceed the pre-determined limit. Refer to the curves in Fig. 4.4 (b). The
accelerating contactors should close at time intervals of t1, t2, t3. There may be three types of
magnetic controls depending upon the criterion used for closing of the accelerating contactors.
They are :
        (i) Definite time control: The closing of acceleration contactors takes place after defi-
            nite time period in sequence. The timings are adjusted to restrict current peaks within
            limits.
       (ii) Current limit control: The accelerating contactors close when the current peak
            falls back to a pre set lower limit with the help of current limit relays.
       (iii) Secondary frequency control: Frequency response relays are used to close the
             actuating contactors as the motor reaches pre-determined speeds.
4.5.1 Definite Time Limit Starter
In definite time limit starters, the accelerating contactors close after pre-set delays determined
by the timers. The time periods are so adjusted that when a resistance step is cut off, the
resulting current peaks remain within limits. The time delay between energisation of successive
accelerating contactors can be obtained by using any of the following types of time delay
elements :
        (i) Individual timers, either pneumatic or electronic for each step;
       (ii) Motor driven cam timer;
       (iii) Timer heads mounted on contactors; and
       (iv) Flux decay relays.




dharm
d:N-MachMac4-1.pm5        116
STARTERS FOR WOUND ROTOR INDUCTION MOTORS                                                                             117

       Control circuits for all the above are discussed one by one as follows. The power diagram,
however, would remain the same for all these control circuits. While studying all these control
circuits it would be essential to refer back to the power diagram shown in Fig. 4.8.

                         L1
                         L2
                         L3




                                                              M




                                                                                    R4

                                                                                          R3
                                                                                               R2

                                          M                                                         R1
                                          3~

                                                          D            C        B          A


                                                          D            C        B          A



                         Fig. 4.8 Power diagram for automatic control of acceleration
                                        of a slip ring induction motor

4.5.1.1 Control Circuit Using Individual Time for Each Step
Explanation of the control circuit: Pressing of ON-push button energises control relay
CR. Contactor M and timer 1T also get energised as contact CR2 closes. Contactor M starts
                                CR2
                P

                                           D2                                                                     D1
                                                                                                         4T
                    OFF


                    ON        CR1                    1T                2T            3T
                         D1




                          CR          M         1T        A       2T        B   3T        C         4T        D
                N
           Fig. 4.9 Control circuit for a slip-ring induction motor starter using individual timers




dharm
d:N-MachMac4-1.pm5          117
118                                                                               CONTROL OF MACHINES

the motor with full resistance in the rotor circuit. When timer 1T times out its delayed contact
1T closes to energise contactor A and timer 2T. Energisation of contactor A causes cutting off
of resistance R1 from the three rotor phases. When timer 2T times out its contact 2T closes to
energise contactor B which shorts second step of resistance i.e., R2 and the motor accelerates
further. Along with contactor B timer 3T also gets energised which after its pre-set delay
energises contactor C. Contactor C shorts resistance R3. Timer 4T gets energised along with
contactor C and when it operates, it energises contactor D which shorts the remaining resistance
of the rotor circuit i.e., now, the whole of the resistance R4 is cut off from the circuit. When
contactor D energises it gets hold through its contact D3 while its contact D2 opens and de-
energises contactor A, B and C and timer 1T, 2T, 3T, 4T.
4.5.1.2 Control Circuit Using a Motor Driven Cam Timer
Explanation of the control circuit: A double element start push button is used to energise
the main contactor M and cam timer motor C. Main contactor gets hold through its contact M1
and contact M2 connects control supply to the accelerating contactor circuit as shown in
Fig. 4.10 (a). The starting position of cam timer is as shown in Fig. 4.10 (b). In this position
contact ‘0’ of cam timer is in actuated position. As normally closed (NC) contact of ‘0’ has been
used, in starting position contact ‘0’ is open. When START-push button is pressed, the cam
timer motor gets energised and it rotates the cam shaft in the direction shown in Fig. 4.10 (b).
First of all contact ‘0’ gets de-actuated. Supply to cam motor gets hold through’ closed contact
‘0’ and therefore push button can now be released. When motor shaft rotates further, cams 1,
2, 3, 4 actuate the respective contacts after fixed time intervals set by protruding portions on
the cams. Resistance shorting contactors A, B, C and D are energised through the closing of
contact 1, 2, 3 and 4. Last of all contactor D is energised through closing of timer contact 4 and




             Fig. 4.10 (a) Control circuit for a slip-ring induction motor starter using a motor
               driven cam timer (b) Schematic representation of a motor driven cam timer




dharm
d:N-MachMac4-1.pm5    118
STARTERS FOR WOUND ROTOR INDUCTION MOTORS                                                   119

gets hold through its own contact D1. At the same time opening of contact D2 de-energises,
contactors A, B and C. Cam timer motor also gets de-energised when after a full rotation
contact ‘0’ is actuated. Contact ‘0’ opens and supply to cam timer motor is cut off. Cam timer
rests in this position till the START-push button is pressed again.
4.5.1.3 Control Circuit Using Contactor with Timer Head
Explanation of the control circuit: In this circuit, timer heads (Pneumatically operated)
are mounted on the contactors. When a contactor is energised, the plunger of the timer is also
attracted along with contactor plunger. Contactor contacts close immediately while timer head
mounted on contactors closes its contact after the pre-set time delay, set on the timer head.
Variation in operating time obtained is, however, small by using the timer heads. In the above
control circuit the motor starts with full resistances, when the ON-push button is pressed.
Timer head of contactor M operates after pre-set delay and its contact M1 closes to energise the
accelerating contactor A. Contactor A shorts a set of resistance of the rotor circuit. Timer head
A closes after some delay and energises contactor B. This goes on till the last contactor D is
energised.




                         Fig. 4.11 Control circuit for a slip-ring induction motor
                                starter using contactors with timer heads
4.5.1.4 Control Circuit Using Flux Delay Relays
Explanation of the control circuit: When switch S is closed the control transformer is
energised. The secondary voltage is rectified by a bridge rectifier. D.C. supply so obtained is
given to flux-delay relays AX, BX, CX and DX. In these relays flux decays slowly when their
coils are de-energised. The relay contacts come to their normal de-energised condition with a
delay of time which depends on the rate of decay of flux. In this circuit, initially all the relays
AX, BX, CX, DX are in energised condition through normally closed (NC) contact of contactor
M,A, B, C and D. The contacts of these relays AX2, BX2, CX2, DX2 are therefore open. When
motor is started by pressing the ON-push button contactor M gets hold through its contact M2
while its NC contact M1 opens and de-energises relay AX. Relay AX gets de-energised instantly
but its contact AX2 closes, when flux becomes zero after some time delay. Closing of contact
AX2 energises accelerating contactor A. Thus first step of resistance gets cut off from the rotor
circuit due to closing of contactor A. Its contact A1 opens and de-energises relay BX. Also
contact A2 closes in the coil circuit of contactor B, After pre-set delay of relay BX, its contact




dharm
d:N-MachMac4-1.pm5   119
120                                                                                                                 CONTROL OF MACHINES

BX2 closes and energises contactor B. Thus second step of resistances is also cut off from rotor
circuit. The same sequence of operations follows for energisation of contactor C and D.

             P
                     S
                                                                            OFF


                                           M1            A1    B1     C1 ON                   M2



                                                                                            AX2    A2          B2        C2


                                                                                                   BX2         CX2       DX2

                                                AX        BX    CX     DX

                                                                                        M     A            B        C         D

             N

           Fig. 4.12 Control circuit for a slip-ring induction motor starter using flux-delay relays
4.5.2 Current Limit Acceleration Starter
In this type of starter, the accelerating contactor closes depending upon the amount of stator/
rotor current. Accelerating contactors are energised when current peak falls to a pre-determined
value equal to full-load current. Refer to Fig. 4.4 (a) at points B, D, F and H the acclerating
contactors are energised and they cut off resistance in steps.
       A current limit acceleration starter uses a special relay known as current limit relay.
This relay has two coil viz. a potential coil and a current coil. The current coil restrains the
relay from operating when current through the coil is more than the pre-set value. As the
current through the current coil drops to the pre-set value, the relay operates provided, however,
the potential coil is also energised.If the potential coil is not energised, the relay would not
function. The current coil of the current limit relay is energised by a current transformer
provided on one phase of the stator line connections. The control diagram is shown in Fig. 4.13.

                                From Current Transformer (C.T)
                 P
                                         X(C)    X(V)                Y(C)        Y(V)                   C2          D2
                                                          X1   A2                       Y1 B2
                     OFF



                         ON         M1
                                                M2                          A3                    B3           C3

                                                 A1                         B1                     C1          D1



                                M                    A                            B                    C            D
                 N

                              Fig. 4.13 Control circuit for a current limit acceleration starter




dharm
d:N-MachMac4-1.pm5           120
STARTERS FOR WOUND ROTOR INDUCTION MOTORS                                                    121

        One point to be understood before studying this control circuit is that, the auxiliary
contacts of contactors are so adjusted that normally open (NO) contact closes before the normally
closed (NC) contact opens. This provision is necessary for functinoning of the above control
circuit: The motor is energised when the ON-push button is pressed and contactor M closes.
Voltage coil X(V) of relay X is energised through closed contact A1 and M2. Coil of contactor A
and X(V) are in series. Contactor A does not pick up as its coil impedance is high and the
current flowing through the coil circuit is not sufficient for the contactor to pick up. Relay X
would operate provided the required amount of current through the current coil X(C) flows.
Initially when the motor is energised, high inrush current flows and therefore the current coil
X (C) restrains the relay from operating. The relay operates when the current falls to a pre-
determined lower value. When the relay operates its contact X1 closes and short the voltage
coil X(V) while direct supply to contactor coil A gets applied. Contactor A closes and gets hold
through its contact A2. Little later its contact A1 opens. Opening of A1 de-energises the voltage
coil of relay X. Its contact X1 also opens. When contactor A closes, some resistance from rotor
circuit gets cut off, now again an inrush of current takes place. Current coil Y(C) of relay Y
restrains the relay Y from operating. Due to closing of contact A3 voltage coil Y(V) which is in
series with coil of contactor B gets energised. Contactor B does not pick up as the voltage coil
Y(V) is in series. When the motor accelerates, and current through current coil Y(C) comes to
a lower pre-set value, relay Y operates and closes its contact Y1. Closure of contact Y1 energises
contactor B which then gets hold through its own contact B2. Contact B1 opens and keeps the
relay Y inoperative due to de-energisation of voltage coil Y(V). Contactor B shorts another set
of resistance from the rotor circuit. Again there is a current peak. Relay X again comes into
action, as its voltage coil X(V) gets energised through closing of contact B3. The contactor C
will close when the relay operates as a result of current falling to a lower pre-set value. As
contactor C closes, relay Y comes into operation due to closing of contact C3. When relay Y
operates, accelerating contactor D is energised. These two relays X and Y may be used to
energise any number of accelerating contactors.
4.5.3 Secondary Frequency Acceleration Starter
When a wound rotor induction motor accelerates from standstill to final speed the rotor voltage
drops from a maximum value at standstill to nearly zero value at final speed. The frequency of
the rotor voltage also drops from line frequency at standstill to nearly zero at the final speed.
Frequency of rotor induced emf, fr at any speed is a function of slip s, of the motor and is
expressed as:
                                      fr = sf
       If line frequency is 50 Hz. then frequency of rotor voltage at a slip of 0.02 is, fr = 0.02 ×
50 = 1 Hz. From the above, it is seen that the accelerating contactors may be made to close as
a function of motor speed by using some relays which would respond to the rotor voltage and
rotor frequency conditions. Frequency responsive relays 1F, 2F, 3F as shown in Fig. 4.14 (a),
are connected in the secondary circuit. Each relay coil is connected through a capacitor to a
potentiometer resistor, which in turn is connected across one leg of the starting resistor. The
inductance of each relay coil in combination with the capacitor forms a series resonant circuit,
allowing a high current flow within a certain frequency range, width of the frequency range
being determined by the adjustment of the resistor. Frequency control relays 1F, 2F and 3F
are tuned so that they would drop at a desired frequency below their series resonant frequency.
For example relay 1F is resonant (minimum impedance) at 50 Hz but drops out at 45 Hz, relay
2F is resonant at 45 Hz but drops out at 30 Hz and relay 3F is resonance at 30 Hz but drops out
at 15 Hz. The starter shown in Fig. 4.14 will operate in the following manner:




dharm
d:N-MachMac4-1.pm5   121
122                                                                                      CONTROL OF MACHINES




                                   M
                                   3~



                                         C                  B             A



                                         C                  B             A




                                                                1F                     50-45 Hz
                                                                              C1


                                                                2F                     45-30 Hz
                                                                              C2


                                                                3F                     30-15 Hz
                                                                              C3


                        P




                            Stop
                                             M2


                                                                2F1           3F1
                         Start                    1F1
                                        M1
                                                                A1            B1


                                   M                    A             B            C

                        N

                       Fig. 4.14 Control circuit for a rotor frequency acceleration starter
        (i) When the START-push button is pressed, the contactor M energises the stator and
            motor starts with full resistance in rotor circuit. At starting, relay 1F will pick up as
            its resonant frequency is 50 Hz. Its contact 1F1 opens. As the motor accelerates the
            rotor frequency drops. When the frequency falls to 45 Hz, the relay 1F drops, its
            contact 1F1 closes and energises contactor A.
        (ii) Energisation of contactor A cuts off one set of resistance from rotor circuit and the
             motor accelerates further.
       (iii) As the motor gains speed its rotor frequency falls. At 30 Hz the relay 2F drops and
             relay 3F picks up. As relay 2F drops its contact 2F1 closes and energises contactor B




dharm
d:N-MachMac4-1.pm5        122
STARTERS FOR WOUND ROTOR INDUCTION MOTORS                                                          123

           which shorts another set of resistance. At the same time relay 3F picks up at 30 Hz
           and its (NC) contact 3F1 opens.
       (iv) The motor further gains speed and its frequency decreases to 15 Hz. At this fre-
            quency relay 3F drops. Its NC contact 3F1 closes and energises contactor C through
            already closed contact B1. Energisation of contactor C cuts off all the resistance from
            the rotor circuit and the motor accelerates to its final speed.
        In this scheme, the resistance steps get cut off quickly if the motor is lightly loaded i.e.,
if the motor gains speed quickly and thus its rotor frequency falls quickly, the respective relays
would drop and the resistance steps would be cut off similarly. When the motor is heavily
loaded it would gain speed slowly and the rotor frequency also would fall slowly and therefore
the resistance steps would get cut off slowly.

                                      REVIEW QUESTIONS
   1.   Show the effect of variation of rotor circuit resistance on torque slip characteristic of a wound
        rotor induction motor.
   2.   Draw torque speed characteristic during the period of acceleration of a slip ring induction motor.
   3.   Explain whether wound rotor motors with secondary control or squirrel cage motors with pri-
        mary reduced voltage starting gives the higher starting torque.
   4.   Discuss Manual face plate starters for a slip ring induction motor.
   5.   Discuss working of definite time limit starter using (a) Individual timer (b) Motor driven cam
        timer.
   6.   What are flux delay relays ? How are they used for automatic acceleration of wound rotor motors ?
   7.   Discuss the working of current limit acceleration starter for slip ring induction motor.
   8.   Discuss rotor frequency acceleration starter for slip ring induction motor.
   9.   The rotor windings of a wound rotor induction motor are:
        (a) Star connected and three terminals taken out
        (b) Delta connected and three terminals taken out
        (c) Not connected inside and all the six terminals are taken out
 10. In wound rotor induction motors, when rotor reistance is increased, the starting torque:
     (a) decreases                                   (b) increases
     (c) remains same
 11. If rotor resistance of a wound rotor motor is 6 ohms and rotor resistance is 12 ohms, the maxi-
     mum torque will occur at:
     (a) starting                                    (b) rated speed
     (c) half the rated speed                        (d) one fourth the rated speed
 12. In wound rotor motors as the motor accelerates the rotor frequency:
     (a) decreases                                   (b) increases
     (c) remains same
 13. The starting current of wound rotor induction motor is in the range of:
     (a) 2.5 to 3                                    (b) 2.5 to 4
     (c) 5 to 6                                      (d) 1 to 2 times the rated current.




dharm
d:N-MachMac4-1.pm5     123
5
                                   Starters for Direct Current Motors


In this chapter brief description of different types of dc motors and their fields of applications
have been given. Principles of motor acceleration have been first discussed before dealing with
different types of manual and automatic starters.

   5.1 TYPES OF DC MOTORS AND THEIR APPLICATIONS
DC motors are classified into three types depending on the way their field windings are excited.
Field winding connections for the three types of dc motors have been shown in Fig. 5.1.

                         V                         V                         V

                     Shunt field                 Series
                     stablising                                             Series
                                                  field
                        field                                                field


                         M                         M                        M

                    Shunt motor               Series motor           Compound motor
                        (a)                        (b)                     (c)

                 Fig. 5.1 Connections of field windings for different types of dc motors
      Brief description of different types of dc motors are given as follows:
5.1.1 Shunt Motor
In this type of motor, the field winding is connected in parallel with armature as shown in
Fig. 5.1(a). There are as many number of field coils as there are poles. When connected to
supply, constant voltage appears across the field windings (as they are connected in parallel
with armature). The field current is therefore constant and is independent of the load current.
Shunt field winding usually are designed to have large number of turns of fine wire. Its
resistance, therefore, is high enough to limit the shunt field current to about 1 to 4 percent of
the rated motor current.
       A shunt motor operates at nearly constant speed over its normal load range. It has a
definite stable no-load speed. The motor is adaptable to large speed variations. The disadvantage
of the motor is that it has low starting torque and over-load torque capability.
5.1.2 Series Motor
A series motor receives its excitation from a winding which is connected in series with the
armature and carries load current. As the series field has to carry high load current, it is made

                                                  124
STARTERS FOR DIRECT CURRENT MOTORS                                                          125

of a thick wire and a few turns. As the resistance is low, the voltage drop across the series
winding is small.
      This motor has excellent starting and over-load torque characteristics. The disadvantages
are that the motor attains dangerously high speed at no-load. Speed adjustment of the motor
is somewhat difficult.
5.1.3 Compound Motor
In compound motors excitation results from combined action of both shunt field winding and
series field winding. Fig. 5.1(c) shows the winding connections with the series field of the
compound motor carrying the armature current(the long-shunt connection). In the short-shunt
connection, which is sometimes used, the shunt field is directly connected in parallel with the
armature, in which case, the series field current is the same as the line current. Excitation of
a compound motor is a combination of series and shunt excitation. The motor, therefore, has
mixed characteristic between that of a series motor and a shunt motor. This motor behaves
somewhat better than a shunt motor from the point of view of starting and overload torque;
and has definite stable no-load speed like a shunt motor. Speed of this motor is adjustable as
easily as that of a shunt motor. It’s speed, however, tends to change as much as 25 percent
between full-load and no-load due to the effect of series winding.
       A brief description of some special field windings used in modern motors for corrective
influence upon the operation of the motor under load is given as follows.
       These field windings are called corrective fields. Their purpose is to reduce the effects of
armature reaction such as poor commutation, instability at high speeds, and commutator
flashover under conditions of suddenly applied overloads.
       Interpole windings are most widely used corrective field windings. Interpole windings
are connected permanently in series with the armature circuit. This field maintains the magnetic
neutral axis in the same position under all load conditions and thereby permits the motor to
commutate well i.e., without sparking at the brushes.
       Stabilising field winding is used only in shunt motors that are made to operate at high
speeds by shunt-field weakening. This a series field winding placed directly over the shunt
winding whose moderate flux tends to prevent run away operation or instability that may
result from the demagnetising effect of armature reaction.
       Compensating winding is placed in slots or holes in the main pole faces. This winding is
also connected in series with the armature circuit. This winding creates a magnetic field that
tends to offset the armature reaction which acts to distort the flux-density distribution under
the pole faces. If this flux distortion is left uncorrected, it would increase the probability of
flashover between brushes under conditions of suddenly applied overloads.

   5.2 PRINCIPLES OF DC MOTOR ACCELERATION
In any motor, whether ac or dc both motor and generator action takes place simultaneously.
This would become clear when we examine how torque is produced and how the armature
current gets regulated automatically depending upon varying load requirements of the motor.
       In a dc motor when supply voltage is impressed at the motor terminals current flows
through the armature conductors placed in the magnetic field. Interaction of magnetic field
and armature conductors carrying current results in development of a force on the armature
conductors. As a result the armature starts revolving (motor action). When the armature starts
revolving its conductors cuts the magnetic field and an emf is generated in these conductors
(generator action). This generated emf is also called counter emf as its polarity is opposite to




dharm
d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5   125
126                                                                       CONTROL OF MACHINES

the polarity of the applied voltage. This generated counter emf exercises a limiting effect upon
the armature current and causes the motor to adjust its speed automatically to meet the varying
demands of the load. Armature current in a dc motor is directly proportional to the difference
between the impressed armature voltage V and the counter emf E and inversely proportional
to the armature circuit resistance Ra. The equation for armature current can, therefore, be
written as
                                              V–E
                                       IA =                                                   ...(1)
                                               Ra
      At the instant when motor is switched on by application of voltage to motor terminals
the armature is at rest and therefore the counter emf generated in armature is zero. The
expression for counter emf E
                                E = K φ ZN                                                      (2)
where        φ = Field flux
            Z = number of conductors
            N = speed in rpm
      From equation (1) and (2) it can be seen that when the armature is at rest i.e., when N
is equal to zero, the armature current, also called inrush current, is
                                                V
                                I A in rush =
                                                Ra
      This inrush current will normally be very high as armature resistance of dc machine is
generally very small. For example a 230 V, 10 hp, 500 rpm motor with full load current of 37 A
has an armature resistance of about 0.4 ohms. The starting current or the inrush current for
this motor is therefore equal to
                                           230
                                I inrush =      = 575 A
                                           0.4
       As the horse-power rating of motor increases, the values of armature resistance decreases
resulting in very high inrush currents. A 75 hp motor, having armature resitance of the order
of 0.06 ohm will have inrush current of 3833 Amps. Actually, however, inrush current would
be somewhat less than the above calculated values because the armature inductance would
somewhat delay the current built up and during this time the armature would start rotating
and developing some counter emf. Such high currents during starting are undesirable as they
may cause damage to the commutator and result in high line voltage drops. Repeated starting
and stopping of a motor may also damage the armature winding which is designed for full-load
currents. If high inrush currents during starting are to be avoided an external resistance
should be connected in the armature circuit of the motor. As the motor accelerates this external
resistance also called as accelerating resistance may be cut out (or short-circuited) in steps.
When the whole of resistance is cut off, armature of the motor gets directly connected across
the line and runs at full speed. Fig. 5.2 (a, b) shows how external resistance can be cut off
manually in steps in a manual starter and shorted by contactors in an automatic starter.
       As seen from Fig. 5.2 the accelerating resistance is cut out (or short circuited) in several
steps, each of which is so chosen that the maximum current or the torque peaks during
acceleration are adjusted on the basis of good commutation and torque requirements of the
driven mechanical load. The value of the total accelerating resistance is so selected as to permit




dharm
d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5   126
STARTERS FOR DIRECT CURRENT MOTORS                                                                   127

the armature take about 125 to 175 per cent of the rated current so that the motor is capable of
starting on load.


                                          Shunt field
                                              c
                                    b                      d


                              a                                    e




                                                                           M
                                                                                     – L2
               L1 +
                                                   (a)


                                             Shunt field




                                                    A          B       C    D



                                     M
                 L1 +                                                                  – L2

                                                         (b)

       Fig. 5.2 Cutting off of armature resistance of dc shunt motor (a) Manually (b) Automatically
        To further understand the behaviour of a motor during the accelerating period, it would
be useful to consider the operating characteristic of a shunt motor. Fig. 5.2 (a) has shown a
five-step manual starter (with four accelerating resistors). Assume that accelerating resistance
steps have been selected such that the inrush current peaks would be limited to 1.5 IA where IA
is the full load armature current and also that a resistance step would be cut out when current
drops to IA as the motor accelerates. At the instant the starter arm is moved to position a,
(refer to Fig. 5.2 (a)) there will be an initial current inrush of 1.5IA , the motor will then
accelerate along the line aa as shown in Fig. 5.3 (a) and would theoretically continue to attain
100 per cent speed provided the mechanical load on the motor is zero. However as the motor
accelerates due to the opposing induced emf in the armature, currents would drop. When
current drops to IA and the arm is moved to point b on the starter, the armature current will
again rise to 1.5 IA and mortor would be accelerating along curve bb′. At point b′ when motor
current      again falls to IA starter arm is moved to point C, another step of resistance is cut off
and the motor would continue to accelrate along curve cc′. Finally when the arm has reached
the last position and all the accelerating resitance are cut off, the motor would reach its final
speed and draw the normal full load current IA. Since in a manual starter the movement of the
starter handle from one position to another depends upon the skill of the operator, it would be
difficult to maintain the operation according to the curve of Fig. 5.3 (a). However, this sequence
and manner of current change and motor acceleration can be maintained in an automatic
starter using four contactors A, B, C and D and suitable control circuit associated with these
contactors. Several types of control schemes may be designed for this operation. The nature of



dharm
d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5    127
128                                                                                                              CONTROL OF MACHINES

variation of armature current with time during acceleration has been shown in Fig. 5.3 (b)
which assumes that the motor would develop rated torque after each accelerating period i.e.,
when its current falls to IA at points ta , tb , tc , td , and te.
         The motor will, however, develop more than rated torque while it is accelerating between
two consecutive time periods. It is seen from the graph that the time periods decrease gradually
i.e., tb – ta  tc – tb  td – tc  te – td .
       The speed time graph of Fig. 5.3 (c) shows how the motor accelerated smoothy from zero
to final speed without any sudden and violent jerks. This kind of smooth acceleration is
particularly desirable on certain installations. In other installations where rapid speed-up is
either desirable or permissible and where high current inrushes are not objectionable,
comparatively few accelerating setps may be used. Small dc motors up to 2 to 3 hp ratings and
in certain special installations motors having ratings as high as 7.5 hp can be started directly
from the lines without having any external resistance as high initial current in such installations
are of short duration and the coupled loads are capable of withstanding sudden shock due to
high torques developed.



                                           1.5IA a                             b           c      d    e
                             Armature current




                                                         IA
                                                                          a¢          b¢       c¢     d¢




                                                              0           Percent of Non-load R.P.M.        100
                                                                          (a) Current vs speed curves



                                           1.5IA

                                                         IA




                                                              0             ta          tb       tc    td   te
                                                                                 Time
                                                                      (b) Current vs time curves



                                                         c¢
                                                R.P.M.




                                                         b¢
                                                         a¢



                                                                               Time
                                                                       (c) Speed vs time curves

                                                                  Fig. 5.3 Shunt motor acceleration




dharm
d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5   128
STARTERS FOR DIRECT CURRENT MOTORS                                                              129

   5.3 MANUAL STARTERS FOR DC MOTORS
Various types of manual face plate dc motor commonly known as two-point, three-point, four-
point starters are available. These types of starters are described as follows: A degree of
similarity exists among these starters. All have a face plate rotary switch with a connected
group of current limiting resistors. The differences lie in the form of protection they contain.
5.3.1 Two-point Starter
A two-point starter is used for starting a dc motor which has the problem of over-speeding due
to loss of load from its shaft. Such a starter is shown in Fig. 5.4.

                                                                  Starting           Series
                                                                  resistance         field



                                         OFF          Soft iron        ON
                                                                            F        M
                                    Control arm
                                                      L
                                                           Spring       Hold on
                           D.C.
                          Supply                                     electromagnet


                               Fig. 5.4 Two-point starter for a dc series motor
       Here for starting the motor, the control arm is moved clock-wise from its OFF position
to the ON position against the spring tension. The control arm is held in the ON position by an
electromagnet. The hold-on electromagnet is connected in series with the armature circuit. If
the motor loses its load, current decreases and hence the strength of the electromagnet also
decreases. The control arm returns to the OFF position due to spring tension, thus preventing
the motor from overspeeding. The starter arm also returns to the OFF-position when the supply
voltage decrease appreciably. L and F are the two points of the starter which are connected
with the supply and motor terminals.
5.3.2 Three-point Starter
A three-point starter is used for starting a dc shunt or compound motor. The coil of the hold-on
electromagnet is connected in series with the shunt-field coil. Such a starter is shown in Fig. 5.5.

                                                                            A

                                                                            F
                                        OFF                       ON                 M

                           D.C.
                                                  L
                          Supply


                       Fig. 5.5 Three-point starter for a dc shunt or compound motor

       In case of disconnection in the field circuit due to internal failure or field-rheostat failure,
the control arm will return to its OFF position due to spring tension. This is necessary because
the shunt motor will overspeed in the same manner as the series motor if it loses its field
excitation. The starter also returns to the OFF position in case of low supply voltage or complete
failure of supply voltage. This protection is therefore called No Volt Release (NVR). Over-load
protection for the motor can be incorporated by connecting another electromagnetic coil in




dharm
d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5     129
130                                                                                  CONTROL OF MACHINES

series with the armature. When the motor is overloaded it draws a heavy current. This heavy
current also flows through the electromagnetic coil. The electromagnet then pulls an iron
piece upwards which short-circuits the coils of the hold-on electomagnet (NVR coil, see Fig.
5.6). The hold-on electromagnet gets de-energised and therfore the starter arm returns to the
OFF position, thus, protecting the motor against overload. The complete circuit connection for
a three-point starter with NVR and Over Load Release (OLR) is shown in Fig. 5.6. It is to be
noted that points L, A, and F are the three terminals of a three-point starter. Use of a brass
arc, as shown in the figure, enables connection of the field circuit directly with the supply
instead of via the starter resistance.




                                   OFF                      ON              A1
                                             Brass arc
                                                                  A

                                                             NVR             M
                                         L   OLR
                                                             F    F1
                           D.C.
                                                         Moving        F2        A2
                          Supply
                                                          iron


                       Fig. 5.6 A three-point starter with No Volt Release (NVR) and
                                  Over Load Release (OLR) arrangement
       A three-point starter may not be suitable where a large field current adjustment by
using a field regulator is needed. This may cause weaking of the field current to such an extent
that the hold-on electromagnet may not be able to keep the starter arm in the ON position.
This may therfore disconnect the motor from the supply when it is not desired. Such a problem
is overcome by using a four-point starter.
5.3.3 Four-point Starter
The disadvantage of a three-point starter as mentioned above is overcome in a four-point
starter by connecting the hold-on coil across the line instead of in series with the shunt-field
circuit. This makes a wide range of field adjustments possible. The connection diagram for a
four-point starter is shown in Fig. 5.7. In a four-point starter, therefore, when the starter arm
touches the starting resistance, current from the supply is divided into three paths. One through
the starting resistance and armature, one through the field circuit, and one through the NVR
coil. A protective resistance is connected in series with the NVR coil. Since in a four-point
starter the NVR coil is independent of the field-circuit connection, the dc motor may overspeed
if for some reason there should be a break in the field circuit. It is, therefore, recommended
that before starting a dc motor the field circuit be checked against an open circuit.
       A dc motor should be stopped by opening the main switch rather than by throwing back
manually the starting arm to the OFF position. If the starting arm is thrown back manually,
the field circuit suddenly gets opened. The electromagnetic energy stored in the field gets
discharged through the OFF contact button of the starter in the form of an arc, thereby gradually
burning the contact. On the other hand if the motor is stopped by opening the main switch, the
electormagnetic energy of the field circuit gets slowly discharged through the armature. The
starting resistance used in various types of starters is cut out of the circuit in steps while
starting a motor. The steps of the starting resistance are so designed that the armature current




dharm
d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5    130
STARTERS FOR DIRECT CURRENT MOTORS                                                         131

will remain within certain limits and will not change the torque developed by the motor to
great extent.



                                                            ON            A
                                   OFF
                                                          NVR        F
                                                                 L              M
                                            OLR
                                    L

                  D.C.                                           Protective
                 Supply                                          resistance



                       Fig. 5.7 A four-point starter with NVR and OLR arrangement
      So far, face plate starters have been discussed. The same type of control as achieved
with a face-plate starter can be obtained with a drum-rotary-switch starter. The durm switch
has the advantage of being able to handle a large current and therefore is suitable for motors
with high ratings. Current-limiting starting resistors are not part of the drum switch and they
may be made as large as possible which are rated to carry current continuously. (In a
conventinoal starter, the starting resistors are rated to carry current for small durations of
time. This reduces the size of the resistances). As a result, the drum switch is able to control
the motor continoulsy at intermediate or even at the lowest speed. Drum-rotary-switch starters
are suitable for tram car-motor controls and for large crane-motor controls.
       Nowadays automatic motor-control starters are also available which can be operated by
pressing push-buttons. The working of such automatic starters is as follows: Upon pressing an
ON push-button, current-limiting starting resistors get connected in series with the armature
circuit. Then some form of automatic control progressively disconnects these resistors unit full
line-voltage is available to the armature circuit. On pressing an OFF push-button the system
should get back to its original position. Protective devices, such as OLR, NVR, etc. are usually
the same as that of a manual starter. Automatic starter circuits are designed using
electromagnetic contactors and time-delay relays.

   5.4 TYPES OF STARTERS FOR AUTOMATIC ACCELERATION
From the discussions made in the earlier section it is clear that except for very small motors
resistance must be connected in the armature circuit during starting period and then be cut-
out (or short-circuited) progressively as the motor accelerates to the rated speed. The connection
of accelerating resistors becomes necessary due to the following reasons:
       (i) to limit the inrush current (since high current would produce arcing at the brush
           sliding contacts and thus damage the commutator surface).
      (ii) to minimise line voltage drop due to excessive inrush of current; and
     (iii) to cause smooth acceleration of the driven machinery by avoiding undue mechanical
           stresses due to sudden application of high torques.
      There are many types of automatic starters for dc motors. They can be classified under
the heading of three general methods of motor acceleration namely




dharm
d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5    131
132                                                                              CONTROL OF MACHINES

        (i) Direct-on-line acceleration
       (ii) Current limit acceleration
       (iii) Definite time acceleration
        Starters designed on the above three methods are discussed as follows:
5.4.1 Direct-on-line Starter
Small dc motors can be started directly by connecting them across the lines as the magnitude
of starting current drawn is not very high. Direct-on-line starting of dc motors is similar to ac
two wire or three wire control. Some dc contactors have dual windings. These two windings
are known as starting winding and holding winding. During closing of a contactor when a
large magnetic pull is required, both the windings are energised. When the contactor is closed
a small magnetic pull is sufficient to hold the contactor closed and therefore the starting winding
is disconnected and only the holding winding drawing a small amount of current is kept
energised. This type of design gives a longer life to the contactor as unnecessary overheating of
coils is avoided. A direct-on-line starter with dual winding contactor coils has been shown in
Fig. 5.8.




             Fig. 5.8 Direct on line starter for a dc motor which uses a dual winding contactor
       The armature has been shown connected directly across the lines i.e., without introducing
any resistance in the armature circuit. When the START-push button is pressed, both the
starting coil (1) and the holding coil (2) of contactor M get energised by getting supply through
the START-push button and the normally NC contacts M2 of contactor M. As soon as the
contactor closes, normally closed contact M2 will open and disconnect the starting coil 1 while
the holding coil will remain enrgised by getting supply through holding contact M1 which has
been connected in parallel with the START-push button. It may be understood that in this
type of arrangement setting of NC contact M2 has to be so adjusted that it would open up when
the contactor is almost in closed position. If due to some reason M2 fails to open the starting
coil will aslo remain permanetly energised in which case the coil may get burnt due to over
heating since this starting coil is not designed for continous rating.
       Another method used to start a dc motor is to connect a limiting resistor in series with
the contactor coil when the contactor closes. This would avoid over-heating of the coil as the




dharm
d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5    132
STARTERS FOR DIRECT CURRENT MOTORS                                                           133

limiting resistor would allow only a small current sufficient to hold contactor closed. The control
circuit for such a scheme has been shown in Fig. 5.9.

                                 +
                                              Stop



                                            Start             M1




                                                     R1        M2




                                                          M
                                 –

                   Fig. 5.9 Control circuit for direct on-line starting of a dc motor with
                                a limiting resistor in contactor coil circuit
       When the START-push button is pressed, coil M receives maximum current required to close
contacts through normally closed (NC) contact M2. When contactor is closed, M2 opens and M1 closes.
Now coil remains energised through contact M1 and resistance R1. Thus the resistance limits the
current to a value just sufficient to keep the contactor closed.
5.4.2 Current Limit Acceleration Starters
In this type of starters the load (i.e., the current) will determine how rapidly a motor is to be
brought to full speed. A lightly loaded motor may be brought to final speed more quickly than
heavily loaded motor. This is made possible by utilizing the fact that rate of current change
varies with the load. Inrush current drops faster with a lightly loaded motor and slower with
a heavily loaded motor.
       In these starters, a set of series or current relays pick up and drop out on changing
values of armature current which occurs as the motor accelerates and these relays in turn
energise contactors to successively cut out (or short-circuit) resistors from the armature circuit.
Current limit starters functioning on the basis of current change are of three types, viz (i) the
series relay type (ii) the counter emf type and (iii) the lockout type.
5.4.2.1 Series Relay Starter
This starter uses a dc series relay to sense changes in the armature current. The relay consists
of a few turns of heavy wire and operates extremely fast as its armature is light in weight and
is well balanced having a small air gap. A spring changes the contact position when current
through the relay falls below the setting of the relay. Current setting of the relay can be adjusted
by varying the spring tension. A series relay starter for a separately excited dc shunt motor
has been shown in Fig. 5.10.
      In this starter the shunt winding has been shown separately excited and the interpole
winding (I.W.) has been shown connected in series with the armature. Three resistances R1,
R2 and R3 are also connected in series with the armature. Three series relays 1AR, 2AR and
3AR are also connected in the armature circuit.




dharm
d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5   133
134                                                                                                      CONTROL OF MACHINES

             L1
                  +
                                     M1


                                                                    Stop
                      Field coil


                                              M
                                                                   Start       M2
                                                  I.W                               M3



                                         R3                   3A
                                                                                     1AR1     2AR1       3AR1
                                                        3AR




                                         R2                   2A
                                                        2AR




                                                                                              1A1        2A1

                                         R1
                                                              1A
                                          1AR                              M             1A         2A         3A

             L2 –

                  Fig. 5.10 Series relay starter circuit for separately excited dc shunt motor
      Before analysing the working of the control circuit of this starter two important points
regarding the series relay and the main contactor should be throughly understood and kept in
mind while reading the control diagram.
      (i) Auxiliary contacts (NO) of contactors M, 1A, 2A and 3A are set to close after some
          delay from the closing of their main contacts (i.e., power contacts) and
       (ii) Operation of series relay is much faster than contactors.
       Now we will discuss the working of the control circuit. When the START-push button is
pressed, contactor M gets energised and first its main contact M1 closes. Motor starts with
armature resistance R1, R2 and R3. The relay 1AR picks up and opens its normally closed (NC)
contact 1AR1 in coil circuit of contactor 1A. After the contact 1AR1 has opened, auxiliary contacts
M2 and M3 of contactor M would close and therefore contactor 1A cannot close. When the motor
accelerates sufficiently and the motor current drops to normal value, relay 1AR drops, thus
closing its contact 1AR1 and thereby energising contactor 1A. Main contacts of contactor 1A
closes and shorts resistance R1. Now, second current inrush takes place as the motor accelerates
with resistance R2 and R3 and series relay 2AR in circuit. Relay 2AR picks up and opens its
contact 2AR1 before interlock contact 1A1 closes. As the motor accelerates further, again the
armature current falls to normal and relay 2AR drops out and thus its contact 2AR1 closes and
thereby energise contactor 2A. Main contacts of 2A shorts resistance R2. When resistance R2
gets shorted a third inrush of current takes place through R3 and relay 3AR.
       Relay 3AR picks up and opens its contact 3AR1 before contact 2A1 (interlock of contactor
2A) closes in the coil circuit of contactor 3A. Finally when the armature current falls again to
normal value, relay 3AR drops out and closes its contact 3AR1 and therefore contactor 3A gets
energised. Main contact of 3A shorts resistance R3. Now the armature gets connected directly
to line and the motor accelerates to its final speed.




dharm
d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5               134
STARTERS FOR DIRECT CURRENT MOTORS                                                                            135

5.4.2.2 Counter emf Starter
These starters are economical and perform well for small motors up to 5 hp rating. These
starters use voltage relays to cut off resistance from the armature circuit in steps. Voltage
relays are voltage sensitive and they can be set to pick up at any desired voltage level. In this
type of starter counter emf generated in armature is utilised to energise voltage accelerating
relays. These relays are connected in parallel with the armature of the motor as shown in
Fig. 5.11.
          L1
               +
                       M1



                                                           Stop

                             M
                                       1AR    2AR   3AR
                                                          Start       M2
                                 I.W                                       M3



                                                                           1AR1        2AR1        3AR1

                        R1              1A1


                        R2              2A1

                                                                  M               1A          2A          3A
                        R3              3A1

          L2 –

                       Fig. 5.11 Circuit diagram for counter emf starter for a dc motor
       When motor just starts, counter emf in the armature is zero. As the motor accelerates,
counter emf also starts building up. The accelerating voltage relays 1AR, 2AR and 3AR are set
to pick up at different increasing values of emf and their contacts energise contactors 1A, 2A
and 3A to cut off resistance R1, R2, R3 from armature circuit. In the four step starter shown in
Fig. 5.11, the voltage accelerating relays may be set to pick up at 50, 75 and 90 percent rated
speed. The working of the control is explained as under:
       When the START-push button is pressed, contacotor M is energised and it gets hold
through its own contact M2. Its main contact M1 energises the armature with resistance R1, R2
and R3 in the circuit. The motor accelerates and when say 50% of the normal speed is reached,
emf generated causes the relay 1AR to pick up. Contact of 1AR closes to energise contactor 1A
which shorts resistance R1 through its main contact 1A1. Due to cutting of resistance R1, the
motor accelerates further and at 75% of normal speed counter emf generated makes the relay
2AR to pick up. When 2AR picks up contact 2A1 of contactor 2A closes and shorts resistance R2.
Thus the motor accelerates still further and at 90% of the normal speed, relay 3AR picks up
and thus the third resistance R3 is short circuited by contactor 3A. Now the motor gets connected
directly to the lines and reaches its final speed.
5.4.2.3 Lock-out Acceleration Starter
In this starter a special type of contactor known as lock-out contactor is used. This has been
explained in detail in the chapter on control components. The contactor has two coils, closing



dharm
d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5     135
136                                                                              CONTROL OF MACHINES

coil and lock-out coil. These coils are connected in series. The magnetic circuit of these coils are
so designed that during the inrush current, lock out coil has greater pull than closing coil
while at normal current the closing coil has greater pull than the lock out coil. Lock out coil has
the tendency to keep the main contact open while closing coil has the tendency to close it. The
starter is shown in Fig. 5.12.
                 L1
                       +

                                 M1
                                                        M2
                                                                     STOP

                                      M


                                                                  START          M3
                                  3AH                      3AS

                                 R3                   3A


                                                3AC
                                 R2
                                                 2A
                                          2AH




                                 R1             2AC

                                  1AH            1A



                                  1AC                                       M

                 L2 –

                  Fig. 5.12 Circuit for shunt motor starter using lock-out type contactor
       As seen from Fig. 5.12, the starter has three contactors 1A, 2A and 3A. Each of the
contactors 1A and 2A have two coils i.e., 1AH and 1AC for contactor 1A and 2AH, 2AC for
contactor 2A. Contactor 3A has three coils holding coil 3AH, closing coil 3AC and shunt coil
3AS. The shunt coil is also wound on the core of the closing coil. The shunt coil cannot close the
contactor by itself but can hold the already closed contactor. The working of the starter is as
follows:
       When the START-push button is pressed, main contactor is energised and it gets hold
through its auxiliary contact M3 . Main contact M1 energises the armature of the motor. Current
flows through R1, R2, R3 and the contactor coils 1AH, 1AC and 3AH. Lock-out coil 1AH keeps
the contactor open during current inrush. When current drops to normal value, closing coil
1AC closes the contact 1A and thus shorts resistance R1 and lock-out coil 1AH. When contactor
1A closes another inrush current flows through R3, R2, 2AH, 2AC and 1AC. When this inrush
current falls to the normal value, closing coil 2AC picks up and closes contact 2A which shorts
resistance R2 and coil 2AH. At this instant, another inrush current flows through 3AH, R3,
3AC, 2AC and 1AC. Closing coil 3AC picks up when current falls to normal value and closes its
contact 3A, which shorts resistance R3 along with 3AH, 3AC, 2AC and 1AC. Contactor 3A is
held closed through shunt coil 3AS which is energised directly from the lines through contact




dharm
d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5       136
STARTERS FOR DIRECT CURRENT MOTORS                                                                      137

M2. Now the armature gets connected directly to the lines and the motor accelerates to its final
speed.
5.4.3 Definite Timer Acceleration Starters
In definite time acceleration starters, resistances from the armature circuit are cut off at fixed
intervals independent of the load (i.e., load current). Contacts across accelerating resistors are
made to close at successively longer time intervals with the help of special solenoid or motor
driven timer, dashpot relays, pneumatic timers, inductive time limit contactors and others.
The preset timings of the relays and timer cause the motor to operate on a given acceleration
time cycle independent of the load conditions. Definite time acceleration starters are more
widely used than current limit starters. This is because timed acceleration is often useful
when a driven machine must always repeat the same cycle of operation in manufacturing
process or in situations where several motors in a system must perform in a given timed
sequence. Several of the above mentioned schemed of definite time acceleration starters are
discussed as follows.
5.4.3.1 Starters Using Timers
In the conrol scheme shown in Fig. 5.13, any type of timers i.e., electronic, pneumatic, or a
dasphot relay timer may be used for the starter. Three such timers 1T, 2T and 3T have been
used as shown in Fig. 5.13.
       If we observe the contact connections across accelerating resistors, we will see that they
differ from connections made in the earlier described starters. The advantage of using such
connections is that when finally contactor 3A gets energised, it will short all the resistances
along with R3 and thus the other contactors 1A, 2A and timers 1T, 2T, 3T can be de-energised.
Thus unnecessary energisation of contactors and timers is eliminated.

    L1
         +
                 M1
                                                 Stop

                      M

                                            Start           M2
                          I.W

                          Series winding

                                                                                                   3A3
                 R1        1A1             3A1                    1T1        2T1        3T1



                 R2        2A1
                                                            3A2


                 R3                                     M         1T    1A   2T    2A   3T    3A

    L2 –

             Fig. 5.13 Definite time acceleration starter using timers for a dc compound motor

      When the START-push button is pressed, contactor M and timer 1T are energised and
they get hold through contact M2.Timer 1T gets energised with normally closed (NC) contact




dharm
d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5        137
138                                                                                                 CONTROL OF MACHINES

3A2 in series. When timer 1T operates after pre-set delay its delayed contact 1T1 closes and
energies contactor 1A. Contact 1A1 of contactor 1A closes across resistance R1 and thereby
shorts it. The motor now accelerates further with R2 and R3. As soon as contactor 1A is energised,
timer 2T, which is connected in parallel with it, also gets energised. After its pre-set delay its
contact 2T1 closes and energies contactor 2A and timer 3T. Contactor 2A closes its contact 2A1
across R2 and therfore the motor now accelerates further with only one resistane i.e., R3.
When timer 3T operates after its pre-set delay it closes its contact 3T1 and energises contactor
3A which gets hold through its contact 3A3 connected across the timer contact 3T1. Contactor
3A shorts resistance R3 and bypasses R1, R2, and contacts 1A1 and 2A1. Now there is no need
for keeping contactor 1A and 2A energised. This is made possible by using a normally closed
contact 3A2 in series with the coil of timer 1T. When contactor 3A is energised contact 3A2
opens and de-energises timer 1T. This in turn de-energises 1A, 2T, 2A, 3T while contactor 3A
remains energised through its own contact 3A3.
       Another control circuit using a synchronous motor (or cam timer) which rotates a shaft
that closes a set of contacts in a definite and adjustable time sequence has been shown in
Fig. 5.14.
       Working of this circuit is similar to the circuit given in Fig. 4.10 (a). The cam timer
figure given in Fig. 4.10 (b) also applies to this circuit. The only difference is that the contactors
1A, 2A, 3A in this case get hold through their contacts 1A1, 2A1 and 3A1.

          L1
               +
                         M1               Stop


                               M
                                          Start                    0   CT1    IA1   CT2        2A1     CT3   3A1
                                   IW
                                                      M2


                          R1         1A



                          R2         2A


                                                  M           CT             1A           2A             3A
                          R3         3A

          L2 –
                                                           Cam timer
                                                             motor

                   Fig. 5.14 Definite time acceleration starter using synchronous cam type timer
5.4.3.2 Starter Using Time-delay Contactors
This starter uses special contactors which opens with a time delay when its coil is de-enrgised.
During energisation of the coil the contactor behaves like a normal contactor and therefore
closes instantly. Timer delay during opening is provided by a special copper sleeve which is
slipped directly over the core before the exciting coils are installed. During energisation the
copper sleeve is electrically idle but when the coil gets disconnected from supply the copper
sleeve acts like a short circuited secondary of a transformer. During this period a current flow



dharm
d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5           138
STARTERS FOR DIRECT CURRENT MOTORS                                                                  139

in the copper sleeve opposes decay of core magnetism. The armature of the contactors, therefore,
is released after a time delay. Time delay of such contactors is however fixed and does not
depend on any adjustment. The circuit diagram, as in Fig. 5.15, shows how time delay contactors
are used for dc motor acceleration. Here the normally closed contacts of the contactors are
used across the accelerating resistors.
                 L1
                       +
                                 M1
                                                 Stop


                                      M

                                                 Start         M2
                                          I.W


                                 R1        1A1
                                                         M3    1A2        2A2        3A2       M4


                                 R2        2A1



                                                          1A         2A         3A         M
                                 R3        3A1

                 L2 –

        Fig. 5.15 Circuit diagram for a dc motor acceleration starter using time delay contractors

       In this starter, during starting the START-push button has to be kept pressed till
contactors 1A, 2A, 3A and M pick up. First, contactor 1A picks up through normally closed
contact M3 and subsequently interlock contact of 1A, 2A and 3A energies respectively contactors
2A, 3A and contactor M. Contactor M gets hold through its contact M4 . Energisation of 1A, 2A
and 3A causes opening of 1A1, 2A1 and 3A1 respectively which are connected across resistance
R1, R2 and R3.
       When contactor M is energised, the motor starts with R1, R2 and R3 in its circuit. With
the energisation of contactor M contact M3 opens and de-energises 1A. However, it drops only
after a fixed time delay when it closes its contact 1A1 across R1 and shorts it. Motor accelerates
further. As soon as 1A drops, its another contactor 1A2 opens and de-energises contactor 2A.
Its contact 2A1 closes after a fixed delay and shorts resistance R2, and at the same time
contactor 3A gets de-energised because of opening of contact 2A2. When contactor 3A drops it
shorts resistors R3. Contactor M does not drop due to opening of contact 3A2, as it remains
energised through its own contact M4. When the STOP-button is pressed contactor M gets de-
energised and the motor comes to standstill due to opening of main contact M1.
5.4.3.3 Starters Using Inductive Time Limit Contactors
An inductive time limit contactor is similar in construction to that of a lock-out contactor. It
also has two coils whose mmfs simultaneously act on a pivoted armature. Holding coil tends to
oppose pick up while the closing coil attempts to pull the armature. The holding coil, whose
magnetic circuit is of iron, can prevent pick-up due to the closing coil, even when it is excited at
about 1 per cent of the line voltage. As the holding coil is highly inductive its flux decays slowly
when it is short circuited. Air gap between the coil plunger and armature is also extremely




dharm
d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5       139
140                                                                               CONTROL OF MACHINES

small. The closing coil, on the other hand has a large air gap. With the line voltage applied
across it, the closing coil cannot cause the contactor to pick up when the holding coil is carrying
current. It picks up only when the holding coil is shorted and its flux decays to zero. Fig. 5.16
shows the circuit in which three inductive time-limit contactors have been used to provide
time delays for short-circuiting the accelerating resistors.
                L1
                     +
                                M1                           1AH
                                            Stop


                                      M
                                          Start        M2


                          2AH    R1       1A


                                                             r
                          3AH    R2       2A




                                 R3       3A       M               1AC      2AC      3AC


                L2 –

     Fig. 5.16 Circuit diagram for a dc motor acceleration starter using inductive time limit contactors
       When the line switch is closed, the holding coil 1AH is energised, its current being limited
by a resistance r. Thus the closing coil of 1AC cannot pick up and therefore its contact 1A
across R1 remains open. When the START-push button is pressed, contactor M gets energised
and its contact M1 energises the motor armature with resistance R1, R2 and R3 in series. Voltage
drop across R1 and R2 also sends current through holding coils 2AH and 3AH. Thus, contactors
2A and 3A cannot close even though full line voltage appears across their closing coil 2AC and
3AC through contact M2. It may be noticed that as soon as M2 closes, holding coil 1AH of
contactor 1A gets short circuited. Its current decays to zero within a fixed time. When current
in holding coil becomes zero, closing coil 1AC picks up to operate the relay contacts. Resistance
R1 gets short circuited due to closing of contact 1A across R1. Simultaneously holding coil 2AH
of contactor 2A gets short circuited. Its current decays to zero after some fixed time and therfore
2AC picks up and short resistance R2 and coil 3AH by closing contact 2A. When current through
3AH decays to zero closing coil 3AC of contactor 3A picks up and closes its contact 3A and short
resistance R3. Armature of the motor now gets connected directly across the lines and the
motor attains the final speed.

   5.5 REVERSING OF DC MOTORS
The direction of rotation of dc motor can be reversed in either of the two ways:
       (i) Reversing current through the armature and the interpole windings (if they exist)
       (ii) Reversing current through the field windings i.e., through shunt and or series
            windings but not through the interpole windings (if they exist).
       Reversing current through the armature is preferred because reversing current through
the field windings involves breaking and making highly inductive current of the field windings.




dharm
d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5     140
STARTERS FOR DIRECT CURRENT MOTORS                                                        141

Also field reversal of compound motor requires connections of both shunt and series windings
to be changed. In this section only the armature reversal method will be discussed. The basic
motor connections for reversal of armature current has been shown in Fig. 5.17.
                              L1
                                   +


                                         F1                      R1

                                           a        M                 b
                                                           I.W

                                         R2                      F2



                                                          Series Field




                                                     R1          1A



                                                     R2          2A




                                                     R3          3A

                                   –
                              L2

                       Fig. 5.17 Circuit diagram for reversal of direction of rotation
                                of a dc motor by armature current reversal
      In this circuit when forward contactor contacts F1 and F2 close, current through the
armature flows from a to b and the motor rotates in forward direction. When the motor is to be
rotated in reverse direction, forward contactor should get de-energised while the reverse
contactor should get energised so that contact R1 and R2 close and thereby current through the
armature windings flow in the reverse direction i.e., from b to a. In both the above cases,
however, current through the series field winding flows in the same direction. The forward
and reverse contactor should not get energised simultaneously when the motor is running
normally with all the armature resistance out of circuit, as it will cause dead short circuit of
power lines and also of the counter emf generated in the armature winding. One method of
avoiding this undesired possibility is to interlock both the contactors mechanically. However,
more frequently electrical interlocks are provided in the control circuit thereby making it
impossible for one contactor to pick up while the other is energised. For double safety sometimes
both mechanical and electrical interlocking of contactors is done. A control circuit for direct
reversing of dc motor has been shown in Fig. 5.18. Forward and Reverse-push buttons are
shown to have back and front contacts.
      When the Forward-push button is pressed supply to forward contactor coil reaches
through back contact of Reverse-push button and normally close (NC) contact of contactor R. If
the motor is to be directly reversed, the Reverse-push button is pressed, its back contact opens
and de-energises contactor F. De-energisation of contactor F leads to closing of contact F2 in




dharm
d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5    141
142                                                                                               CONTROL OF MACHINES

the coil circuit of contactor R. Contactor R thus gets energised through front contact of REV-
push button and back contact of FOR-push button and normally closed (NC) contact F2. If the
motor is to be brought to rest the STOP-bush button has to be pressed.
                       L1
                             +

                                                     STOP




                             FOR                    F1              R1                       REV




                                    REV                                                    FOR



                                         R2                                           F2


                                          F                                            R
                             –
                       L2

                                 Fig. 5.18 Control circuit for direct reversing of dc motor
       In some applications it may be necessary to stop the motor first before it can be run in
the reverse direction. This can be accomplished by using a timer relay and zero speed plugging
switches. Here, control circuit using an OFF-delay timer for this purpose has been discussed.
The control diagram has been shown in Fig. 5.19.
              L1
                   +

                                          Stop


                                                                         F3       R3

                        F1                    TR1              R1


                                                                                             Accelerating
                                                                                             relays and
                                                                                             contactors
                                   For                       Rev




                                         R2          F2


                                              F          R                       TR

              L2 –
                                                                          OFF delay timer

     Fig. 5.19 Control circuit for forward-stop-reverse operation of a dc motor using OFF-delay timer




dharm
d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5         142
STARTERS FOR DIRECT CURRENT MOTORS                                                              143

       When FOR-push button is pressed contactor F gets energised and the motor runs in the
forward direction. Its contact F3 energises the OFF-delay timer TR which opens its contact
TR1 immediately. At the same time contact F3 also energises the accelerating relays and timers
which cut off acceleration resistors from the armature circuit of the motor (refer Fig. 5.19).
Opening of contact TR1 makes both FOR and REV-push buttons inoperative thus making it
impossible to change the direction of rotation of the motor. When the motor direction is to be
reversed, first the STOP- push button is pressed, which de-energises contactor F. Timer TR is
also de-energised due to opening of contact F3. After pre-set delay from de-energisation of
timer TR its contact TR1 will close. This implies that REV-bush button becomes operative only
after a pre-set delay from the instant of pressing the STOP-button. Thus forward to reverse
operation becomes possible only when the motor comes to stop first.

   5.6 JOGGING OPERATION OF MOTOR
The common usage of the word ‘Jogging’ in our daily life is for slow running. ‘Jogging’ or
‘inching’ of a motor also implies the same i.e., to have small movements of the driven machine.
In jogging, starting and stopping of a motor is under the direct control of the operator. The
primary objective of jogging is generally, to move tools, equipment or processed material into
position very slowly. A typical example of jogging is a small portable crane which is moved in
small incremental steps to position certain material on a processing line in an industry.
      In jogging operation, motors are expected to run at slow speed. Therefore, the jogging
control circuits are designed to prevent accelerating resistors from being cut out from the
armature circuit. This means when the JOG-push button is pressed, the accelerating contactors
do not pick up and therefore the whole of the accelerating resistance remains in the circuit.
High resistance in the armature circuit limits the speed of the motor to a low value. A simple
control circuit that provides for jogging in one direction only has been shown in Fig. 5.20.

                        L1
                             +

                                 Stop                            CR3




                                         A               B
                                 Jog                                   Accelerating
                                                                       relays and
                                                                       contactors
                                                   CR2

                             Start           CR1




                                        CR                   M
                             –
                        L2

              Fig. 5.20 Control circuit for jogging of a dc motor in one direction of rotation
      In the above control circuit, when JOG-push button is pressed, the contact A opens
while contact B closes. Contactor M is energised due to closing of contact B and makes the
motor run with all the accelerating resistors in the armature circuit (refer Fig. 5.20). Due to
presence of high resistance in the armature circuit the motor runs at a slow speed. Accelerating




dharm
d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5   143
144                                                                                              CONTROL OF MACHINES

relays and the contactor circuit are not energised during this operation thus making the motor
run at slow speed till such time the JOG-push button is held pressed. When normal operation
of motor is required the START-push button is pressed. The control relay CR gets energised
and is held through its own contact CR1. Contactor M also gets energised and is held through
contact CR2 . Accelerating relays and contactor circuit also gets energised through closing
contact CR3. Accelerating relays and contactors as discussed earlier will cut off the accelerating
resistances in the armature circuit step by step and the motor would attain its final speed. The
control circuit diagram, Fig. 5.21, shows how a dc motor can be jogged and also operated normally
in both the directions of rotation.
                 L1
                       +

                  Stop
                                                                                     CRF3    CRR3


                                                             Jog-Rev
                Jog-For                       CRF2
                                 A    B                      C        D       CRR2
                                                                                            Accelerating
                                                                                            relays and
                  For
                                                     Rev                                    contactors
                             CRF1                            CRR1


                           CRF            F                CRR            R


                                 R1                              F1
                       –
                 L2

             Fig. 5.21 Control circuit for jogging a dc motor in both the directions of rotation
       Operation of this circuit is similar to that of the circuit meant for jogging in one direction
of rotation only. Forward and reverse contactors are interlocked both mechanically and
electrically. When the JOG-FOR or JOG-REV button is pressed the corresponding contactor F
or R is energised due to closing of contact B or D. Contactor F or R does not get hold as control
relay CRF or CRR does not get energised. Accelerating relay and the contactor circuit also do
not get energised causing the motor to run with all the accelerating resistors in the circuit at a
slow speed. For normal running, push button FOR or REV is to be pressed. This will energise
either the forward control relay, CRF or the reverse control relay CRR. The respective relays
will remain energised by getting supply through their own contact CRF1 or CRR1. Forward or
reverse contactor will also get held throuh contact CRF2 or CRR2. The accelerating relay and
the contactor circuit would also get energised and will be held through either contact CRF3, or
contact CRR3 .

   5.7 DYNAMIC BREAKING OF MOTOR
The principle of dynamic breaking involves utilization of generator action of a motor to bring it
to rest quickly. In this method of breaking, the armature terminals are disconnected from the
main supply and immediately transferred across a resistor while the field winding is kept
energised. Quick stop through dynamic breaking may be explained in following two ways:
        (i) When the motor armature having counter emf induced in it is disconnected from the
            supply and is connected across a resistor the counter cemf sends reverse current
            through the armature. This causes the motor to slow down due to reverse torque




dharm
d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5       144
STARTERS FOR DIRECT CURRENT MOTORS                                                          145

          developed. Reverse torque is developed due to interaction of field flux and the reverse
          current flowing through the armature.
      (ii) When the motor is disconnected from the supply and is connected across a resistor
           the counter emf sends current through the resistor which is converted into I2R heat
           loss. Thus mechanical energy of the rotor is dissipated as heat energy in the resist-
           ance. The rapidity with which this energy can be dissipated determines how quickly
           the motor can be stopped. If a low value resistor is used the motor comes to stop
           quickly. Control circuit for dynamic breaking of a dc shunt motor has been shown in
           Fig. 5.22.




                       Fig. 5.22 Control circuit for dynamic breaking of dc shunt motor
       In this circuit dynamic breaking resistor R4 is connected across the armature through
normally close (NC) conctact DB1 of the dynamic breaking contactor. This dynamic breaking
contactor DB is a special contactor having two coils i.e., a retard coil and closing coil. The
retard coil exerts an opposite pull on the armature to that exerted by the closing coil. In this
circuit the retard coil is kept permanently energised. When the closing coil is energised contactor
DB closes after a time delay as there is a pull by the retarding coil in the opposite direction. It
must be understood clearly here that this delay in closing of the contactor has no effect on the
staring operation. However, when the closing coil of contactor DB is de-energised by pressing
the STOP-push button it opens very fast due to the pull exerted by the retard coil DB, which is
always energised. Thus the contact DB1 which is meant for breaking closes with a snap action
thereby causing breaking action to start immediately. It is therefore seen that the function of
providing retard coil is for achieving a quick stop and it has no specific function during starting
of the motor. A brief description for the control circuit is as follows:
       When the START-push button is pressed the contactor DB is energised first and then
the main contactor M gets energised through its contact DB2. Both the contactors are held
through contact M2. Accelerating relays of contactor circuit are energised through closing of




dharm
d:N-MachMac5-2.pm5      145
146                                                                                               CONTROL OF MACHINES

contact M3. Resistances from the armature circuit are cut out in steps by contactors 1A, 2A and
3A. When the STOP-push button is pressed, closing coil of DB and contactor M are de-energised.
Contactor DB opens very fast as the retard coil is already energised. Its contact DB1 closes
with a snap action and the armature gets connected across resistances R4, R1, R2 and R3. The
electrical energy of the armature is thus dissipated in resistor R4, R1, R2 and R3 and the motor
comes to stop quickly. If the value of resistance R4 is decreased the motor can be brought to
stop more quickly.

   5.8 PLUGGING CIRCUIT FOR DC MOTOR
Plugging or plug stopping of a motor means bringing the motor to standstill quickly by applying
reverse torque on the armature. Plugging of a dc motor is done by reversing the supply to the
armature while the motor is still running. This develops a counter-torque and motor slows
down quickly. When the motor reaches zero speed and tends to reverse, supply to the motor is
disconnected by a zero speed plugging switch which opens on zero speed. As during plugging
the impressed supply voltage and counter emf in the armature adds up, a plugging resistance
is inserted in the armature circuit to avoid excessive current flow.
       Plugging is not only used to bring a motor to stop but is also used in drives where quick
reversal of drive is required, such as, in cranes and in rolling mills. In a crane plugging is done
with the help of master controllers. This is done by moving the handle from full speed forward
position to full-speed reverse position or vice-versa. Plugging circuit for a non-reversing shunt
motor has been shown in Fig. 5.23.

              L1
                   +
                                                                           plugging switch
                                                                             Zero speed




                       M1             P1    M3                                                    M6
                                                  Start       A    B
                         a                 b
                                                    CR1           M4
                       P2             M2                                           CR2             Accelerating
                             RP                                                                    relays and
                          Plugging                                                                 contactors
                         resistance               Stop
                                R1    1A

                                                                  M5
                               R2     2A



                               R3     3A                  M            P                     CR

              L2 –

                       Fig. 5.23 Circuit for plugging to stop a non-reversing shunt
                                motor with a zero speed plugging switch
       In this circuit, when the START-push button is pressed, its contact A closes and contact
B opens. Contactor M thus gets energised and is held through its contact M3. When the START-
push button is released, contact B closes and relay CR also gets energised through closed
contact M4. Contactor P cannot get energised as M5 is open. As soon as contactor M gets energised
its main contacts M1 and M2 energise the motor armature with accelrating resistors in the
circuit.




dharm
d:N-MachMac5-2.pm5   146
STARTERS FOR DIRECT CURRENT MOTORS                                                                                  147

        Contact M6 energises the accelerating relays and the contactor circuit. The motor comes
to its final speed when all the resistances are successively cut out by accelerating contactors
1A, 2A and 3A respectively. The zero speed plugging switch closes as soon as the motor starts
rotating. Control relay CR is held through the zero-speed switch and its already closed contact
CR2. Another contact of CR, i.e., CR1 opens and makes the START-push button ineffective till
the motor comes to rest. This interlocking prevents simultaneous energisation of contactors M
and P.
       When the STOP-push button is pressed, contactor M is de-energised and therefore
contacts M1, M2, M3, M4 and M6 open. The armature gets disconnected from the supply and the
accelerating contactors 1A, 2A, 3A also open. Normally closed contact M5 closes and contactor
P gets energised. The armature of the motor gets energised through contacts P1 and P2 with
plugging resistance RP and accelerating resistors R1, R2 and R3 in the circuit. A reverse torque
is developed and the motor comes to zero speed quickly. As the motor reaches zero speed and
tends to rotate in the reverse direction, the zero speed switch opens and de-energises relay CR.
Contactor P also gets de-energised due to opening of control contact CR2. Contacts P1 and P2
opens to disconnect the motor from the supply. Control circuit diagram for plugging a reversing
motor from either direction of rotation has been shown in Fig. 5.24. In this circuit a zero speed
plugging switch with two normally open (NO) contactors has been used. Both the contacts are
open at zero speed. The FOR-contact closes when the motor rotates in forward direction while
a REV-contact closes when the motor rotates in the reverse direction. Push button interlocking
as also auxiliary contact interlocking have been provided between forward and reverse direction
of rotation. A plugging resistance Rp which is connected in series with the armature remains
shorted through contact P1 of contactor P during normal forward and reverse operation of the
motor. This resistance comes into circuit only during plugging operation.

        L1
             +

                                                   Stop
                    F1               P1     R1
                                                                           CR4 FR3 RR3     F4          R4
                            M                    For   A Rev         CR3
                                          RP
                    R2                      F2             C
                                                                               Zero
                                                                             Speed                    Accelerating
                     Series field                  D                 B     Plugging Rev               relays and
                                                                                           For
                                                                             Switch                   contactors
                                                 CR1       CR2
                                R1         1A1
                                                 FR1       RR1                RR2

                                R2         2A1                                FR2

                                                  R3        F3
                                R3         3A1
                                                       F         R       CR    P      FR         RR
        L2 –

                 Fig. 5.24 Circuit for plugging a reversing motor from either direction of rotation
        To study the operation of the circuit let us assume that the FOR-push button is pressed.
Contactor P and relay CR are energised and gets hold through contact CR3. Then contactor F
is also energised and is held through contacts CR3 and CR1. Closing of main contacts F1 and F2
causes the motor to run in forward direction while closing of contact F4 helps energise




dharm
d:N-MachMac5-2.pm5         147
148                                                                             CONTROL OF MACHINES

accelerating relays and the contactor circuit and as a result the resistances are cut off in steps.
Plugging resistance Rp remains bypassed through contact P1. When the motor accelerates in
the forward direction, relay RR gets energised through contact CR4 and contact FOR of the
plugging switch. Relay RR gets held through its contact RR3. Closing of contact RR2 of this
relay prepared the circuit for plugging operation. Now let us see what happens when the
STOP-push button is pressed. Contactor F, P and relay CR get de-energised. Due to de-
energisation of F its contact F3 closes. Reverse contactor R gets energised through contacts
RR3, for-plugging switch contact, and contacts RR2 and F3. Energisation of contactor R causes
the motor to run in the reverse direction with plugging resistance Rp and the acceleration
resistors in the armature circuit (as P1 is open).
       When the motor comes to standstill, FOR plugging switch contact open thus de-energising
relay RR. Due to opening of contact RR2, the reverse contactor, R also gets de-energised. Now,
the operation for reverse running and plugging of this circuit can be explained in a similar way
as already done for forward running and plugging operation.

                                      REVIEW QUESTIONS
   1.   Discuss different types of corrective windings used in dc motors.
   2.   Discuss principle of acceleration of dc motors and draw armature current versus speed and time
        curves. Also draw speed versus time curves for a shunt motor.
   3.   Explain the working of four point manual face plate starter for dc shunt or compound motor.
   4.   Explain the meaning of current limit acceleration. Explain working of series relay starter.
   5.   Discuss counter emf starter for dc shunt motor.
   6.   Explain the working principle of lock out contactor with the help of a diagram.
   7.   Discuss the working of lock out contactor for a dc shunt motor.
   8.   Explain a definite time limit starter.
   9.   Explain the method of starting of dc shunt motor using inductive time limit contactors.
  10.   What is the basic requirement of a reversing starter? Draw fundamental power and control
        circuit for reversal of a dc shunt motor.
  11.   Draw control diagram for forward-stop-reverse operation of a dc motor using an OFF-delay timer.
  12.   Explain the meaning of jogging / inching operation of a motor. Draw control circuit for jogging a
        dc motor in both the directions of rotation.
  13.   How is dynamic braking achieved in dc motors?
  14.   What is plugging? Draw control diagram for plugging a non-reversing shunt motor using a zero
        speed plugging switch.
  15.   Can a timer be used for the plugging circuit of a dc motor?
  16.   Draw control circuit for plugging circuit of a dc compound motor from either direction of rotation.
  17.   Direction of a dc motor can be reversed by:
        (a) reversing the supply voltage
        (b) reversing current through field winding only
        (c) reversing current through armature winding only
        (d) reversing current through both field winding and armature winding.
  18.   Dynamic braking for a dc motor is accomplished by
        (a) connecting ac voltage to the armature
        (b) maintaining dc current flow through the armature and connecting a load resistor to the field
        (c) maintaining dc current flow through the field and connecting the armature to a load resistor
        (d) disconnecting dc power from the motor and reconnecting the armature to a load resistor.




dharm
d:N-MachMac5-2.pm5     148
$
                                            Control of Single Phase Motors


   6.1 TYPES OF SINGLE PHASE MOTORS
Single phase motors are manufactured in fractional kilowatt range to be operated on single
phase supply and for use in numerous applications like ceiling fans, refrigerators, food mixers,
hair driers, portable drills, vacuum cleaners, washing machines, sewing machines, electric
shavers, office machinery etc. Single phase motors are manufactured in different types to
meet the requirements of various applications. Single phase motors are classified on the basis
of their construction and starting methods employed. The main types of single phase motors
are :
       (a) Induction motors
      (b) Synchronous motors
      (c) Commutator motors
      The various types of motors under each class are shown as under:

                                             Single-phase motors



           Single-phase induction               Single-phase             Single-phase-commutator
                   motors                    synchronous motors                   motors



              Split     Shaded      Reluctance         Repulsion   Repulsion AC series   Universal
             phase       Pole          start            motor      induction  motor       motor
              type       type          type                          motor



                                    Reluctance              Hysteresis motor
                                      motor

       It is assumed here that the reader has already studied the construction and working
principle of all these motors. For review the reader may refer to any standard book on ‘Electrical
machines’.
       Repulsion, repulsion induction and reluctance start motors are not used these days,
they have been largely replaced by split phase motors with special capacitors which can be
designed to perform equally well as repulsion types. In addition they offer such advantages as
lower cost and trouble free service.

                                                     149
150                                                                       CONTROL OF MACHINES

       Shaded pole motors are extremely popular motors used in low-starting torque
applications. Split phase motors are widely used and are designed in several ways to develop
different values of starting torque.
       Universal series motor is another very popular type of motor which can operate on both
ac and dc supply. They generally run at high speed and employ special design features to
reduce commutation and armature reaction difficulties on ac supply.
       Synchronous motors such as reluctance motor and hysteresis motor operate at
synchronous speed for all values of load. They are manufactured in very smal ratings. Practically
all single phase motors are designed for line voltage starting and take inrush currents that
may be little more than the rated values in some types and six or more times as much in
others. Like polyphase motors they are also frequently jogged, plugged, reversed, dynamically
braked and plug reversed. When the above mentioned operations are done, contactors of larger
ratings than normal are used, as their frequent operations cause overheating and excessive
wear of contacts. Control circuits of single phase motors are however simple as few contactors
and relays are used.

   6.2 UNIVERSAL SERIES MOTORS
The construction and principle of working of a universal series motor are similar to a dc series
motor. To enable the motor to work satisfactorily on ac supply also, some modifications are
required in its construction. The important modification required are :
        (i) Field structure should be completely laminated to avoid losses due to eddy currents:
       (ii) To combat effects of armature reaction and resulting poor commutation the arma-
            ture is to be designed to have lower voltage gradient between adjacent commutator
            segments than in an equivalent dc motor;
       (iii) Poor commutation with ac (due to emf induced by the alternating main field flux in
             a coil undergoing commutation) is improved by using distributed field windings and
             compensating field windings that are placed in a slotted stator core. When a univer-
             sal motor is used with ac supply the armature reactance drop exerts a speed lower-
             ing effect with increased loading. At the same time at increased loading the effective
             flux per ac ampere is less than that produced per dc ampere. This condition tends the
             motor to run faster on ac supply. Out of the above two factors i.e., of armature reac-
             tance drop, and effective flux, the factor which pre-dominates determines the speed
             of the motor on ac supply.
6.2.1 Reversing Direction of Rotation of Universal Motor
The direction of rotation of a universal motor can be changed by either:
        (i) Reversing the field connection with respect to those of armature; or
       (ii) By using two field windings wound on the core in opposite directions so that the one
            connected in series with armature gives clockwise rotation, while the other in series
            with the armature gives counterclockwise rotation.
       The second method, i.e., the two field method is used in applications such as motor
operated rheostats and servo systems. This method has somewhat simpler connections than
the first method.
       For simple applications like portable drills etc. manual switches are frequently used for
reversing the direction of rotation of the motor. Fig. 6.1 (a and b) shows how a DPDT (Double
Pole Double Throw) switch and a three position switch may be used for reversing the direction
of rotation of single field and double field type of motors respectively.




dharm
d:N-MachMac6-1.pm5   150
CONTROL OF SINGLE PHASE MOTORS                                                             151
                                   Series field



                                               A2         2   A   1    A1

                       AC/DC             DPDT                                ARM
                       Supply            Switch
                                               B2                      B1
                                                              B



                                                    (a)


                                                     1        FORW Field


                                           0
                                Three position       2         REV Field
                       AC/DC        switch
                       Supply                                               ARM




                                                    (b)

              Fig. 6.1 Reversing of a universal motor (a) Armature reversing method using
                  a reversing switch (b) Two-field method using a three-position switch

       In Fig. 6.1 (a), when the DPDT switch is in the position shown, the switch blade bridges
the switch terminals A – A1 and B – B1, current through series field and armature flows in the
direction as indicated by arrows. When direction of rotation of the motor is to be reversed the
switch is thrown to position 2.
       Now, terminal A gets connected to terminal A2 and terminal B gets connected to B2.
Current through the armature reverses while direction of current through the series field
remains unchanged. This leads to reversal of direction of rotation of the motor. As shown in
Fig. 6.1 (b) the direction of rotation of the motor is reversed by moving the selector switch in
position 1 or 2. In position 1, the FORW-field runs the motor in one direction and in position 2,
REV-field runs the motors in the reverse direction. Automatic control circuit for reversal of
motor by armature-reversing method is similar to the circuit studied for dc motors in Chapter
5. Power and control circuit for a double field universal motor has been shown in Fig. 6.2.
       When the FOR-push button is pressed, the forward contactor F get energised and its
contacts F1 and F2 close to energise the armature and the FORW-field winding. Similarly
when the reverse contactor is energised the REV-field winding and the armature get energised
by receiving supply through contacts R1 and R2. In the control circuit, push button interlocking,
as also auxiliary contact interlocking have been provided to avoid simultaneous energisation
of contactors F and R.




dharm
d:N-MachMac6-1.pm5     151
152                                                                                     CONTROL OF MACHINES

                       L1
                            +

                                                                 Stop



                                  F1     R1           F3                REV         R3
                                                           FOR



                                       ARM                 REV                    FOR



                            FORW              REV           R4           F4
                             field            field

                                                                 F            R
                                  F2     R2


                       L2 –

              Fig. 6.2 Power and control circuit for reversing of a two-field universal motor

6.2.2 Speed Control of Universal Motor
There are various methods of controlling the speed of a universal motor. A wide range of speed
control is possible by inserting a rheostat in the line circuit which causes variable voltage to
appear across the motor terminals resulting in reduced motor speed. Another method of speed
control, not very commonly used is by brush shifting mechanism. The speed of the motor
increases when the brushes are moved backward relative to the direction of rotation. However,
only a limited range of speed control is possible by this method. This is because when the
brushes are moved further from the magnetic neutral, commutation worsens.
       Another speed control method makes use of a tapped field winding. Universal motors
are always bipolar. The number of turns on the two poles need not always be the same as the
air gap flux is created by series combination of mmfs of the two pole windings.
       As shown in Fig. 6.3 the field winding having larger number of turns is tapped at three
points thus making possible a total of four operating speeds. For a given value of load, minimum
speed will be obtained when the entire winding is used (this gives maximum mmf and flux).
Maximum speed will result when the selector switch is on point H at which minimum flux is
obtained. This method offers possibility of tapping the field winding at appropriate points to
permit the motor to run at the same speed on direct current and also on alternating current for
a particular input. This, however, does not mean that speeds will be the same on ac and dc
supplies for some other values of input currents.
       Another popular method of speed control is the governor controlled speed adjusting
method. In this method of speed adjustment of a series motor, a governor consisting of an
assembly of a spring loaded contacts is mounted on the shaft of the motor. The current enters
the governor contacts through carbon brush and slip-ring arrangement. When the motor is
running, governor contacts open and close very rapidly depending upon the natural resonant
frequency of the moving contacts. For a given spring tension setting, the contacts vibrate at a
certain rate. Figure 6.4 shows how a governor is connected to a series motor for non-reversing
as well as for two field reversing service.




dharm
d:N-MachMac6-1.pm5        152
CONTROL OF SINGLE PHASE MOTORS                                                                   153



                                                  ARM


                                                                             3
                                                                     2              4 H(High)

                 AC/D.C                                                            Selector
                 Supply                                          1(Low)             switch



              Fig. 6.3 Tapped field winding speed adjustment method for a universal motor


                                             Governor                              Governor

                                R                                  R



                                       ARM                                        ARM
                 AC/D.C                                 AC/D.C
                 Supply                                 Supply

                                                                   FORW                   REV
                                    Series                          field                 field
                                     field

                                                                       Selector
                                                                       switch

                       (a) Non-reversing                         (b) Reversing

               Fig. 6.4 Governor controlled speed adjustment method for a series motor

       For a given spring tension setting, contacts vibrate at a certain rate. When the speed
rises above the particular value set by the spring tension, the contacts remain open for a
relatively longer period of time, than the time the contacts take for closing. This keeps a line
resistance R in the circuit a little longer and acts to reduce the speed. The reverse is true when
speed falls below the adjusted value. Now the closing time of contact is longer than its opening
time and hence the resistance remains in circuit for smaller duration of time and as a
consequence the motor speed tends to rise.
      In this type of speed adjustment the motor does not run at a constant speed but runs in
a narrow range above and below the set speed. A wide range of speed adjustment is thus
possible by adjusting the spring tension of the contacts. A small capacitor is used across the
contacts to prevent excessive arcing.

   6.3 SHADED POLE MOTOR
Shaded pole motors are induction motors manufactured for very small ratings and are used in
applications where starting torque requirement of the load is very low. Some of the applications
of shaded pole type induction motors are in blowers, fans used in heaters, slide and film
projectors, advertising display devices etc. The outstanding features are the low initial cost,
small size, and ruggedness. An advantageous feature of such small motors is that the starting




dharm
d:N-MachMac6-1.pm5      153
154                                                                             CONTROL OF MACHINES

current is only slightly higher than the full-load current and therefore the stalled motor condition
is not harmful to the motor windings.
       Cross sectional view of a shaded pole type motor has been shown in Fig. 6.5. The stator
shown are projected type. Short circuited coils known as shading coils (rings) are fixed on one
portion of each pole. A pole on which a shading ring is fixed is called a shaded pole. Shading
coil can be of thick single turn in the form of a ring or have a number of short circuited turns.
The rotor is of conventional squirrel cage type.

                                                    Unshaded
                                                    portion of
                                                    the pole
                                                     Shaded
                                                     portion


                       V~                             Shading V~
                                                      ring


                                                     Squirrel
                                                     cage rotor

                                      (a)                                  (b)

                       Fig. 6.5 Shaded pole type induction motors of different design

        The magnetic field created by the field ampere-turns of a shaded pole motor varies in
magnetic strength and merely shifts from one side of the salient pole to the other side for every
half cycle of the supply voltage. The direction of rotation of shaded pole motors with a single
set of field windings and shading coils can not be reversed. The motor would always rotate in
a direction from the unshaded part to the shaded part of the pole. For enabling reversal of
direction of rotation, the construction of the stator must be changed to include :
       (1) Two sets of shading coils that are normally open circuited and occupy different posi-
           tions with respect to the main field winding.
       (2) Two main windings that occupy different positions with respect to the shading coils.
       (3) A special distributed continuous winding that is placed in a slotted stator core and is
           tapped at appropriate points with respect to the shading coils.
       Fig. 6.6 (a) shows shading coils placed on both sides of each of the salient poles. With the
help of short-circuiting switch either set of shading coils can be made effective. The coils which
are short circuited determine the direction of rotation. When the selector switch [Fig. 6.6 (a)] is
in position F, shaded coils A and A′ are shorted while shaded coils B and B′ are open. When the
switch position is changed, coils B and B′ are shorted while A and A′ become open.
       In Fig. 6.6 (b) two distributed windings are placed 90° electrical degrees apart with
respect to each other and 45° electrical degrees from the shading coils in a slotted stator. In
Fig. 6.6 (c) a continuous distributed winding is used and tapped at 90° electrical degrees.
Leads from these tappings are connected to a DPDT switch. With alternate position of DPDT
switch, the main winding can have either positive or negative 90° electrical degrees relationship
with respect to the shading coils. In one case the rotor will turn clockwise and in the other case
the rotor will turn counter clockwise.




dharm
d:N-MachMac6-1.pm5     154
CONTROL OF SINGLE PHASE MOTORS                                                                             155




       Fig. 6.6 Method of changing the direction of rotation of a shaded pole type induction motor

      The speed of the shaded pole motor can be changed by changing the impressed voltage
across the main winding. Three methods are generally employed to vary the winding voltage.
They are : (i) by using an auto transformer that is tapped for several voltages. (ii) by using a
tapped reactance coil that incurs a line voltage drop, and (iii) by using tapped exciting winding
to enable supply voltage to be applied across the whole winding or across a part of it.
       Method of speed control illustrated through Fig. 6.7 (a) and Fig. 6.7 (b) are self
explanatory. In the method of speed control illustrated through Fig. 6.7 (c), the highest speed
results when the smallest portion of the winding is energised.
                                                           Reactance coil




                         3H
           AC supply




                                               AC supply




                                                                                 AC supply




                         2
                                                                                             OFF
                         L                                                                     H
                         OFF                                                                   M
                                 M                                          M                 L

         (a) Auto transformer method        (b) Reactance coil method           (c) Tapped-winding method

                             Fig. 6.7 Speed control methods of shaded pole motors
       This is because in such a case volts per turn increases resulting in increased speed.

   6.4 SPLIT PHASE MOTORS
Split phase induction motors are the most widely used type of single phase motors. They are
made in larger sizes than shaded pole type motors. They are used in refrigerators, washing
machines, portable hoists, many kinds of small machine tools, grinders, blowers and fans,
wood working equipment, centrifugal pumps, etc. Two types of split phase motors are generally
available. They are:
       (i) Standard split phase motor; and
      (ii) Capacitor split phase motors.
6.4.1 Standard Split Phase Motors
The stator of a standard split phase motor has two windings viz., a main winding and an
auxiliary winding. These two windings have different ratios of resistance to inductive reactance.
The windings are connected in parallel across the single phase ac supply. The line current is




dharm
d:N-MachMac6-1.pm5     155
156                                                                                                             CONTROL OF MACHINES

thus split into two parts; one part flowing through the main winding and the other part flowing
through the auxiliary windings. Because of different ratio of resistance to inductive reactance
of these two windings current flowing through them will have a time phase difference of 30
electrical degrees or more. In some motors, both the windings are energised continuously,
while in most of them, the auxiliary winding is used only during the starting period along with
the main winding to develop the required starting torque. When the motor reaches final speed
the auxiliary winding is disconnected from the supply. The auxiliary windings can be
disconnected by using a centrifugal switch in series with it. During starting, the centrifugal
switch remains closed. When the motor reaches normal speed the centrifugal switch opens
and disconnects the auxiliary winding. This has been shown in Fig. 6.8 (a).

                                         Centrifugal switch

                                                                                                                   Disc

                                                                                                                Plunger
                          Main winding




                                                              Aux winding
              AC supply




                                                                               AC supply




                                                                                                                          Aux winding
                                                                                           Main winding

                                               (a)                                                        (b)

            Fig. 6.8 Use of (a) Centrifugal switch (b) Electro-magnetic relay for connecting an
                     auxiliary winding in parallel with the main winding during starting

      Another method of disconnecting the auxiliary winding when the motor has picked up
speed is by using an electromagnetic relay as has been shown in Fig. 6.8 (b).
      During starting the relay picks up due to high starting current and connects the auxiliary
winding in the circuit. When the motor reaches normal speed, current drops to normal value
and the electromagnetic relay is dropped and therefore the auxiliary winding gets disconnected
from supply.
       Reversal of direction of rotation of a split phase motor is obtained by interchanging the
auxiliary winding terminal connections with respect to the main winding. The motor must be
brought to rest or the centrifugal switch must be closed before reversal is attempted. The basic




                                                     Fig. 6.9 Reversing of split phase motor




dharm
d:N-MachMac6-1.pm5                     156
CONTROL OF SINGLE PHASE MOTORS                                                                                                  157

circuit for reversal of small split phase motor using a DPDT (Double Pole Double Throw) switch
and contactors has been shown in Fig. 6.9 (a and b).
        Speed control of standard split phase motors is achieved with difficulty. The usual method
is to use two or more windings designed to produce different number of poles. The complications
arise as both the main and the auxiliary windings have to be arranged for pole changing. The
capacitor type split phase motor which will now be discussed have better possibility of speed
adjustments.
6.4.2 Capacitor Type Split Phase Motors
Capacitor type split phase motors are generally similar to the standard split phase construction
except for the addition of capacitor and a slightly modified switching arrangement for the two
value capacitor type motors. The three types of capacitor split phase motors have been shown
in Fig. 6.10.

                                         Main
                        C.S             winding                                                 C.S
                                                                     Capacitor
            AC supply




                                                  AC supply




                                                                                    AC supply




                                                                                                                          Main
                              Capacitor
                                Aux winding                          Aux winding                             Aux



                         (a) Capacitor-start                  (b) Permanent-split               (c) Two-value capacitor
                                                                   capacitor

                                 Fig. 6.10 Three types of capacitor type split phase motors

6.4.2.1 Capacitor Start Split Phase Motors
These motors are used where high starting torque is required. To accomplish this, capacitors
of large values are to be used. Electrolytic capacitors designed for short duty service are available
and used in these motors. The motor should come upto its speed quickly and disconnect the
capacitor from the windings, otherwise the capacitor will get damaged. The centrifugal switch
or the relay that function in auxiliary winding should be very reliable.
6.4.2.2 Permanent Split Capacitor Motors
These motors are mainly used for low starting torque loads where they are generally shaft
mounted. Their particular fields of applications are in air moving equipment such as fans,
blowers, oil burners etc. where quiet operation is required.
6.4.2.3 Two Value Capacitor Motors
This type of capacitor motors has the advantage that they develop extremely high locked rotor
torque with one value of capacitance in the auxiliary winding circuit and gives quiet running
performance of the motor with another capacitor. Electrolytic capacitors are used for starting.
Their values are 10 to 15 times as much as the value of the running capacitor.
6.4.3 Starters for Capacitor Type Split Phase Motors
We know that direction of a split phase motor can be reversed if the connection of one of the
windings is reversed with respect to the other. In an automatic starter this can be achieved by
using two contactors i.e., one for forward direction of rotation and the other for reverse direction
of rotation. The connections for control circuit and the power circuit diagrams have been shown
in Fig. 6.11. The circuit does not need any further explanation as it is a simple forward reverse
starter scheme.




dharm
d:N-MachMac6-1.pm5              157
158                                                                                                                                               CONTROL OF MACHINES

              L1

                                                Stop

                                                                                               F                                R
                        AC supply




                                     FOR            F        REV           R
                                                                                F                                                             R




                                                                                                                                                                   Aux winding
                                            R                     F
                                                                                                         Main
                                                                                                        winding
                                                                                R                                                             F
                                                F                     R


              L2

                   Fig. 6.11 Forward/reverse starter for a permanent split capacitor motor

6.4.4 Starter for Two Value Capacitor Type Split-phase Motors
This type of split phase motors have two capacitors of different values in the auxiliary winding.
The motors develop a high starting torque with one capacitor of a higher value and gives a
quite running performance with the other capacitor of comparatively lower value. The circuit
for forward / reverse operation of a two value capacitor motor has been shown in Fig. 6.12.


                                                                                M2


                                    Stop
                                                                                                                                Aux winding
                                                                                Main winding




                                                                                                         Oil filled capacitor




                                    Start               M1
                   AC supply




                                                                                                                                                    Electrolytic
                                                                                                                                                     capacitor




                                                              R2          TR1                                                                 R3
                                                        R1



                                                                                                   M3
                                                M            TR           R


                                                    Thermal timer

                               Fig. 6.12 Forward/reverse starter for a two value capacitor motor
         In the circuit shown an electrolytic capacitor has been used for starting purpose and an
oil filled capacitor has been used for continuous running operation. During starting both the
capacitors are in the circuit. When the motor picks up speed the electrolytic capacitor gets
disconnected due to opening of a relay contact. The circuit operation is as follows :




dharm
d:N-MachMac6-1.pm5                 158
CONTROL OF SINGLE PHASE MOTORS                                                                     159

      When the START-push button is pressed the M contactor is energised which inturn
energises both the main and the auxiliary windings (with both the capacitors in the auxiliary
winding circuit) due to closing of contacts M2 and M3. A thermal timer TR is also energised
along with the contactor.
        This thermal timer consists of a heater coil wound on a bimetallic strip. After a pre-set
delay the bimetallic strips bends and closes contact TR1. Closing of contact TR1 causes
energisation of relay R which then gets hold through its own contact R2. At the same time
relay R disconnects the electrolytic capacitor from the auxiliary winding circuit due to opening
of its normally closed (NC) contact R3. The thermal timer gets de-energised as soon as relay R
is energised due to opening of its contact R1.
6.4.5 Starter for a Two Value Capacitor Motor Using a Current Relay and an Auto
      Transformer
This type of starter uses a current relay in series with the main winding and an auto-transformer
in the auxiliary winding to increase the effective value of the capacitors in the auxiliary winding
circuit. The circuit has been shown in Fig. 6.13.




   Fig. 6.13 Starter for a two value capacitor motor using an overcurrent relay and an auto-transformer

       In this circuit, when contactor M is energised, a high inrush current flows through the
main winding which energises relay R. Its contact R1 closes and contact R2 opens. Due to
closing of contact R1, the auto transformer winding comes in circuit and the effective value of
capacitor is increased. The current relay is designed to pick up at 3 times the full load current
and to drop at twice the full-load value. The motor therefore develops high starting torque
during starting due to high effective capacitance. When the motor picks up speed, the current
drops and the relay R drops out. Due to opening of contact R1 and closing of contact R2, the
auto-transformer gets open circuited. The auxiliary winding then gets connected through the
capacitor only. The relay R can pick up again, if load on the motor causes current to rise to its
pick up value and thus re-inserts the auto-transformer. Thus, this increased capacitance permits
the motor to develop more torque and prevents stalling at heavier loads.




dharm
d:N-MachMac6-1.pm5    159
160                                                                                     CONTROL OF MACHINES

6.4.6 Dynamic Breaking of Split Phase Motors
The principle of dynamic breaking discussed earlier in connection with polyphase induction
motors, also applies well to split phase motors. The procedure, as already explained, is to
disconnect the stator windings from ac supply while the motor is running and instead, connect
dc supply across the windings. Full wave rectifier is used to obtain dc supply from the available
ac source. Precaution must be taken to avoid, simultaneous energisation of the stator windings
from both ac as well as dc supply. This is taken care of by providing electrical and/or mechanical
interlocking of the contactors. A rheostat is provided in the dc circuit to control the time required
for the motor to stop. Less is the value of rehostatic value of resistance, more quickly will the
rotational energy get converted to electrical energy and get dissipated as heat and hence less
will be the time required for the motor to stop. The control diagram for dynamic breaking of a
split phase motor is shown in Fig. 6.14.



                                                           TR1      DB             M3
                             Stop
                                                          (Inst)

                                                                              DB
                             Start       M1
                                                    TR2
                 AC Supply




                                                                         DB
                                                                                         M
                                   DB
                                              M2
                                                                     R
                                     M         DB              TR                  M4
                                                                    DB

                                                                                   O.L




              Fig. 6.14 Control circuit for dynamic breaking of a split phase induction motor

       When the STOP-push button is pressed, contactor M gets de-energised and closes its
contact M2. Contactor DB gets energised through the back contact of the STOP-push button,
closed contact TR2 and contact M2. Timer TR also gets energised along with contactor DB. The
instantaneous contact of relay TR, i.e.,TR1 closes and thus both contactor DB and relay TR
remain energised. Contactor DB energises a bridge rectifier which feeds dc current into the
stator winding of the motor. Current to be fed is adjustable through a rheostat, R. Due to
feeding of dc current the motor slows down and comes to a quick stop. After a pre-set delay
which would match with the time taken by the motor to stop, the timer TR operates and opens
its delayed contact TR2 and thus de-energises contactor DB and gets reset. The time allowed to
stop the motor, as explained earlier, can be varied by adjusting the rheostat R.
6.4.7 Plug Reversing of Capacitor Start Motors
The capacitor start motors suffer from the disadvantage that they are not easily reversible due
to the centrifugal switch connected in the auxiliary winding. The motor can not be
instantaneously reversed by simple control as the auxiliary winding remains disconnected till
the motor comes near to zero speed. However, by proper design of the control circuit the motor




dharm
d:N-MachMac6-1.pm5         160
CONTROL OF SINGLE PHASE MOTORS                                                                          161

can be made instantly reversible. This is accomplished by using an electromagnetic relay along
with a special two contact centrifugal switch as shown in Fig. 6.15.


                                       Stop
                                                                             U3                 D3
                                                        U1             D1




                                                                                  Aux winding
                                 Up
                                                    Down
                                                              Main
                                                             winding
                  AC supply




                                                        D2        U2

                                                                                                C
                                LSU           LSD
                                                                                                 B   R
                                       U            D                       R1                   A

                                                                       R
                                                                                                R2




                              Fig. 6.15 Control circuit for a small hoist using a capacitor start
      The circuit shown in Fig. 6.15 is for a small hoist using a capacitor start motor. The
upper and lower limits of travel are controlled by two limit switches viz. LSU and LSD.
       When UP-push button is pressed, contactor U gets energised. Its contacts U1 and U2
energise the main winding. Closing of its contact U3 causes relay R to get energised through
the centrifugal switch contacts A—B. After the energisation of relay R auxiliary winding gets
energised through capacitor C, the centrifugal switch, and the closed contact R2 of relay R.
When the motor reaches near normal speed, the centrifugal switch opens and the auxiliary
winding gets connected to a high resistance R. Under this condition the auxiliary winding is
effectively an open circuit and therefore the developed torque is only by the main winding
(recall that this is what is required during normal operation of the motor). When the hoist will
reach the upper limit the limit switch LSU will be actuated, U contactor will get de-energised,
relay R also drops out due to opening of contact U3. If, to achieve instant reversal, the DOWN-
push button is pressed, contactor D would pick-up energising the main and also the auxiliary
winding through normally closed (NC) contact R1 (as relay R will not pick-up because of
centrifugal switch being open). The centrifugal switch would close when speed becomes zero,
the relay R would then get energised. The auxiliary winding would also get energised through
the centrifugal switch contact B. In the downward direction when motor again reaches its final
speed the centrifugal switch would open thus connecting the auxiliary winding to the high
resistance R.
6.4.8 Speed Control of Split Phase Motors
Speed control of split phase motors (without capacitors) is obtained by either pole changing
method or by using special winding arrangements. These methods will, however, increase the
size of the such motors and make them expensive.
      To obtain two speed operation of a split phase motor, the motor will have two main
windings and two auxiliary windings, each set wound for different number of poles. However




dharm
d:N-MachMac6-1.pm5             161
162                                                                              CONTROL OF MACHINES

by special design a single auxiliary winding may also be used. In two speed operation, the
centrifugal switch is set to open at the lower of the two speeds. In case of fast speed operation,
therefore, the rotor has to accelerate to full speed on the main winding only. No problem would
arise on this account if the load on motor is moderate.
       Figure 6.16 shows the control circuit for a two speed motor with two main and two
auxiliary windings. The control circuit permits starting of the motor at slow or fast speed
depending upon the setting of the selector switch. During running condition, transfer can be
made from one speed to the other speed.
       For the selector switch setting for slow speed, as shown in Fig. 6.16, the motor can be
started by pressing the SLOW-push button. A relay CRS first gets energised through contact
S3 and then gets hold through its contact CRS1. Contact CRS2 also closes and makes the
circuit ready for fast operation. Whenever a change over is required for fast operation, the
FAST-push button is to be pressed which would first release the slow contactor S and then
energise the fast contactor F. A relay CRF would then get energised and get hold through its
own contact. Contact CRF2 of this relay closes allowing transfer from fast speed to slow speed
operation when required. Thus, it follows from the above that the motor can be started for a
particular operation, fast or slow, depending upon the setting of the selector switch and then
change over to the other operation by pressing the corresponding push button.
6.4.9 Speed Control of Permanent Split Capacitor Motors
The speed of a permanently split capacitor motor can be adjusted by connecting it to a variable
voltage source such as an auto-transformer. The limitation of this method is that the starting
torque developed is very low, especially when the motor is started on low speed. Another
limitation is that speed is sensitive to voltage changes on low speed connections. Further.
speed varies considerably for different loading conditions of the motor.
       The motor can be started in three different ways using an auto-transformer as shown in
Fig. 6.17. In Fig. 6.17 (a) the voltage across the main winding and the auxiliary winding are
varied simultaneously resulting in low starting torque for low speed operation. This shortcoming,
however, can be overcome by first starting the motor on high speed and then stepping it down
to low speed as shown in Fig. 6.17 (a).




                       Fig. 6.16 Control circuit for a two speed split phase induction
                             motor having two main and two auxiliary windings




dharm
d:N-MachMac6-1.pm5    162
CONTROL OF SINGLE PHASE MOTORS                                                                                                                                                     163

      Good starting torque at all speeds can be obtained if the auxiliary winding is connected
across the mains supply and voltage adjustment is provided only for the main winding as
shown in Fig. 6.17 (b).

                           Selector
                     H      switch                                                                        H




                                                                                                                                           220V AC
                                                                      220V AC
                M                                                                                     M
                                                                                                                                                                 H
                L                                                                                     L       Off                                            M
    220V AC




                     Off
                                                                                                                                                             L
                                      Aux
                         Main




                                                                                                                     Aux
                                                                                                                                                                 Off




                                                                                                              Main




                                                                                                                                                                       Main
                                                                                                                                                                              Aux
                                               Cap                                                                             Cap


                (a)                                                                                       (b)                                                        (c)

              Fig. 6.17 Voltage control method for speed adjustment of split capacitor motors
       In the third method of connections shown in Fig. 6.17 (c), the two windings are connected
to a tapped auto transformer so that any voltage change across the main winding is accompanied
by an inverse change across the auxiliary winding. This method with a properly designed
motor can be applied to an installation whose speed should not be sensitive to variations of
normal line voltage.
       In another design of split motor a special winding arrangement is made to eliminate the
requirement of an auto tansformer. The motor in this case, in addition to the main and the
auxiliary windings, is provided with a so called intermediate winding. The intermediate winding
so provided is in space phase with the main winding. The main and the intermediate windings
occupy the same slots, the later placed directly over the former. They need not have the same
number of turns. The wire of the intermediate winding is invariably smaller in size than the
main winding. Two different connections for this type of motor design are shown in Fig. 6.18 (a
and b).
                                                                                          Capacitor




                                                                                                                                 winding
                                                                                                                                  Main
                                            winding
                                             Main




                                                                                                                                                                  Auxiliary
                                                                                                                                                                  winding




              110V                                                                                        230V
                                                                                Auxiliary winding
                                                       Intermediate




                                H
                                                          winding




                                                                                                                                              Intermediate




                                                                                                                           H
                                                                                                                                                 winding




                                L
                                                                                                                           L


                                                 (a)                                                                                 (b)

                 Fig. 6.18 Speed control of split capacitor motor with intermediate winding




dharm
d:N-MachMac6-1.pm5            163
164                                                                           CONTROL OF MACHINES

       The connection scheme shown in Fig. 6.18 (a) is generally used for 110 volt motors. The
main and the intermediate winding are connected in series across the auxiliary winding and
the capacitor. The terminal of SPDT (Single Pole Double Throw) switch H and L are wired to
the intermediate winding as shown in Fig. 6.18 (a).
        Connections shown in Fig. 6.18 (b) are used for 230 voltage motors.

                                      REVIEW QUESTIONS
   1.   How are single phase motors classified ? Name different types of motors under each classifica-
        tion.
   2.   What modifications are required to use a dc series motor on ac supply ?
   3.   Draw connection scheme for armature reversing of a universal motor.
   4.   Discuss two field method of reversing the direction of rotation of a universal motor.
   5.   How can the speed of a universal motor be controlled ?
   6.   Draw power and control diagram for starting a two-value capacitor type split phase motor.
   7.   Explain with the help of diagram how a current relay and an auto transformer can be utilised for
        starting a capacitor split phase motor.
   8.   Discuss dynamic breaking of a split phase induction motor.
   9.   Discuss plug reversing of capacitor start motors using an electromagnetic relay and a special
        two contact centrifugal switch.
  10. Draw power and control diagram for a two speed split phase induction motor having two main
      and two auxiliary windings.
  11. Explain how you will obtain the speed control of a permanent split capacitor motor.




dharm
d:N-MachMac6-1.pm5    164
%
                                      Control of Synchronous Motors


   7.1 CONSTRUCTION AND OPERATION OF A SYNCHRONOUS MOTOR
The stator winding of a synchronous motor is similar to that of a 3 phase induction motor. The
rotor consists of salient poles excited by dc field windings like that of inward-projecting poles
of a dc motor. The rotor field windings are energised by direct current passed through slip
rings from an external source or from a dc generator, mounted on the same rotor shaft.
      When the stator winding is energised from a 3 phase supply, a revolving magnetic field,
                                      120 f
the speed of which is given by Ns =          is produced. This speed is called synchronous speed.
                                        P
To enable the synchronous motor to run at the above mentioned synchronous speed the rotor
field winding is energised and at the same time brought near to the synchronous speed, by
some other means. The rotor poles, which are always equal to that of the stator poles, are
pulled to synchronous speed and the two set of poles lock with each other and the rotor starts
rotating at synchronous speed. Thus, to run a synchronous motor, the rotor has to be brought
near to synchronous speed first by some means, say by some external prime mover. This is a
big disadvantage of this motor. However, a synchronous motor is made self starting by providing
a squirrel cage winding (like that of an induction motor) along with the dc field winding on the
rotor. In such a case when three phase supply is applied across the stator windings the rotor
starts rotating as an induction motor and when it reaches near its final speed (near synchronous
speed), dc field winding is energised and the rotor thus pulls into synchronism with the revolving
field and continues to run at synchronous speed. At synchronous speed there will be no current
in the squirrel cage winding since at synchronous speed slip is zero. The squirrel cage winding
therefore is designed only for short duty services. During the starting period the dc field winding
has to be kept shorted through a discharge resistance. This is done so as to avoid building up of
an extremely high voltage in the winding. If field is left open circuited a high voltage will
develop in the open field winding as it has large number of turns and the relative speed of
stator flux to the windings of the poles is high during starting. But this induced high voltage
will gradually decrease as the motor will be picking up speed. The induced emf in the field
winding is kept to a safe value by shorting the winding. This would limit the demagnetising
effect on the main flux otherwise caused due to current flowing in the dc field winding as a
result of induced emf in it. This demagnetising effect, if allowed to happen will reduce the
starting torque of the motor. If in some special applications a higher starting torque is required
the field winding can be left open circuited, but should be sectionalised, to have reduced voltage
induced across the separated portions.

                                               165
166                                                                                    CONTROL OF MACHINES

       From the above, it is seen that the primary purpose of the squirrel cage in this motor, is
for starting the motor. As mentioned earlier this winding is designed for low thermal capacity.
If, however, the motor picks up speed too slowly under some loading condition, it will run as
induction motor for extended period of time and as a result the squirrel cage winding may get
over heated and get damaged. To overcome this problem a certain protection must be provided
which should disconnect the motor from the supply in the event of its failure to get synchronised
properly within a certain prescribed time. A timing relay is used for this purpose to open the
control circuit if the motor fails to synchronise within the set time.
       Synchronous motors, like the induction motors, can be started by applying line voltage,
reduced voltage, or using part winding controllers depending upon the kind of load, frequency
of starting, and power serivce restrictions. The starters for the motor can be manual, semi-
automatic, or fully-automatic using a polarising frequency relay.
       From the above it follows that synchronous motor control has two basic functions:
        (i) To start the motor as an induction motor (the motor can be started by any schemes
            such as across the line, auto-transformer, primary resistor or any other method) ;
       (ii) To bring the motor up to synchronous speed by exciting the dc field. Different types
            of synchronous motor starters are discussed as follows.

   7.2 MANUAL PUSH BUTTON SYNCHRONISING STARTER
When the START-push button shown in Fig. 7.1 is pressed contactor M gets energised and the
motor starts as induction motor. The field winding remains shorted through normally closed
contact F1 and discharge resistance. When the motor has reached its maximum speed, the
RUN-push button is closed which energises and holds contactor F contacts F2 and F3 closed
and contact F1 open. The field winding is thus energised and the motor pulls into synchronism.
An ammeter and a rheostat are connected in the field circuit to control the excitation current.

             L1
             L2
             L3                                              P
                                                                 Stop             Stop




              M1   M2        M3                                  Start       M4    Run       F4



                                                                                    M5

                                                                         M               F
                                       F2
                        MS
                                               A             N
                                                         +
                                                                                  (b)
                                  Discharge
                                  resistance
                                                       DC
                                  F1
                                       F3
                                                         –
                                               (a)

            Fig. 7.1 Power and control circuit for a manual push button synchronising starter




dharm
d:N-MachMac7-1.pm5     166
CONTROL OF SYNCHRONOUS MOTORS                                                                167

Unity power factor of the motor can be obtained by adjusting the rheostat. A leading power
factor can also be obtained by increasing the excitation.
      The disadvantage of the starter is that synchronisation of the motor depends entirely
upon the judgement of the operator.

   7.3 TIMED SEMI-AUTOMATIC SYNCHRONISING
In this method the synchronous motor may be brought up to synchronous speed by exciting the
field winding with the help of a Definite Time relay instead of a push button. The control
scheme is as shown in Fig. 7.2.

                                 P

                                      Stop
                                                           TR1


                                                             M5
                                     Start       M4




                                             M        TR          F

                                 N

                       Fig. 7.2 Control scheme for timed semi-automatic synchronising

       In this circuit, timer TR is energised along with the main contactor. After a pre-set time
delay the rotor accelerates to its maximum when the contact TR1 closes and further accelerates
the rotor to synchronous speed by energising the field winding. The setting of the timer is
adjusted to the maximum value ever required for the motor to accelerate. This method of
starting, like the push button operated synchronising method, is also not satisfactory because
of the reason that if the synchronism operation fails, it becomes necessary to depress the
STOP-button and repeat the starting cycle. Rotor will however continue to rotate and only the
timing cycle will start again. It thus follows that neither the push button nor the timer method
of synchronising is a satifactory method of starting.

   7.4 AUTOMATIC STARTER USING POLARISED FIELD FREQUENCY
       RELAY
It is known that synchronous motor is started by first accelerating the rotor with the help of its
squirrel cage winding upto near its synchronous speed and then synchronising by applying the
dc field excitation. In an automatic starter using polarised field frequency relay, synchronisation
is obtained automatically when about 92 to 97 percent synchronous speed is obtained with the
help of a Polarised Field Frequency Relay (PFR). Such a PFR has two coils one for ac supply
and the other for dc supply. This relay is used in the circuit along with a reactor as shown in
Fig. 7.3. The working principle of a PFR will be discussed a little later. First we will discuss the
functions of a PFR relay and an Out of Step Relay, TR used in the starter circuit shown in
Fig. 7.3.



dharm
d:N-MachMac7-1.pm5      167
168                                                                                                       CONTROL OF MACHINES

                L1                             + DC –
                L2
                L3
                                                                                      P

                                                                          M5                           CR1
                                                                                       Stop
                                          F1            F2                PFR1
                                                                                               M4
                                                                                      Start




                                                             resistance
                                                             Discharge
                 M1    M2        M3
                                                  F3                           F
                                                                                               CR2


                                                                                      TR1
                                                      TR                  Polarised
                                                                          frequency
                                                                          relay
                            MS
                                                       Reactor

                                                                   AC
                                      To motor                            DC                  CR              M
                                      field winding                            PFR
                                                                                      N
                                                       (a)                                           (b)

              Fig. 7.3 Power and control circuit for an automatic starter for a synchronous
                              motor using polarised field frequency relay

      When the START-push button is pressed, CR relay gets energised and consequently the
main contactor M, is energised through its contact CR1. It gets hold through its contact CR2
and contact M4 of the main contactor. Normally closed (NC) contact of the overload relay and
the Out of Step Relay TR are connected in series with AC coil of relay CR.
       At the instant of starting when contactor M closes and the motor starts on its squirrel
cage winding, the polarised field frequency relay (PFR) opens its normally closed contact PFR1
and thus does not allow the field contactor F to get energised. When the motor reaches 92 to 97
percent of its synchronous speed, PFR relay closes its contact PFR1 which causes energisation
of the field contactor F through already closed contact M5. A positive interlocking between the
normally closed and the normally open contacts of contactor F causes the normally open contacts
F1 and F2 to close earlier than the opening of the normally closed contact F3. This positive
overlap is desired in contactor F so that the field winding does not remain open at any instant
during starting or running of the motor. An open field winding can cause damage of insulation
of the winding due to high voltage developed in it. From the circuit diagram it is clear that as
long as contactor F is de-energised, the field winding remains shorted through the normally
closed contact F3, the discharge resistance, the Out of Step Relay TR, and the reactor. Now, let
us consider the instant when the contactor F closes. The closing of field contactor F applies dc
excitation to the field winding and causes the motor to pull into synchronism. Now let us
consider the function of Out of Step Relay TR which is connected in series with the field discharge
circuit. It the motor fails to synchronise or re-synchronise after pulling out of synchronism
within the pre-set time delay of TR relay and if the amount of current induced in field winding
exceeds the value set on TR relay, the relay contact opens thereby de-energising the main
contactor of the motor.
        Let us now discuss the working principle of the polarised field frequency relay and also
the function of the reactor in the circuit. Polarised field frequency relay has a direct current
coil (A), induced field current coil (B), and a pivoted armature with its contact PFR1 as shown
in Fig. 7.4. Coil A is connected to the source of dc excitation and thus builds up constant
magnetic flux in the relay core and polarises it. Alternating flux produced due to current flowing
in coil B is superimposed on the constant flux of coil A. The flux through the armature, thus,




dharm
d:N-MachMac7-1.pm5   168
CONTROL OF SYNCHRONOUS MOTORS                                                                            169

depends on the flux produced by both coils A and B. The resultant wave form of flux through
the armature is shown in Fig. 7.4 (c).

                                                                                               PFR1
                          A            B                          A               B


                    DC          AC                        DC             AC



                                (a)                                       (b)

                                      DC polarising current                Resultant magnetic
                AC induced
                                            in coil A                    flux in armature excita-
                field current
                   in coil B                                          tion applied in this direction
                                                                                E Motor synchronise D
                                                              C            D

                                                        Relay              Relay makes contact PFR1
                                                        opens              to apply excitation to motor
                                               (c)

                                     Fig. 7.4 Polarised field frequency relay
       As seen from Fig. 7.4 (c) coil B produces alternating flux of equal positive and negative
magnitude. The combined flux through armature will be much larger when coil B flux is opposing
the dc coil (coil A) flux as shown in Fig. 7.4 (a). This is so because coil B opposes the flux from
dc coil A and causes it to take a longer path through the armature of the relay. This condition
has been shown through darker loops (lower loops) of Fig. 7.4 (c). When flux due to coil B is in
the other direction as shown in Fig. 7.4 (b), it does not force much flux from coil B to take
longer path through the armature. This condition has been shown by darker loops (upper
loops) in Fig. 7.4 (b). The armature will open when current level falls to a certain low level as
shown by point C in Fig. 7.4. When armature drops, relay contact PFR1 closes which energises
the field contactor F. Contact F1 and F2 closes and the rotor field winding is excited by dc
supply. F3 opens and removes the short across the field winding. Excitation is applied in a
direction opposite in polarity to that of the induced field current at the point of application to
compensate for the time required to build up excitation due to magnetic inertia of the motor
winding. The inertia is however such that dc excitation does not become appreciably effective
until induced current has reversed (Point D on the curve) to the same polarity as the direct
current. Excitation then continues to build up until the motor synchronises as shown by point
E on the curve.
      Now we come to the function of the reactor across the rotor field winding and AC coil of
PFR relay. When the motor is accelerating the slip frequency is high and therefore the current
induced in the field winding will have higher frequency. Thus the reactor would offer a high
impedance, the induced current would be diverted to AC coil of PFR relay and the relay would
pick up. When the rotor would gain speed, the frequency of induced current would get reduced
and therefore reactor impedance would decrease. At 92 to 97 percent of the synchronous speed,
reactor impedance will be quite low and thereby allowing more current. Current flow through
AC coil B or PFR relay will be reduced. The relay thus would drop precisely at the right moment
when rotor speed frequency and polarity of induced current are most favourable for
synchronisation. As already explained, when the relay drops, its contact PFR1 closes and
completes the control circuit for field contactor F.




dharm
d:N-MachMac7-1.pm5     169
170                                                                            CONTROL OF MACHINES

       During running of the motor, if an overload or a voltage dip causes the motor to lose
synchronism, slip frequency currents are immediately induced in the field winding which flows
in the AC coil of PFR relay. Relay armature gets attracted and opens the PFR1 contact. This
leads to de-energisation of contact F and thus dc field excitation to rotor is cut off. If the
normal conditions of line and load are restored within the preset time of the Out of Step Relay,
and if the motor has enough pull-in-torque, the motor will automatically re-synchronise. If,
however, the abnormal conditions continue, either the over load relay will operate or the motor
will get disconnected from the supply by the Out of Step Relay.

                                       REVIEW QUESTIONS
   1.   Explain in brief the construction and working of a synchronous motor.
   2.   Discuss Manual push button synchronising circuit for a synchronous motor.
   3.   Draw the control scheme for timed semi-automatic synchronising.
   4.   Explain the construction and working of a polarised field frequency relay.
   5.   Discuss starting of synchronous motor using a polarised field frequency relay.
   6.   The speed of a synchronous motor is fixed by
        (a) Stator supply voltage
        (b) Rotor supply voltage
        (c) Frequency of power supply and number of poles in stator
        (d) Starting winding
   7.   To make the synchronous motor self starting a winding is placed.
        (a) in the stator pole faces
        (b) in the rotor pole faces
   8.   A synchronous motor can be used to increase the power factor of an electrical system by:
        (a) increasing the speed
        (b) over exciting the rotor field
        (c) under exciting the rotor field
        (d) applying dc to the rotor field
   9.   Mention the disadvantage of a manual push button operated synchronising starter. Show and
        explain with the help of a schematic diagram how this is overcome in an automatic starter.




dharm
d:N-MachMac7-1.pm5     170
Protection of Motors


   8.1 PROTECTION OF AC MOTORS
Contactors, fuses and over-load relays are used for control of motors upto 150 hp while for
larger high voltage motors circuit breakers along with protective relaying are used. Moulded
Case Circuit Breakers (MCCB) are used for LT (low tension i.e. low voltage) motors of high
ratings. MCCBs are available for range settings upto 800 A. In general two basic protections
are always provided for every motor ;
       (i) Over-load protection.
      (ii) Short-circuit protection.
      In addition to these, protection against unbalanced supply voltages, under voltage, reverse
phase, over temperature, stalling, etc. are provided in motors used in special applications.

   8.2 CO-ORDINATION OF FUSE, OVER-LOAD RELAY AND CONTACTOR/
       CIRCUIT BREAKER OPERATING CHARACTERISTICS
While studying starters for induction motors it has been seen that the fuses and the overload
power contacts are connected in series with the motor supply lines. An over load protective
device provides protection to a motor against carrying sustained over current which may be
due to mechanical over-loading or under voltage supply. Fuses on the other hand, provide
protection against any earth fault or short
                                                                 Fuse characteristic
circuit in the motor winding or at its
terminals. The characteristic of fuse should                                Margin to avoid
be co-ordianted with the starting current of                                operation of the
the motor. An induction motor draws 6 to 7                                  fuse during
times the full load current during starting                                 starting

period and this current approximately
                                                   Current




remains at this high value upto about 80%
of the rated speed. The fuse characteristic
and the starting current characteristic of the                                      Motor starting current
                                                                                    characteristic
motor should be matched as shown in
Fig. 8.1.
       It is clear from Fig. 8.1 that sufficient
margin should be there between the start-                        Time
ing current characteristic and fuse charac-
teristic to avoid blowing of the fuse during        Fig. 8.1 Co-ordination of fuse and motor
                                                               starting current characteristics

                                                  171
172                                                                                  CONTROL OF MACHINES

starting. When starting current of a motor is not known, the following approximations may be
made :

                       Type of Starting                     Motor starting current times the
                                                                  rated load current
                       Direct-on-line                                    6 to 8
                       Star-delta                                       2.5 to 3
                       Auto-transformer                                 2.5 to 4
                       Slip-ring starter                                 1 to 2

       In a starter the breaking capacity of contactor or circuit breaker should be fully exploited.
For this purpose the overload characteristic, which is responsible for switching off the contactor/
circuit breaker, should be co-ordinated with fuse in such a way that for the value of fault
current upto the breaking capacity of contactor/circuit breaker, the circuit breaker should
operate and for current higher than rated value of contactor/circuit breaker, the fuse should
blow. To obtain this co-ordination the characteristic of over-load relay should lie below the
characteristic of the fuse as shown in Fig. 8.2.
       These characteristic should
intersect at a point, preferably above the
breaking current capacity of the contactor/
                                                  IB
circuit breaker. As seen from Fig. 8.2 it is
clear that for any fault current greater than
                                                  IA                                  Capacity of contactor
IA, the operating time for fuse to blow is
                                                  Current




                                                                                      or circuit breaker
smaller than the overload tripping time,
and, for current lower than IA the over-load      IC
tripping time is less than the blowing time                                           Fuse characteristic
of the fuse. For currents smaller than IA,
                                                                                      Over-load
the fuse will however provide back-up                                                 characteristic
protection, that is, it will blow if the over-             t 1 t2    t3  t4
load fails to strip. Referring to Fig. 8.2 it is
                                                                  Time
observed that for current IB  I A fuse
operating time t1  t2 i.e., of the overload          Fig. 8.2 Matching of fuse and overload relay
tripping time and for current IC  IA fuse                 characteristic for motor protection
operating time t4  t3 i.e., of the overload tripping time.

   8.3 OVERLOAD, SHORT CIRCUIT, AND OVER-TEMPERATURE
       PROTECTION
8.3.1 Overload and Short Circuit Protection
Motors are designed to operate under definite temperature rise limitation which depends upon
the class of insulation used. The most serious effect of overload on motor is the temperature
rise of the motor which tends to weaken the insulation and thus shorten its life. The expected
life of insulation is halved for every 10°C rise in temperature above the recommended upper
limit. Temperature rise depends on heating and heating is caused due to one or more of the
following reasons:
         (i) Types of load (continuous or intermittent)
        (ii) Mechanical overloading
       (iii) Reduced line voltage




dharm
d:N-MachMac8-1.pm5    172
PROTECTION OF MOTORS                                                                     173

      (iv) Higher ambient temperature
       (v) Inability of the machine to cool itself.
       All the above reasons do not cause over current. For example, higher ambient temperature
will not cause excessive current to be drawn by the motor but will cause over-heating. It is
therefore clear that protective devices must be designed to trip the motor on the basis of
temperature rather than on the basis of only over-load current. Operation of a circuit breaker
is however an exception to this practice which operates to trip instantly to avoid damaging
effects of a short circuit or a sudden current increase of extremely high value. Moulded Case
Circuit Breakers, now being extensively used in L.T. installations, however, have both the
over load and short circuit tripping facility. In MCCBs, currents greater than 10 times the
rated current are broken instantly by magnetic release while currents less than 10 times are
broken by thermal overload element having inverse time characteristic.
      Although many designs and constructions of overload relays are used in control circuits
for motors, they can however be classified on the basis of two general principles of operation
viz.
       (i) Thermal principle
      (ii) Electromagnetic principle
       In thermal overload relays (this has been explained in details earlier) the temperature
sensitive element such as bimetallic strip of low melting point is used. The relay has inverse
time characteristic i.e., it responds more rapidly to increased current and vice-versa.

                       L1
                       L2
                       L3



                                                                         Supply to
                                                                         control
                                                                         circuit




                                                                         Over-load
                        C.T
                                                                         contact




                                 Star-Delta                          Control
                                   starter                           circuit




                                    M
                                              120 H.P
                                    3~



                       Fig. 8.3 Overload relay connection through CTs for overload
                                   protection of a motor of high rating




dharm
d:N-MachMac8-1.pm5    173
174                                                                                  CONTROL OF MACHINES

       The electromagnetic type of relay operates instantly when over-current reaches some
definite value. Time delay is obtained by using dashpot or magnetic varying assembly. Overload
can be auto reset or hand reset. In hand reset, a knob has to be pressed to reset the relay.
      For larger motors upto 1500 hp, overload relays are connected indirectly through current
transformers, as heat dissipation becomes a problem in higher rating of overload elements.
For example, for a 120 hp motor having a rated current of 170 amps, current tansformer of
200/5 A are connected to an overload relay of 3-6 range. Connection of an overload relay through
current transformers has been shown in Fig. 8.3 in block diagram form.
                                                                   5
       For full load of 170 amps the overload needs to be set at       × 170 = 4.3 A. For this
                                                                  200
overload setting at 4.3 A, the overload would protect the motor for rated current.
      For still larger LT motors, as already explained, MCCBs are used which are available
with thermal settings up 800 A.
      For high voltage motors above 1200 hp, Circuit Breakers along with protective relays
are used as shown in Fig. 8.4.

                       L1
                       L2
                       L3




                                                  Circuit breaker

                                                               Over current
                                                                  relay
                                                                              Earth fault
                            C.T                                                 relay



                                                              Over current
                                                                 relay




                                      M
                                      3~



             Fig. 8.4 Protection of H.T. motor using over current relays and earth fault relay
      In this circuit two over current relays and one earth fault relay have been connected.
Over current relay has instantaneous element as well as inverse time element. Inverse time
element is set at somewhat less than 4 times the rated current of the motor allowing sufficient
time delay so that the motor does not trip during starting.
      Instantaneous element is set so as to pick up at little above the locked rotor current and
provide short circuit protection. The earth fault relay also has instantaneous as well as inverse




dharm
d:N-MachMac8-1.pm5   174
PROTECTION OF MOTORS                                                                      175

time delay elements. Its inverse-time delay element is adjusted to pick up at not more than
about 20% of rated current or about 10% of the maximum available ground fault current
whichever is smaller.
      The instantaneous element should pick up at current ranging from about 2.5 to 10 times
the rated current.
      For larger motors, Percentage Differential Relaying is provided for short circuit
protection. The advantage of this protection is that it provides faster and more sensitive
protection than over current relaying and at the same time it does not operate on starting or
on other transient over currents.
       For continuous rated motors without short time overload ratings, the protective relays
or devices should be adjusted to trip at not more than about 115% of rated motor current. For
motors with 115% short time overload rating, tripping should occur at not more than about
125% of rated motor current. The tripping current should not exceed 140% of rated motor
current even if the motor has high short time overload ratings.
8.3.2 Over Temperature Protection
For over temperature protection a special type of semiconductor device known as thermistor is
used. It is also known as thermistor type overload relay. This makes use of a special
semiconductor resistor, chemically similar to ceramic oxides. The unique property of the material
is that the resistance is comparatively low at normal temperature, remains nearly constant
upto some critical value, and has an extremely large positive temperature co-efficient of
resistance within a narrow range above the critical temperature. Moreover, by varying the
composition of doping of the ceramic disc which is about the size of a small tablet, the critical
range can be controlled to permit selection of the temperature at which protection is required.
Another good feature is that its power carrying capacity is self-limiting since the device has
the tendency to increase its resistance as the temperature rises.
       Since the device is small enough to be placed in direct contact with the motor winding
and has good thermal response, it eliminates the delay factor in transferring heat to the actual
sensing elements. The element is encapsulated in an epoxy resin having compatable thermal,
electrical and mechanical properties and is generally capable of carrying the coil current of
industrial type relays. In the circuit diagram of Fig. 8.5 three thermistors are shown placed at
the surfaces of three stator windings of a motor.
       During starting sufficient current will flow through the CR relay to actuate it as the
temperature and resistance of the thermistors are low. When the START-push button is pressed
the primary winding of control transformer T1 gets energised and therefore the secondary
winding sends direct current to CR relay through diodes D1 and D2. With the closing of CR,
contact CR1 closes and hence coil M gets energised. The three main contacts close and the
motor is energised. Whenever there is excessive motor temperature due to some reason, the
thermistor resistance increases and causes reduction in the current flowing through CR relay
coil. Thus the CR relay drops, which in turn drops contactor M and therefore the motor stops.
      The motor can be started again only when temperature and hence resistance of the
thermistors drop to low values. For this, the relay is adjusted such that its pick up current is
more than twice its drop out current.




dharm
d:N-MachMac8-1.pm5   175
176                                                                                    CONTROL OF MACHINES




                                                                                 Stop



                                                                             Start




                                                                   M

                                                             CR1


                                                                                           T1
                                                              D1                           D2


                                          Motor stator
                                           windings                         CR




                             Thermistor

                   Fig. 8.5 Three phase motor protected by thermistor overload relay

8.3.3 Under Voltage Protection
If the starter of a motor is controlled by a maintained contact control device, the contactor will
drop out when supply fails and will get energised L
again when supply is restored. This type of control
                                                                 DIODE
can be used where the operator is not required to
be near the machine. If, however, an operator is                                   CR2
there on the machine, such unpredictable re-
starting of the motor may cause accident to the                    CR1
                                                      Start
operator.
       Motors are mostly controlled by push but-
tons and spring returned master switches which                               R

provide under voltage protections. Contactors do
not pick up when supply is restored. AC contactors
have a short drop out time. A system disturbance
                                                             Stop
resulting in a voltage dip for a very short time
                                                                            Capacitor
will shut off the motors. In continuous process
industries it is desired that the plant should not                     CR                          M
stop for such small duration of voltage dips. To
achieve this, undervoltage protection as shown           N
in Fig. 8.6 is used.                                          Fig. 8.6 Under voltage protection circuit




dharm
d:N-MachMac8-1.pm5   176
PROTECTION OF MOTORS                                                                         177

      Main contactor M is controlled through normally open contact of under voltage relay
CR. Relay CR is a dc relay fed through a rectifier. A capacitor gets charged to supply voltage.
When power supply fails, capacitor discharges through the CR coil and keeps the relay closed
for some time. If during this period supply is restored contactor M will automatically get
energised due to already closed contact CR2 of relay CR.
      Careful judgement has to be exercised while using this protection scheme. High switching
transients may result in automatic starting of the motor due to the magnetic flux remaining
entrapped, especially in larger motors. It may be understood that undervoltage protection
may not be provided to all motors as simultaneous starting of all motors on restoration of
power supply will result in drawing of high current from the mains which can cause large
voltage drop in the system.
8.3.4 Phase Failure and Phase Reversal Protection
If a fuse blows or a wire carrying supply to a motor breaks while the motor is running, the
motor will continue to run on two healthy phases but will draw higher currents. This is known
as single phasing of a 3-phase motor. The current in the two healthy phases would increase by
1.73 times. This would cause severe overheating of rotor due to negative phase sequence currents
flowing as a result of unbalanced voltages. On the other hand, if two phases of supply to a
three phase induction motor are interchanged the motor will reverse its direction of rotation.
This action is called phase reversal and it can cause injury to people and damage to equipment
in many applications. To protect a motor against these conditions, phase failure and phase
reversal relays are used.
       Many types of design of phase failure and phase reversal relays are available. One type
of relay which provides protection for both phase failure and phase reversal consists of four
magnetic poles the coil of which are excited by the currents of the two stator phases of the
motor. These coils set up a rotating flux which intersects a disc pivoted at the centre. A torque
is produced due to interaction of flux and eddy currents induced in the disc. Torque is made of
two components: A clockwise rotating torque is produced by the normal polyphase supply and
a counter clockwise torque is produced due to the action of the shaded poles.
       When balanced three phase currents are flowing through the windings, clockwise torque
is pre-dominant and it tends to turn the disc in clockwise direction. The turning of the disc,
however, is prevented beyond a certain point when a projection on disc comes to rest against a
stopper. If one line opens the polyphase clockwise torque disappears while counter clockwise
torque due to pole shaders remains and rotates the disc in the counter clockwise direction. The
projection on the disc actuates a contact which is connected in series with the contactor coil. In
case of phase reversal, the polyphase torque helps the counter clockwise torque to turn the
disc and actuate the contact disconnecting the motor from the line.
       Another very common type of relay being used nowadays is based on detecting negative
phase sequence currents during single phasing and during unbalanced voltages. This relay
has two built in current transformers which sense currents of the motor. The secondary of CTs
feeds a negative sequence filter. The output of this filter is proportional to the negative sequence
component of currents. This output is fed to a sensor which detects the level of negative sequence
components of the currents and thus trips the motor starter by opening its control contactor.




dharm
d:N-MachMac8-1.pm5   177
178                                                                                     CONTROL OF MACHINES

   8.4 PROTECTION OF DC MOTORS
Like ac motors, dc motors are also protected against short circuit and overload faults. For
overload protection, the thermal relay used however will have only one element as against
three elements connected in series with the three phases in ac motors. In addition to these
basic protections, field failure protection in shunt motors is provided by a field failure relay.
When a shunt motor is run on variable speed by inserting a rheostat in series with the shunt
field winding, two more protections namely Field Acceleration and Field De-acceleration
protections are also provided. All these three types of field protections are discussed as follows:
8.4.1 Field Failure Protection Circuit for dc Shunt Motors
If the main field of a shunt motor or a compound motor is extremely weakened or if there is
complete loss of main field excitation, a serious damage to motor can occur under certain
conditions of operation. Since the speed of a dc motor is inversely proportional to flux, its speed
tends to rise rapidly when the flux is decreased. If the field failure occurs on a motor which is
coupled to a load, which can neither be removed nor be reduced to a very low value, the residual
flux due to the open field will develop a torque which will not be able to sustain rotation. Thus
the motor will stall, heavy current will be drawn from the mains and the overload relay will
trip. On the other hand if field failure occurs on an unloaded motor or if the application is such
that it permits the motor to be unloaded or overhauled as in the case of a hoist, the motor will
not stall but instead its armature will accelerate quickly to a mechanically dangerous high
speed or there will be destructive commutation. To prevent the above situation of over speeding,
a field failure relay is used. This relay consists of a low voltage coil which is connected in series
with the shunt field. The relay has a normally open (NO) contact which is connected in series
with the main contactor coil circuit as shown in Fig. 8.7.

                       +

                                                                     M3
                                                    Stop


                                      M1                                  Accelerating
                                                                M2        relays and
                                                    Start                 contactors

                                           M
                                           –
                                                      FL1



                                      R1       1A




                                      R2       2A
                                 FL                         M

                       –

                 Fig. 8.7 Circuit diagram for the field failure protection of dc shunt motor




dharm
d:N-MachMac8-1.pm5       178
PROTECTION OF MOTORS                                                                          179

       As seen from Fig. 8.7, the relay coil FL has been connected in series with the shunt
winding. Normally, the relay remains picked up and its contact FL1 in series with the overload
contact remains closed. Whenever the field opens, relay FL drops and its contact FL1 opens to
de-energise main contactor M. Thus the FL relay prevents overload tripping or overspeeding
of the motor, as the case may be.
8.4.2 Field Acceleration Protection Circuit
This protection scheme is provided in shunt motors, where speeds higher than the base speed
(rated speed) are desired to be achieved by inserting resistance in the field winding. For a
motor which is to be operated at speeds higher than the base speed, two difficulties are faced
which are as under:
       (i) If the resistance in field is inserted during starting, field current will be low and,
           therefore, the motor will draw heavy inrush current to produce the required torque
           (as torque developed depends upon fiux and armature current). To minimise the
           inrush current it is therefore desired that the motor should be operated on full field
           strength while it is accelerating i.e., while accelerating resistors are being cut out
           and the speed is increasing. This means, the field regulating resistance should be
           inserted only when the motor has reached the base speed.
      (ii) When the field regulating resistance is inserted, an extremely high armature cur-
           rent is drawn because motor must develop considerable additional torque to speed
           up. This excessive current peak can be avoided if resistance is inserted slowly or in
           multiple steps.
       Both of the above requirements that is (i) short circuiting the field rheostat until the
motor reaches base speed, and (ii) weakening the field slowly above the base speeds are fulfilled
by a field accelerating relay. This relay limits the armature current peaks, prevents tripping of
overloading relay, prevents commutator flash over and makes the motor accelerate smoothly
to the desired higher speed.
       Field acceleration relay FA is constructed with a series exciting coil having an
intermediate tapping. Its contact is provided with magnetic blowout and an arc shield for
efficient arc extinction. Pick-up value of relay is adjusted by varying the air gap between
magnetic core and plunger by a slotted nut. The drop out value can be adjusted by varying the
tension of a spring. The double coil design of the relay not only permits it to pick-up at higher
currents when acceleration proceeds above the base speed but also at low currents when the
motor is accelerating up to base speed with the accelerating resistances in circuit. Figure 8.8
shows the connection of a field accelerating relay in the control circuit.
       In the control diagram shown in Fig. 8.8 it is seen that the tapped exciting coil is connected
in series with the armature circuit. When the motor is started, armature current flows through
all the turns of the accelerating relay and the relay closes its NO contact FA1 across the field
rheostat. Thus the field rheostat is short-circuited during the acceleration period. When
contactor 3A gets energised it short circuits a portion of the field acceleration relay winding in
addition to the accelerating resistance R3. Now FA relay has fewer ampere turns for a given
value of armature current. When the motor reaches base speed and armature current falls to
normal value, the relay will drop and its contact FA1 will open and resistance RA would come
into the field winding circuit. Insertion of rheostat RA in the field winding will accelerate the
motor further and in doing so armature current would rise sufficiently to acturate relay FA.
The rheostat FA would be short circuited second time. The armature current will again decrease
and same action of relay FA will be repeated. The relay may open and close its contact FA1
several times before the motor reaches its final speed.



dharm
d:N-MachMac8-1.pm5   179
180                                                                                           CONTROL OF MACHINES

               +

                                                     M1
                                                                        Stop


                                                                                         Accelerating
                                                                                         relays and
                                                                                         contactors
                                                                                    M2
                                                                        Start
                                                          M


                                                              I.W


                                                              FA
                                          Rheostat
                                Field circuit




                   FA1
                                                     R3            3A
                         RA



                                                     R2            2A

                                                                                M

                                                     R1            1A




                          Fig. 8.8 Field accelerating protection circuit for a dc motor

       The above operation can also be obtained by another type of field acceleration relay
which has a shunt coil of many turns and a series coil of a few turns of heavy copper. The
polarities of coil are additive i.e., their mmfs produce fluxes in the same direction during
acceleration. This relay is used in a circuit which uses delay type contactors for cutting out
acceleration resistance. Connection of this type of relay when used in the starter with delay
type contactors, has been shown in Fig. 8.9.
       In this circuit when the START-push button is pressed contactors 1A, 2A and 3A are
energised, their contacts 1A1, 2A1 and 3A1 open and therefore resistances are inserted in the
armature circuit. Contactor M closes after energisation of contactor 3A by its contact 3A2 and
is held energised through its own contact M1. Energisation of contactor 3A in turn causes
energisation of shunt winding of relay FA. Its contact FA1 opens to insert rheostat RA in the
shunt winding of the motor. As soon as contactor M is energised its contact M3 opens and de-
energises contactor 1A which drops after its pre-set delay. Its contact 1A1 closes and shorts
resistance R1. Interlocking contact of 1A in the circuit of contactor 2A opens and thereby
contactor 2A de-energises after the pre-set delay. When finally contactor 3A drops and cuts off
resistance R3, it also de-energises shunt winding of relay FA due to opening of contact 3A3.
Relay FA thus drops and its contact FA1 opens and rheostat RA gets inserted in the circuit. As
already explained, inrush of current takes place which generates sufficient ampere turns in
the series coil and this causes the relay to pick up and hence rheostat RA is shorted a second




dharm
d:N-MachMac8-1.pm5      180
PROTECTION OF MOTORS                                                                                 181

time. Thus relay FA closes and opens its contact several times before the motor reaches its
final speed.




     Fig. 8.9 Protection for dc shunt motor using field acceleration relay having series and shunt coil

8.4.3 Field Deceleration Protection Circuit
This protection is required when a shunt or a compound motor running at high speed is to be
brought down to a low speed by cutting down field circuit rheostat resistance. When the field
circuit resistance is suddenly cut out or decreased the flux would rise suddenly while the speed
of motor will still remain high. It thus gives rise to high counter emf (cemf is proportional to
flux and speed), induced in the armature which may exceed the impressed supply voltage.
Under such conditions cemf will send back current into the mains and this increase in current
will be so quick that flash over may occur at the commutators. This abnormal condition can be
avoided by using a field deceleration relay which would automatically weaken the field during
the slow down period.
       Field deceleration relay FD is similar in the construction to the field acceleration relay
FA having shunt and series exciting coils. The shunt and series coils are so connected that the
polarities of their mmfs are oppositely directed. The NC contact of the relay is connected across
a separate field deceleration resistor RD as shown in Fig. 8.10.
       To understand the working of the circuit, let us assume that under normal conditions
the motor is running at a higher speed with rheostat RA in series with field, winding. In this
condition deceleration relay FD will get dropped out (as mmfs of two coils cancel each other)
and its contact FD1 will short resistance RD. When the portion of Rheostat resistances RA is
cut out of the circuit to decrease the motor speeds the counter emf becomes more than the




dharm
d:N-MachMac8-1.pm5    181
182                                                                                          CONTROL OF MACHINES

impressed supply voltage and thus armature current flowing through the series winding
suddenly reverses. This causes the mmfs due to shunt and series coils to be additive and
therefore the relay FD picks up and opens its contact FD1 across resistance RD. Insertion of
RD in series with the field winding reduces the field flux and thus the counter emf is brought
down quickly so that normal current flows through the armature. This normal current flow
causes relay FD to drop. Its contact FD1 recloses across resistance RD and the motor settles
down to its reduced speed setting.

               +

                                            M2
                                                                                      M3
                                                                      Stop



                                                                                           Accelerating
                                                    M                            M1        relays and
                                                                  Start                    contactors
                                          FA


               FA1
                                                                      FL1
                              RA

                                   3A          R3




                                   2A          R2
               FD1
                              RD

                                   1A          R1


                        F.L                                                  M
                                        Series                Shunt
                                                        FD
                                         coil                  coil
               –
                                         Field deceleration
                                                relay

                     Fig. 8.10 Circuit diagram showing field failure, field acceleration and
                               field deceleration protection for a dc shunt motor

                                         REVIEW QUESTIONS
   1.   How will you match the fuse characteristic with the starting current characteristic of a motor ?
        Explain with the help of a diagram.
   2.   Explain how the contactor rating, fuse and overload relay characteristic are matched for motor
        protection.
   3.   What are the different possible causes of over heating of a motor ?
   4.   Show how an ordinary overload relay of 2-5 A range can be used for protection of a 150 hp motor.




dharm
d:N-MachMac8-1.pm5      182
PROTECTION OF MOTORS                                                                             183

  5.   Draw protection circuit for a H.T. motor using current relay and earth fault relays.
  6.   What is a thermistor ? Show how it can be used for over-temperature protection of a motor.
  7.   Why under voltage protection is not provided for all motors in industries ?
  8.   Draw under voltage protection circuit for an induction motor.
  9.   Disuss field failure protection circuit of dc shunt motor.
 10.   Disuss field acceleration protection for dc shunt motor using field acceleration relay having two
       coils in series and intermediate tapping.
 11.   Discuss field acceleration protection for dc shunt motor using a relay having series and shunt
       coils.
 12.   When do we require field deceleration protection ? How is this achieved in dc shunt motors ?
 13.   Temperature rise of a motor depends on:
       (a) mechanical overloading                       (b) reduced line voltage
       (c) higher ambient temperature                   (d) all of these.
 14.   When the temperature of motor rises above the prescribed upper limit, the life of its insulation
       is halved for every:
       (a) 5°C rise in temperature                      (b) 10°C rise in temperature
       (c) 15°C rise in temperature                     (d) 20°C rise in temperature.
 15.   As the temperature rise above the critical temperature of a thermostat, its resistance;
       (a) decreases                      (b) increases                 (c) remains constant.
 16.   If one fuse of a motor gets blown during running, the current in the healthy phases will rise to
       ........ times the normal current.
       (a) 1.70                                         (b) 1.73
       (c) 1.75                                         (d) 2.00.




dharm
d:N-MachMac8-1.pm5   183
'
                                                Industrial Control Circuits


   9.1 INTRODUCTION
In industry a control engineer is frequently called upon to design and modify control circuits
as per specified requirements. He is also expected to slove unusual problems occurring in
control circuits. Considerable amount of knowledge and experience is required to accomplish
the above mentioned tasks.
        In modern industry very few machines operate from a single motor. Most of machines
have a number of operations. These operations are controlled by different motors or by a number
of cylinder piston assemblies powered by hydraulic (oil) or pneumatic (air) pressure. The specific
sequence of operations are obtained through relay contacts, timer contacts or through actuation
of sensing devices like limit switches, pressure switches, temperature switches etc. As the
number of components used on a machine increase, the circuit becomes more and more complex.
        This chapter includes study of a number of industrial circuits of varying degrees of
complexity. Most of the machines discussed here are general purpose machines found in most
of the industries. For each circuit discussed, first a brief description about the machine operation
has been given and then the working of its control circuit has been discussed in detail. Working
of complex circuits has been explained in steps. Having thoroughly understood the working of
all the circuits given in this chapter one should be able to read and analyse any industrial
control circuits that he may encounter in practice.

   9.2 PLANER MACHINE
Planer machines (also called a shaper) is one of the basic machines used in all mechanical
workshops. This machine is used for shaping a job/work piece to required dimensions by a
cutting tool. This machine can be of two types, viz.,
       (i) Where the job or the workpiece is fixed and the cutting tool moves to and fro to
           remove the extra material from the job.
      (ii) Where the cutting tool is fixed and the job or the workpiece moves to and fro.
       Here, we will study the second type of machine in which the cutting tool is stationary
and the job fixed on a table (also known as bed) moves to and fro. The to and fro movement of
the bed is achieved by forward and reverse rotation of the motor. Rotational motion of the
motor is converted into longitudinal motion with the help of rack and pinion arrangement.
Rotational motion of the motor is transmitted to the load with the help of an electrically operated
clutch. When the dc coil of this clutch is energised the motor pulley gets coupled to the bed side
pulley. When the coil is de-energised the motor pulley gets decoupled from the bed side pulley
and the bed comes to standstill quickly. The clutch coil is energised along with the motor
                                                184
INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS                                                                      185

irrespective of whether the motor is to run in forward direction or in reverse direction. The
limit of forward and reverse movement of the bed is determined by the positions of two limit
switches as shown in Fig. 9.1. This figure also shows the rack and pinion arrangement for
obtaining to and fro movement of the bed.



                                       Work piece
                                                                     Planing tool
                       Table bed




                                                                   Rack
                       LLS                                                                 RLS
                                                                   Pinion
                   Left limit switch                                                Right limit
                                                                                     switch
                                                Coupled to motor

                                             Motor

                                       Fig. 9.1 Planner machine arrangement
        When bed moves towards right side the work piece placed on table bed is worked upon
by the cutting tool. Forward movement towards the right direction will be stopped due to
actuation of a limit switch RLS. Actuation of this limit switch will also initiate bed movement
in the reverse direction i.e., from right to left direction. Reverse motion of the bed would stop
when the left side limit switch LLS gets actuated, and immediately will start another cycle of
bed movement. It may be understood that the cutting tool works on the job only in forward
movement of the bed. No material is cut from the job in the reverse direction. To start with, the
cutting tool is given a fixed depth of cut. After one cycle of bed movement the tool gets horizontal
feed (i.e., step movement perpendicular to the direction of bed movement) automatically through
mechanical gear arrangment. The starting position for the machine is that the bed should be
in the extreme left position with the limit switch LLS actuated.
       If the bed is stationed in between the two limit switches the machine can be started by
pressing any of the Forward or Reverse-push buttons. The drive for the machine movement is
a 3 phase squirrel cage induction motor which is controlled by a forward/reverse starter. The
forward/reverse starter of this motor is controlled through two limit switches namely, the left
side limit switch LLS and the right side limit switch RLS. These two limit switches restrict the
movement of bed or the motor in either direction. The power circuit of the motor includes
simple connections for forward reverse operation of the motor. In Fig. 9.2 only the control
circuit has been shown.
       Working of the control circuit of Fig. 9.2 is explained as follows:
       (i) As discussed earlier, the pre-condition for starting the machine in Auto mode is that
           the bed should be in extreme left position actuating the limit switch LLS;
      (ii) When the bed is at extreme left position and the limit switch LLS is actuated, nor-
           mally open (NO) contact LLS1 will be closed and normally closed (NC) contact LLS2
           will be open. In this position of the bed the right side limit switch RLS will be in
           unactuated condition, its contact RLS1 being open and RLS2 being closed.




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5     185
186                                                                                             CONTROL OF MACHINES

                               S2
                                    1
                P

                Stop                LLS1

                                                         F1    R1             RLS1        F3     R3
                               S1
                 Start

                                           RLS2                     LLS2

                                                R2                       F2
                                                                                        Clutch
                                                                                         coil
                         S                           F                        R

                N
                    Start relay            Forward contactor        Reverse contactor      Clutch

                                    Fig. 9.2 Control diagram for planner machine
       (iii) Now, when the START-push button is pressed starting relay S gets energised and is
             held through its contact S1. Supply then reaches the control bus through contact S2.
       (iv) With the energisation of control bus contactor F which runs the motor in the right
            (forward) direction will get energised through closed contact LLS1 and normally closed
            contacts RLS2 and R2. Contactor F will now get hold through its own contact F1 since
            LLS1 will open as soon as the bed starts moving in right direction.
        (v) Electrically operated clutch will get engaged as soon as contactor F is energised (the
            clutch coil will get energised through Contact F3). Clutch coil will get energised again
            when the reverse contactor R will be energised, contacts F3 and R3 being connected
            in parallel. DC current is fed to the coil by a rectifier bridge to have a strong mag-
            netic action;
       (vi) When the bed reaches extreme right position limit switch RLS is actuated, its con-
            tact RLS1 closes while RLS2 opens and causes de-energisation of contactor F and
            thus supply to the motor is cut off and the clutch is also disengaged. The bed comes
            to stop quickly.
       (vii) Due to closing of limit switch RLS, contactor R will be energised when contactor F
             drops. Contactor R will get energised through closed contact RLS1 and normally
             closed contacts LLS2 and F2, and will be held through its own contact R1. Its contact
             R3 will energise the clutch coil. Closing of contactor R will therefore cause movement
             of the bed towards the left till left side limits LLS is actuated.
    (viii) When the limit switch LLS is actuated contactor R will get de-energised due to open-
           ing of contact LLS2 while contactor F again will get energised through closed contact
           LLS1 and normally closed contact RLS2 and R2. Thus it is seen that after completing
           one cycle of movement, the bed again starts automatically for the second cycle and so
           on without having any need to press the Cycle START-push button. This to and fro
           motion will continue till the STOP-push button is pressed to de-energise the start
           relay.
       (ix) If the bed stops in between due to power failure, the machine would not start in Auto
            mode when Cycle START-push button is pressed after the supply is restored. This is
            because when both the limit switches LLS and RLS are in de-actuated condition




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5         186
INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS                                                                     187

          their contacts LLS1 and RLS1 are open. Thus neither contactor F nor contactor R
          picks up when the start relay is energised. In this condition to start the machine the
          bed has to be moved to the extreme left or to the extreme right by pressing the
          respective Reverse or Forward push buttons. These push buttons are connected in
          parallel with the limit switch contacts LLS1 and RLS1 as shown in the control dia-
          gram.

   9.3 SKIP HOIST CONTROL
Skip hoist is used in industry for shifting material from floor level to some higher altitude.
Skip hoist consists of a trolley which moves on rails on an inclined plane. On reaching the top
of the incline the trolley tilts and drops the material into a large container called silos. The
material from silos is then utilised as per requirement. Tilting of trolley at the top is done by
mechanical means. The trolley is tilted only upto a particular angle and it remains in that
position for a preset time to allow all the material to fall into silos. After the preset halt at the
top the trolley returns down the incline. See Fig. 9.3.
                                                                              Motor pulley

                                                          Tilted trolley



                                                                                     Up limit
                                                                                     switch
                                          Wire rope

                                                                                     Container
                                                                Mechanical            (Silos)
                                                                  stop
                          Trolley

                                                                                Gate

                     Down
                  limit switch


                                 Fig. 9.3 Schematic representation of a skip hoist

       The hoist is operated by a rope wound on the drum attached to the shaft of an induction
motor. Two limit switches are provided, one for stopping the trolley at bottom of the incline,
and the other at the top of the incline. The motor is stopped quickly by an electromagnetic
brake which is not shown in the figure. Normally, when power is off, the brake remains engaged
and it opens when the motor is energised.
       The movement of trolley in the skip hoist is governed by a 3 phase, 415 volt induction
motor. This induction motor is controlled by two contactors U and D. The power diagram is
similar to Forward/Reverse starter. When contactor U is energised the motor runs in forward
direction and the trolley is pulled up the incline. When contactor D is energised the motor runs
in reverse direction and the trolley moves down in the incline. Thermal overload relay is provided
for the protection of motor.
       The control circuit for the skip hoist has been connected between phase (P) and neutral
(N), as shown in Fig. 9.4. When the START-push button for upward motion is pressed, contactor




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5     187
188                                                                                       CONTROL OF MACHINES

U gets energised through normally closed contact D2 and LSU1 the upper limit switch. As the
U contactor closes the motor runs in forward direction and the trolley is pulled up. When
trolley reaches the top of the rail, its front wheel is stopped at the mechanical stop provided on
the rail while the motor is still pulling the trolley. As a result, the trolley is tilted as shown
through dotted lines in Fig. 9.3. The motor stops when UP limit switch LSU is actuated and its
NC contact LSU1 opens and de-energises contactor U. At the same time normally open contact
LSU2 of the upper limit switch closes and energises time delay relay T. The motor remains off
and the trolley stays tilted for a period, as set on the time delay relay T. This delay is provided
so as to allow all the material in the trolley fall into the silos. When the relay operates, its
contact T1 closes and energises contactor D (responsible for downward motion) through normally
closed contact U2 and normally closed contact LSD1 of the limit switch. As the contactor D
closes, motor runs in the reverse direction and the trolley starts moving in downward direction.
When the trolley reaches the down position, limit switch LSD is actuated and thus its normally
closed contact LSD1 opens and de-energises contactor D.

            P




                                              Stop
                                 V1


                Start up              Ui
                                                     Start    T1            D1    U3         D3
                                                     down


                             D2                                    U2




                       LSU1            LSU2                    LSD1



                                  U            T                        D              B

            N
                                 Up        Time delay               Down           Brake

                                      Fig. 9.4 Control circuit for a skip hoist

       For the next cycle of hoist, the START-push button for up motion is pressed when the
trolley has been filled with material to be taken up. For manual operation of the downward
motion, the DOWN-start push button can be pressed. This push button is necessary for bringing
the trolley to down position in case of power interruption during the downward motion of the
hoist. The brake coils of the motor are controlled by contactor B. The brake opens when brake
coils are energised through closing of contactor B. Contactor B is energised by the normally
open contacts U3 and D3 of Up and Down motion contactors. The brake remains engaged when
both the contactors are in de-energised condition.




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5       188
INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS                                                               189

   9.4 AUTOMATIC CONTROL FOR A WATER PUMP
The control operations discussed in this section are of a water pump which pumps water from
a storage tank into a pressure tank. The pump is allowed to run until the tank is full upto a
certain level. To maintain sufficient pressure in the lines, air pressure is maintained into the
overhead tank above the water level. The physical arrangement of the pump and the two
tanks along with the control components have been shown in Fig. 9.5.

                                                          Solenoid valve
                                                 PS1                        Air supply


                                                                   FS1

                                                   Pressure
                                                     tank
                                                                   FS2


                                                                           Discharge


                                     FS3
                       Storage
                        tank
                                      Pump

                       Fig. 9.5 Schematic arrangement of overhead pressure tank
       Various requirements for the proper functioning of the control circuit are as follows:
       (i) The control operation of pump should be possible either on Manual mode or on Auto
           mode. A three position selector switch may be used for this purpose.
      (ii) It should be possible to control the pump so as to maintain the water level in the
           pressure tank between a high and a low limit.
     (iii) The pump should be prevented from running in case the water level in the storage
           tank falls below a certain level.
      (iv) A certain amount of air pressure on the pressure tank be maintained whenever re-
           quired.
      Brief explanation of the functions of various control components has been provided before
explaining the control circuit.
        Float switch FS1 will actuate when water of the tank would reach its upper most level
H. Under such limiting position the float switch will stop the pump. Float switch FS2 would
sense the lowest level (L) of water in the tank. When this float switch actuates, it would start
the pump to raise the water level upto the upper limit. To let pressurised air enter the tank
above the water level, a solenoid valve has been provided. When the coil is energised the valve
opens and air enters the tank. When sufficient pressure is built up inside the tank, pressure
switch PS1 actuates and supply to solenoid valve is cut off. Float switch FS3 in the storage tank
has been provided to sense a very low level of water. If the water level in the storage tank
would reach a very low level the switch would put off the pump, as otherwise, the pump would
fail to lift water from such a low level. The control circuit using all these components has been
shown in Fig. 9.6.



dharm
d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5    189
190                                                                                      CONTROL OF MACHINES

                 P


                                          4                                    FS1
                        Manual
                                     OFF Auto
                                 1                    FS1                            7
                        Stop                                5                   PS1
                                                      FS3
                                 2                              6                    8


                                         M1          FS2            M2
                       Start

                                 3




                                                                    Solenoil coil     S
                                     M

                 N

                               Fig. 9.6 Control circuit for a pressurised overhead tank
      In this control circuit, lines have been marked as 1, 2, 3 and so on so as to help explaining
the control circuit.
Manual Operation
The pump is run on manual mode when there is some fault in the circuit for automatic operation,
otherwise the pump is normally run in auto mode. To run the pump in manual mode, the
selector switch is put on manual position ‘M’ and line 1 is energised. Contactor M of the pump
motor gets energised and is held through its own contact M1 when the START-push button is
pressed. The operator has to watch and see that when the tank is nearly full, the pump is
stopped by pressing the STOP push button.
Auto Operation
For automatic operation of the pump, the selector switch is put on Auto mode. On Auto mode
of the selector switch, control supply reaches line 6 through normally closed contacts of upper
level float switch of discharge tank FS1 and low level float switch FS3 of the storage tank.
Supply reaches line 6, if contact FS1 and contact FS3 are not actuated i.e., if water is below the
upper most level (H) in pressure tank and above the lowest level in storage tank. Contactor M
gets energised when FS2 is actuated i.e., water level falls below the lowest level (L) in pressure
tank. Contactor M gets energised through the close contact of FS2 and is held through its own
contact. Float switch FS2 then loses control and the pump continues to run even when water
rises above the lower limit (L). When the upper limit float switch FS1 is actuated and its
normally closed NC contact opens to disconnect supply at line 5, contactor M will get de-energised
and the pump would stop. Contactor M is also de-energised if FS3 actuates and opens its
normally closed, NC contact when water level in the storage tank goes below the lowest level.
      From the circuit it is seen that the coil of the solenoid valve is energised when pressure
in the tank is below a certain setting and the normally closed contact PS1 of the pressure




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5       190
INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS                                                                 191

switch is closed. Another condition for allowing the air to enter the tank is that water level
should be above the upper level limit set by float switch FS1. When the water level will fall
below this level, FS1 will open and air supply will be cut off. When the pressure of air inside
the tank increases above the setting, contact PS1 opens to de-energise the solenoid S.

   9.5 LIFTING MAGNET
Lifting magnets have become an essential material handling equipment where iron and steel
are processsed such as in steel mills, foundries, ship operations, scrap yards etc. Lifting magnets
are used for handling every form of steel such as scrap, pellets, pig iron and various kinds of
finished products such as castings and moulds in foundries, wheels, rails, tie plates, ingots,
coiled sheet steel, pipes any type of machine parts.
        A lifting magnet is put to use with the help of over-head crane. A crane which has a
lifting magnet hanging on the hook of its hoist rope is also called a raw material crane. This
crane has got two hoist motors, one is for normal lifting and the other, called auxiliary hoist
motor, is for moving the lifting magnet up and down. Figure 9.7 shows a lifting magnet in
diagrammatic form.


                                                     Hook of
                                                      crane




                                                                Magnet
                             Chain                               cable




                                                                  Lifting
                                                                  magnet

                                      Fig. 9.7 Lifting magnet
      For lifting magnets circular construction is the most popular one as it permits the operator
to handle most types of material without the necessity of positioning the unit accurately with
respect to the load. Rectangular type of magnets on the other hand are particularly used for
handling of regular shapes of iron and steel such as bars, billets, plates, pipes etc.
      Connections to the exciting coil of the magnet is done through a cable which runs along
with the hoist rope. The cable also winds and rewinds over a durm on the crane depending
upon whether the hook moves up or down. In the magnet, the exciting coil is placed over the
central pole so that mmf producing flux penetrates into the work to be lifted.
        The control circuit for energising and de-energising the highly inductive coil circuit of
lifting magnet is discussed as follows:
        For magnets of smaller sizes, Manual drop magnet controllers are used. These are
designed with three position master controller having OFF, LIFT and DROP-points or with
three push buttons. The circuit diagram for this type of a controller is shown in Fig. 9.8 (a).




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5   191
192                                                                                           CONTROL OF MACHINES

                              +

                                   L1                            D2
                                                                           Lift         Drop
                                                                                  OFF
                                                      M
                                                  Magnet
                                                       R
                                                 D3

                                   D1                            L2
                                                                           L             D

                              –

                       Fig. 9.8 (a) Lifting magnet circuit using three position switch
       When the master controller is in OFF position, both contactors L and D are de-energised.
When the lever is brought to LIFT position, contactor L gets energised and closes its contact L1
and L2 to energise the magnet coil. When magnet is to be demagnetised, Master controller
lever is brought to DROP-position which energises contactor D and de-energises contactor L.
Reverse current flows through the magnet coil through contacts D1 and D2 to demagnetise it.
When the lever is brought to OFF position, magnet coil discharges through resistance R through
normally closed contact, D3 of contactor D.
       Automatic Drop Magnet controllers are generally used with larger magnets. These have
two position controllers. In the ON position the magnet is connected to the line and therefore
exciting coil is energised. In the OFF position first the magnet discharges fully and then is
demagnetised of its residual magnetism by a reverse current. The circuit diagram for this
arrangement has been shown in Fig. 9.8 (b).

                       +

                              L1                           R1


                                                           D1         ON       OFF
                                        R3
                                                      D3

                                             D

                                                            L3
                                   a                   b
                                             M
                                         Magnet
                              D2                           L2

                                                                           L
                              R2

                       –

           Fig. 9.8 (b) Control circuit for lifting magnet with atuo-drop using two position switch
       When the master switch is moved to the ON position and contactor L picks up, its two
line contacts L1 and L2 close and a NC contact L3 opens. Current passes through the coil in the



dharm
d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5    192
INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS                                                                 193

direction from a to b. When the load is to be dropped, master switch is moved to the OFF
position, contactor L is de-energised and its contact L1 and L2 open. Opening of L1 and L2
disconnects power supply to the magnet. As soon as power gets disconnected a large voltage
gets induced in the highly inductive circuit that retards current decay. This voltage energises
the contactor D placed across it. Contact D1 and D2 close while D3 opens. The exciting coil of
the magnet discharges its energy back to the mains and current gradually diminshes.
Resistances R1 and R2 are provided in the circuit to limit the discharge current since the
induced voltage in the coil would be very high. The direction of current through the exciting
coil is from a to b. As the induced voltage falls, current will first become zero and then reverse.
Current will flow from b to a and will demagnetise the magnet of its residual magnetism.
When the induced emf of the coil falls sufficiently, the contactor D drops. Its line contacts D1
and D2 open while contact D3 closes. Now the exciting coil of the magnet will discharge its
remaining energy in the resistance R3.

   9.6 CONTROL OF ELECTRICAL OVEN
Electrically heated ovens are used for a wide variety of purpose in industry, e.g., in heat
treatment of metals like annealing and hardening, stoving of enamelled wire, drying and baking
of cores in foundry, drying and baking of pottery etc. Ovens using wire resistance heating
elements can be made to produce temperatures upto 1000°C. Temperatures upto 3000°C can
be obtained by using graphite elements. However, such a high temperature is usually obtained
by some other convenient methods.
        Oven enclosure is constructed by using insulating materials between two metal frames
or by lining fire bricks inside a metal enclosure. The heating elements are mounted on the top
or at the bottom or on the sides, according to the application. An oven can be of batch type or of
continuous type. In a batch type oven, material to be heated is stacked inside the oven and
then the doors are closed. The doors are opened when the heating time is complete. In a
continuous type oven, material to be heated travels slowly through the oven. Continous loading
of material into the oven is made. Material to be heated is placed on trolley which move on
rails placed inside the oven. Trolleys containing material are loaded into oven at the entrance
door while hot material on trolleys are taken out at the exit door. In ovens if heat transfer from
heating elements takes place entirely by radiation then there would be a possibility of
considerable temperature difference in various parts of the object being heated. To obtain
uniform heating of the material, air inside the ovens is circulated by employing blowers. Blowers
pass air over the heating elements and then over the object placed in the oven. In this way a
certain degree of uniformity in heating is obtained. However, the side of the material which
first comes in contact with air flow gets heated up slightly more than on the other sides. This
is because heat is given up by air as it travels pass over the material. More uniform heating
can be obtained by periodically reversing the direction of flow of air. It is difficult to make
actual calculation of the watts or kilowatts electrical power required to heat an object to a
desired temperature in a definite time period. The main problem lies in determining the heat
losses.
       Various losses in a resistance over are
       A = Heat used in raising temperature of oven.
       B = Heat used in raising temperature of container or carrier.
       C = Conduction of heat through walls.
       D = Escape of heat due to opening of the door.




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5   193
194                                                                      CONTROL OF MACHINES

       If W is the heat required to raise the object to required temperature, then the efficiency
of the oven is given by
                                                     W
                                Efficiency =
                                               W + A+B+C+D
       Efficiency of most ovens lies between 60 to 80%. Resistance ovens are operated on low
voltage network of 240 or 415 V supply and they are generally built upto a maximum of 100 kW
rating. Temperature control in ovens is obtained by changing current through the heating
elements. Current through the heating elements is changed by connecting them in different
fashion. Some methods of control of current through the resistance elements are as follows:
        (i) Using variable number of resitance elements: This method tends to give uneven
            temperature in the oven if the elements not in use are not evenly distributed over
            the oven surface. Even distribution of such elements, however, leads to complicated
            wiring.
       (ii) Series parallel and star-delta connection of heater elements: This is the simplest and
            most widely used method of control of current. When this method is used in combi-
            nation with the method mentioned in (i) above, sufficient variations in temperature
            is obtained for most practical purposes.
      In smaller ovens where automatic control of temperature is not required the heater
elements are switched ON and switched OFF with the help of drum switches. In ovens of
higher ratings requiring automatic temperature control, contactors are used to switch ON or
switch OFF the heater elements. Contactors are automatically de-energised by a thermostat
switch when required set temperature is reached. The thermostat controls the temperature of
the oven within a certain range which is determined by the differential setting of thermostat.
For example, if temperature setting and differential setting are 250°C and 20°C respectively
then the temperature of the oven will vary from 250°C to 230°C. The heater will be cut off at
250°C and will be energised again when temperature would fall to 230°C. Series-parallel and
star-delta type of connections of heaters are discussed as follows:
      (a) Series parallel connection of heating elements. It is sometimes required to
reduce the heat in an oven to a low level particularly during the weekend when normal
production is stopped.
      We already know that heat produced in a resistance heating element is proportional to
the square of the voltage applied. Therefore any reduction in applied voltage will greatly reduce
the heat. For example, if voltage of heater element is reduced from 240 to 120 V, the heat
reduction will be reduced to one fourth.
       Half the line voltage can be applied to resistance elements by reconnecting them in
series from parallel connection. When two elements are to be in series they should be of equal
kilowatt rating so that voltage is divided equally between them. Figure 9.9 shows a single
phase circuit for series-parallel connection using a drum switch or a selector switch.
        In Fig. 9.9 two heater elements HE1 and HE2 are controlled through a drum switch.
When the drum switch lever is on right hand side, the heater elements get connected in parallel
due to closing of drum switch contacts A, B, and D. Full supply voltage of 240 V appears across
each of the heater elements. For having a lower temperature, the drum switch lever is shifted
towards the left hand side due to which contacts A and C get closed. The heater elements get
connected in series across the supply voltage. The voltage appearing across each heater element
is halved if they are of equal wattage rating, and heat produced is reduced to one fourth.




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5   194
INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS                                                                                  195
                       L1
                           240 V
                       N



                                                                                       OFF
                                                                        Series                    Parallel

                              A                                                    A
                                                                                   B
                                                            D
                                                                                   C
                                              HE1
                                                                                   D
                              B                                                   Drum switch
                                                                                   contacts


                                              HE2
                              C



                              Fig. 9.9 Series parallel connection using drum switch

      Series-parallel connection of heaters in 3 phase system has been shown in Fig. 9.10. In
a 3 phase system connection of heater elements are controlled by contactors, if automatic
control of temperature is desired. Where automatic temperature control is not desired, drum
switches can be used.

               L1
               L2
               L3
                                                                                             C1




                                   CR2
                                                                             1
                                                                         B
                                                                    1
                                                                A




                                                                                                         A1




                                      T
                        Off
                                                                                       HE
                                                                         HE
                                                                1
                                                                C




                                                                                                    B1




                    Control
                     ON           CR Low High                           B2         HE

                             CR           A         B   C                    A2               C2

                                          (a)                                          (b)

                    Fig. 9.10 Series parallel connection of heaters in a 3-phase system
                                     (a) Control circuit (b) Power circuit

       As in the control diagram of Fig. 9.10 (a), when the control relay CR is ON, through a
selector switch either contactor A or contactors B and C can be energised. When the selector
switch is set for low heat, contactor A is energised through closed contact of thermostat
(temperature controller). Contactor A when energised connects the two heater elements in




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5        195
196                                                                                   CONTROL OF MACHINES

each phase in series. The line voltage thus gets divided across the two elements. When the
selector switch is put on high heat contactor A is de-energised and contactors B and C are
energised. Referring to power diagram it can be seen that closing of contactors B and C results
in the two heater elements of each phase getting connected in parallel across full line voltage.
      When the selector switch is on high heat, the thermostat setting should also be made at
the required higher temperature. Thermostat will control the temperature within a certain
range depending upon the differential setting.
      (b) Star-delta connection of heating elements. Figure 9.11 shows a three phase
connection where the full line voltage gets applied across each heating element connected in
delta when contactor B closes. Heater elements can be switched over into star connection if
instead of contactor B, contactor A gets closed. In star connection the voltage across a heater
element will be V/ 3 times the voltage in delta connection, V being the line voltage. Thus in
star connection the heat will be 33% of that in delta connection.
       A selector switch is to be used to energise contactor A when low heat is required, and
contactor B when high heat is required. The thermostat contact connected in series with the
selector switch has been used to get automatic switching off of contactors so as to maintain the
required temperature.

             L1
             L2
             L3




                               CR2


                                        T                         HE             B3

                                                                        A   A2
                                                                        1
                                       Low      High         B1
                             CR1                                                       HE
                                                                       A3

                                                                   HE             B2
                        CR               A        B

                                        Star     Delta

                             Fig. 9.11 Star-delta connection of heating elements

   9.7 OVERHEAD CRANE
Overhead cranes are used for shifting heavy weights within a limited area. The area is decided
by the span of ‘long travel motion’ and ‘cross travel motion’ of the crane. The wheels of the
crane structure move on rails mounted on concrete pillar or steel towers. Weights in the defined
area of the crane are picked up and shifted to any desired position with the help of three
motions. These motions are hoisting, lowering, long travel i.e., forward/reverse, and cross travel
which is perpendicular to long travel.




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5   196
INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS                                                                                   197

       An over head crane has to handle heavy weights in terms of thousands of kilos requiring
high starting torques in all the motions. This necessitates the use of slip ring induction motors
for causing all the three motions. Figure 9.12 shows a crane in three views.

                              Hoist motor
                                       Cross travel motor           A
                                       Cross travel                               Long travel
               Crane                           Wheels                                           Rail


                                  Rope
                                                Pillars




                       (a) Front elevation                         (b) Side elevation

                                                  Cross travel
                                                    trolley
                                 Pillars
                                  top
                                 Crane                            Rail for cross travel
                                                                  of trolley
                                                                  Rail for long travel




                                                  (c) Plan view

                                             Fig. 9.12 Overhead crane

        As shown in Fig. 9.12 (b), the whole of the crane structure denoted by letter A moves on
the rails for long travel, driven by a slip ring induction motor known as long travel or LT
motor. This motor is installed on the structure itself. The motor rotates the wheel shaft with
the help of sprockets and chain arrangement. On the structure itself are mounted rails for
cross travel (CT) trolley. The CT trolley moves on these rails as it is driven by a cross travel
motor mounted on the trolley itself. The Hoisting motor is also installed on the trolley. Hoisting
is done by a rope wound on the drum attached to the motor shaft. A hook hangs at the bottom
of the rope which is engaged with the weight to be lifted. Winding of the rope on a drum results
in raising of the weight, whereas rewinding of the rope results in its
lowering. The operation of crane is done from a cabin on the crane. Cabin              OFF
is situated on the lower side of the crane in such a way as to allow clear            1 0 1
visibility of the shop floor to the operator. In the cabin are installed            2        2
three master controllers for hoist, long travel, and cross travel.                3            3

       An outer view of a master controller has been shown in Fig. 9.13
       The master controller has three or four steps on each side. At
every step of the master controller, a contact actuates which is used in
the control circuit. Positions 1, 2, 3 of the master controller in one
direction gives three speeds of the motor in one direction. By moving                           Fig. 9.13 Pictorial
the handle in the other direction the motor can be run in the reverse                           view of a master
                                                                                                    controller




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5    197
198                                                                             CONTROL OF MACHINES

direction at three different speeds. An important interlocking arrangement made in crane
control is that the control can be switched ON only when all the master controllers are in the
neutral or OFF position. If this interlocking is not provided accidents can occur due to abrupt
starting of the motor. The motion of the crane either in long travel or in cross travel direction
is restricted by mechanical stoppers, as well as by control limit switches and power limit
switches. Hoist i.e., up down motion is restricted by use of control and power limit switches. In
total six control limit swicthes, two for each type of motion are provided.
      Supply to the crane is given through overhead bus bars known as down shop leads or
DSL. Four bus bars run along the whole length of the long travel below the crane. These bus
bars are supported on pillars or steel towers with the help of porcelain insulators. Three bus
bars are energised by three phases and the fourth is connected to earth. Current is collected
from the bus bars by current collectors which are fitted on a channel on the crane. The
arrangement has been shown in Fig. 9.14.

                                     Leads



                                                   Current collectors



                                                              Bus bars




                                             Frame moves along
                                             with the crane

                       Fig. 9.14 Bus bar arrangement for an over-head travelling crane

       The current collectors slide on the bus bars when the crane moves in the long travel
direction. Three leads of a cable are connected to three current collectors. Supply through the
cable is taken to the control panel on the crane.
       Now, we will discuss the power diagram for the crane. Connections for hoist, LT and CT
motors are basically of forward/reverse starter except for the hoist motor in which an extra
contactor is used for single phasing of the motor for a few seconds during lowering operation.
This is done so as to avoid a sudden jerk on the rope due to the weight when lowering operation
has stared. Single phasing of motor during lowering results in development of less torque, and
since the brake does not open fully, sudden jerk is avoided. The largest motor on the crane is
the hoist motor. For example for a 10 Ton capacity overhead crane the hoist motor is of 30 hp,
the LT motor is of 10 hp, and CT motor is of 5 hp.
      For the sake of simplicity power circuit and control circuit for only the hoist motor have
been shown in Fig. 9.15 and 9.16 respectively. As shown in Fig. 9.15 contactors 1M and 2M are
respectively for raising and lowering motion while 2M′ is for single phasing during lowering
operation. Resistance in the rotor circuit is cut off in steps by contactors 1R, 2R and 3R.




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5      198
INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS                                                                 199




                        Fig. 9.15 Power circuit diagram for an overhead crane

       Before going into the working of the control circuit it is essential to become familiar
with the operation of the master controller. Let us refer to the table for master controller given
in Fig. 9.16. The master controller has got six contacts numbered 0, 1UP, 1DOWN, 2, 3, and 4.
The 0 contact is normally closed (NC) while all other contacts are normally open (NO). Note
the mark X placed in front of any contact denotes its operation. For example, contact 0 operates
and becomes open for all the lever position from 1 to 4 on either side. Contact 1 UP operates
and becomes closed for lever operation towards the right at position 1 of the lever and also
remains operated for further movement of the lever. Contact 1 DOWN operates on position 1
to 4 on the left side. Contact 2 operates on second position of the lever on both sides and also
remains operated for position 3 and 4 on both sides. Contact 3 operates on position 3 of the
lever on both sides and also remains operated on position 4. Contact 4 operates when the lever
is moved to position 4 on either side.
       In the control circuit start relay S gets energised and remains held only when the ‘0’
contacts of all the three Master controllers (Hoist, LT and CT) are in closed position i.e., levers
are in neutral or OFF position. Energisation of relay S activates the control circuit through
contact S2. Detailed working of control circuit has been explained in steps as follows:




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5   199
200                         CONTROL OF MACHINES




                                 Fig. 9.16 Control circuit for an overhead crane




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5   200
INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS                                                                  201

       (1) On moving the controller handle to position 1 on the right for raise operation, contact
           1UP closes. Closing of this contact energises contactor 1M provided the up limit
           switch contact is closed. When contacor 1M closes the motor starts to raise the weight
           up at slow speed as all the resistances R1, R2 and R3 are connected in the rotor
           circuit.
       (2) When 1M is energised, its auxiliary contact 1M3 closes and energises timer 1T. After
           the pre-set time, 1T operates and its delayed contact 1T1 closes in the coil circuit for
           resistance contactor 1R. Contactor 1R however gets energised when the controller is
           brought to position 2, towards right i.e., when the controller contact 2 closes.
           Energisation of 1R cuts off one set of resistance R1 from the rotor circuit and therefore
           the motor accelerates to a higher speed.
       (3) Auxiliary contact 1M1 and 1M2 also opens when contactor 1M gets energised. They
           provide interlocking so as to avoid simultaneous operation of lower motion contactors
           2M and 2M′.
       (4) Energisation of contactor 1R, also leads to energisation of timer, 2T through the
           auxiliary contact 1R1.
       (5) When timer 2T operates, its contact 2T1 would close but contactor 2R will get ener-
           gised only when the controller is brought to position 3. Energisation of 2R cuts off
           another set of resistance R2 from the rotor circuit and therefore the motor acceler-
           ates to third higher speed.
       (6) Energisation of contactor 2R also leads to energisation of timer 3T through the aux-
           iliary contact 2R1.
       (7) When timer 3T operates and the lever of the controller is brought to position 4, the
           resistance contactor 3R gets energised which accelerates the motor to the final speed
           by cutting off the last step or resistance R3 from the motor circuit.
       (8) It may be understood that the timer contacts are used in series with the controller
           contacts to avoid the possibility of bringing the motor to a higher speed directly.
           Even if the operator moves the handle directly from OFF-position to fourth position
           the motor will accelerate to fourth speed in steps because timer 1T, 2T, and 3T will
           provide delays in energisation of contactor 1R, 2R and 3R.
       (9) At the same time it should also be clear that the timers provide only minimum delay
           required between the energisation of contactors 1R, 2R, 3R. The delay between their
           energisation can be increased by the operator. He can run the crane on any desired
           speed by keeping the controller lever on the corresponding position.
     (10) To prevent over hoisting of the motor, an UP-limit switch is provided which de-
          energises contactor 1M. The DOWN-limit switch would de-energise contactor 2M
          when the lower limit is reached. Power limit switch contacts are provided only for
          upper limit. These contacts are connected in two phase leads going to motor termi-
          nals. They work as back up protection and operate only if the control limit switch
          fails to operate.
     (11) For downword motion i.e., for lowering, when the lever of the master controller is
          moved towards the left side position 1, contact 1 DOWN is actuated which energises
          contactor 2M′ through normally closed contact of the DOWN-limit switch. This con-
          tactor connects only two phase supply to the motor. Thus due to single phasing effect
          less torque is developed by the motor and the brake also does not release fully. A
          timer T also gets energised in parallel with contactor 2M′. When the timer T oper-
          ates after a few seconds its contact T1 opens and de-energises contactor 2M′, whereas



dharm
d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5   201
202                                                                            CONTROL OF MACHINES

           contact T2 closes to energise contactor 2M. Energisation of contactor 2M supplies
           three phase power to the motor for lowering operation. This single phasing of motor
           during starting of lowering operation, as already described, prevents a sudden jerk
           on the rope due to the weight hanging on the hook.
       (12) The auxiliary contact 2M3 of contractor 2M starts cutting off the resistance in the
            same sequence as in the case of raising operation, already described.

   9.8 BATTERY TROLLEY
A battery trolley is operated by a small dc series traction motor energised from a 24 V battery
placed on the trolley itself as shown in Fig. 9.17. The seat of the trolley can be lowered or
raised with the help of a hydraulic motor pump and a manually operated hydraulic valve. The
forward and reverse operation of trolley is done by two special push buttons which operate a
set of five finger contacts. Hydraulic pump motor can be started by pressing an ordinary push
button.

                                      Forward and reverse
                                         push buttons



                                                    Battery

                                                                       Weight




                                  Fig. 9.17 Battery operated trolley
       A battery trolley is used in industry to shift any type of weight like finished products,
motors, heavy tools etc., from one place to other in the shop floor. This trolley is, however,
especially useful for transporting racks because its seat can be lowered or raised by hydraulic
pressure. To transport racks the seat of the trolley is to be inserted below the standing rack
and then the seat is to be raised by running the hydraulic motor and operating the hydraulic
valve. When the seat is fully raised it would lift the rack from ground level. The traction motor
can now be run to transport the rack to the desired place. At the destination the seat is lowered,
and when the rack comes back to the ground level, the trolley can be taken out from below the
rack. Before the control and power circuit for a battery trolley is discussed it is essential to get
familiar with the special push buttons used for forward/reverse motion of the trolley. The
operation of special push buttons is explained with the help of Fig. 9.18.
      The normal positions of the contacts, when neither of the push buttons is pressed have
been shown in Fig. 9.18 (a). Figure 9.18 (b) shows the positions of the contacts when the Forward-
push button is pressed. When the Forward-push button is pressed slightly, the strip containing
contact 3 bends. As a result contacts 1′ and 3 get broken and contact 3 and 5 get closed. The
arrangement is such that on further pressing the push button the strip containing contact 4, 5
and 6 bends in the direction shown by dotted lines and as a result contact 6 touches contact 7.
On fully pressing the push button, the strip containing contact 7 also bends and contact 7 and




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5   202
INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS                                                                            203
                 1¢ 3        5                     1¢ 3    5                    1¢ 3    5


                             6     7   8                   6   7      8                 6    7      8




                 1     2     4                     1   2   4                    1   2   4
                Normal contact                    Contact positions             Contact positions
                   position                      when forward push             when forward push
                                                  button is pressed             button is pressed
                           (a)
                                                          (b)                           (c)

                           Fig. 9.18 Operation of special push-buttons for battery trolley
8 touch each other. Thus when the push button is fully pressed, connection is made between
contacts 3-5, 6-7 and 7-8 resulting in making continuity between contacts 3 and 8. It is to be
noted that during pressing of Forward-push button, contacts 1 and 2 continues maintaining
contact with each other. Actuation of finger contacts in three steps by gradually increasing
pressure on the push button is used for obtaining two speeds of the trolley. Figure 9.18 (c)
explains the sequence of contact actuation when the reverse-push button is pressed. When the
Reverse-push button is pressed contact 2 breaks away from contact 1 and gets connected to
contact 4. On further pressing of the push button, contacts 6 and 7 touch each other and when
the push button is fully pressed contacts 7 and 8 also touch each other. Thus finally we have
continuity between contacts 2 and 8. During the process of pressing the Reverse-push button,
contact 1′ and 3 continue to touch each other.
       Forward/reverse push button control of the traction motor has been shown in Fig. 9.19 (a).
Figures 9.19 (b) and (c) show the direction of current through armature and field windings of
the traction motor respectively for forward and reverse motion.
       As shown in Fig. 9.19 (a) a 24 V battery has been used for traction and control. Contactors
A and B have been used for obtaining two speeds of the motor. They are energised from contacts
7 and 8. Resistance R1 is connected in the armature circuit for obtaining a lower speed. When
this resistance is bypassed by contactor B, higher and final speed is obtained. The hydraulic
pump motor and also a dc series motor are controlled by contactor C. A toggle switch SW1 is
used for switching supply to the control circuit. The explanation of control circuit is as follows:
       When the Forward-push button is pressed, strip containing contact 3 bends and touches
contact 5 as shown in Fig. 9.19 (b).
       Due to the actuation of these contacts, current will flow in the series field and the
armature winding as shown by arrows in the figure. Current starts from +ve terminal of the
battery and flows in a clockwise direction through the series field winding and the armature
winding. This current will, however, start flowing when the push button has sufficient pressure
on it and contact 6 and 7 touch other, and contactor A is energised (refer Fig. 9.19). When
contactor A closes its contact A1, the armature gets energised with a resistance R1 in the
circuit. Let the motor run in say forward direction when the Forward-push button is fully
pressed. Contacts 7 and 8 will make contact thus establishing continuity from 3 to 8. This will
energise contactor B. Its contact B1, on closing, would short circuit resistance R1 in the armature
circuit. The motor will therefore run on full speed.
      When the trolley is to be driven in the reverse direction the reverse push button is
pressed. First, contact 2 will touch contact 4. On further pressing when contact 6 touches 7,
contactor A is again energised. Now the current through the series field winding will flow in




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5         203
204                                                                                                                                                   CONTROL OF MACHINES

anticlockwise direction while current through armature winding will continue to flow in the
same direction as shown in Fig. 9.19 (c). The direction of rotation of the motor will thus get
reversed. The sequence of operation of contactors A and B remains the same. When contactor
B is energised the motor would attain final speed in the reverse direction.

                                                                               Battery

                                                        C1                                                                           200 A
                                                                                                 HM                                 HM = Hydraulic
                                              Contactor C                                              Fuse                          pump motor

                                                                                                      A1                   B1
                                                                                            TM                                      TM = Trolley
                                                                           3                                                          motor
                                                                                         Armature
                                                                  1¢            5                                          R
                                     Series field




                                                                                                                           R1
                                                                                      7 8
                                                                           6

                                                                                4
                                                                  1        2                 B


                                                                                             A
                                                                                (a)                        Fuse control
                                                                                                               on

                                                                               HM                                                                          HM
                                                    3       5                                                                       3          5
                                1¢
                                                                                                                            1¢
                 Series field




                                                                                                            Series field




                                                                  7    8                                                                           7   8
                                                        6                                                                                 6


                                1                                                                                               1
                                                    2 4                                                                              2
                                                                                                                                               4


             +                                                                                         +
                                                            (b)                                                                          (c)

                                                                       Fig. 9.19 Control of battery trolley
      The hydraulic pump motor is controlled by a push button which when pressed energises
contactor C. The pump would run as long as the push button is held pressed.
      The seat of the trolley is lowered or raised manually by operating the lever of a valve.
The push button of the pump motor and the lever of the valve have to be pressed simultaneously.
       To ensure proper operation of the trolley the battery should be well maintained. With
proper care and maintenance the life of the battery can be prolonged and trouble free services
ensured. To have continuous working of a trolley for 24 hours, two batteries are sufficient.
When one is being used the other should be kept on charging. At the end of each shift of the
factory the batteries can be interchanged. A discharged battery should be topped with distilled
water and then put on charging. A fully charged battery should give a specific gravity reading
of 1.280 and should never be allowed to discharge below a specific gravity level of 1.140.




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5                 204
INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS                                                                        205

      For details on maintenance of battery the user may refer to the manufacturers handbook
on battery maintenance.

   9.9 BATTERY OPERATED TRUCK
Battery operated truck is used in industry for shifting heavy weight from one place to another
in the shop floor. It is also commonly known as fork lifter as the weight is lifted up on two
forks. These forks can move up and down on an assembly of two vertical shafts and this total
assembly of forks and vertical shafts can be tilted forward and backward as shown in
Fig. 9.20 (a).

                                            Forks UP/DOWN and
                          Driver¢ s
                                            forw/reverse levers
                           seat
             Battery
                                                    Pedal switch
                                                                   Weight to be lifted


                                                          Weight
                                                                                    Bricks or
                                                                                  wooden blocks


                                      (a)                                (b)

     Fig. 9.20 Battery operated truck (a) Pictorial view (b) Weight placed on wooden blocks or bricks

       It may be understood that the forks can be utilised to lift a weight only when the weight
has already been placed on some wooden blocks or bricks as shown in Fig. 9.20 (b). The forks
are first lowered and inserted below the weight and then they are raised to lift the weight.
After lifting the weight, the truck can be taken to desired position by running the traction
motor. If a weight lying on the ground is to be transported with help of the truck the weight
has to be lifted first by an overhead crane or chain pulley block for placing it on the forks.
       Two identical batteries of 36 V each are installed on the truck for control of the traction
motor and the hydraulic pump motor. The truck is run either in the forward direction or in the
reverse direction by a dc compound motor. Forward/reverse direction of rotation is selected
through a selector switch provided on the control desk fixed in front of the driver. A control ON
selector switch is provided on the control desk fixed in front of the driver. Forward/Reverse
selector switch is also provided on this desk.
       The motor runs either in forward or in reverse direction when a pedal switch is pressed
by the foot of the driver. This pedal switch looks similar to the accelerator pedal in a common
four wheel automobiles. Five separate speeds are made possible as the pedal switch is gradually
pressed down. The pedal switch has five micro-switches which operate in sequence when the
pedal is pressed. The pedal switch is spring returned i.e., it comes back to its original position
when the pressure on the pedal is released. Two batteries operate in parallel for the first three
speeds and then in series for the fourth and the fifth speed of the traction motor.
       Raising/lowering or tilting of forks is done with the help of cylinder piston assemblies
which operate on hydraulic oil pressure. Hydraulic oil pressure is generated by a pump driven
by a dc series motor. Hydraulic oil from the pump flow to the cylinder piston assembly through
a manually operated hydraulic valve. Two valves, one for UP/DOWN operation of the forks




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5    205
206                                                                       CONTROL OF MACHINES

and the other for forward/backward movement are provided. The levers for operating these
valves are accessible on the control desk in front of the driver. When any of the levers is
operated, it first actuates a micro switch which gives signal for running the hydraulic pump
motor. The lever also operates the associated valve which allows pressurised oil to flow into
the associated cylinder piston. In the control circuit an interlocking is provided which ensures
that the hydraulic pump motor can only be run when the batteries are in parallel. This means
that the forks cannot be operated when the truck is running on fourth and fifth steps of speed.
      The power circuit diagram for the truck and control circuit have been shown in Fig. 9.21
and 9.22 respectively.
       An explanation of the truck control circuit has been given in steps as follows:
       (1) Pressing the control ON-push button energises control relay C. Through its auxil-
           iary contact, control circuit gets energised while its power contact C in the power
           circuit energises the shunt field winding of the traction motor.
       (2) Initially when the truck is at standstill and the pedal is not pressed, all the contacts
           viz S1 to S5 are in 0-1 position as shown by dotted lines in the control diagram.
       (3) As soon as the control relay C is energised contactor 7C and 9C get energised through
           the pedal switch contact S4. The power contacts of 7C and 9C connect the batteries in
           parallel.
       (4) Forward/Reverse operation of the truck is chosen by selecting For/Rev selector switch
           connected in series with the pedal switch contact S1.
       (5) When the pedal switch is slightly pressed with foot pressure, its contact S1 actuates
           and contact between its terminal 0-2 is made. Depending upon the selection of Forwad/
           Reverse switch, either contactor 1C or contactor 2C gets energised.
       (6) Normally closed (NC) auxiliary contacts of 1C and 2C are used in the coil circuit of
           contactor 3C and 4C. Thus 1C-4C or 2C-3C get energised simultaneously. 1C and 4C
           contactors run the motor in the forward direction while contactors 2C and 3C run
           the motor in the reverse direction. These two alternate pairs of contactors reverse
           the current flow through the armature winding of the traction motor while the direc-
           tion of current through the series field winding Y1 and Y2 remains same in both the
           cases. The motor starts with resistance R1 and R2 in the armature circuit.
       (7) The purpose of providing contactor 3C and 4C along with 1C and 2C is to provide
           braking torque when the pedal switch is released. When the pedal switch is released
           both the contactors 1C and 2C are OFF while the contactors 3C and 4C are ON.
           Power contacts of 3C and 4C shorts the armature of the traction motor through a
           resistance R2. As the control circuit is ON, and the motor shunt field winding is
           energised, the armature of the motor will generate and dissipate energy in the re-
           sistance R2. This generating action would provide a braking torque.
       (8) When the pedal switch is further pressed to actuate its contact S2, contactor 5C gets
           energised. Energisation of 5C cuts off resistance R1, thus the motor accelerates to
           the second higher speed.
       (9) When the pedal switch is further pressed to actuate switch S3 contactor 6C gets
           energised and shorts resistance R2 in the armature circuit. The motor therefore at-
           tains a higher speed i.e., the third higher speed.



dharm
d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5   206
INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS                                                                                                              207



                                              O.L                                                                                   O.L
                                              Y2
                     C
                                              Series field




                                                                                                        36 Volts
                                              Y1                                                                    Pump
                                                                                                                          ARM
                                                                                                                    motor

                                        R1                 5C

                                                                                                                          10C
                                                                                        7C
                                                    1C              3C


                                                                                                        8C          9C
                  Shunt field




                                                               ARM
                                                    Traction
                                                    motor




                                                                                                   36 Volts


                                                          R2
                                                                     6C


                                                    2C                    4C        +




                                            Fig. 9.21 Power circuit for a battery operated truck

                                    C
                 +
                                                                                Pedal switch contacts                          S4
                                              R3
                                                                                                                          1
                                                                                                                               2
                OFF                            S1                         S2             S3                                   S5
                                              2                            1    2        2
                                        1                                           1                                 1 2
                     C                                                                                                Micro
             Control
               on    Forw OFF Rev                                                                                     switch
                                1C                                  2C                                                contact




                                C       1C      2C             3C        4C    5C       6C    7C               9C   10C            8C

                 Control Forw                  Rev         Rev       Forw Resistance          Batteries in Hydraulic Batteries in
                   on                                                       cutting            parallel pump motor series
                                                                           contactor

                                          Fig. 9.22 Control circuit for a battery operated truck




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5                207
208                                                                       CONTROL OF MACHINES

       (10) When pedal switch contact S4 is actuated by increasing pressure on the pedal, its
            contact changes from 0-1 to 0-2. This de-energises contactors 6C, 7C and 9C but at
            the same time energises contactor 8C. De-energisation of contactor 7C and 9C opens
            parallel connections of the batteries while energisation of 8C connects them in se-
            ries. De-energisation of 6C inserts resistance R2 back in the armature circuit. The
            fourth higher speed is obtained as now a potential of 72 volts is connected across the
            armature terminals of the traction motor with resistance R2 in the circuit.
       (11) When the pedal switch is fully pressed and contact S5 gets actuated, it again ener-
            gises contactor 6C through closed contacts of S4 and S5. Energisation of 6C again
            cuts off resistance R2 from the armature circuit and the motor attains its final speed
            with both the batteries in series.
       (12) To avoid direct reversing i.e., to provide antiplugging on higher traction speed, re-
            duced voltage equal to hold on voltage is supplied to contactors 1C or 2C after the
            second microswitch operation. Resistance R3 sends the reduced voltage to 1C or 2C
            after the operation of microswitch S2. If at higher speed the selector switch for FOR/
            REV operation is changed, contactor 1C and 2C would fail to pick up due to the
            availability of a reduced voltage.
       (13) The hydraulic pump motor can be started by operating the lever of the valve which
            actuates a micro-switch. When the micro-switch contact closes contactor 10C is ener-
            gised, which then connects the armature of the motor across the supply. Contactor
            10C can be kept energised till contact S4 remains unactuated. This interlocking is
            provided, as described earlier, to avoid operation of the forks when the truck is run-
            ning on higher speeds.
       (14) Some of the protective devices which are otherwise provided in the control circuit of
            the truck but have not been shown in Fig. 9.22, are:
            (a) An under voltage relay will either cut off supply to control circuit or show an
                indication of low voltage when the battery voltage drops below a ceratin limit.
            (b) A rectifier provided across shunt field of the traction motor to suppress switch-
                ing surges.
            (c) Capacitors provided across the coils of the contactors to suppress switching surges.

   9.10 AIR COMPRESSOR
Air compressor is an equipment which one will find in almost all industries. An air compressor
is used to build up air pressure in a big reservoir for use in the plant. Air pressure in an
industry may be used for various purposes like for cleaning operations, as drive for pressure
operated machines, in L.P.G. burning, in circuit breaker operation, etc.
       A compressor basically consists of a cylinder piston assembly in which reciprocating
motion of the piston is used for building up air pressure. An electrical motor is used as drive for
the compressor. Rotary motion of the motor is converted into reciprocating motion of the piston
through crank-shaft arrangement. There are two valves provided in the compressor cylinder.
They are called suction valve and exhaust valve. When the piston moves away from the suction
valve, the valve opens and air from atmosphere is sucked into the cylinder. At this time the
exhaust valve remains closed. When the piston moves towards the suction valve, this valve
closes while the exhaust valve opens. The air in the cylinder is compressed by the piston
movement and is forced into the reservoir. A non return valve and an unloading valve are
provided in the pipe line connecting the exhaust valve and the reservoir. The non return valve




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5   208
INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS                                                                    209

allows passage of air only in one direction i.e., from the compressor cylinder to the reservoir. It
blocks air flow in the reverse direction i.e., from the reservoir back to the cylinder. The unloading
valve is used to unload the compressor i.e., to connect the cylinder exhaust to the atmosphere.
Most about working of this valve is explained a little later.
         Constant movement of the piston inside the cylinder at high speed will generate a lot of
heat due to friction. To minimise generation of excessive heat and to facilitate smooth movement
of the piston, oil lubrication of the cylinder walls is done. This is accomplished with the help of
an oil lubricating pump. This pump is also driven by the main compressor motor. The pump
lifts oil from the oil pump and feeds it into the cylinder assembly. Oil lubrication is very essential
as, in its absence, the piston will cease due to overheating and thus the compressor will get
damaged. A protection is therefore required to ensure that oil lubrication takes place
continuously. This is made sure by measuring the oil lubrication pressure. If the oil pressure
falls below the set value the compressor motor will trip automatically.
       Heat generated due to movement of the piston is removed from the cylinder by
surrounding it with a water jacket. Cold water is permanently circulated through this jacket
to absorb heat from the cylinder walls. Cold water from a chilling plant is circulated through
the water jacket with the help of a water pump. To ensure that proper cooling is being done a
temperature switch is provided to measure the temperature of the outgoing cooling water. A
flow switch is also provided to ensure that proper flow of cooling water is maintained. If cooling
water flow stops or become slow, the flow switch immediately operates to stop the compressor
motor. The motor also stops if the temperature of the outgoing cooling water rises above the
set value of temperature of the temperature switch. Actuation of the temperature switch would
indicate that either the cooling water from chilling plant is not sufficiently cold to produce
efficient heat conduction from compressor or there is some defect in the compressor.
      In addition to use of an oil lubrication pressure switch, a cooling water flow switch, a
temperature switch and a pressure switch can also be provided in the air reservoir for controlling
the compressor motor. This pressure switch as described below, can be used in two ways to
control the compressor motor :
The Use of Pressure Switch
       (i) May be used to trip the compressor motor when air pressure in the reservoir reaches
           a preset high value. When pressure again falls below the set value, the motor does
           not start automatically but has to be started manually by pressing the ON-push
           button. This is the disadvantage of using this type of control.
      (ii) The pressure switch may also be used to control the motor by unloading the com-
           pressor when pressure in the reservoir reaches the preset high value. When the
           compressor is unloaded, the motor runs on almost no-load drawing a low value of
           current. The compressor can be unloaded by using a solenoid operated valve. When
           pressure switch actuates and closes its contact the solenoid coil of the unloading
           valve is energised. Due to energisation of the coil the valve spool shifts and the ex-
           haust line of the compressor gets connected to atmosphere instead of the reservoir.
           This control, using solenoid operated valve has the advantage that the unloading
           valve can also be used to unload the compressor during the starting period of the
           compressor motor. This avoids high inrush of current which the motor will otherwise
           draw if it is started directly on load i.e., when the compressor exhaust is connected to
           the reservoir. This starting current will be automatically high when air pressure in
           the reservoir is high. The control circuit using a solenoid operated unloading valve is
           shown in Fig. 9.23.



dharm
d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5   209
210                                                                                                                                    CONTROL OF MACHINES

              P
               Stop


                               2P1
               Start
                       C1                  1P                   T              F               2P                       P1
                                                                                                               ON
                       1P1           UL1




                                           pressure switch




                                                                                             pressure switch
                                                             Cooling water


                                                                             Cooling water
                                           Oil lubrication




                                                                                               Air reservoir
                                                              temp switch


                                                                              flow switch
                  T1                                                                                                         1P1   T2   F2 2P2

                  F1



                   C       UL                1P                          T              F                 2P        P
              N
              Compressor Unloading Unloading                        Relays for various Cooling Indication lamps
                motor      relay    solenoid                            switches      water pump
                                      coil

                               Fig. 9.23 Control circuit for a compressor motor
       Unloading and loading of the compressor can also be obtained by using a mechanical
valve which operates due to air pressure only. This valve is also called high pressure valve.
When air pressure in the reservoir reaches a high preset value this high pressure valve operates
to unload the compressor. In this arrangement there is saving of one pressure switch. However,
automatic unloading of the compressor during starting of the motor cannot be obtained by this
valve. To unload the compressor during starting this valve has to be operated manually by the
operator and when the motor reaches its final speed the valve is again operated to load the
compressor. If the operator does not unload the compressor and the pressure in the reservoir is
high, the compressor motor will start against load and its overload relay will trip due to high
inrush current or the fuse may also blow. In addition to the protective devices which stops the
compressor motor during any abnormal motion, ON and OFF-push buttons are also provided
to manually start and stop the compressor.
       In the control circuit diagram of compressor motor in Fig. 9.23, for the sake of simplicity,
the motor has been shown to the controlled by a direct on line starter. In actual practice the
rating of a plant compressor is generally high, and as such star-delta starters are used.
       For better understanding, working of the control circuit has been explained in steps as
follows:
       (1) When it is desired to start pump, first the water pump is to be switched on. This
           pump would draw water from the tank of the chilling plant and circulate through the
           water jacket of the compressor. The flow switch provided to detect the flow of cooling
           water will operate and close its normally open contact. Closing of this contact will
           energise relay F due to which its normally open contact F1 will close in the coil circuit
           of the contactor C, i.e., the contactor connecting supply to the motor of the compres-
           sor.
       (2) For maintaining flow of cooling water, normally closed contact of the cooling water
           temperature switch has been used in the circuit. This contact remains closed as long
           as the temperature of the outgoing water remains below the high preset tempera-
           ture. Through this contact a relay T remains energised and hence its contact T1,
           which is in the circuit of contactor coil C, remains closed.




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5     210
INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS                                                                  211

       (3) Normally open contact of the pressure switch of the reservoir has been used in the
           circuit of relay 2P. When air pressure in the reservoir is less than the preset high
           value, this contact will remain open and therefore relay 2P will be in the de-ener-
           gised condition. A Normally open contact 2P1 of this relay has been used to energise
           the unloading solenoid coil.
       (4) Normally open contact of the coil lubricant pressure switch has been used to ener-
           gise relay 1P. When the compressor motor is at standstill having no oil pressure this
           contact will remain open. Relay 1P will thus be in the de-energised state and its
           contact 1P1 used in the holding circuit of contactor C will remain open. As the oil
           pump is coupled with the main compressor motor, initially the oil pressure is zero.
           When the motor is started and picks up speed, oil pressure also builds up. When the
           desired oil pressure as set on the pressure switch gets built up, the contact of the
           pressure switch closes and energises the relay 1P. Its normally open contact 1P1 has
           been used in parallel with the ON-push button.
       (5) When ON-push button is pressed, main contactor coil C gets energised through closed
           contacts T1 and F1 in series. When the motor picks up speed, oil pump coupled to it
           will also pick up and oil pressure will build up. When the required pressure gets
           built up, contact of the oil lubrication pressure switch closes and therefore relay 1P
           gets energised. Its contact 1P1 which has been connected in parallel with ON-push
           button and in series with holding contact C1 closes and therefore contactor C will
           remain energised through C1 and 1P1. From this it follows that the ON-push button
           is to be kept pressed till the oil pressure builds up to actuate the pressure switch. If
           due to some reason oil pressure does not build up or is not sufficiently high enough to
           actuate the pressure switch, the motor will stop when the ON-push button is re-
           leased. Oil pressure may fail to build up if there is any leakage or if the oil level in
           the sump is low.
       (6) When ON-push button is pressed another normally open contact used in parallel
           with the air reservoir pressure switch will also close. Thus relay UL will get energised
           and its contact UL1 will close to activate the solenoid coil of the unloading valve.
           Thus, during starting, as long as the ON-push button is kept pressed the solenoid
           coil will remain energised and will keep the compressor unloaded. When the push
           button is released, the compressor will get loaded to force air into the reservoir.
       (7) If during normal running, the temperature switch of the compressor cooling water
           operates due to increase in temperature of the outgoing cooling water, the relay T
           will get energised and its contact T1 will open to de-energise contactor C, thus stop-
           ping the motor.
       (8) Similarly if cooling water flow stops due to tripping of the water pump, or for any
           other reason, the flow switch contact will open and contactor F will get de-energised.
           Its contact F1 will open and the motor will stop due to de-energisation of contactor C.
       (9) When air pressure in the reservoir rises to the value set on the reservoir pressure
           switch, the switch will actuate and contact will close to energise relay UL. Energisation
           of the relay, as explained earlier, will energise the solenoid coil of the unloading
           valve. This would lead to unloading of the compressor. The compressor motor would
           run unloaded as long as pressure in the reservoir remains above the set value of the
           pressure switch. The motor in this condition will draw a low current which could be
           only a little higher than its no load current. Due to use of air in the plant, when




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5   211
212                                                                      CONTROL OF MACHINES

          pressure of air would fall below the preset value, the pressure switch will get
          deactuated and the solenoid coil will also get de-energised. The spool of the unload-
          ing valve will shift again to load the compressor. Air will again be compressed and
          get forced into the reservoir.

   9.11 WALKING BEAM
A walking beam, with the help of hydraulic pressure, is made to move in directions in the
following sequence: Upward-Forward-Downward-Reverse so as to return to its original position.
       A walking beam is operated in these four directions with the help of four cylinder-piston
assemblies. The piston moves due to the pressurised oil fed into the cylinder by a hydraulic
pump which lifts oil from an oil tank. Pressurised oil from the pump is fed to the cylinder
piston assemblies by a two position single solenoid valve and a spring returned solenoid valve.
Four solenoid valves, one for each motion have been provided. A loading solenoid valve is also
provided to load the pump when required. The pump motor runs continuously, however the
pump gets loaded only when the loading solenoid valve is energised. Normally, this solenoid
valve remains off and keeps the pump unloaded by relieving the oil picked up by the pump
back to the tank. When any operation is desired, the loading solenoid valve is energised along
with solenoid valve for one of the motions and this diverts the pressured oil to the required
cylinder through that particular solenoid valve.
       Walking beam is used in industry to transfer material on to a moving conveyor. The
particular application that we will be discussing, is one where the beam is used to transfer
automobile leaf springs to a conveyer. In this particular industry the conveyor takes a number
of leaf springs into the annealing furnace. The conveyor belt is made of special metal and
therefore does not get damaged due to heat of the furnace. The conveyor moves at a very low
speed through the furnace thus annealing the leaf springs placed over it. The leaf springs are
dropped into a quenching (cooling) medium on the other side of the conveyor. As the annealed
springs are dropped into the quenching medium, new leaf springs are loaded on the front side
of the conveyor continously by the walking beam.
       The benefit of loading leaf springs on to the conveyor with the help of a walking beam is
that the operator remains at a distance from the direct heat of the furnace. Operation of the
walking beam has been ilustrated in Fig. 9.24.
        In the top view of the walking beam as in Fig. 9.24 (a), the beam has been shown in fully
down but in reversed position. Leaf springs are placed on the walls on either side of the beam
by the operator. On being loaded the beam will move up therby lifting the leaf springs from the
walls. When the up limit switch LS1 is actuated (refer Fig. 9.24 (c)) the beam then moves in the
forward direction towards right as shown by the arrow. When the forward limit switch LS2 is
actuated the beam will move down, and the limit switch LS3 will get actuated. While moving
down the beam will place the leaf springs on to the conveyor. This is shown in Fig. 9.24 (b). A
slot is specially cut in the conveyor to enable the beam to place the leaf springs on it. When the
beam is fully down and the Down limit switch LS3 actuates, the beam moves in the reverse
direction. It stops when the reverse limit switch LS4 gets actuated. The beam thus returns to
its starting point. In automatic operation, the beam rests at this position for some time to
enable the operator to place new leaf springs on the walls. The beam then again moves up to
deliver the leaf springs on to the conveyor. Figure 9.24 (c) shows the side view of the beam
movement and the location of the limit switches.




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5   212
INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS                                                                 213
                                                         Leaf spring
                                                                             Annealing
                                                            Walking           furnace
                                                             beam

                       Walking beam




                                                                  Conveyor
                                                  (a)
                                                                               (b)
                                            LS1            Forward
                                                                              LS2


                                      UP                                             DOWN



                                        LS4
                                                  Beam                        LS3
                                                           Reverse
                                                                (c)

                Fig. 9.24 Movement of a walking beam (a) and (b) Top view (c) Side view
       The control circuit for the walking beam has been shown in Fig. 9.25. This control circuit
diagram has been represented as an actual drawing used in industry. At the top of the control
circuit is shown the arrangement of the limit switches, push button legend, and legend of the
solenoid valves. These have to be referred to while studying the control circuit drawing. Each
vertical line in the control diagram is represented by a number at the top. At the bottom of
each contactor, a table shows the line numbers in which the NO and NC contact of the contactor
have been used. This information becomes useful in reading control circuit drawing, when a
write up (explanation) for the circuit is not available Contactors U, F, D  R are respectively
meant for the upward, forward, downward and reverse motion of the walking beam. The solenoid
valves SV1, SV2, SV3, SV4 respectively are energised through the normally open contacts U5,
F5, D5 and R5. The loading solenoid valve SV5 also gets energised when any of the contactors,
U, F, D or R is energised. Contactor A is for auto selection and contactor AS is for auto start.
An ON-delay timer T has been used for allowing rest time for the beam at LS4 position in the
auto cycle. Starter for the pump motor has not been shown in the diagram for sake of simplicity.
The control circuit is energised through the starter contact M connected in series with the
selection switch. The walking beam has three modes of operation viz Manual, Reset and Auto,
selection for any mode is done by the selector switch SW. Selection on any mode energises the
respective control bus designated as L-A (Auto) L-M (Manual) and L-R (Reset). The walking
beam cycle can be started in auto or manual mode only if the beam is at any extreme end
position and actuates a limit switch. To bring the beam from any in-between position to the
extreme end positions, reset mode is provided. The operation of the walking beam in three
different modes i.e. in Manual mode, Reset-mode and Auto-mode are discussed as follows:
(a) Manual mode of operation of the walking beam
       (1) When the selector switch SW is turned to manual mode the control bus L-M
           is energised. If the beam is at its starting point and the limit switch LS4 is actuated,
           contactor B also gets energised through the close contact of LS4. Thus when the
           contactor B is closed, its contact B1 in line 2 gets closed and contact B2 in line 14
           becomes open.




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5                  213
214                         CONTROL OF MACHINES




                                   Fig. 9.25 Control circuit for a walking beam




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5   214
INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS                                                               215

       (2) When the beam UP-push button b1 is pressed, up contactor U is energised through
           closed contacts B1, b1, A1, D2 and LS1. Energisation of contactor U will cause opera-
           tion of loading solenoid valve SV5 and also up solenoid valve SV1 through contacts U5
           and U6 and therefore the beam will start moving up.
       (3) Contactor U gets hold through its contact U1 before the opening of contact B1 as a
           result of de-energisation of contactor B. Contactor B gets de-energised due to open-
           ing of contact LS4 in line 20 when the beam moves in the upward direction.
       (4) When the beam reaches its upper limit, limit switch LS1 is actuated. Its NC contact
           opens and de-energises contactor U. De-energisation of contactor U stops movement
           of the beam in the upward direction due to de-energisation of solenoid valves.
       (5) Acutation of limit switch LS1 also closes its NO contact in line 5 and thus supply
           reaches the Forward-push button b2.
       (6) When Forward-push button b2 is pressed contactor F gets energised through close
           contacts LS1, b2, A2, R2, and LS2 in line No.5. Energisation of contactor F also helps
           energistaion of the respective solenoids through its contacts F5 and F6. The beam
           moves in the forward direction till limit swtich LS2 is actuated.
       (7) On actuation of LS2 forward contactor F is de-energised and the beam movement in
           forward direction stops while supply reaches Down-push button b3 through the closed
           contact of LS2 in line-8.
       (8) The beam can be run in down motion by pressing push button b3. When the limit
           switch LS3 is actuated, the beam can be run in reverse direction by pressing its push
           button b4. Limit switch LS4, when actuated stops the reverse motion of the beam.
          This way one cycle of beam movemnt is completed. In practice, the beam is not run in
          this fashion. It is run mostly in auto operation. The manual push button b1 to b4 are
          mostly utilized only to reset the beam if it stops inbetween due to power failure.
(b) Reset mode of operation of walking beam. Reset mode is required to reset the beam
since neither the manual nor the auto cycle can be started if the beam positon is such that no
limit switch gets actuated. The beam will stop in any intermediate position during its travel
cycle if there is power failure. On restoration of power the beam cannot be made to run in
manual or auto mode from such intermediate position. For example let us examine the case
when the beam has stopped while moving in forward direction due to power failure. In such a
case, both the limit switches LS1 and LS2 are in deactuated condition. The beam cannot be run
in forward direction as contact of LS1 in line 5 is open and hence supply does not reach upto
push button b2. To make the push button effective the beam should be reversed to actuate LS1
or alternately the beam should be taken to fully forward condition to actuate LS2 so that
operating cylcle can be started for downward motion. The beam is reset to actuate LS1 or LS2
with the help of reset-push button b6.
       When the beam is to be reset, first the selector switch SW is put on reset mode, This will
energise the reset control bus L-R. Now b6 is pressed which energises contactor C. Its contact
C5 closes and energises the manual control bus L-M. Also the control contacts C1,C2,C3 and C4
close to bypass the contact B1 and normally open contacts of LS1, LS2 and LS3.Thus supply
reaches at all the push buttons from b1 to b4. The required push button can now be pressed
along with b6 to complete the beam movement in a particular direction. Push button b6 is
released when the beam reaches the required limit and the concerned limit switch has actuated.
Then the selector switch is returned back to Manual or Auto mode as per requirements.




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5   215
216                                                                        CONTROL OF MACHINES

(c) Auto mode of operation of the walking beam
        (1) When selector switch is placed in Auto made, control bus L-A is energised and con-
            tactor A picks up. Its normally open contact A6 closes and energises the manual line
            L-M. Its NO contact A5 also closes to make the Auto start push button b5 effective. Its
            NC contacts A1 to A4 open to make the push button b1 to b4 ineffective during auto
            operation.
        (2) Let us start the walking beam in auto from the starting point i.e., when beam is
            down in fully reversed position. In this position limit switch LS4 will be actuated and
            its contact in line No. 20 will close to energise contactor B.
        (3) When auto start push button b5 is pressed, auto start contactor AS gets energised
            and closes its contact AS1. Contactor U gets energised through closed contacts B1,
            AS1, D2 and closed contact of LS1. Contactor U is held through its own contact U1.
        (4) In auto cycle, during starting, the push button b5 in line 13 has to be kept pressed till
            LS4 is de-actuated due to the movement of the beam in the upward direction. This is
            so desired because auto start contactor AS will hold only when contactor B is de-
            energised due to de-actuation of limit switch LS4. When B is de-energised contactor
            AS is held through contacts AS5 and B2.
        (5) When the beam reaches up and LS1 is actuated its NC contact opens and de-ener-
            gises contactor U. At the same time its NO contact closes in line 5 to energise forward
            contactor F. Contactor F gets energised through closed contactor LS1, AS2 and NC
            contact of LS2.
        (6) When the beam is fully forward, LS2 gets actuated, it de-energises contactor F and
            energises contactor D for downward motion in a simillar fashion.
        (7) When Down-limit switch LS3 gets actuated, it de-energises contactor D and ener-
            gises contactor R for reverse motion of the beam. At the same time a timer T is also
            energised through the contact R3. Timer T is held through the instantaneous con-
            tacts T2. The timer is of 3 minutes duration.
        (8) When the beam is fully reversed, limit switch LS4 gets actuated. Its NO contact
            closes in line 20 to energise contactor B. Contact B2 thus opens and de-energises
            auto start contactor AS.
        (9) The beam now does not start in upward direction due to opening of contact AS1, as
            AS is de-energised.
       (10) When timer T operates after the pre-set time delay, its delayed contact T1 closes and
            energises contactor AS. Timer T decides the time for which the beam should rest at
            the location of LS4 required for loading of leaf springs on the beam.
       (11) Energisation of AS through timer contact will again start the beam in upward direc-
            tion as contactor U will get energised through closed contacts B1, AS1, D2 and LS1.
       (12) As the beam moves up, LS4 is de-actuated and contactor B gets de-energised. The
            holding circuit for AS also gets completed through contacts AS5 and B2 in addition to
            the timer contact circuit.
       (13) Timer T resets when the beam starts moving in forward direction due to opening of
            contact F3. Its contact T1 will open but the contactor AS will continue to remain
            energised through its own holding circuit.




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5    216
INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS                                                                                 217

   9.12 CONVEYOR SYSTEM
In large plants, materials are shifted from the place                                Belt
of storage to near the machines for processing,
through belt conveyors. Finished products from the             Drive                                         Tail
machines are also carried away through conveyors.              pulley                                        pulley
Infact, any heavy material can be transported by                                    (Side view)
conveyors. For example in airports, luggage of
passengers is transferred through belt conveyors.
The drive for such belt conveyors is an electric
motor. A conveyor consists of a rubber belt about                                                 Belt
                                                                              Motor
3/4 to 1 metre wide tightly fitted over two pulleys                                               conveyor
                                                                              Gear box
as shown in Fig. 9.26.
       One pulley is coupled to the motor through
a gear box as the belt is required to move at a slower                  (Top view)
speed as compared to the motor speed. The pulley         Fig. 9.26 Top and side view of a conveyor
which is coupled with the motor is shown as drive
pulley while the other pulley is called the tail pulley. As the belt is fitted tightly over the two
pulleys, rotation of the drive pulley will cause movement of the belt over the two pulleys. A
number of such conveyors may be used to shift material from one place to the other at different
heights. The number of conveyors in a system can be very large depending upon the requirement.
One example of a small conveyor system with 5 conveyors has been shown in Fig. 9.27. In this
system the final product from plant is first stored in silos (large containers) with the help of
conveyors.
       As shown in Fig. 9.27, conveyors 1 and 2 feed material into silos, 1 and 2. Diverters are
provided on conveyor 2. When diverter 1 is down, material will fall in silos 1 and when diverter
1 is up and diverter 2 is down material will fall in silos 2. When both the silos are filled,
proximity switches provided in silos will actuate and stop conveyors 1 and 2. Finished product
from silos can be taken out through gates on to conveyor 2 and taken to packaging machine
through conveyors 3, 4 and 5.

                                        Diverter 1
                                                     Diverter 2

               Conv 1
                                                              Conv 2



                        Silo (1)                       Silo (2)




                               Conv 3
                                                     Conv 4

                                                                           Conv 5
                                                                        Packaging
                                                                        machine


                          Fig. 9.27 Schematic arrangement of a conveyor system




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5     217
218                                                                                            CONTROL OF MACHINES

       Conveyor motors are started in sequence one after the other. One major reason for
sequence starting of conveyors is to avoid high inrush current during simultaneous starting of
motors. If all the motors in a conveyor system are started simultaneously the current drawn
from supply will be the sum of inrush current of all the individual motors. This current obviously
will be very high as it is known that inrush current of an induction motor is 6 to 7 times its
rated current. Another reason for sequence starting could be the process requirements. In
some applications stopping of conveyors may also be required to take place in a particular
sequence. For example in the conveyor system just discussed, it is desirable that conveyors 3,
4 and 5 should stop in sequence and further, conveyor 4 and 5 should stop after a successive
gap of 30 seconds each. This is required to enable material lying on belts get emptied into the
packaging machine before the conveyors stop.
      Conveyor motors can be started in sequence by using auxiliary contact interlocking, if
no time gap is required between starting of two conveyors. However, if time gap is required
between successive starting of motors then timers have to be used. Control circuit using auxiliary
contact interlocking and timers for sequence starting of motors has been shown in Fig. 9.28.

                         P

                                    Stop



                       Start
                                        1C1           1T         2C1           2T         3C1
                       cycle




                                           2C2                      3C2


                                   1C            1T         2C            2T         3C

                         N
                               Conv 1                      Conv 2                   Conv 3

                          Fig. 9.28 Control circuit for sequence starting using timers
       In this control circuit, it is seen that to start three motors in sequence with a time gap,
two timers are needed, thus if the number of motors to be started are more, say 10, then we
will require nine timers. Such circuit will obviously be very costly. In practice there are many
appliactions where the conveyor system consists of a large number of conveyors. To economise
on expenditure for such control systems a special timer, known as cam timer, is used to start
conveyors in sequence. Cam timers have already been discussed in chapter 2. In a cam timer,
there is a small synchronous motor which rotates a shaft. On the shaft are mounted plastic
cams which actuate there respective contacts at particular instant of time during the rotation
of the shaft. A conveyor system which uses cam timers is discussed as follows:
       Sequence starting of three conveyors in manual and auto mode is explained. Only three
conveyors have been taken for sake of simplicity although in practice the number may go upto
fifteen or so. In this conveyor system there is provision to start the conveyor in auto cycle
through cam timer or through manual operations. In manual operation there is a provision to
start individual motors in sequence either from the control panel or with the help of push




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5         218
INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS                                                                219

buttons provided by the side of the respective motors. It may be understood that control panels
for conveyor systems are located at a suitable enclosed place preferably in a room away from
the conveyor system where dust and dirt of plant can not enter the panel. This centralised
control panel of a number of conveyor motors is also known as Motor Control Centre or MCC.
      A general safety precaution employed in all conveyor systems is that before starting of
conveyors a hooter is sounded for about 60 secs or so to alarm the workers that the conveyor
system is going to be started. This alarm is meant to inform that if any body is near the
conveyor or working on them he should get aside. If somebody is working on the conveyor and
conveyor is not in working condition or disassembled, the site emergency push button can be
pressed which will not allow the conveyors to start. Control circuit having all the functions
discussed above is shown in Fig. 9.29. An Auto/Manual selector switch is used to select conveyor
system operation either in auto mode or in manual mode.
      (a) Manual mode of operation
       (1) When the selector switch is placed on manual mode, relay M will get energised. Its
           contact M1 will close and energise the manual bus. Normally closed contacts of con-
           tactor M i.e., M2 M3 and M4 will open and thus will isolate the cam-timer contacts
           from the circuit during manual operation.
       (2) In manual mode, conveyor 1 can be started by pressing panel ON-push button or site
           ON-push button which is provided near the motor. These push buttons are connected
           in parallel. When any of these ON-push buttons is pressed, contactor 1C will get
           energised and will remain energised through its auxiliary contact 1C1. Now supply
           to the coil of contactor 1C reaches through the contact of the OFF-push button of the
           panel, auxiliary contact A4, auxiliary contact 1C1, and the site OFF-push button on
           conveyor 1.
       (3) When contactor 1C is energised its auxiliary contact 1C2 in the coil circuit of contac-
           tor 2C also closes thus providing an interlocking, where conveyor 2 can only be started
           if conveyor 1 is running.
       (4) Now, conveyor 2 can also be similarly started by pressing its ON-push button. After
           starting of conveyor 2, conveyor 3 can also be started by pressing its ON-push but-
           ton.
       (5) Any conveyor can be stopped by pressing its panel or site OFF-push button. The
           following conveyor will also stop due to interlocking. Over-load tripping of any con-
           veyor will also result in stoppage of the conveyors following it.
       (b) Auto mode of operation. Before the working of the circuit in auto mode is dis-
           cussed it is essential to get familiar with the operation of cam timer used for this
           circuit. The cam timer used has four contacts as shown in Fig. 9.30.
        As shown in Fig. 9.30, normally open (NO) contacts of contact block CT1, CT2 and CT3
have been used while normally closed (NC) contact of CT4 has been used. The starting position
of the cam timer will always be the same as shown in Fig. 9.30. Observe the protruding portions
of the cams. In the starting position shown, it is clear that contact block CT4 is in actuated
position as its knob is pressed by the protruding portion of cam 4. Thus it is clear that during
starting, position of cam timer contact CT4, will be open as this contact block is actuated. This
contact will remain open as long as the protruding portion of cam 4 pushes the knob of the
contact block. For any other position of cam 4 i.e., throughout 360° of cam rotation, contact
block CT4 will remain deactuated and thus its contact CT4 will remain closed. This point has to
be kept in mind while studying the control circuit for auto operation. The other contacts CT1,




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5   219
220                         CONTROL OF MACHINES




                                      Fig. 9.29 Control circuit for a conveyor system




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5   220
INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS                                                                221

CT2, CT3, will close when their contact blocks are actuated by protruding portions of their
respective cams 1, 2 and 3 during rotation of the timer shaft in anticlockwise direction as
shown in the figure.




                              Fig. 9.30 A cam timer with four contacts
       The working of the control circuit is explained below in steps:
       (1) When selector switch is in Auto mode, Auto relay A will get energised on pressing
           the Auto ON-push button. Due to energisation of relay A, Auto bus is also energised
           through closing of contact A3. Normally closed (NC) contacts A4, A5, A6 will open to
           isolate manual ON and OFF push buttons from the circuit.
       (2) When the START cycle push button is pressed, its both contacts a and b will close.
           Closing of contact ‘a’ will energise timer T and also hooter H through delayed NC
           contact T2 of the timer. Timer T gets hold through its instantaneous contact T1. The
           setting of the timer is kept at about 60 secs to warn the workers that conveyors are
           going to be started. When timer operates after preset time, its contact T2 opens to de-
           energise the hooter while its contact T3 will close.
       (3) When contact T3 of timer closes, cam timer motor CT will get energised if contact ‘b’
           of the START cycle push button is still closed. This means that START cycle push
           button has to be kept pressed during starting for more than the time setting of the
           timer, so that energisation of cam timer motor is possible. As the motor starts rotat-
           ing in the direction shown, immediately the contact block CT4 will deactuate and its
           contact CT4 will close i.e., it will come back to its normal position. As soon as this
           happens, START cycle push button can be released. Now cam timer motor CT will
           remain energised through its own contact CT4 till cam 4 rotates through 360° to
           again actuate contact CT4.
       (4) When cam timer shaft rotates by 90° from its initial position, contact block CT1 will
           be actuated by cam 1 and contact CT1 will close. Contactor 1C for conveyor 1 will get
           energised through this contact and will get hold through its own contact 1C1. As the
           protruding portion of cam 1 moves past contact block CT1, contact CT1 open but
           contactor 1C will remain energised by getting supply through its contact 1C1.
       (5) When timer shaft rotates by 180°, protruding portion of cam 2 will actuate contact
           block CT2. Its contact will close and energise contactor 2C. When protruding portion
           of cam 2 moves past the contact, contractor 2C will remain enrgised rotation its own
           contact 2C1.
       (6) Similarly contactor 3C for conveyor 3 will get energised when after 270° rotation, cam
           3 actuates contact block CT3.



dharm
d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5   221
222                                                                           CONTROL OF MACHINES

       (7) When the shaft has rotated by full 360° i.e., when it comes back to its starting point,
           contact block CT4 will get actuated to open its normally closed (NC) contact CT4.
           This will de-energise cam timer motor CT and hence the cam timer will stop at this
           point. Cam timer motor CT will remain de-energised till it is again energised by
           pressing the START cycle push button.
       (8) If auto STOP-push button or Emergency STOP-push button of any conveyor is pressed,
           all the conveyors will stop immediately due to de-energisation of relay A. De-
           energisation of A will switch off the auto bus due to opening of relay contact A3.
       (9) When any site OFF-push button of a conveyor is pressed, then that particular conveyor
           and the conveyors following it will stop while the conveyor preceding it will continue
           to run. For example, if site OFF-push button of conveyor 2 is pressed, conveyor 2 and
           conveyor 3 will stop while conveyor 1 will continue to run. Similarly, tripping of over
           load relay of any of the conveyors will also trip the conveyors following it.

   9.13 ELEVATOR
Elevators or lifts are used in multistoried buildings for carrying passengers from one floor
level to another at a fast speed. The cage in which passengers travel (also known as car)
travels vertically, guided by four rails in the hoist-way. There are doors at each floor through
which passangers can enter into or come out of the car. These doors are also referred to as hall
gates. There is a gate in the car which should open only when the car is stationary in front of
any of the hall gates. All these gates are of collapsable type. The gates may be hand operated
or servo motor operated. A lift can not be operated if any of the hall gates or the car gate is
open.
       The car is suspended in the hoist way by one end of a wire rope which is wound on a
drum at the top of the hoist way. On the other end of the rope a counter weight, whose weight
is generally 60% more than the weight of the empty car, is suspended. The wire wound drum
is coupled to a motor through gears for achieving the required speed. Rotation of drum in one
direction will lift the car up while the counter weight will go down. When the drum rotates in
the reverse direction, the opposite will follow. Motor drum and control panel for the lift are
situated at the top of the hoist way i.e., on the top most ceiling of the building.
      Motors, nowdays being used for lifts are 3 phase induction motors instead of dc motors
used earlier.
       Lifts can be of a single speed type or double speed type. Double speed lifts are faster
than single speed ones. Double speed lifts run at lower speeds near starting and stopping and
at faster speeds during free running.
       In both the types of lifts, a set of electromechanical brakes are provided to stop the car
exactly at the floor level. Normally, the brake remains engaged but opens when the motor gets
the start command. The details of a single speed lift are discussed as follows:
        Control of a lift is obtained through a set of push buttons and limit switches. A set of
push buttons (equal to the numbers of floor levels in the building) enable the operator to take
the car to the required floor level. One push button is also provided near each hall gate for
calling the lift to that particular floor. If the lift is idle at some floor level and its door is closed
the lift can be brought to the required floor level by pressing the Hall gate-push button. When
the lift gate is open, pressing of any one of the Hall-push buttons will sound a bell and also
light an indicating lamp to inform the operator about the floor level at which the lift is required
by the passenger.




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5    222
INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS                                                                                              223



                                     HK
                                                                                                  UD
                       DOB
                                                           T1 T2 T3
                                                           T4 T5 T6
                                          U

                                          D                            Reverse
                                                                       power
           Ground   I     II   III                                     relay
            floor Floor Floor Floor
                                                                                                   U                  D
              (a) Up-down annunciation                     Rectifier




                                                             Control
                                                             supply                     M
                                                                                                  (b) Power circuit



                                                                Reset
                 HB1         HB2     HB3         HB4            switch    BZ     1AN        2AN    3AN      4AN


                                                           Latch
                        1AN        2AN        3AN      4AN relays

                                                                       Buzzer

                                      BZ      Buzzer relay

                                              (c) Hall button annunciation in circuit

                                   Fig. 9.31 Power and annunciation circuit for a lift
      The bell is called ‘door open bell’ indicating that the door should be closed so that the lift
can be brought to the required floor by the waiting passenger. The Hall-push buttons become
inoperative when the lift is moving up or down. However, indication can be given to the operator
about the floor level at which the lift is required.
       Main annunciation circuits (light indicators, buzzers, bells etc.,) provided in the lift are
as follows:
       (1) A light indicator is provided at each floor level to show ‘up’ or ‘down’ movement of the
           car.
       (2) A target annuciation comprises indication showing the floor towards which the car is
           approaching. This is provided at each floor level and also in the car panel.
       (3) Hall-push button annuciation which comprises indication of floor level at which the
           lift is required by the passenger along with a buzzer in the car to attract operators
           attention.
       (4) A bell provided in the car which rings when the car door is open and the lift is wanted
           at some other floor by a passenger.
       In the case of failure of power supply during the travel period, the car will immediately
stop. In such eventuality either an alternative supply arrangement from standby generator is
to be made for bringing the car to the nearest floor opening, or a manual handle is to be used
through which a drum is rotated to bring the car to the nearest opening so that the entrapped




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5         223
224                                                                        CONTROL OF MACHINES

passengers may come out. In case of rope failure, there is a provision of safety shoes with the
car which will jam with the guide rails when the car would fall down at 150% of its rated speed.
In case of phase reversal of supply the lift becomes inoperative due to energisation of a reverse
phase relay, provided in the circuit.
        The control circuit which is being discussed here is based on the control circuit for a lift
manufactured by a leading concern. The control circuit shown in Fig. 9.32 has been simplified
to some extent from the original drawing for easy understanding. Lighting, fan, and alarm
circuits have been omitted and the annunciation circuit has been simplified. Before explaining
the working of the control circuit, some important devices, relays and selector switches used in
the lift control are discussed as follows:
       (a) A retiring cam device is provided at the top of the car which mechanically locks the
           car at a particular floor so as to enable passengers to come in or go out without
           physically shifting the car. Retiring cam device consists of a coil and a plunger. When
           coil CM is energised it attracts the plunger against a spring pressure. Normally,
           when the lift is working, this coil remains energised. It has 1600 µF capacitor across
           it. When the lift remains 30 cms away from desired floor level, the level limit switch
           actuates and coil CM is de-energised. The condenser across CM discharges through
           the coil and makes the plunger drop softly into the hole provided in the hoist way at
           the top of the hall gate. If a condenser is not provided across the coil, the plunger
           would drop abruptly and make a lot of noise. A blocking diode is used in the circuit
           which does not allow the condenser discharge current to flow back into the rest of the
           circuit.
       (b) Another important relay used is the Hall time switch relay, NT. Function of this
           relay is to make the hall push button in-operative when the lift is in motion and also
           for 5 seconds after its stoppage. This delay in operation of hall buttons after stoppage
           is desired so as to allow the operator to open the car gate. Once the car gate opens,
           lift cannot be operated from hall gate. Thus if this delay is not there, the lift will not
           stop at the floor level where the operator desires, but will move to another floor level
           where a waiting passenger has pressed the hall button.
       (c) An annuciation cut out switch ‘ACS’ is used in the control circuit to cut-off the hall
           buttons permanently.
       (d) An inspection switch 1NS is provided in the car panel which also makes the Hall-
           push button in-operative enabling the lift to be operated only through the Car-push
           buttons.
       (e) At the top of the car, inspection switch TES is provided which allows inspection of
           the car carriage way. This switch makes both the car and Hall-push buttons in
           operative. The car can be operated by the person who is inspecting the carriage-way
           using Up and Down push buttons provided on the top of car.
       (f) Level sensing limit switches used to stop the lift at different floors are also of special
           construction. Their contact operation has to be thoroughly understood before read-
           ing the control circuit. The lowest level and the highest level limit switches i.e., GFS
           and 3FS are of ordinary type. There is only one contact which opens when the limit
           switch is actuated. However, the limit switches provided in the intermediate floors
           are of special construction. The contacts are of changeover type with three termi-
           nals. This type of a limit switch contact has been shown in Fig. 9.33 in three different
           positions.




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5   224
INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS   225




                                 Fig. 9.32 Control circuit for a lift




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5   225
226                                                                                 CONTROL OF MACHINES




                                    (a)               (b)               (c)

            Fig. 9.33 Limit switch contact position (a) when lift actuates it at a particular floor
             (b) when lift moves to a higher floor level (c) when lift moves to lower floor level
       When this particular limit switch is actuated, the contact position will be as shown in
Fig. 9.33 (a). When the lift moves to a higher floor the contact position will be as shown in
Fig. 9.33 (b). If, however, the lift moves to a lower floor from its position the contact position
will be as shown in Fig. 9.33 (c). The contact positions described here are with reference to the
limit switch usage in the control circuit. In the particular example we are studying, the level
sensing limit switches for floor 1 and 2 will be of the special construction described above
while ground floor and top floor limit switches are of ordinary type. Also, the final Up and
Down limit switches are of ordinary type.
       In Fig. 9.31 have been shown the power circuit and the annunciation circuit of the lift.
In the power circuit it is seen that the motor is controlled by three contactors UD (main
contactor), U (upward motion contactor) and D (downward motion contactor). The main contactor
has been provided for the sake of saftey. In case one of the contactors U or D gets stuck or their
contacts weld-during operation, accident is avoided due to opening of the main contactor, UD.
Use of three contactors is justified here as public safety is directly involved. DC control supply
is obtained through a rectifier and a control transformer as shown. The value of control supply
is kept low i.e., 110 V for sake of saftey of the operator.
        A reverse phase relay is connected between the output terminals of the 3 phase control
transformer T. There are two secondary windings of the control transformer. Three phase
windings T4, T5, T6 have been used for main control. These three phases are connected to the
rectifier. Single phase ac output between T7, T8 has been used for the annunciation circuits.
        Now let us refer to the control circuit in Fig. 9.32. Working of this circuit from the car
push button is described as follows :
       Operation of the lift through Car-push buttons
       (1) The lift can be operated in Up or Down motion by pressing car push button if control
           supply reaches the upper coil terminal of contactor U and D. Supply reaches upto
           these points if the contacts of all components such as over load relay (OL), reverse
           power relay (RP) over speed switch (OS), car gate switch (GS), contact B of car
           inspection switch TCIS-1, upper and lower final limit switches ILS and 2LS, hall
           gate limit switches DS6 and DS1 to DS3 are closed. If the contact of any of the above
           mentioned components opens the lift will not operate.
       (2) The level sensing limit switch contact position shown in the control circuit of Fig.
           9.32 indicates that the lift is on the first floor, as first floor limit switch 1FS has been
           shown actuated. Now let us examine how the control works when lift is to be taken to
           second floor. Car push button CB2 is to be pressed. Control, supply would reach coil
           of relay 2F through closed contact UD3, contact A of switch TCIS2 and push button
           CB2. Relay 2F will get energised and its contact 2F2 will close. This will lead to
           energisation of contactor U and UD. The circuit will complete through coil of contac-
           tor UD, contact D2, coil of contactor U, contact OB of second floor limit switch 2FS,
           contact 2F2 and coil of relay 2F. Thus the lift will move in upward direction. When it
           would reach second floor, limit switch 2FS will get actuated.




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5    226
INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS                                                                        227

       (3) When the lift leaves the first floor for the second floor, contact position of limit
          switch 1FS will change. Its contact OA will be made.
       (4) From the control circuit it may be observed that, when contactor UD gets energised,
           supply to car buttons is cut off due to opening of contact UD3.This means that the car
           buttons become inoperative, once the lift starts moving. A command given while the
           car is stationary can not be overruled by pressing car buttons when the lift is moving.
       (5) If now the lift is moved to the third floor by pressing car button CB3, contactor U and
           UD get energised through closed contact of floor limit switch 3FS and coil of relay 3F
           and its contact 3F2. The lift stops when 3FS is actuated.
       (6) When the lift moves from second floor to third floor, second floor limit switch contact
           will change position. It moves from neutral to OA position. When the lift is at third
           floor i.e,... , at the top most floor (in this case). The contact position of the limit
           switches at all the floor levels will be as shown in Fig. 9.34.

                                       A         B       A         B



                              GFS          1FS               2FS             3FS

             Fig. 9.34 Various limit switch contact positions when lift car is at the third floor
       (7) Now let us see the downward motion of the lift from the third floor. To bring the lift
           to the second floor, car button CB2 will be pressed. This will energise relay 2F and
           hence its contact 2F2 will close. Down contactor D will get energised as the contact of
           2FS is closed in OA position. Remember, this contact has changed over in (refer Fig.
           9.34) this position during the movement of the lift from the second floor to the third
           floor. When the lift reaches second floor, 2FS is again actuated and both contacts OA
           and OB will be open.
       (8) When the lift is moved further down to first floor, contact position of limit switch
           2FS will change and now contact would be made between O and B.
       (9) When the lift reaches the ground floor contact position of various limit switches will
           be as shown in Fig. 9.35.

                                        A            B     A           B



                              GFS           1FS                2FS             3FS

              Fig. 9.35 Various limit switch contact positions when the lift is at ground floor

     (10) The lift can be moved from ground floor to the top floor or any other floor directly
          without stopping at intermediate floors. For example, if the car button of third floor
          is pressed, the lift will move from ground floor to third floor directly without stop-
          ping in between at first and second floor. This can be verified by tracing control
          operation in the control circuit diagram.
Operation of the lift through Hall-push-buttons
       (1) When the car gate is closed i.e., contact GS1 of car gate switch GS is closed and GS2
           is open and the lift is stationary, lift movement can be controlled by Hall-push but-




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5    227
228                                                                        CONTROL OF MACHINES

          tons also. When the lift is stationary, UD is de-energised and therefore its contact
          UD2 is open and thus NT is in de-energised condition. Supply to Hall-gate-buttons
          will reach through contact NT2. Pressing of any of the hall buttons will energise the
          respective floor relay and the lift will move to the desired floor level through
          energisation of contactor U or D and UD.
       (2) When the lift is moving in Up or Down motion, contactor UD is energised and there-
           fore its contact UD2 is closed. This will energise relay NT which has a 500 µF capaci-
           tor across it. When NT is energised its contact NT2 will open and supply at Hall-
           buttons is cut off. Thus the Hall-button contacts shown in Fig. 9.32 become inopera-
           tive. However, the other set of contacts of the hall buttons which have been used for
           the annunciation circuit remain operative. These contacts have been shown, in
           Fig. 9.31 (c).
          Referring to this circuit it may be seen that when any one of the Hall-buttons is
          pressed, a latch relay and buzzer relay BZ are energised. Closing of latch relay will
          energise an indicator through its contact and a buzzer will get energised through
          buzzer relay contact BZ. It may be recalled that the latch relay has got two coils. The
          relay will remain closed even when supply to its latch coil is disconnected. It will
          drop only when its other coil called unlatch coil is energised (refer chapter 2). For
          example, let us assume that button HB2 is pressed, then relay 2AN will get ener-
          gised and get latched. Its contact 2AN will close and energise the indicator on car
          control panel and a buzzer will also sound to draw operators attention. This indica-
          tion will go off only when the operator presses the Reset-push button to drop 2AN by
          energising its unlatch coil. This means that as long as the operator does not accept
          the information sent by the waiting passengers, the buzzer will continue to sound
          along with the floor indication signal of the floor at which the lift is required.
       (3) When the lift comes to a stop at any floor level, contactor UD will get de-energised
           and it will also cut off supply to relay NT due to opening of contact UD2. Relay NT,
           however, remains energised for about 5 seconds due to discharge current of con-
           denser C fitted across it. This delay is to keep the Hall-buttons inoperative for 5
           seconds after stoppage of a lift so as to allow the operator to open the car gate. As
           described earlier, if this delay is not there, then the lift will not stop at the required
           floor but will move over to that floor where the Hall button has been kept pressed by
           the waiting passanger.
       (4) Once the lift car gate opens, relay NT is again energised through closed contact GS2
           of the gate limit switch. Now supply reaches hall buttons through closed contact
           GS2, contact B of ACS switch, contact NT1 and through relay HK. When any of the
           Hall-buttons is pressed having the car gate open, the respective floor relay (GF, 1F,
           etc) is energised. However the lift does not operate as supply does not reach the
           upper coil terminal of contactor UD due to open gate contact GS1. Energisation of
           relay HK, in this case, will energise a bell called DOB i.e. Door open bell through its
           contact HK1 (refer annunciation circuit in Fig. 9.31 b). This bell rings to attract op-
           erators attention and demands that the door should be closed so that the waiting
           passenger can bring the lift to the desired floor level.




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5   228
INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS                                                                        229

Functions of Various Switches
        (1) Inspection Switch (INS): When the switch INS is put in ON position, supply at the
            upper terminal of relay HK and thus also to the Hall-push buttons is cut off. The lift
            can not therefore be operated when the switch INS is put on ‘ON’ position.
        (2) Top of Car Inspection Switch (TCIS) : Two contact block of this switch have been
            used, designated as TCIS1 and TCIS2. In the OFF position of the switch, contact B of
            TCIS1 is closed while contact A of TCIS2 is closed. When inspection of the car car-
            riage-way is to be done, this switch is put ON. The contacts will change over their
            position. Now contact A of TCIS1 and contact B of TCIS2 are closed. Due to closing of
            contact TCIS1 ON-push buttons CIB and OFF-push buttons UIB1 and DIB1 come
            into circuit. On the other hand closing of TCIS2 will bring ‘UP’ and ‘DOWN’ push
            buttons UIB2 and DIB2 in the circuit. All these push buttons CIB, UIB1, DIB2, UIB2
            are on the top` of the car. When a person, who is on the top of the car for inspection
            of car carriage-way, pushes button CIB and DIB2, relay GF is energised and the lift
            moves towards the ground floor irrespective of where it is situated.
        (3) Annunciation Cutout Switch (ACS) : When this swtich is placed in ON position,
            its contact A will close and contact B will open. Closing of contact A will permanently
            energise relay NT. Energisation of NT will cut off the supply to relay HK and Hall-
            buttons and thus the door open bell annunciation circuit will be cut off.
        (4) Target Annunciation : This is provided in the car panel and at all floor levels
            towards which the car is approaching. As seen from the control circuit diagram these
            indication lamps glow along with the energisation of relay GF. 1F, 2F etc. For exam-
            ple, when the car button CB2 has been pressed, relay 2F will get energised, and in
            parallel with this relay, five indicating lamps provided one each at all the floor levels
            and one in the car panel will get enrgised.
        (5) Up and Down Indication : These are provided at all floor levels to indicate up and
            down movement of the lift. The indication lamp for up or down movement of the car
            at all floors gets lighted up through contacts of contactors U or D as shown in
            Fig. 9.31 (a).

                                      REVIEW QUESTIONS
   1.   In a planer machine, what will happen if the right hand side limit switch does not actuate? What
        back-up protection should be there to cover up such malfunctioning?
   2.   What is the purpose of pressurised air in an overhead tank?
   3.   In lifting magnets the material will drop when power supply fails. What precaution should be
        taken to avoid accidents due to such power failure?
   4.   What is the necessity of providing power limit switches in overhead cranes?
   5.   Why single phasing of hoist motor in overhead crane is done at the start of lowering motion?
   6.   Draw the control circuit for a Battery trolley by using a simple selector switch and push buttons.
   7.   How will you modify the control circuit of a battery truck so that it does not operate when the
        battery voltage is low.
   8.   What will happen if the unloading relay does not energise in an air compressor ?
   9.   What will happen if air reservoir pressure switch in an air compressor fails to actuate?




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5     229
230                                                                             CONTROL OF MACHINES

  10. In the control circuit of a walking beam, it may happen that sometimes beam may not stop at
      LS4 position but will stop at LS1 position. What could be the possible reason?
  11. Design control circuit for following specification:
       (a) One push button should start conveyor motors in sequene;
       (b) An over load on any conveyor should stop all conveyors;
       (c) One stop button should stop all conveyor in sequence;
       (d) There should be 30 seconds delay between the stopping of each conveyor working in sequence.
  12. Design and draw the control circuit for a lift to be used in a four storied building with the desired
      features. Also explain in brief its working.




dharm
d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5    230
Troubleshooting in Control Circuits


   10.1 INTRODUCTION
Troubleshooting or fault finding in control circuits can take a few minutes, hours or days
depending upon the complexity of the problem and the expertise of the troubleshooter. If the
troubleshooter does not understand the control functions and is not familiar with control
components and troubleshooting procedures, then, even a small fault in the electrical control
circuit can baffle him. This may lead to unnecessary production loss in the plant. A technician
engineer who may be skilled in wiring a control circuit from the given diagram may not
necessarily be able to troubleshoot control circuits efficiently. For troubleshooting of control
circuits the main asset is the possession of analytical mind trained in all aspects of control
functions, knowledge of components and circuits. The secret to efficient and accurate trouble-
shooting lies in determining the section of the control circuit that contains the trouble component
and then selecting the proper component to be checked. This can however be accomplished by
efficient and accurate circuit analysis and not by trial and error or by checking of components
at random.
      Troubleshooting starts with the analysis of the problem. To analyse any problem it is
helpful to first identify the type of problem. This limits the area in which troubleshooting is to
be done. In identifying the type of fault the following areas might be considered:
      • Electrical
      •   Mechanical
      •   Hydraulic power system
       • Pneumatic system
       If the exact area of fault is not identified successfully then the troubleshooter will
unnecessarily waste time. Sometimes what appears to be an electrical problem at first instance
turns out be a mechanical one. Sometimes when electrical maintenance and mechanical
maintenance of a plant are looked after by different persons this discrepancy in deciding the
type of problem cause undue wastage of time. An employer therefore always prefer that his
technician engineer should be responsible for both mechanical and electrical maintenance. In
small industries almost always the same man is responsible for troubleshooting electrical and
mechanical faults. In big industries an electrical engineer however will look after electrical
maintenance while mechanical engineer will look after mechanical maintenance.
       In a plant, problem sometimes arises in the machines due to operators misunderstanding,
lack of cooperation among the operators, or lack of knowledge of the machine. Whatever may
be the reason of the problem it should be handled carefully so that the machine can be returned
quickly to its trouble-free operation.
                                               231
232                                                                        CONTROL OF MACHINES

      Before discussing the general troubleshooting procedure, it will be helpful to go through
the possible trouble spots described in the following section.

   10.2 TROUBLE SPOTS
As it is impractical, if not impossible to list all the trouble spots, only those trouble spots have
been discussed in which the troubles are quite frequent. The possible trouble spots are as
follows.
10.2.1 Fuses
It should be the first spot to be checked but very often this is overlooked.
       One of the trouble at this spot could be looseness of fuse carrier or its falling out due to
looseness. Fuse carrier can become loose and come out due to vibrations of the machine. In
such case the permanent solution is to insulate the control panel from vibration. Temporary
solution is to adjust the male contacts of the fuse carrier so as to fit tightly into female contacts
of fuse base. Alternatively the fuse carrier can be replaced with a new one.
        Another trouble at this spot could be the blowing of the fuse. As it is known, the fuse will
blow only when there is some short circuit or grounding in the control circuits. One can try
once or twice by replacing the fuse, as some times the fault is of transitory nature and may get
cleared by itself. If replaced, the fuse should be exactly of the same voltage and current rating.
If the fuse continues to blow out then further checking should be done to detect the fault. If the
control circuit is very large then it is better to have sub control fuses for different sections of
the control circuit.
        This way the faulty position of the control circuit is very easily segregated from the rest
of control circuit. For example, a control circuit having relays and solenoid valves, can have
separate fuses for relay circuit and solenoid valve coils.
10.2.2 Loose Connections
The control circuit as we normally see on a drawing does not give a true picture of its complexity.
In practice the control circuit is wired between three locations viz.:
       (1) Control panel,
       (2) Operators panel, and
       (3) The machine.
       Control relays are located in the control panel, pilot devices like push buttons and
indication lamps are provided on operators panel while limit switches, pressure switches, float
switches etc. are provided on the machine. Control wires from control panel get distributed to
the operators panel and the machine through terminal blocks. In modern machines there are
hundred of connections involved in wiring the control circuit. These connections are at relay
contacts, coils, terminal blocks, pilot devices and sensing devices. All these connections are the
possible trouble spots for loose connection. Advancement in the design of terminal block and
the use of stranded conductors in place of solid round conductors have greatly reduced this
problem. To avoid problems due to loose connections, the best course of action will be to follow
a good programme of preventive maintenance in which connections are periodically checked
and tightened.
       The problem of loose connection becomes serious in case of power circuits as the current
handled is of higher magnitude. A loose connection in a power circuit generates local heat
which spreads to other parts of the same component and also to adjoining components. Loose
power connection finally damages the component due to insulation failure. Loose connection
in thermally sensitive components may result in malfunctioning.



dharm
d:N-MachMac10-1.pm5   232
TROUBLESHOOTING IN CONTROL CIRCUITS                                                         233

       For example, a thermal sensitive overload relay may trip due to conduction of heat to it.
A regular check for loose connection is the best remedy for avoiding such troubles. Flexible
control wires are preferred for wiring a control circuit. These wires are not connected directly
in the terminal block or at the relay terminals but are connected after crimping a terminal end
on the wire end. Different type of terminal ends are shown in Fig. 10.1.

                              A
                                        B
                                                                           A


                                                                               B


                                  (a)                               (b)


                                         A


                                        B


                                  (c)                               (d)

                  Fig. 10.1 Different types of terminal ends (a) Pin type (b) Ring type
                                   (c) Reducer type (d) Tubular type
        In Fig. 10.1 (a) is shown a control terminal end or a pin type terminal end. In the
portion ‘A’ flexible control wire is inserted after applying a crimping paste on it, and then, this
portion is crimped i.e. pressed and squeezed by a crimping plier. Terminal end is inserted in
the terminal block, keeping portion ‘B’ on upper side and tightened with the help of terminal
block screw. The terminal end shown in Fig. 10.1 (b) is for connecting wires at relay/contactor
terminals. Flexible wires are inserted in portion ‘A’ and crimped after applying crimping paste.
The other end ‘B’ of the lug is tightened at the relay contact terminals. Crimping paste is an
inhibitor compound used so as to avoid oxidation.
       Power connection at the main switch, contactors, terminal blocks etc. are also done
through reducer terminal ends and Tubular terminal ends, shown in Fig. 10.1 (c) and (d).
Stranded cable conductors are used. Crimping of terminal ends is done by a hydraulic crimping
machine. A pressure gauge is fitted on the crimping machine. Terminal ends are crimped upto
a pressure as prescribed by the manufacturer. Terminal ends are available in different sizes
and corresponding matching terminal blocks are available for connections. For proper crimping
exact pressure should be applied during crimping. If a solid conductor is to be connected through
a terminal end then the terminal end is to be soldered to the conductor. A soldering rod is
melted and put in the portion A to hold the conductor.
10.2.3 Faulty Contacts
This trouble occurs in such components as motor starters, contactors, relays, push buttons,
and various types of switches.
      The most common problem appears with normally closed contacts. Although visible
observation shows that such contacts are closed but in actual practice they may not be conducting
current. Contacts may not be conducting due to dirt or formation of copper oxide films which is
an insulator. Another reason could be improper spring pressure. Oxide film from the contact
can be cleaned by drawing a piece of rough paper between the contacts. Care should however




dharm
d:N-MachMac10-1.pm5   233
234                                                                        CONTROL OF MACHINES

be taken to use only a fine abrasive to clean contacts. Contacts should never be filed. Most of
the contacts being used today have silver coating, the silver coating will get destroyed if filing
is done. If the contacts are badly worn out and heavily pitted these should be replaced. Problem
with silver coated contacts is that the silver oxide film formed becomes conducting. If this film
is not cleaned at regular intervals, it may short circuit the adjacent contact terminals. It is
therefore recommended that silver coated contacts should be cleaned with carbon tetrachloride
at regular intervals to remove silver oxide film.
       Another problem with contacts is that they may get welded together during an overload
or a short circuit fault. If the contacts get badly damaged they should be replaced. Sometimes
the spring pressure on contacts is not sufficient, this should be adjusted, or springs should be
replaced with new ones.
       In a newly wired control circuit, problem may be due to use of wrong contacts. Error is
often made in wiring a control circuit, particularly when only one of the two available contacts
of a component is used. The error consists of wiring the wrong contact, that is using a NO
contact instead of a NC contact or vice-versa.
       This error is too frequent, it can be due to carelessness or lack of familiarity with the
component being wired. To avoid such problems the person who is wiring should be completely
familiar with components and he should double check his work.
10.2.4 Incorrect Wire Marking
This problem will usually appear at the initial stage of control panel wiring or at the stage of
assembly and erection of the machine in the plant. The error can also creep in during preventive
maintenance or during any alteration done in the control circuit. This error becomes difficult
to locate as control cables running from a control panel to the machine may have as large as 20
conductors. One common problem is the transposition of numbers. Another problem that may
occur with numbering ferrules is during connecting conductors into a terminal block. With a
long block and many conductors, it is a common error to connect a conductor either one block
above or one block below the proper position.
10.2.5 Combination Problems
As described earlier some of the problems in machines cannot be referred to as faults exclusively
due to defective electrical or mechanical or hydraulic or pneumatic system. Mere observation
does not give any positive clue to the area of trouble spot. The problem may be in one area or it
may be simultaneously in two areas. Whenever such a discrepancy arises, it is better to first
check the electrical circuit as it is faster to check an electrical circuit than a mechanical system.
       To quote an example, one very common combination problem is overload tripping of a
motor. The motor may be tripping due to actual mechanical overload or due to malfunction of
overload relay or due to defect in the motor itself. It is also possible that two abnormalities
may be existing at the same time. An overload may malfunction due to heat generated by a
loose power connection. A motor may take more current due to damaged bearing. If discrepancy
arises in such cases the motor should be decoupled from mechanical load and thorough checking
from electrical point of view should be done first.
      Another example of combination problem is burning of solenoid valve coils. Probably,
over 90% of all troubles on valves develop from a faulty mechanical or pressure condition,
which prevents the solenoid plunger from seating properly leading to drawing of excessive
current by the coil. As a result either the fuse blows or the solenoid coil burns out.




dharm
d:N-MachMac10-1.pm5   234
TROUBLESHOOTING IN CONTROL CIRCUITS                                                        235

       Electrical cum pressure could also be another combination problem. A particular
operation of a machine may not happen due to fault in the control circuit or due to improper
fluid or pneumatic pressure.
      An electrical cum temperature combination problem can occur in ovens and furnaces.
Required temperature may not be obtained and the possible reason could be low voltage,
damaged heaters, blown fuses or leakage of heat due to use of improper heat insulating material.
       A methodical approach should be made to analyse such problems instead of attempting
a trial and error method.
10.2.6 Low Voltage
If the system voltage becomes low, relays, contactors, timers etc. start dropping (getting de-
energised) and as a result control circuit starts malfunctioning. Motors would trip at low voltage
as they would draw more current from the supply. The system voltage may become low because
of heavy loading or inadequate conductor size. A common source of such problem is the addition
of new machines without properly checking the capacities of power supply line and the
transformer.
      Low voltage will result in generation of inadequate heat in ovens. For example, if the
voltage is dropped to one half the heating element’s rated voltage, the heat output will be
reduced to one fourth.
10.2.7 Grounding
We can have two types of control supply, one is with neutral grounded and the other without
grounding. Each has its own merits. In the first case one terminal of control supply from
control transformer is grounded. The other terminal of control power supply is protected by a
fuse or a miniature circuit breaker. The advantage of this method is that it is easy to check
supply at any point, as it is to be done with reference to ground. In this method when a ground
fault occurs, the control fuse blows and the machine remains inoperative until the fault is
located and removed.
       The second type of control supply with ungrounded neutral is preferred for large
production shops. In this type of control supply the circuit continues to work even if a ground
fault occurs. Control fuse will blow and the machine will stop only when a second ground fault
occurs. The method thus has an advantage because production can continue with one ground
fault leaving some time to locate the fault and remove it. In this type of control supply, some
type of indication has to be provided which should convey that a ground fault has occurred.
Two indication lamps are used to denote which one of the control lines has got grounded. This
scheme is shown in the control circuit of Fig. 10.2.
       In this control circuit, ground detection indication lights are A and B. Wire no.10 between
A and B is solidly grounded. When none of the line 1 and 0 are grounded, both the indication
lights A and B will glow at half brilliance as two 220V bulbs are connected in series. If a ground
fault occurs in the system, one of the lamps will go off, while the other one will glow at full
brilliance. A bulb getting switched off in a particular side will indicate that control supply of
that side has become grounded.
       If a ground fault occurs at wire no. 3 and also simultaneously at wire no. 8, control fuses
will blow due to short circuiting of the secondary terminals of the control transformer.
       The advantage with ungrounded control supply is that even if any point of the control
circuit gets grounded, it would not cause immediate trouble. Production can go on without
interruption and ground can be detected and removed on the maintenance day.




dharm
d:N-MachMac10-1.pm5   235
236                                                                                        CONTROL OF MACHINES

                L1              L2
                        440V
                                        1                     1                    1             1
                     X1 220V X2                         Rev
                              For                       PB                                           Lamp
                                                                         R1   F3       R3
                              PB            LLS1   F1             RLS1                                 A
                                    2
                                                                               9
                                            RLS2                  LLS2                      10
                                    3                     6
                                            R2                    F2
                                    4                     7
                                        F                     R                    B                 B

                                                    8

               O                Forward                  Reverse              Brake    Ground detector
                                                                                           lights

                           Fig. 10.2 Control circuit having ground detector lights
      There are many locations on a machine where a ground can occur. However, there are a
few spots in which grounds occur more often. These spots are discussed below:
      (1) Often ground fault occur in limit switches, pressure switches, temperature switches,
          float switches etc. Most of the time this is due to the compact design of many compo-
          nents allowing very small space for making connections. Due to lack of space, bare
          conductors at terminals of a component may come in contact with the case of the
          component. Many times the cables/wires going to a component may get pulled and
          cause breakage or grounding of the wires. Control wires in control panel can also get
          grounded in the panel itself or with an adjacent ground wire.
      (2) A ground may occur due to damaging of insulation while pulling control wires through
          a conduit, if proper care is not taken. Insulation damage may also occur when there
          are several bends in the conductors.
       (3) A ground fault may also occur due to improper use of a stranded conductor. Care
           must be taken while placing a stranded conductor into a connector. All strands must
           be used. One or two strands which have not been used may touch the case or a
           normally grounded conductor. Even if this does not happen, current carrying capacity
           of the conductor gets reduced due to less number of strands in use.
10.2.8 Momentary Faults
Sometimes faults occur but do not persist for a long time. It becomes really difficult to locate
the origin of such momentary faults.
       The operator of the machine needs to keep a close observation to find out at which part
of the cycle of control circuit operation the fault occurs. When the part of the cycle at which the
fault occurs is identified, the control circuit pertaining to that portion needs to be checked
thoroughly. If the fault occurs at random during the cycle then those components which are
common for the whole cycle operation should be checked.
       Loose connection or a broken conductor inside the insulation can also be the cause of
momentary fault. Sometimes a control component may be malfunctioning. In case of doubt a
component can be replaced by a new one. If the machine is new, fault may already exist in the
control circuit due to improper connection.




dharm
d:N-MachMac10-1.pm5     236
TROUBLESHOOTING IN CONTROL CIRCUITS                                                              237

10.2.9 Poor Maintenance
If regular maintenance of a machine is not done the frequency of occurrence of faults will
increase. Regular maintenance also includes proper cleaning of machine and control panel.
The control panel door should be properly sealed so as not to allow dust and dirt to enter the
panel. Though manufacturers of components have improved their product design so as to prevent
dust, dirt, and fluids entering inside the components, proper care should also be taken by the
users. In large motor starters moving mechanical parts should be checked for loose pins and
the bolts. Dust, dirt and grease should be removed from electrical parts, otherwise short circuit
may develop. It is recommended that a regular maintenance schedule should be followed.
History sheet of each individual machine should be maintained. In this history sheet details of
all break-downs occurring on machines and also details of preventive maintenance done should
be noted. History sheet can be very useful to a supervisor in detecting fault in the machine.

   10.3 GENERAL PROCEDURE FOR TROUBLESHOOTING
Firstly, we will consider a control circuit which has just been wired but is not working as per
the design. The procedure for detecting fault in such a circuit is as follows:
       (1) The first step should be to analyse the control circuit and ascertain that it has been
           properly designed as per the control function requirements;
       (2) The next step is to run the machine and follow the operation through the expected
           sequence until one finds the section of control circuit which is not operating;
       (3) After locating the faulty section, wiring should be checked. If wiring is as per draw-
           ing then control components of this section should be checked thoroughly;
      (4) When trouble in the faulty section is located and removed, the machine should be
          started again to run successfully throughout the complete cycle. In case of fault ex-
          isting in any other section of the control circuit, one should now try to locate the fault
          of that section.
       Secondly, we will study the troubleshooting procedure for an already existing circuit
which was working properly before the occurrence of a fault. The possibility of improper
connection therefore is eliminated. The procedure for troubleshooting in such a circuit is as
follows:
       (1) The first step is to understand the operation and control circuit of the machine. If the
           control circuit is very large and complex, help of the operator should be taken to find
           out how much of the circuit is operating. In this way one can directly start with the
           section of the circuit that does not function.
       (2) When the faulty circuit section has been identified, first a careful check of the circuit
           and components involved in that section should be done. A careful visual inspection
           may help to detect a faulty component or an open wiring. If nothing is found out in
           the visual inspection then the procedure may be as follows.
       (3) Find out which operation is not taking place and identify the contactor/solenoid valve
           coil which is responsible for this operation. Operate the machine and check whether
           there is voltage across the coil of relay or the contactor/solenoid valve coil. If proper
           voltage is available across the coil then trouble, most likely, is in the winding of the
           coil itself. Now, to check the continuity of coil, power is switched off and continuity of
           the coil is checked with an ohm meter. If the coil is alright, a low resistance is indicated.
           Working of the contactor or solenoid valve should be checked before replacing the
           burnt coil. If it is suspected that contactor closing mechanism or solenoid valve is
           defective, a new contactor or a new solenoid valve should be installed.



dharm
d:N-MachMac10-1.pm5    237
238                                                                                CONTROL OF MACHINES

       (4) Suppose that in the step discussed above voltage is found to be not reaching the
           contactor coil. This indicates that some contact is not closing when it should, thus
           disconnecting supply to the coil. In such a case control circuit drawing should be
           referred, to find out components whose contacts should close to energise the coil.
           These contacts may be of different relays, limit switches, pressure switches, tem-
           perature and float switches etc. Now the task will be to determine which of the com-
           ponents connected in series is not making contact.
       (5) To find out contact of which particular component is not making, supply should be
           checked at various points leading to the contactor coil. Here, note that difficulties
           may be faced in checking if limit switches, pressure switches etc. which are on the
           machine are wired directly in the control circuit. If, however, relays are energised
           through limit switches etc., and then contacts of these relays are used in control
           circuit, checking will become easier. This point has already been explained in Chap-
           ter 2 while discussing relays. Once the defective component is detected then the
           cause of malfunctioning can be found out. If the contact is not making due to a cop-
           per oxide film or dirt, cleaning should be done and if contact is not closing properly,
           adjustment can be done. If, contact is badly pitted it should be replaced. The other
           possibility during this checking can be detection of open circuit due to a broken or
           burnt wire.
       (6) Having eliminated the fault, the machine should be started again and if the machine
           does not operate successfully throughout the complete cycle of operation, the above
           procedure should again be applied to the next section of the control circuit which is
           faulty.
       (7) Quite frequently, grounding of a wire going from control panel to the machine may
           be the cause of trouble. A check should be made for detection of ground fault, by
           putting off the power supply. Resistance to ground of the wires should be checked
           with an ohm meter, or alternatively, a test lamp can be used to detect ground, where
           230 V supply with neutral earth is available.
                To check ground, one side of test lamp is connected to phase wire while the other
           end is connected to the wire which is to be tested for ground. If the wire is grounded
           the lamp will glow, otherwise it will remain off. This is shown in Fig. 10.3.

                        P                                          Lamp glows in
                                                                 case of ground fault

                        N




                            Fig. 10.3 Detection of ground fault using a test lamp
       The above procedure of fault detection is based on the fact that control circuits are made
up basically of only two things viz., contacts which make and break the circuit, and relay coils
which operate these contacts. If the contacts open and close as they should, then proper voltage
gets applied to the coils or the coils get de-energised, as desired. The fault can thus lie with the




dharm
d:N-MachMac10-1.pm5   238
TROUBLESHOOTING IN CONTROL CIRCUITS                                                                      239

contacts, relay/contactor coils, or the associated wires which carry current through the contacts
to the coil.
       One improtant rule to be observed while troubleshooting is to attend to only one thing
at a time. If you suspect that a contact is malfunctioning, first correct this contact and then
check machine operation. If fault persists then proceed to check other suspected possible trouble
spots. It is very seldom that several parts of a machine would wear out at the same instant
even though their condition may be poor. Tempering with more than one component at a time
may introduce more trouble than original trouble. In order that the procedure outlined above
for troubleshooting becomes clear, we will determine probable causes of some troubles which
we will assume to have occurred in the circuit. The circuit is a simple control of an air compressor
motor shown in Fig. 10.4.

                              CR2
                                        4                                     4
               P
                         1

                   OFF
                                                    1P        T           F
                                                                                              9
                         2                    5          6        7           8
                                                                                      Stop

             Control                                                                         10
              ON              CR1
                         3                                                                          1P1
                                                                                       Start

                                                                                             11

                                                                                                  1M1
                                                                                             12
                                                                                                  T1
                                    4
                                                                                             13
                                                                                                  F1

                                                                                             14

                         CR                    1M        1P           T           F            2M

              N
                    Control ON               Cooling                                    Comp motor
                                            water pump                                   contactor

                             Fig. 10.4 Control diagram for an air compressor motor
       In this circuit CR is control relay, 1M is cooling water pump motor contactor, 2M is
compressor motor starter contactor. Oil lubrication pressure switches, cooling water
temperature switch, and cooling water flow switch energise relays 1P, T, and F. Contacts of
these relay are used in the starting circuit of the compressor motor contactor 2M. Brief
description about working of circuit is that when control relay CR is energised by pressing
control ON-push button, relay CR closes and is held through its contact CR1. Its contact CR2
also closes and energies terminal 4. Cooling water pump starts due to energisation of contactor
1M (Remember cooling water pump circulates cold water for cooling the compressor).
Compressor motor contactor 2M can be energised by pressing START-push button. Contactor
2M gets energised if contact 1M1, T1 and F1 are in closed condition. When 2M is energised,




dharm
d:N-MachMac10-1.pm5        239
240                                                                          CONTROL OF MACHINES

compressor motor starts and lubrication oil pressure also starts building up as the oil pump is
coupled with the main compressor motor. If sufficient pressure builds up, oil lubrication pressure
switch 1P closes and energises relay 1P. Contact 1P1 of this relay closes across the START-
push button and contactor 2M is held through contact 1P1. START-push button has to be kept
pressed till contact 1P1 closes. Having understood the working of the circuit, we will now
discuss detection of some troubles assumed to have occurred in the circuit:
       (1) Suppose that the trouble reported by operator is that the control circuit is not func-
           tioning. This will also be indicated by non-glowing of ‘control ON’ indication lamp.
           First of all, by visual inspection check if the control relay CR is closed. If found
           closed, then check supply at terminal 4. If there is no supply then contact CR2 is not
           making contact. Take action to rectify defects in the contact. If on visual inspection,
           relay CR is found to be de-energised, then press control ON-push button and check
           supply across the coil. If full voltage is available then fault lies in the coil. Disconnect
           the coil and check its continuity. If the coil is found burnt replace it after checking
           the relay.
           In the previous check, with the ON-push button pressed, if no voltage is found avail-
           able across the coil i.e., at terminal 3 with respect to neutral 0, then proceed to check
           voltage at terminal 2. If voltage is available at terminal 2, it would mean that control
           ON-push button is not making contact on being pressed. Replace the contact block to
           rectify the fault. If, however, supply is not available at terminal 2, fault may be there
           in the OFF-push button, its NC contact may not be making contact. If during this
           checking no supply is detected upto terminal 1, then it would mean that the control
           fuse is blown. Check the control fuse. The control fuse may get blown due to fault in
           any part of the whole control circuit. Fuse can blow due to any coil getting shorted as
           a result of burning or due to grounding of any wire. If control fuse is blown, proceed
           as follows to detect the fault.
           To detect the trouble spot for fuse blowing, first one has to find out the section in
           which fault exists. If the fuse is getting blown before the compressor motor has started,
           the possibility of fault lying beyond terminal 11 is ruled out. Now remove all the
           wires marked number four (4) from the contactor strip and check with the help of an
           ohm meter or test lamp each individual wire for a ground. Suppose wire no. 4 going
           to cooling water temperature switch is showing ground then check for any physical
           damage to the wire going from panel to the switch. Also check the switch as wire
           may be getting ground by touching the case of the switch.
       (2) Another problem with control relay may be that it does not remain energised when
           the ON-push button is released. For this, check if any wire is open at contact CR1 of
           the relay. If wires are found connected properly then the problem, most probably, is
           with the contact CR1. This contact may not be making due to oxide film or dust and
           dirt etc. It may also need adjustment or replacement.
       (3) Another problem could be that the compressor motor fails to start when the START-
           push button is pressed. First step should be to check visually in the control panel the
           condition of relays T, F and 1M. 1M should be closed while T and F should be open.
           Suppose the relay T is found closed, it would mean that the cooling water tempera-
           ture switch is actuated. It should be found out whether the temperature switch is
           malfunctioning or whether the temperature of the cooling water has actually in-
           creased. If the temperature switch is defective it should be replaced. If cooling water
           temperature had increased find out the cause and remove it. Fault may be in the
           compressor itself, or perhaps the inlet water temperature is already high.




dharm
d:N-MachMac10-1.pm5   240
TROUBLESHOOTING IN CONTROL CIRCUITS                                                          241

           If during visual inspection, the condition of the relay is found as desired, then pro-
           ceed to check voltage at various points, starting from the coil terminal 14 with the
           START-push button pressed. If voltage exists at terminal 14, then disconnect coil of
           contactor 2M and check its continuity. If no voltage exists at terminal 14 then pro-
           ceed backward to check voltage at terminal 13, 12, 11, 10, 9 till the terminal where
           supply is available is reached. Suppose supply voltage is found at terminal 9 and not
           at terminal 10, it would be clear that OFF-push button is not making contact. Re-
           move dust from this push button contact element, or if required replace the contact
           block. Suppose the supply was detected at terminal 12 while there was no supply at
           terminal 13 then fault lies in the contact T1 of relay T. Proper contact may not be
           making, or the wire may be open at the terminal of the relay.
        (4) Suppose the problem reported is that the compressor motor starts but does no hold
            i.e., trips as soon as START-push button is released. Since oil lubrication pressure
            switch contact 1P1 is used to hold the contactor 2M, immediately check is to be made
            whether oil pressure is being developed so as to actuate the pressure switch and
            relay 1P. The problem may be in the contact 1P1 or pressure switch itself or oil level
            in the sump may have fallen down due to leakage and thus oil pressure is not build-
            ing up.

                                    REVIEW QUESTIONS
   1.What are the two main assets of a troubleshooter which help him in early detection of a fault ?
   2.What are the possible troubles in the fusebase and carriers ?
   3.What problems are caused by loose connections in control and power connection ? Draw different
     types of terminal ends used in solving the problem of loose connections ?
  4. What type of contacts may cause trouble and yet they appear to be in good condition ?
  5. Why should you never file a contact ?
  6. What is a combination problem as applied to machine control ?
  7. What conditions lead to a low-voltage problem in plants ?
  8. Discuss the merits and demerits of using a control supply with grounded and ungrounded neu-
     tral.
  9. Explain with the control diagram how indication lamps are used to denote which of the control
     line has got grounded in an ungrounded control supply scheme.
 10. List a few spots where ground fault occur more often.
 11. Explain the general procedure for troubleshooting.
 12. Draw a sketch explaining detection of ground fault using a test lamp.




dharm
d:N-MachMac10-1.pm5   241
Static Control of Machines


   11.1 INTRODUCTION
An industrial control system, whether it is magnetic control or static control can be divided
into three distinct sections viz.:
       (i) Information gathering section or input section
      (ii) Decision making section or logic section
     (iii) Actuating device section or output section
Relationship between the three sections is shown in Fig. 11.1.


                  Push buttons                  Magnetic
                  Limit switches                 relays                 Electric motor
                  Temp switches                                            solenoid
                  Pressure switches                                         valves
                                                  OR
                  Photo cells
                Information gathering            Solid                Actuating devices
                       section                   state
                                                digitial
                                                devices



                                         Decision making section

           Fig. 11.1 Relationship between the three sections of an industrial control system
       It is clear from Fig. 11.1 that information gathering section components like push buttons,
limit switches, pressure switches etc. and actuating devices like motors and solenoid valves
are common in both types of control i.e., static or magnetic. The components in the decision-
making section are, however, different. In magnetic control circuits, magnetic relay constitute
the decision making elements. In static control, decision-making section consists of solid state/
digital devices. These devices have no moving parts and no contacts. Digital devices used in
decision-making are:
                  AND Gate               Memory
                  OR Gate                Delay Elements or Timers
                  NOT Gate               Registers
                  NAND Gate              Counters
                  NOR Gate
                                                  242
STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES                                                                       243

         It is known that in electromagnetic control, relay contacts have only two possibilities
i.e., they can either be closed or open. Similarly in digital or static control there are two conditions
or states. These two states are the two voltage levels, high or low. The two voltage levels are
represented by binary digits 0 and 1. When 0 represents a low voltage and 1 represents a high
voltage, it is known as positive logic. When 0 represents a high voltage and 1 represents a low
voltage, it is known as negative logic. We will confine only to positive logic in the rest of the
chapter. The above mentioned form of reasoning is derived from Boolean algebra which was
developed by an Englishman named George Boole in the last century. It was used at that time
as a way of expressing statements that could be either true or false. It thus follows from the
above that the two states, high voltage and low voltage represented by digits 1 and 0 in solid
state logic circuits correspond to closed and open condition of relay contacts.
         Digital devices were originally made using discrete combinations of diodes, transistors
and resistors on a board. Now these are available as integrated circuits in a single chip of semi-
conductor material. Digital devices were first fabricated using resistor transistor logic (RTL)
followed by diode transitor logic (DTL). These logic elements are not much in use now. Now a
days logic gates and devices are made using transistor logic, known as TTL logic. TTL logic
elements operate on 5 volts. A voltage level of + 5 volts is considered as a high level voltage and
that of 0 volts as a low level voltage. Another type of logic frequently used in industry is high
transit logic (HTL). This is used because it ignores the voltage spikes and drops caused by
starting and switching of induction devices. HTL generally operates on 15 volts.
         Another type of logic which has become very popular is CMOS which stands for
complementary-symmetry metal oxide semi-conductor. The advantage of this logic is that it
has a very high input impedance and it requires very less power to operate. This logic also has
certain disadvantages. One major disadvantage is that it is very sensitive to voltage, sometimes
even the static charge of a person’s body touching the IC can destroy it. People who work with
CMOS logic often use a ground strap which straps around the wrist like a bracelet. This strap
prevents static charge from building up on the body. Another limitation of this logic is that
unused inputs can not be left open. Unused inputs must be connected to either a high state or
a low state.
         A control engineer need not go into the internal structure of an IC but should be
thoroughly familiar with their functions and use as components in control functions. The
objective of this chapter is to enable the students to design control circuits using digital devices.
To give an idea about the internal structure of digital devices only two devices, AND gate and
OR gate will be discussed. Before various digital gates and their applications in building up
control circuits are discussed, it will be worthwhile to compare the advantages and disadvantages
of static control with respect to magnetic control.

   11.2 ADVANTAGES OF STATIC CONTROL OVER MAGNETIC RELAY
        CONTROL
       (i) The first and very important advantage is the more reliable and maintenance free
           operation. Although nowdays with high quality materials available, relays can be
           designed for a longer trouble free operation yet their life expectancy is shorter as
           compared to static switches. This is because relays have moving mechanical link-
           ages and contacts which are subject to wear. Relay coils draw fairly high inrush
           currents to produce the necessary force to move the linkages. This puts stress on the
           coil wire and insulation. This limits the life expectancy of relay to a few million
           operations. Relay parts are exposed to atmosphere and therefore dirt particles inter-
           fere with proper movement of relay parts. Also, the chemicals in atmosphere can
           damage coil insulation and contacts.



dharm
d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5    243
244                                                                         CONTROL OF MACHINES

           Solid state gates on the other hand are completely independent of number of opera-
           tions performed and thus have unlimited life expectancy. They have no moving parts
           and no appreciable inrush current. They are impervious to atmosphere dusts or dirts
           as they come in sealed packages. Thus, if these devices are protected against ther-
           mal shocks and over currents, they will last almost forever and will require no main-
           tenance.
        (ii) Static switches provide much higher speed of operation which is often desirable in
             modern machines and processes. Relays operate in milli seconds whereas, most solid
             state devices operate in micro seconds or nano seconds. Thus a solid state gate is at
             least 1000 times as fast as a relay.
       (iii) Static switching provides comparatively simpler circuit design than relays for com-
             plicated processes, which must sense and evaluate many factors and conditions. This
             is due to the basic difference between a static switch and a magnetic relay. Static
             switch is a multiple input and single output device whereas a relay is a single input
             multiple output device. The above will become clear on studying various static
             switches.
       (iv) Static switches can be used in explosive environment as they switch ON and OFF
            without sparking. If relays have to be used in explosive environments they have to
            be housed in expensive airtight enclosures.
        (v) A solid state logic element is much more compact than a relay. Thus for extensive
            control circuits, which require hundreds of relays, use of solid state logic will require
            much less space as compared to relay logic circuit.
      (vi) Solid state logic is cheaper than an equivalent relay circuit for an extensive control
           circuit. A solid state logic circuit requires extra dc power supply, signal converter
           and output amplifier. However, the low ‘per gate cost’ over-rides the expenses due to
           the above mentioned equipments for extensive control circuits that contain hun-
           dreds of decision-making elements.
    (viii) Solid state logic gates consume very less power as compared to relays. Therefore, for
           extensive circuits there can be an appreciable saving of energy.

   11.3 DISADVANTAGES OF STATIC CONTROL OVER MAGNETIC RELAY
        CONTROL
        (i) Static circuits can malfunction due to noise signals. Separate circuits are to be provided
            to safeguard against these. Relays on the other hand are not prone to noise pick up.
        (ii) A static circuit is not suitable for a small control circuit as it requires separate dc
             power supply, signal converters for interfacing information, sensing devices, and
             amplifiers for interfacing output devices. This increases the cost of the circuit. Relay
             circuits are cheaper and simpler for small control circuits.
       (iii) Solid state logic gates do not work well at high temperature. In an industrial envi-
             ronment, where temperature is generally high, some type of cooling, like fan cooling
             or air-conditioning, of the panel is required. This negates the advantage of energy
             conservation and reliability. In comparison to this, relays work well at high ambient
             temperatures.
       (iv) Alteration or modification in an existing static circuit is dificult to accomplish as
            compared to magnetic relay circuit.
        (v) Trouble shooting is difficult in static control circuits as compared to relay circuits.




dharm
d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5    244
STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES                                                                245

       Two sets of symbols are used to represent logic gates. They are USASI symbols and
NEMA symbols. USASI symbols, which are more common, will be used in this chapter. Control
diagrams using logic gates have been drawn in the ladder form of diagram. In these, control
supply is represented by two vertical lines spaced apart. Control circuit is built between these
two lines in form of horizontal rungs. These rungs resemble the rungs of a ladder and therefore
these diagrams are known as ladder type diagrams. This is the universal procedure for making
diagram using logic gates. For the sake of symmetry, in this chapter, relay circuits have also
been drawn in ladder form. (Although in previous chapters the relay circuits have been drawn
in the other form). In earlier chapters the control supply was represented by two horizontal
lines and the circuit was built up in rungs from left to right. Some of the magnetic control
symbols used in this chapter are different from that used in previous chapters as they are
more suitable in ladder form of diagram. Another purpose of using different symbols is to
familiarise the student with these symbols as these symbols are also widely used in Indian
Industries. Various magnetic components which have been shown different in this chapter are
tabulated in Table 11.1. Static switch symbols will be discussed as we proceed to study various
switches.
                  Table 11.1 USASI symbols for some common control components

 S.No.   Component                                        Conventional Symbol    USASI Symbol


   1.    Relay/Contactor coil



   2.    Normally Open (NO) Relay/Contactor contact




   3.    Normally Closed (NC) Relay/Contactor contact




   4.    Time Delay relay coil




   5.    Limit Switch (NO) contact




   6.    Limit Switch (NC) contact



   11.4 EXPLANATION OF DIFFERENT GATES
11.4.1 AND Gate
The symbol for AND Gate is shown in Fig. 11.2 (a), it has two or more inputs but only one
output. In an AND Gate output signal is obtained when all the input signals are present. Thus,
output Y will be high i.e., 1 when both input A and B are high i.e.,1, if any of the input is low



dharm
d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5   245
246                                                                             CONTROL OF MACHINES

i.e.,0, output will also be low i.e., 0. This relationship between inputs and output for a two
input gate is tabulated in truth table shown in Fig. 11.2 (b).

                                                A       B       Y
                                                0       0       0                                A
        A
                                Y
                                                0       1       0
        B                                                                                        B
                                                1       0       0
                                                                             A    B
                   (a)                                                                       Y
                                                1       1       1

                                                     (b)                              (c)

             Fig.11.2 (a) Symbol (b) Truth table (c) Equivalent relay circuit for an AND gate
       The equivalent relay circuit for AND Gate as shown in Fig. 11.2 (c), consists of two
normally open contacts of relay A and B connected in series. In this circuit when both the
relays A and B are de-energised there will be no supply at point Y. If any of the relays A or B is
energised, even then, there will be no supply at point Y. When both the relays are energised
only then there will be supply at point Y, as both relay contacts in series are closed. These
conditions are analogous to the conditions shown in truth table of AND Gate, if it is assumed
that an energised relay corresponds to high input i.e., 1 and a de-energised relay corresponds
to low input i.e., 0.
11.4.2 OR Gate
OR gate symbol for two inputs is shown in Fig. 11.3 (a) In OR gate output is obtained if there
is signal at any one of the inputs. This means, output Y is high if any of the input A and B is
high. This relationship between inputs and outputs are tabulated in truth table of Fig. 11.3 (b).
The equivalent relay circuit for OR gate shown in Fig. 11.3 (c) consists of two normally open
contacts of relay A and B connected in parallel. When both the relays are de-energised output
Y will be zero. When any one of the relays is energised there will be output Y due to closing of
either contact A or B. When both the relays are energised, again there will be supply at Y.
Assuming that energised relay corresponds to high input i.e., 1, de-energised relay corresponds
to low input i.e., 0, these conditions of relays and output Y are found analogous to conditions in
the truth table.


                                                                                                 A
                                            A       B       Y
                                            0       0       0                                    B
                                                                                  A
        A
                               Y            0       1       1
        B                                   1       0       1
                                                                                  B          Y
                   (a)                      1       1       1

                                                    (b)                                (c)

              Fig.11.3 (a) Symbol (b) Truth table (c) Equivalent relay circuit for an OR Gate
      Some students may be interested to know the internal circuitry of these gates. To give
an idea how transistors are used to build gates, only AND and OR gates will be discussed.
Internal circuitry for these gates have been shown in Figs. 11.4 (a) and (b).
      In Fig.11.4, dc supply is used for operating these circuits. High voltage here refers to
+ 5 V while low voltage is 0 volts.



dharm
d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5    246
STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES                                                                    247

       In the AND gate circuitry when any of inputs A, B or C is low the voltage at the base of
transistor Q1 is low (0) as most of the + 5 volts drops across resistance R1. Transistor Q1 is
therefore in cut off state. Thus voltage at collector of transistor Q1 i.e., at point X is high and
this voltage is coupled to the base of transistor Q2. Thus base of transistor Q2 is at higher
voltage with respect to its emitter. Transistor Q2 therefore conducts and is in saturation state.
Voltage at point Y on the collector side of transistor Q2 is therefore low. When all the inputs A,
B and C are + 5 V high i.e., + 5 volts, the voltage at the base of transistor Q1 is also high and
therefore transistor Q1 conducts, and the voltage at point X or at the base of transistor Q2 is
low, thus it does not conduct. If Q2 is cut off then voltage at point Y is high (+ 5 V). Thus it is
clear that output Y will be high (+ 5 V) only when all the inputs are also high.
       Now, referring to the OR gate circuitry, when any of the input is high, the base of
transistor Q1 is also high with respect to its emitter, as a result the transistor conducts. This
leads to low voltage at point X and thus transistor Q2 remains cut off. As Q2 is cut off, the
voltage level at point Y is high. If all the inputs are low then Q1 will be cut off and Q2 will
conduct. This gives low voltage at Y. Thus we see that this circuit fulfills the conditions described
for an OR gate.

                                                       + 5V




                                            R1                 R2              R3


                                                          X
                        A                                                               Y

                        B
                                                              Q1              Q2
                        C



                                                 (a)

                                                       + 5V



                                                              R1              R2

                                                         X
                            A                                                           Y

                            B

                            C                                 Q1             Q2



                                                 (b)

                                Fig.11.4 (a) AND gate circuitry (b) OR gate circuitry
       In practice the high and low values for static devices are not rigidly fixed at + 5 V or
0 volts. For example with 7400 series TTL devices any input voltage between 0 and 0.8 V is
considered low and any input voltage between 2 and 5 V is considered a high input. This is so,




dharm
d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5       247
248                                                                                        CONTROL OF MACHINES

because voltage within these ranges can force the output to change states. Similarly low output
from a 7400 series device may be from 0 to 0.4 V and in the high output value may be from 2.4
to 5 V. In other words, output voltage, as small as 2.5 V, is considered high as this voltage can
drive the other TTL circuits.
11.4.3 NOT Gate or Inverter
This is the simplest of all gates. It has one input and one output. The output is inverted or
becomes opposite of the input. If input is high (1) then output is low (0) and if input is low (0)
then output is high (1). The symbols, truth table, and equivalent relay circuits are shown in
Fig. 11.5.

                                                    A             Y                                     A

                                                    0             1
        A                          Y                                                    A
                                                    1             0
                                                                                                  Y
                       (a)                              (b)                                       (c)

               Fig.11.5 (a) Symbol (b) Truth table (c) Equivalent relay circuit for a NOT Gate
       Equivalent relay circuit is a single normally closed (NC) contact of relay A. When relay
A is in de-energised state there will be output at Y, whereas when it is energised, there is no
output at Y. If we compare these conditions with the truth table it will be found that the
conditions are analogous.
11.4.4 NOR Gate
NOR gate is equivalent to connecting a NOT gate to the output of an OR Gate. This is depicted
in Fig. 11.6 (a). The symbol for NOR gate is obtained by connecting a bubble to the OR gate
symbol as shown in Fig. 11.6 (b). Comparing the truth table of a NOR gate with the truth table
of an OR gate it will be observed that for the same inputs, the output of NOR gate is the
inverse of the output of OR gate. The equivalent relay circuit for NOR gate consists of two
normally closed (NC) contacts of relay A and B connected in series as shown in Fig.11.6 (d).
When both relays A and B are de-energised, there is an output at Y. If any or both the relays
are energised, there is no output at Y. These conditions are analogous to the conditions shown
in truth table. If an energised relay corresponds to a high input, a de-energised relay corresponds
to a low input.

              A                                               A
                                                                                                    Y
              B                                               B

                             (a)                                          (b)

                   A          B        Y
                                                                                              A
                   0          0        1

                   0          1        0                                                      B

                   1          0        0
                                                                                    Y
                   1          1        0
                                                                      A   B
                             (c)                                              (d)
            Fig. 11.6 (a) and (b) Symbols (c) Truth table (d) Equivalent relay circuit for NOR gate




dharm
d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5        248
STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES                                                                                     249

11.4.5 NAND Gate
NAND gate is equivalent to an AND gate followed by a NOT gate. This is depicted in Fig. 11.7 (a).
The symbol for NAND gate is obtained by connecting a bubble to the AND gate symbol as
shown in Fig.11.7 (b). On comparing the truth table of NAND gate shown in Fig.11.7 (c) and
the truth table of AND gate, it is found that for same input conditions the output for NAND
gate is inverse of the output of AND gate. The equivalent relay circuit for NAND gate consists
of two normally closed contacts (NC) of relays A and B connected in parallel as shown in
Fig. 11.7 (d). When both relays A and B are de-energised or any one of them is de-energised
there will be output at terminal Y. When both the relays are energised there will be no output
at terminal Y. These conditions are analogous to the truth table conditions where an energised
relay corresponds to high input and a de-energised relay corresponds to a low input.

          A                                             A
                                                  Y                                                 Y

          B                                             B

                                (a)                                       (b)

                                                                                          A
                A       B                 Y

                0       0                 1                                               B

                0       1                 1                           A

                1       0                 1                                           Y
                1       1                 0
                                                                      B
                        (c)                                                     (d)

         Fig. 11.7 (a) and (b) Symbols (c) Truth table (d) Equivalent relay circuit for NAND gate
11.4.6 Exclusive OR gate
This gate gives an output only when either of its input is high (not when all the inputs are
high). Symbol, truth table, and equivalent relay circuit for this gate are shown in Fig. 11.8.

                                                                                                            A
                                              A   B      Y
                                                                                                            B
                                              0   0      0

                                              0   1      1                            A         A
A
                                      Y                                                                     Y
                                              1   0      1
B
                                              1   1      0                            B                 B
              (a)
                                                  (b)                                     (c)

           Fig. 11.8 Symbol, truth table, and equivalent relay circuit for an Exclusive OR gate
       On comparing truth table of an Exclusive OR gate with an OR gate it is found that first
three conditions are same while the fourth is different. Equivalent relay circuit consists of two
normally open (NC) contacts of relay A and B connected in parallel followed by normally closed
(NC) contacts of same relays connected in parallel. On comparing the conditions of relay circuits
with truth table of logic gate it is found that they are analogous.



dharm
d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5         249
250                                                                                   CONTROL OF MACHINES

   11.5 SOLID STATE TIMER
Solid state timers are built using transistors and resistor-capacitor charging circuit. A standard
solid state timer symbol shown in Fig. 11.9 (a) is analogous to an ON delay type timer with a
normally open delayed contact. The standard timer can be modified as shown in Fig. 11.9 (b),
(c) and (d) to give functions which are analogous to the function of ON and OFF delay timer
relays. Input output waveforms, shown besides each timer, describe the operation of a timer.
While comparing action of a solid state timer with an analogous relay contact it is to be kept in
mind that a high output corresponds to closed condition of relay contact, while a low output
corresponds to an open contact condition.

                                                                                       Equivalent
                                                               Waveform                time delay
                                Symbol                   Vin                          relay contact
                                                                                  t
                 Input   Vin             Output Vout
                                  T                                  Time delay
                                                        Vout

                                                                    (a)           t


                                                         Vin
                                                                                  t
                Vin                              Vout          td
                                  T
                                                        Vout
                                                                    (b)           t

                                                         Vin
                                                                                  t
                Vin                              Vout          td
                                  T                     Vout


                                                                    (c)           t

                                                         Vin

                Vin                              Vout          td
                                                        Vout

                                                                    (d)

                  Fig.11.9 Solid state timer and their input-output waveforms along with
                                   analogous time delay relay contacts
       In the waveform for the standard timer shown in Fig.11.9 (a) the output voltage Vout
becomes high after a pre-set delay td from the instant the input voltage Vin becomes high. Vout
becomes low immediately as Vin becomes low. Equivalent relay contact for this timer is the
normally open (NO) delayed contact of ON delay type time delay relay. In Fig. 11.9 (b) timer
duplicates the action of normally closed (NC) delayed contact of an ON delay type time delay
relay. This is done by adding a NOT gate in the output of the standard timer circuit. The action
of timer is also represented in the waveform. In Fig. 11.9 (b) when Vin is low, Vout is high
because of NOT gate. When Vin becomes high, timer output will become high after a pre-set
delay of time td , while Vout will become low. When Vin returns to low value, Vout will return to
high value. This action of timer is analogous to normally closed (NC) delayed contact of ON-
delay type time delay relay.




dharm
d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5     250
STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES                                                                251

        Modified timer shown in Fig. 11.9 (c) is analogous to a normally open (NO) delayed
contact of an OFF-delay type time delay relay. Recollect that in off-delay timer when timer coil
is initially energised, its normally open contact closes immediately. The contact opens after a
pre-set delay from the instant when timer coil is de-energised. It is to be observed that the
waveform depicting the action of solid state timer in Fig. 11.9 (c) is analogous to the above
mentioned action of normally open contact of an OFF-delay timer. When Vin is high, timer
input is low, therefore timer output is also low thus giving a high Vout. When Vin goes low due
to input NOT gate, the timer input goes high. Vout remains high as timer output is still low.
After a pre-set delay of time td, when timer output goes high the Vout goes low due to the NOT
gate. This is analogous to the action of normally open contact of an OFF delay timer. Similarly,
the modified timer circuit and its associated waveforms can be shown analogous to normally
closed (NC) delayed of an OFF-delay time relay.

   11.6 MEMORY ELEMENTS (OFF-RETURN TYPE)
The well known flip-flop circuits can be used as memory elements in the control circuits. Flip
flop memory is an off-return memory i.e. memory is washed away when control supply fails.
Its equivalent relay circuit is the widely used holding circuit or sealing three wire control
circuit. The simplest off-return memory element used is the RS flip flop.
       Circuit for an RS flip is shown in Fig.11.10. In this circuit when control input S is made
high, transistor T1 is saturated, while T2 is cut off. Thus output at terminal Q is high while at
Q is low.

                                                         + 5V




                                        5 KW                             5 KW



                            –
                            Q                                                        Q


                                   T1                                           T2
                                               100 KW           100 KW




                        S
                                  100 KW

                        R
                                  100 KW

                        Fig. 11.10 Circuit for RS Flip-flop using discrete components

     Output at Q and Q remains the same even when S goes low. When control input R is
made high, it will saturate transistor T2 while T1 will be cut off. The output will thus change
states. The output becomes low at Q and high at Q . This output condition is retained even
when R goes to low. Applying a high input to S is called the setting mode, and applying a high
input to R is called the resetting mode. When both S and R are low, there is no change in the




dharm
d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5       251
252                                                                                                          CONTROL OF MACHINES

output, as transistors remain in their previous states. This condition is called inactive mode
because there is no change. when both S and R are high, the output is unpredictable and this
condition is called a race condition. This input condition is forbidden. The general symbol,
truth table and equivalent relay circuit for an RS flip-flop are shown in Fig. 11.11. The asterisk
mark in the truth table denotes the race condition or forbidden input.

                                                                                  R       S              Q              Comments

                                                                                  0       0          NC                 No change
                         S             Q
                                                                                  0       1              1                 Set
                                       –
                         R             Q                                          1       0              0                Reset
                                                                                                                        Race
                                                                                  1       1              *           (Forbidden)
                              (a)                                                                  (b)

                                                    S                     R
                                                                                      CR




                                               CR               CR
                                                                                  Q


                                                                                  –
                                                                                  Q
                                                                CR
                                                                    (c)

            Fig. 11.11 (a) Symbol (b) Truth table (c) Equivalent relay circuit for a RS flip flop
      RS flips are no longer manufactured using discrete components as shown in Fig. 11.10.
Instead, they are manufactured using NOR or NAND gates as shown in Fig. 11.12.
                                                                              R
                 R                                                                                                  Q
                                                                Q



                                                                                                                    –
                                                                                                                    Q
                                                                –             S
                 S                                              Q


                     R             S       Q         Comment                      R   S       Q          Comments

                                                    No change                     0                         Race
                     0             0       NC                                         0       *
                                                                                                         (Forbidden)
                     0             1       1             Set                      0   1       1               Set

                     1             0       0            Reset                     1   0       0              Reset

                     1             1       *           Race                       1   1       NC         No change
                                                    (Forbidden)

                         Fig. 11.12 RS flip-flops using NOR gates and NAND gates




dharm
d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5        252
STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES                                                                        253

        On comparing the truth tables of both types of flip flops it is found that inactive and race
conditions for the two types are exactly opposite. Therefore to avoid using the forbidden inputs,
it is essential to know the type of flip flop being used.
11.6.1 Clocked RS Flip Flop
Clocked RS flip flop has an extra terminal called clock terminal. This provision helps to pervent
the flip flop from changing state until the right time is determined by the clock pulse. Whenever
it is required to change the state of flip flop according to the state of inputs (S, R) a square
wave is sent to the clock terminal. Flip flop responds to its S and R inputs only when clock
pulse switches a transition from high to low or vice-versa.
       A positive edge triggered flip flop responds to its static inputs (S, R) when the clock line
makes a transition from low to high i.e., during the rising edge of a square pulse. A negative
edge triggered flop flop responds to its static inputs S and R when its clock line makes a
transition from high to low i.e., during the falling edge of a square wave. Edge triggering is
used to prevent oscillations in the flip flop. In this chapter all flip flops are assumend to be
negative edge triggered. The symbol and truth table for this flip flop is shown in Fig. 11.13.

                                                        CK   S   R     Q     Comment
                                                             ×   ×   Last
                                                        0                    No change
                                                                     state
                               S          Q                          Last
                                                        1    ×   ×           No change
                                                                     state
                               CK                            1   0     1        Set
                                          –                  0   1     0       Reset
                               R          Q                            *
                                                             1   1   Race    Forbidden
                                    (a)
                                                                     (b)

            Fig. 11.13 Schematic symbol for a negative edge triggered clocked RS Flip flop
       The small circle outside the box in front of clock terminal CK is the general digital
symbol used for distinguishing a negative edge triggered clocked device from a positive edge
triggered clocked device. In the truth table, a downward pointing arrow ↓ denotes a negative
going transition from high to low, (×) denotes any state, high or low.
11.6.2 JK Flip Flop
The most widely used flip flop is the JK flip flop. It has two inputs just like the RS flip flop, but
the inputs are referred to as J and K. The action of JK flip flop is quite similar to RS flip flop,
the only difference being that JK flip flop has what is called a toggling mode.

                                                        CK   J   K     Q     Comment
                                                                     Last
                                                         0   ×   ×           No change
                                                                     state
                          J               Q                  ×   ×   Last
                                                         1                   No change
                                                                     state
                               CK                            1   0     1       Set
                                          –                  0   1     0      Reset
                          K               Q
                                                                      Changed Toggle
                                   (a)                       1   1
                                                                       states
                                                                       (b)

          Fig. 11.14 Schematic symbol and truth table for a negative edge triggered JK flip flop




dharm
d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5    253
254                                                                                   CONTROL OF MACHINES

      Toggles means switching opposite state. The schematic symbol and truth table for a
negative edge triggered JK flip flop is shown in Fig. 11.14.
       The inactive, set mode and reset mode are similar to RS flip flop except that input
terminals are designated as J and K. Flip flop is in toggling mode when J and K are both high
and it is possible to set or reset the flip flop depending on the current state of the output. If Q
is high, the lower gate passes a reset trigger on the next negative clock edge. On the other
hand when Q is low, the upper gate passes a set trigger on the next negative clock edge. Either
way, Q changes to the compliment of the last state. Therefore, J = 1 and K = 1 means that flip
flop will toggle on the next clock edge. Many JK flip flops have preset (PR) and clear (CL) static
inputs which override the clocked inputs J and K i.e., they have the first priority. Preset and
clear have active low states. This means that the signal at preset and clear terminals are
normally high, and taken low temporarily to preset or clear the circuit. When preset goes low
the Q output goes high and stays there, no matter what the J and K and clock (CLK) inputs
are doing. The output will remain high as long as preset is low. Therefore, the normal procedure
in presetting is to take the preset low temporarily, then return it to high. Similarly for clear
function, clear signal is made low to reset the flip flop, then taken back to high to allow the
circuit to operate. The schematic symbol and truth table for JK flip flop with preset and clear
function are shown in Fig. 11.15.


                                               Preset   Clear   CK    J    K    Q       Comment

                                                 0       0      ×    ×     ×    *       Forbidden
                                                                               Race
                                                 0       1      ×    ×     ×    1          Set
                    J        PR    Q                     0      ×    ×     ×    0         Reset
                                                 1
                                                                     ×     ×   Last     No change
                        CK                       1       1      0
                                                                               state
                                   –                                           Last
                    K        CL    Q             1       1      1    ×     ×            No change
                                                                               state
                                                 1       1            1    0     1         Set
                                                 1       1            0    1     0        Reset
                             (a)
                                                                     (b)

                        Fig. 11.15 Schematic symbol and truth table for a JK flip flop
                                       with preset and clear function
       There are other types of flip flops also, like D flip flop, T flip flop, etc. In this chapter
only the RS and JK flip flops have been used for developing the control circuit.

   11.7 RETENTIVE MEMORY ELEMENT
Retentive memory element retains the conditions of output corresponding to the input last
provided, irrespective of whether control power is maintained or not. These memory elements
are built using tiny toroidal magnetic core.
      Nowadays, Charge Coupled Devices (CCD) and Magentic Bubble Memory (MBM)
techniques are also used for building retentive memory elements. Retentive memory is also
known as non-volatile memory. The schematic symbol and equivalent relay circuit for retentive
memory element is shown in Fig. 11.16.




dharm
d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5        254
STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES                                                                  255

                                                       A
                                                                                  Latch
                                                                                   coil
                                                                         LC
                                                       B
                                                                                  Unlatch
                                                                                   coil
                                                                         ULC
                        A         X                    LC
                                                                     X

                        B         Y
                                                                     Y
                            (a)
                                                               (b)

             Fig. 11.16 Symbol and Equivalent relay circuit for a retentive memory element

       Relay equivalent for retentive memory is the mechanically held or permanent magnet
latch type relay. In the memory element when input A = 1 (high) and B = 0 (Low), the output
X is high (1) and Y is low (0). This output state is maintained even when control supply is
restored after a failure. When input states change i.e., A = 0 and B = 1, then output X becomes
low (0) and Y becomes high (1). Considering the relay circuit for analogous operation it is
observed that closing of contact A (equivalent to A = 1) will energise latch coil (LC), giving
output at X through closing of its normally open (NO) contact. Once the latch coil is energised,
it remains latched even when control supply fails. Supply at X can be cut off by dropping the
relay. Relay drops when its mechanical latch is disengaged or the core is demagnetised by
energising another coil i.e., ULC. It is clear from Fig. 11.16 that coil ULC is energised when
contact B closes.
        This is equivalent to A = 0 and B = 1 for the static element. Both A and B cannot be high
as it is the forbidden input and leads to unpredictable output (Race condition).

   11.8 DEVELOPMENT OF LOGIC CIRCUITS
Digital logic elements and their circuitry can be understood better by comparing them with
their equivalent relay circuits. However, once the fundamentals of logic design are understood,
one should try to design the circuit directly using digital elements, instead of first developing
the circuit with relays and then converting it into digital circuitry. Developing circuit directly
in digital logic will avoid wastage of time and labour. No universal theory can be given on how
to approach the circuit design as circuit details vary considerably from job to job. Inspection
and common sense are the most important tools for designing the control circuits. However, a
few suggestions are given here on how to approach the design of logic circuit for a specific
application. Design work is greatly simplified if the following steps are followed:
       (1) Study the various machine operations and write them in their proper sequence.
       (2) Identify the control devices used for controling each operation. Write down the relation
           between control devices and resulting operation in simple English logic statements.
       (3) Draw logic diagram of each statement by translating the word picture of statement
           into logic element block diagram.
       (4) Combine the individual logic sequence to form a complete control circuit.
       (5) Inspect the diagram, minimise circuits and save devices by simplifying circuits.




dharm
d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5       255
256                                                                             CONTROL OF MACHINES

       To start with the three wire holding sealing control circuit which has so frequently been
used in the study of magnetic controls is taken. This circuit is shown in Fig. 11.17 (a). Equivalent
digital logic circuit for holding/sealing function are shown in Figs. 11.17 (b), (c) and (d). The
same function is designed in three different ways by using different logic elements like OR
gate, AND gate, and MEMORY element. At this stage there is no need of explaining the first
circuit as the reader is already familiar with relay circuits.

                        1                                                  2
                                           Start
                                                                     M
                                  Stop
                                            M


                                          (a)



                                                                OA
                                  Start
                                                AND                      M

                                  Stop
                                          (b)


                                                               OA
                                           S          Q                  M


                                                      –
                                           R          Q

                                          (c)




                                             OR




                                                                 AND




                                          (d)

                   Fig. 11.17 Development of a simple logic circuit for holding funtion

       Now refer to the logic diagram in Fig.11.17 (b), one input is always provided to the AND
gate through STOP-button. When START-button is pressed, the second and final input to
AND element is provided and output is obtained. Once an output is obtained, the internal feed
back loop maintains the input even though the START-button is released. This is equivalent to
holding or sealing function of Fig.11.17 (a). When the STOP-button is pressed, AND gate loses
one input and so, the output goes to the low (O) value and the contactor M is de-energised.
Observe that an amplifier (OA) is used in between output of the AND gate and contactor M.




dharm
d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5       256
STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES                                                                  257

This amplifier has been used because output of AND gate is a low voltage dc and can not
directly energise the output devices like contactor, solenoid, etc.
       In Fig. 11.17 (c) an RS flip flop has been used for obtaining a holding circuit. As STOP-
button is always closed, there is always a low input at terminal R of flip flop due to a NOT gate
in series with the STOP-button. When START-button is pressed, input at terminal S becomes
high and flip flop is set. A high output appears at terminal Q which energises contactor M.
Output Q remains high even when input S goes to low value due to release of START-button.
When contactor M is to be de-energised or sealing of the circuit is to be broken, the STOP-
button is pressed. This applies a high input at terminal R of the flip flop and it gets reset.
Output Q becomes low and contact M gets de-energised. Another holding circuit can be built
using OR gate and AND gate as shown in Fig. 11.7 (d).
       An important difference between a relay circuit shown in Fig.11.17 (a) and a digital
logic circuit shown in Figs. 11.17 (b), (c) and (d) is that in a relay circuit, current flow can be
traced from line 1, through the control devices, contactor coil and back to line 2 and is easy to
understand. On the other hand, a digital logic circuit is only a block diagram of the control
functions of the circuit. In the logic circuit actual wiring is omitted and only symbolic
representation is done. The logic diagram, therefore, does not represent the actual circuit. The
common bus to which all input and output voltages are referred to is also omitted so as to avoid
unnecessary cluttering of circuit. Also, it adds nothing to the information given by the logic
diagram.
       In the above discussed circuits, pilot devices like push buttons have been shown connected
directly to the logic elements. However, in practice they are connected to the digital elements
through signal converters as shown in Fig. 11.18.


                                                                    OA
                 110 V
                   or                               AND                         M
                 220 V

                                  Signal
                                 converter

                               Fig.11.18 Logic circuit with signal converters
        Logic elements are low voltage low power devices. They operate at say + 5 V dc (TTL).
The control components may be even 500 metres away from the circuit. If the push buttons or
limit switches in control ciruits are directly connected through logic elements, there will be
appreciable voltage loss. Therefore, the practice is to feed high voltage i.e., 110 V and 220 V ac
to the sensing device and then convert back to low dc voltage by signal converters for feeding
to digital logic elements. On the output side, output devices also work on high voltage. Therefore,
the output from logic elements is amplified and then fed to these devices.
      Before control circuits are discussed, it will be worthwhile to stydy an example on how
the specifications for a control operation are first written in logic statments in English, and
then converted into graphical logic diagrams.
      The specifications for a control circuit are as follows:
       A contactor coil M is to be energised whenever a normally open push button PB1 is
pressed or whenever both limit switch LS1 and temperature switch T1 are closed and extreme
limit switch LS2 and extreme temeperature switch T2 are open.




dharm
d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5    257
258                                                                              CONTROL OF MACHINES

      The first step in developing a logic circuit is to convert the above specifications into logic
statements. The first statement is:
       Contactor M will be energised when PB1 or LS1 and T1 are closed. The above statement
is translated into graphical picture as shown in Fig. 11.19 (a). The inputs from LS1 and T1 are
ANDed and then ORed with inputs from PB1 in the diagram.
                               PB1
                                                                        OA
                                    Signal                        OR          M
                                   converter
                         LS1

                                                     AND


                              T1
                                                (a)


                         LS2

                                                             OR

                              T2
                                               (b)


                               PB1
                                                                        OA
                                                                  OR          M

                         LS1

                                                       AND


                              T1

                        LS2
                                                           OR

                              T2
                                                (c)

                               PB1
                                                                        OA
                                                                  OR          M



                         LS1                           AND


                              T1

                        LS2
                                                           NOR

                              T2
                                                (d)

                                    Fig. 11.19 Development of logic circuit



dharm
d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5   258
STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES                                                                      259

      The second statement is: Statement 1 will be true only if LS2 and T2 are open. The
graphical picture for second statement is obtained by ORing inputs from LS2 and T2 followed
by a NOT element as shown in Fig. 11.19 (b).
      The next step is to combine the circuits for the above two statements. This is done as
shown in Fig. 11.19 (c). Further, next step is to simplify the circuit, if possible. In this case it is
done by using a NOR gate instead of an OR gate followed by a NOT gate. The last step is to
analyse the circuit whether it works according to the specifications. According to Fig.11.19 (d),
when PB1 is pressed, it sends a signal to OR gate through its signal converter. There is an
output from OR gate, which is fed through an amplifier for energisation of contactor M.
       If LS1 and T1 are both closed, there are two inputs at the AND gate. The third input is
provided by the inputs from LS2 and T2. If these two are open, there is no input to the NOR
element, and therefore it will have an output which is the third input to the AND gate. When
all the three inputs are present at the AND element it will have an output. The output of AND
gate provides an input to the OR element and thus there is an output for energising contactor M.

   11.9 INPUT DEVICES FOR SOLID STATE LOGIC
In addition to signal converters mentioned in last section, another input device used in series
with pilot and sensing device is the bounceless switch. It is necessary to use this because
mechanical switches never make a clean contact closing in a single action. Most of the contacts
of pilot and sensing devices are snap action type i.e., they are spring loaded. When the movable
contacts meet the stationary contact, there is often a fast bouncing action. This means, the
movable contact may make and break the contact three or four times in succession before the
switch finally closes. The action of contact bounce is shown in Fig. 11.20.

                                                        V

                                             Input
                                               to
                 DC
                                             digital
                                            element


                                                                                       t
                                                              t1                  t2

                              Fig. 11.20 Illustrates the contact bounce problem

       As a result a series of pulses are generated till the final closure of contact takes place.
Each of the pulse generated due to bounce can act as a command. As the digital elements are
very fast acting, they will respond to these commands and control circuit will malfunction. An
intermediate circuit is thus required which should not allow the bouncing action to affect the
control circuit. Bouncing of contacts, however, does not pose any problem in relay circuits as
relays are relatively slow acting devices as compared to digital logic elements. In digital circuits
the bouncing action of contacts can be prevented from effecting the control circuit by using
capacitive switch filters or Bounce eliminators.
11.9.1 Capacitive Switch Filters
A capacitive switch filter is shown connected in between a limit switch contact and a logic gate
in Fig. 11.21.




dharm
d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5   259
260                                                                              CONTROL OF MACHINES

       When the limit switch first closes, capacitor C starts getting charged through the venin
resistance of R1 and R2. As the limit switch contact stays closed only for a very short time
during the bouncing action, the capacitor does not get charged to such an appreciable value as
to trigger the logic gates. When permanent closure occurs the capacitor will get charged to the
full voltage required to turn on the digital element. This filter circuit also helps in arresting
high speed noise pulses on the load coming from the switch. The final value of voltage appearing
across the capacitor is less than the supply voltage due to the divider action of resistance R1
and R2. This, however, does not cause any problem, as digital elements can operate reliably
with an input voltage less than the full supply voltage. For example, for a TTL gate although
the high voltage signal is 5 V, it can operate with as low a voltage as 2.4 V.



                 + 5V                     R1                      Filter
                                                                 output
                                               R2
                                                          Capacitor




                 Fig. 11.21 Capacitive switch filter to eliminate effects of contact bounce

11.9.2 BOUNCE ELIMINATORS
Bounce eliminators are manufactured using gates as shown in Fig. 11.22. In bounce eliminators,
the output appears at its terminal on the first contact bounce, instead of waiting for the final
closure of limit switch contact as in capacitive filter circuits. The disadvantages of this circuit
is that it requires a double throw switch instead of a single NO contact.
       When the limit switch contact is open as shown in Fig.11.22 (a), high input is applied to
R2 and also to input 2 of NOR2. The output of NOR2 is thus low causing input 2 of NOR1 to be
low. Input 1 of NOR1 is also low because contact of the limit switch is open. Output of NOR1 is
thus high, as both its inputs are low. The output of NOR1 is then inverted to make the final
output low.


                                           1
               + 5V
                                                NOR 1
                                     R1    2




                                           1
                                                NOR 2
                                           2


                                     R2




                        Fig. 11.22 Bounce eliminator built with digital logic gates




dharm
d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5    260
STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES                                                                  261

      When the limit switch contact closes the following action takes place in the bounce
eliminator switch:
       (i) The NC contact of limit switch opens first, causing the number 2 input of NOR2 to be
           low. NOR2 does not change state as its output 1 is still high.
      (ii) The NO contact of limit switch closes momentarily on the first closure. This puts a
           momentary high pulse on input 1 of NOR1 causing its output to go low. The inverter
           drives the final output high. The NOR1 output feeds input 1 of NOR2 and, therefore,
           NOR2 now has two inputs. Its output therefore goes high which is applied to input 2
           NOR1. NOR1 now has two high inputs.
     (iii) When the NO contact of limit switch opens on first rebound, a low voltage appears at
           input 1 of NOR1, but its input 2 maintains its high voltage. Therefore NOR1 does not
           change states and the final output remains high.
      (iv) Several more bounces of limit switch contact takes place, which changes the voltage
           level of input of NOR1. However, NC contact of the limit switch does not close during
           bounces and a high input is maintained on input 2 of NOR1 from the output of NOR2.
           Thus the output of NOR1 remains steady at high value.
       (v) When the limit switch is released, the bounce eliminator reverses the above action
           resulting in one time transition of low level at the final output of the bounce elimina-
           tor switch.
11.9.3 Signal Converters
The function of a signal converter, as described earlier, is to step down a high (110 or 220 V) ac
or dc voltage fed to information gathering devices to a suitable low dc voltage for feeding to
logic elements. Brief description of different types of signal converters is given below:
       In a dc to dc signal converter, high dc voltage (110 V) from the information gathering
devices is given to a potential divider circuit. Low voltage (+ 5 or + 15 volts) is taken from the
potential divider as shown in Fig. 11.23 (a). This simple circuit can be improved by adding a
transistor circuit to the voltage divider network to make the output insensitive to electric
noise and line disturbance.
        A simple ac signal converter is shown in Fig. 11.23 (b). In this signal converter, electric
isolation is provided between high voltage input circuit and low voltage logic circuit due to
magnetic coupling provided by transformer windings. A center tapped transformer is used to
step down ac voltage from the sensing switch, a limit switch in this case. Step down voltage is
rectified and applied to a potenitial divider. The output voltage from the potentiometer is fed
to a logic element. Transistor circuit can be used so that the output is not affected due to noise
and line disturbance. The signal converter shown in Fig. 11.23 (c) uses a reed relay, to switch
on and off the output logic supply to the signal converter output line. When limit switch LS
closes, rectified dc voltage will energise realy RR. Its contact will close and switch + 5 V to the
logic gate. The reed relay, in this case can provide electric isolation between high voltage and
low dc logic circuit supply.
      As the above two types of signal converters use a capacitor to smoothen the dc voltage
from rectifier, no separate bounce eliminator is needed. The capacitor in the signal converter
takes care of the bouncing of switches and line disturbance.




dharm
d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5   261
262                                                                                 CONTROL OF MACHINES



                                        LS


                             110V dc
                                                                      Output




                                                                      To logic
                                             (a)
                                                                      ground



                                LS
                    110V
                      or                                           Cap        Output
                   220V ac



                                                                         To logic
                                               (b)                       ground

                                                                                 + 5V



                                                                RR                  RR


                    110V                                  Cap                          + 5V
                      or
                                                                                    Output
                   220V ac




                                                                                     To logic
                                                                                     ground
                                               (c)

                  Fig. 11.23 Different types of signal converters (a) dc to dc converter
                        (b) ac signal converter (c) ac converter using reed relay

       In recent years, optically coupled signal converters have become very popular due to
their light weight, low cost and more reliablility. The optically coupled signal converters work
equally well on either ac or dc high voltage signals. They are therefore also referred to as the
universal signal converters. In these converters no transformer or relay is required. One type
of opto coupled signal converters, which is built using a light emitting diode and photo transistor,
is shown in Fig. 11.24.
       When limit switch LS is open, LED does not conduct. Photo transistor is cut off, while
transistor T1 is conducting as its base to emitter is forward biased due to voltage appearing
across the photo transistor. As transistor T1 is conducting, a low voltage appears at terminal
Vout. When limit switch closes, LED will conduct and emit light which would fall on the base of
photo transistor and it would start conducting. Due to the conduction of photo transitor, the




dharm
d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5   262
STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES                                                                          263

base to emitter bias for transistor T1 falls and it goes to cut off state. When T1 is cut off, a high
voltage i.e., (+ 5 V) will appear at the output terminal Vout.

                                                                               + VCC(+ 5V)



                                                                       100 KW       1KW

                                                                                             Vout
                                L.S                                                       (+ 5V)
                 220V                                                               T1
                  A.C
                                                      LED               Photo
                                                                      transistor




                                      Fig.11.24 Opto coupled signal converter

   11.10     OUTPUT DEVICES FOR SOLID STATE LOGIC
The actuating devices like solenoids, motor starter coils etc. can not be energised directly from
gates as they are low voltage, low power devices. Thus, an output amplifier is required between
the logic gate output and the actuating devices. The purpose of the output amplifier is to
increase the low-voltage low current logic power to high voltage high current output power.
       Most of the output amplifiers are designed to drive 110 V or 220 V ac load, since most
industrial solenoid valves and starter coils are designed for this voltage. An output amplifier
using a reed relay is shown in Fig. 11.25. In this circuit, when the output from the logic circuit
is high, transistor T1 will conduct and thus relay R will operate. Its contact R will close and
energise the solenoid coil. This type of arragement provides electrical isolation between the
logic circuit and the output circuit.


                         + 5V
                          or                                        Solenoid
                         15V                      R           R                      220V
                                                                                      ac


                                                  T1
                        Output
                         from
                         logic
                        circuit



        Fig. 11.25 Output amplifier using a relay contact to control current through output device
       Modern output amplifiers are built using an SCR, triggered by a UJT. A typical design
of such output amplifier is shown in Fig. 11.26. Due to the closing of limit switch, when a high
input appears at RC potential divider, a capacitor starts charging. At a particular value of
capacitor voltage the UJT is turned on and capacitor gets discharged through it. A pulse thus




dharm
d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5       263
264                                                                                           CONTROL OF MACHINES

gets applied to the primary of a pulse transformer connected to the base of UJT. This pulse is
transferred to the secondary side of the transformer and gets applied between gate and cathode
of SCR. The SCR will trigger on and will start conducting if its anode is positive with respect to
cathode. To achieve current flow through load on both half cycles of ac voltage, a bridge rectifier
is used to provide a continuous dc supply to the SCR.

                                                    + DC
                  Input                             Logic
                   from                            supply
                   logic
                  circuit
                                  R1          R2
                                                            SCR

                                                                                                220V
                                                                                                 ac
                                        UJT
                  Capacitor




                        Fig. 11.26 Logic output amplifier using a UJT and an SCR

   11.11     SOLENOID VALVE OPERATED CYLINDER PISTON ASSEMBLY
A cylinder piston assembly is used to get to and fro motion of a machine part. It is a very
fundamental operation in any industry. Thus, before more complicated machine circuits are
discussed, it will be worthwhile to study the control circuit for solenoid valve operated cylinder
piston assembly, shown in Fig. 11.27.

                                                              Position 1          Position 2


                                                                      1 LS                 2 LS




                                                                  Valve port connections
                                                                   shown with solenoid
                        SOL                                           de-energised
                                                    Spring

                                       Tank
                                               Pressure

                   Fig. 11.27 Cylinder piston assembly operated by a solenoid valve
      A single solenoid spring return valve is used to supply fluid power to this cylinder.
Various control requirements for this cylinder piston assembly are as follows:
       Piston has to move between two extreme positions 1 and 2 determined by the locations
of limit switches 1 LS and 2 LS. The initial or starting position of piston is position 1 in which
limit switch 1 LS is actuated as shown in Fig. 11.27. On giving the starting command, the




dharm
d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5       264
STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES                                                                 265

piston should move to the right until it actuates the limit switch 2LS. Thus, at position 2, on
actuation of 2LS the piston should immediately move backward to position 1. There should
also be provision to return the piston back from any point in its forward travel (from left to
right). Control circuit shown in Fig. 11.28 fulfills all the control requirements listed above.




                              Fig. 11.28 Logic circuit for piston movement
        In this control circuit normally open (NO) contact of limit switch 1LS and normally
closed (NC) contact of limit switch 2 LS have been used. A Reverse push button is used to bring
back the piston to position 1 from any point in its forward travel. Working of the control circuit
is as follows:
        When piston is in position 1, limit switch 1LS is actuated, its normally open (NO)
contact is closed, thus providing a high signal to input terminal 2 of AND1. On pressing the
START-push button a high signal appears at terminal 1 of AND1. Its output therefore goes
high which appears at input terminal 2 of OR1. Thus, output of OR1 goes high which is fed back
to the terminal 1 of AND2. Terminals 2 and 3 of AND2 already have high signals as Reverse
push button and contact of 2LS are closed. Thus when START-push button is pressed, all three
inputs to AND2 become high and it gives a high output. This output is amplified and applied to
the solenoid valve coil. Valve shifts its spool and piston starts moving in forward direction
from left to right towards position 2. Signal from output of AND2 is fed back to terminal 1 of
OR1 for sealing, as the input at terminal 2 of OR1 will disappear as soon as START-push
button is released. Contact of limit switch 1LS will also open as soon as piston leaves the
position 1. The output of AND2 is maintained till limit switch 2 LS operates and cuts off the
input at its terminal 3. Loss of one input to AND2 brings its output low which leads to de-
energisation of the solenoid. As the solenoid valve is spring controlled the spool will come back
to its original position and the piston will move back to position 1.
       The piston can also be made to reverse at any point from its forward movement by
pressing the Reverse-push button. When the Reverse-push button is pressed the high signal at
terminal 2 of AND2 goes low which causes output of AND2 also to go low. As output of AND2
goes low, the solenoid valve is de-energised and sealing/holding of circuit is also broken. The
piston thus moves back to position 1.

   11.12     CONTROL OF THREE STAGE AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
A simple air conditioner system consists of a single compressor motor which gets switched off
when temerature of the space being controlled falls below the setting on the thermostat.
Thermostats are provided with differential setting to avoid frequent switching ON and OFF of
the compressor motor.



dharm
d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5   265
266                                                                                CONTROL OF MACHINES

       A three stage air conditioning system is used for conservation of electrical energy and
optimum utilisation of the installed capacity of the compressor. There are two compressor
motors in this system. One motor is of smaller horsepower, and the second one is of higher
horsepower rating. These motors are designated a comp. 1 and comp. 2 in this case. The system
is installed in a cinema hall for maintaining the hall temperature between 20-24° C. Depending
upon the number of viewers in the hall and the ambient atmospheric conditions, comp. 1 and
comp. 2 motors can be run in three different combinations. The three combinations described
below are also the control requirements of the air conditioning system.
       (1) Compressor 1 and compressor 2 should run when the temperature in the hall is above
           28°C.
       (2) Only compressor 2 should run if temperature in the hall rises above 24°C but is
           below 28°C.
       (3) Only compressor 1 should run if temperature in the hall is above 20°C but below 24°C.
       A pre-condition for running any compressor is that chilling water flow switch FS1 should
be closed. Chilling water flow is necessary to take away heat from the compressed cooling gas.
       Three thermostats with different settings are used for the control of compressor motors
running in three different stages described above. The three thermostats T1, T2, T3 are set at
20°C, 24°C and 28°C respectively.
       The control of three stages with three thermostats and flow switch (FS 1) of air
conditioning system can be understood from the control circuit shown in Fig. 11.29. The START-
push button, STOP-push button, and over load contacts for compressor motors have not been
shown in the circuit for sake of simplicity.
       Working of the control circuit is as follows:
       (1) When chilled water flow is maintained, flow switch FS1 will actuate and close its
           contacts. Closing of contact FS1 causes application of a high logic signal to terminal
           2 of all AND gates.
       (2) When temperature in the cinema hall is above 28°C, contacts of all the three
           thermostats T1, T2, T3 close. Closed contacts of T1 will give a high input to terminal
           1 of AND1 but closed contact of T2 will give low logic signal to terminal 3 of AND1 as
           there is a NOT gate in series. The output of AND1, therefore, becomes low.

                                                  1
                                                                                  OA
               20°C                               2    AND1         1   OR1                 C1
                       T1                                           2
                                                  3


               24°C
                       T2
                                                  1
               28°C                                    AND2
                       T3
                                                  2


                      FS1                         1                1              OA
                                                       AND2        2    OR2                 C2
                                                  2


                       Fig. 11.29 Control circuit for three stage air conditioning system




dharm
d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5       266
STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES                                                                    267

       (3) Closed contact of thermostat T3 will give a high signal to terminal 1 of AND2 while
           its other terminal 2 is already high due to closure of FS1. AND2 thus gives a high
           output which is applied to both OR1 and OR2. As one terminal each of OR1 and OR2
           is now high, their outputs are also high. Output from OR1 leads to energisation of
           contactor C1 and output from OR2 leads to energisation of contactor C2 through their
           repsective amplifiers. Thus, compressors 1 and 2 will run when temperature in the
           hall is above 28°C.
       (4) When the hall temperature is below 28°C but more than 24°C, contact of thermostat
           T3 will be open while contacts of T1 and T2 are closed. Due to open contact of T3 there
           is low signal at terminal 1 of AND2 and therfore its output is low. Output of AND1 is
           also low as closed contact of T2 gives a low signal at terminal 3 due to a NOT gate in
           series. In this case AND3 will have high output as its input terminal 1 has high
           signal from the closed contact of thermostat T2. It is to be noted that supply to terminal
           1 of AND3 is taken prior to the NOT gate. High output from AND3 goes to terminal 2
           of OR2 which then gives a high output. This output energises contactor C2 through
           the amplifier. Thus compressor 2 will run only when the temperature is above 24°C
           but below 28°C.
       (5) When temperature falls below 24°C contact of thermostat T2 opens and output of
           AND3 will then go low due to a low signal at its input terminal. The open contact of
           T2 will however give a high signal to terminal 3 of AND1 (due to the NOT gate in
           series). It will get switched ON as its terminal 1 and 2 are already high. The high
           output from AND1 then goes to terminal 1 of OR1 which then gives a high output to
           energise contactor C1. Thus, one compressor will run when temperature is below
           24°C but above 20°C. When temperature falls below 20° C, contact of thermostat T1
           also opens and terminal 1 of AND1 goes low and it is switched off. Thus compressor 1
           also stops when temperature falls below 20°C.
       Compressor 1 continues to run if temperature in the hall remains between 20-24°C. If
due to more viewers in the hall, compressor 1 is unable to maintain temperature below 24°C,
compressor 2 will be switched ON while compressor 1 will be switched off. If the load is still
more and compressor 2 alone can not cope up and temperature goes above 28°C then compressor
1 will also start to bring down the temperature.

   11.13 SPEED CONTROL OF WOUND ROTOR INDUCTION MOTOR
Let us consider a wound rotor induction motor which is to run on three different speeds. Separate
push buttons are used to select the speed of operation. The motor accelerates automatically to
the selected speed. For example, if the second speed is selected, the motor first starts running
on low speed and then accelerates to the second higher speed. If the third speed is selected, the
motor must start in first speed, accelerate to second speed and then accelerate to third speed.
The various control requirements for the control circuit are as follows:
       (1) One STOP-push button to stop the motor regardless of the speed of rotation of the
           motor.
       (2) An overload protection for the motor.
       (3) Three separate push buttons to select the first, second or third speed.
       (4) A 5 seconds time delay between acceleration from one speed to another.
       (5) If the motor is in operation and a higher speed is desired, it should be obtained by
           pushing the respective push button. On the other hand if the motor is running and a




dharm
d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5   267
268                                                                             CONTROL OF MACHINES

          lower speed is desired, the stop button should be pressed before pressing the required
          speed push button. Recall that speed control for a wound rotor motor is obtained by
          placing a resistance in the rotor circuit as shown in Fig. 11.30.

               L1       L2         L3




                                        M



                                                    2S                      1S


                                                     R2                          R1



                    Rotor




                 Fig. 11.30 Power circuit for a three speed wound rotor induction motor

       In this starter contactor M is used to connect the stator windings of motor to the supply
mains. When contactor M is energised the motor starts with all resistances in the rotor circuit,
and accelerates to its first speed. For the second higher speed, contactor 1S closes and shorts
resistance bank R1 from rotor circuit. Third speed can be obtained by closing contactor 2S
which cuts R2 also from the rotor circuit. This shorts the rotor winding terminals and the
motor operates as a squirrel cage motor at third speed. Control circuit for the above mentioned
operation is shown in Fig. 11.31.




                 Fig. 11.31 Control circuit for a three speed wound rotor induction motor




dharm
d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5        268
STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES                                                                 269

       Working of the circuit is as follows:
       (1) When push button for the lowest speed is pressed, memory element 1 goes into set
           mode, its output Q becomes high which appears at terminal 1 of OR1. Output of OR1
           thus becomes high and contactor M is energised through the amplifiers. Motor starts
           with all resistances in rotor circuit at a slow speed.
       (2) When the motor is desired to run in next higher speed, the corresponding push button
           is pressed which brings the memory element 2 in set mode. Its output appears at
           input terminal 2 of OR1 and also at terminal 1 of OR2. Output of OR1 goes high and
           energises contactor M while OR2 output goes high and appears at input terminal 2 of
           AND1. Besides energising contactor M, output of OR1 also appears at terminal 1 of
           AND1. Now both the terminals of AND1 are high, thus output of AND1 becomes high
           and timer T1 is energised. After a pre set delay, timer output goes high and energises
           contactor 1S. Energisation of 1S shorts one bank of resistance R1 from the rotor
           circuit and thus motor accelerates to second higher speed.
       (3) When the third speed push button is pressed, memory element 3 goes into set mode
           and its output goes high and appears at terminal 3 of OR1 and energises contactor
           M. Then, as described earlier, contactor 2S gets energised after a fixed delay, set by
           timer T1. When T1 has timed out its output energises contactor 1S and also appears
           at input terminal 1 of AND2. Output of AND2 goes high as its terminal 2 is already
           high due to output from memory element 3. Output of AND2 energises timer T2 and
           its output goes high after a fixed delay. This energises contactor 2S, which shorts
           resistance R2 from the rotor circuit. The motor thus accelerates to the final i.e., the
           third speed.
       (4) When STOP-push button is pressed or over load relay trips the output of NOT1 goes
           high which appears at reset terminal R of all the three memory elements and resets
           them. This leads to the dropping of all the three contactors M, 1S and 2S.

   11.14     CONTROL OF PLANER MACHINE
The machine has already been discussed in the chapter on industrial applications of magnetic
control. Here it will be shown how the same machine is controlled using digital logic elements.
Schematic representation of a planer machine is shown in Fig. 11.32.



                               Work piece
                                                          Planing tool

                              Table




                                                            Rack
                                1LS                                      2LS
                                                         Pinion


                                            Motor

                         Fig. 11.32 Schematic diagram for a Planer machine




dharm
d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5   269
270                                                                                          CONTROL OF MACHINES

        In this machine, the work piece or the job placed on the table moves to and fro by rack
and pinion arrangement mounted on the shaft of a squirrel cage motor. The cutting tool is
fixed while the job placed on the table is worked upon by movement of the table. Movement of
the table is controlled between two limits on left and right by limit switches 1LS and 2LS.
When table moves from left to right, tool works on the job while it remains ideal during right
to left motion of the table. At the end of right to left motion, tool gets feed for the next cut on
the job. Various control requirements for the machine are as follows:
       (1) The motor is to be started manually by pressing START-push button. Once the motor
           starts it is reversed automatically at the end of right or left stroke by limit switches
           2LS and 1LS.
       (2) There should be provision for jogging the motor by a Jog-push button.
       (3) If the machine table is lying in between extreme positions, machine should fail to
           start. Selection of initial direction of travel should be possible through right and left
           traverse push button, PBR and PBL.
       (4) There should be a delay in starting the motor in left to right stroke so as to allow the
           tool to get the feed for a fresh cut on the job.
       (5) The machine should stop on pressing of STOP-push button or on over-load tripping
           of motor.
       (6) Interlocking of coolant pump motor (running) should be provided as a pre-condition
           for starting of the machine.
      Control circuit for the machine adhering to the above mentioned control requirements
is shown in Fig. 11.33.

                    Start                     1
                    Stop                      2    AND1

                                                                  1 OR1
                    JOG                                            2


                         Coolant
                          pump            1
                                         2         AND2
                                         3

                    PBR                                                   1
                                                                                     OA
                                           A                  X           2   AND3        R
                                                                   T
                                         (Set)
                              1LS             B
                                    (Reset)
                                                  Retentive
                                                  memory                  1
                                                                                     OA
                    PBL                                                   2   AND4        L



                        2LS

                              Fig. 11.33 Logic control circuit for a planer machine
      There are two major sectors of this control circuit. One is the control of the starting and
stopping of the motor, and the other is the automatic reversing control.




dharm
d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5       270
STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES                                                                271

       Working of the circuit is as follow:
       (1) When START-push button is pressed, input terminal 1 of AND1 becomes high. Its
           output also goes high as its input terminal 2 is already high due to closed contact of
           STOP-push button. Output is fed back to terminal 1 for holding the output high.
       (2) Output of AND1 appears at terminal 1 of OR1 making the output of OR1 high which
           appears at terminal 1 of AND2. If motor overload relay contact is closed and coolant
           pump motor is running, then terminals 2 and 3 of AND2 also have a high signal.
           Thus all the three input terminals of AND2 are high and so its output goes high.
       (3) Output of AND2 appears at terminal 1 of AND3 and AND4. Depending upon the
           condition of memory element i.e., whether it is in set mode or in reset, either AND3
           or AND4 output will go high and will energise the respective contactor R or L. Desired
           direction of travel may however be selected by pressing the right or left traverse
           push buttons PBR or PBL before pressing the START-push button.
       (4) To understand the reversing action of circuit, it is assumed that initially the ma-
           chine table is in extreme left position so that the limit switch 1LS is in actuated
           condition and its normally open (NO) contact is closed. Thus, a high signal appears
           at terminal A of the retentive memory through closed contact of 1LS. Memory ele-
           ment gets set and its output terminal X goes high.
       (5) High output from terminal X appears at terminal 2 of AND3 after some delay set by
           the timer T while at terminal 2 of AND4, a low signal appears because of the NOT
           gate being in series with the output from X.
       (6) As both the terminals 1 and 2 of AND3 are now high, its output becomes high which
           energise motor contactor R through the amplifier. Machine table thus moves in right
           direction.
       (7) When extreme right position is reached, limit switch 2LS gets actuated. Its normally
           Open (NO) contact closes and resets the memory element. Output at terminal X goes
           low and thus terminal 2 of AND3 also becomes low. Output of AND3 therefore goes
           low and contactor R is de-energised.
          At the same time when memory element gets reset, terminal 2 of AND4 goes high
          due to a NOT gate inverting the low output from X.
       (8) Thus, due to actuation of limit switch 2LS terminal 2 and AND4 goes high while its
           terminal 1 is already high. Hence, a high output appears which energise motor con-
           tactor L through the amplifier. Motor now runs in reverse direction to move the
           table from right to left.
       (9) When the table reaches extreme left position, limit switch 1LS gets actuated and
           memory element is set and thus terminal 2 of AND4 goes low and its output becomes
           low. Contactor L is therefore de-energised. After a delay set on timer T, again con-
           tactor R is energised as output of AND3 becomes high. The to and fro motion, due to
           setting and resetting of memory elements by actuation of limit switches, continues
           till the STOP-push button is pressed or overload trips to make the terminal 1 of
           AND3 and AND4 low.
     (10) If the machine table is required to be moved slowly in steps for adjustment of the tool
          with respect to the job position then Jog-push button alongwith the required traverse
          push button PBR or PBL is used. As seen from the control circuit, Jog-push button
          output is connected to terminal 2 of OR1 and there is no feedback for holding the



dharm
d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5   271
272                                                                                  CONTROL OF MACHINES

           output of OR1. Therefore, output of OR1 remains high as long as Jog-push button is
           kept pressed. Thus the table can be moved as desired in steps by the Jog-push
           button. Students are advised to trace out the energisation of contactor R and L when
           the Jog-push button is used.

   11.15     CONTROL OF THREE CONVEYORS
A conveyor system, discussed here, consists of three conveyors used to transfer sand from silos
(large container) to the sand hopper of a mould making machine used in a foundary. The
arrangement is as shown in Fig. 11.34.


                                  Silos

                                  Silos gate
                                          Conv 1

                                                    Conv 2
                                                                              Sand hopper
                                                                 Conv 3       full limit switch




                                                                           Mould
                                                                          making
                                                                          machine

                              Fig. 11.34 Schematic diagram for three conveyors

        Sand is fed to conveyor 1 by opening the gate of silos which is operated by a pneumatic
cylinder. The gate opens only when all the three conveyors are running. Conveyor 1 dumps
sand on to conveyor 2 which in turn dumps sand onto conveyor 3. Sand from conveyor 3 falls in
the sand hopper. Conveyor can be started and stopped through the ON or OFF push button
provided near the mould making machine. Conveyors stop automatically when the sand hopper
is full. Various control requirements for this system are as follows:
       (1) ON-push button is to start all conveyor motors in sequence from 3 to 1, i.e., from the
           last to the first.
       (2) Sand gate of the silos should open automatically when all the three conveyors are
           running.
       (3) An over-load on any of the conveyors should stop all these conveyors.
       (4) When sand hopper of the machine is full, a limit switch should actuate and stop all
           the conveyors.
       (5) Stopping of the conveyors should follow the sequence 1, 2, 3 i.e., from first to last.
       (6) An additional requirement during stoppage is that there be a delay of 2 minutes
           between the stopping of subsequent conveyors, in order that the sand on the following
           conveyor might clear before it is stopped.
       (7) A STOP-push button near the mould making machine should also be able to stop the
           conveyors.




dharm
d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5   272
STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES                                                                 273

       Control circuit for the above requirements is shown in Fig. 11.35.




                              Fig. 11.35 Control circuit for three conveyors
       In this control circuit, timer elements T1 and T2 have been prefixed and post fixed by
NOT elements to make the timer action equivalent to an OFF-delay timer with a normally
open delayed contact. Students are advised to clearly understand the operation of an OFF
delay timer, if they have any doubt, before proceeding further.
       Operations of the control circuit is as follows:
       (1) The conveyors can be started if the contact of the sand hopper limit switch LS1 is
           closed (i.e., sand level is lower than the limit in the sand hopper) and all the over-
           load relay contacts are closed. If the above two conditions are true then there will be
           high signals at input terminal 2 and 3 of AND1.
       (2) On pressing the ON-push button, a high signal appears at input terminal 1 of AND1
           and its output goes high. This output is fed back to terminal 1 for sealing. High
           output from AND1 appears at terminal 2 of AND2, AND3 and AND4.
       (3) Output of AND1 also appears at input terminal 1 of OR1. Its output therefore goes
           high and energises contactor 3 to run conveyor 3. Output of OR1 also appears at
           input terminal 1 of AND2 and its output becomes high and appears at terminal 1 of
           OR2. Output of OR2 thus also goes high and energises contactor 2 to run conveyor 2.
       (4) Output from OR2 appears at input terminal 1 of timer T1 and its output immediately
           goes high (off delay timer action) and appears at input terminal 2 of OR1.
       (5) Output from OR2 also appears at input terminal of AND3 and makes its output high
           to energise contactor 1.
       (6) Output from AND3 also appears at input terminal of timer T2 and its output immedi-
           ately goes high and appears at input terminal 2 of OR2.




dharm
d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5   273
274                                                                          CONTROL OF MACHINES

        (7) Output of AND3 also appears at input terminal 1 of AND4 after a small delay through
            timer T3. Output of AND4 therefore goes high and energises the solenoid to open the
            gate of the silos. Thus, sand from silos starts falling on conveyor 1 after a small delay
            from the starting of conveyor 1.
        (8) Now, when output of AND1 goes low either due to pressing of OFF-push button or
            tripping of some over-load relay or actuation of sand hopper limit switch, the input
            at terminal 1 or OR1 goes low, but its output remains high as its input terminal 2 is
            high (output from timer T1). Similarly, output of OR2 remains high due to a high
            signal at its input 2 although its terminal 1 goes low. Thus, conveyor 3 and 2 con-
            tinue to run. Conveyor 1, however, stops immediately when AND1 output goes low as
            input terminal 2 of AND3 goes low. Silos gate also closes immediately as output of
            AND4 goes low due to output of AND1 going low.
        (9) As output of AND3 goes low, input to timer T2 becomes low. Timer output goes low
            only after a delay of 2 minutes and makes the input terminal 2 of OR2 also low. The
            output of OR2 thus also becomes low. This leads to stopping of conveyor 2 after a
            delay of 2 minutes from the stopping of conveyor 1.
       (10) As output of OR2 goes low, input of T1 also becomes low, and therefore its output
            becomes low after 2 minutes. This makes the input terminal 2 of OR1 low and its
            output also becomes low. As a result contactor 3 gets de-energised. Conveyer 3 thus
            stops after a delay of 2 minutes from the stopping of conveyor 2.

   11.16      SHIFT REGISTER
Shift register consists of JK flip flops connected in series which transfer their contents from
one to another. Schematic diagram of a shift register having four flip flops is shown in Fig. 11.36.
Output of the first is connected to input of the second and so on. Clock and clear terminals of
all are connected in parallel.
Working:
When a low clear signal is applied, all flip flops get reset i.e., Q1, Q2, Q3, Q4 becomes low while
Q1, Q2 , Q3 , Q4 becomes high. The state of the register is Q1, Q2, Q3, Q4 = 0000.
        Now suppose a high signal is applied to J terminal of the first flip flop FF1 and is
maintained. When clock pulses, also called shift commands are applied to the CK terminals of
all flip flops, then on negative edge of first pulse, FF4, FF3, FF2 remain in reset mode as their
J input terminal is low. Flip flop FF1, however gets into set mode and its output terminal Q1
becomes high. Thus state of the register after first pulse becomes 1000. When second negative
edge appears, FF2 will go into set mode as it has a high at its J terminal. FF1 remains in set
mode since a high is maintained at its input terminal J. FF4 and FF3 remain in reset mode as
they have a low at their J terminal. Thus after the second pulse the state of register becomes
1100. If high input at J terminal of FF1 is maintained, then on application of third negative
edge to CK terminals FF3 will also go into set mode and the state of register becomes 1110.
Similarly on fourth negative edge the state of the register becomes 1111. On subsequent pulses
the state of register remains unchanged as 1111, if constant high is maintained at J terminal
of FF1. Registers continue to lose 1 from the extreme right flip flop while another 1 is added in
the extreme left flip flop FF1. Hence, the information in the flip flops is shifted one place to the
right whenever a shift command occurs, while an external circuit keeps feeding 1’s into the
leading flip flop FF1.




dharm
d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5    274
STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES                                                                                         275
                                      FF1                     FF2                    FF3                 FF4
           High                   J         Q1           J           Q2          J          Q3       J         Q4

                                      CK                     CK                      CK                  CK

                                  K CL Q1                K CL Q2                 K CL Q3             K CL Q4




          Clear

                              Fig. 11.36 Shift register built with JK Flip-flops
      The schematic diagram of flip flop represents how pre-packaged shift registers are
internally built however, they are illustrated in a different way as shown in Fig. 11.37 (a).



                                              J PR1      PR2       PR3    PR4

                                                  CK

                                              K
                                                 CL



                                                 Q 1 Q1 Q 2 Q2 Q3 Q 3 Q4 Q 4
                                                               (a)



                                 J            4 bit                        J                4 bit
                                     CK     register                           CK         register
                                 K                                         K
                                 CL              Q4 Q4                      CL




                                                             (b)

      Fig. 11.37 (a) Symbol for prepackaged register (b) Cascade connection of two shift registers

       Most common length for pre-package shift registers are 4, 5 and 8 bits. If a longer shift
register is required, two or more small ones can be cascaded as shown in Fig. 11.37 (b). There
are many different types of shift registers but the basic function of all is to shift binary bits
from one location to the next. To avoid confusion only the type discussed above will be used
subsequently.

   11.17     CONVEYOR SYSTEM USING A SHIFT REGISTER
Shift registers are widely used in industrial applications involving conveyor systems. Each flip
flop in shift register represents one zone on the conveyor system. The state of a particular flip
flop, ON or OFF, stands for some characteristic of the piece in that zone. The most obvious




dharm
d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5   275
276                                                                                                CONTROL OF MACHINES

example which can be represented in binary 1 or 0 is pass or fail, i.e., either the piece passes
inspection and is routed to the next zone or it fails inspection and is rejected.
      Let us discuss a practical application of shift register in control of a production set-up in
which evenly spaced parts come down a conveyor for inspection. Schematic representation of
the system is shown in Fig. 11.38.

                             1                   2                  3                4
                        Inspection             Work               Work
                           zone                zone               zone

                                                                                                   Pusher




                                                      Conveyor
                                                                                                   Bad
                                                                                                   parts




                                                                                  Reject bin

                              Fig. 11.38 Plan layout of a conveyor inspection system

        Assume that the conveyor is divided in four zones. Inspection of the piece is done in zone
1. In zones 2 and 3 some work is done on the piece if it passes inspection, while the piece which
fails, is allowed to pass through unattended. For identification of the rejection piece, it is
marked with paint by an inspector of zone 1 for the benefit of workers of zones 2 and 3. A reject
push button is also pressed while the rejected piece is still in zone 1. When the piece reaches
the fourth zone, a pneumatic pusher extends and pushes the rejected piece into the reject bin
while the good parts move past the fourth zone.
      Control circuit for the above system is shown in Fig. 11.39. Shift register in the circuit
has been used to keep track of the progress of a bad piece on the system and to operate the
pusher when the bad piece reaches zone 4.
             + 15V
                     Reject



                                                                                                   OA
                                     J     Q           J     Q       J        Q          J     Q
                                      CK                CK               CK              CK          Pusher
                                                                                                    solenoid
                                     K      Q          K      Q      K      Q            K     Q
                                         FF1               FF2           FF3                 FF4


                     LS


              Fig. 11.39 Control circuit of conveyor inspection system using a shift register




dharm
d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5         276
STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES                                                                        277

       Working of the circuit is as follows:
       (1) If the Reject-button is pressed while the bad piece is in zone 1, the preset terminal of
           flip-flop FF1 becomes low and it goes into set mode (assuming that the flip flop responds
           to low preset signal). Its output Q1 becomes high and appears at input terminal J of
           FF2.
       (2) When the rejected piece leaves the zone 1 and enters zone 2, a limit switch is actuated.
           The limit switch gives a low signal to all CK terminals. Flip flop FF2 goes into set
           mode and its output Q2 becomes high while FF1, FF3 and FF4 get reset. FF1 gets
           reset due to its J terminal being grounded. Thus we see that as the rejected part
           moves into zone 2, the information about its non-acceptance enters flip flop 2.
       (3) When the rejected piece enters zone 3, limit switch is again actuated, by the piece
           following it i.e., by the one entering zone 2. Shift command thus appears at all the
           CK terminals.
       (4) On application of signal to CK terminals, FF3 gets in set mode as its input is high (Q2
           = 1), the information of a bad piece in zone 3 enters flip flop FF3. Similarly, when a
           bad piece enters zone 4 the limit switch is again actuated and another shift command
           occurs, which turns on FF4.
       (5) When output Q4 of FF4 goes high it energises the solenoid which applies a push to
           the work piece. Pusher moves forward and the bad piece is thrown into the reject
           bin.
       (6) When the next piece enters zone 4, FF4 gets reset if the part is good and the pusher
           immediately moves backward before the part can run into it.

   11.18     COUNTER
A digital counter can count the number of pulses appearing at its input terminal. Counting,
however, is done in Binary coded decimal number since the counter circuit is made of flip flops
and logic gates. Schematic representation of a decade counter is shown in Fig. 11.40 (a).
       Input count pulses apear at terminal CK and the count number in binary code appears
at terminal DCBA with corresponding numerical values of 8, 4, 2, 1. Input count pulse number
versus the corresponding BCD output is given below:

                                                              A
                                                              B
                                      CK
                                                              C
                                                              D

                                      CL
                                                    (a)
                            C1                      C2                        C3
                        A                       A                         A
                        B                       B                         B
                              CK                     CK                        CK
                        C                       C                         C             Count
                        D                       D                         D             input

                                                                                           Clear

            Hundred                    Tens                       Units
                                                    (b)

                      Fig. 11.40 (a) Symbol for counter (b) Cascading of counters for
                               measurement in terms of tens and hundreds




dharm
d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5       277
278                                                                                     CONTROL OF MACHINES


                                    CK                             DCBA

                                        1                          0001
                                        2                          0010
                                        3                          0011
                                        4                          0100
                                        5                          0101
                                        6                          0110
                                        7                          0111
                                        8                          1000
                                        9                          1001

       When clear terminal CL goes to its active low, all four bits clear to 0. The counter output
becomes 0000.
       From the above table, it is clear that a decade up-counter counts upto 9. However, counting
pulses greater than 9 is done by cascading the counters as shown in Fig. 11.40 (b). At the tenth
pulse all the bits DCBA of counter 1 clear to 0. As the terminal D of the unit counter is connected
to CK terminal of counter 2, the negative going edge of D triggers the counter and its output
becomes 0001. Thus second counter registers, tens, and similarly, third counter will register
hundreds. For example, when 15 number of pulses have appeared the output of counter will
be :
       Counter 3                     Counter 2                     Counter 1
       (hundreds)                           (tens)                            (unit)
       BCD number 0000                       0001                              0101
       Numerical number 0                     1                                  5
                                                     i.e., 00010101 = 15

   11.19 DECODER
A counter records pulses in binary coded decimal numbers. But this information is not
understood by a layman. A decoder is thus required which converts BCD number into decimal
number. Schematic representation of a Decoder is shown in Fig. 11.41 (a).
       If the binary information represents the decimal digit 3 (DCBA = 0011), the decoder
drives the output line No. 3 high.

                                    0                                     0
                                    1                                     1
                                    2                                     2
               A
                                    3                     A         A     3
               B                    4                     B         B     4
               C                    5                     C         C     5
                                    6                     D         D     6
               D
                                    7                                     7
                                    8             Decade counter          8
                                    9                                     9
                        Decoder   (a)                              Decoder (b)        Ten position
                                                                                     selector switch

           Fig. 11.41 (a) Schematic representation of a decoder (b) Combination of a decade
                           counter, decoder and a 10-position selector switch




dharm
d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5      278
STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES                                                                       279

        In many industrial applications, where a certain action has to be taken after a fixed,
count, a ten position selector switch is connected to the output of decoder as shown in Fig. 11.41
(b). If it is desired to initiate some action after a count of say 5, selector switch is placed in
position 5 as shown in Fig. 11.41. After 5 number of count pulses, DCBA of counter will be
0101, which would also appear at DCBA terminals of Decoder. Decoder terminal 5 will go high
and a high output will appear at common terminal of the switch to initiate the desired action.
Here, the BCD number has been referred to the decimal decoder. There are other types of
decoders available such as BCD to seven segment, grey code to decimal, excess three code to
decimal etc. In this text, the term decoder will refer to the BCD to decimal decoder. Interested
students may refer to a text book on digital electronics for study of inbuilt structure of a decoder.

   11.20 LOADING OF CASTINGS INTO ANNEALING FURNACE USING
         DECADE COUNTER AND DECODER
The schematic arrangement for the system is shown in Fig. 11.42.




     Fig. 11.42 Plan layout of automatic loading of castings into Annealing furnace using conveyors
       In this system a number of castings are loaded on a metallic roller conveyor passing
through the annealing furnace. On pressing the loading/unloading push button, annealing
furnace door opens. When doors are fully open annealing furnace conveyor (conv. 2) and loading
furnace conveyor (conv. 1) will start. As the conveyors start, annealed castings come out of the
exit side, while fresh castings are loaded on to the annealing furance conveyor from loading
conveyor. When the selected number of castings enter the annealing furnace, both the conveyors
stop and furance doors close. Annealing of the castings can then be done for required time.
       The number of castings to be admitted in furnace can be changed depending upon their
size. Selector switches are used to select the number of castings to be admitted. Number of
castings entering the furance is counted with the help of a limit switch LS3 mounted on the
end of the loading conveyor. Every time a casting de-actuates the limit switch while leaving
conv 1 and entering conv 2, the CK terminal of units counter becomes zero. The negative going
edge causes the counter to produce a pulse at its output in binary coded decimal form. Control
circuit for the system is shown in Fig. 11.43.
       Explanation of the control circuit is as follows :
       (1) Suppose 12 castings are to be loaded into the furnace. This number being greater
           than 9, two decade counters are cascaded as shown in the diagram. Output D of the
           units counter is connected to the CK terminal of tens counter. Clear terminals of
           both the counters are connected to the output of AND3 through a NOT gate as shown
           in the control circuit. Units counters selector switch is set at 2 while Tens counter
           selector switch is set at 1 to get a total setting of 12.



dharm
d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5   279
280                                                                              CONTROL OF MACHINES




                Fig. 11.43 Control circuit for loading of castings in an annealing furnace




dharm
d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5   280
STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES                                                                281

       (2) For loading, Start loading/unloading push-button is pressed. Output appears at AND1
           gate as its input terminal 2 and 3 are already high.
           Terminal 3 is high as R-S flip-flop is in reset mode. Output is fed back to terminal 1
           for sealing the circuit.
       (3) As soon as the AND1 output goes high, entry and exit door opens due to energisation
           of solenoids S1 and S2.
       (4) When both the doors are open, LS1 and LS2 get actuated and AND2 output goes high.
           This output runs the furnace conveyor and loading conveyor by energising contactor
           C1 and C2 respectively.
       (5) As the conveyors start, the castings placed on loading conveyor also move and are
           shifted over to the furnace conveyor. Number of casting loaded on the furnace conveyor
           is counted by de-actuation of limit switch LS3 installed on the end of the loading
           conveyor. Every time LS3 is deactuated, CK terminal of units counter goes low and
           registers the count at its output-binary coded decimal form. Decoder converts it into
           decimal form. At the second count the ouput of units selector switch will go high and
           appear at input terminal 1 of AND3 but no further action takes place as the other
           input terminal 2 of AND3 is low.
       (6) Units counter will count upto 9 and when 10th count pulse appears, its output resets
           to 0000 from 1001 (9). Negative going transition of terminal D causes the tens counter
           to register a count and its output becomes 0001.
           Thus a high signal appears at input terminal 2 of AND3 on the 10th, count, but now
           the input at terminal 1 of AND3 is absent as unit counter is reset.
       (7) From 11th count, units counter again starts counting from 1 onwards. At the 12th
           count pulse, common terminal of Decoder selector switch goes high. Now both the
           inputs of AND3 are high so its output becomes high. This brings the R-S flip-flop in
           set mode and its output becomes high. This causes the input terminal 3 of AND1 to
           go low due to the presence of a NOT gate in series. Thus AND1 output goes low.
           Conveyors 1 and 2 stop immediately and furnace door starts closing due to de-
           energisation of door solenoids.
       (8) As the output of AND3 goes high, a low signal appears at CL terminal of units and
           tens counter due to the presence of a NOT gate in series with output of AND3 gate.

   11.21     MONO SHOT
Mono shot is a very useful digital element used in industrial controls. Its formal name is
monostable multivibrator. The symbol for a mono shot is shown in Fig. 11.44 (a).
       It has two outputs Q and Q similar to a flip-flop. In this text, it is assumed that mono
shot are triggered by a negative edge at trigger terminal T. However, they can be triggered by
a positive edge also. When one shot is triggered, the Q output goes high while the Q output
goes low.
      After a preset period of time, called firing time tf , the output Q returns to low and Q
returns to high. Triggering of the mono shot by a short pulse and the resulting output Q and Q
are shown in Fig. 11.44 (b). This way, a mono shot may be used as a pulse stretcher, or for
delaying the negative edge of a pulse by a firing time tf .




dharm
d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5   281
282                                                                                     CONTROL OF MACHINES

        Mono shots are frequently used to reset a counter or a flip-flop in circuits where the
conditions are such that a long term level change cannot be used to reset the counter or the
flip-flop (since the counter is to resume counting again after a short duration). Long term level
change as compared to a small time change by a mono shot, is shown in Fig. 11.44 (c). Suppose
the counter is to reset at instant A when Vin changes to low, and has to resume counting at
instant B. If Vin is used to clear the counter by negative going edge at instant A, then even at
instant B, the counter will remain reset and hence cannot resume counting. Thus Vin cannot
be used to clear the counter. Instead, if a mono shot is triggered by Vin and its Q output is used
to clear the counter, then counters can be resumed at instant B, since by that time Q of the
mono shot will be back to its high state after firing time tf (refer Fig. 11.44 (c)). The above will
become more clear when a practical industrial circuit is discussed.

                                                                                         B
                                                                             A
                                               Vin                     Vin       Long term level
                                                                                    change
                                               (T)                     (T)
                                           Q
                   T
                                 T              Q                       Q
                 Trigger
                                           Q             tf                        tf
                  input
                           Mono shot
                                                Q        tf             Q
                                     (a)
                                                                                   tf    Counter
                                                         (b)
                                                                                         starts
                                                                              Counter again
                                                                               resets
                                                                                      (c)

                                 Fig. 11.44 Symbol and waveforms of a mono shot

   11.22     CLOCK
The formal name of a clock in digital text books is astable multivibrator or free-running
multivibrator. A clock generates a continuous train of pulses which may be utilised to
synchronise various digital devices in an industrial circuit. It may also be required to provide
count pulse to an industrial system which does not generate count pulses naturally. Symbol of
a clock is shown in Fig. 11.45.

                                                               5 khz



                  Clock                          Clock
                                      Output

                                                                       Frequency
                                                                         divider
                                 (a)                             (b)

             Fig. 11.45 (a) Symbol for a clock (b) A clock combined with a frequency divider
        The frequency of the waveform is set by values of resistor, capacitor, and inductor which
are internally connected to the circuit. A lower frequency can be obtained by connecting a
frequency divider circuit as shown in Fig. 11.45 (b). A frequency divider divides the clock pulse
by an integer and produces a lower frequency pulse train. Some systems require clock pulses
of different frequency in order to synchronise various events properly.




dharm
d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5      282
STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES                                                                    283

   11.23 AUTOMATIC FILLING OF SILOS USING A CLOCK AND A MONO
         SHOT
The schematic diagram for the system is shown in Fig. 11.46.

                                                              Diverters
                        Main silos
                                                     operated by solenoid valves




                                            1                                         3
                                                                    (Down
                 Gate                                             2 position)

                 Conv
                               Up
                          limit switch

                             Down
                          limit switch


                             Silos
                             gate




                                         Machine 1            Machine 2            Machine 3

            Fig. 11.46 Schematic diagram for an automatic machine filling a number of silos
        In this system, certain material is to be distributed in three small silos 1, 2, 3 which feed
individual machines 1, 2, and 3.
        Material is fed to silos from the main silos through a belt conveyor and diverters. Level
of material in small silos is sensed by a lower level and an upper level limit switch as shown in
the figure. Filling of any of the silos starts when the level of material in it falls below certain
level as determined by the position of the lower level limit switch. When material in all the
silos is above the upper level, conveyor is at standstill and diverters are in up position. Gate of
main silos is also closed.
        When level of material in any of the silos falls below the lower limit, the conveyor starts
moving and gate of the main silos opens. Diverter above the particular silos falls down so that
material is diverted into that silos from the conveyor. When level rises to the upper limit, up
limit switch gets actuated which causes the conveyor to stop, gate of the main silos to close,
and the diverter to go up. In the diagram, diverter 2 is shown in down position and material is
shown falling in to silos No. 2.
        In the diagram, the diverters are shown connected in series, so that only one silos may
be filled at a particular time.
       Gate of main silos and diverter 1, 2, 3 are operated by solenoid valves. Special limit
switches are used for sensing low and high level in silos.
       Material for processing in machines can be taken out from the silos by manual operation
of the gate of a silos by the operator of a particular machine.




dharm
d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5      283
284                                                                                        CONTROL OF MACHINES

       Control circuit for the above system is shown in Fig. 11.47, and the explanation for the
circuit is as follows:
       (1) If the level in all the silos 1, 2 and 3 are above the upper limit, FF4 remains OFF. Its
             Q output is high, and so, input 1 of AND4 is high. At its terminal 2, clock is delivering
             square-wave pulses and, therefore, the output from AND4 is also a square-wave of
             same frequency as the clock. These pulses appear at CK terminal of decade counter
             and it starts counting.
             The counted number appears in BCD form at its output which is given to the decoder.
             Thus, terminal 1 of decoder goes high first and then 2, 3 and 4. When 4th output goes
             high it appears as a negative going edge at trigger terminal T of OS4 due to a NOT
             gate in series. OS4 fires for a few microseconds, applying a low signal to CL terminal
             of the counter, and counter immediately resets to zero. Counter again starts counting
             from 1. This is because when count pulse appears through AND4, the clear pulse has
             long departed from counter terminal CL. This is the example of a mono shot resetting
             the counter and then removing the clear signal in time for the counter to resume
             counting again. Thus the counter continuously counts from 1 to 3.

                                                                                                 Main silo gate

                                                                               OA
                                                                OR1
       Low                                                                                          Conveyor
                            1                     FF1
                                                                                                    OA
                            2 AND1            S
                                                                        Q                         Diverter 1
                                              R         Q         T
         Up                                       FF2                    Q
                            1
                                                                      OS1                           OA
        Low                 2 AND2            S         Q
                                                                        Q                         Diverter 2
                                                        Q         T
         Up                                       FF3                    Q
                            1                                                                       OA
                                                                      OS2
        Low                 2 AND3            S         Q
                                                                                                   Diverter 3
                                                                        Q                   1
                                              R         Q                                    2
                                                                  T                                OR2     S          Q
                                                                        Q                   3
                                                                      OS3                                  R          Q
         Up                                                                                                     FF4
                                                                                       1
                                                                                        2        OR3
                                                                                       3
                                                                                   1
                                              1    D        D
                                              2    C        C CK            AND4
                                              3    B        B
                                              4    A        A CL                   2
                                              Decoder       Counter
                                          Q                                             Clock
                                T
                                          Q
                                    OS4

                          Fig. 11.47 Control circuit for an automatic machine filler




dharm
d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5     284
STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES                                                                  285

       (2) In case the output, 1 to 3 of the decoder goes high in succession, AND1, AND2 and
           AND3 are enabled partially in succession, as their terminal 1 goes high in succession.
           If low level limit switch of any of the silos is closed, then the corresponding AND gate
           will be fully enabled. Let us assume in this case that lower limit switch of silos 2 is
           actuated and thus AND2 is enabled. Its output therefore goes high and brings FF2 in
           set mode. Now due to output Q of FF2 going high, three actions take place.
            (i) Gate of main silos opens and conveyor also starts running with material falling
                from main silos on it.
           (ii) Diverter 2 falls down so as to divert material from conveyor into silos 2 due to
                energisation of diverter 2 solenoid.
          (iii) Q output of FF2 also appears at terminal 2 of OR2 and its output goes high which
                brings FF4 in set mode. Thus Q of FF4 goes low and AND4 is disabled and coun-
                ter does not receive count pulses. The counter therefore freezes in its present
                state.
       (3) When the level in silos 2 rises, lower limit switch opens, thus disabling AND2 but FF2
           remains in set mode due to its memory ability. Thus filling of material continues till
           upper level limit switch is actuated which resets FF2. FF2 output Q goes low which
           disables OR1 and OR2 and de-energises the solenoid of Diverter 2. Disabling of OR1
           stops the conveyor and main silos gate also closes. Disabling of OR2 removes high
           state from the S terminal of FF4.
       (4) Also, when Q of FF2 goes low, it delivers a negative edge to the trigger terminal of
           OS2 causing it to fire. Its output goes high for a few microseconds enabling OR3. The
           output of OR3 goes high and resets FF4 thus high state appears at terminal 1 of
           AND4 and thus clock pulses again appear at CK terminal of the counter. The counter
           starts counting from where it had stopped.
       In the above circuit, observe the utility of using mono shots, 1 to 3 for resetting FF4.
Suppose, if FF4 is reset by the output Q of flip-flops from FF1 to FF3 then if FF4 is reset due to
Q of FF2 going high it will remain in reset mode even if Q of FF1 or FF3 goes low as Q of FF2
will hold in reset mode. Thus it is necessary to temporarily apply a high to the terminal R of
FF4 when any of the flip flops, FF1 to FF3 goes into reset mode.

   11.24     DOWN COUNTER
In a down counter every time a count pulse is delivered the number stored in the counter
decreases by one. This type of counter is especially required in circuits where an output signal
after a preset number of counts, and another signal earlier to a fixed number of counts, is
desired. Symbol and table showing states of down counter after each input pulse are shown in
Fig. 11.48.
      Down counters have input terminals DCBA, in addition to the output terminals, so as to
preset a number into the counter in BCD form. When the load terminal of the counter goes
low, BCD number at input is loaded into the counter and it appears at output terminals DCBA.
Assuming that number 9(1001) is present at input terminals when load terminal goes low, the
output is preset to 1001 as shown in the table of Fig. 11.48 (b). When the first pulse appears at
CK terminal, output becomes 1000(8). At 9th pulse the output becomes 0000. At 10th pulse the
counter again resets to 1001(9).




dharm
d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5   285
286                                                                                                       CONTROL OF MACHINES

                                                                           Initial       Preset BCD            Decimal
                                                                           pulse           number              number
                                                                           at CK     1     0    0   1            9
                                                                             1       1     0    0   0            8
                                 CK                                          2       0     1    1   1            7
                                D            D                               3       0     1    1   0            6
                                                                             4       0     1    0   1            5
             Inputs




                                C            C
                                                       Outputs               5       0     1    0   0            4
                                B            B
                                                                             6       0     0    1   1            3
                                A            A                               7       0     0    1   0            2
                                Load                                         8       0     0    0   1            1
                                                                             9       0     0    0   0            0
                                       (a)
                                                                            10       1     0    0   1          Preset
                                                                                             (b)

                              Fig. 11.48 (a) Symbol for decade down counter (b) Truth table

   11.25 ENCODER
An encoder is the inverse of a decoder. In this, input is in the decimal form and output appears
in a binary equivalent number. There are various types of encoders, but in this text only 1-of-
10 decimal input to BCD output type is discussed. Symbols for Encoders with active low inputs
is shown in Fig. 11.49 (a).

                                                                                   Input           Output
                                                                                 terminal
                                             0                                               D         C   B    A
                                                                                   low ¯
                                             1
                                             2                                       0       0         0   0    0
                                             3   D                                   1       0         0   0    1
                      Input




                                             4   C                                   2       0         0   1    0
                                                                 Outputs
                                             5   B                                   3       0         0   1    1
                                             6   A
                                                                                     4       0         1   0    0
                                             7
                                             8                                       5       0         1   0    1
                                             9                                       6       0         1   1    0
                                                                                     7       0         1   1    1
                                         BCD encoder                                 8       1         0   0    0
                                          (a)
                                                                                     9       1         0   0    1
                                                                                                 (b)

               Fig. 11.49 (a) Symbol for 1-of-10 decimal encoder (b) Truth table for encoder
       In an active low input encoder any one of the lines 0, 1, 2, 3 etc. going low is considered
to be the desired input number. When input 0 is low while all others are high, output of the
encoder is 0000, and when 1 becomes low while others are high, output becomes 0001. Truth
table shown in Fig. 11.49 (b) indicates the output states for various inputs. Generally, the
encoders receive their input from a 10-position selector switch. Selector switch can be set at
any desired number by the operator and equivalent BCD number will appear at the output.
This output is then loaded into a down counter when its load terminal goes low. Arrangement
of selector switch, encoder and decade down counter is shown in Fig. 11.50.
       The encoder discussed here is supposed to belong to the logic family which interprets a
floating input as High i.e., when all terminals from 0 to 9 except 3 appear as high to the



dharm
d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5            286
STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES                                                                          287

encoder (terminal 3 being connected to a low). Active high input encoders may also be used
from logic families which interpret floating input as low.


                       0                                                   CK
                           1
                               2
                                3                         D               D      D

                                4                         C               C      C         Counter
              Low     Com
                                5                                                          outputs
                                                          B               B      B
                               6
                                                          A               A      A
                               7
                           8
                       9                                                  Load
                    Selector switch                Encoder               Decade down
                                                                           counter

           Fig. 11.50 Combination of a 10-position selector switch, a decimal-to-BCD encoder
                                      and a decade down counter

       In this text, active low convention has been followed.

   11.26 PRODUCT DISPERSION CONVEYOR SYSTEM USING A
         DOWN-COUNTER, AN ENCODER, A MONO-SHOT AND A TIMER
The conveyor system, used for dispensing a product to any desired zone is illustrated in
Fig. 11.51.

                                         Zone        Zone         Zone           Zone     Zone
                                          1           2            3              4        5
                Loading
                 zone




                                                     Conveyor run by A
                 Product                              two speed motor




                                    Fig. 11.51 Plan view of a product dispersion system

       In this system, a product is loaded on the conveyor in the loading zone by the operator.
Depending upon the zone in which this product is desired, operator selects the zone number on
the selector switch. After selecting the zone, operator presses the conveyor START-push button.
First, the conveyor runs in slow speed for a small time as set by a timer. Then it runs in fast
speed, and again it becomes slow when it reaches a zone prior to the zone set on the selector




dharm
d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5          287
288                                                                        CONTROL OF MACHINES

switch. In each zone, limit switches are provided for sensing the product in that particular
zone. As seen from Fig. 11.51 there are five zones and LS1 to LS5 are provided in these zones.
There is an interlocking in the system due to which the conveyor cannot be started if a product
is lying in any of the zones and has not been picked by the workers of that zone. Another
provision in the control circuit is that if the product is desired in zone 1 then conveyor does not
shift to fast speed but continues to run in slow speed. Control circuit for the above system is
shown in Fig. 11.52.
       Explanation of the circuit is as follows :
       (1) Suppose it is desired to take the product to zone 5. First of all, the operator will set
the selector switch to position 5. Terminal 5 of encoder thus goes low and binary coded decimal
number 0101 appears at the output terminal of the encoder. This number also appears at the
input of decade down counter.
       (2) When operator presses the conveyor START-push button, terminal 1 of AND1 goes
high. If all the limit switches from LS1 to LS5 are in de-actuated condition, a high state appears
at terminal 2 of AND1. Its output goes high. This causes terminal T of OS1 to go low. Its output
Q , which is connected to load terminal of decade down counter, also goes low. Decade-down
counter thus gets loaded to 0101 (5) which is present at its input terminals. Output of the
down counter gets connected to the decoder. Thus, decoder’s terminal 5 will be high.
       (3) As soon as AND1 output goes high it also turns on FF1. Its output Q goes high and
energises the main contactor of conveyor motor. A high also appears at terminal 2 of NAND
gate but its terminal 1 is low so its output will be high and appear at terminal 1 of OR1 causing
its output to go high. Slow contactor gets energised through the amplifier and thus the conveyor
motor runs in slow speed. After some time delay, the timer T output goes high and appears at
terminal 1 of NAND gate. As both the inputs of the NAND gate are now high, its output goes
low. OR1 is disabled as its terminal 2 is already low. Slow contactor of the motor is de-energised
while the fast contactor gets energised and the conveyor runs at fast speed with the product
loaded on it.
       (4) When LS1 is actuated a low appears at CK terminal of the down counter and its
output decreases from 0101(5) to 0100(4). Now the decoder output terminal 4 goes high. As the
product on the conveyor proceeds further, limits switches LS2, LS3 and LS4 are actuated in
succession. The decoder output terminals 3, 2 and 1 become high in succession. When terminal
1 of decoder becomes high, it appears at terminal 2 of OR1 and thus its output goes high. Fast
contactor is de-energised and slow contactor is energised. Conveyor again shifts to slow speed.
When limit switch LS5 is actuated, fifth count pulse is delivered to the down counter and its
output becomes 0000 and decoder terminal 0 becomes high. Immediately trigger terminal T of
OS2 goes low and its output Q becomes high which resets flip-flop FF1. When FF1 resets, its Q
goes low and conveyor main contactor M is de-energised. Conveyor thus stops. Now the product
can be lifted from the conveyor for further work on it in zone 5.
       (5) Similarly the product can be taken to any zone by selecting the required position on
the selector switch.




dharm
d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5   288
dharm
                        Start
                                          1                                                              FF1
                                                                                                                         OA
                                              AND1                                                   S
                                          2                                                                    Q                            M




d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5
                                                                            Q                Q       R
                                                                      T                 T




289
                                                                            Q                Q OS
                                                                                                 2
                                                                                                                                                  STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES




                                                                          OS1
                                Selector switch
                                                  Encoder
                                      0           0                                    0
                                                                                                                               1
                                      1           1                                    1                                 T
                                      2           2                  CK                2                                            NAND
                                                                                                                               2
                                      3           3      D          D       D          3
                                      4           4      C          C       C          4
                                      5           5      B          B       B          5
                                      6           6      A          A       A          6                       1               OA
                                      7           7                 Load               7                           OR1
                                                                                                               2
                                      8           8                 Decade             8                                                   Slow
                                      9           9                  down              9
                                                                    counter        Decoder                                           OA

                        LS1
                                                                                                                              NOT          Fast




                        LS6




                                                      Fig. 11.52 Control circuit for a product dispersion system
                                                                                                                                                  289
290                                                                                 CONTROL OF MACHINES

                                        REVIEW QUESTIONS
   1.   Enumerate various advantages and disadvantages of static control as compared to magnetic
        relay control.
   2.   In what way the static control differs as compared to magnetic relay control.
   3.   List the logic gates used in building control circuits. Draw their symbols and explain their work-
        ing in brief.
   4.   Draw the USAI symbols for Relay coil, Relay contact, Time delay relay, and Limit switch,
   5.   Draw the internal circuitry of AND and OR gate using TTL logic and also explain its working.
   6.   Discuss solid state timer and its various modifications which are analogous to ON and OFF
        delay time delay relays.
   7.   Discuss OFF-return memory. Draw the internal circuitry and explain its working.
   8.   Explain how RS flip-flop can be built by using NAND gates and NOR gates only.
   9.   How does a clocked RS flip-flop differ from an ordinary RS flip-flop. What is negative edge trig-
        gering and positive edge triggering as aplicable to clocked flip-flop.
  10.   Discuss in detail the working of JK flip-flop.
  11.   What is Retentive memory ? How is it built ? Draw its symbol and equivalent relay circuit.
  12.   Enumerate various steps which are useful in designing a control circuit.Develop holding circuit
        using AND gate, RS flip and using both AND gate and OR gate.
  13.   What is the necessity of signal converters in static control ? Discuss different types of signal
        converters.
  14.   What is a Bounce Eliminator ? Discuss Bounce Eliminator circuit using NOR gates.
  15.   Discuss the working of a modern output amplifier using a UJT and SCR.
  16.   Draw schematic arrangement of a solenoid value operated cylinder piston assembly. Discuss the
        motion of piston between two extreme positions by drawing the control circuit.
  17.   Explain how the speed of a wound rotor induction motor can be controlled using logic elements.
  18.   Draw control circuit for Planer machine and discuss its working.
  19.   Explain working of a shift register using JK flip-flops.
  20.   If it is desired to build a 10-bit shift register, how many packaged 4 bit shift registers are needed ?
        Draw a schematic diagram showing all the interconnections between the packages.
  21.   Explain the action of a BCD-to-decimal decoder.
  22.   What is the formal name of a mono-shot ? Explain what a mono-shot does.
  23.   What is the function of clock generator in industrial circuits ?
  24.   Draw symbols for down-counter and Encoder and explain their working.




dharm
d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5     290
Programmable Logic Controller


   12.1    INTRODUCTION
The control requirements of industry were served well for many generations by relays, drum
switches, mechanical (physical) timers and counter etc. The relay control circuits had a
disadvantage that when the control requirements change, relays had to be added or removed
and rewiring was required to be done. This was time consuming and tedious process. In extreme
cases, such as in Auto industry with the change in the model of the automobile being
manufactured, complete panels had to be replaced, since it was not economically feasible to
rewire the old panels. Also some control functions required could not be easily achieved using
relay circuits. Also the increasing sophistication and complexity of the control systems in
industry required more faster acting control elements. The electronic industry responded to
this need of the industry and developed modular solid state electronic devices. These devices
were faster, had low power consumption and eliminated much of the hand-wiring, but brought
with them a new language. The language consisted to AND gates, OR gates, NOR gates, OFF
return memory, J-K flip flops, and so on.
       Static control circuit using logic gates and other solid state devices also had some
disadvantages. Although the circuits were faster but reliability was not as expected. Noise
signals could cause the control circuit to malfunction. Solid state devices did not work well at
high temperatures encountered in industry. Also static control was economically not feasible
for small control requirements. Alteration or modification in an existing circuit was not easy.
It required the change in copper track connections and addition or removal of solid state devices.
Trouble shooting was difficult as compared to the relay circuits. The above mentioned
disadvantages and the reluctance of the technicians to learn a new language comprising AND,
OR gates etc. and the advent of microprocessor gave industry what is now known as
Programmable Logic Controller (PLC). Internally there are still AND gates, OR gates, and so
forth in the processor but the design engineers have preprogrammed the PLC so that program
can be entered using RELAY LADDER LOGIC.
     The first PLC was invented in 1969 by Richard Dick E. Morley, who was the founder of
the Modicon Corporation.
        The PLC consists of a programming device (Keyboard), processor unit, power supply
and input/output interface. At this point you will wonder, “is PLC a computer ?”. The answer
to this is ‘Yes’ PLC is a computer but designed for specific application. There are thus similarities
and also some major differences between a PLC and a computer. Some differences between
PLC and computer are:

                                                291
292                                                                      CONTROL OF MACHINES

       1. PLCs are designed to be operated in industrial environment with wide range of
          ambient temperature, vibration and humidity conditions. It is not effected by the
          electrical noise present in the industrial environment.
       2. In computer, the inputs are floppy drives and CD Roms and output is a printer, but
          in PLC the inputs are signals from control elements like push-buttons, limit switches,
          temperature switches, pressure switch and transducer etc., installed on the machines
          to be controlled. Also the output are final control elements like contactors, solenoids,
          positioning valves, indication lights, an so forth.
       3. The PLC is not a disc based system like PC. With a disc based system there is a
          continuous checking of what to do next. With a PLC the answer of what to do next is
          inherent, there is no consulting. The PLC program is stored in battery backed RAM
          or EPROM.
       4. Another important difference between PLC and PC is that the PLC contains the
          operating systems and application programs in ROM memory. The operating system
          does not have to load an application program, as it is already in ROM. It is difficult to
          differentiate between PLCs, ‘BIOS’, operating system and application program.
       5. PLCs are designed to be operated in industrial environment with wide range of
          ambient temperature, vibration and humidity conditions. It is not effected by the
          electrical noise present in the industrial environment.
       6. Another major difference between PLC and computer is the programming language.
          PLC is not programmed in one of the high language used for programming a computer.
          As PLC is designed to be operated by plant engineers and maintenance personnel
          with limited knowledge of computers, it is designed to be programmed using RELAY
          LADDER LOGIC. However some PLCs are available which can be programmed using
          FORTRAN and BASIC, but relay ladder logic programming is the most popular.
          Some PLCs are also programmed using, Boolean Algebra, Satement lists and Control
          system flow chart languages.
       7. Another major difference is that troubleshooting is simplified in most PLCs because
          they include fault indicators, blown-fuse indicators, input and output status indicator,
          and written fault information that can be displayed on the programmer.
       From the above discussion, the programmable logic controller (PLC) can thus be defined
as follow:
     It is a solid state system, with a programmable memory for storing instructions
to implement specific functions such as logic, sequencing, timing, counting and
arithmetic to control machine and processes.
       A typical PLC can be divided into five components. These components consist of the
processor unit, memory, power supply, input/output section (interface) and the programming
device. Some manufacturers refer to the processor as a C.P.U. or central processing unit. The
components are shown in Fig. 12.1.
      The power supply is required to convert 240 volts AC voltage to the low voltage DC
required for the logic circuits of the processor and the internal circuits of the input and output
modules. DC power for the input and output devices, if required is generally provided from a
separate source.




dharm
d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5   292
PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER                                                                      293

                                                  220 V AC

                                                 Power supply


                                                       DC(Low Voltage)

         Input devices                                                             Output devices
                                                                             O
                           I
                                                                             U
                           N                                                              M
                                                                             T
                           P
                                                  Processor                  P
                           U
          Limit switch                                                       U
                           T
                                                                             T
                           M
                                                                             M
                           O
                                                                             O
                           D
                                                                             D
                           U                       Memory                    U
                           L
                                                                             L
                           E
                                                                             E



                            Programming device                     Printer



                         Fig. 12.1 Components of a programmable logic controller
       The input module and output modules are referred to a I/O section (I for input and O for
output). The real word input devices like push buttons, limit switches, analog sensors are
wired to input module and real word output devices like contactors, solenoid valves indicator
lights, positioning valves etc., are wired to the output modules. Real word input and output
devices are of two types: discrete and analog. Discrete I/O devices are either ON or OFF (open
or closed), while analog devices have infinite number of possible values. Examples of discrete
input devices are pushbutton and limit switch while analog input device are temperature
probes, Pressure transducers etc. which gives varying voltage and current. The input from the
analog input device is converted by the analog module called Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
into a proportional binary number and stored in memory of the PLC for further use by the
processor.
       Discrete output devices like contactors, solenoid valve coils, indication lamps are either
energised or de-energized, but Analog output devices require varying current or voltage to
control the output. Example of analog output device is the positioning valve, which gives variable
opening of the valve depending upon the variable voltages/current applied to the valve which
is obtained using the Digital-to Analog Converter (DCA) as the output module.
       The processor unit operates on low DC voltage of 5 volts. Input modules thus contains
circuitry that converts input voltages of 120-240 V AC or 0-24 DC, etc., from discrete input
devices to low level DC voltage typically 5 V DC. Analog input modules converts the
4-20 millampere signals from sensors to low-level DC voltages for the processor unit. Similarly,
the output modules change low level DC signals from the processor to 120-240 AC or low level
DC voltages or give output currents in range 4-20 millampere.
       The programming device for a PLC can be a Hand-held programmer, Dedicated
programmer or Personal computer. The program is entered using Relay Ladder Logic, Statement
Lists or Control System flow charts but the most popular method of programming is the Relay
Ladder logic.



dharm
d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5     293
294                                                                      CONTROL OF MACHINES

       The hand-held programmer uses either LED (light emitting diode) or LCD (liquid crystal
display). The hand-held programmers are small, light weight and convenient to use in the
field. They just look like a small calculator with small display windows. The small display
capabilities limits its use for reviewing the program and trouble shooting.
      Dedicated programmers use a standard video display terminal (VDT) and keyboard for
entering and displaying the program. Large video screen makes the viewing, and trouble
shooting of program easier. They however are even more expensive than the personal computer,
as they are designed-to operate in the industrial environment.
      Personal computers have become the most popular programming device today due to its
lower cost and more versatility than the dedicated programmers. A personal computer can be
used to program a PLC using a special software installed on it. Some PLCs require only a
software to communicate with PC while others require a special hardware communication
card also in addition to the software installed on PC. Nowdays these software are windows
based and are very user friendly. Using a PC for programming offer other advantages also as
number of programs can be stored in the hard disk of the PC and other softwares like spread
sheets, word and graphics can also be used.

   12.2     INPUT/OUTPUT SECTION
The processor in PLC operates at a control voltage of 5 V DC. It is thus essential that input
signals to the processor from input devices be of 5 V DC. We however cannot energies the input
devices at 5 V DC because, the input devices may be at a appreciable distance from PLC. Thus
there would be a voltage drop. Thus input devices are energized generally at higher DC or
AC voltage. The input signals from the devices thus are required to be stepped down to 5 V DC.
This is accomplished by using input modules.
      The output devices to be energised like solenoid coils, indicator lights etc. are to be
energized generally at 110V/220V A.C. The output signals from processor however will be
5VDC. Thus to interface the processor with output devices, output modules are required. Output
modules will convert the low voltage signals from processor to proper voltage level required to
energise the output devices. Thus all the different types and levels of signals (voltage and
currents) used in the control process are interfaced in the I/O section.
      The I/O section generally can be divided into two categories; fixed I/O and modular I/O.
12.2.1    Fixed I/O
PLCs with fixed I/O come in a complete unit that contains the processor, I/O section and the
power supply. The I/O section contains a fixed number of inputs and outputs, all of which have
the same voltage level (120V AC, 24V DC, or 230V AC). For example the Allen Bradley SLC
150, PLC shown in the Fig. 12.2 has 10 discrete inputs and 12 discrete outputs of 24 V DC. As
mentioned earlier discrete type I/O signals are ON or OFF and do not vary in level. When a
limit switch connected to 24 V DC is ON, the signal to the input section will be 24 V and when
the switch is open it will be OV. Discrete I/O is sometimes also referred to as Digital I/O as
digital signals also have two levels, high and low. Once digital signal is high, its level remains
constant and it does not change. An analog type signal on the other hand will vary in magnitude
and will be constantly changing based on control variables in the process. A pressure transducer
that sends a 20 milliampere signal at 500 psi or a 10 milliampere signal at 250 psi is an
example. Many manufacturers offer analog expansion units that can be added to their fixed
I/O, PLCs.
       The cost of PLCs are nowadays so competitive that any control process which uses a
small number of relay and timers can now be controlled using a small PLC. Fixed I/O PLCs are




dharm
d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5   294
PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER                                                                             295

also referred as “Shoebox” or “brick” by manufacturers due to their shape and size. The SLC
150 PLC shown in Fig. 12.2 also has the provision for adding a analog module.




                         Fig. 12.2 Photographic view of a PLC with fixed input/outputs

12.2.2    Modular I/O
In modular type of I/O, different types of module, discrete, analog or special are housed in a
Rack or chasis having a number of slots. Each module is inserted in a slot. Rack or chasis come
in many size for example 4, 8, 12 slots. Generally the first slot contains the power supply and
is numbered 0, the second slot contains the PLC and in the rest of the slots, different types of
input and output modules are inserted. The back panel of the I/O rack contain a printed circuit
board having connectors for each slot, into which the individual I/O modules are inserted. The
proper alignment while the modules are inserted is provided by guides in the slots on both
upper  lower side. Racks that contain I/O module and the processor are referred to as local I/O.
Racks that contain I/O modules, power supplies, remote I/O communication cards and located
away from the local I/O are refered to as remote I/O. The number of remote I/O racks that a

      DC                             Resident
     Supply   PLC   Input Output     rack




                                                               Remote I/O
                                                                 racks                    Leo Indicators




                            DC                         DC                         DC
                           Supply                     Supply                     Supply




                       Fig. 12.3 Local Rack with processor and three Remote I/O racks




dharm
d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5        295
296                                                                         CONTROL OF MACHINES

processor can control varies with each manufacturer. The communication between the remote
rack and the processor is accomplished using several different types of communication methods
like co-axial cable, twin axial cable, shielded-twisted pair or by fibre optical cable if distance is
more and electrical noise is also a consideration. Fig. 12.3 shows a local rack and three remote
I/O racks.
      An Allen Bradleys modular type of PLC is shown in Fig. 12.4. The first slot contains the
power supply, second one contains the SLC 500 PLC, third one contains discrete input module,
fourth slot contains discrete output module, fifth and sixth slots contain analog input and
analog output module while slot number 8 is empty.




       Fig. 12.4 Photographic view of Allen Bradleys Modular type PLC and Input/Output modules.

       Input and output devices connected to input and output modules must have a address
so that the processor knows where which input and output device is located. Within each rack
individual input and output device connections must have a distinct address. Allen Bradley for
example uses the rack number, location of a module in the rack (i.e., slot number) whether
input or output device is connected, to determine the device address. Racks normally have
jumpers or switches that have to be set or configured in order for rack to communicate with
the processor. A common type of switch used for rack configuration is called DIP switch (Dual-
in-line package), which are intended for use on printed circuit boards. These switches are
either ON or OFF. These switches when set in proper sequence, are used to assign an address
to a rack, such as Rack 1, Rack 2. etc. DIP switches are used for other processor functions also.
For example a Analog current input module can be configured as Analog voltage input module
by changing the DIP switch positions provided on the printed circuit board of the module. DIP
switch settings are specified in the installation manual supplied by the PLC manufactures.

   12.3     DISCRETE INPUT MODULES
Discrete input modules are available in wide range of voltages for various applications. Some
more common voltage modules are 120V AC, 240V AC, 24VDC. The cost of a input module
depends upon the number of input terminals available for connecting the real word input
devices like push-buttons, Limit switches etc. Common sizes available are 8, 16 and 32 point.
Nowadays, optically coupled input and output modules are used as they provide isolation of




dharm
d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5   296
PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER                                                                                  297

processor circuit from the real word input and output devices which may be energized on
higher level voltages.
12.3.1    AC Discrete Input Module
A typical AC input module for 8 inputs is shown in Fig. 12.5. L1 is the hot terminal of AC
supply and L2 is the neutral.

                                    L1                   L2

                                                                   Input module
                                         220 V AC

                                                                          Com


                                                                          IN1


                                                                          IN2


                                                                          IN3


                                                                          IN4


                                                                          IN5


                                                                          IN6


                                                                          IN7


                                                                          IN8



                        Fig. 12.5 Connection for an 8 input AC discrete input module
       The enclosure of the input module shown contains a printed circuit board on which
eight number of circuits shown in Fig. 12.6 are there for each of the eight individual inputs.

                                                                                            Vcc ( + 5V)
                                                              Input indicator led
                          R                                      (Status light)
     L1                                                                                         1KW
                                                                                    100 K
              Input                                                                              Vout ( + 5V)
             device
                         R                                                                     T1
     L2
                                                    R2              D



                                                                         Photo transistor

          Fig. 12.6 Simplified AC input module circuit with indication light for on input terminal

      The input module has a common connection for the neutral or grounded potential (L2)
for AC modules and the negative (–) for DC modules. To wire the input devices to AC input




dharm
d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5         297
298                                                                          CONTROL OF MACHINES

module one terminal of all the input devices are connected to hot terminal (L1) of the ac supply
and the other terminal of each input device is connected to the input terminal on the module.
       Resistors are used to drop the incoming voltage, then a bridge rectifier is used to convert
the AC input voltage of DC. Next a filtering circuit is used to condition the DC and also to
provide a delay in sending the signal forward. The delay is required to safeguard against
electrical noise signals generated due to bouncing action of limit switch.
       When the input device closes, LED emits light which falls on the photo transistor and
turns it ON. Turning ON of photo transistors will switch OFF the transistor T1, thus + 5V
appears at the Vout terminal of logic circuit, which is communicated to the processor and the
information is stored as binary 1 in the memory location assigned for the status of input device.
By employing this type of optical coupling, or isolation, there is no actual connection between
the input device and the processor. This eliminates any possibility of the 240V input voltage
from coming in contact with and damaging the low-volage DC section of the processor. Optical
isolation also protects the processor from electrical noise, voltage transients or spikes.
       Status indication, whether the input device is ON or OFF is provided by another LED
used in the optically coupled circuit. All the eight LED for this purpose are provided on the top
of the input module (see Fig. 12.6). The status light is lit, when the input device is closed and
is OFF when the input device is open. Status lights are very helpful for troubleshooting, as just
looking at the status lights, technicians know the status of all input devices.
12.3.2   DC Discrete Input Module
A typical DC input module wired to input devices is shown Fig. 12.7(a).

                                  +          –

                                                              Com


                                                              IN1


                                                              IN2


                                      Input Devices           IN3


                                                              IN4


                                                              IN5


                                                              IN6


                                                              IN7


                                                              IN8


                        Fig. 12.7 (a) Connections for a discrete DC input module




dharm
d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5    298
PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER                                                                           299
                                                                               + VCC (+ 5V)



                                                                                       1 KW
                                      Input indicator LED         100 KW
                                                                                                Vout
                                         (Status light)
                                                                                                (+ 5V)
                                                                                                to PLC
                                  R
     +
             Limit Switch                                   L
                                                            E
                                         D                  D

                                  R
     –
                                                            Photo transistor
              Fig. 12.7 (b) Simplified circuit for one terminal of a DC discrete input module
      The enclosure shown in the Fig. 12.7 will contain eight number of electronic circuits as
shown in Fig. 12.7(b), which are similar to the circuit shown in Fig. 12.6 except that there is no
bridge rectifier required, as the voltage used to energize the input device is DC.

   12.4    DISCRETE OUTPUT MODULES
Discrete output module can be AC or DC type. Both types are available in a wide range of
voltages. The function of discrete output module is to energies the output device such as motor
starter coil, pilot lights, solenoids valve etc., connected at its terminal, when the processor
places a binary 1 in the memory location assigned for that particular device.
        The cost of a output module is proportional to the number of terminals provided for
connecting output devices. The standard terminals available are 8, 16 and 32. Output module
has a continuous current rating for each terminal as well as continuous overall rating for the
module. A surge rating is also specified, indicating the maximum current that can be allowed
to flow for a specific time. A typical current rating of a 240 V AC output module would be 1 amp
maximum, continuous duty with a surge current rating of 3 ampers.
        The output module are provided with fuse to protect against over current, short circuits
and ground faults. The number of fuse used vary with each manufacturer. In some modules
only one fuse is provided for all the outputs while in others individual fuses are provided for
each output. Some manufacturers do not provide any fuse, so external fuses must be connected.
Blown fuse indication is also provided on most PLCs. Some PLCs have only one blown-fuse
indicator while others have blown-fuse indicator for each individual output thus simplifying
the troubleshooting.
        Status lights are also provided in the modules to indicate the status of any particular
output. Some modules have two status lights for each output point. One is referred to as the
logic light, and the other as the output light. When the logic lamp is lit, it indicates that logic
to turn on the output device has been sent from the processor. When the output light is on, it
indicates that current is actually flowing to the output device. Status lights are thus very
important tools in troubleshooting, but it should be ascertained what the status lights indicate.
12.4.1    AC Output Module
AC output module standard voltages are 120 V or 240 V as most industrial solenoid valves and
starter coils are designed for this voltage. A 8 circuit AC output module for 240 volts is shown
in Fig. 12.8. One wire of each output device is connected to the neutral (L2) of the AC supply.



dharm
d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5       299
300                                                                            CONTROL OF MACHINES

The other terminals of output devices are connected to the output terminals of the module.
The hot wire (L1) of the AC supply is connected to the common terminal available on output
module.
                                                       L1                  L2
                                                            220V AC
                                  COM

                                 OUT1

                                 OUT2                            M

                                 OUT3                            B

                                 OUT4

                                 OUT5                            H

                                 OUT6

                                 OUT7                           CR

                                 OUT8


                         Fig. 12.8 Connection of output devices to a output module
       The internal circuit for one terminal of the output module is shown in Fig. 12.9. In a
8-Point module, there will be 8 such type of circuits mounted on a printed circuit board. Either
a SCR or a TRIAC is used as the switching device.
       A circuit using SCR is shown in Fig. 12.9, when a signal from processor appears for
energisation of a solenoids coil, the RC potential divider is energized and capacitor will start
charging. At a particular value of capacitor voltage, V, T is turned on and capacitor gets
discharged through it. A pulse thus gets applied to the primary of a pulse transformer connected
to the base of UJT. This pulse is transferred to the secondary side of the transformer and gets
applied between gate and cathode of SCR. The SCR will trigger on and will start conducting if
its anode is positive with respect to cathode. To achieve current flow through load on both half
cycles of ac voltage, a bridge rectifier is used to provide a continuous dc supply to the SCR.
Instead of a pulse transformer an optically coupled photo transister can also be used to energies
a TRIAC for switching on the supply to output device.

                                         + DC
                                         logic
               Input                    supply
                from
             processor      R1          R2

                                                 SCR
                                                                                        220 V
                                                                                         AC
                                 UJT

                 CAP



                    Fig. 12.9 Simplified circuit for one terminal of an output module




dharm
d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5     300
PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER                                                                                301

12.4.2   DC Output Modules
DC output modules are available in ranges from 12-240VDC. Suitable voltage  current range
has to be selected by the consumer according to the load requirements. The operation of a DC
output module is similar to that of an AC module, except that instead of SCR or TRIAC, power
transistor will be used to switch on power to the output device. When connecting the output
device to the output module, one terminal of all the output devices are connected to the negative
of the DC supply and +ve terminal is connected to the common terminal on the module. A
typical DC output circuit for each terminal of the output module will be as shown in Fig. 12.10.


                                                                                                       + DC
                                                                                         Fuse
                                                       Power
             From                                      transistor
             processor                                                          Output indicator led
                                          Photo                                          R
                     LED                  transistor

                                                                                                       – DC

                                                                                       Load

                                 Fig. 12.10 Simplified DC output module circuit
      The power transister has a quicker switching capability than the SCR and TRIAC used
in AC output modules; therefore the response time of DC modules is faster than the AC modules.
12.4.3   Rating of Output Modules
Output modules have limited current ratings. Thus, when larger loads are to be energized, a
interposing relay is used, which is a standard control relay, having small inrush and continuous
current value. The contacts of the control relay are generally rated at 10 amp. The contacts of
the relay are used to energise a larger size contactor used for motor starter or heating loads.
The connection for energising a large motor using interposing relay is shown in Fig. 12.11.

                                     L1                220V AC                    L2

                                           CR                              OL
                                                                       M
                                                                    Size 4
                                                                    contactor


                                                   1                    CR
                                                   2
                                                   3
                                                   4                Interposing
                                                   5                relay
                                                   6
                                                   7
                                                   8           Output module


                                   Fig. 12.11 Interposing relay connections




dharm
d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5      301
302                                                                              CONTROL OF MACHINES

   12.5     ANALOG I/O MODULES
Analog input and output modules are used in process control where variables such as tempera-
ture, light intensity, speed, pressure, position and flow measuring instruments etc have to be
read and output devices like positioning valves, strip chart recorders, actuators, displays and
variable drive systems have to be energized. Most of the todays analog I/O modules are avail-
able in three ranges:
        (1) 0 to 10 volts (DC) also called unipolar
        (2) –10 to +10 volts (DC), also called bipolar and
        (3) 4 to 20 milliampers (mA DC), also refered to as current.
        The last version can, many times be expressed as 1 to 5 volts (DC) with a simple
reconfiguration of the module.
        Input modules are available in configuration of two, four and eight channels. Output
modules are available in configuration of four or two channels. Newer analog I/O modules
provide the mixing of analog input and output on one module.
        In analog input module, the analog signal from the sensing device is converted to 8 bit
or 16 bit binary values for storage in the PLC processor memory with the help of a analog to
digital (ADC) converter. The analog output module changes the 8 bit or 16 bit binary from the
PLC memory to analog value using the Digital to Analog (DAC) converter. A typical mixed
type of analog I/O module having two input and two output channels is shown in Fig. 12.12.

                 Output status                              Input status LED
                 LED                 Output      Input
                                              Power         Power status LED
                                    Analog

                                                         (1) IN 0±
                                                         (2) IN 0±
                                                         (3) ANL COM             Door label
                                                         (4) IN 1+
                         Terminal
                         block                           (5) IN 1±
                                                         (6) ANL COM
                                                         (7) OUT 0
                                                         (8) ANL COM           Door

                                                         (9) OUT 1
                                                         (10) ANL COM




                                    Fig. 12.12 Analog input/output module
       The module shown contains a openable door exposing the terminal block to provide
connection for the analog input and output channels. It is specifically designed to interface
with analog current and voltage input signals. The channels can be wired as either single-
ended or differential inputs. There are DIP switches on the circuit board of the module for
selecting voltage or current input.
      Analog modules are generally classed by their resolution, which is their ability to convert
the analog information to digital form in the case of an input, the reverse for an output. This




dharm
d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5    302
PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER                                                              303

resolution is expressed in bits: for examples 16 bit or 8 bit resolution. It should be clear that
higher the resolution, the more accurately an analog value can be represented digitally.
        Here we have discussed some basic input/output modules for a basic understanding
only. Each PLC manufacturer however has a long list of modules they market for common or
specialized applications. An example of specialized module is high speed counting and position
sensing module, A PLC manufacturer representative should be contacted for a full and complete
list of modules that are available.

   12.6    SAFETY CIRCUIT
PLCs of today are though very rugged and dependable, but where safety is concerned, it is
recommended by the manufacturing associations not to solely depend on the solid-state devices
or PLC program for removal of power to output devices on emergency stop. It is thus
recommended, that a hard-wire emergency Stop push button should de-energies the power to
output module. Thus safety circuit as shown in Fig. 12.13 is recommended.
      A control relay designated as master control relay (MCR) is used to de-energies the
output devices when emergency stop push button is pressed. The contact of MCR relay in the
neutral will de-energise all the output device on emergency stop and MCR contact in line will
de-energise all inputs and power supply to output module. The MCR contact in line is however
optional as normally the inputs are kept energized for ease in troubleshooting.

                                 Emergency                                      Neutral
                        Line       stop
                        fuse                       Start              MCR


                     MCR
                    Optional                   MCR
                    contact                                 Input module



                                                                                  MCR



                                                            Output module


                                                                       C




                        Fig. 12.13 Safety circuit using physical master control relay

   12.7    PROCESSOR UNIT
The processor consists of a microprocessor, memory chips, circuits necessary to store and retrieve
information from the memory, and communication circuits required for the processor to interface
with the programmer, printer and other peripheral devices. Block diagram for Processor unit
is shown in Fig. 12.14. Memory of the Processor has been shown divided into subsections for
easy understanding. Microprocessor and its associated circuits have been referred to as Central
Processing Unit (CPU).




dharm
d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5     303
304                                                                            CONTROL OF MACHINES



           From input           Input image                      Output image         To output
            module                 table                             table             module
                                                  CPU
                                (Memory)                           (Memory)




                                 User program                  Variable data
                                   memory                        memory


                                                Processor

                        Fig. 12.14 Block diagram representation of a processor unit

        The processor may be part of the self-contained unit housing processor, input and output
modules and power supply. A Allen Bradley make SLC 150, is a self-contained PLC (refer
Fig. 12.2). The porcessor may be modular in design and plug directly into the I/O rack (refer
Fig. 12.3). In the extreme left is the dc power supply. The processor is inserted into the first
slot of the rack. The Fig. 12.3 shows a SLC 5/02 CPU in the first slot. In other slots modular
input and output modules are installed. This whole assembly of power supply, processor and
input/output module comprise the programmable logic controller.
      The processor is the brain of programmable logic controller. It is the decision maker and
controls the operation of the machine to which it is connected. The processor controls the
output devices connected to output modules based on the status of the input devices and the
program that has been entered into the PLC memory. The processor is also referred to as
central processing unit or CPU by some authors. Here the sub-section of the processor which
actually performs program execution is called CPU.
      The microprocessor used in the processor depends upon the number of inputs to be
monitored and number of outputs to be controlled. Larger the number of inputs and outputs,
and more complicated the control functions to be performed, the more powerful the
microprocessor required. Various functions of micro processor are:
       1. Monitors the status (ON or OFF) of the input devices.
       2. Solves the logic of the user program stored in the memory.
       3. Controls the output devices (ON or OFF) based on status of input devices and user
          program.
       4. Communicates with other devices like hand held programmer, personal computers
          etc.
       5. Manages memory and update timers, counters and internal registers.
      When the micro processor executes the above task in sequence given above it is called
the processor scan.
        When a PLC is powered up, the processor runs an internal self-diagnostic or self-check,
prior to entering the mode, it was left in, when power was last shut down. During the diagnostic
test, if it is detected that any part of processor is not functioning such as faulty memory,
improper communication with I/O section etc., then a message is displayed on the display
window of Hand-held programmer or VDT screen of programming terminal.




dharm
d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5     304
PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER                                                             305

      PLC can be put in various modes of operation. Some typical PLC modes of operation are:
      1. CLEAR program memory Mode
      2. PROGRAMMING Mode
      3. RUN Mode
      4. TESTING program mode
      5. DIAGNOSTIC test mode
      6. Enter/Change Access Code.
        When PLC is put in CLEAR memory mode, the user program stored in PLC memory can
be cleard. Now all the memory is free for entering a new program. A new program can now be
entered by bringing the PLC into PROGRAMMING mode and then program instructions are
entered one by one in sequence. After entering the program, the program execution can be
checked by putting PLC in TEST program mode. In test mode, PLC executes the user program
but does not energise the outputs, only LED displays for outputs are energised. Thus program
working can be checked without actually energising the outputs. This avoids a prospective
damage to machinery on account of incorrect program. The machine can be run continuously
by bringing the PLC in RUN mode. In RUN mode, the PLC first reads the status of input
devices and store them in the memory. Then it executes the user program instructions one by
one and if any outputs are to be energized, the memory location for that output device is updated
by storing binary 1 at that memory location. When whole of the program is executed, the
output devices are energised. After this the PLC will communicate with any connected devices
like hand-held programmer, personal computer, and will also perform any necessary memory
management (housekeeping). Memory management will include updating timers, counters
and internal registers etc. This four-step process called processor scan is repeated over and
over. The scan time of PLC is in milliseconds. The scan time can vary from a fraction of a
millisecond to 100+ milliseconds depending upon the size of the program. Each manufacturer
lists the scan time based on the use of 1K (1024 words) of program memory. A typical scan time
is 3-5 msecs per 1K (1024 words) of memory used. A typical processor scan is shown in Fig. 12.15.

                        Communication
                        and housekeeping                   1      Input scan

                                      4


                                                                    2
                                  3                                       Program
                         Output
                         scan                                             execution




                                      Fig. 12.15 Typical processor scan

       It must be noted that output devices are energized all together during the output scan
rather than energizing them while the program is being executed. This is because, in general
the load devices themselves are hopelessly slow compared to the scan cycle of the PLC. For
example a real solenoid might require 30 to 50 milliseconds to get magnetically flushed and
pull in its armature. This much time is enough for the PLC to scan its whole cycle several
times. Thus, if during program scan, a solenoid is to be energized the signal has to be sent to




dharm
d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5   305
306                                                                                      CONTROL OF MACHINES

the above said duration and program execution is halted. Thus under these circumstances,
instead of delaying the program execution, the outputs are energized together in output scan
after the whole of program is executed. Waiting for the output scan to energies outputs is soon
enough in most of the industrial control applications.
      In some rare applications, it may be necessary to energies an output immediately during
user-program execution. To facilitate this, advanced PLCs have a instruction called immediate
output instruction. This instruction temporarily suspends the normal business of the program,
and energise the required output device. After the energisation of the output device, the normal
execution of the user program is restored. This type of processor scan is shown in Fig. 12.16.

                          Input scan                                               Output module



                             Immediate
                             output                                                         One output
                                               One location                                 energised
                             instruction       in output        Transfer to
                                               image table     output module
                                               changed




                                              Return to normal program execution


                        Fig. 12.16 Processor scan with a immediate output instruction

       Similarly advanced PLCs also provide a special instruction called immediate input
instruction, which can be used to update the status of a particular input device in the input
image table, during the execution of the user program, just prior to the user program instruction
which uses the status of that input. The use of this instruction is necessitated in a control
situation, where it really matters if the input has changed during the few milliseconds that
may have elapsed between the last input scan and the point in the user program, where the
critical instruction is encountered. The input immediate capability during a processor scan is
shown in the Fig. 12.17.

                                 Input scan                         Input
                                                                    module

                                    Immediate                       One input
           Output
                                    input                           read
           scan
                                    instruction                                    One location
                                                                                   in input image
                                                                     Transfer      table
                                                                     to input
                                    Interrupt                        image table
                                    program execution
                                    to read one input


                                                              Return to normal program execution

                        Fig. 12.17 Processor scan with a immediate input instruction




dharm
d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5      306
PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER                                                             307

12.7.1   Internal Self Diagnostic System
During normal operation, the processor scan is completed and started again in an orderly
predictable cycle. The processor should not stuck while scanning the user-program or for some
other reason is unable to complete the current scan. Being unable to complete the scan means
that the processor has no control over the real-word outputs. Real word outputs without control
might be left running when they were to be stopped. This could spell disaster. A watch dog
timer is used to insure that the processor complete each scan in a timely manner.
       The watchdog timer is preset to an amount of time that is slightly longer than the scan
time would be under normal conditions. At the start of each scan, the watch dog timer is
turned ON and starts to accumulate time. If the program is correct, the program scan will be
complete prior to the time set on the watchdog timer, and at the end of each scan, the watch
dog timer is reset to 0 (zero). If for some reason the program scan is not completed in the
allotted time, indicating that there is a problem with the program, the watchdog timer will
time out, which puts the processor into a faulted condition and all outputs will be turned OFF.
The range of the timer is software selectable (adjustable) on many PLCs.
       A program that faults due to watchdog timer timing out may have become caught in an
endless loop within the porgram. This could be the result of programming problems such as
the use of too many uncontrolled backward jumps where there is no defined jump out of the
loop. Using subroutines where too much time is spent within one or multiple subroutines,
could also result in the program scan time exceeding the watchdog timer time value. In some
instance, lengthening the watchdog timer preset value can solve the problem.
       In addition to the scan time problem detected by watchdog timer, other processor errors
that are detected by the internal diagnostic system are: processor hardware problem, processor
memory problem, communication problem, expansion unit problem, EEPROM module problem.
The problems related to programmer and programming are also detected by the internal
diagnostic system which are as follows. Incomplete rung (no output instruction), invalid address
for instruction, user memory exceeded, branch error (short circuit), branch error (incomplete
branch), invalid access code (password).
12.7.2   Memory Types
Memory types will be discussed here in a generalized way for basic understanding. Memory
chips used in the processor can be separated into two distinct groups: volatile and non volatile.
A volatile memory is one that loses its stored information when power is removed. Even
momentary loss of power erases any information stored or programmed on a volatile memory
chip. A non volatile memory has the ability to retain stored information when power is removed
accidentlly or intentionally.
       The most common type of volatile memory is Random Access Memory (RAM) also
refered to as read/write memory, as information can be written into, or read from this memory.
Random access means, any memory location can be accessed or used easily. RAM is used for
both, as user memory for storing the program and as storage memory for storing of status of
input and outputs and other data required for execution of the program. As RAM is volatile, it
must be backed up with a battery to retain or protect the stored program. Various forms of
RAM are MOS, HMOS and CMOS-RAM (complimentary Metal Oxide Semiconductor) is one of
the most popular type of RAM. CMOS-RAM is popular as it has a very low current drain when
not being accessed (15 micro amperes) and the information stored in memory can be retained
by as little as 2V DC. Back-up power for CMOS-RAM is provided by a replaceable battery
assembly. The lithium battery provides back-up power for approximately 2-3 years. However
in the absence of battery, there is a provision of a standard back-up power provided by a
capacitor which can hold or protect the program for 1-2 weeks.



dharm
d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5   307
308                                                                       CONTROL OF MACHINES

      Non-volatile memories are memories that retain their information or program when
power is lost, and they do not require battery backup. A common type of non-volatile memory
is Read Only Memory (ROM). Read only means that information can be written only once and
subsequently, that information can only be read but cannot be changed. In PLC processor, the
ROM used contains the program for internal use, of the PLC. It is this program, which makes
the PLC different from the ordinary personal computer. This programme cannot be changed.
ROM chips can however be changed to upgrade the PLC. Other types of non-volatile memory
are PROM, UVPROM, EPROM, EAROM and EEPROM.
       EEPROM i.e. Electrically Erasable Programmable Read only Memory is also used with
PLC to upload program from the RAM of PLC or for loading a program into the PLC. A special
Pin Socket is available on the PLC for the EEPROM module. EEPROM is thus used as a
nonvolatile backup for the user program RAM. If the user program in RAM is lost or erased a
copy of the program stored on an EEPROM, chip can be downloaded into RAM. It is common in
some PLCs for the processor to load the program from EEPROM chip into RAM memory each
time the processor is powered up or after a power failure. EEPROM is a chip that can be
programmed using a standard programming device and can be erased by the proper signal
being applied to the erase pin.
       Memory in PLC can be subdivided into sub-section for easy understanding. The
subsections are input image table, output image table, user-program memory and variable
data memory (refer block diagram for processor unit Fig. 12.14).
12.7.3   Input Image Table
It is a portion of the processor memory, where the status of input devices whether open or close
is stored. Every single input terminal of a input module is assigned a particular location (address)
in the portion of memory called input image table. This particular location is dedicated solely
to the task of keeping track of the latest condition of its input terminal. If a particular input
terminal has 220 volts fed to it, due to closing of input device connected to it, a binary (01) is
stored in that memory location allotted to that particular input module. If there is no voltage
at the input terminal then binary (0) is stored in that particular location. Thus only one bit is
required to store the status of discrete inputs. In case the input module is a analog module
then the memory assigned to each input is 8 bits or 16 bits depending upon the PLC.
        The memory locations in the input image table thus store the image of the input devices,
that is why it is named as input image table. The image of status of input devices is created in
the input image table before the processor starts executing the user program, as the status of
input devices are the deciding factors in the execution of user program.
12.7.4   Output Image Table
This is another portion of the processor memory, where the each output terminal of the output
module is assigned a particular memory location (address). When the processor executes the
user program and a particular output is required to be energized a binary (1) is stored in the
memory location alloted to that particular output. Thus when the user program execution is
complete the output image table updating is also complete. Now all the outputs which have
binary (1) stored in their assigned memory locations are energized simultaneously after the
last instruction of user-program is executed. This period of the processor cycle in which outputs
are energized is called the output scan.
       It may be noted that the processor can write to and also read from the output image
table as the status of any output being energized may affect the user program in subsequent
instructions of user program. However, the processor only reads from the input image table
during the execution of the user program.




dharm
d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5   308
PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER                                                             309

12.7.5    User Program Memory
This is the portion of the processor memory which is used for storing the program in the form
of coded instruction which represents the logic of the functions to be carried out. This
programming is done through a key board and the program can be seen on a VDU (Visual
Display Unit).
      As the instructions are entered through a key board, they are automatically stored as
sequential location within the user-program memory. The total number of instructions can
range from a dozen or so, for controlling a simple machine, to several hundreds, for controlling
a complex machine or a process.
       Central processing unit executes the User-program instructions step by step. During
execution, if the instruction execution calls for a change at any of the output image table
locations, it immediately updates the output image table.
       The CPU executes subsequent instructions by taking into account the output conditions,
since these often effect later instructions in the program.
       It thus becomes clear that the output image table has two functions. Its first function is
to receive immediate information from the CPU and pass it on to the output module. The
second function is to pass on information backwards to the CPU when any instruction calls for
the state (high or low) of a particular output, for its execution.
        On the other hand, the input image table has only to acquire information from the input
module of I/O section and pass on that information to CPU when the instruction execution
calls for any input information. The dual nature of information flow for the output image table
is shown by an arrow in the block diagram in Fig. 12.14.
12.7.6 Variable Data Memory
       User program instruction can have time settings, counter settings, numeric comparison
instruction (greater than, less than etc.). These types of instructions will require storage of
data like setting of timers, counters, down counters, etc. The memory which keeps track of
these variable data is called variable-data memory. There are five types of numeric data that
can be present in the variable-data memory.
      •   Preset value of a timer—This is the number of seconds for which the timer must
          remain energized.
      •   Instant value of a timer—This is the number of seconds that elapses after the timer
          is energized.
      •   Preset value of a counter—This is the number that an Up counter must count or the
          starting number from which the Down counter starts counting down.
      •   Instant value of a counter—This is the number of counts recorded by an Up counter
          or the number of counts remaining for the Down-counter.
      •   Value of a physical variable in the controlled process—This value can be temperature,
          pressure, flow etc. Such a value is obtained by making measurement with the help of
          a transducer and converting the transducer’s analog output voltage into digital form
          using Analog to Digital (ADC) converter.
       When the CPU is executing an instruction for which a certain data must be known, it
fetches that data from the variable data memory. Also, when CPU executes an instruction
which produces a numeric value, it is stored in the variable data memory. This two way flow of
information is shown by arrows in the block diagram of Fig. 12.14.



dharm
d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5   309
310                                                                       CONTROL OF MACHINES

   12.8     PROGRAMMING DEVICE
Programming device is the control console for the PLC. PLC is operated in different modes like
Programming mode, Run mode, Test mode etc., through the programming device. It is through
the programming device, that a program is entered into the PLC memory. Editing and
troubleshooting of an existing program in PLC memory is also done through programming
device. Once the program has been entered into the PLC memory and PLC is brought into Run
mode, the programming device may be disconnected. It is not necessary for the programming
device to be connected for the PLC to operate, but it can be used to monitor the PLC program
while the program is running. Programming device or also called programmer can be of Hand
held type, Dedicated desktop type or a computer can be used as programming device. Each of
the above type of programmer has its own advantages and disadvantages.
12.8.1    Dedicated Desktop Programmers
A typical dedicated programmer consists of a keyboard, VDT (Video display terminal) and
necessary electronic circuits and memory for developing, editing and loading program into the
PLC processor memory.
       In appearance, the dedicated programmers resembles the personal computer but not in
their capabilities. They are not capable of computer functions like running software programs
for word processing and spreadsheets. They are however rugged in construction and can
withstand the mechanical shock associated with moving the programmer from machine to
machine. They can function in the industrial environment under high humidity, high
temperature, dust dirt and electromagnetic interference.
       The keyboard of the dedicated programmer can be like the keyboard of a computer with
raised keys or have sealed touchpad type keyboard suited for the industrial environment.
Most dedicated programmer keyboards have electrical symbol keys for normally open normally
closed contacts, timer contacts, output symbol, Relay, timer, counter etc. These dedicated keys
pertaining to ladder logic program development make programming easier for the technician
who are not much familiar with computers. The keyboard also has special function keys that
are used for program development and numeric and alpha keys for addressing and labeling
the program.
       Video display terminals can have screen sizes from 5 to 12 inches, measured diagonally.
They are also referred to as CRTs (Cathode ray tubes). When the PLC is put in program mode;
and program is entered through the programmer keyboard, the program appears on the VDTs
screen as it is entered. The video screen allows to display multiple lines or rungs of the program.
This makes the entering and editing of program easy. After the completion of program, it is
down loaded from the programmer memory to PLC processor memory. Once the program has
been into user memory the PLC is placed in the RUN mode, and thus the program is activated.
The programmers VDT now gives the visual display of the program execution. The program
instructions which are true are highlighted either by making them brighter of by using reverse
video. No matter which method is used this feature of dedicated desktop programmer is a
powerful troubleshooting aid.
        The above discussed advantages of dedicated desktop programmer are however obtained
at a relative high cost. The other disadvantage is that limited models of PLC can be programmed
with a particular programmer. It also has limited documentation and graphic capabilities. The
physical size of the programmer makes it unsuitable for portability; which is very much required
in an industry as PLCs installed on various machines are supposed to be programmed using a
single programmer.




dharm
d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5   310
PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER                                                            311

12.8.2   Hand-held Programmers
Hand-held programmers resemble a calculator in appearance
and is only a slightly bigger. A Hand-held programmer for Allen
Bradleys SLC is shown in Fig. 12.18.
      Hand-held programmers are thus smaller, cheaper, and
more portable than dedicated desktop programmer. They are
most suitable for installations, where control functions have to
be changed frequently. It is also much easier to connect the hand-
held programmer to the processor for changing program
parameters or for troubleshooting than to bring the heavier
desktop programmer.
       The main limitation of the hand held programmer is that,
it has a limited display capability. Some hand-held programmer
display a Rung of logic with up to four horizontal line, while
others display only one line and some do not display any rung at
all. The location of cursor in the program in such a programmer
is made out from the LED glow for the type of instruction and
liquid crystal display of its address and Rung number. The hand-
held programmer takes more time to go through the program
one contact or one rung at a time and also more keystones are
required to enter the program. Fewer functions are possible and
it works with only specific PLC model. It has limited access to       Fig. 12.18 A hand held
memory and also has limited or no documentation capabilities.               programmer

12.8.3   Computer Programmers
A PLC can be programmed using a Personal Computer with the help of a special programming
software loaded on the PC and a special card installed on the PC for communicating between
PLC and PC. However some PLCs may not require communication card to communicate with
PC.
       PLC programming software have been developed by PLC manufactureres themselves
and also by other companies. The software’s developed by a company other than the
manufacturer of PLC are referred as “third party software”. With softwares available for all
major brands of PLCs, the personal computer has now become the most common programming
device. These software programs can generally be used with most personal computers in either
DOS or Window environment. For example Rockwell Automation, has developed a windows
based program called RS logix 500 which can be used to program the Allen Bradleys PLC-5,
SLC 500 and Micrologic 1000 and 1500 PLCs. Fig. 12.19 shows a PC with RS logix 500 program
installed.
       Programming using a Personal Computer provide many of the advantages of the
dedicated desk-top programmer, but also provides features not available on most dedicated
desktop programmers. The personal computer usually has a colour monitor (VDT), and the
monitor shows multiple rungs of program logic, as well as highlighting the circuit elements to
indicate status, just like the dedicated desktop programmer. When the program is first
developed, it is done in the program mode or also called off line mode. Off line mode means
program is being developed in the RAM of the computer memory and it has not yet been loaded
into the processor memory. Once the program is developed it is downloaded into the processor
memory for testing and verification. For testing, the PLC is put in test mode, in which the



dharm
d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5   311
312                                                                       CONTROL OF MACHINES




                        Fig. 12.19 Programming software on personal computer
program is executed but the output devices are not energized. After verifying the proper
functioning of program, the PLC is put in RUN mode. If any changes to the program is done
while PLC is in RUN mode, it is called ON-line programming. Making changes to the program
while the program is running and the driven equipment is operational (ON line programming)
must only be done by trained personnel who not only understand the PLC program, but also
thoroughly understand the driven machinery or process. To prevent unauthorized access to
the software, most of the softwares requires activation key, when the software is turned on.
Activation key can be in the form of a hardware key, which is usually connected to one of the
printer ports or it can also be in the form of a floppy disk or a password may be required when
the software is first started. Some manufactures however do no copy-protect their software
and encourage copying and widespread use of their software.
12.8.4    Advantages of Using Personal Computers for Programming
         1. The foremost advantage of using personal computer for programming is that the
            program can be stored in its hard disc or in a floppy disc. If the program in PLC
            processor memory is lost due to any reason, the program can be restored easily from
            the hard disc or floppy disc of personal computer.
         2. PLC programming software for personal computers provide more documentation
            capabilities than desktop programmers. Graphic capabilities of the software, provide
            for developing a flow diagram of the controlled equipment or process, and provide
            operator alarms and messages from the process information.
         3. The software updating can be easily accomplished by loading the new software into
            the computer hard disk through floppy/CD disk drive. On the other hand a Dedi-
            cated desktop programmer requires changes in ROM chips to accomplish updates.
         4. The computer has the added ability to interface the PLC software program with
            other software programs for “cut and paste” program development and editing.
         5. PLC programming software used on personal computer have the feature of being
            able to display Rungs of logic in any order that may be helpful for troubleshooting.
            This feature though also available on few dedicated programmers but is a standard
            feature on all computer based software’s.
         6. Computer provides more flexibility and networking capabilities than the Dedicated
            Programmers for networking multiple PLCs.




dharm
d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5   312
PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER                                                                          313

         7. Availability of small laptop computers provide an added flexibility in the use of com-
            puter for programming PLCs.
         8. Low cost when compared to dedicated desktop programming.
12.8.5    Disadvantages of Using Personal Computer for Programming a PLC
         1. The programming learning curve for programming using a computer based software
            is longer than the Dedicated programmer programming, as the keys using control
            component symbols are not used as in the case of a Dedicated programmer keyboard.
        2. The computer is not designed for the industrial environment. It is affected by electri-
           cal noise, high temperature and humidity conditions in the industrial environment.
       To overcome the shortcoming of personal computer in its use in the industrial
environment has led to the development of Industrial-rated computer programmers. It is a
mix of the Dedicated programmer and the personal computer. Allen Bradley, Siemens, Modicon
and GE-Fanuc are several of the companies that offer these highbred programmers. This type
of programmer, however, is more expensive than the Dedicated desktop programmer or a
personal computer, but one gets the best features of both.

   12.9         FUNDAMENTAL PLC PROGRAMMING
12.9.1    Introduction
The fundamental level, ladder logic programs for PLC are very similar to the relay control
circuits, we have studied in this book. In this book, we have drawn the relay control circuits
between two horizontal lines representing a phase and neutral of the control supply. If the
same control diagram is drawn between two vertical lines, it is called ladder logic diagram, as
the two vertical lines representing phase and neutral resemble two poles of a ladder and the
control circuits drawn between the two vertical lines resemble the rungs of a ladder. A control
circuit for starting two motors in a sequence is shown drawn in two different types of control
circuit representation
         Line                                    Line                                  Neutral

            Stop               A2       B1
                                             Rung 1                                A       Motor 1
                                                                    OL1 OL2                contactor
                                                                    (Overload relay
                          A1                                 A2        contacts)
            Start

                                             Rung 2                               B        Motor 2
                                                        A2                                 contactor
                OL1
                                                        B1
                OL2                          Rung 3                                        Indication
                                                                                           lamp

                      A             B
           N
                               (a)                                  (b)

           Fig. 12.20 Logic of sequence starting of two motors using relay ladder logic diagram
       Ladder logic diagram is a graphical language that is based on relay ladder logic and is
the most widely used language to program the current generation PLCs.
       The first PLC was programmed with ladder logic. This decision to use the relay logic
was a strategic one. This eliminated the need to teach the electricians, technician and engineers



dharm
d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5           313
314                                                                            CONTROL OF MACHINES

how to program. The ability of PLCs to accept programming in ladder diagram format is one of
the reasons for the success of PLCs in industry. The many similarities between the ladder
diagrams used to program PLCs and the relay ladder logic used to control industrial systems,
eased the transition from hardwired relay system to PLC based systems for many people in
the electrical industry. Also the ability to monitor PLC logic in ladder diagram format also
made troubelshooting easier for those already familiar with relay based control systems.
Although there are many higher-level languages now available for PLC programming, the
majority of systems are still programmed in ladder diagram format because of these advantages.
Ladder logic diagram is quite flexible and it is best used for
       •   Boolean operations
       •   Computer logical operations
       •   Message and communication processing
       •   Interlocks
       •   Troubleshoot a machine and process
       When a PLC is to be used primarily to replace relays, timers and counters, it’s hard to
beat the simplicity and usefulness to ladder diagram programming. However it has a number
of deficiencies also.
       The basic ladder diagram instructions are fine for performing many simple tasks, but
sometimes things get more complicated for example when a shift register, stack is to be
programmed. Although these complex tasks can be programmed with combinations of the
standard ladder logic instructions but PLC manufacturers have used function blocks to make
programming some of the more common tasks easier. Many PLC manufacturers have now
converted timing, counting and arithmetic instructions to the more use-friendly functions in
the block format.
      Function block diagram is another form of graphical language. The main concept is that
the data flow start from inputs and passes in block(s) and generate output. Thus the program
elements appear (i.e., reusable software elements) as Functions blocks, which are connected
together with lines that represent wires in a way, that look much like a circuit diagram. The
ladder logic diagram shown in Fig. 12.21 shows the use of a function block.

                        Switch                     T ON
                         IN 1
                                                   Timer ON
                                                   Timer T1               DN
                                                   Time Base 1.0
                                                   Preset 5
                                                                          EN
                                                   Accum 0



                          T1                                            OUT 1


                         TT                                            Indicator
                                                                         lamp




                              Fig. 12.21 PLC program using a function block
      RS logix 500 a software for programming of Allen Bradly PLC-5, SLC 500 and micrologix
family of PLSs use the combine of ladder logic and function block as the programming language.



dharm
d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5   314
PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER                                                                        315

12.9.2   Physical Components Versus Program Components
One of the most difficult concepts to grasp while learning PLC programming is the difference
between physical components and program components. The physical components like switches,
push-buttons, pressure switches, relays, solenoids are connected to the input/output terminals
of the PLC. When the PLC is programmed, then the physical components connected to PLC
are programmed as program components. The program component corresponding to a physical
components will not have the same symbol as the physical component but will have the same
name. All input physical components which have only two positions ON or OFF are represented
by normally open and normally closed contacts. Similarly all output devices are represented
by one symbol i.e., a relay or output symbol. The logic for the control is built using the internal
program components like relays, latch relays, timers, counters, sequences and shift registers
etc. It should be understood here that there are no such physical components in the PLC but
the microprocessor simulates the function of a physical component which is programmed as a
program component in the program.
       Now, we take a simple relay circuit having two pushbuttons PB1 and PB2 connected in
series to operate a lamp. The circuit is shown in Fig. 12.22.

                               Line     Push buttons                            Neutral
                                       PB1         PB2

                        Rung 1

                                                                   Indication
                                                                     lamp

                          Fig. 12.22 A simple relay circuit using two pushbuttons
       When we convert this circuit to run through PLC, we will remove the components from
the circuit and wire them to the PLC as shown in Fig. 12.23.

            Line             Neutral                                      Line              Neutral
                   220V AC                          PLC                           220V AC
                                            COM           COM
                                            IN1           OUT1
                                            IN2           OUT2
                                            IN3           OUT3
                                            IN4           OUT4
                                            IN5           OUT5
                                            IN6           OUT6
                                            IN7           OUT7
                                            IN8           OUT8

           Fig. 12.23 Wiring of push buttons and indication lamp to input and output module
       One major difference in this circuit is that the two switches are no longer wired in
series. Instead, each one is wired to a separate input on the PLC. By providing each push
button as a separate input to PLC, we gain the maximum amount of flexibility i.e., we can
program them in any fashion in the ladder logic program.




dharm
d:N-MachMac12-2.pm5     315
316                                                                                  CONTROL OF MACHINES

       Now we will see, how the logic is programmed in the PLC to get the same operation as is
obtained by the hard wire circuit shown in Fig. 12.22. The push-buttons in the program will be
designated by the input addresses to which they are connected on the PLC. The output in the
program will be designated by the output address to which the output (indication lamp) is
connected. Since push-button PB1 is connected to input address IN1, it will be designated as
IN1 in the program and will be represented by a normally open contact. Likewise push-buttons
PB2 will be designated IN2 in the program. Indication lamp will be represented in the program
by the output symbol ( ) and will be designated by OUT1, i.e., the output address to which it is
connected. The program to control lamp is shown in the Fig. 12.24.


                                   PB1              PB2                  Indication
                                   IN 1             IN 2                   OUT 1
                  Rung 1




                             Fig. 12.24 PLC program for a simple control circuit
       There is a provision in the PLC software to label the Program component with symbol
(PB1) and discription as Push-button as shown in Fig. 12.24. All input devices are represented
by the same programming instruction i.e., (Examine ON instruction), if they are wired with
normally open contact.
       After entering the program of Fig. 12.24 into PLC, when the PLC is put in RUN mode,
the PLC will first update the input image table (a portion of memory) by storing the values of
the inputs on terminals IN1 and IN2 (it stores a 1 if an input is ON and a 0 if it is OFF). Then
it solves the ladder diagram accordingly based on the contents of the input image table. For
this program if there is supply at IN1 and IN2, then both instructions IN1 and IN2 are true
and the output instruction will be made true i.e., address allotted to OUT 1, in the output
image table is made true (1 is stored at OUT 1 location in output image table). Note : it does
not turn on the output terminal yet ! When PLC has scanned the entire program, it performs
another update. This update transfers the contents of the output image table to the output
terminals. This brings supply of 220 V at terminal OUT1, which turns on the lamp. This whole
cycle is repeated again and again.
      For a simple circuit like the one we have discussed, it would be very uneconomical to
implement this circuit on PLC. However, for extensive circuits requiring a lot of relays and
timers, PLC can economise not only on wiring but on the complexity and cost of external
components.
      In the previous section, we discussed how physical control components connected to the
input and output terminals of PLC are represented by various symbols in the programme.
Now, we will study some of the the basic instructions, for writing the ladder logic program.
12.9.3    Examine ON Instruction
This instruction is represented by the symbol of a normally open contact -| |-. This instruction
in a program instructs the processor to examine supply at the input address designated on the
instruction. If there is supply at the designated address the instruction is read as true otherwise
as false.




dharm
d:N-MachMac12-2.pm5      316
PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER                                                               317

12.9.4   Examine OFF Instruction
This instruction is represented by the symbol of a normally closed contact – –. This instruction
                                                                             |/|
in a program instructs the processors to examine the supply at the designated address and if
there is no supply, the instruction is read as true. If there is supply at the designated address
the instruction is read as false.
12.9.5   Internal Relay Instruction
Most important and a valuable programming instruction in a PLC is the internal relay. Internal
relays are general purpose relays which can have any number of normally open and normally
closed contacts for use in the program. It must be understood that they are not “real” relays in
a physical sense, but instead are a digital bit of memory in an internal image register.
      For programming, a relay is represented by a symbol consisting of two paranthesis–( )-
and a designator address, which corresponds to internal memory address allotted to this relay.
The relay contacts are represented by normally open and normally closed contacts having the
same address as that of the relay coil (– –, – –).
                                        || |/|
       All PLCs provide this programming instruction, however the internal addressing scheme
and the maximum number of relays that can be used in a program depends on the PLC brand
and model. Therefore the programmer must refer to the technical manual for the PLC in order
to determine how to reference them in a program and the maximum allowable number that is
available.
       In some PLC brands, the internal relays are also reffered to a Flag or bit.
       NOTE: The same symbols of normally open contact (– –) and normally closed contact
                                                               ||
(– –) are used for Examine ON and Examine OFF instruction and also for the contacts of a
  |/|
internal relay. The golden rule to differentiate whether the normally open or normally closed
contact in a program represents a Examine ON or Examine OFF instruction is to see its address.
If the contacts bears the address of a input terminal of PLC, they are Examine ON or OFF
instruction and if the address is of a relay, they are the contacts of that particular relay.
       The internal relay instruction allows the programmer to perform more complex internal
operations without needlessly using costly output relay. In the programming examples in this
text all internal relays will be designated with a “CR” prefix followed by a number i.e., CR1,
CR2 etc.
12.9.6   Latching Instruction
Latch and Unlatch instructions like their physical real-world counterparts are retentive during
a power failure. When the PLC processor loses power or is switched to either the TEST or
PROGRAM modes, or detects a major fault, outputs are turned OFF. However the state of
latch instruction is retained in memory.
       Latch and unlatch instruction can be used as an internal relay, if the address designated
to this instruction is of the relay. If the Latch instruction is designated with an output terminal
address, then the supply at that particular address is latched. When the supply to processor is
restored after a power failure or processor is brought back to RUN mode after switching out to
TEST or PROGRAM mode, the supply at the latched output terminal will be restored
automatically. The symbol for programming a Latch and Unlatch coil is same as ordinary coil
with letter L and U inserted between the parentheses.
                                          -(L)-, -(U)-




dharm
d:N-MachMac12-2.pm5   317
318                                                                              CONTROL OF MACHINES

12.9.7    Output Instruction
Output instruction is used to program the real word physical control components connected to
the output terminal of the PLC. Irrespective of the type of physical output component connected,
the output instruction is programmed by a symbol consisting of two parentheses and designated
by the address of the output terminal at which the physical output is connected. The information
of a particular output whether it is energized or not can be used in the subsequent rungs of the
ladder program by using normally open or normally closed contacts having the same address
as that of the output.
12.9.8    Programming Stop Push-buttons
Now we discuss the programming of a simple program for the direct on line starting of a motor
as shown in Fig. 12.25(a). In the early days of programmable controllers it was common for the

               L                                                                                N


                                  Stop                Start

               1                                                             M




                                                       M1
                                                       (a)

               Line              Neutral                                   Line              Neutral
                      220V AC              Inputs     PLC        Outputs           220V AC
                          Start                 COM           COM
                                                IN1           OUT1                     M
                                 Stop
                                                IN2           OUT2
                                                IN3           OUT3




                                                       (b)




                                   IN 2               IN 1                 OUT 1
         Rung 1

                                                      OUT 1


                                                       (c)

           Fig. 12.25 (a) Standard STOP/START circuit (b) Wiring of input and output devices
                               (c) PLC programmed STOP/START circuit




dharm
d:N-MachMac12-2.pm5      318
PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER                                                                  319

salespeople to use a demonstrator model that had the STOP push button wired normally open
(N.O) to the input terminal of the PLC as shown in the Fig. 12.25(b). This resulted in the
program very similar to the actual wiring circuit of the Start Stop circuit as shown in
Fig. 12.25(c). By using a normally open contact of STOP push-button, the Examine OFF
instruction is true as normally there will be no supply at terminal IN1 and the circuit will
energies when start push-button is pressed. The output OUT 1 will hold due to relay contact
instruction having address OUT1 getting true once OUT1 is energized. The only way to de-
energies the output now is to push the STOP button. This will make the Examine OFF
instruction IN1 false and the output OUT1 will be de-energized.
       While this circuit will work, there is a built in danger that must be considered. If a
STOP button is wired in a normally open (NO) position, and a wire opens from the terminal of
the STOP button, it will be impossible to de-energise the circuit. With the wire broken, change
in the status of the STOP button cannot be conveyed to the processor and the circuit or equipment
cannot be de-energised.
       The desirable way to connect a STOP button is as shown in Fig. 12.26(a) by using the
normally close contact of the pushbutton. The program now will be as shown in Fig. 12.26(b).
We will have to program a Examine ON instruction for STOP push-button.

              L                 N                                           L               N
                                                                                 220V
                        START              COM            COM
                                           IN1            OUT1                      M
                                           IN2            OUT2
                        STOP
                                           IN3            OUT3
                                           IN4            OUT4
                                           IN5
                                           IN6
                                           IN7
                                           IN8

                                                    (a)




                                    IN1          IN2
                                                                         OUT2
             Rung 1


                                    OUT1




                                                    (b)

                  Fig. 12.26 (a) Desirable input device connections (b) Resulting program




dharm
d:N-MachMac12-2.pm5     319
320                                                                                    CONTROL OF MACHINES

       Note: For safety reasons, all STOP buttons must be wired so that a failure of the switch or a
broken wire will automatically break logic continuity and turn the circuit OFF. A good programmer
should always wire the devices and program the circuit so that if the real-world device fail, it creates a
safe condition, not a safety hazard.
12.9.9    Logical Holding Instructions Versus Discrete Holding Contacts
In the stop, start program for motor discussed in the previous section, we have used the address
of the output for the holding instruction across the start instruction. The output instruction
will be held true once it is turned true due to start instruction getting true but there is no
guarantee however that the actual motor starter connected to the output module has been
energized.
       The only way to guarantee, that the actual motor contactor has energized is to actually
wire the holding contacts of the motor starter to an input module point, and use that address
when programming the holding contacts. This is shown in Fig. 12.27.

               L                 N                                                  L               N
                    220V                   Inputs                        Outputs            220V
                                                    COM    PLC    COM
                                                                                               OL
                                                    IN1           OUT1                  M
                                                    IN2
                           M1
                                                    IN3




                                                            (a)




                                     IN1                  IN2                OUT1



                                     IN3


                                                            (b)

         Fig. 12.27 (a) Use of discrete holding contact. (b) Program using discrete holding contact

12.9.10 Overload Contacts
It is common practice to wire the overload contact, in series with the contactor coil as shown in
Fig. 12.27(a). When the over load contact opens, it will de-energies the motor contactor M. The
holding contact M1, connected to the input module and programmed in the PLC program as
IN3 will break logic, which turn off the supply at OUT1, where the contactor coil is connected.
This type of overload only works, if the holding contacts are wired to an input module and
programmed into the PLC program.




dharm
d:N-MachMac12-2.pm5      320
PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER                                                                     321

       If the holding contact is not wired to an input module but instead the output address is
used for holding logic, then the tripping of overload relay will de-energise the contactor coil
but PLC program logic is not broken and output address supply will remain ON. This can
cause a safety hazard, that the motor will start automatically if the overload is reset. This type
of wiring can also cause problems in sequential motor circuit or other automated circuits.
      If the address of the output is used for logic continuity (holding circuit), then the actual
overload contacts must be wired to an input module and referenced in the PLC program as
shown in Fig. 12.28.

              L                 N                                                 L            N
                   220V                   Inputs                       Outputs          220V
                                                   COM    PLC   COM
                           Start
                                                   IN1          OUT1                       M
                          Stop
                                                   IN2
                           OL
                                                   IN3




                                    IN1                  IN2      IN3            OUT1



                                 OUT1




                          Fig. 12.28 Wiring of overload contact to an input module
      Wiring of overload contact to input module has an added advantage in troubleshooting.
As any address used in PLC program can be viewed for its ON or OFF status by viewing the
LEDs meant for them or on the PLC or the input module.
12.9.11 Master Control Relay Instruction
In relay circuits, a relay is often used to control power to the entire control circuit or to a
portion of control circuit. This relay is also referred to as start relay, control relay or Master
control relay. Fig. 12.29 shows a typical hardwired master control relay that controls power for
the whole control circuit. When the relay switches off power to the whole circuit, it is also
referred as Emergency stop release.




dharm
d:N-MachMac12-2.pm5     321
322                                                                                    CONTROL OF MACHINES

               Line                                                                         N
                                     Switch
                                                                                  MCR



         MCR                                                                                      MCR
                         Stop                 Start           O.L
                                                                                  M

                                                 M2

                             M2
                                                                                                Green lamp



                                M3
                                                                                                Red lamp



                                      Fig. 12.29 Hardwired master control relay
       All PLCs also provide Master Control Relay (MCR) instruction to control an entire
program or selected rungs of a program. When the MCR instruction is programmed as shown
in the Fig. 12.30, the portion of the program which is in between two MCR instructions is
enabled only when the first MCR instruction is true. It means rungs 2 to 4 are enabled only
when the instruction IN1 is true. Two MCR instructions are used to create a zone. In the
circuit shown rung 5 is outside the areas of MCR zone created by two MCR instructions and
thus works independently of the MCR instruction.

                                     IN1
                Rung 1                                                              MCR


                                     IN2              IN3
                Rung 2                                                                CR1

                                                      CR1

                                     CR1                                           OUT1
                Rung 3



                Rung 4                                                              MCR


                                     IN4                                           OUT2
                                                      IN5
                Rung 5




                                                      IN6

                      Fig. 12.30 Two MCR instructions used to create two different zones




dharm
d:N-MachMac12-2.pm5      322
PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER                                                                  323

      Any number of zones can be created in a program but an MCR zone cannot be nested
within another MCR zone.
       Note : A programmed MCR must never be used to replace a hard wired master control relay that
provides emergency shutdown. It is recommended that a hard wired emergency STOP push-button
should remove power to the output devices. This is achieved by using the normally open contact of a
physical MCR relay in the neutral to cut off power to the output module of the PLC as shown in the
Fig. 12.31.
      Another contact of MCR can be used in the line, but it is optional, as it is advantageous
to keep the inputs energized for troubleshooting.

                            Emergency
                        L     stop               Start                                N

                                                                            MCR
                                                  MCR


                                                           Input module
                MCR                                  COM




                                                                                          MCR

                                               Output module
                                                  COM
                                                                            M




                             Fig. 12.31 Safety circuit using a physical MCR relay
12.9.12 Branch Open and Branch Close Instructions
Whenever two instructions are to be programmed in parallel (for example the holding circuit)
Branch open  Branch close instructions are required to program the circuit into PLC memory.
The circuit shown in Fig. 12.32 will be programmed using a branch open instruction (L) and
branch close instruction by entering the instructions as follows with the help of a hand held
programmer in the Allen Bradleys “SLC 150” PLC.


                                  Start                  Stop
                                  IN 1                   IN2
                                                                                CR1


                                  CR 1




                                          Fig. 12.32 A simple PLC program
       Program Entry : Press symbol L(Branch open)
                              Press symbol – – (Examine ON) and give it address IN1
                                            ||



dharm
d:N-MachMac12-2.pm5       323
324                                                                           CONTROL OF MACHINES




                        Rung 1


                                                           (a)



                                     A                B
                        Rung 1

                                                                Cursor
                                                           (b)
                                         Cursor

                                 A                B
                        Rung 1


                                                           (c)



                                 A       IN1      B
                        Rung 1


                                                           (d)



                                     A   IN1      B
                        Rung1



                                                          (e)


                                     A   IN1      B
                        Rung1
                                         CR1

                                                          (f)



                                     A   IN1
                        Rung1                         B

                                         CR1

                                                          (g)


                                         IN1                     IN2     CR1
                        Rung1
                                         CR1
                        Rung2
                                                          (h)

                 Fig. 12.33 Programming of a parallel branch using computer software




dharm
d:N-MachMac12-2.pm5      324
PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER                                                               325

       Press symbol L again (Branch Open)
       Press Symbol – – (Examine ON) and give it address CR1
                     ||
       Press Symbol (Branch close)
       Press Symbol – – (Examine OFF) and give it address IN2
                     ||
       Press Symbol –( )– (Relay) and give it address CR1
       Press Enter
       If window based Personal computer software is used to program a PLC through Keyboard/
Mouse of the PC, then a single instruction called Branch instruction is available in the software
to program the instructions connected in parallel. The symbol used for branch instruction in
RS logix 500 software for programming Allen Bradley make PLC is , which is available on
the tool bar of the window.
       When the software is opened for programming a dotted line (rung) will appear in the
working window where Ladder program is to be entered as shown in Fig. 12.33(a). When
branch instruction available on the toolbar of the window based software is called by left click
of the mouse, the rung 1 will be modified and the branch will appear on the rung as shown in
Fig. 12.33(b) and the cursor is shown by a rectangle. To enter the instruction in the top branch,
mouse is clicked at junction A as shown in the diagram. This will move the cursor to point A as
shown in Fig. 12.33(c). Now clicking an Examine ON instruction on the tool bar will modify the
circuit as shown in Fig. 12.33(d).
       After entering the address IN1 for this instruction, mouse will be clicked at the starting
of bottom branch, which will shift the cursor shown by rectangle as shown in Fig. 12.33(e).
Now clicking again on Examine ON Instruction on the toolbar will add the instruction in
parallel with the first instruction as shown in Fig. 12.33(f). This instruction is given address
CR1.
       Now again clicking the mouse at point B in the program, the rectangle will appear as
shown in Fig. 12.33(g). Now the Examine OFF instruction can be added to the circuit by clicking
its symbol on the toolbar and then its address is entered. Finally the rung can be completed by
clicking the relay instruction -( )- on the toolbar and entering its address CR1 from the keyboard.
The complete rung 1 will be as shown in Fig. 12.33 (h) and clicking a new rung instruction on
the toolbar will enter a new rung as shown in the diagram.
12.9.13 Timer Instruction
Timer instruction is used to perform timing operations based on a precise internal clock,
generally 0.1 or 0.01 seconds per clock pulse. In many PLCs, the time increment is user
selectable, with the 0.1 sec incrementing the timer is called standard timer and the 0.01 sec
incrementing timers are called high-speed timers. Timers generally fall into two different
categories depending on the PLC manufacturers. These are retentive and non-retentive. Further
the timer can be of two types, On-delay timer and OFF delay timer. Defference in working of
ON and OFF delay timers has already been discussed in chapter on control components. Review
it, if you cannot recollect. Most of the PLC manufacturers only provide ON-delay timer
instruction. Thus we will discuss here the ON-delay timer only.
      A non-retentive timer is the one, which has got only one control line as shown in Fig. 12.34.
Timer is represented by a coil symbol or by a box symbol as shown in Fig. 12.34(a) and (b)
respectively.




dharm
d:N-MachMac12-2.pm5   325
326                                                                                 CONTROL OF MACHINES

                         Start switch                                Timer on-delay
                              IN1                                          T1
             Rung 1                                                       RTO             Timer

                                                                      Preset : 50
                              T1                                         OUT1
             Rung 2



                              T1                                         OUT2
             Rung 3
                                                    (a)



                              IN1                                               EN
                                                     Timer on
             Rung 1
                                                     Timer T1
                                                     Time Base 0.1              DN
                                                     Preset 50
                                                     Accum 0

                              T1                                            OUT1
             Rung 2
                                   DN

                              T1                                            OUT2
             Rung 3
                                   EN

                                                    (b)

              Fig.12.34 (a) Timer representation in ladder logic (b) Timer representation in
                                       functional block language
        In the timer circuit, of Fig.12.34(a) when the Examine ON instruction IN1 is true, timer
starts counting the time in intervals of 0.1 or 0.01 depending upon the time base. A preset of 50
for time base 0.1 sec means timer setting is 5 seconds. After 5 secs, the timer contacts, T1 will
changeover their positions. Timer instruction in functional block language is more interactive.
Time base selection is possible and time counted at a particular instant is shown against
ACCUMULATED VALUE. Two coils EN and DN are shown. EN coil will remain energised as
long as timer is ON. Thus contact T1/EN will changeover as soon as Timer is energised due to
IN1 instruction getting true. The DN coil will energised/becomes true when the timer has
timed out, that is when the ACCUMULATED VALUE = PRESET VALUE. Thus the timer
contacts T1/DN will changeover. If the IN1 instruction goes false or supply fails at any time
when timer is counting or has already timed out the ACCUMULATED VALUE will be reset to
zero (0) and all timer contacts will come to their original condition. On restoration of power
supply or closing of IN1 contact, timer will again start counting from zero towards the PRESET
value.
        Retentive type of timers have two control lines as shown in Fig. 12.35.
        In this type of timer, the accumulated time at any instant is retained, if the power goes
off or Examine ON instruction IN1 becomes false. Timer resumes counting from the accumulated
value, when power is restored or when Examine ON instruction again becomes true. Once the




dharm
d:N-MachMac12-2.pm5   326
PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER                                                                   327

PRESET VALUE = ACCUMULATED VALUE, the timer contacts will changeover and remain
so until the reset instruction for the timer becomes true due to Examine ON instructing IN2
becoming true. This will reset the timer contacts to their original position and accumulated
value will be reset to zero.


                               IN1                                      T1
                                                                       RTF
                                                                   Preset : 50

                               IN2                                      T1
                                                                       RES
                                                                   Raccum : 0

                                                  (a)



                               IN1                                           EN
                                                        Retentive
                                                        on-delay
                                                        Timer T1
                                                        Timebase 0-1
                                                        Preset : 50          DN
                                                        Accum 0



                               IN2                                       TM1
                                                                         RES


                                                  (b)

                 Fig.12.35 (a) Retentive timer representation in ladder logic language
                (b) Retentive timer representation in functional block diagram language
       Note : As long as the reset instruction is true, timer instruction will not work. In some PLCs,
Reset instruction can be programmed to have the initial accumulated value called reset accumulated
value other than zero (0). If the reset instruction is programmed to have a non-zero intial accumulated
value, the time required to change the timer contacts will be equal to PRESET VALUE—RESET
ACCUMULATED VALUE.
12.9.14 Counter Instruction
Counter instruction is similar to timer instruction, the only difference being that timer counts
the internal pulses generated, by an internal clock while the counter counts internal pulses. A
very common example of internal pulse generation is the counting of products moving on a
conveyor system. A limit switch installed on the conveyor is actuated each time a product
passes across the limit switch arm. Normally open, contact of limit switch, will close and open
when a product actuates and deactuates the limit switch arm while passing through where the
limit switch is installed. This closing and opening of contact is used to give a pulse to counter
for counting the number of products passed. Counters are always of retentive type.
      Some manufacturers have counter instructions using one coil instructions each in two
rungs as shown in Fig. 12.36. In one rung, there is Up counter instruction (CTU) and in the
other rung is the reset instruction -(RST)-. A preset value is given to counter instruction,
which corresponds to the maximum count. The reset instruction by default has a reset




dharm
d:N-MachMac12-2.pm5   327
328                                                                               CONTROL OF MACHINES

accumulated value of zero (0). Reset instruction can however be programmed to have any
Reset value upto the preset value of the counter in case of a Up-counter.
        In the program shown in Fig. 12.36, note that the IN1 instruction going true and then
false will increase the accumulated value of counter C1 by one. When the accumulated value
becomes equal to the preset value of 5, the counter contact C1, will close energizing the OUT1.
If however the RAC value of counter C1, is programmed to say 2, then the counting will start
from 2. The counter contact C1, will become true (close) after three counts i.e., (5 – 2 = 3).
        Some manufacturers represent the counter instruction in a box with two inputs and two
coil in its output as shown in Fig. 12.36 (b), CTU at the top of the box represents that it is a Up-
counter. The CU relay is true, when the IN1 instruction is true. Thus for each count, the relay
becomes true and its contact C1/CU will close and then open for each count. When the
Accumulated value = Preset value, the DN relay will become true and its contacts C1/DN will
change their positions.

                               IN1                                       C1
                                                                        CTU

                                                                      Preset : 5

                               C1                                       OUT 1




                               IN2                                      C1
                                                                        RST

                                                                    RAC = 0000
                                                     (a)




                         IN1
                                                                CTU                     CU

                                                                Counter C1
                                                                Preset : 5
                                                                Accum : 0
                         IN2
                                                                Reset
                                                                                        DN




                         C1                                                     OUT1


                                DN

                                                     (b)

                        Fig. 12.36 (a) Counter representation in ladder logic diagram
                           (b) Counter representation in functional block diagram
      In down counter, the counter instruction will be represented by CTD. In case of down
counter the Reset accumulated value will be programmed equal to the preset value




dharm
d:N-MachMac12-2.pm5     328
PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER                                                                   329

(counts required) and the preset value will be programmed to zero. When the IN1 instruction
will go true, the accumulated value will decrement by one. When the accumulated value becomes
equal to the preset value the down counter contact will changeover.
       In some cases, it is convenient to have a counter that can count in either of the two
directions, called a bi-directional counter or UP-Down counter. One example of UP-Down counter
can be to keep a tally of number of vehicles in the parking lot and to give indication when the
parking is full. In this situation, entry of a car into the parking lot will be sensed and will be
used to increase the count of bi-directional counter and when a vehicle exits from the exit gate,
a sensor will provide pulse to decrement the count in the bi-directional counter. The accumulated
value of the counter at any time can be displayed to know the number of vehicles parked at any
time in the parking lot. Program using a Up-Down counter is shown in Fig. 12.37. Note that in
this program the counter up instruction -(CTU)- and the Down-counter instruction -(CTD)-
have been given the same address as C1. This indicates that both the instructions constitute
the Up-Down counter. When the accumulated value is equal to the Preset value of the Counter
Up instruction, the contact C1 will close and light the indication lamp connected to OUT1 of
the output module to indicate that the vehicle in the parking lot are equal to 100.

                              Sensor 1
                                IN1                               C1
                                                                 CTU
                                                              Preset : 100
                              Sensor 2
                                IN2                               C1
                                                                 CTU
                                                              Preset : 100

                                                                 Lamp
                                C1                               Out1




                                IN3                               C1
                                                                 RES


        Fig. 12.37. Program using a up-down counter for counting the number of vehicles parked

12.9.15 Sequencer Instruction
In some control applications, it is required that a particular sequence of events occur. Mechanical
sequencers have been used for such applications. In automatic washing machines, a timer
motor rotates one or more cams mounted on its shaft, which in turn causes switches to open or
close to activate the next process in the wash cycles e.g., the machine advance from the main
wash to the rinse cycle involving switching OFF of heaters, switching on pumps etc. A cam can
consist of an eccentric circle of metal or plastic that rotates on a shaft. As it rotates, it pushes
a switch or switches are closed to produce a sequence of steps. Sequencer is also referred to as
cam timer. This has already been discussed on the chapter of control components and its
application for conveyor system has been discussed in the chapter on industrial control circuits.
       The speed of the sequencer motor and the shape of the cams determine the time allowed
for each operation. The relation of the cams to each other determine the sequences of steps.
These electro-mechanical sequential controllers are called Drum sequencers.




dharm
d:N-MachMac12-2.pm5   329
330                                                                                    CONTROL OF MACHINES

       The main disadvantage of these sequencers is that they were time driven only i.e., each
sequence was allowed a certain amount of time depending upon the speed of the motor. In
modern control systems it is necessary for the sequencer to be advanced in response to an
event. For example, consider the control of a small oven. If the oven is not up to the desired
temperature, despite the heater being on for the allowed amount of time, then the processor
should not advance the sequencer to the next step. The sequencer should only be advanced in
response to an event, in this case a thermal switch closing of which indicates that the oven is
up to temperature. PLCs also have sequencers but they are not physical device but exist only
as software instructions. They can be visualized as a drum that rotates in steps. At each step a
series of pegs along the drum can activate switches which then initiates a control action. This
electro-mechanical drum switch is shown in Fig. 12.38 (a).
     The presence of Peg indicate a logic 1 and the absence as logic 0. If the drum were
unwound and laid flat then it would appear as shown in Fig. 12.38(b).

         PEGS

                  0                                                          5


              1
                                                                  Rotation       4   Drum cylinder


                  2                                                          3

                                                (a)

                                           Switches
                      Steps         S5    S4          S3    S2         S1
                       0            ON    OFF         ON    ON        OFF
                       1            OFF   OFF         ON    ON        ON                  Motor rotates
                                                                                          drum. Speed
                       2            ON    OFF         ON    OFF       ON                  determines time
                       3            ON    ON          OFF   ON        OFF                 for each step

                       4            ON    OFF         ON    ON        ON
                       5            ON    ON          ON    OFF       OFF

                                                (b)

            Fig. 12.38 (a) A electro-mechanical drum sequencer (b) Alternate representation
                                   of drum sequencer in the chart form
       OFF may be represented by logic 0
       ON may be represented by logic 1
       after step 5, the cycle repeats with step 0.
       Unlike the mechanical Sequencer, the PLC Sequencer can be either EVENT or TIME
driven. Also PLC Sequencer can be a output sequencer or a input sequencer. A output Sequencer
sets up the outputs ON or OFF for each step while input Sequencer examines inputs to determine
their ON and OFF status for each step.




dharm
d:N-MachMac12-2.pm5         330
PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER                                                           331

12.9.16 Basic Operation of Time Driven Output Sequencer Instruction
The operation of a time driven Sequencer can be explained with the help of the program and
table shown in Fig. 12.39.



                               IN1                                    S1
                                                                     SQO




                        Step                    Output addresses              Time per
                                                                                step
                                     OUT1     OUT2       OUT3       OUT4
                         0            0         0          0          0         5 sec.
                         1            0         1          0          1        20 sec.
                         2            1         0          1          0        60 sec.
                         3            1         1          1          1        25 sec.

                             Fig. 12.39 Operation of a time driven output sequencer

       The data shown in the table has to be programmed for the Sequencer instruction S1
shown in the program. When the PLC will be put in the run mode after entering the program
and data. The Sequencer rung goes true when the examine ON instruction IN1 becomes true.
This starts the Sequencer action and the step 0 occurs for 5 secs, and all output from OUT1 to
OUT4 will be off. After 5 secs the Sequencer will advance to step 1 and the status of OUT1 to
OUT 4 will be as shown in the table and it will remain in step 1 for 20 secs. After 20 secs,
Sequencer will go to step 2 and then to step 3, remain there for the programmed time and
change the status of outputs as programmed which is shown in the table. After the step 3,
Sequencer will again come back to step 0. The same operation is repeated as long as the IN1
instruction remains true. If IN1 goes false anytime during the Sequencer operation or the
supply fails, the Sequencer operation will stop but the changes already made are retained and
the Sequencer operation will resume from the same point when the instruction IN1 goes true
or supply is restored. Similarly we have a Event Driven Output Sequencer in which the
Sequencer shifts to the next step when an external pulse is given to the Sequencer instead of
a preset time for each step.
       In Time Driven Input Sequencers, the Sequencer stays at the predefined steps for
the programmed times and monitor the status of specified inputs. If during its stay on a
particular step for particular time the input status match the programmed status for the
specified inputs, a sequencer contact is made true. This action is repeated at each step.
      Similarly we have a Event Driven Input Sequencer, in which the Sequencer shifts to
the next step in response to an external pulse given to the Sequencer.
      There are many more instructions available in PLCs like Math functions, Data
manipulation functions, Word and File move functions. For example in the Allen Bradleys
‘SLC 500’ PLC having 5/02 processor the number of functions available are seventy one (71).




dharm
d:N-MachMac12-2.pm5        331
332                                                                           CONTROL OF MACHINES

   12.10 A SIMPLE PROGRAMMING EXAMPLE
12.10.1 Sand Mixing Machine
A simple machine for preparation of a resin bonded sand is shown in Fig.12.40. Resin bonded
sand is required in foundries for making cores which are used in the sand moulds for the
making of metal castings. The sand and resin are mixed at a particular temperature to prepare
the sand. Sand and resin are added in a predetermined proportion by adjusting the time of
opening of ON-OFF type resin solenoid valve and the sand hopper gate. Sand hopper gate is
operated by a pneumatic operated cylinder piston as shown in the diagram. Another Pneumatic
operated gate is the mixer gate to throw out the mixed sand. Mixing is done by blades which
rotate inside the mixer through the gear box connected to the shaft of a three phase squirrel
cage induction motor. A limit switch is actuated when the mixer gate opens to throw out the
sand. Sand is automatically thrown out due to the rotating mixer blades. This application
requires the use of retentive timers as fixed quantities of resin and sand are to be mixed. The
operation required from the machine is explained in steps given below:


                               Sand hopper


                              Sand hopper gate




                              Solenoid
                               valve                                  Door


                                                                      Blades


                                                 Gear
                                         Motor
                                                 box

                              Fig. 12.40 Diagram of a sand mixing machine
        1. On pressing the Start push-button, the heaters installed inside the mixer should get ON.
        2. When the required temperature of 100 centigrade is achieved, the mixer motor should
           start, and the resin solenoid valve should get energised to add resin into the mixer
           for 20 secs.
        3. After the resin addition, the sand hopper gate should open for 30 secs to add the
           required quantity of sand into the mixer.
        4. The mixing of the sand and resin should continue for 300 secs.
        5. The mixer gate should now open for 60 secs to throw the mixed sand out of the mixer.
        6. When the mixer gate closes, all the timers should be reset and the heaters should be
           switched off.
12.10.2 Relay Ladder Logic Diagram
The Relay ladder diagram for the sand mixer machine will be as shown in Fig.12.41. It is left as
an exercise for you to study this diagram thoroughly before you go to the next section to see how
the same machine can be controlled by a PLC.



dharm
d:N-MachMac12-2.pm5   332
PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER                                                                         333

                        Stop                 Start
                                                            4T2
        Rung 1                                                           C           Heater On
                                              C1

            C2                                                                       C3

                               Temp switch
        Rung 2                                                           H           Heaters
                          T
                              H1                     OL
        Rung 3                                                           M           Mixer motor


                              H2
        Rung 4                                                          1T           Resin addition
                                                                                     timer
Control of machines
Control of machines
Control of machines
Control of machines
Control of machines

More Related Content

PPTX
Traction system
PPS
Motores electricos
PPT
Babic components of hydraulic & pneumatic systems
PPTX
variable frequency drive
PPTX
Out of phase current switching in High Voltage Circuit Breakers
PDF
Les procédés de démarrage
PPTX
Variadores de Velocidad
PPTX
Predefined speed control of bldc motor
Traction system
Motores electricos
Babic components of hydraulic & pneumatic systems
variable frequency drive
Out of phase current switching in High Voltage Circuit Breakers
Les procédés de démarrage
Variadores de Velocidad
Predefined speed control of bldc motor

What's hot (20)

PDF
Adaptacion de motor trifasico a linea monofasica JAM
PPTX
Variable frequency drive and variable frequency control
PPTX
Metadyne control
PDF
HYDRAULIC FORK LIFT.pdf
PDF
شرح Boucles de-regulation
PPTX
Couplings , Clutches and Brakes
PPTX
Transformers in NTPC
PPTX
Analysis, design and modeling of dc dc converter
PDF
Hydraulic brake
PDF
Ratchet and Pawl Mechanism
PPTX
Beam Engine Mechanism: A Review
PPTX
LOAD FREQUENCY AND VOLTAGE GENERATION CONTROL
PPTX
Several types of motor
PPTX
PPT
DC SUPPLY SYSTEM.ppt
DOCX
Presentation Report On Dynamometers
PDF
Installation industrielle
PPTX
Introduction to Mechanical Engineering_BME_Unit 1
PDF
1302580505523 train lighting book
PPT
freewheel mechanism ppt by pradeep samal nitrr
Adaptacion de motor trifasico a linea monofasica JAM
Variable frequency drive and variable frequency control
Metadyne control
HYDRAULIC FORK LIFT.pdf
شرح Boucles de-regulation
Couplings , Clutches and Brakes
Transformers in NTPC
Analysis, design and modeling of dc dc converter
Hydraulic brake
Ratchet and Pawl Mechanism
Beam Engine Mechanism: A Review
LOAD FREQUENCY AND VOLTAGE GENERATION CONTROL
Several types of motor
DC SUPPLY SYSTEM.ppt
Presentation Report On Dynamometers
Installation industrielle
Introduction to Mechanical Engineering_BME_Unit 1
1302580505523 train lighting book
freewheel mechanism ppt by pradeep samal nitrr
Ad

Similar to Control of machines (20)

PDF
Controlofmachines 130110181054-phpapp01
DOCX
33/11 kV substation (u.p.p.c.l.)
PDF
Controlofmachines 130110181054-phpapp01
DOC
Lesson plan for ee2352
PDF
The beginig
PDF
PDF
MIProject2015
PDF
27 i6 ijaet0511571
PDF
Electric_Drives_FinalProj
DOC
Yuvaraja project
PDF
print
DOCX
Led dimmer report
PDF
Essential Guide Automation
PDF
Arc proof 1 sdc007105g0201
PDF
Introduction of LVAC Auto Change Over Scheme in DEWA Transmission System
PDF
Digital Current Mode Controller for Buck Converter
PDF
Power electronics note
PDF
Okotech Catwww3
PDF
Okotech Catwww3
PDF
G5_31352_Final_Report (3)
Controlofmachines 130110181054-phpapp01
33/11 kV substation (u.p.p.c.l.)
Controlofmachines 130110181054-phpapp01
Lesson plan for ee2352
The beginig
MIProject2015
27 i6 ijaet0511571
Electric_Drives_FinalProj
Yuvaraja project
print
Led dimmer report
Essential Guide Automation
Arc proof 1 sdc007105g0201
Introduction of LVAC Auto Change Over Scheme in DEWA Transmission System
Digital Current Mode Controller for Buck Converter
Power electronics note
Okotech Catwww3
Okotech Catwww3
G5_31352_Final_Report (3)
Ad

Recently uploaded (20)

PDF
Anesthesia in Laparoscopic Surgery in India
PDF
Module 4: Burden of Disease Tutorial Slides S2 2025
PDF
Classroom Observation Tools for Teachers
PDF
Supply Chain Operations Speaking Notes -ICLT Program
PDF
Weekly quiz Compilation Jan -July 25.pdf
PDF
Yogi Goddess Pres Conference Studio Updates
PDF
FourierSeries-QuestionsWithAnswers(Part-A).pdf
PDF
Black Hat USA 2025 - Micro ICS Summit - ICS/OT Threat Landscape
PDF
RMMM.pdf make it easy to upload and study
PPTX
202450812 BayCHI UCSC-SV 20250812 v17.pptx
PDF
RTP_AR_KS1_Tutor's Guide_English [FOR REPRODUCTION].pdf
PDF
01-Introduction-to-Information-Management.pdf
PDF
3rd Neelam Sanjeevareddy Memorial Lecture.pdf
PPTX
school management -TNTEU- B.Ed., Semester II Unit 1.pptx
PDF
A systematic review of self-coping strategies used by university students to ...
PDF
grade 11-chemistry_fetena_net_5883.pdf teacher guide for all student
PPTX
Lesson notes of climatology university.
PPTX
Cell Types and Its function , kingdom of life
PPTX
Final Presentation General Medicine 03-08-2024.pptx
PPTX
Final Presentation General Medicine 03-08-2024.pptx
Anesthesia in Laparoscopic Surgery in India
Module 4: Burden of Disease Tutorial Slides S2 2025
Classroom Observation Tools for Teachers
Supply Chain Operations Speaking Notes -ICLT Program
Weekly quiz Compilation Jan -July 25.pdf
Yogi Goddess Pres Conference Studio Updates
FourierSeries-QuestionsWithAnswers(Part-A).pdf
Black Hat USA 2025 - Micro ICS Summit - ICS/OT Threat Landscape
RMMM.pdf make it easy to upload and study
202450812 BayCHI UCSC-SV 20250812 v17.pptx
RTP_AR_KS1_Tutor's Guide_English [FOR REPRODUCTION].pdf
01-Introduction-to-Information-Management.pdf
3rd Neelam Sanjeevareddy Memorial Lecture.pdf
school management -TNTEU- B.Ed., Semester II Unit 1.pptx
A systematic review of self-coping strategies used by university students to ...
grade 11-chemistry_fetena_net_5883.pdf teacher guide for all student
Lesson notes of climatology university.
Cell Types and Its function , kingdom of life
Final Presentation General Medicine 03-08-2024.pptx
Final Presentation General Medicine 03-08-2024.pptx

Control of machines

  • 3. THIS PAGE IS BLANK
  • 4. NEW AGE INTERNATIONAL (P) LIMITED, PUBLISHERS New Delhi · Bangalore · Chennai · Cochin · Guwahati · Hyderabad Jalandhar · Kolkata · Lucknow · Mumbai · Ranchi PUBLISHING FOR ONE WORLD Visit us at www.newagepublishers.com
  • 5. Copyright © 2006, 1996 New Age International (P) Ltd., Publishers Published by New Age International (P) Ltd., Publishers All rights reserved. No part of this ebook may be reproduced in any form, by photostat, microfilm, xerography, or any other means, or incorporated into any information retrieval system, electronic or mechanical, without the written permission of the publisher. All inquiries should be emailed to rights@newagepublishers.com ISBN : 978-81-224-2440-9 PUBLISHING FOR ONE WORLD NEW AGE INTERNATIONAL (P) LIMITED, PUBLISHERS 4835/24, Ansari Road, Daryaganj, New Delhi - 110002 Visit us at www.newagepublishers.com
  • 6. Dedicated to Parents Our Parents dharm d:N-MachTITLE.pm5 iii
  • 7. THIS PAGE IS BLANK
  • 8. Preface The purpose of this book is to present the subject of Control of Machines using electromagnetic relays, static switching devices and programmable logic controllers. The book has been de- signed for use as a text in diploma and degree courses. The content of this book may also be used effectively in conducting industrial training programmes. It will be of immense help to students who intend to join industry. Electrical control of motors and other machinery started with the advent of relays, timers and contactors. In the 1960s, programmable controllers started being widely used in industry. In India, however, these technologies were introduced much later. Indian industries are now fast switching over to programmable controlled machines. All the three types of controls have been discussed in this book. However, more emphasis has been laid on magnetic control using relays. This is so because, inspite of the increasing popularity of solid state control and programmable controllers, relay logic control will continue to be used as far as single motor control or the control of a machine with few operations is concerned. Thus, study of relay logic becomes essential for an electrical engineer in order to gain proficiency in the design of control logic. The first section of the book deals with motor control using relays and timers. Here construction and working of different types of components have been described in detail. It is recommended here that students support their study of components with catalogues published by various manufacturers. The symbols followed for control components are as recommended by the Bureau of Indian standards. Starters for different types of ac and dc motors have been covered in detail. The main highlight and interesting part of this section is the explanation of a large number of typical control circuits used in industry. Description of machines, various control operations desired and the step by step working of control circuit have been discussed. Students will find these circuits very interesting. It is hoped that a careful study of these circuits will generate confidence in the students and enhance their confidence in handling such control circuitry employed in industry. Besides these there are chapters devoted to troubleshooting and protection of motors. The second portion of the book deals with static control using digital devices. Modern control systems are designed using integrated circuit elements. These control systems are particularly useful in adverse environments for complex control situations, and applications where high speed operation is required. In this section, ladder logic diagram and USAUI symbols for digital devices have been used, as these are universally used in industry. To make students familiar, the alternate symbols, other than those specified by BIS, have also been used in the section for control components. Besides discussing the general approach to development of circuits, a number of industrial circuits have been discussed. vii dharm d:N-MachTITLE.pm5 iv
  • 9. viii The last section of the book deals with use of programmable logic controllers for control of machines. PLC architecture and its programming in Ladder Logic Language has been discussed extensively. We hope that this book will be useful to teachers and students of polytechnics and engineering colleges. Suggestions for the improvement of this book will be thankfully acknowledged. Finally, we would like to thank our colleagues in the institute as well as teachers of various technical institutes who have encouraged us to make our best efforts in bringing forth this book. Thanks are also due to the publishers, M/s New Age International Pvt. Ltd. for bringing out this book in a very presentable manner. Dr. S.K. Bhattacharya Brijinder Singh dharm d:N-MachTITLE.pm5 v
  • 10. Contents Preface vii 1 INTRODUCTION TO CONTROL OF MACHINES 1 1.1 General Idea of Controls 1 1.2 Disadvantages of Manual Control 2 1.3 Introduction to Magnetic Control 2 1.4 Advantages of Magnetic Control 4 1.5 Semi-automatic and Automatic Control of Modern Machinery 5 1.6 Development of Control Circuit 6 1.6.1 Development of Two-wire and Three-wire Control 6 1.6.2 Remote Control Operation of a Motor 8 1.6.3 Interlocking of Drives 9 2 CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS 11 2.1 Introduction 11 2.2 Fuses, Switches and Fuse Switch Units 12 2.3 Moulded Case Circuit Breaker and Miniature Circuit Breaker (MCCB & MCB) 14 2.4 Contactors 16 2.4.1 Solenoid Type Contactor 16 2.4.2 Clapper Type Contactor 17 2.4.3 Lock-out Type Contactor 19 2.4.4 Inductive Accelerating Contactors 20 2.5 Contactor Ratings 21 2.6 Relays 22 2.6.1 Voltage Relays 23 2.6.2 D.C. Series Current Relay 24 2.6.3 Frequency Responsive Relay 25 2.6.4 Latching Relays 26 2.7 Overload Relays 28 2.7.1 Bimetallic Thermal Overload Relay 28 2.7.2 Ratchet Type Eutectic Alloy Relay 30 2.7.3 Magnetic Dash Pot Oil Filled Relay 30 2.8 Time Delay Relays (Timers) 32 2.8.1 Thermal Timer 33 ix dharm d:N-MachTITLE.pm5 vi
  • 11. x 2.8.2 Pneumatic Timer 33 2.8.3 Motor Driven Timers 35 2.8.4 Electronic Timer 36 2.9 Phase Failure Relay (Single Phasing Preventer) 37 2.10 Push Button Switches 39 2.11 Selector Switches 40 2.12 Drum Switches 42 2.13 Limit Switches 42 2.13.1 A Simple Limit Switch 43 2.13.2 Rotary Cam Type Limit Switches 45 2.13.3 Heavy Duty Limit Switches 45 2.13.4 Speed Actuating Sensing Switches 46 2.14 Solenoid Valves 46 2.15 Pressure Switches 48 2.16 Pressure Transducer 50 2.17 Temperature Switches (Thermostats) 51 2.18 Float Switch 52 2.19 Control Transformer 54 2.20 Symbols for Various Components 55 2.21 Control Diagrams 56 3 STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR 63 3.1 Introduction 63 3.1.1 Motor Current at Start and During Acceleration 64 3.1.2 No-load Speed and Final Speed of Motor 65 3.1.3 Starting of Motor 66 3.2 Primary Resistor Type Starters 67 3.2.1 Manual Primary Resistor Type Starter 67 3.2.2 Semi-automatic Stepless Resistance Starter 69 3.2.3 Automatic Primary Resistor Type Starter 70 3.3 Increment Resistance Starter 71 3.4 Line-reactor Reduced Voltage Starter 73 3.5 Auto-Transformer Reduced Voltage Starters 75 3.5.1 Manual Auto-transformer Starter 76 3.5.2 Automatic Auto-transformer Starter (Open Circuit Transition) 77 3.5.3 Auto-transformer Voltage Starter (Closed Circuit Transition) 79 3.6 Part Winding Motor Starter 82 3.6.1 Two Step Starting 83 3.6.2 Three Step Starting 84 3.7 Star-Delta Starter 85 3.7.1 Manual Star-delta Starter 87 3.7.2 Push-button Operated Manual Star-delta Starter 88 3.7.3 Semi-automatic Star-delta Starter 89 dharm d:N-MachTITLE.pm5 vii
  • 12. xi 3.7.4 Automatic Star-delta Starter (Open Circuit Transition) 91 3.7.5 Automatic Star-delta Starter (Closed Circuit Transition) 92 3.8 Starters for Multi-Speed Motors 95 3.8.1 Starter for Two-speed, Two Winding (Separate Winding) Motor 97 3.8.2 Two Speed One Winding (Consequent Pole) Motor Starter 99 3.9 Reversing the Direction of Rotation of Induction Motors 102 3.10 Plug Stopping of Motor 103 3.11 Dynamic Braking 104 4 STARTERS FOR WOUND ROTOR INDUCTION MOTORS 109 4.1 Introduction 109 4.2 Motor Acceleration 111 4.3 Manual Face Plate Starter 113 4.4 Manual Starter Using Master Controllers 115 4.5 Automatic Control of Acceleration 116 4.5.1 Definite Time Limit Starter 116 4.5.2 Current Limit Acceleration Starter 120 4.5.3 Secondary Frequency Acceleration Starter 121 5 STARTERS FOR DIRECT CURRENT MOTORS 124 5.1 Types of DC Motors and their Applications 124 5.1.1 Shunt Motor 124 5.1.2 Series Motor 124 5.1.3 Compound Motor 125 5.2 Principles of DC Motor Acceleration 125 5.3 Manual Starters for DC Motors 129 5.3.1 Two-point Starter 129 5.3.2 Three-point Starter 129 5.3.3 Four-point Starter 130 5.4 Types of Starters for Automatic Acceleration 131 5.4.1 Direct-on-line Starter 132 5.4.2 Current Limit Acceleration Starters 133 5.4.3 Definite Timer Acceleration Starters 137 5.5 Reversing of DC Motors 140 5.6 Jogging Operation of Motor 143 5.7 Dynamic Breaking of Motor 144 5.8 Plugging Circuit for DC Motor 146 6 CONTROL OF SINGLE PHASE MOTORS 149 6.1 Types of Single Phase Motors 149 6.2 Universal Series Motors 150 6.2.1 Reversing Direction of Rotation of Universal Motor 150 6.2.2 Speed Control of Universal Motor 152 dharm d:N-MachTITLE.pm5 viii
  • 13. xii 6.3 Shaded Pole Motor 153 6.4 Split Phase Motors 155 6.4.1 Standard Split Phase Motors 155 6.4.2 Capacitor Type Split Phase Motors 157 6.4.3 Starters for Capacitor Type Split Phase Motors 157 6.4.4 Starter for Two Value Capacitor Type Split-phase Motors 158 6.4.5 Starter for a Two Value Capacitor Motor Using a Current Relay and an Auto Transformer 159 6.4.6 Dynamic Breaking of Split Phase Motors 160 6.4.7 Plug Reversing of Capacitor Start Motors 160 6.4.8 Speed Control of Split Phase Motors 161 6.4.9 Speed Control of Permanent Split Capacitor Motors 162 7 CONTROL OF SYNCHRONOUS MOTORS 165 7.1 Construction and Operation of a Synchronous Motor 165 7.2 Manual Push Button Synchronising Starter 166 7.3 Timed Semi-automatic Synchronising 167 7.4 Automatic Starter Using Polarised Field Frequency Relay 167 8 PROTECTION OF MOTORS 171 8.1 Protection of AC Motors 171 8.2 Co-Ordination of Fuse, Overload Relay and Contactor/Circuit Breaker Operating Characteristics 171 8.3 Overload, Short Circuit, and Over-temperature Protection 172 8.3.1 Overload and Short Circuit Protection 172 8.3.2 Over Temperature Protection 175 8.3.3 Under Voltage Protection 176 8.3.4 Phase Failure and Phase Reversal Protection 177 8.4 Protection of DC Motors 178 8.4.1 Field Failure Protection Circuit for DC Shunt Motors 178 8.4.2 Field Acceleration Protection Circuit 179 8.4.3 Field Deceleration Protection Circuit 181 9 INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS 184 9.1 Introduction 184 9.2 Planer Machine 184 9.3 Skip Hoist Control 187 9.4 Automatic Control for a Water Pump 189 9.5 Lifting Magnet 191 9.6 Control of Electrical Oven 193 9.7 Overhead Crane 196 9.8 Battery Trolley 202 9.9 Battery Operated Truck 205 dharm d:N-MachTITLE.pm5 ix
  • 14. xiii 9.10 Air Compressor 208 9.11 Walking Beam 212 9.12 Conveyor System 217 9.13 Elevator 222 10 TROUBLESHOOTING IN CONTROL CIRCUITS 231 10.1 Introduction 231 10.2 Trouble Spots 232 10.2.1 Fuses 232 10.2.2 Loose Connections 232 10.2.3 Faulty Contacts 233 10.2.4 Incorrect Wire Marking 234 10.2.5 Combination Problems 234 10.2.6 Low Voltage 235 10.2.7 Grounding 235 10.2.8 Momentary Faults 236 10.2.9 Poor Maintenance 237 10.3 General Procedure for Troubleshooting 237 11 STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES 242 11.1 Introduction 242 11.2 Advantages of Static Control Over Magnetic Relay Control 243 11.3 Disadvantages of Static Control Over Magnetic Relay Control 244 11.4 Explanation of Different Gates 245 11.4.1 AND Gate 245 11.4.2 OR Gate 246 11.4.3 NOT Gate or Inverter 248 11.4.4 NOR Gate 248 11.4.5 NAND Gate 249 11.4.6 Exclusive OR Gate 249 11.5 Solid State Timer 250 11.6 Memory Elements (Off-return Type) 251 11.6.1 Clocked RS Flip-Flop 253 11.6.2 JK Flip-Flop 253 11.7 Retentive Memory Element 254 11.8 Development of Logic Circuits 255 11.9 Input Devices for Solid State Logic 259 11.9.1 Capacitive Switch Filters 259 11.9.2 Bounce Eliminators 260 11.9.3 Signal Converters 261 11.10 Output Devices for Solid State Logic 263 11.11 Solenoid Valve Operated Cylinder Piston Assembly 264 11.12 Control of Three Stage Air Conditioning System 265 dharm d:N-MachTITLE.pm5 x
  • 15. xiv 11.13 Speed Control of Wound Rotor Induction Motor 267 11.14 Control of Planer Machine 269 11.15 Control of Three Conveyors 272 11.16 Shift Register 274 11.17 Conveyor System Using a Shift Register 275 11.18 Counter 277 11.19 Decoder 278 11.20 Loading of Castings into Annealing Furnace Using Decade Counter and Decoder 279 11.21 Mono Shot 281 11.22 Clock 282 11.23 Automatic Filling of Silos Using a Clock and a Mono Shot 283 11.24 Down Counter 285 11.25 Encoder 286 11.26 Product Dispersion Conveyor System Using a Down-counter, an Encoder, a Mono Shot and a Timer 287 12 PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER 291 12.1 Introduction 291 12.2 Input/Output Section 294 12.2.1 Fixed I/O 294 12.2.2 Modular I/O 295 12.3 Discrete Input Modules 296 12.3.1 AC Discrete Input Module 297 12.3.2 DC Discrete Input Module 298 12.4 Discrete Output Modules 299 12.4.1 AC Output Module 299 12.4.2 DC Output Modules 301 12.4.3 Rating of Output Modules 301 12.5 Analog I/O Modules 302 12.6 Safety Circuit 303 12.7 Processor Unit 303 12.7.1 Internal Self Diagnostic System 307 12.7.2 Memory Types 307 12.7.3 Input Image Table 308 12.7.4 Output Image Table 308 12.7.5 User Program Memory 309 12.7.6 Variable Data Memory 309 12.8 Programming Device 310 12.8.1 Dedicated Desktop Programmers 310 12.8.2 Hand-held Programmers 311 12.8.3 Computer Programmers 311 12.8.4 Advantages of Using Personal Computers for Programming 312 dharm d:N-MachTITLE.pm5 xi
  • 16. xv 12.8.5 Disadvantages of Using Personal Computer for Programming a PLC 313 12.9 Fundamental PLC Programming 313 12.9.1 Introduction 313 12.9.2 Physical Components Versus Program Components 315 12.9.3 Examine ON Instruction 316 12.9.4 Examine OFF Instruction 317 12.9.5 Internal Relay Instruction 317 12.9.6 Latching Instruction 317 12.9.7 Output Instruction 318 12.9.8 Programming Stop Push-buttons 318 12.9.9 Logical Holding Instructions Versus Discrete Holding Contacts 320 12.9.10 Overload Contacts 320 12.9.11 Master Control Relay Instruction 321 12.9.12 Branch Open and Branch Close Instructions 323 12.9.13 Timer Instruction 325 12.9.14 Counter Instruction 327 12.9.15 Sequencer Instruction 329 12.9.16 Basic Operation of Time Driven Output Sequencer Instruction 331 12.10 A Simple Programming Example 332 12.10.1 Sand Mixing Machine 332 12.10.2 Relay Ladder Logic Diagram 332 12.10.3 Ladder Logic Program on PLC for Sand Mixing Machine 334 12.10.4 Explanation for the Ladder Program 334 References and Suggestions for Further Study 338 dharm d:N-MachTITLE.pm5 xii
  • 17. THIS PAGE IS BLANK
  • 18. Introduction to Control of Machines 1.1 GENERAL IDEA OF CONTROLS A machine, as we know, is a device consisting of several interconnecting parts which by their motion, transform/transmit power to do some work. The motion of various parts of a machine can be obtained by using two types of devices, viz. (i) an electrical motor (ii) a solenoid valve and cylinder piston assembly operated by a compressor or a pump. A constant rotational motion developed by a motor can be converted into linear mechanical movement through rack and pinion arrangement connected to the motor shaft. In solenoid valve and cylinder piston assembly, fluid or air pressure is applied to cylinder piston through a solenoid valve. Solenoid valve consists of a mechanical valve operated through an electrical coil. Fig. 1.1 shows how a cylinder piston is used to get linear to and fro motion of a machine part. A spring returned solenoid valve is also shown in Fig. 1.1. Cylinder Piston Cylinder Piston A B A B D C D C Coil Spring Spring Exhaust Exhaust Air Air Receiver receiver Compressor Motor Compressor Motor (a) (b) Fig. 1.1 Operation of a solenoid valve (a) solenoid coil de-energised (b) solenoid coil energised In Fig. 1.1 (a) the solenoid coil is de-energised and ports of the valve are connected as shown by arrows. Port A is connected to exhaust while port B is connected to air receiver in 1
  • 19. 2 CONTROL OF MACHINES which air is stored at a high pressure. The machine part connected to the piston will be in the position as shown. This is due to air pressure acting on the right-hand side of the piston. When the solenoid coil is energised, a spool will get shifted in the valve and now the ports of the valve will get connected as shown by arrows in Fig. 1.1 (b). Port A gets connected to pressurised air while port B gets connected to exhaust. The piston will thus move forward to the extreme end due to air pressure on the left-hand side of the piston. In this arrangement also, of course a motor is used as drive for the air compressor or the pump (if fluid is used) to build up air or fluid pressure. Thus it is seen that a motor is the heart of all machinery whether its output is used directly or indirectly. In this text the main emphasis is on the study of control of motors. However some control circuits using solenoid valves will also be taken up. Now we will proceed to discuss methods of control of motors. 1.2 DISADVANTAGES OF MANUAL CONTROL When electric motors were first introduced, simple manual switches were used to start and stop the motor. The only protective device used was the fuse. Progress was subsequently made along the lines of improving the reliability, flexibility and make-break performance of the manual switches. In those days one large motor was used to drive a line shaft through a belt pulley arrangement. Individual machines were then connected to the line shaft through belt and pulley arrangements. This system of driving a number of individual loads from a common line shaft and manual switching of motors had many disadvantages as listed below: • Starting, stopping and speed control of motor had to be performed by hand every time. The operator had to move a manual switching device from one position to another. • Switching of large motors required great physical effort. • Operator had to remain continuously alert to watch indicators so as to adjust motor performance according to drive requirements. • Sequence operations of number of motors could not be accomplished in common line shaft arrangement. • The varied needs of individual machines like frequent starts and stops, periodic reversal of direction of rotation, high-starting torque requirement, constant speed, variable speed, etc., could not be accomplished in common line shaft arrangement. 1.3 INTRODUCTION TO MAGNETIC CONTROL The disadvantages of common line shaft arrangement necessitated the use of small motors on individual machines instead of one large motor in line shaft arrangement. The use of individual motors on different machines made the machine shop or factory more flexible. Introduction of electromagnetic CONTACTORS AND RELAYS, that is, devices actuated by electromagnets and requiring only a small power for actuation as compared to the power switched ON through their main contacts, led to the much desired control of machines possible. The word control means to govern or regulate. By control of a motor we mean regulation or governing of its various operations like starting, stopping, acceleration, reversal of direction of rotation, speed variation, protection etc. Fig. 1.2 shows the connections for manual and magnetic control of a small squirrel cage induction motor using push buttons. In a simple manual control the motor starts when the main switch is closed by the operator. The motor is protected by fuses as shown in Fig. 1.2 (a). In Fig. 1.2 (b) an electromagnetic contactor is used to switch on the motor. Before we discuss the working of the circuit, it is essential to be familiar with the working principle of a contactor. Various types of contactors, however, will be discussed in detail in the next chapter. dharm d:N-MachMac1-1.pm5 2
  • 20. INTRODUCTION TO CONTROL OF MACHINES 3 Fig. 1.2 Manual and Magnetic control of a small squirrel cage induction motor In Fig. 1.3 it is seen that a coil is wound on the fixed core while the contacts are mounted on the moveable core, called the armature. The contacts remain in the normal position as shown in Fig. 1.3 (a) i.e., when the coil remains de-energised. The spring (S) keeps the main and the auxiliary contacts in the position shown. In Fig. 1.3 (b) the contactor is shown with its coil in energised condition. As soon as the coil is energised, the armature i.e., the movable core is attracted towards the fixed core against the pressure of spring (S). The contacts thus change their positions. The normally open main contacts close. Simultaneously auxiliary contacts also change their positions. The normally open contacts close and normally close contacts open. The main contacts are used for switching the power to the motor while auxiliary contacts are used in the control circuit. When the coil is again de-energised armature comes back to its original position due to the tension of the spring (S). Now let us refer back again to the starting circuit of motor in Fig. 1.2 (b). In this figure there are two separate circuits, i.e., the power circuit and the control circuit. Supply to the control circuit is isolated from the main supply using a control transformer T1. Alternatively, a phase and neutral can also be used for providing supply to the control circuit. The motor can be switched ON and OFF with the help of push buttons. These push button switches require small force to actuate their contacts. These contacts remain operated as long as pressure is applied and they return to their normal position when pressure is released. In this circuit when the ON-push button is pressed, contact P2 closes. Supply from secondary terminal of the control transformer reaches the contactor coil through contacts, P1 (OFF-push button), P2, (ON-push button) and the over-load relay contact OL. The other terminal of the coil is connected directly to the terminal b1 of the transformer. The coil is thus energised dharm d:N-MachMac1-1.pm5 3
  • 21. 4 CONTROL OF MACHINES Normally closed Auxiliary contacts Normally open Normally open Main contacts Armature Spring Switch Switch I Supply Supply (a) (b) Fig. 1.3 Operation of an electromagnetic type contactor (a) coil de-energised (b) coil energised and contactor closes its main contacts M1, M2, M3 and the auxiliary contact M4. Closing of contact M4 bypasses ON-push button contact P2. Now if pressure on the ON-push button is released contact P2 will open but supply to contactor coil M would reach through closed contact M4 connected in parallel with contact P2. This contact M4 is known as holding or sealing contact. A bimetallic thermal over-load is also shown connected in the power circuit. If motor draws more current than its rated value, thermal relay contact OL opens and de-energises coil M. De-energisation of coil opens the contacts M1, M2, M3 and M4. Supply to motor stops and holding of control supply through M4 is also broken. Motor can also be stopped by pressing the OFF- push button. When OFF-push button contact P1 opens, coil M is de-energised and thus holding of supply through contact M4 is broken. Motor can be switched on again by pressing the ON- push button. This circuit that we have discussed is also known as direct-on-line starting of motors. This is the simplest control circuit in the field of industrial control. 1.4 ADVANTAGES OF MAGNETIC CONTROL Having discussed the starting and stopping of a motor by using control devices like push buttons, contactors and over-load relays, we are in a position to discuss the advantages of magnetic control over the manual control. The various advantages are listed as follows: dharm d:N-MachMac1-1.pm5 4
  • 22. INTRODUCTION TO CONTROL OF MACHINES 5 • Magnetic control permits installation of power contacts close to motor whereas the actuating control device i.e., a push button switch could be located away from the motor in a position most convenient to the operator. • Magnetic control provides safety to the operator as remote operation described above minimises the danger to the operator of coming into accidental contact with live parts or being exposed to power arc and flashes at the main contacts. • The most important advantage of magnetic control is the elimination of dependence on operators’ skill for control of motor performance. Current and torque peaks could be limited thus resulting in less wear and less maintenance. • Magnetic control also makes interlocking (to be discussed later) between various operations of a multi motor drive easy. The various operations can be performed in the desired sequence automatically. • With the demand for more production in industry, it became necessary to automise the machinery to meet the challenge. Today in our industrial plants most of the machines are automatic. Once the machine is started most of the operations are carried out automatically. 1.5 SEMI-AUTOMATIC AND AUTOMATIC CONTROL OF MODERN MACHINERY Control of a machine can be semi-automatic or fully automatic. There are probably more machines operated by semi-automatic control than by manual or fully automatic controls. Consider, for example, an over-head tank which supplies drinking water to a factory. If we provide a manual switch near the pump motor and depute an operator to switch it ON when water level falls, then this is classified as manual control. Here, the operator has to go to the pump site to fill the tank. For the same pump if a magnetic starter is provided near the pump motor and for its starting, a switch is provided near foreman’s desk it may be classified as a semi-automatic control. A lamp indication or a bell can also be provided near the desk to indicate if the tank is full. The foreman can switch ON the pump from his desk without going to the pump site. Over-flow can also be avoided by switching OFF the pump when the lamp glows or the bell rings. If a float switch is provided in the tank to switch ON the pump motor when water level falls below a certain lower limit, and switch it OFF when water level rises beyond a certain upper limit, then the control becomes fully automatic. The cost of installation of an automatic control system will be higher than the other two types of controls. However, an automatic control arrangement relieves the operator from the task of keeping an eye on the water level and operate the pump. Also there is no danger of over-flow from the tank. Thus it is seen that the basic difference in manual, semi-automatic and fully automatic control lies in the flexibility it provides to the system being controlled. The study of control circuits involves study of the construction and principle of operation of various control components and learning the art of designing control circuits for various functions of machines. In this text, we have first discussed the various control components and then control schemes for ac and dc motors. Some important industrial control circuits have also been discussed. Modern machines have large number of operations requiring extensive control circuits consisting of large number of relays. Thus the control panel occupies a lot of space and control circuit design also becomes tedious. Static control is used for such machines as the control design is easy with static control devices. The static devices used for design of control circuits are the digital logic gates. With dharm d:N-MachMac1-1.pm5 5
  • 23. 6 CONTROL OF MACHINES much advancement in the field of computers this static control is also becoming obsolete as more and more machines are now being controlled by programmable controllers. Inspite of all these developments as far as single motor control or a machine having few operations is concerned, the magnetic control using contactor and relay will continue to be in use because it is the simplest and cheapest method of control for such applications. 1.6 DEVELOPMENT OF CONTROL CIRCUIT 1.6.1 Development of Two-wire and Three-wire Control In this section we will explain the various steps of developing a control circuit. A control circuit is to be drawn in a simple form between two horizontal lines designated by 1, which denotes a phase and by 0, which denotes the neutral wire. In this section also explained are some control functions like remote operation, inter-locking of drives etc. As shown in Fig. 1.4 a motor is connected to supply through a switch fuse unit, a contactor, and an overload relay. For developing the control circuit, we take a phase say L1 and neutral as shown in the figure. A control fuse is connected in phase L1 and outgoing control supply wire is numbered 1 and neutral is numbered 0. Fig. 1.4 Development of control circuit Now we will study how the control circuit for energising a motor is developed. The motor is energised by closing the contactor and stopped due to opening of the contactor. One method of designing of the control circuit is to connect a simple selector switch S and an overload relay control contact in series with control supply wire no. 1 and then connect it to contactor coil M as shown in Fig. 1.5. When switch S is open there is no supply at terminal 2 dharm d:N-MachMac1-1.pm5 6
  • 24. INTRODUCTION TO CONTROL OF MACHINES 7 and, therefore, M remains de-energised. When the switch, S is closed supply reaches terminal 3 through the normally closed overload relay contact OL and thus the coil M is energised. The motor gets supply because of closing of the main contacts of the contactor (not shown in the figure). This control circuit just developed is known as two wire control. In this type of control circuit, however, the motor would automatically start when power supply to the motor is restored after a failure. This type of control is only useful for starting of motors at remote places, e.g., starting of water pump for filling an over-head tank. Here the advantage is that the operator is not required to switch on the motor when power supply is restored after a failure. This type of control may however be dangerous in industries and can cause accidents due to sudden restarting of motors on restoration of power supply. Thus the control circuit of Fig. 1.5 has very limited application due to safety reasons. Fig. 1.5 Two wire control circuit Now let us develop a control circuit using push button switches. The normally open contacts of these push buttons remain closed as long as the button is kept pressed by hand. Each push button has one normally open (NO) and one normally closed (NC) contact. To use a push button as stop (OFF) switch, the normally closed (NC) contact is generally used and for start (ON) operation the normally open contact (NO) is generally used. In Fig. 1.6 the stop and start push buttons and the over-load relay control contact have been connected in series with the contactor coil. Under normal conditions as the STOP-push button contact is normally closed supply would reach upto terminal 2. When START-push button is pressed supply would reach the contactor coil and hence the contactor would get energised. The coil will remain energised as long as the START-push button is held pressed. As soon as the pressure on the START-push button is released, the supply is cut off at terminal 3 and the coil is de-energised. To develop the circuit further i.e., to ensure that the coil remains energised permanently once the push button is pressed, we connect an auxiliary contact M1 of contactor M in parallel with the push button as shown in Fig. 1.6 (b). When the coil M is energised, along with the main contacts the auxiliary contact M1 also closes. The supply from terminal 2 now has two parallel paths i.e., one through the closed contact of the START-push button and the other through the closed contact M1. Thus even when the pressure on the START-push button is released, supply reaches coil M through closed contact M1. Thus supply to coil M is held (or sealed) through its own dharm d:N-MachMac1-1.pm5 7
  • 25. 8 CONTROL OF MACHINES 1 1 1 Stop Stop Stop M2 2 2 2 5 M1 M1 Start Start Start 3 3 3 4 4 4 Indication M M M lamp 0 0 0 (a) (b) (c) Fig. 1.6 Development of three wire control circuit contact M1. When it is desired to stop the motor, the STOP-push button is pressed and therefore its normally closed contact opens and the coil M gets de-energised. De-energisation of coil M also opens its sealing contact M1. Thus when the pressure on the STOP-push button is released the coil does not get energised as both the parallel paths i.e., of the START-push button and that of contact M1 are open. To start the motor again the START-push button has to be pressed. It is therefore seen that unlike the control circuit of Fig. 1.5, here the control circuit does not get energised when the power supply gets restored after a failure. Thus the danger of motors getting restarted on restoration of power supply is eliminated. In case of over loading of the motor the over-load relay contact opens and supply is disconnected at terminal 4 thereby de- energising the contactor and subsequently stopping the motor. Even if the over-load protective device is of auto reset type i.e., if its contact closes when the bimetallic elements cool down the motor would not start on its own. However, in the two wire control circuit as in Fig. 1.5, if the overload relay is of auto reset type the motor would restart automatically. Thus the motor may get damaged due to repeated on-off on over loading. The control, we have just discussed in Fig. 1.6, is known as three wire control. This designation is given because in this control circuit, three wires lead from a pilot device to the starter. The term two wire and three wires are used as they describe the simplest application of the two types. Actually in control circuits any number of wires can start from a pilot device in a three wire control. The control contact M1 used in parallel with the START-push button is called the holding contact or sealing contact. The name is so because it holds/seals the contactor coil in the energised condition even when START-push button switch is released. The step in further development of the circuit is to have a ‘motor ON’ indication. An auxiliary contact M2 of contactor M is connected in series with supply wire 1 to feed an indicator lamp terminal. Its other terminal being connected to the neutral as shown in Fig. 1.6 (c). 1.6.2 Remote Control Operation of a Motor In further development of circuit of Fig. 1.6 (c) it may be desired that starting and stopping of the motor should also be possible from a distant place (remote place) while the starter being dharm d:N-MachMac1-1.pm5 8
  • 26. INTRODUCTION TO CONTROL OF MACHINES 9 fixed near the motor. In this case, obviously, the control wire will have to be taken to the remote START and STOP-push buttons from the starter. Now, it is to be seen as to how the remote START- STOP push buttons should be connected to the circuit of Fig. 1.6 (c). The required connections for remote control have been shown in Fig. 1.7. The remote STOP-push buttons have been connected in series with local STOP-push button and the remote START-push button has been connected in parallel with local START-push button. The motor can be started and stopped from any number of locations by making connections as above i.e., by connecting all the STOP-push buttons in series and all the START-push buttons in parallel. If the motor is to be started by some other pilot device like pressure switch, thermostat etc., the same may be made by connecting such a device in parallel with START-push button. If such a device is to be used for stopping also it is to be Fig. 1.7 Control circuit for remote connected in series with the STOP-push button. operation of a motor 1.6.3 Interlocking of Drives We well now see how the control function of interlocking of drives is incorporated into the circuits. Let us take motors A and B. It is required that motor B should start only after motor 1 1 P1 P3 P1 P3 P5 2 5 2 5 9 P4 P2 A1 B1 P2 A1 P4 B1 P6 C1 3 6 3 6 10 A2 A3 11 B2 7 12 4 7 4 8 13 A B A B C 0 0 (a) (b) Fig. 1.8 Interlocking of drives dharm d:N-MachMac1-1.pm5 9
  • 27. 10 CONTROL OF MACHINES A has started. It should however be possible to stop the motor independently. The first step would be to develop the starters of motor A and motor B independently as shown in Fig. 1.8. In order that contactor B should energise only when contactor A is energised we will have to insert a normally open contact of contactor A in series with the contactor coil B after terminal 6 as shown in Fig. 1.8 (b). As shown in the figure a normally open contact A2 has been connected after wire No. 6. Thus when contactor A is not energised the contact A2 will be open. If we press the push button P4 the supply will reach upto terminal 6 only. The contactor coil B can be energised only when contactor A is energised i.e., only when its contact A2 is closed. If in the above circuit it is further required that a motor C should run only if both motors A and B are running, we will be able to get this function by connecting normally open contacts of contactor A and B in series with the coil of contactor C. This development is also shown in Fig. 1.8 (b). When push button P6 is pressed the supply will reach coil of contactor C at terminal 13, only if contacts A3 and B2 are closed i.e., only when both contactors A and B are energised. When either of the two motors is not running motor C can not be started. REVIEW QUESTIONS 1. State the disadvantages of using manual control for control operations of electrical motors. 2. Name the devices which led to the use of automatic control for motors. 3. State the advantages of magnetic control over manual control. 4. What is the difference between semi-automatic and automatic control? 5. What will happen if the plunger of a contactor is prevented from completing its stroke? 6. When will a contactor coil take maximum current and why? 7. Under what conditions static control is preferred against magnetic control? 8. Explain why magnetic control is used for control having few operations. 9. State the difference between a two wire and a three wire control. 10. When the plunger of a contactor is in closed position the coil current is: (a) maximum (b) minimum (c) zero. 11. When the contactor coil is de-energised: (a) the contacts remain closed (b) are held closed by mechanical latch (c) gravity and spring tension open the contacts. 12. The purpose of using over load protection in a motor is to protect the motor from: (a) sustained overcurrent (b) over voltage (c) short circuit (d) all the above. dharm d:N-MachMac1-1.pm5 10
  • 28. Control Circuit Components 2.1 INTRODUCTION All components used in motor control may be classified as either primary control devices or as pilot control devices. A primary control device is one which connects the load to the device, such as switch, fuse switch unit, circuit breaker, contactor, overload relay etc. Pilot devices are those which control the primary control devices. Pilot devices comprise items like selector switch, push button switch, float switch, pressure switch, limit switch, thermostat etc. Fig. 2.1 shows the control scheme in block diagram form of an induction motor for an air compressor. Fig. 2.1 Block diagram for automatic control of a compressor motor 11
  • 29. 12 CONTROL OF MACHINES As shown in Fig. 2.1 power to the compressor motor is controlled i.e., switched ON or OFF through a contactor. Contactor closes its main contacts when its coil is energised. As shown in the block diagram the contactor coil is controlled through the following: (a) Oil lubrication pressure switch: The contactor is switched off if oil lubrication pres- sure for compressor falls below a certain limit; (b) Cooling water temperature switch: The contactor is switched off if the temperature of water being used for cooling the compressor rises above a certain limit; (c) Cooling water flow switch: The contactor is switched off if flow of cooling water to the compressor stops; (d) Air reservoir pressure switch: The contactor is switched off when air pressure in the reservoir becomes higher than the set limit; (e) ON-push button: The contactor is energised initially through ON-push button when all the above mentioned conditions are favourable to run the compressor; (f) OFF-push button: Pressing of the OFF-push button at any time will switch off the contactor due to the de-energisation of its coil. From the block diagram it is clear that control of the compressor motor involves use of two separate circuits. One is the power circuit which consists of isolator switch, fuse, contactor and overload relay. The second circuit is control circuit which consists of ON and OFF push button switches, pressure switches for the lubricating oil of the compressor and for air in the reservoir, flow switch and temperature switch for cooling water of the compressor. All these components in the control circuit are pilot devices and provides a means for controlling the motor. In the following sections all these primary control devices and pilot control devices have been discussed. 2.2 FUSES, SWITCHES AND FUSE SWITCH UNITS Both the power circuit and the control circuit of a control scheme are protected against short circuit faults by means of fuses. Short circuit faults may occur due to mistakes made during wiring, fault within the motor winding, or due to mechanical injury to the cable and wires. A fuse is a calibrated conductor which melts and breaks the circuit when current passing through it increase beyond its calibrated value. The fuse element melts due to generation of excessive heat under short circuit condition and thus isolates the circuit from the source of power supply. Figure 2.2 shows the construction of a typical high rupturing capacity (HRC) fuse link. Blade Body Filler Element Fig. 2.2 Construction of a typical HRC fuse The fuse element is surrounded by a filler material such as quartz sand which provides effective heat transfer. The fuse exhibits inverse time current characteristic to the heat transfer from the element. The fuse element can sustain small overloads for longer duration but in case dharm d:N-MachMac2-1.pm5 12
  • 30. CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS 13 of large overloads and short circuits the small cross-section of the fuse element melts quickly and opens the circuit. Fig. 2.3 shows the typical time characteristic of a HRC fuse. Fuses are provided into the circuit through fuse base and fuse carriers generally made of bakelite material. Fuse Melting Time is inserted in the fuse carrier which is then fixed into the fuse base. Figure 2.4 (a) shows the power circuit for a motor. It includes four necessary elements for the control and protection of motor. None of the items used can be eliminated Current as they incorporate four basic functions very different in Fig. 2.3 Characteristic of nature. a HRC fuse Switch: To isolate the circuit for repairs and maintenance, Fuse/Fuse base: To provide short circuit protection, Contactor: To achieve automatic on-off of motor, Overload relay: To protect the motor against overloading. Development of a new type of switch gear, called fuse switch unit, has led to the use of a modified power circuit as shown in Fig. 2.4 (b). This fuse switch unit came into existence when the fuse base was integrated with switch. The advantages of using fuse switch unit are that the number of electrical joints becomes less due to the elimination of one element from the circuit and hence requires less maintenance, and the space occupied is less as the combination fuse switch occupies less space than fuse/fuse base and switch when used separately. L1 L1 L2 L2 L3 L3 Switch Fuse switch unit Fuse C Contactor C Contactor Overload Overload relay relay M M 3~ 3~ (a) (b) Fig. 2.4 Two types of power circuits for motor dharm d:N-MachMac2-1.pm5 13
  • 31. 14 CONTROL OF MACHINES Fuse switch units are of two types, namely, (i) where the fuse is stationary and (ii) where the fuse is mounted on the moving assembly. Both the above types are in use. However, the one having stationary fuse has the following advantages over the other type. — The moving assembly weight is less as it does not carry the fuse, thus it is more reliable against mechanical failure. — There is less deterioration of electrical joints between fuse and fuse switch. Switches and fuse switch units are manufactured upto a rating of 1000 A, 415 V with breaking capacity of 50 KA. They are manufactured in standard ratings. For example Larsen Toubro Ltd. manufacture these in the ratings of 63 A, 100 A, 250 A, 400 A, 630 A and 800 A while Siemens manufacture in standard ratings of 200 A, 400 A and 600 A. Switches and fuse switch units are available in three-pole (TP) type and three pole neutral (TPN) type. 2.3 MOULDED CASE CIRCUIT BREAKER AND MINIATURE CIRCUIT BREAKER (MCCB MCB) A slow and steady change to moulded case circuit breakers and miniature circuit breaker as an alternative protection system to fuse switch units and air circuit breakers is taking place in the Indian industry. As a result, distribution and control system without fuse are being designed today. Miniature circuit breakers are manufactured in 1, 2, 3 and 4 pole versions upto fault levels of 10 KA. They find applications in protection of lighting circuits, sub-distribution and control circuits. Moulded case circuit breakers are available in higher ratings. L T manufactures MCCBs of rating 100 A, 200 A, 250 A, 450 A, 630 A, 800 A, 500 V, 50 Hz with fault level withstanding capacity of 50 KA. They cover a wide range of applications in circuit protection in branch feeders, motor circuits, transformer secondaries, lighting distribution systems, capacitor switching and DC circuits. Figure 2.5 shows a DTH 100 L T make MCCB. Fig. 2.5 Photographic view of a Moulded Case Circuit Breaker dharm d:N-MachMac2-1.pm5 14
  • 32. CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS 15 An MCCB automatically isolates an electrical circuit under sustained overloads or short circuits. A thermal release consisting of bimetallic elements having inverse time current tripping characteristic trips the circuit breaker on sustained overload. The breaker is opened by an electromagnetic release in case of short circuit faults. When the current is less than 10 times the setting of the thermal release the breaker trips due to thermal release and when current exceeds 10 times its value, the breaker is opened by magnetic release. The main features of a MCCB are: • The breaker is switched on by a toggle type switch. The operating mechanism is “quick-make, quick-break” and is independent of manual operation. The breaker cannot be held closed under fault conditions. • The housing is made of heat resistant insulating material. All parts are enclosed in the housing except terminals which are accessible for external connections. Terminals have large dimensions to accept links or cable lugs. • All phases are disconnected even when a fault occurs on only one of them. The operating switch gives a clear trip indication. It assumes a position midway between ON (1) and OFF (0) on tripping. • Arc chutes envelope each contact and draw the arc away from the contact tips thus quenching it rapidly. Silver alloy contacts having high arc resistance and long electrical life are used. The magnetic thermal release has three bimetals to provide thermal overload protection and has an electromagnet for short circuit protection. The magnetic thermal release is direct acting. The settings of thermal as well as magnetic release are adjusted over a wide range. MCCBs offer a number of advantages over conventional breakers and fuse switch units. They are: (i) Operating switch is easy to handle. There is no down time and need for replacement of fuse. After the breaker trips, it can be switched on again simply by resetting it. When the breaker trips, the operating switch occupies mid-position between ON (1) and OFF (0). To reset the trip mechanism the operating switch is to be moved to OFF-position. (ii) In fuse switch units blowing of fuse on one of the phases results in single phasing. This problem is eliminated in MCCBs because a common trip bar ensures opening of all the phases even when a fault occurs on only one of them. (iii) MCCBs are five to ten times smaller in size and weight as compared to conventional air circuit breakers and fuse switch units of similar ratings. This results in saving on panel space and supporting structures. Table 1 shows range of L T make DTH type MCCBs. Table 1 L T make standard DTH type MCCBs Standard rating Setting range of thermal relay Short circuit rating DTH-100 12-100 A 700 A non-adjustable DTH-250 80-150 A 375-2000 A adjustable DTH-400 225-400 A 960-2560 A adjustable DTH-630 360-630 A 1500-4500 A adjustable DTH-800 600-800 A 2600-6400 A adjustable dharm d:N-MachMac2-1.pm5 15
  • 33. 16 CONTROL OF MACHINES 2.4 CONTACTORS A contactor can be best described as a magnetically closed switch. It is the basic unit upon which the motor starter is built. Contactors are also used for switching ON and OFF of heavy loads like furnaces, heaters, capacitors, etc. A contactor consists of an electromagnet, a movable core, sets of stationary and moving contacts and an arc quenching structure. Contactors can be broadly classified in to two general types: (a) Solenoid type (b) Clapper type There are other contactors for specific applications such as lock-out type and inductive accelerating type used in dc motor controls. 2.4.1 Solenoid Type Contactor In this type the movable contacts are attached to the movable core of a magnet. When the electromagnet coil is energised, the movable core is pulled to the stationary core, thus closing the contacts. Fig. 2.6 (a) shows a solenoid type contactor. For better understanding, the contacts have been shown mounted in vertical plane though actually the contacts are in horizontal plane. Contacts mounted here NO contact (Only one contact shown) Spring Armature Shading ring Stationary core Contactor coil (b) Fig. 2.6 (a) Solenoid type contactor (b) Contactor with E-type magnetic core Mounting of contacts in horizontal plane reduces the size of the contactor. The position of plunger i.e., movable core shown in the figure is for the coil in de-energised state. When the coil is energised, plunger moves up, moving contacts mounted on plunger also moves up and closes the normally open contacts. At the same time normally closed contacts open. When the coil is de-energised contacts are broken and they come back to their normal position by the pull of gravity. dharm d:N-MachMac2-1.pm5 16
  • 34. CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS 17 The pole face of the magnet are provided with shading coil. This creates an out of phase flux to hold the magnet closed during the zero points of alternating current thus preventing chatter of the contactor. For contactors of higher ratings where chattering noise is to be avoided, dc coil is used. The solenoid type of contactors shown in Fig. 2.6 (a) are used for small ratings. For higher ratings E type construction for the magnetic core is used. A contactor with E type magnetic core is shown in Fig. 2.6 (b). Symbols used for contactor coil, contactor with main and auxiliary contacts, and photographic view of a contactor have been shown in Fig. 2.7. Contactor Normally open Normally closed contact (NO) contact (NC) Contactor with normally open and normally closed contacts (a) (b) Fig. 2.7 (a) Symbols for contactor coil and contacts (b) Photographic view of a contactor 2.4.2 Clapper Type Contactor In clapper type dc contactors the movable contacts are mounted on a hinged movable armature. The hinged armature when pulled by magnetic core moves the movable contact in more or less in the horizontal direction to make contact with the stationary contact mounted on the vertical back-plate of the contactor. Figure 2.8 shows the general arrangement of the core, coil, contacts etc., of a clapper type dc contactor. The magnet is shown to consist of a round solid core on which the coil is mounted and a bent piece on which the moving armature is hinged. All parts of the magnetic circuit are made from a soft steel having high permeability. The moving armature carries the movable contacts. When the coil is energised the armature is attracted towards the core causing the movable contacts to close against the stationary contacts. A movable contact is not rigidly attached to the armature but is held in place by a spring and bolt. When the armature fully closes, a spring exerts a force on the movable contact. The amount of force to be applied on the moving contact can be varied with the help of a bolt on which the spring is fixed. Arcing horns are provided on both the fixed and movable contacts. Arc shifts towards the arcing horns during interruption thus saving the main contacts from damage. A blow out coil is also provided to extinguish the arc. The action of blow out coil is shown in Fig. 2.9. A blow out coil is circular strip having an insulated solid core inside. Current flows from fixed contact through the circular strip to the outlet terminal. dharm d:N-MachMac2-1.pm5 17
  • 35. 18 CONTROL OF MACHINES Arcing horn Blow out coil Fixed contact Out going terminal Moving contact Insulated iron core Spring Insulated bakelite sheet Bolt Flexible connection Long bolt Hinged armature Core Coil Incoming terminal Fig. 2.8 Construction of a clapper type contactor Circular strip Solid insulated core Moving contact Fig. 2.9 Action of blow out coil dharm d:N-MachMac2-1.pm5 18
  • 36. CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS 19 When the contacts separate, the magnetic field set up due to current flowing through the blow out coil exerts a force on the arc. Due to this force arc is elongated between the arcing horns. The arc chutes provided over the fixed and moving contacts also help in quenching the arc due to cooling action. Arc chutes also help to confine the arc and help avoid striking other structural parts. The force exerted by magnetic coil on the arc depends upon the current flowing through the coil. Force exerted is proportional to the square of the load current. A shunt blow out coil is sometimes used in contactors when current to be interrupted is small. In this arrangment a constant blow out flux is obtained independent of the load current. A similar effect is sometimes obtained by the use of a permanent blowout magnet. AC contactors of large rating are also built in clapper type with dc coil. 2.4.3 Lock-out Type Contactor This type of contactor was primarily designed for the starting circuit of dc motors. Lock out contactors are used for cutting the resistance of the armature circuit of a motor in steps. The contactor is so designed that its contacts normally remain open. They also remain open during the inrush current on starting of motors. The contactor consists of two coils i.e., a closing coil and a lock-out coil. The lock-out coil prevents the contactor from closing during the inrush current of the motor. The magnetic circuit of closing coil (A) is made of such magnetic material which gets saturated easily. The magnetic circuit of the lock-out coil has air gaps and does not get saturated easily. The pull exerted by the lock-out coil, therefore, varies much more widely with changes in current than the pull of closing coil. The graph in Fig. 2.11 shows torque versus current characteristics of both coils. Fixed contact Moving contact Insulated bakelite sheet Closing coil (A) Armature Closing coil (B) Fig. 2.10 Lock-out type contactor dharm d:N-MachMac2-1.pm5 19
  • 37. 20 CONTROL OF MACHINES B Torque on armature Closing coil Lock out coil A B Ampere Fig. 2.11 Torque versus current characteristic of coils Both the closing coil and the lock-out coil are connected in series with the motor circuit. During starting, high inrush current flows which is beyond point B (see graph). For point beyond B armature pull of lock-out coil is much greater than that of the closing coil (see graph), thus the contacts remain open due to armature being pulled by lock out coil. As the current drops below B the pull on armature increases for closing coil (refer point A on the graph) and therefore the armature is pulled by the closing coil and the contacts close. The closed contacts shorts the resistance in the armature circuit of the motor. The circuit is so arranged that when the contactor closes the lock out coil is short-circuited thereby preventing it from opening the contactor. This ensures that the contactor will remain closed after it has operated. In some contactors closing coil may be shunt wound connected directly across the line. This removes the disadvantage of possible opening of the series connected closing coil on low loads. However, any variations in line voltage would affect the setting at which the contactor would close. At one time lock out accelerating contactors were very popular due to their simplicity. Now due to development of better and simpler accelerating means they are rarely used. 2.4.4 Inductive Accelerating Contactors It is similar in appearance to the double coil lock out type contactor. However its lock out coil (also known as hold out coil) magnetic circuit is highly inductive. The magnetic circuit of the hold out coil is so designed that a certain fixed duration of time is required for the flux to die down to a value to permit the closing coil to close the contactor. This time may be varied by varying the air gap in the hold out magnetic circuit. The relative strengths of the closing coil and the hold out coil is so adjusted that the contactor remains open with full line voltage on closing coil and approximately 1 per cent of full line voltage on the holdout coil. The closing coil and hold out coil are energised at the same time and then the hold out coil is short-circuited. The shor circuiting of holding coil will result in slow decay of flux in its magnetic circuit. The closing coil will close the contacts when flux of hold out coil falls to a certain low value. This type of contactors are also used in dc motor starting for cutting the armature resistances in steps. dharm d:N-MachMac2-1.pm5 20
  • 39. 22 CONTROL OF MACHINES From the technical details it is also seen that the same contactor can be used with a dc, control supply also. Resistors are connected in series with the ac standard rating coils for use on dc supply. The electromagnetic coil picks up positively between 85 and 110 per cent of the rated coil voltage. The drop off voltage for ac operated models is roughly between 65 and 45 per cent and for dc operated models it is between 45 and 20 per cent of the rated coil voltage. The contact material used is silver alloy so as to avoid welding tendency of pure silver. Some of the common alloys used are: — Silver Nickel — Silver Cadmium Oxide — Silver Tin Oxide Silver Nickel is good for contactors of lower ratings upto about 100 A. For higher size of contactors, silver cadmium oxide is used as it has superior anti-weld property. The latest innovation is the use of Silver Tin Oxide (AgSnO2) for contactors of higher ratings. Notable advantages of Silver Tin Oxide are: • Erosion of contacts is very less • No toxic effect because of absence of cadmium. Table 4 gives standard ratings of contactors manufactured by Larsen Toubro and Siemens India Ltd. Table 4 Standard contactor ratings L T Make Type: Nominal Rating at Siemens Make Type: Nominal Rating at 415 V, 50 Hz 415 V, 50 Hz MM00 10 A 0 10 A ML0 12 A 1 16 A ML1 16 A 2 32 A ML1.5 16 A 4 70 A ML2 32 A 8 170 A ML3 40 A ML6 110 A ML7 125 A ML10 200 A ML12 300 A 2.6 RELAYS The literary meaning of the word relay is to transmit information. The function of relays in control circuit is also the same i.e., to sense or accept information from some sensing device and feed it into control circuit at proper level. The sensing devices used in conjunction with relays are known as pilot devices. Pilot devices, as described earlier, can sense or detect variables like current, voltage, overload, frequency, temperature, pressure and many others. Besides accepting information from pilot devices relays are also used to multiply the contacts available on pilot devices. Timing relays may be used to count or to insert time delays in a control circuit. In big machines large number of pilot devices like limit switches, proximity switches, pressure switches etc., are used to control various operations. Relays are used to locate the complex wiring in the panel by eliminating interwiring between pilot devices. Though extra dharm d:N-MachMac2-1.pm5 22
  • 40. CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS 23 expenditure on account of using relays is involved, a lot of time is saved in trouble shooting i.e., locating faults in the control circuit. Figs. 2.12 (a) and (b) show how an air compressor motor control circuit having four pilot devices can be wired with and without relays. The function of various pilot devices used for control of compressor motor has already been discussed in the beginning of the chapter (refer introduction to control components). Fig. 2.12 Control diagram for a compressor motor Control relays used are similar in construction to a contactor and therefore the same symbol of contactor coil is also used for ordinary voltage relays employed in control circuits. The working of the above circuit will be discussed at a later stage. Here let us observe only the difference between the two circuits at (a) and (b) respectively. Note that the components and the wiring enclosed by dotted lines in the figure are located in the control panel. In case of any fault say, when the motor is not running, in the control circuit of Fig. 2.12 (b) the operator can find out the condition of any pilot device by inspecting its respective control relay. If indication lamps are also provided through relay contacts on the panel door he need not even have to open the panel, indication lamps will indicate the condition of pilot devices. However, in control circuit of Fig. 2.12 (a), although less number of components are used, it is difficult to detect which of the pilot devices is not working since they are all connected in series. Thus use of relays provides multiple contacts for indicating devices and makes fault analysis rather easy. Some of the important type of relays are discussed as follows: 2.6.1 Voltage Relays This is just a small contactor which changes its contact positions from normally open to close and normally close to open when a proper voltage is applied across its coil. These relays come with as many normally open and close contacts as required. dharm d:N-MachMac2-1.pm5 23
  • 41. 24 CONTROL OF MACHINES The voltage level which when applied to the relay coil results in movement of relay contacts from their normal unoperated position to their operated position is called pick up voltage. The relay coil is generally designed to pick up at 85 % of its rated coil voltage. The voltage level at which the already operated relay contacts return to their unoperated position is called drop out voltage. Drop out voltage is generally less than 65 per cent of the rated coil voltage. This design characteristic of the relay can advantageously be utilized to provide under voltage protection. Under voltage protection for two direct-on-line starters of squirrel cage motors using a simple voltage relay is shown in Fig. 2.13. Fig. 2.13 (a) Control relay used for under voltage protection (b) Photographic view of a control contactor Whenever voltage level falls below the drop out voltage of the control relay, relay contact C1 and C2 open and supply to contactor coils A and B of motors gets disconnected. Thus contactors drop and motors also gets disconnected from the supply. 2.6.2 D.C. Series Current Relay This relay changes its contact position in response to current change in its coil. The relay coil is connected in series with the circuit in which current change is to be sensed. The armature of the relay is light thereby making it very fast in action. The armature is attracted when the current through the coil reaches a value high enough to produce the necessary magnetic flux for attraction. When the armature gets attracted, the closed auxiliary contacts will open. When current through the coil falls below a predertmined value the spring pulls the armature back and contacts close. The value at which the coil fails to hold back the attracted armature is determined by the setting of the spring. Some terms used in connection with a current relay are: Pull in current. It is the minimum value of current to close or pull in the relay armature. Drop out current. It is the value of current below which the relay no longer remains closed after having being pulled in. dharm d:N-MachMac2-1.pm5 24
  • 42. CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS 25 Differential current. It is the difference in value of pull in and drop out currents. For example if a relay is energised or pulled in at 5 amps and drops out at 3 amps, then pull out current is 5 amps, drop out current is 3 amps and the differential current is 2 amps. For heavier current applications, a current transformer is used and its output is applied to the current relay coil. One of the common applications of current relays is for timing acceleration of dc motors, which will be discussed at a later stage. Auxiliary contact Spring Series coil Fig. 2.14 Series type current relay 2.6.3 Frequency Responsive Relay This type of relay changes its contact position when the frequency of applied voltage to the relay coil falls below a pre-determined value. The relays are designed differently for different applications. In one type of construction, voltage is applied to the relay coil with a capacitor in series through a potentiometer resistor as shown in Fig. 2.15. Potentiometer V Relay coil Capacitor Fig. 2.15 Frequency responsive relay dharm d:N-MachMac2-1.pm5 25
  • 43. 26 CONTROL OF MACHINES The inductance of the relay coil and capacitor form a series resonant circuit through which a high current flows for a certain frequency range. The band width of the frequency range can be varied by changing the tapping of the potentiometer resistor. When the frequency falls below the resonant frequency range, current through the relay coil falls to a low value and the relay drops and its contacts open. In another type of construction two similar coils are arranged for a common armature. One coil is energised from a reference frequency source and the other is energised from the one to be sensed. The relay is closed one way when the frequencies are the same or within a predetermined percentage and is closed the other way when the frequency differs by a given amount or more. The frequency relays are used to apply field excitation to synchronous motors at the right instant and for acceleration control of wound rotor motors. 2.6.4 Latching Relays The difference between a conventional voltage relay and latching relay is that the former drops to its de-energised position when the operating coil is de-energised, whereas a latching relay remains in energised position even when operating coil is de-energised. Latching relay has two coils, an operating coil which is also referred to as latch coil and an unlatch coil. When the latch coil is energised the relay operates and is held in the energised position either by a mechanical latch or a permanent magnet. The relay remains in the energised position even when the latch coil is de-energised. The relay can be brought back to the de- energised position only when the unlatch coil is energised. The relay construction can be of two types depending on how the relay is held in the energised position when the latch coil is de-energised. The construction and working of the two types of latching relays i.e., the mechnical latched type and the permanent magnet type are described as follows. In a mechanical latched relay, when armature is pulled by the operating coil (latch coil) a mechanical latch engages the armature and holds it in place even when the coil voltage is removed. The relay can be brought back to the de-energised position when the mechanical latch is opened by energising the unlatch coil. In permanent magnet type latch relay the magnetic circuit material gets permanently magnetised when current flows through the operating coil (latch coil). Both the latch coil and the unlatch coil are mounted on the same magnetic core. See Fig. 2.16. When supply is given to terminals 1 and neutral, latch coil is energised and current flows in the direction shown. Relay is actuated and held closed due to magnetisation of the core even when supply is cut off. The supply to latch coil can also be cut off by using a normally closed contact of the relay in series with the coil. When relay closes, the contact opens and disconnects the coil (because the coil is not designed for continuous flow of current). Diodes are used to allow flow of dc current through the coil. When the relay is to be opened, supply is given between terminal 2 and neutral. Current in the unlatch coil flows through diode D2 in a direction so as to demagnetise the core. The current direction is opposite to that of the latch coil. When the core gets demagnetised the relay opens and supply to unlatch coil is also disconnected through a normally open contact of the relay. Latching relays are often used as memory relays on machines or processes where the work on machine must start from where it stopped when power had failed. When ordinary relays are used the machine cycle starts from the beginning when power is restored after a failure. Latching type relays can also be used where ac hum of the relay is objectionable. Here the relay coil is cut off once it is energised. A simple application of latching relay can be to start dharm d:N-MachMac2-1.pm5 26
  • 44. CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS 27 a motor automatically when power is restored after a failure. The control circuit is given in Fig. 2.17. Latch coil LCR ULCR NO NC Unlatch coil 2 1 Neutral Latch coil Unlatch coil Fig. 2.16 Latching relay P ON OFF L1 LCR ULCR C N Latch Unlatch Motor coil coil contactor Fig. 2.17 Simple application of a latch relay When ON-push button is pressed latching relay LCR is energised and contact L1 closes. Closing of contact L1 energises motor contactor C. When power fails relay does not drop and contact L1 remains closed. Therefore when power is restored, contactor C gets energised automatically and there is no need to push the ON-push button. Whenever it is desired to stop the motor the OFF-push button is pressed which energises the unlatch coil and thus contact L1 opens. dharm d:N-MachMac2-1.pm5 27
  • 45. 28 CONTROL OF MACHINES 2.7 OVERLOAD RELAYS The function of overload relay is to protect a motor against overloading. When a motor is mechnically overloaded it will draw more current than its rated value. The overload conditions can also be caused if the supply voltage is low or one of the supply phases is lost. When supply voltage falls the motor draws excessive current for the same load. In case one of the phases is lost the motor continues to run but draws excessive current through the remaining two phases. In both the cases if the excessive current is allowed to flow for a long time the motor windings will get heated up, resulting in failure of insulation and eventually burnout of the windings. To protect a motor against flow of excessive current an overload relay is connected in the power circuit. The relay is set at a certain value of current. When the motor current exceeds this value the contact of the control relay opens after a time delay depending upon the relay characteristic. The overload relays have inverse time current characteristic i.e., time for relay operation decreases as the current increases. It means a small overload will take more time for the relay to operate whereas the heavy overload will operate the relay almost instan-taneously. However, the overload relay does not provide short circuit protection as the relay operating time is still large. In the control circuit the contact of the relay is connected in series with the contactor coil. Opening of the control contact causes deenergisation of the contactor thus disconnecting supply to the motor terminal. For large motors the overload relay may be connected indirectly through current transformers. These relays are built with auto reset or hand reset facility. In hand reset a knob has to be pressed to reset the relay contact. Different type of overload relays are discussed as follows. 2.7.1 Bimetallic Thermal Overload Relay This is the most widely used relay because of its simple construction and minimal cost. The relay consists of three bimetallic strips with current coils wound on them as shown in Fig. 2.18. The whole of the assembly is mounted on a bakelite enclosure. Bimetallic strips comprising two dissimilar metals having different thermal coefficients of expansion are used for the three phases. Current flowing through the coils heat the bimetallic strips. Upper ends of the strips are firmly held while lower ends are free to move. When temperature of the strips increases due to current flowing through the coils, the strips bend towards right due to different expansion of metals. When the strips bend towards the right, the tripping mechanism gets actuated and opens the relay contact (refer Fig. 2.18). More is the current flowing through the coils, faster will be the action of relay (as more current increases the temperature quickly resulting in faster bending and in turn faster operation of the relay). The relay thus has inverse time characteristic. A typical current curve of the relay is also shown in Fig. 2.18. From the curve we see that at 100% of rated current motor will not trip, while at 200% of rated current, motor trips in two seconds. For 300% of rated current, the tripping time of the relay is less than 1 sec. However due to inverse time current characteristic, tripping of the relay due to momentary high currents during motor starting is avoided. As the thermal relays are heat dependent the relay cannot distinguish whether the heat is from the current flowing through the coil or from the surroundings. Therefore changes in ambient temperature changes the relay characteristic. To compensate for the ambient temperature changes, relays are designed with temperature compensating strip. The compensated overload relays are unaffected by variation in ambient temperature from – 22°C to 55°C. dharm d:N-MachMac2-2.pm5 28
  • 46. CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS 29 Strip fixed at this end Bimettalic strip Symbol Coil Control contacts Tripping mechanism (a) 7 6 Time in seconds required to trip 5 4 3 2 1 0 100 200 300 400 500 600 700 Percentage rated motor current (b) (c) Fig. 2.18 Bimetallic overload relay (a) Construction (b) Tripping characteristic (c) Photographic view dharm d:N-MachMac2-2.pm5 29
  • 47. 30 CONTROL OF MACHINES 2.7.2 Ratchet Type Eutectic Alloy Relay It consists of a fixed metallic tube filled with an eutectic alloy in which a closely fitted rotating shaft is inserted. A heating coil through which the load current flows, surrounds the tube. Eutectic alloy has the property of instantly changing over from soild state to liquid state when a particular temperature is reached. A ratchet wheel is attached to one end of the shaft. When normal current flows through the heating coil, solidified eutectic alloy holds the rotating shaft and the ratchet firmly. A spring loaded contact actuating assembly is engaged with the ratchet wheel as shown in Fig. 2.19. Under normal condition the ratchet wheel does not rotate inspite of spring pressure. When overload takes place, excessive current produces heat to melt the eutectic alloy. Now the rotating shaft and the ratchet wheel are free and therefore cannot restrain the spring loaded actuating mechanism from moving from left to the right direction. The ratchet wheel therefore rotates and the actuating mechanism is released. The spring pressure causes the mechanism to move towards the right side and the actuating knob actuates the relay contact. The relay can be reset by hand when the eutectic alloy solidifies. This is done by engaging the mechanism with the ratchet wheel against the spring pressure. Actuating Ratchet mechanism Spring Actuating knob Contact Top view of ratchet contact arrangement Ratchet Rotating shaft Heating coil Eutectic alloy Fixed metallic tube Fig. 2.19 Cross-sectional view of an eutectic relay 2.7.3 Magnetic Dash Pot Oil Filled Relay This relay consists of a coil through which the motor current can safely flow. Inside the coil is a plunger which tends to rise up against gravity due to magnetic pull, when motor current flows through the coil. The relay, for each phase, consists of a coil, a plunger and a piston. One element for this type of relay is shown in Fig. 2.20. dharm d:N-MachMac2-2.pm5 30
  • 48. CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS 31 Spring Relay contacts Coil Plunger Dash pot up/down adjustment Dash pot Oil Piston with holes Fig. 2.20 Cross-sectional view of magnetic dash pot oil filled relay The plunger, attached with a piston, is immersed in oil in the dash pot. The piston has bypass holes of different sizes. When current through the coil increases, the plunger and the piston move up. As the piston moves up, oil is forced through bypass holes which dampens the piston movement and provides delay. There is a provision for opening and closing of the bypass holes of different sizes by turning a valve disc over the piston. Thus by changing the area of bypass holes the delay characteristic of the relay can be changed. The relay provides inverse time current characteristics, larger is the overload, faster the plunger will move up and actuate the contact. Tripping adjustment can be obtained by adjusting the plunger core position with respect to the relay coil. This magnetic dash pot type of relays are used in controlling large motors. Another form of magnetic type relay is the instantaneous trip magnetic current relay. These relays are used to disconnect the motor when a predetermined load condition is exceeded. The relay does not have inverse time current characteristic, thus the relay cannot be used in place of an ordinary overload relay. It is a special purpose relay. To avoid tripping of this relay during starting of motors, the relay contact has to be by-passed during the starting period. See the control circuit shown in Fig. 2.21. The relay contact is used in parallel with the ON-push button and in series with the holding contact. As long as the ON-push button is held pressed the contact of the relay remains by-passed. When the motor accelerates fully the push button is released. The operating mechanism of the trip relay consists of a solenoid coil through which the motor current flows and a movable iron core within the coil. An over current causes the iron core to move up and operate a snap action contact mounted on top of the solenoid frame. The normal current of the motor does not exert sufficient magnetic pull to lift the core. The tripping values of the relay can be adjusted by changing the core position in the solenoid coil. If the iron core is moved down in the coil the relay will operate at a higher value of dharm d:N-MachMac2-2.pm5 31
  • 49. 32 CONTROL OF MACHINES current. Moving the core position higher in the coil will operate the relay at a lower value of current. The important application of the relay is in conveyors where the driving motor is stopped before mechanical breakage results due to jam-up. P OFF push button ON push C button Instantaneous current trip relay contact C N Fig. 2.21 Control circuit for instantaneous trip relay 2.8 TIME DELAY RELAYS (TIMERS) In time delay relays the relay contacts change over their position after a pre set delay from the time of energisation or de-energisation of the relay coil. Time delay relays are also commonly known as Timers. Timer can be of ON-delay or an OFF-delay type. A timer is referred to as an ON-delay type if the contacts change over after a pre-set delay after energisation. On the other hand a timer is referred to as OFF-delay type if the contacts change over after a pre-set delay from the instant of de-energisation. Besides the delayed contacts a timer can also have another set of contacts which operate as in an ordinary voltage relay. These are known as instantaneous contacts as they changeover their positions instantaneously when the timer is energised or de- energised. The representation of ON-delay and OFF-delay contacts of a timer in a control circuit is as shown in Fig. 2.22. We will represent the coil of the timer as the same for both ON- and OFF-delay but delayed contacts will be represented differently. Normally, most circuits require ON-delay timers. Applications requiring OFF-delay timers can also be covered by ON-delay timers with suitable modifications in the circuitry. However, OFF-delay timers can, in few cases, simplify circuitry and thereby reduce the cost. Though the OFF-delay timer find limited applications, the reader should however thoroughly understand the contact operation of OFF-delay timer, to avoid confusion between the two types of timers. The difference of operation becomes clear from the following explanation. ON-delay timer is normally in de-energised condition. The normal position of delayed contacts is shown in Fig. 2.22. When the timer is energised, after a pre-set delay the contacts change over their positions. Contact 1 will become closed and contact 2 will open. However, when the timer is de-energised contacts change over almost instantaneously. An OFF-delay timer is normally in energised condition. Thus, normally, contact 3 will be closed and contact 4 will be open. When the timer is de-energised the counting starts and after the pre-set delay, contacts 3 will open and contact 4 will close i.e., their positions will be as shown in Fig. 2.22. In the control circuits the changed over positions of the contacts are dharm d:N-MachMac2-2.pm5 32
  • 50. CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS 33 shown. As the time delay is only on one side (i.e., OFF-delay only), when timer is energised, contacts change over almost instantaneously. Fig. 2.22 Symbols for a timer and its contacts Timers can also be classified as cyclic and non-cyclic timers. When a timer continues to repeat its sequence of operation till the supply is switched off, it is called a cycle timer. The change over contacts would continually switch ON and OFF at intervals as long as operating voltage is on. The non-cyclic timers operate only for one timing cycle when they are switched on. The change over contacts get switched over after the set time and stay in that state till they are reset either manually or by a knob or by switching ON or OFF an electrical signal. Majority of applications require ON-delay, non-cyclic, non-manual reset type timers. There are four different types of timers utilising different operating principles. These timers are thermal timers, pneumatic timers, electronic timers and motor driven (synchronous) timers. 2.8.1 Thermal Timer Principle of working of a thermal timer is the same as that of a bimetallic overload relay discussed earlier. These are available with a limited delay range of 0–20 sec. The timing error can be very large of the order of ± 10 to 30%. By timing error it is meant that the time variation (plus or minus) between successive timing operations on the same timer represented as a percentage of maximum range of the timer. Due to higher timing error thermal timers are used only in star-delta starters where such error does not matter much. Pneumatic and Electronic timers are suitable for delay range of 0–3 minutes. For delays exceeding 3 minutes, synchronous timers are preferred. Pneumatic timers have a timing error of ± 10%, electronic timer, ± 5% and synchronous timers have timing error limited to ± 1%. The construction and working of these timers are discussed as follows. 2.8.2 Pneumatic Timer It consists of solenoid coil, a plunger assembly, and an air bleed unit consisting of an air chamber divided into upper chamber and lower chamber by a diaphgram. The diaphragm is attached to an operating rod and disc D as shown in Fig. 2.23 (a). There is a provision of air bleed (air flow) from upper chamber to lower chamber through a needle valve. Air flow rate can be changed by adjustment of needle valve screw. Solenoid coil plunger assembly and air bleed unit are assembled together as shown in Fig. 2.23 (a) for ON-delay type operation. The contact block is mounted on the air bleed unit. dharm d:N-MachMac2-2.pm5 33
  • 51. 34 CONTROL OF MACHINES Before the coil is energised the diaphragm is in its down position as shown in the figure. A small orifice at the bottom of the lower air chamber is held closed by the diaphragm and does not allow air flow from upper air chamber to lower air chamber. Diaphragm is held in the down position as the plunger is pressing the disc and the operating rod down. (b) Fig. 2.23 (a) Cross-sectional view of pneumatic timer (b) Photographic view of a pneumatic timer dharm d:N-MachMac2-2.pm5 34
  • 52. CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS 35 When the solenoid coil is energised the plunger is attracted and thus pressure on the disc (D) and the operating rod is released. Now the diaphragm is free. Air from upper chamber leaks to the lower chamber through the needle valve. The rate of air flow can be adjusted by the screw of the needle valve. As pressure of air in the lower chamber starts increasing the diaphragm moves up slowly at a speed which depends upon the rate of air flow through the needle valve. The diaphragm in turn moves the operating rod and the disc upward. The diaphragm will move up till air pressure in both the chambers is equal. An actuating lever attached to the disc, which moves upwards, actuates the timer contacts. The delay or time for actuation can be varied by adjustment of the needle valve. Operating rod, disc and diaphragm remain in up position as long as the coil is energised and therefore relay contacts remains closed. When the coil is de-energised, plunger falls down which in turn presses the diaphragm down through the disc and the operating rod. The air in the lower chamber is pressurised and it flows to the upper chamber through the check valves. It may be understood here that check valves allow air flow only in one direction. In this case this direction is from lower chamber to upper chamber and air flow is blocked in the reverse direction. On de-energisation the same position from where we started is reached and the relay is ready for another ON-delay operation. In the OFF-delay type of timer the air bleed unit and solenoid assembly are so arranged that, normally, when the coil is de-energised and the plunger is down the diaphgram is in the centre position and the contacts are in actuated condition. This is achieved if the whole of air bleed assembly (refer figure) is inverted and assembled over the solenoid coil assembly so that the rod of disc (D) enters the hole at the top of the coil assembly (shown dotted). When the coil is energised, the diaphragm is pushed by the plunger through the disc and the operating rod to close the orifice. Therefore the contacts also get de-actuated. When the coil is de-energised, diaphragm becomes free and starts moving towards the centre due to bleeding of air. Depending upon the speed of the operating rod and disc (D), the contacts are actuated after a delay. 2.8.3 Motor Driven Timers This timer consists of a small motor, usually a synchronous motor, which is engaged with gear arrangement with the help of electrically operated clutch. Gear arrangement reduces the speed of motor to a desired low value. Motor thus rotates a contact actuating lever through gear arrangement. The actuating lever after travelling a pre-set distance operates the timer contacts. The time delay for actuation of contacts can be changed by a knob which varies the distance between the actuating lever and the contacts. If the distance between the actuating lever and the contacts is increased, the timer will take more time to actuate the contacts (as the motor speed is constant) and vice-versa. In ON-delay timers the motor starts counting time when the clutch coil is energised and in OFF-delay timers counting starts when the clutch coil is de- energised. Timer gets reset when the clutch is de-energised in an ON-delay timer and energised in case of an OFF-delay timer. In an ON-delay timer the motor can be energised along with the clutch but in an OFF-delay timer the motor has to be kept running continuoulsy. Synchronous motor timers are also available in simple version without a clutch. In this case the timer starts counting time when motor is energised and actuates contacts after the actuating lever moves through a pre-set distance. The timer gets reset when supply to motor is disconnected. Another version of motor driven timer makes or breaks a number of contacts during its timing period with the help of cams mounted on the motor shaft. A cam is a circular plastic material which is fitted on the motor shaft as shown in Fig. 2.24. Cams are shaped to produce protruding portions which actuate the contact blocks. dharm d:N-MachMac2-2.pm5 35
  • 53. 36 CONTROL OF MACHINES Fig. 2.24 Simplified representation of a motor driven cam timer When the motor is energised the cams start rotating. Protruding portion of the cam presses the knob of contact block and thus contacts remains actuated as long as the protruding portion of the cam passes over the contact knob. For the remaining position of the cam the contact gets de-actuated. The time period required for actuation and de-actuation of a particular contact can be obtained by adjusting the shape of the cam as per requirement. These timers are very useful for initiating different processes in sequence. Another important application is starting of motors in a conveyor system. A time switch is another form of a motor driven timer. It offers independent control of the ON and OFF-duration of the contacts. Any combination of ON-time and OFF-time can be selected as long as the total of ON-time and OFF-time does not exceed the maximum or full range-time of the device. An important application of time switch is for street lighting control where the full range-time is 24 hours. Time switch, for this purpose, is provided with battery supply also which can run the timer in case the main supply fails. Thus interruptions due to supply failure does not effect the ON and OFF-time of the timer. 2.8.4 Electronic Timer Electronic timers are widely used in industry for various applications due to their better accuracy and longer life than the pneumatic timers. They are less expensive than synchronous timers. Only critical processes which demand very high accuracy require synchronous timers. Electronic timers achieve their timing action with an electronic circuit. Electronic timers are generally of the ON-delay type. When supply to the timer is given it starts counting and the contacts change over their positions after a pre-set delay. The length of time delay period is easily adjusted by a variable resistor placed in the electronic circuit. The timer gets reset when supply to the timer is cut off. A very simple electronic timer circuit using a silicon controlled rectifier (SCR) is shown in Fig. 2.25. The SCR, also generally known as Thyristor, has three terminals Anode, Cathode and Gate. It conducts when a signal is applied between its Gate and Cathode and continues to conduct even if signal to the gate is removed after conduction starts. It conducts only when there is positive supply at the Anode and negative supply at the Cathode. The gate supply should be positive with respect to the Cathode to cause its conduction. In the circuit of Fig. 2.25, control transformer (220/12 V centre tapped) and diodes D1 and D2 provide 12 V dc supply to the electronic circuit. When the timer switch is closed 12 V dc is available to the timer circuit. Resistance R1 and capacitor C form the RC charging circuit. The coil of the timer relay is connected in series with the SCR as shown. The gate of SCR is connected to the capacitor terminal. When the timer switch is closed, the capacitor C starts charging. When the voltage of the capacitor is sufficient to send minimum gate current to trigger on the SCR, the SCR starts conducting. Resistance R2 is there to limit the gate current. When the SCR starts conducting, relay coil picks up and closes its contacts. The required delay in closing dharm d:N-MachMac2-2.pm5 36
  • 54. CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS 37 the relay contacts may be obtained by changing the charging rate of capacitor (by varying the variable resistance R1). A suitable time range of the timer can be designed by using required values of R1 and C. The timer gets reset automatically when supply to the timer is cut off. The contacts of the timer then return to the normal position immediately. Switch D1 Timer relay coil R1 Timer Anode contacts 220 V 12 V Gate Cathode C R2 D2 (a) (b) Fig. 2.25 (a) Simple circuit of an electronic timer (b) Photographic view of an electronic timer 2.9 PHASE FAILURE RELAY (SINGLE PHASING PREVENTER) In a 3-phase motor, when under running conditions, one of the three fuses blows and power to the motor is supplied by the remaining two phases, the motor is said to be running on single phasing condition. To maintain the same power input to the motor during single phasing the current in the remaining two phases will increase by 1.73 times. If the motor is lightly loaded, currents in healthy phases will not increase beyond the full rated current setting on the overload relay. Thus overload relay will not be able to detect single-phasing when the motor is lightly dharm d:N-MachMac2-2.pm5 37
  • 55. 38 CONTROL OF MACHINES loaded. For example, consider a 10 hp motor with rated current of 14 A and over-load relay setting at 10 A. At a particular load, let the motor be drawing a current of 5 A. If one of the fuses blows out or a conductor breaks, current in the two phases will become 5 × 1.73 = 8.65 A, which is much below the relay setting of 10 A. Therefore, the motor will continue running under single phasing. Single phasing of the motor results in superpositon of negative sequence of current flow over the positive sequence through the motor windings. These negative sequence currents are of double frequency as compared to positive sequence currents and produce a torque which is opposite to that produced by positive sequence currents. As the iron losses are proportional to frequency, the negative sequence currents cause higher iron losses and therefore greater heating of the rotor. Rotor heating is further increased due to skin effect (due to higher frequency). This undetected heating can damage the rotor and due to convection, stator windings also. This excessive heat can finally cause burn out of the motor. To avoid failure of the motor due to single phasing, phase failure relay or commercially known as single phase preventer is used in the motor circuit as shown in Fig. 2.26. CT CT Single phase 1 3 5 11 preventor relay 2 4 6 12 1 3 5 11 Normally closed 2 4 6 12 contacts 11-12 in series with coil circuit of contactor Contactor In series with the coil circuit of contactor Overload relay M 3– Fig. 2.26 Connection scheme for phase failure relay As shown in the figure the relay is connected in the incoming supply phases. The control contact (11-12) is connected in series with the contactor coil circuit. If the starting time of the motor is more, to avoid undesirable tripping, the control contact should be by-passed during starting. Brief description of a relay which works on the basis of detection of negative sequence current is explained as follows. The relay has two built-in current transformers which sense currents of the motor. The secondary of the CTs feeds a negative sequence filter. The output from this filter is proportional to the negative sequence component of currents. This output is fed to a sensor which detects the level of negative sequence components of current and thus trips the motor starter by opening its control contact. These relays are designed for different ratings of motors upto 20 hp. For dharm d:N-MachMac2-2.pm5 38
  • 56. CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS 39 motors above 20 hp, a relay rated for a 3 hp motor can be used by using current transformers on the lines as shown in Fig. 2.26. The CTs should have a secondary current of 5 A, the primary current should correspond to full rated current of the motor. The two secondaries are connected to two phases of the relay. The control contact is used as usual in series with the contactor coil. 2.10 PUSH BUTTON SWITCHES It is a pilot device which provides control of an equipment by pressing an actuator which looks like a button. Push button switch can be divided into two parts. One part is the mechanical actuator or button assembly and the second part is the electrical portion or contact assembly called the contact block. The mechanical actuator or button assembly can be of momentary-contact spring returned type or of maintained contact type. The momentary-contacts spring returned push button remains actuated as long as the button is physically held pressed by the human operator. Under pressed condition the contacts change their positions in the contact block. Once the button is released the contacts return to their normal position. Maintained contact push buttons are held actuated by some latching mechanism even when the operator releases the pressure on the push button. Such units consist of two push buttons, only one remains in actuated position at a time, when the other button is pressed the first one gets released. A spring returned momentary contact push button is shown in Fig. 2.27. The contact block has two contacts, one normally open (NO) and the other normally closed (NC). When the push button is pressed, NC contacts opens and NO contact closes. When the push button is released a spring inside the actuator assembly brings back the push button and a spring inside the contact block brings the contacts back to their normal position. The symbol for the push button switch is also shown in Fig. 2.27. Return spring Front view Side view Mounting screw Mounting screw Normally open contact Normally closed Contact Terminal contact block Actuator Actuator spring Actuator Push button Check nut Symbol Fig. 2.27 (a) Cross sectional view and end view of a push button. dharm d:N-MachMac2-2.pm5 39
  • 57. 40 CONTROL OF MACHINES (b) Fig. 2.27 (b) Photographic view of a push button Push button switches can be of different types depending upon the type of actuator assembly. They are: • Recessed button type • Mushroom head type • Illuminated type • Key lock type. Colour of the button is also an important factor in push button switches. Standards have been developed which specify certain colour for a particular function. For example, red push buttons are used for stop and emergency stop operations, while green push buttons are used for start operations. When two or three push button switches are mounted on a steel or plastic enclosure it is known as a push button station. For example, in a three push button station, one push button may be for running the motor in forward direction, the second for running the motor in reverse direction, and the third for stopping the motor. 2.11 SELECTOR SWITCHES Many machines and process operations are designed so as to function in any one of the several ways. For example, the three different modes of operation may be Manual, Semi-automatic and Automatic. A selector switch will enable the operator to predetermine the manner in which his machine is to operate. As with push-button switches, selector switches also have two main parts, the mechanical actuator and the contact block. Selector switches are usually of the maintained position type, although momentary spring return selectors are also available. Selector switches can have single break contacts or double break contacts. The symbols for both these type of contacts have been shown in Figs. 2.28 and 2.29. dharm d:N-MachMac2-2.pm5 40
  • 58. CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS 41 Fig. 2.28 Connection of two position and three position selector switches in a simple circuit OFF N P 1 2 1 2 N P OFF 1 2 N P 1 2 N P OFF N P 1 2 (a) Two position selector switch (b) Three position selector switch (a) (b) Fig. 2.29 (a) Connection of double break two position and three position selector switches in a simple circuit (b) Photographic view of a three positions selector switch The selector switches are generally made for four Selector switch positions positions. As the number of positions increase to four, manufacturer provide charts of tables which display 1 2 A 3 4 positions of the selector switch actuator. Fig. 2.30 shows B a four position selector switch. Note the use of × under the position number. This indicates that the contact in C line with × is closed in that position. D Below position 1 (Fig. 2.30) × is against contact B and C i.e., in position 1 contact B and C are closed. Fig. 2.30 Symbolic representation of four position selector switch dharm d:N-MachMac2-2.pm5 41
  • 59. 42 CONTROL OF MACHINES In position 2 contacts B and D will close, further in position 3 contact A and D will close and in position 4 contacts A and C will close. 2.12 DRUM SWITCHES Drum switches, also referred to as Master Controllers are identical in function but of a different type of construction than selector switches. A selector switch uses components similar to a push-button while a drum switch consists of a shaft attached to the operating lever (actuator), which has a number of cams mounted on it. Cams actuate their respective contact when the operating lever is rotated. A single cam can operate two contacts, one mounted on right side and one on left side of the shaft cam arrangement. The contact ratings can be high depending upon the application. A Drum switch can be considered as the ‘big brother’ of a selector switch. One of the important applications of Drum switches is in overhead cranes for controlling hoist, long travel, and cross-travel operations. Separate drum switches are used for each of these operations. Fig. 2.31 shows the symbolic representation of a master controller used for forward-reverse operation of a motor used in a crane. Off Reverse Forward 5 4 3 2 1 A 1 2 3 4 5 B C D E F G H Fig. 2.31 Symbolic representation of master controller used for forward/reverse operation Master controller contacts are shown by A, B, C, D, E, F, G, H. When the lever is in OFF position, contact A remains closed, and opens for any other position of the switch. When the controller is moved towards right side (forward), contact B and D actuate at position 1 and these contacts remain actuated till the lever is moved to position 5. Let us co-relate the position, the × mark under the position, and the contact in line with the ×. Contact C will not actuate in any position on right side. On further moving the lever to position 2 contact E will close and at position 3 contact F will close and so on. Similar action takes place when the operating lever is moved towards left side. At this point one may wonder as to why so many contacts are needed for forward reverse operation of a motor ! In fact, master controller contacts are used to get different speeds of the slip-ring motor used in cranes by cutting the rotor resistance in steps. When we discuss the starter for slip ring induction motor at a later stage, we will again have to refer to the master controller explained above. 2.13 LIMIT SWITCHES Limit switch is an important control element. Limit switch contacts change over their position when its actuating lever or knob is actuated by the mechanical part of a machine. The mechanical dharm d:N-MachMac2-2.pm5 42
  • 60. CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS 43 part attached to the machine which actuates the limit switch lever or knob is known as actuator or dog. Limit switches are used to stop a mechanical movement of a machine and may also be used to stop a particular movement, and initiate another movement. The simple application of a limit switch is in producing automatic to and fro movement of a planar machine bed shown in Fig. 2.32. It must be understood here that a limit switch is not used as a mechanical stop. A limit switch controls the electrical signal which is responsible for mechanical stop/movement. L.S L.S (A) (B) (a) Control off-motor standstill, bed at extreme left with limit switch ‘A’ actuated L.S L.S (A) (B) (b) Control on-motor runs in clockwise direction and bed moves in right direction due to actuated condition of limit switch ‘A’ L.S L.S (A) (B) (c) Limit switch ‘B’ actuates which stops motor and runs it in anti-clockwise direction L.S L.S (A) (B) (d) Motor runs in anticlockwise direction till limit switch ‘A’ is actuated. On actuation of limit switch motor stops and again runs in clockwise direction Fig. 2.32 Application of limit switch for automatic to and fro movement of planar bed Actual control circuit for achieving this to and fro movement with help of limit switches shown in Fig. 2.32, will be discussed at a later stage. 2.13.1 A Simple Limit Switch The simplest construction of a limit switch is shown in Fig. 2.33. When the knob or pin is pushed the plunger attached to the knob move down against spring pressure. The moving contacts mounted on the plunger also moves down. Thus the terminals 1 and 2, which are normally closed, become open and terminals 3 and 4, which are normally open, get closed. When the pressure on the knob is released the contacts return to their normal position. Another commonly used limit switch is the lever type. This may be single side actuation type or double side actuation type, as shown in Figs. 2.33 (b) and (c). In a single side actuation type limit switch the contacts operate when the limit switch arm moves in one direction, either the right or to the left. Movement on the other side does not actuate the contacts. The arm returns to the normal position when the actuating force is removed. The limit switch can also be of maintained contact type in which arm has to be brought dharm d:N-MachMac2-2.pm5 43
  • 61. 44 CONTROL OF MACHINES Pin or knob 1 2 Symbol Moving NO NC contacts contact contact Terminals 3 4 Plunger Return spring (a) A B (b) (c) Fig. 2.33 Inside view of (a) Knob type limit switch (b) Single side actuation lever type limit switch (c) Double side actuation lever type limit switch Fig. 2.34 Photographic view of (a) Knob type limit switch (b) Lever type limit switch dharm d:N-MachMac2-2.pm5 44
  • 62. CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS 45 back manually to normal. However this type of limit switches are rarely used. In double side actuation type limit switch, when the arm is moved in one direction, say towards right, contact block A operates; and when the arm is moved towards left, contact block B operates. This type of a limit switch can serve the purpose of two single side actuation limit switches needed in controlling to and fro movement of a machine. If the contacts of the limit switch change-over independent of the speed of operation, the limit switch is known as snap-action limit switch. At a particular position of the arm, the contacts change-over. If the contacts also move at the same speed as that of the arm of the limit switch, it is called a slow-action limit switch. Most limit switches used are the snap- action type. There are only few applications where slow acting limit switches are preferred. 2.13.2 Rotary Cam Type Limit Switches In this type of limit switches, the contacts are mounted on the stationary frame. The cams, which have to actuate the contacts, are mounted on the rotating shaft. The position of the cams is adjustable. The rotating shaft is coupled to the driving motor of the machinery either through chain and sprockets or by gear arrangement. The rotation of the driving motor is thus transmitted to the shaft of the limit switch. The cams mounted on the shaft are shaped and their position adjusted to actuate the contacts at the desired instant. In the machinery, the rotary motion of the driving motor is converted into longitudinal motion through mechanical arrangement. Thus, the cam shaft of the limit switch rotates proportional to the longitudinal motion of the machine. The limits of travel of the machinery, therefore, can be adjusted by changing the cam position. The advantage of a rotary cam limit switch over an ordinary limit switch is that the instant of actuation and hence limits of travel can be varied easily over a wide range by changing the cam positions. In an ordinary limit switch, however, once the limit switch is fixed, only very little adjustment is possible by adjusting the lever position. The reliability of rotary limit switch using sprocket and chain is however low and, therefore, wherever these are used a back-up-protection of ordinary limit switches is generally provided to avoid damage due to over travel, in case the rotary limit switch fails due to slipping or breaking of chain. Rotary limit switches are preferred where frequent adjustment of limits of travel is required. One of its important application is in over-head cranes for hoisting and lowering motion. In over-head crane, for hoisting operation, the rotary motion of the motor is converted into longitudinal motion with the help of a rope wound on the drum attached to the motor shaft. The rope winds on the drum in one direction giving hoisting (raising) operation and unwinds in other direction giving lowering motion. The limits of hoisting and lowering can be easily adjusted by varying the cam positions which have to actuate the hoisting and lowering limit switch contacts. 2.13.3 Heavy Duty Limit Switches As the name signifies, these limit switches are used in heavy duty machines such as cranes, conveyors and heavy material handling equipment. The basic difference between an ordinary limit switch and a heavy duty limit switch is that the former is used in the control circuit while the latter is used in the power circuit. Actuation of a heavy duty limit switch cuts off power supply to the motor. Heavy duty limit switch requires a minimum of two normally closed contacts because to stop a motor two phases have to be cut off. A heavy duty limit switch may be either lever type or rotary cam type. They are rugged, and the current rating of their contacts matches with the motor rating. If the rating is quite high, arc chutes are also provided over the contacts. These heavy duty limit switches are used in addition to the control limit switches. They are generally used as back-up-protection for control limit switches. If the control limit dharm d:N-MachMac2-2.pm5 45
  • 63. 46 CONTROL OF MACHINES switch fails or contactor gets stuck or welded, then the heavy duty limit switch operates to disconnect power supply to the motor. The limit switch contacts are connected in series with the main contactor contacts. These limit switches therefore avoid damage and accidents due to over-travel of machinary like overhead crane and other heavy material handling equipment. 2.13.4 Speed Actuating Sensing Switches These are also commonly known as plugging switches or zero speed switches. These switches have two sets of contacts, one each for either direction or rotation of the motor. The contacts for a particular direction of rotation open or close when a predetermined rotational speed in that direction is achieved. These switches are used in circuits where the motor is to be stopped quickly (i.e., to be brought to standstill quickly by plugging method of braking). In plugging, the motor is stopped by reversing its two supply leads till motor comes to standstill. The torque developed during reversing causes the motor to come to standstill in a short time. The most commonly used design of this device is the one which use the effect of induced magnetic forces. In this type, a shaft having a permanent magnet on it rotates inside a copper cup. The copper cup can rotate in either direction against spring pressures. The shaft of the switch is coupled with the motor shaft. As the motor shaft rotates, the permanent magnet on the switch shaft rotates inside the cup. Magnetic induction due to its rotation causes the cup to follow the rotation of the shaft. An actuator is connected on the copper cup which can actuate the contacts in either direction. The speed at which the contacts would operate can be adjusted by varying the spring tension which restrain the movement of the cup. The contacts get reset to their original position when the motor speed falls below the value set by the spring tension. If the contact of the speed switch is so adjusted that contacts operate immediately on rotation in either direction and reclose only when zero speed is reached the switch is known as zero speed switch. The plugging switch or zero speed switch is represented in a control circuit as shown in Fig. 2.35. (a) Unactuated position (b) Actuation at a (c) Actuation at a forward speed reverse speed Fig. 2.35 Representation of plugging switch or zero speed switch 2.14 SOLENOID VALVES Solenoid valves are electromechanical devices like relays and contactors. A solenoid valve is used to obtain mechanical movement in machinery by utilizing fluid or air pressure. The fluid or air pressure is applied to the cylinder piston through a valve operated by a cylindrical electrical coil. The electrical coil along with its frame and plunger is known as the solenoid and the assembly of solenoid and mechanical valve is known as solenoid valve. The solenoid valve is thus another important electromechanical device used in control of machines. Solenoid valves are of two types: (i) Single solenoid spring return operating valve, (ii) Double solenoid operating valve. dharm d:N-MachMac2-2.pm5 46
  • 64. CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS 47 In Fig. 2.36 (a) is shown a single solenoid spring return valve in its de-energised condition. The symbol for the solenoid and the valve are also shown. The solenoid valve is shown connected to the cylinder to help readers understand the solenoid valve action. In the de-energised condition, the plunger and the valve spool position are as shown in Fig. 2.36 (a). In this position of spool, port P is connected to port A and port B is connected to tank or exhaust (i.e., atmosphere) if air is used. Spring pressure (S) keeps the spool in this condition as long as the coil is de- energised. Fluid pressure from port P through port A is applied to the left side of the cylinder piston. Thus the cylinder piston moves in the right direction. Now when the solenoid coil is energised, plunger is attracted and it pushes the spool against spring pressure. The new position of plunger and spool are shown in Fig. 2.36 (b) In this position of spool, port A gets connected to tank and port P gets connected to port B. Thus pressure is applied to the cylinder piston from the right and moves the piston rod to the left. At the same time fluid in the other side is drained out to the tank. When the solenoid coil is again de-energised, the spring (S) will move the spool to its original position as shown in Fig. 2.36 (a). Thus normally when the solenoid coil is de-energised the piston rod remains extended. Cylinder Piston rod Load Pressurised P fluid or air A B Spring A B A B Valve spool To tank or exhaust (a) P T P T Valve symbol Pressurised fluid or air Solenoid symbol A P B Valve Spool Plunger To tank or attracted Solenoid coil exhaust (b) Fig. 2.36 Single solenoid spring return valve dharm d:N-MachMac2-3.pm5 47
  • 65. 48 CONTROL OF MACHINES Fig. 2.37 (a), (b) and (c) shows the double solenoid operating valve in three conditions. In Fig. 2.37 (a) both the solenoids are de-energised, and, therefore, the centering springs keep the spool in the position shown. In this position of spool, pressure port P is connected to tank while port A and B are closed by spool. No pressure is applied to either port A or port B. In Fig. 2.37 (b) is shown the spool position when solenoid A is energised. Energisation of solenoid A attracts its plunger and the spool moves in right direction compressing the right side centering spring. In this condition port P is connected to port A and port B is connected to tank (exhaust in case of air). Fig. 2.37 (c) shows the valve with solenoid B energised. The plunger is attracted and in turn spool moves towards the left, compressing the centering spring to the left. Now pressure port P is connected to port B and port A is connected to tank or exhaust. When the solenoid is de-energised the spool returns to the original position as shown in Fig. 2.37(a). Fig. 2.37 Double solenoid valve in three operating conditions 2.15 PRESSURE SWITCHES Pressure switches are used in the control systems to sense pressure of gas, air or liquid and feed a signal into the electrical control circuit. Pressure switch can have a normally open or a normally closed contact or it can have both types of contacts. The contact operation of a pressure switch is different from the switches we have discussed so far. The extra feature is the differential setting. The cut out point of a pressure switch is that pressure at which its contact opens to de- energise the associated pump/compressor from raising the pressure further or to stop a machine dharm d:N-MachMac2-3.pm5 48
  • 66. CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS 49 cycle. Before we take up differential setting, we will see how the control system behaves if the pressure switch has only the cut-out point setting. For example, if a pump is used to raise water pressure in a tank to say upto 50 P.S.I. the pressure switch will energise the pump when pressure falls below 50 P.S.I. and will de-energise it when water pressure rises above 50 P.S.I. The variation from the above setting is generally only 1% of setting on either side which is called the accuracy of the pressure switch. When water pressure of the tank is being utilized the water pressure will fall and therefore opening and closing of the pressure switch contacts will be very rapid. Consequently the ON-OFF frequency of the pump motor will be high which will shorten its life. However, the pressure will be maintained very close to the value set on the pressure switch. To avoid this frequent switching ON-OFF of pump, a differential setting is provided in the pressure switch. Let us say a differential setting of 10 P.S.I. is provided. Now, what will happen is that when pressure drops below the cut out value of 50 P.S.I. the pressure switch contact will not open, it will open only when pressure falls to a lower value known as low pressure cut in, and this value is given by: Low Pressure cut in = High pressure cut out—differential setting. In this case the ‘cut in value’ is therefore equal to 40 P.S.I. Thus when water pressure falls below the cut in value of 40 P.S.I. the contact will again close and energise the pump to raise the water pressure again to 50 P.S.I. (the cut out value). The differential setting may be of a fixed value or it may be variable depending upon the provision made. Thus we see that if the cut out value is fixed and differential setting is varied, the cut in value changes according to the variation in differential setting. In the above example the cut out point referred to as high pressure and cut in point referred to as low pressure. However, these terms may also refer to as carrying opposite meanings in other applications. Now, let us consider the case of a machine whose various operations are done by air pressure. Let us assume that for satisfactory operation of the machine the air pressure should be more than 80 P.S.I. i.e., the machine should start only if the air pressure in the reservoir is more than 80 P.S.I. and it should stop if air pressure falls below 70 P.S.I. In this case, therefore, the cut in point is 80 P.S.I. above which the machine starts and cut out point is 70 P.S.I. below which the machine stops. As the value of cut in pressure is higher than the cut out pressure, it would be proper to mention these terms as high pressure cut in and low pressure cut out. Note that here the prefix high pressure and low pressure have changed their meanings from the previous example. The pressure switches basically falls into three general categories depending upon the manner of operation. The principle of working of one type, called the bellow type, is illustrated in Fig. 2.38. The actual switches, however, vary considerably in their mechanical design. Further the differential setting arrangement is also not shown in this figure. The bellow expands or contracts depending upon the pressure. The movement of the bellow tilts the lever which rests on the micro switch knob. The thrust of lever on the micro switch knob can be varied by adjusting the screw. This would change the pressure at which the micro switch contact will change over. The second general type of pressure switch uses a diaphragam in place of a bellow, the other operation being the same. The third type uses a hollow tube of semicircular shape. When pressure is given to this tube, it tries to straighten up and this action is transformed into a rotary motion and through a mechanical linkage a micro switch is actuated. Pressure switches are designed to operate within a certain range. For example a switch of 15-55 P.S.I. range cannot be used for higher ranges of pressure of say 100-150 P.S.I. dharm d:N-MachMac2-3.pm5 49
  • 67. 50 CONTROL OF MACHINES Micro switch Pivot Pressure Adjustment inlet screw Adjusting spring Fig. 2.38 Bellow type pressure switch 2.16 PRESSURE TRANSDUCER A pressure transducer is an important pilot device of modern machines used in industry and controlled by programmable controllers. A pressure transducer utilizes piezo electric or semi- conductor strain gauges to measure presssure. Semi-conductor strain gauges are very small, typical dimension being 0.3 inch overall length, 0.01 inch width and 0.001 inch thick. A strain gauge changes its resistivity when it is stressed, the change in resistivity being proportional to the strain produced in the gauge due to external stress. In pressure transducers the strain gauges are epoxy bounded on the metallic diaphragm of pressure transducers. The four strain gauges Rsg1, Rsg2, Rsg3 and Rsg4 bonded on the diaphram are connected in the Wheat Stone bridge as shown in Fig. 2.39. Two strain gauges Rsg2 and Rsg4 are mounted such that increase of pressure increases their resistance and the other two strain gauges Rsg2 and Rsg3 are so mounted that increase of pressure decreases their resistance. Fig. 2.39 Pressure transducer using strain gauges dharm d:N-MachMac2-3.pm5 50
  • 68. CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS 51 At balance when there is no pressure, there is no output between terminals A and B. As soon as the pressure is applied, the strain gauges get stretched or compressed accordingly and the bridge circuit gets unbalanced due to changes in resistance of strain gauges. Thus, a voltage output becomes available between terminal A and B which is proportional to the pressure on the diaphragm. 2.17 TEMPERATURE SWITCHES (THERMOSTATS) In many industrial processes temperatures have to be maintained within very close limits or otherwise, the finished product may not come up to the standards. Temperature switches or thermostats are used for maintaining a prescribed value of temperature. There are two general types of temperature switches used in industry. The first one is bimetallic strip type which works in a similar way to that of an overload relay discussed earlier. The unequal expansion of two bimetallic strips causes them to bend and this bending movement is used to actuate a snap switch. The accuracy of this type of thermostats is not of a high order, it is mostly used where high precision work is not required such as for room heating, air conditioning and refrigeration. However, it has a compact and rugged construction. Another type of thermostat which has wide industrial application uses either a liquid, a gas or a vapour as the sensing element in a short length of pipe or in a long thin tube called capillary tube with a bulb at one end. The expansion of the liquid, gas or vapour is utilised to actuate the switch contact. The temperature ranges for these units are as follows: Liquid filled 100°F to 2200°F Gas filled 100°F to 1000°F Vapour filled 50°F to 700°F. Figure 2.40 shows a view of a capillary tube type thermostat. Actuating pin Contact block Actuating spring Bulb sensor or probe Operating bellow Housing Capillary Fig. 2.40 Capillary type thermostat The probe is inserted at the location where the temperature is to be measured, the liquid in the bulb expands and pressure is developed in the bellow which also expands and moves the actuating pin which operates the contact operating mechanism. This liquid filled type of thermostat has a very quick response. However if the length of the tube is long the dharm d:N-MachMac2-3.pm5 51
  • 69. 52 CONTROL OF MACHINES response becomes a little slower. This thermostat is especially useful where the switch actuating mechanism has to be kept away from the temperature sensing side. The disadvantage of this type is that the capillary tube gets easily damaged if it is not carefully handled. 2.18 FLOAT SWITCH Float switches are used to maintain liquid levels within a certain range in a tank by energising a pump when the liquid level falls to a certain lower pre-set height and by de-energising the pump when liquid level rises above a certain higher pre-set height. This level sensing switches using a float can be of two types, one using a rod and the other a chain with a counter weight. A float switch using a rod is shown in Fig. 2.41. Stopper Lever Actuator Contact block Rod Hinge Ft Ft Float Symbol for float switch Fig. 2.41 Level sensing using a float and a rod A float is attached to the lower end of the rod. The rod passes through a hole of a lever. Two stoppers fitted on two ends of the rod cannot pass through the hole (see Fig. 2.41). When the liquid level rises the float also rises and moves the rod up. At a certain level depending upon the position of lower stopper the lever gets tilted up and it inturn actuates the contact. When the water level starts falling the float and the rod also moves down. The lever, however, remains in the same position and keeps the contact actuated. At a certain lower level depending upon the position of the upper stopper the lever gets tilted down by the stopper and the contact gets deactuated. When the liquid level starts rising the contact remains unactuated till the higher level set by stopper position is reached. This actuation and deactuation of the contact are used to stop and start a pump motor for maintaining the desired liquid level in the tank. The other form of float switch uses a chain passing over a pulley with float at one end and a counter weight at the other end (see Fig. 2.42). The stoppers fitted on both sides of the chain tilts the lever. The contact is opened or closed by the position of mercury placed in a tube. The tube is mounted on the lever and thus dharm d:N-MachMac2-3.pm5 52
  • 70. CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS 53 tilting of lever causes the contact to open or close. When the liquid level raises the float, the stopper on the left hand side of the chain tilts the lever in clock-wise direction and thus the switch contacts open (see Fig. 2.42). When the liquid level drops and the counter weight rises and at certain limit the stopper fixed on the right hand side of the chain pushes the lever and tilts it in the anticlockwise direction, the switch contact closes. A float switch may not be suitable for certain applications, for example, in situation where there is some mounting difficulty or where ice may form on the surface of the liquid due to low ambient temperature. When the water level falls the ice layer remains fixed and therefore the decreasing liquid level below the ice remains undetected by the float. In such cases the liquid level is sensed by measuring the pressure of the liquid level. For this a special differential switch is used which compares two pressures from different sources. The switch has differential adjustment instead of range adjustment. The difference adjustment is used to set the maximum pressure difference between the two sources to actuate the switch contact. The differential adjustment is used to get the minimum pressure difference to deactuate the switch contact. In a tank where liquid level is maintained with the help of a differential pressure switch the top of the tank is filled with compressed air to maintain constant pressure in the outgoing lines. When water level falls, more compressed air enters the tank and thus the total pressure in the tank remains constant. In this case an ordinary pressure switch fitted at the bottom of the tank will therefore always read the constant pressure in the tank. Pulley Lever Chain Stopper Hinge Float Mercury To control circuit Counter weight Fig. 2.42 Level sensing using a float, chain pulley and counter weight The differential pressure switch solves the problem. It measures the difference between the total pressure in the tank i.e., (air and water) and only the air pressure. This differential pressure is proportional to the height of water in the tank. One connection of the pressure switch is placed at the bottom of the tank to measure the total pressure of air and water column. The other connection is at the top of the tank which measures only the air pressure. The switch is easily set to control the water level in the tank by setting the maximum and minimum difference in pressure to actuate and deactuate the switch contact. dharm d:N-MachMac2-3.pm5 53
  • 71. 54 CONTROL OF MACHINES 2.19 CONTROL TRANSFORMER The function of a control transformer is to obtain the desired low voltage control supply from the power supply system. The stepped down control supply voltage may be 220 V or less. There are two advantages of using a low control voltage. (i) Reduced risk to the operator, and (ii) Reduced risk of insulation break down and grounding in the control wiring and pilot devices. In India the most commonly used control voltage is 220 V, however in situation where the operator has to continuously hold the control console in hand such as in small hoist, a lower voltage of 110 V, 48 V or 24 V is used. Electro-magnetic devices such as contactors, relays, solenoids etc., are manufactured in these standard control voltage ratings. The disadvantages of using low control voltage is that the cross-section of control wire increases and hence the cost also increases. The electromagnetic coils of contactors, relays and solenoids pick up above 85% of their rated coil voltage. This provides a higher safe value of operation as burn out of coils may occur above 110% of the rated voltage. These devices have inrush currents of nearly 6 to 9 times the continuous holding current. Both the inrush and holding currents have low power factor. The control transformer design should be such as to provide good regulation under poor power factor loads. It should maintain 95% of the rated secondary voltage at all load to avoid (i) chattering of relays and contactors; (ii) dropping of already energised devices; (iii) failure of solenoids being closed. R Y B N 440 V 440 V 220 V 480V 380V 220V 110V 110V 110V (a) (b) (c) Fig. 2.43 Control transformer connections (a) Primary winding with tappings (b) Two primary windings connected in series (c) Two primary windings connected in parallel Control transformers are generally of two types. First type is the simple one having one primary winding and one secondary winding with no tappings. To use the transformer at various supply voltage the primary winding is to have tappings. For example, a typical control transformer will have tappings at the primary winding at 440, 415, 380, 230, 200 V, while the secondary may have only one winding giving constant voltage. The number of turns upto 440 V dharm d:N-MachMac2-3.pm5 54
  • 72. CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS 55 tapping will be double the number than at 220 V tapping, thereby keeping the ratio of voltage per turn the same whether the tappings are connected to 440 V or 220 V. As the volt/turn remains same we get constant voltage on secondary side. The second type of control transformer known as Dual primary type is the most widely used control tansformer. It has got two identical primary windings and one secondary windings. In India we have three phase supply system of 415 V line to line and 240 V line of neutral (declared voltage by the supply authorities at Consumers’ end) with ± 6% variation. The primary of a dual transformer can be connected across line to line (415 V) if the two primary windings are connected in series (see Fig. 2.43 (b)). In series connection the number of turns on each winding are added together. The transformer primary can be connected across line and neutral (240 V), if the two primary windings are connected in parallel. The effect of connecting two windings of equal number of turns in parallel is the same as connecting only one winding as in Fig. 2.43 (c) because the effective number of turns for determining the turns ratio remains the same. Determination of Rating of Control Transformer The primary voltage of the transformer depends upon the supply voltage available while the secondary voltage depends upon the control circuit application. The voltage ampere rating of the transformer depends upon the continuous holding volt ampere (VA) rating and inrush current rating of various relays, contactors, solenoids and indication lamps to be connected to the transformer secondary. The volt ampere rating of the components are available from the manufacturers literature. The method of finding out the approximatte VA rating of the control transformer is to: (i) Calculate the maximum continuous holding current by adding the holding current of all the coils that will get energised at the same time and then multiplying this amount by a factor of 5/4. (ii) Calculate the total maximum inrush current by adding the inrush current of all the coils that will be energised together at any one time and then multiplying this figure by 1/4. Now taking the larger of the two figures calculated above, multiply this current by the control voltage. This product is the volt ampere (VA) required by the transformer. When it is difficult to find out how many contactors are switched on simultaneously, take 80% of the holding capacity of all contactors and relays. Another simple method for finding out approximate VA rating of the transformer is to make calculations using the following formula: PTR = ΣPh + P1C + ΣPL where, PTR = The nominal power (VA) of the control transformer. ΣPh = The holding apparent power (VA) of all the contactors energised simultaneously. P1C = Inrush apparent power (VA) of the contactor of largest size. ΣPL = Active power of all signal lamps. 2.20 SYMBOLS FOR VARIOUS COMPONENTS Control diagram is the language of control and control circuits. Symbols for various components are the various alphabets of this language. The symbols for various components have been standardised by the Bureau of Indian Standards (BIS). In this book symbols recommended by BIS will be followed. However, in industry one comes across drawings having different symbols as Indian industry imports lot of machinery from outside the country. To make the students familiar with these alternate symbols some control circuits will be discussed using the Amercian dharm d:N-MachMac2-3.pm5 55
  • 73. 56 CONTROL OF MACHINES and British standard symbols. Once an engineer is able to read and interpret the drawings, difference in symbol representation does not pose much problem as most of the drawings carry a key to various symbols at the bottom of the drawings in tabular form. We have already studied symbols for various components while studying about the components. Now all those symbols for various components have been compiled in a tabular form for ready reference as in Table 5. 2.21 CONTROL DIAGRAMS As discussed earlier the control diagram is the language of controls and control circuits. In a control diagram is hidden the logic of the control, which can be decoded only if the reader is familiar with various control symbols and knows how to read the drawing. A good control diagram is that which any control engineer will be able to read even if he is not associated with the design of the circuit. To understand the working of control circuit, first one should get familiar with the various operations required from that control i.e., the machine operations. The same knowledge is required when one has to design a control circuit for some machine. Before the various types of control diagram are discussed, the following points which are building blocks in the development of a control diagram may be gone through. (i) All control components like contactors, relays, push buttons, etc., are designated by some alphabets. The alphabet is generally the first alphabet of the operation obtained by energisation of that particular contactor or relay. For example in forward and reversing of a motor the starter has two contactors one for forward motion and another for reverse motion. In control diagram the contactor responsible for forward motion is designated by letter F i.e., the starting letter of the word forward and reverse contactor is designated by the letter R. In most of the drawings this procedure of designating the components is followed. (ii) All contacts of various contactors and relays shown in the diagram are for the coils in the de-energised state. The normally closed contact of contactor will open and normally open contact will close when that particular contactor is energised. (iii) The various contacts of a particular contactor are designated by numerals. For ex- ample various contacts of a contactor F will be represented as F1, F2, F3, F4, in the control circuit. (iv) The control wires are also designated with numbers in the diagram. These numbers are also actually marked on the wires by inserting numbering ferrules on the wires. Numbers of wires in the drawing makes the initial wiring easy and it also helps in tracing of wires during trouble shooting. The general trend is to mark the two supply leads from control trans- former as L1 and L2, L2 is generally grounded and L1 acts as the phase supply for control circuit. L1 is connected to a control fuse. After the control fuse the supply wire is marked as 1 and the neutral as 0. The other wires following from components and connected to supply wire no. 1 are marked 2, 3, 4 etc. We will now discuss the three types of control diagrams in general use. These three types of diagrams are: (a) Wiring diagram (b) Elementary line diagram or Schematic diagram (c) Wireless connection diagram In a wiring diagram various components are shown exactly according to their physical relationship and location in the panel. Components are represented by their standard symbols along with their terminals on it. A wire between two terminals is represented by a line. dharm d:N-MachMac2-3.pm5 56
  • 74. CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS 57 Table 5 Symbols for Control Components S.No. Name of Component Symbol S.No. Name of Component Symbol 1 Crossing of 21 On-Delay Relay Conductors Contacts 2 Joint or Junction of 22 Off-delay Relay Conductors Contacts 3 Earth / Ground 23 Contactor or Relay Coil 4 Chassis 24 Make Contact Normally Open (NO) 5 Indication Lamp 25 Break Contact 6 Resistor R Normally Closed(NC) 7 Variable Resistor R 26 Limit Switch 8 Capacitor 27 Selector Switch 2-Position 9 Fuse 28 Selector Switch 3-Position 10 Switch 29 Selector Switch 2-Position Double Break 11 Switch Fuse Unit 30 Selector Switch On Off Off 3-Position Double Break 12 Three Pole Switch 31 Circuit Breaker 13 On Push Button 32 Solenoid Valve Single A BA B Acting PT P T 14 Off push Button 33 Solenoid Valve V AB A B V 15 Pressure Switch Double Acting PTP TPT P Contact 34 Winding 35 Inductor L 16 Thermostat Contact T 36 Solenoid Coil 17 Flow Switch F 18 Thermal Overload 37 Control Transformer Relay 19. Control Contact of Overload 38 Induction Motor 20 Time Delay Relay Single Phase M 1~ (Contd...) dharm d:N-MachMac2-3.pm5 57
  • 75. 58 CONTROL OF MACHINES S.No. Name of Component Symbol S.No. Name of Component Symbol 39 Three phase Squirrel 41 D.C. Shunt Motor M Cage Induction Motor ~ M 3~ 40 Three phase wound 42 D.C. Series Motor M ~ Rotor Induction M Motor 3~ 43 Contactor Representation with Contacts The wiring is represented as it is actually wired in the panel. In other words, a wiring diagram is a drawing of equipments and wires more or less as they should appear on the panel or on the machine. A wiring diagram is useful for initial wiring of the control circuit. It is also helpful in trouble shooting when actual wiring needs to be traced. The wiring diagram of ‘Direct on line starter’ with motor ‘ON’ indication, for a three phase motor is given in Fig. 2.44. Fig. 2.44 Wiring diagram for a direct on line starter dharm d:N-MachMac2-3.pm5 58
  • 76. CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS 59 Let us understand working of the control circuit by tracing the control wires from control fuse onward. The operation required here is only to run the motor by pressing the START- push button and when it is desired to be stopped, it should be by pressing the STOP-push button. This is the simplest control circuit, a little introduction to this direct on line starter was given at the beginning of the text book. If you can understand the circuit it is well and good, if not, let us study the circuit diagram shown in Fig. 2.45 which is the elementary line diagram or more commonly known as the Schematic diagram. Fig. 2.45 Elementary or schematic diagram for a direct on line starter This diagram is a representation of the circuit in its proper electrical sequence. Such a diagram provides easy understanding of working of the circuit. Whenever a control circuit is designed it is done in the schematic diagram form. A brief explanation of this circuit is as follows: All contact positions in this control diagram are in their normal positions meaning that when the coil M is de-energised. In normal position the supply reaches upto wire number 3 through the normally closed contact of overload relay and STOP-push button. When the START- push button is pressed, supply reaches terminal 4 at contactor coil and energises the contactor coil. The main contacts of the contactor close and the motor starts running. At the same time auxiliary contacts M1 and M2 also close. Closing of M1 provides a parallel path across the START-push button. Now, even if START-push button is released, contactor coil remains energised through the closed contact M1. Closed contact M2 energises the indication lamp showing that the motor is ON. Referring back to the wiring diagram it will be observed that the circuit is the same as the schematic diagram but is little difficult to read than the schematic diagram. dharm d:N-MachMac2-3.pm5 59
  • 77. 60 CONTROL OF MACHINES The schematic diagram is simpler as compared to the wiring diagram. As the circuit here is the simplest one, much difficulty may not be faced in reading the wiring diagram. However, for more complicated circuits, the wiring diagram becomes very difficult to read due to large number of wires crossing each other. Another point to observe is that in the schematic diagram the components and their contacts are placed in the sequence of their operation and not according to their physical position as is done in case of a wiring diagram. In a schematic diagram the contacts of a particular contactor or relay will be found scattered in the drawing. In the rest of this text book all control circuits will be discussed in their schematic diagram form due to simplicity in understanding and ease in the development of circuits. The third type of control diagram is the wireless connection diagram. This kind of a diagram is not much used but is drawn in situations where the number of wire connections are large and there is possibility of creating confusion in reading the drawing. Such a wireless diagram for the same motor starter (DOL starter) is shown in Fig. 2.46. Fig. 2.46 Wireless connection diagram for a direct on line starter In this diagram wiring is not shown but the wire numbers are shown on the terminals of the various components. The location of components in the diagram resembles their physical location in the panel (as in case of wiring diagrams). Comparing the wireless diagram with the wiring diagram, it may be observed that a wireless diagram is not at all useful in understanding the circuit. The drawing may however be used for wiring the control circuit when components are fixed in the panel as in the diagram. dharm d:N-MachMac2-3.pm5 60
  • 78. CONTROL CIRCUIT COMPONENTS 61 REVIEW QUESTIONS 1. State the advantage of using a fuse switch unit over a switch and a fuse in series. Discuss the two types of fuse switch units in use. 2. What are the main features of moulded case circuit breakers? What are their advantages over conventional breakers and fuse switch units? 3. Explain with the help of a diagram the working of a solenoid type contactor. 4. Make a labelled diagram for clapper type contactor. Explain the function of its blow out coil. 5. Explain the working of two types of latching relays. Where are these relays used? 6. Discuss the working of a bimetallic type over-load relay. 7. Explain the working principle of eutetic type alloy and magnetic over-load type relays. 8. What is the difference between a ON-delay and OFF-delay timer? How does the contact changeover take place in these timers? 9. Explain with the help of a diagram the working of a pneumatic timer. 10. Explain various forms of synchronous motor timers. 11. Discuss the principle of operation of an electronic timer. 12. Explain the working of phase failure relay which operates on negative sequence components of currents. 13. Explain the function of push button, selector switch, drum switch and limit switch used in con- trol circuits. 14. Mention the types of control diagrams in general use. Explain the use of each of them. 15. Explain why thermal timers are used only in star-delta starters. 16. What is a zero speed switch and where is it used? 17. State the function of differential setting in pressure and temperature switches ? 18. What are the respective temperature ranges for a liquid filled, a gas filled, and a vapour filled thermostats? 19. Explain how you will measure the liquid level in a tank where ice formation takes place in winters. 20. When speaking of current relays, what is meant by pull in current, drop out current and differential current. 21. Explain the purpose of using shading coil on magnetic pole faces of a relay for ac operation. 22. Mention the exact situation where a frequency relay is used. 23. Draw the symbols for permanent magnet type latch relay, ON-delay timer contacts, pressure switch, single acting solenoid valve and three position selector switch. 24. The purpose of quartz and fillers in the fuse is to: (a) increase voltage rating (b) increase current rating (c) increase heat transfer (d) increase weight. 25. Contactor coils are designed to drop the plunger when voltage falls to ______ per cent of rated voltage: (a) 50% (b) 65% (c) 75% (d) 85% 26. Which one of the following timers is the most accurate one ? (a) Thermal timer (b) Electronic timer (c) Synchronous motor timer (d) Pneumatic timer 27. Liquid filled thermostats can measure temperatures in the range of: (a) 50 to 700°F (b) 100 to 100°F (c) 150 to 2200°F dharm d:N-MachMac2-3.pm5 61
  • 79. 62 CONTROL OF MACHINES 28. A pressure transducer consists of (a) pressure switch and a special relay (b) a low resistance coil (c) a semi-conductor strain gauge 29. Material used for contacts of high rating contactor is (a) Copper (b) Silver (c) Silver Nickel (d) Silver Cadmium Oxide 30. The error in synchronous timer is in the range of (a) ± 10% (b) ± 5% (c) ± 3% (d) ± 1% dharm d:N-MachMac2-3.pm5 62
  • 80. ! Starters for 3-Phase Squirrel Cage Motor 3.1 INTRODUCTION Three phase squirrel cage motors are the most widely used motors in industry. About 80% of the motors manufactured are squirrel cage motors. Simplicity, ruggedness and reliability of such a motor make it the standard choice for alternating current, all purpose, constant speed applications. These motors are less expensive, require less maintenance than dc motors of equal kilowatt rating and speed. Before discussing the various types of starters for this motor, brief description of characteristics of this type of motor is included as follows: A squirrel cage induction motor consists of a frame, a stator and a rotor. The stator or the stationary portion carries the three stator windings. The rotor consists of cylindrical member made of steel laminations mounted rigidly on the motor shaft. The rotor winding consists of copper or aluminium bars fitted into slots in the rotor member. The bars are shorted at each end by a closed continuous ring. This assembly of bars and end rings looks like a squirrel cage and this similarity has given the motor its name. When a three phase supply is given to the three stator windings a resultant magnetic field is set up which revolves around the rotor. The resultant magnetic field revolves around at a speed given by equation, 120 f Ns = p where Ns = Speed in revolutions of the magnetic field f = Supply frequency p = Number of stator poles for which the stator winding is made. The minimum number of poles for a winding can be two. Thus, at 50 Hz supply the maximum speed of revolution of the field is 3000 r.p.m. For a 4 pole machine it would be 1500 r.p.m. This revolving field cuts the rotor bars and induce current in them. The induced current in the rotor produces its own magnetic field. The stator magnetic field and rotor magnetic field interact and the rotor magnetic field follows the stator magnetic field thereby establishing a torque on the motor shaft. The current in the rotor is maximum at standstill (when the rotor is stationary, emf induced in the standstill rotor is maximum). As the motor picks up speed, the rotor current decreases as the relative speed between the rotating field produced by the stator and rotor 63
  • 81. 64 CONTROL OF MACHINES speed decreases. The torque speed characteristic of a typical squirrel cage motor is shown in Fig. 3.1. 2 1 Torque T1 N3 N2 N1 Ns Speed Fig. 3.1 Torque speed characteristic of a three-phase induction motor This characteristic remains fixed for a particular rotor design. The characteristic can be changed by making changes in the rotor resistance and reactance. 3.1.1 Motor Current at Start and During Acceleration At standstill when voltage is applied to the stator winding, the rotor winding acts like a short circuited secondary of a transformer. The secondary current and thus in turn the primary current drawn by stator winding from supply is large. The starting current may be as high as 4.5 to 6 times the full load current of the motor depending upon the motor characteristics. As the motor accelerates, the current goes on decreasing but at a slow rate. The current decays sharply when motor reaches near its rated speed. Fig. 3.2 shows the current versus speed characteristic of an induction motor. 6 Current in terms of full load current 4 2 IFL 50% 80% 100% Speed Fig. 3.2 Current drawn by a three phase induction motor during starting As shown in Fig. 3.2 upto 50% of the rated speed the current drawn remains approximately 6 times the full load current. When motor reaches about 80% of the rated speed dharm d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5 64
  • 82. STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR 65 the decline in the current is very fast. The motor heating rate is proportional to I2R (copper- loss). Thus the rate of heating of the motor is high during acceleration. 3.1.2 No-load Speed and Final Speed of Motor On no-load motor accelerates until the necessary speed is reached to overcome windage and friction losses. This speed is very near to the synchronous speed which is the speed of the revolving magnetic field. The motor, however, never reaches synchronous speed, since then a current will not be induced in the rotor and the motor will not produce any torque. Refer Fig. 3.1 for a motor with a particular characteristic designated as 1, the no-load speed is shown as N1. When the motor is loaded, speed adjusts itself to the point where the force exerted by the magnetic field on rotor is sufficient to overcome the torque required by the load. In Fig. 3.1 say for torque requirement of T, the motor will run at speed N2. The difference between the speed of magnetic field (synchronous speed) and rotor is known as slip. The slip in the first case is Ns – N1 and in the second case it is Ns – N2. The slip is also generally expressed as percentage of the synchronous speed. the percentage slip for the above two cases then becomes, N s − N1 % slip (No-load) = × 100 Ns N s − N2 % slip (On-load) = × 100 Ns With the same load requirement if the characteristic of motor is changed to the characteristic designated as 2 (see Fig. 3.1), it is seen that the motor will run at a speed of N3 . From the above it follows that the slip necessary to carry the full load depends upon the characteristic of the motor. As mentioned earlier the characteristic of motor depends on reactance and resistance of the rotor. The slip of the motor varies also with variation in line voltage. An increase in line voltage causes a decrease in the slip (i.e., motor runs at higher speed) and a decrease in line voltage causes an increase in the slip. In either case sufficient current is induced in the rotor to carry the load. For a particular load on motor, when line voltage decreases the rotor current and hence the line current increases to produce the same torque. This causes increase in the heating At voltage rated voltage At rated voltage At voltage Torque rated voltage N3 N2 N1 Ns Speed Fig. 3.3 Variation of slip with variation of line voltage for an induction motor dharm d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5 65
  • 83. 66 CONTROL OF MACHINES of the motor. On the other hand increase in line voltage decreases the rotor current and also the line current and there is decrease in heating. In other words the motors can carry a larger load. The slip at rated load may vary from 3 per cent to 20 per cent for different types of motors. The variation of slip at a particular load for different voltages is shown graphically in Fig. 3.3. Observe that variation in slip is very small. 3.1.3 Starting of Motor A motor may be required to start on no-load or on full load depending upon the machinery to which it is connected. Many industrial applications require a machine to be started at no-load, while some machines may require starting at its full-rated load. In the first case during no- load starting motor needs only a small torque to overcome the starting inertia. In the second case the motor starting torque should be enough to start with the normal load against the starting inertia. The most common method of starting of poly-phase squirrel cage motor is to connect the motor directly to the main supply through a manual or magnetic starter. At starting, the inrush current is high but due to this high current a high starting torque is developed, which accelerate the motor quickly to its final speed. As the accelerating rate is fast the I2R heating time in the motor is small. This starting method is however used only for small motors upto 5 hp. Higher capacity motors are generally started at a reduced voltage for the following two reasons: (i) The high starting current drawn from the main supply is objectionable to the supply authorities as it causes heavy line voltage drops which adversely effects the per- formance of other loads connected to the system. The supply authorities, therefore, impose restriction on the industries not to start large motors directly from supply. Consider a 415 V, 50 hp motor whose full load current is about 70 amps. The motor if started direct-from main supply will draw a current of about 6 × 70 = 420 A. Thus it is apparent that such a high current will disturb the supply network system. The motors are therefore recommended to be started at a lower voltage so that the inrush current drawn from supply is lower. The voltage, however, can be reduced upto a certain level as, lowering of voltage also lowers the starting torque. (as T ∝ V 2). To start a motor from standstill, certain minimum starting torque is required depending upon the load on the motor. For motors which have to start on full-load the supply authorities allows the direct on line starting, provided the peak current is drawn in steps so that the rate of rise of current/sec is reduced. The purpose is to enable the automatic voltage regulators provided in the supply system to have sufficient time to adjust system voltage due to peak currents drawn. (ii) The second reason for starting motors on reduced voltage may be to obtain low starting torque. This may be desired in certain machinery where full voltage starting torque applied suddenly may cause machinery to get damaged due to sudden jerk. The sudden application of high torque may cause wear or damage of gears, chains or couplings. The belts may slip and the material being processed on conveyors may get damaged. It thus follows that squirrel cage motors are usually to be started at a reduced voltage. The desired result may be either reduced current drawn from supply to avoid disturbance in dharm d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5 66
  • 84. STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR 67 the supply system or reduced torque to avoid jerk. The reduced voltage at the motor terminals can be applied by using different types of starters. Different types of reduced voltage starter used are: (i) Resistance reduced voltage starter; (ii) Increment resistance starter; (iii) Reactance reduced voltage starter; (iv) Auto transformer reduced voltage starter; (v) Part winding reduced voltage starter; (vi) Star delta starter. Detailed description on all these starters are included in the next section. It is very important to understand the behaviour of an induction motor during the start up and acceleration periods. Such an understanding would enable one to select the proper starting method to confirm to local supply authorities regulation. Though several starting methods may appear suitable for a particular motor application, a careful examination of the specific application will lead to the selection of the best method of starting. 3.2 PRIMARY RESISTOR TYPE STARTERS This is a simple and common method of starting a motor at reduced voltage. When motor is first started, a line resistance is inserted in the motor circuit. Voltage drop takes place across the resistor and reduced voltage is applied at the motor terminals. As the motor accelerates, the current drawn by motor reduces and therefore less voltage drop takes place across the resistor and more voltage is available at the motor terminals. Thus a smooth acceleration is obtained with gradually increasing voltage and torque. The resistance is disconnected when the motor reaches near its rated speed and full line voltage appears across the motor terminals. The purpose of inserting resistance during starting is two fold. On one hand it reduces the inrush current of the motor which may be objectionable to the supply authorities as it would cause a high line voltage drop. Secondly, reduced voltage applied to the motor at start provides a reduced starting torque which prevents damage to the driven machinery, avoiding a sudden jerk. The value of resistance connected should, however, be so selected that besides limiting the current inrush the motor should be able to develop sufficient torque to start from standstill. The resistance type starters are used for small horse power rating motors where main consideration is limiting the starting torque to avoid damage to the connected machinery rather than controlling the line voltage drop. These starters also have a low starting economy because the starting resistors dissipate electrical energy. Depending upon the equipment and arrangement, these starters may be manually operated or may be semi-automatic or automatic. The various types of resistance starters are discussed as follows: 3.2.1 Manual Primary Resistor Type Starter Manual starters use Master switches or Drum controllers for connecting the motor terminals to supply. Master switch used for this starter has three positions of the operating handle i.e., OFF-START-RUN. In OFF-position all contacts are open. In START-position only start contacts are closed and in RUN-position both Start and Run contacts are closed. Fig. 3.4 shows the manual starter scheme for single step resistance. In the OFF-position of Master switch all the contacts S1, S2, S3 and R1, R2 and R3 are open. When the drum controller handle is brought to START-position contacts S1, S2 and S3 close as denoted by × in Fig. 3.4 (b). dharm d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5 67
  • 85. 68 CONTROL OF MACHINES Fig. 3.4 Manual primary resistor type starter The motor starts with resistance in the circuit. When the motor picks up speed the master switch handle is brought to RUN-position by the operator, contacts R1, R2, R3 also close and they short circuit the line resistances and the motor gets directly connected to the supply. Master switch handle is held in the RUN-position by an electro-magnet shown in the diagram as under-voltage (latch) relay UV. This relay coil is connected through STOP-push button and over-load relay contact across two supply lines. Whenever the over-load relay trips or power fails, the coil is de-energised and the Master switch handle is released, which falls back to OFF-position. The switch is also released when voltage falls below a certain value thus giving under voltage protection to the motor. The operation of this starter depends upon the skill of the operator. The time gap between START and RUN-position may be varied by the operator to suit the particular load requirement of the motor. The motor current versus time characteristic during starting is shown in Fig. 3.5. The motor current versus time characteristic is shown by a dotted line when the motor is started direct ON-line. The starting current has been taken as six times the full load current of the motor. The motor current versus time characteristic with resistance in circuit has been shown through a continuous line as shown in Fig. 3.5. The current has been shown reduced to four times the full-load current. The motor current follows the path parallel to dotted line but at a reduced level. At time t1, when motor has reached near its normal speed, the resistance is cut off from the circuit and full supply voltage gets applied to the motor terminals. At this time there is sudden inrush of current as shown in the figure. Afterwards, the motor follows the upper curve and runs at its rated speed. dharm d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5 68
  • 86. STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR 69 6 Starting current 4 2 Full load current t1 Time Fig. 3.5 Motor starting current versus time in primary resistor type starter 3.2.2 Semi-automatic Stepless Resistance Starter This is another type of line resistance reduced voltage starter which gives stepless decrease of line resistance. In this, resistors are made up of stacks of specially treated graphite discs placed in steel tubes. The inside surface of steel tubes are lined with insulating refractory material. When a mechanical force is applied to the columns of graphite discs through a manually operated handle the discs are compressed. The compressing of the discs reduces air gap between the discs and thereby resistance is decreased. As the pressure on the top of discs is increased the resistance decreases gradually (steplessely). These types of units provide a wide range of variation of resistance and in addition have good heat dissipating capacity. This type of starter can therefore be employed for squirrel cage motors upto 200 hp. The starter consists of a steel cabinet which houses the resistor units, contactors, over-load devices and control contacts L1 P L2 Stop L3 R1 S1 S r S¢ R s S R N (b) r r r s¢ s¢ s¢ s s s M Off position Start position Run position 3~ (a) (c) Fig. 3.6 Semi-automatic stepless resistance starter (a) Power diagram (b) Control diagram (c) Control contacts of operating lever dharm d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5 69
  • 87. 70 CONTROL OF MACHINES associated with the operating lever. The operating lever is provided outside the enclosure which apply varying equalised pressure to the stacks of graphite disc when moved from OFF- position to RUN-position. Diagram showing wire connections for the starter is shown in Fig. 3.6. When the operating lever is in the OFF-position both contactors S and R are de- energised. To start the motor lever is raised quickly to START-position where pilot control contacts s′ and s close and contactor S is energised. Its main contacts close and energise motor terminals through the graphite resistance disc tubes and thus a reduced voltage is applied to the motor terminals. As the motor accelerates, operating lever (handle) is moved up from the START-position toward RUN-position. This movement of handle applies equally increasing pressure on the graphite disc in the tubes and thus resistance gets reduced uniformly and steplessly. When the lever reaches the end of its travel i.e., to RUN-position, contact is made between s′ and r. This leads to energisation of contactor R. Contactor R then gets hold on through its own contact R1. The main contacts of contactor R close and thereby by-pass the resistors. Once the contactor R is energised, the handle can be dropped down to the OFF-position which de-energises contactor S. The motor can be stopped by pressing the STOP-push button. In case of over-loading the over-load relay control contact opens and de-energises contactor R. 3.2.3 Automatic Primary Resistor Type Starter This starter also has two contactors marked START and RUN as in the case of semi-automatic starter. Here, the time gap between closing of start contactor and run contactor is controlled automatically with the help of an electrical timer. The time can be adjusted as per requirement. The power and control diagram for the starter is shown in Fig. 3.7. (a) dharm d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5 70
  • 88. STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR 71 CR2 P R1 TR1 R2 OFF CR1 ON CR S TR R N (b) Fig. 3.7 Automatic primary resistor type starter (a) Power diagram (b) Control diagram When ON-push button is pressed the control relay CR gets energised and is held energised through its contact CR1, the over-load relay contact being in closed condition. Normally open contact CR2 also closes and energises the rest of control circuit. Closing of CR2 energises contactor S and the time delay relay TR through normally closed contact R1 of contactor R. Energisation of contactor S causes the main contacts to close and the motor starts running with resistance connected in series with the supply lines [see Fig. 3.7 (a)]. When the time delay relay TR operates after a pre-set time, its delayed contact TR1 closes and thereby energises the run contactor R. Contactor R remains energised by getting supply through its own contact R2. Closing of contactor R short circuits the resistances and the motor gets supply through the closed contacts of contactor R. The energisation of contactor R causes switching off of start contactor S and time delay relay TR. De-energisation of contactor S disconnects resistors from main supply. Also opening of delayed contact TR1 of time delay relay TR does not effect the working of the run contactor as it is now held through its own contact. The time set on the time delay relay determines the acceleration time of the motor with resistors in circuit. This time can be increased or decreased depending upon the load on the machines. 3.3 INCREMENT RESISTANCE STARTER In increment resistance starter the resistance connected in the motor circuit is cut off in steps. The motor starts only when all the resistances have been cut off and motor gets connected to full supply voltage and draws the normal direct on line current, which is about six times the full load current. At this point one may wonder, that what is then the need for inserting resistance in the circuit and cut it off in increments till the motor again gets connected to supply ! This starter is used for large motors which require high starting torque to start from standstill. A reduced inrush current cannot start these motors from standstill. The current required for starting such motors is the direct on line current. However, if this large current is drawn by connecting the motor directly to supply, the supply network gets unstable. The voltage regulators connected in the network cannot correct the voltage drop due to this sudden heavy current drawn from supply. In order to allow time for the voltage regulators to correct the system network voltage, the direct on line inrush current from the supply is drawn in two or three steps with certain fixed time delays. This time delay after each current inrush allows the voltage regulators to adjust the network voltage. This would become more clear when we look dharm d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5 71
  • 89. 72 CONTROL OF MACHINES at the motor current versus time characteristic of this increment resistance starter as shown in Fig. 3.8. 6 Third step run Current in terms of full load current 4 Second step start 2 First step start t1 t2 Time Fig. 3.8 Current versus time characteristic of an increment resistance starter When motor is first switched ON, the current drawn from supply is 2 times the full load current and the motor does not start up as the starting torque developed is not sufficient to pull the motor from standstill. After time t1, some resistance is cut out from the motor circuit and as a consequence another inrush of current takes place. The current drawn becomes 4 times the full load current but even then the motor is not able to pull from standstill. After another gap of t2 – t1 seconds the rest of the resistance is cut off and the motor gets directly connected to supply. Now the current inrush reaches 6 times the full load and motor develops sufficient starting torque to start from standstill. Beyond this time the current time curve follows the direct on line starting current as shown in Fig. 3.8. Thus it is seen that although the current drawn from supply is high, rate of rise of current is reduced very much to allow system voltage regulators to adjust for the increase of current from the network. The power circuit and the control circuit for this type of a starter are shown in Fig. 3.9. Referring to the power circuit it is seen that when contactor 1S closes, the motor gets connected to supply with full line resistances. When contactor 2S is energised half of the resistance is by-passed and when the contactor R closes, the whole of the resistances is by- passed and the motor terminals get connected to full supply voltage. Let us see how this operation is accomplished through the control circuit. When the ON-push button is pressed, control relay CR gets energised and is held through its own contact CR1. It’s another contact CR2 energises the rest of the control circuit. Contactor 1S and timer 1T gets energised through the normally closed contact R1 of the contactor R. Energisation of contactor 1S connects motor terminal to supply through the resistance. When timer 1T times out (say in 5 secs), its delayed contact 1T1 closes and energises contactor 2S and the coil of timer 2T. Energisation of contactor 2S, closes its main contacts and half of the resistance is cut off from the motor circuit. After 5 secs the timer 2T also operates and its delayed contact 2T1 closes and energises the coil of the run contactor R. Run contactor immediately gets held through its own contact R2. The normally closed contact R1 of contactor R is now open which de-energises contactor 1S, 2S and timers 1T and 2T. The RUN contactor R, however, remains energised through its own contact and the motor runs by getting supply directly from the mains, the resistances being by-passed. dharm d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5 72
  • 90. STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR 73 Fig. 3.9 Increment resistance starter (a) Power diagram (b) Control diagram 3.4 LINE-REACTOR REDUCED VOLTAGE STARTER A line-reactor reduced voltage starter works on the same principle as the line resistance starter, however, it is used for comparatively high voltage or high current installations where resistors dharm d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5 73
  • 91. 74 CONTROL OF MACHINES become bulky and heat dissipation is a problem. Like a line resistor starter, a reactor starter is also preferred where emphasis is on getting a lower starting torque than on reduction in starting current. Where reduction in starting current is the main consideration, autotransformer starters are preferred. The disadvantage of reactor type starter is that the starting power factor is low which tends to increase the line regulation. Line reactors used consists of coils wound on three legged core. Standard tappings give 50%, 65% and 80% of the supply voltage at the motor terminals. Special care has to be taken while designing the core so that core does not saturate during the period of acceleration. If the core saturates during acceleration period the reactance becomes dφ low (reactance, which depends upon , is small when the core is saturated), and the starting di current drawn by the motor becomes high. The power circuit for the starter is shown in Fig. 3.10. The control circuit is the same as that drawn for a line resistor starter as shown in Fig. 3.7 (b). In Fig. 3.10, 50% tapping has been used. When contactor S is energised the whole of the reactor winding gets connected in circuit and thus 50% of the supply voltage gets applied across the motor terminals. For getting 65% or 80% of the supply voltage the motor terminals are to be connected at 65% or 80% tapping terminals on the reactor. The working of the control circuit is the same as that of the resistance starter already explained. As this type of starter is L1 L2 L3 Overload relay S S S S R R R R 80% 80% 80% 65% 65% 65% 50% 50% 50% M 3~ Fig. 3.10 Power circuit for a line-reactor reduced voltage starter dharm d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5 74
  • 92. STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR 75 used for large motors, the over-load relay is to be connected through current transformer as has been shown in Fig. 3.10. A manual reactor starter will be controlled by a master-switch or a drum controller as explained in case of a manual primary resistor type starter in section 3.2.1. 3.5. AUTO-TRANSFORMER REDUCED VOLTAGE STARTERS This type of starters use an auto-transformer between the motor and the supply lines to reduce starting current of the motor. Taps are provided on the auto-transformer to select 50%, 65%, 80% of the line voltage for starting. The advantage of this starter is that for the same starting torque to be developed, the line current drawn from supply is less than that in case of resistance and reactance starters. For example for starting voltages of 50%, 65% and 80% line currents will respectively be 25, 42 and 64 per cent of the full-voltage values. Because of high cost of auto-transformer starters, they are used for large motors only. An auto-transformer being an inductive load, the power-factor of the total load circuit during starting is low. Auto-transformer starters are of two types: (i) open circuit transition type; and (ii) closed circuit transition type. As observed in the resistance and reactance starters, after the motor has picked up speed, run contactor is energised and then immediately afterwards start contactor is de-energised. In this sequence, when motor shifts from start to run mode, the motor terminals do not get disconnected from supply. This way of energising the contactors is known as closed circuit transition. The other way of switching the contactors is to ensure that the start contactor is de-energised first and immediately afterwards the run contactor is energised. In this case, for a small gap of time between the opening of start contactor and closing of run contactor, the motor terminals get disconnected from supply, the rotor continues rotating and, therefore, emf is induced in the motor stator windings due to rotor flux. Now when the stator is energised by closing the run contactor with full line voltage, in certain conditions, the polarity of generated voltage and the supply voltage may be additive to give a high inrush current which may be harmful to the motor. This type of starting is known as open circuit transition. Now the question arises if open circuit transition is not desirable then why use it at all ! The reason is that open circuit transition starting for auto-transformer starter and star-delta starters are widely used due to economical reason. Closed circuit transition in case of auto- transformer and star-delta starter is not easily obtained as in the case of resistance and reactance starters. This will become clear when we discuss these two types of starters. Closed circuit transition starters are used for motors of very large ratings only. Auto-transformer power connections for open circuit transition: The usual practice is to construct a 3-phase auto-transformer with two tapped windings around the outer legs of a three legged core and connect the coils in open delta as shown in Fig. 3.11 (a). In this connection however due to internal impedance drops, the voltages at motor terminals are unbalanced and thus starting torque developed is relatively low. Where relatively high starting torques are required, auto-transformers with three coil construction are used. The power circuits in Fig. 3.11 (b) shows the three winding auto-transformer connections. From Fig. 3.11 (a) it is clear that reduced voltage is applied between terminal T2 – T1 and T2 – T3. In three winding connections, reduced voltage from tapping is applied to all the three motor terminals. dharm d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5 75
  • 93. 76 CONTROL OF MACHINES L1 L2 L3 L1 L2 L3 T1 T2 T3 M M 3~ 3~ (a) (b) Fig. 3.11 Two winding and three winding auto-transformer connections 3.5.1 Manual Auto-transformer Starter A commonly used manual auto-transformer starter consists of a three legged laminated core around the outer two legs of which are placed the coils. Each coil is tapped at approximately 50, 65 and 80 per cent from one end. As starting torque of a motor is proportional to the square of the applied voltage, connection at 50, 65 and 80 per cent tapping will therefore yield starting torques of 25, 42 and 64 per cent of the full-voltage starting torque. Thus for a motor which develops starting torque of 1.5 times the full load torque (1.5 TFL ), the starting torques of 0.38 TFL, 0.63 TFL and 0.96 TFL respectively can be obtained by using the above mentioned tappings. These values of torques are usually sufficient to start with loads in most of the cases. The starter connections are shown in Fig. 3.12. Connections of the motor to the supply lines are made through two sets of contacts, namely, START (S) and RUN (R). These contacts belong to the Master Switch which is operated by a handle. When the handle of the Master switch is in OFF-position, all the S and R contacts are open. When the handle is brought up towards START-position, all the five S contacts close. Contacts S1 to S5 connect the auto-transformer to line in open delta. As contacts R1 to R3 are open, the voltage across the motor terminals is 50% of the supply voltage as shown in Fig. 3.12. When the motor picks up sufficient speed the handle is moved over to RUN-position. As the handle leaves the START-position, first the S contacts will open and after a split of a second the R contact will close. Closing of contacts R1 to R3 will connect the motor terminals directly to full supply voltage. The master switch handle is held in the RUN-position by an electromagnet, the coil of which is shown in the figure as under voltage relay UV. As in the case of primary resistor type of starter here also the coil is connected in series with a STOP-push button and an over-load relay contact. When there is over-load or voltage dip or when the STOP-push button is pressed, the under voltage relay coil is de-energised leading to the release of the handle. When the handle of the switch is released the switch falls back to the OFF-position. dharm d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5 76
  • 94. STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR 77 L1 L2 L3 Stop UV S1 S2 S3 R1 R2 R3 80% 80% 65% 65% 50% 50% S4 S5 M 3~ Fig. 3.12 Manual auto-transformer starter connections 3.5.2 Automatic Auto-transformer Starter (Open Circuit Transition) In automatic starter, the transition from start to run condition takes place automatically with the help of a timer. The motor is connected to the lines through contactors as shown in power diagram shown in Fig. 3.13 (a). The control circuit diagram has been shown in Fig. 3.13 (b). Four main contacts of start contactor (S) have been used to connect the auto-transformer windings in open delta. As the starter shown is for a large motor, motor has been connected to supply through, circuit breaker and magnetic overload relay. When the start contactor is energised, contacts S4 and S5 connect the transformer windings to neutral points. At the same time closing of contacts S1, S2 and S3 causes supply of reduced voltage from the transformer taps to the motor terminals. The motor accelerates at this reduced voltage. After the motor reaches near its final speed, if contactor R is energised keeping contactor S ON, a circulating current will flow in the auto-transformer windings between the transformer taps and neutral points, causing severe over heating of the transformer windings. Heavy mechanical stresses produced will also be harmful to the windings. Thus the design is such that contactor R cannot be energised unless contactor S is open. This however dharm d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5 77
  • 95. 78 CONTROL OF MACHINES Fig. 3.13 Automatic auto-transformer starter: (a) Power circuit (b) Control circuit will be an open circuit transition and a transient inrush current may flow into the motor. Opening of contactor S first and then energisation of contactor R is accomplished with the help of a control circuit shown in Fig. 3.13 (b). On pressing the ON-push button, the control relay CR is energised and the contactor S gets energised through normally closed delayed contact dharm d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5 78
  • 96. STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR 79 TR1 of timer TR. Timer TR coil is energised through closed contact S6 of the contactor S and gets hold through its own instantaneous contact. The operating time of timer TR determines the accelerating time for the motor. When after a pre-set time the timer TR operates, its normally closed contact TR1 opens and normally open contact TR2 closes. Opening of contact TR1 de-energises contactor S. Due to de-energisation of the contactor its auxiliary contact S6 opens and S7 closes. Opening of S6 has no effect on timer TR while closing of S7 causes energisation of the run contactor R through the closed contact TR2 of the timer. The motor runs on full voltage when the run contactor gets energised after a pre-set time from the instant of starting of the motor. The motor starting current versus time characteristic during the starting is shown in Fig. 3.14. 6 Starting current 4 2 t1 t2 Time Fig. 3.14 Motor starting current in open-circuit transition The dotted line in Fig. 3.14 shows the direct on line characteristic while the full line shows the current with auto-transformer in the circuit. At time t1 the start contactor is opened and at time t2 the run contactor is closed. For a time gap t2 – t1 the motor winding is disconnected from the supply. During this period a voltage is generated in the motor winding due to rotor flux. At t2 when run contactor is energised the induced voltage and supply voltage may get superimposed to give a high transient current of short duration which may be higher than even the direct on line starting current. In case the motor requires a large starting torque, three winding auto-transformer connection may be used. In this case a start contactor having six main contacts will be required. The power connection will be as shown in Fig. 3.15 on next page. The control circuit will however remain same as discussed earlier. 3.5.3 Auto-Transformer Voltage Starter (Closed Circuit Transition) Closed circuit transition operation requires two starting contactors, both having three poles. The contacts used are as shown in Fig. 3.16. Contacts of contactor 1S are used for the neutral of the auto-transformer windings. Contactor 2S connects the transformer windings to the supply. When contactors 1S and 2S are closed, the transformer is energised from the supply. Reduced voltage from the tapping A, B and C is available at the motor terminals. After the motor picks up sufficient speed contactor 1S is first de-energised. Auto-transformer neutral connection gets disconnected. The motor dharm d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5 79
  • 97. 80 CONTROL OF MACHINES L1 L2 L3 R R R R S S S S S S S M 3~ Fig. 3.15 Power connection with three winding auto-transformers remains connected to mains through contacts of contactor 2S and the transformer acts as a reactance in the motor circuit. Next, the run contactor R is energised which by-passes the reactance and connects the motor directly to the supply. Thus, it is seen that the motor gets connected to full supply without getting disconnected from the supply. This avoids the sudden inrush of current as experienced by motor windings in open circuit transition. The control circuit for an auto-transformer reduced voltage starter in closed circuit transition is shown in Fig. 3.17. When by pressing ON-push button the control circuit is energised, the contactor 1S gets energised through normally closed delayed contacts of timer 1TR and simultaneously the coil of timer 1TR is also energised. Closing of contactor 1S also causes closing of contactor 2S through its auxiliary contact 1S1 and normally closed delayed contact of timer 2TR. Contactor 2S is held through its auxiliary contact 2S1. When timer 1TR times out, the NC contact 1TR1 opens and NO contact 1TR2 closes. Opening of 1TR1 causes de-energisation of contactor 1S. When contactor 1S is open, its auxiliary contact 1S2 closes and thus contactor R gets energised. Alongwith contactor R, timer 2TR is also energised. When timer 2TR operates, its delayed contact which is in series with coil of contactor 2S, opens and de-energises the contactor 2S. De-energisation of 2S disconnects the windings of the transformer which were acting as reactance. The motor now runs directly from the supply. The starting current versus time characteristic for closed circuit transition is shown in Fig. 3.18. dharm d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5 80
  • 98. STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR 81 Fig. 3.16 Auto-transformer reduced voltage starter for closed circuit transition CR2 P OFF 1TR1 1S1 2S1 1S2 CR1 ON 2TR1 1TR2 CR 1S 1TR 2S R 2TR N Fig. 3.17 Control circuit for closed circuit transition dharm d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5 81
  • 99. 82 CONTROL OF MACHINES 6 Starting current 4 2 IFL t1 t2 Time Fig. 3.18 Motor starting current in closed circuit transition As seen from Fig. 3.18, two small inrush of currents take place at time t1 and time t2. First inrush at t1 takes place when motor gets disconnected from transformer tappings and runs with reactor in the circuit. Second inrush at t2 takes place when reactor is by-passed due to energisation of the Run contactor. After that, motor characteristic follows the original direct on line current path. When this characteristic is compared with open circuit transition characteristic of Fig. 3.14, it is quite evident that high inrush current experienced in the former is eliminated in this circuit. 3.6 PART WINDING MOTOR STARTER Part winding starters are used with squirrel cage motors having two separate and parallel stator windings. Large motors can be built with three parallel windings also. The windings may be star connected or delta connected depending upon the design of the motor. Part winding motors are used to drive centrifugal loads such as fans, blowers or centrifugal pumps. These motors can also be used for other loads requiring low starting torque. In cases where the motor is started with only one winding, the starting current drawn from line is reduced. When started on one winding the motor draws approximately two thirds of the normal starting current and develops approximately one half of the normal direct on line starting torque. It may however be clearly understood here that if the motor is connected to a heavy inertia load, the starter would work as incremental starting device. The motor will not begin to accelerate until the second winding is connected. The advantages of the part winding starters are: (i) It is less expensive than other reduced voltage starters using resistors, reactors and transformers; (ii) It requires only two contactors having half the rating of the full-load rating of the motor; (iii) The starter provides closed circuit transition. The disadvantage of part winding starting are: (i) The starting torque is fixed and is low; (ii) Neither of the two windings has thermal capacity to operate along for more than a few seconds. Thus, this type of starting is unsuitable for high inertia loads where starting time is long. dharm d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5 82
  • 100. STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR 83 Part-winding starter may be of the following two types, namely: (i) Two-step starting, and (ii) Three-step starting. 3.6.1 Two Step Starting In two step starting, two contactors control the two windings of the motor. Refer power and control circuit diagrams shown in Fig. 3.19. L1 L2 L3 S R OL1 OL2 T1 T4 T2 T5 T3 T6 (a) CR2 P OFF ON CR1 TR1 CR S TR R N (b) Fig. 3.19 Two step starting circuits for induction motors (a) Power circuit diagram; (b) Control circuit diagram dharm d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5 83
  • 101. 84 CONTROL OF MACHINES When the ON-push button is pressed, the control relay, CR is energised which inturn energises contactor S and timer TR simultaneously. Closing of contactor S connects one winding of the motor to the lines. After some time, when timer TR operates, Run contactor R gets closed and therefore the second winding also gets connected to the lines in parallel with the first winding. Now the motor runs with two windings in parallel. Current drawn by the motor gets equally divided between the two windings. The over-load relays are connected in both the windings. Setting of these relays is done according to the current taken by the individual windings. If current increases in any one of the windings and the corresponding overload relay trips, both the contactors get de-energised. This happens because both the contacts are connected in series with the coil of the control relay (CR). 3.6.2 Three Step Starting In three step starting when first contactor is closed, one of the two windings gets connected to the lines through resistors in each of the phases. After a time delay of approximately two seconds, the resistances are cut off and this winding gets connected to the full line voltage through the closing of the second contactor. After another time delay of two seconds, the Run contactor is energised to connect the second winding to the lines. The value of resistance can be so selected that 50% of the line voltage is available at the motor terminals during first step. Thus the motor starts with three approximately equal increments of the starting current. The power and control circuit diagrams for three step starting is shown in Fig. 3.20. L1 L2 L3 S R 1S Resistor T1 T4 T2 T5 T3 T6 (a) dharm d:N-MachMac3-1.pm5 84
  • 102. STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR 85 CR2 P OL1 1T1 2T1 OL2 OFF R1 ON CR1 CR S 1T 1S 2T R N (b) Fig. 3.20 Three step starting of an induction motor (a) Power circuit diagram; (b) Control circuit diagram Pressing of the ON-push button will energise contactor S and timer 1T. Contactor S closes to start the motor with resistors in circuit and the supply reaches motor terminals T1, T2 and T3. When Timer 1T operates after 2 seconds, its delayed contact closes to energise contactor 1S. Closing of contactor 1S shorts the resistances from the circuit. A timer 2T is also energised alongwith 1S. When timer 2T operates after 2 second the Run contactor R is energised, which closes to connect the second winding of the motor also to the lines. Now both the windings are connected in parallel to the lines through contactors R and 1S. Contactor S opens when the Run contactor is energised (due to opening of NC contact R1). 3.7 STAR-DELTA STARTER Star delta starting is the most commonly used reduced voltage starting method. The stator windings of the motor are first connected in star and full voltage is connected across its terminals. As the motor reaches near the rated speed, the windings are disconnected and then re-connected in delta across the supply terminals. The current drawn by the motor from the lines during starting is reduced to one third of the value of current the motor would have drawn if connected in delta. This would become clear when we examine the details given in Fig. 3.21. In Fig. 3.21 (a) the windings are connected in delta. The voltage across each winding is V. Phase current through the winding is say I amps., then the line current, IL = 3 I amp. (as in delta connection line current is 3 times the phase current). Now refer to star connection as shown in Fig. 3.21 (b) the voltage across the windings is V/ 3 so the current through winding is also reduced proportionately. Thus phase current Ip = I/ 3 . As in star connection the line current and phase current are the same, thus line current IL = I/ 3 . A comparison between line current in the two cases shows that: dharm d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5 85
  • 103. 86 CONTROL OF MACHINES Fig. 3.21 Comparison of current drawn from the lines when windings are delta connected and star connected IL (Delta) = 3 I I IL (Star) = 3 Thus it is clear that line current drawn from supply in Star connection is reduced to 1/3 times the line current in delta connection. From the theory of machines it is known that, starting torque is proportional to square of voltage applied to the motor windings i.e., T ∝ V2 V It has been seen that in star connection, the voltage across the motor winding is 3 times the voltage across the winding in delta connection. Thus the starting torque in star connection will be one third of the starting torque in delta connection. It thus follows that along with reduction of current in star connection, the starting torque also gets reduced proportionately. Before different types of star-delta starters are discussed, it is necessary to have some explanations about motor winding connections. The three stator windings of a squirrel cage motor are designated as A1 – A2, B1 – B2, C1 – C2 where A1, B1, C1 are the starting ends and A2, B2, C2 are the finishing ends of the respective windings. To connect the windings in star either the finishing ends or the starting ends of the three windings are connected together to form the neutral connection. As shown in Fig. 3.22 (a), the finishing ends of three windings i.e., A2, B2 and C2 are connected together to form the neutral connection, the supply being connected to terminals A1, B1 and C1. When the three windings are to be connected in delta, finishing end of one winding is connected to starting end of the other winding as shown in Fig. 3.22 (b) where finishing end A2 of first winding (A1 – A2) is connected to starting end B1 of second winding (B1 – B2) and finishing end B2 of second winding is connected to starting end C1 of third winding (C1 – C2), and then finishing end of third winding C2 is connected to starting end A1 of first winding. After these connections are completed supply is given at the junction A1 C2, A2 B1 and B2 C1. dharm d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5 86
  • 104. STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR 87 The connection of windings in star during starting and then in delta during running is done by a manual switch in a manual starter while contactors and timers are used in an automatic starter. A1 A1 C2 V A2 V C2 B2 C1 B1 A2 C1 B1 B2 V V (a) (b) Fig. 3.22 Connection of three phase motor windings (a) in Star (b) in Delta 3.7.1 Manual Star-delta Starter A simple manual star delta starter is shown in Fig. 3.23. L1 L2 L3 A1 A2 (RUN) 2 (OFF) 0 B2 C2 (STAR) 1 B1 C1 Fig. 3.23 Manual star-delta starter When the starter switch is in 0-position the windings are open. When the switch is moved to position 1 (STAR-position) the terminals A2, B2 and C2 get shorted, the windings get connected in star and the motor starts rotating. As the motor reaches near its rated speed the dharm d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5 87
  • 105. 88 CONTROL OF MACHINES switch is moved to position 2 and connections are established at A2 B1, B2 C1, C2 A1 as shown in Fig. 3.23 and the motor continues to run with its stator windings connected in delta. The other type of star-delta starters discussed in the sections to follow are: (i) Push button operated manual star-delta starter (ii) Semi-automatic star-delta starter (iii) Automatic open circuit transition star-delta starter (iv) Automatic closed circuit transition star-delta starter. 3.7.2 Push-button Operated Manual Star-Delta Starter This starter is constructed using one contactor, two push buttons, an over-load relay and a four pole-three position switch connected as shown in the wiring diagram as shown in Fig. 3.24. The three poles of the switch have been used in the power circuit to connect the motor to the supply lines while the fourth one is used in the control circuit. The three positions of the switch are 0 (OFF)-position, 1 (STAR)-position and 2 (DELTA)-position. The moving contacts (blades) of the switch have been shown by dotted lines. With the switch in off position, if the ON-push button is pressed, the contactor cannot be energised and therefore the motor cannot be started (see Fig. 3.24). Now let us put the switch in RUN or DELTA position and press the ON-push button. It can be seen that the control circuit does not get supply and therefore the contactor M cannot be energised. This implies that the motor cannot be started in delta. When the switch is placed in STAR-position contactor coil can be energised by pressing the ON-push button. The main contacts now close and the motor runs in star. It thus follows that by pressing the ON-push button the motor can be started only when the windings are connected in star i.e., when the switch is in star position. The push button is to be kept pressed till the motor picks up speed and the switch is changed over to delta. The ON-push button can then be released as the contactor M will get hold through its own contact M1 and the control contact (fourth contact) of the switch which is in delta position. It thus follows that the ON-push button has to be kept pressed as long as we want to run the motor in star-connection. The push button can only be released when winding connections have been changed to delta by operating the switch. The schematic diagram for the control is given in Fig. 3.24 (b). The reader is advised to study the control circuit according to the control requirement described above. The diagram does not explain the transition from star to delta clearly. However the explanation is as follows: In the schematic diagram, Fig. 3.24 (b), it may be observed that initially the switch contact is in position 1 (STAR). The contactor gets energised when the ON-push button is pressed. The contactor does not hold as contact C-2 is open. Now when the switch is changed from position 1 to 2 the contact between C-1 is broken, the contactor M will get de-energised and contact M1 will open. When contact is established between C-2, the contactor M will remain de-energised as supply to its coil is disconnected due to opening of contact C-1. Thus the question that arises is how the operation which we have described earlier holds true i.e., the contactor M should remain energised till switch is brought to position 2 through pressing of the ON-push button. The contactor M remains energised during the transition from position 1 to 2 of the switch due to a special design feature of the switch. The switch is so made that when its handle is shifted from position 1 to 2 the main contacts open and then change over to their new position while the control contact i.e., the contact between C-1 is maintained till the contact C- 2 is eatablished. After the closure of contact between C-2 the contact between C-1 is broken. This way the contactor coil remains energised while the switch is transferred from STAR-to- DELTA position. dharm d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5 88
  • 106. STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR 89 L1 L2 L3 N OFF P M OFF M1 A1 B1 C1 ON ON M1 0 2 1 A2 B2 C2 C (RUN) 2 Manually M operated OFF (0) C N switch STAR 1 (b) Fig. 3.24 Push-button operated manual star-delta starter (a) Wiring diagram (b) Schematic control diagram 3.7.3 Semi-automatic Star-Delta Starter Semi-automatic and fully automatic starters require three contactors to connect the motor windings first in star and then in delta. The power circuit diagram showing the scheme is given in Fig. 3.25. L1 L2 A1 C2 L3 A2 C1 B1 B2 M D S 1 2 3 1 2 3 A1 B1 C1 A2 B2 C2 Fig. 3.25 Power circuit diagram for a star-delta starter dharm d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5 89
  • 107. 90 CONTROL OF MACHINES Whenever one has to make connections for a star-delta starter it is advantageous to draw the winding diagram as shown in the right hand side of Fig. 3.25. It helps to remember that for delta connection, finishing end of one winding is to be connected to starting end of the other winding as shown in the figure. The three phase supply is then given at the three junctions. Now let us refer to the power circuit diagam of the starter as given in Fig. 3.25. The sequence of operation of the contactors is as follows. First the contactor S will close for star connections, then the main contactor M will close and lastly contactor S will open and contactor D will close for delta connection. When star contactor is first closed, winding terminals A2, B2, C2 get connected together through the contacts of contactor S and thus the windings get connected in star. Now when the main contactor is closed supply reaches terminals A1, B1, C1 and therefore the motor windings are energised in star-connection. For delta connection, first the star contactor should open before the delta contactor is closed. If delta contactor gets closed while star contactor is still ON, dead short circuit takes place at the outgoing leads of over-load relay through contactor D and S. This is taken care of by providing interlocking of auxiliary contacts between contactors S and D. When star contactor opens and delta contactor closes motor winding terminals A2, B2, C2 get connected to B1, C1, A1 through the closed contacts of contactor M and the motor runs in delta connection. In a semi-automatic starter, the motor runs in star connection as long as ON-push button is kept pressed. When ON-push button is released the motor gets connected in delta and continues to run till the OFF-push button is actuated or over-load relay trips. The control diagram for a semi-automatic starter is shown in Fig. 3.26. Explanation of control operation is as follows: P OFF M1 S1 S2 ON D1 S M D N Star Main Delta contactor contactor contactor Fig. 3.26 Control circuit for a semi-automatic star-delta starter When ON-push button is pressed contactor S gets energised and it connects the motor windings in star connection. (Refer power diagram in Fig. 3.25). Simultaneously the auxiliary contact S1 closes and S2 opens. Closing of S1 causes energisation of contactor M which is then kept energised through its own auxiliary contact M1. Opening of contact S2 provides interlocking i.e., the delta contactor cannot get energised as long as contactor S is energised. Contactor S dharm d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5 90
  • 108. STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR 91 remains energised as long as the ON-push button is kept pressed because there is no holding circuit for contactor S. When the ON-push button is released, contactor S gets de-energised, its auxiliary contacts come back to their original positions as shown in Fig. 3.26. Opening of S1 does not make any difference in operation as the main contactor is now held through its own contact. However, closing of contact S2 causes energisation of the delta contactor. Thus, now the main contactor and the delta contactor are energised simultaneously and the motor runs with its windings connected in delta. Whenever the motor is to be stopped the OFF-push button is pressed, both the contactors M and D are de-energised (as holding through auxiliary contact of M is broken). Similar action takes place when the control contact of the overload relay opens. 3.7.4 Automatic Star-Delta Starter (Open Circuit Transition) In an automatic star-delta starter, the time required to change from star to delta connection is obtained with a time delay relay. A knob on the time delay relay can be adjusted at the desired time setting required for running the motor in star. The time setting is around 10 sec. For lightly loaded motor time setting is a little less, while for fully loaded motors the time setting may be a little more than 10 secs. The power circuit diagram for an automatic star-delta starter is the same as that shown in Fig. 3.25. The control circuit is as shown in Fig. 3.27. P OFF M1 ON S1 S2 D1 T1 S T M D N Star Timer Main Delta contactor 9–30 secs contactor contactor Fig. 3.27 Control circuit for an automatic star-delta starter When the ON-push button is pressed the star contactor S is energised. Its contact S1 closes and therefore main contactor M gets energised. Contactor M and contactor S get hold through their own contacts M1 and S1 respectively. A time delay relay T is also energised along with contactor S. Energisation of contactor S and then M cause the motor to run in star connection. This continues till timer T operates after a pre-set time of say 10 secs, its delayed contact T1 opens and causes de-energisation of contactor S. When contactor S is de-energised its contact S1 opens and S2 closes i.e., they come back to their normal positions. As contact M1 is already closed the delta contactor gets energised and the motor runs with its windings in delta connection. As soon as the delta contactor is energised its contact D1 opens which provides dharm d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5 91
  • 109. 92 CONTROL OF MACHINES interlocking avoiding simultaneous energisation of star-contactor. At the same time it also de- energises timer T. In running condition therefore contactor M and contactor D remain energised while contactor S and timer T remain de-energised. The circuit just discussed is for open circuit transition from star to delta i.e., the delta contactor closes only after the opening of star-contactor. Thus for a small duration of time the motor windings get disconnected from the supply. During this period voltage is induced in the windings due to rotor flux. When the star contactor closes, the induced voltage in the windings and the supply voltage get superimposed and high transient current may be drawn from the supply depending upon the phase relationship of supply voltage and the induced voltage. The current versus time characteristic of the open circuit transition starter is shown in Fig. 3.28. 6 Starting current 4 2 IFL t1 t2 Time Fig. 3.28 Starting current versus time characteristic for an open circuit transition starter The starting current, due to motor starting in star connection, reduces current to one third of the rated full load current. At time t1 when the motor reaches near its rated speed, star contactor opens. After a small time gap of t2 – t1 the delta contactor closes. At instant t2 a transient current may flow, the peak value of which may be even higher than the direct on line starting current. Inspite of these disadvantages, this starter is the most commonly used starter in industry. 3.7.5 Automatic Star-Delta Starter (Closed Circuit Transition) For most installations the open circuit transition starter discussed in the previous section works satisfactorily. However, some installations may require closed circuit transition starting to prevent power line disturbances. Closed circuit transition starting is achieved by adding one more three pole contactor and resistors in the circuit of an open circuit transition starter. In closed circuit transition, the motor windings are kept energised with resistors in the circuit when the connections of the winding are changed from star to delta. As the windings remain connected to supply during transition, the incremental current swing during the transition period is reduced to a low value. The power circuit for a closed circuit transition starter is shown in Fig. 3.29. The connection scheme is the same as that for open transition except that a contactor T is connected in parallel with the delta contactor with resistances in the circuit. Thus when contactor T and M are energised, the windings get connected in delta with a resistance in series with each winding. The operating sequence of the contactor is that first the star contactor S and the main contactor M are energised and as the motor picks up speed contactor T is energised. dharm d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5 92
  • 110. STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR 93 L1 L2 L3 D T M S A1 B1 C1 Resis- tance A2 B2 C2 Fig. 3.29 Power circuit diagram for closed circuit transition type star-delta starter Contactor T connects a resistance in parallel with each of the windings. The motor continues to run in star connection as contactor S is still closed. Connections due to contactor T is not effective as value of resistances are very high. After a little more delay, contactor S is de- energised. With de-energisation of contactor S, contactor D closes. During the small time gap between opening of contactor S and closing of contactor D the windings remain connected to supply (through contactor T ) in delta connection with resistances in series. After the closure of contactor D the contactor T becomes open with some time delay. It may be noted that just at the instant of closing of contactor D, the windings get connected in delta as the contactor D gets connected in parallel with contactor T and thus by-pass its action. The operating sequence for star-delta closed circuit transition is shown in Fig. 3.30. The control circuit which accomplishes this control sequence is shown in Fig. 3.31. The control operations performed by the circuit of Fig. 3.31 are as follows: (i) Pressing of the ON-push button energises control relay CR. Its contacts CR1 and CR2 close. Closing of contact CR2 energises star contactor S. (ii) Energisation of star contactor S leads to closing of its contact S1 and opening of S2. Contactor M gets energised through contact S1 and gets hold through its own contact M1. Thus the motor runs in star connection [see Fig. 3.30 (a)]. (iii) Timer A gets energised along with the main contactor M. Timer operates after a pre- determined time and its delayed contact A1 closes to energise contactor T. (iv) Energisation of contactor T connects a high value resistance in parallel with each of the windings, the windings being connected in star and the motor continues to run in star connection [see Fig. 3.30 (b)]. (v) Timer B also gets energised along with contactor T. After some delay the timer oper- ates and its contacts B1 opens and thereby de-energises the star contactor S. dharm d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5 93
  • 111. 94 CONTROL OF MACHINES L1 L2 L3 L1 L2 L3 A1 A1 A2 C2 A2 C2 B2 B2 B1 C1 C1 (a) (b) B1 (1) Contactor S and (2) Contactor T closes M close (S and M also closed) L1 L2 L3 L1 L2 L3 A1 C2 A1 C2 A2 B2 A2 C1 C1 B1 B1 B2 (c) (d) (3) Contactor S opens (4) Contactor D closes (While M and T are closed) (While M and T are ON) L1 L2 L3 Operation Contactor A1 S M T D C2 Start X X Transition X X X 1 Transition X X X 2 Run X X X X A2 C1 (Delta) B1 B2 Note: X indicates closed condition (5) Contactor T opens (While M and D are closed) (6) Contactor operating sequence Fig. 3.30 Operating sequence of a closed circuit transition star-delta starter (vi) De-energisation of contactor S leads to closing of the contact S2 and thus the delta contactor D is energised. During the gap between opening of star contactor and clos- ing of delta contactor, contactor T connects the winding in delta with resistances in series [see Fig. 3.30 (c) and (d)]. (vii) Energisation of contactor D leads to opening of its contacts D1 and D2. Contact D1 opens to provide interlocking with contactor S while opening of contact D2 de-ener- gises contactor T and resets timer A and timer B by de-energising their coils. dharm d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5 94
  • 112. STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR 95 (viii) In the run condition motor runs in delta connection with contactor M and D ener- gised [see Fig. 3.30 (d)]. CR2 P D1 S1 M1 OFF B1 CR1 D2 S2 ON A1 CR S M A T B D N Control on Star Main Timer Transition Timer Delta contactor contactor contactor contactor Fig. 3.31 Control circuit for closed circuit transition automatic star-delta starter 3.8 STARTERS FOR MULTI-SPEED MOTORS A squirrel cage motor is basically a constant speed motor, its speed being determined by the line frequency and the number of poles of the stator winding. Such motors, however, can be designed to have different speed by: (i) having two separate stator windings wound for different number of poles; (ii) having a consequent pole winding which can be reconnected to have two speeds. In this type the choice of number of poles is restricted to a two-to-one ratio. For exam- ple, a consequent pole winding can be wound for four and eight poles, eight and sixteen poles, and so on. Fig. 3.32 shows how poles are doubled by reconnection of windings. Fig. 3.32 The number of poles are doubled by reversing current through half a phase (connection shown for one phase only) dharm d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5 95
  • 113. 96 CONTROL OF MACHINES Multi speed motors are divided into three categories according to the torque developed at various speeds. Before these three types are discussed, let us recall the relationship between horse-power, torque and speed, which is expressed as: Horse-power developed = torque × speed. (i) Constant horse-power motors. These motors develop the same horse-power at all speeds. Thus the torque varies inversely as the speed according to the above equation. (ii) Constant torque motors. These motors develop same torque on all speeds. Horse- power rating of the motor varies in proportion to the speed. (iii) Variable torque motors. These motors are designed to develop a torque which is proportional to the speed. Horse-power rating of these motors is therefore propor- tional to the square of the speed. Torque speed curves are shown dotted for a typical two-speed motor with a two to one ratio for constant horse-power, constant torque and variable torque design. 1.0 0.9 Per unit speed ed 0.8 spe 0.7 High 0.6 0.4 ble torq tant 0.3 ue Varia Torque nt ns 0.2 ta ns P Co 0.1 Co H –5.0 –4.5 –4.0 –3.5 –3.0 –2.5 –2.0 –1.5 –1.0 –0.5 0.5 1.0 1.5 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 0 Per unit torque Fig. 3.33 Typical speed-torque curves of two-to-one multispeed squirrel-cage induction motors We can infer from the curves that when the motor is switched from its high speed winding to the low speed winding the low speed winding develops a considerable amount of retarding torque which in constant horse-power motor may exceed the maximum torque developed by the high speed winding. This high retarding torque is accompanied by high stator currents which can be harmful to the motors. These high currents can be avoided by connecting buffer resistance in the low winding while switching from high to low speeds. Another problem faced while switching from one speed to another is that when the motor is disconnected from the lines and reconnected with a different number of poles, the stator windings remain open during transition. The entrapped flux will generate emf in the winding which may add to the line voltage and a high transient current may flow which may be harmful to the windings. It is thus desired that sufficient time should be allowed for the transition from one speed to another in order to permit decaying of flux entrapped in the magnetic circuit. dharm d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5 96
  • 114. STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR 97 3.8.1 Starter for Two-Speed, Two Winding (Separate Winding) Motor The two separate stator windings meant for different speeds may be connected either in star or in delta. The windings are shown in Fig. 3.34 (a) alongwith their connections for low speed and high speed in a tabular form. T1 T11 Speed L1 L2 L3 Open All Low T1 T2 T3 others All High T11 T12 T13 others T3 T2 T13 T12 T1 T11 Speed L1 L2 L3 Open Low T 1 T2 T3 All T4 others T13 T3 High T11 T12 T13 All T14 others T4 T2 T14 T12 Fig. 3.34 (a) Winding connections for two-speed, two winding motor Refer table for star connection. For low speed, motor terminals T1, T2, T3 have to be connected to L1, L2 and L3 while terminal T11, T12 and T13 have to be left open. For high speed T11, T12 and T13 should be connected to L1, L2, L3 while T1, T2 and T3 should be left open. Similarly for delta connected windings, the connection scheme for two speeds is shown in table of Fig. 3.34 (a). In the delta winding connections, it is seen that windings get connected in delta when terminals T3 and T4 are shorted in low speed winding and terminals T13 and T14 are shorted in high speed winding. This is done because the winding which is idle should remain open otherwise current will circulate in it when motor is running on the other winding. The power diagram for star connected winding for two speed operation of motor is given in Fig. 3.34 (b). L1 L2 L3 L H T1 T11 T2 M T12 T3 3~ T13 Fig. 3.34 (b) Power diagram for star connected winding for two-speed operation of motor dharm d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5 97
  • 115. 98 CONTROL OF MACHINES It is clear from the power diagram that separate overload relays are required for low speed and high speed. While making connections proper care should be taken that phases between high and low speed windings are not reversed. Machines may get damaged if the direction of rotation is changed. Three types of control circuits for the starter are shown in Fig. 3.35. Fig. 3.35 Control circuit for two speed, two winding motor dharm d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5 98
  • 116. STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR 99 In the control circuit of Fig. 3.35 (a) change over from low to high speed and high to low speed can be done by pressing the respective push buttons. Push button interlocking as well as contact interlocking have been incorporated in the control circuit design. This type of control, however, results in rapid speed transfer which may activate the overload relays. To prevent this the control scheme can be equipped with time delay relays that will provide time lag between the speed changes. For some drives the starting torque of the high speed winding is too low, requiring the motor to run on low speed first before being switched over to high speed. This is achieved through a control scheme using a compelling relay as shown in Fig. 3.35 (b). It may be observed that pressing of high speed push button does not have any result. To run the motor at high speed first the low speed push button is to be pressed which would energise contactor L and the compelling relay CR. Contactor L gets hold through contacts CR1 and L2 while compelling relay CR gets hold through its own contacts CR1. Its another contacts CR2 also closes. For running the motor on high speed, pressing of the high speed push button de-energises the low speed contactor L while the compelling relay CR remains hold. The de-energisation of L leads to closing of its normally closed contact L1. Thus high speed contactor H is energised through the normally closed contact of LOW-push button, contact L1 and closed contact CR2. Switching back to low speed can be done by pressing the LOW-push button which would de- energise contactor H and energise contactor L. This control scheme has the disadvantage that both the push buttons, LOW and HIGH have to be pressed for selecting high speed operation. This shortcoming can be removed by using a timer as shown in the control scheme in Fig. 3.35 (c). In this circuit, when the high speed push button is pressed the compelling relay CR gets hold through its contact CR3. Its contact CR1 also closes and energises contactor L through closed contacts TR1 and H1. This in turn energises timer TR through contact L2. Timer TR gets hold through its instantaneous contact TR (Inst). Thus even when the high speed push button is pressed the motor starts in low speed and runs in low speed till timer TR times out and opens its delayed contact TR1, de-energising contactor L and at the same time closing contact TR2. When contactor L drops contactor H picks up through closed contact CR3, TR2 and L1. When the motor is desired to be run only on low speed, low speed push button is to be pressed. Contactor L and timer TR would get energised. Both the contactors get hold through the instantaneous contact of timer TR. When the LOW-speed push button is released, contactor L gets hold through contact TR (inst), L2 and CR2. The operation of timer TR which leads to opening of delayed contacts TR1 has no effect on contactor L. The motor can be shifted to high speed instantaneously by pressing the HIGH-push button. It may be noted that when the motor is running on high speed it cannot be brought to low speed by pressing the LOW speed push button. First the STOP-push button has to be pressed and only then the motor can be run on low speed by pressing the LOW speed push button. 3.8.2 Two Speed One Winding (Consequent Pole) Motor Starter A three phase squirrel cage induction motor can be wound so as to bring out six leads for external connections. By making suitable connections of these leads (T1, T2, T3, T4, T5, T6) the three phase windings can be connected either in series delta or in parallel star as shown in Fig. 3.36. dharm d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5 99
  • 117. 100 CONTROL OF MACHINES L3 T4 L3 L1 T3 T1 T3 T1 T5 T6 T2 L2 T2 L1 L2 (a) High speed (b) Low speed Speed L1 L2 L3 Open Together Low T1 T2 T3 — T4, T5, T6 High T6 T4 T5 All — others (c) Connection table for two-speed one winding constant H.P. motor Fig. 3.36 Winding connections for one winding, two speed induction motor T4 Constant T3 T1 horse power T5 T2 T6 Speed L1 L2 L3 Open Together Low T1 T2 T3 — T4, T5, T6 High T6 T4 T5 All others — T4 T3 T1 Constant torque T2 T5 T6 Speed L1 L2 L3 Open Together Low T1 T2 T3 All others — High T6 T4 T5 — T1, T2, T3 T4 Variable T1 torque T3 T2 T5 T6 Speed L1 L2 L3 Open Together Low T1 T2 T3 All others — High T6 T4 T5 — T1, T2, T3 Fig. 3.37 Typical motor connection arrangement for three phase-two speed one winding motor dharm d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5 100
  • 118. STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR 101 If the windings are designed such that series delta connection leads to high speed as shown in Fig. 3.36 (a), then the horse-power rating would be the same for both high as well as low speeds. On the other hand if series delta connection is designed for low speed and parallel star connection for high speed then torque rating of the motor would be same at both low as well as for high speeds. Typical motor terminal connections, for constant horse-power, constant torque and variable torque are shown in Fig. 3.37. The power diagram for a constant horse-power, two speed, one winding motor is shown in Fig. 3.38. Fig. 3.38 Power diagram for constant horse-power, two speed, one winding induction motor It is clear from Fig. 3.38 that the low speed contactor L requires 5 poles. The control scheme for the starter may be any of the control circuit discussed in the previous section using Figs. 3.35 (a), (b) and (c). We may have three speed consequent pole motors by having one winding which is reconnectable and the other an ordinary winding. Four speeds may be obtained by having two reconnectable windings. dharm d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5 101
  • 119. 102 CONTROL OF MACHINES 3.9 REVERSING THE DIRECTION OF ROTATION OF INDUCTION MOTORS In a three phase induction motor, the rotor tends to rotate in the same direction as the revolving magnetic field produced by the stator windings. The direction of the revolving field depends upon the phase sequence of the supply voltage. If the phase sequence of supply to the motor windings is changed by interchanging two phase leads, the direction of the revolving fields is reversed. Thus the direction of rotation of a three phase induction motor can be reversed if the two supply phase leads to the motor terminals are interchanged. This phase reversal to the motor terminals is accomplished by two contactors. The power diagram for reversing the direction of rotation of the motor and the associated control circuits are shown in Fig. 3.39. Fig. 3.39 Reversing direction of rotation of a three phase induction motor (a) Power diagram (b) and (c) Control circuit diagrams dharm d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5 102
  • 120. STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR 103 It may be seen from 3.39 (a) that phase reversal to motor terminals has been done by interchanging phase L2 and phase L3 leads at the upper terminals of the reverse contactor R. The forward and reverse contactor are mechanically interlocked i.e., if one of them is closed the other cannot close. This is done to avoid dead short circuit in case both the contactors closing simultaneously. Electrical interlocking has also been provided, by using control contacts. Electrical interlocking is essential even if mechanical interlocking of contactors is provided. This is because, if the coil of contactor which is mechanically interlocked not to close, is energised, its coil gets burnt. The coil gets burnt as it draws large current due to less reactance in this case. Reactance of coil is less as reluctance to flux path increases due to large air gap between the electromagnet and the locked armature of contactor. Forward reverse starters may be designed for either Forward-Reverse Operation or Forward-Off-Reverse Operation. The control diagram in Fig. 3.39 (b) is a simple circuit for Forward-Off-Reverse operation. The motor can be run in forward or reverse direction by pressing FOR or REV push buttons. When say the FOR-push button is pressed contactor F gets energised and is held energised through its auxiliary contact F1. As the interolocking contact F2 is now open the reverse contactor R can not be energised even if the REV-push button is pressed. When the motor is to be reversed, the motor is to be stopped first by pressing the STOP-push button which de-energises contactor F, only then the motor can be run in reverse direction by pressing the REV-push button. Control circuit in Fig. 3.39 (c) is for direct reversing of the motor. In this circuit, for reversing there is no need to first press the STOP-push button. Direction of rotation of the motor can be changed by pressing the respective push button. This is accomplished by using interlocking through NC contacts of the push button in the coil circuits of the contactors. Assume that motor is running in forward direction when contactor F is energised through closed contact F1, NC contact of reverse push button, and normally closed contact R2 of reverse contactor R. When it is desired to reverse the motor direction, REV-push button is pressed, its NO contact closes whereas its NC contact which is in series with coil of contactor F opens. Contactor coil of F is thus de-energised and its holding circuit is also released. De-energisation of F also leads to closing of its auxiliary contacts F2. The reverse contactor R is thus energised through NO contact of REV-push button, NC of FOR-push button, and NC contact F2 of contactor F. The contactor R remains energised through its auxiliary contact R1. Similar action takes place when the motor is to again run in forward direction by pressing FOR-push button. Induction motors can be safely reversed by direct reversing method as the inrush current is not significantly more than when it is started direct from rest. Direct reversing is also used for bringing a motor to standstill quickly using reverse torque acting as a brake. 3.10 PLUG STOPPING OF MOTOR Plug stopping or plugging of a motor means bringing the motor to standstill quickly by applying reverse torque on the rotor. Reverse torque for plugging of a motor to standstill is obtained by changing the direction of the revolving magnetic field (interchanging any two stator leads). When the rotor reaches zero speed and attempts to reverse, supply to the motor is disconnected with the help of a zero-speed plugging switch. Control circuit for plugging a small squirrel cage motor from either direction with zero speed plugging switches has been discussed in this section. Here two zero speed plugging switches are required for the control operations. The forward plugging switch contact, FOR- PS close when the motor runs in forward direction and remains closed till the motor comes to standstill or zero-speed. Similarly reverse plugging switch contact, REV-PS close when motor starts in reverse direction. Control diagram of a Forward-Reverse starter with plug-stop facility has been shown in Fig. 3.40. dharm d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5 103
  • 121. 104 CONTROL OF MACHINES Fig. 3.40 Control circuit for Reversing of an induction motor with plugging facility In this control circuit auxiliary contact as well as push-button contact (NC contact) interlocking have been provided between Forward and Reverse contactors. The operations of the circuit is as follows. When the FOR-push button is pressed, contactor F gets energised and the motor starts rotating in forward direction. Forward plugging switch contact closes and contactor F gets hold through closed contact of forward plugging switch and auxiliary contact F2. When the motor is stopped by pressing STOP-push button contactor F gets de-energised, the holding circuit breaks due to opening of contact F2. But the contactor R gets energised through forward plugging switch, back-contact (NC contact) of FOR-push-button, and normally closed contact F1. Thus a reverse torque acts on the motor to bring it to zero speed quickly. Near zero speed the forward plugging switch opens and de-energies contactor R. If the motor is to be run in reverse direction the reverse push-button has to be pressed. Similar action, as described above, takes place when the motor is stopped from running in the reverse direction. 3.11 DYNAMIC BRAKING An induction motor can be brought to rest quickly if ac supply to the motor terminals is removed and instead a dc supply is applied. The dc current flowing through the stator windings would produce the same number of stationary poles as the number of poles of the revolving field produced with ac supply. The rotor would cut the flux of these stationary poles resulting in induced emf and current flow in the rotor windings. This current flow in the rotor would cause I2R loss in the winding resistance or in the external resistances in case it is a wound rotor motor. The rotor would slow down as a result of the mechanical energy of rotation being converted into electrical energy and dissipated as heat. Energy conversion would be complete when the rotor would reach zero speed. For a quick stop, dc current fed to the stator winding should be six to eight times the rated current of the motor. dharm d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5 104
  • 122. STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR 105 Direct current can be supplied to the 3-phase windings in either of the following two ways: (1) A pair of stator terminals T1 and T2 connected across the dc source and the third terminal T3 is left open. The same current would pass through the two windings, they being in series. (2) In this method two winding terminals, say, T2 and T3, are joined together and supply is given between this junction and the third terminal T1. This is more popular ar- rangement as it develops less heating for a given braking torque. This connection arrangement is shown in Fig. 3.41. Fig. 3.41 Stator winding connections for dynamic braking The power diagram and control diagram for dynamic braking of a squirrel cage induction motor is shown in Fig. 3.42 (a) and (b). It can be seen from the power diagram that dc current to the motor stator is controlled by a variable resistance R. Contactor DB [see Fig. 3.42 (b)] has been used to switch on dc supply to the motor terminals during braking. In the control circuit an OFF-delay timer has been used for setting the time for which dc supply is to be given for braking. In an OFF-delay timer, the contact operates after some time from the instant of switching off of the relay coil. In the circuit NC contact of the START-push button has been used in series with the coil of contactor DB for interlocking. This interlocking is to avoid simultaneous energisation of contactor M and DB and thereby mixing of ac and dc supply. The working of the control circuit is as follows: When the START- push button is pressed, contactor M gets energised and is held through its contact M1. OFF- delay time TR also gets energised, its delayed contact TR1 closes immediately, and keeps the circuit ready for dynamic breaking. When the motor is to be stopped, on pressing the STOP- push button contactor M and timer TR get de-energised. Contactor DB gets energised through delayed contact TR1 of the timer and the closed contact M2. Closing of contactor DB applies dc supply to the stator terminals. When the OFF-delay timer operates, its contact opens and de- energises contactor DB. In this type of Dynamic braking, the braking torque varies considerably over the braking period. Depending upon the magnitude of dc excitation, braking torque may be 50% of rated dharm d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5 105
  • 123. 106 CONTROL OF MACHINES motor torque at the instant the dc is applied, rise to a value of 500 to 600 percent at about 3 to 6 percent speed, and then drop rapidly to zero as the motor comes to rest. Fig. 3.42 Dynamic braking of a three phase induction motor (a) Power circuit diagram (b) Control circuit diagram The reason for above mentioned variation in the braking torque is explained as follows: It is known that braking torque is developed due to interaction between the rotor current and the total flux (TBr = K φ t I r ). The total flux φt in an ac motor during braking has resultant value that is represented by the constant dc flux and a superimposed flux caused by the rotor emf. It, dharm d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5 106
  • 124. STARTERS FOR 3-PHASE SQUIRREL CAGE MOTOR 107 therefore, becomes clear that the flux-current product (φt Ir) at any instant of time will determine the torque at that instant. At the start of braking period, the rotor reactance is high, thus the rotor current has a low-lagging power factor. This current therefore has a large reactive component that greatly diminishes the dc field. Thus under this condition the braking torque is low. When the motor slows down, the rotor reactance becomes low, then power factor of the rotor current increases, and the demagnetising effect on main dc flux reduces. The braking torque thus rises even though the motor speed drops. REVIEW QUESTIONS 1. Explain why there is a limitation on the use of across the line full voltage starters for starting of squirrel cage motors. 2. Explain why reduced voltage is applied across the motor terminals during starting of an induc- tion motor. 3. What are the basic methods used for achieving reduced voltage starting ? 4. Discuss the working of a semi-automatic stepless resistance starter. 5. How is an increment resistance starter different from other reduced voltage starters ? Draw its power and control diagram. 6. Name the situation where you will prefer a line resistance reduced voltage starter than a line resistance starter. 7. Explain the meaning of open circuit transition and closed circuit transition, with respect to starting of induction motors. 8. Discuss the working of auto-transformer starter (closed circuit transition) with the help of dia- grams. 9. Mention the advantages of part winding starter as compared to other reduced voltage starters. Draw power diagram for three step starting of an induction motor. 10. Explain the working of a fully automatic open circuit transition star-delta starter. Also draw its starting current versus time characteristic. 11. Explain working of a closed circuit transition star-delta starter. 12. Discuss the working of two speed one winding (consequent pole) motor starter. 13. How will you reverse the direction of rotation of a squirrel cage induction motor ? Draw power and control diagram for the forward/reverse starter ? 14. Draw diagram for plugging a squirrel cage induction motor to stop from either side using zero speed plugging switches. 15. Explain the principle of dynamic braking of squirrel cage induction motor and draw power and control diagram for the same. 16. Starting current of squirrel cage motors is approximately: (a) two times the full load current (b) four times the full load current (c) six times the full load current (d) equal to rated current 17. The primary purpose of applying reduced voltage at starting to squirrel cage motor is: (a) to reduce losses (b) to attain smooth acceleration (c) to avoid voltage fluctuation of mains (d) to obtain high starting torque. 18. At 50% of rated speed during acceleration, the current drawn by an induction motor is almost: (a) equal to rated current (b) twice the rated current (c) four times the rated current (d) six times the rated current. 19. The starting current of a 20 h.p. motor is approximately equal to (a) 100 A (b) 120 A (c) 180 A (d) 250 A. dharm d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5 107
  • 125. 108 CONTROL OF MACHINES 20. In Increment resistance starter, the motor starts accelerating at: (a) the instant of switching on (b) 25% of line voltage (c) 60% of the line voltage (d) full line voltage. 21. For a 120 hp motor which one of the following is the most suitable starter ? (a) Reactor reduced voltage starter (b) Auto transformer reduced voltage starter (c) Star-delta starter (d) Part-winding starter. 22. Dynamic braking for an ac motor is accomplished by (a) reversing the direction of rotation of the motor (b) connecting dc voltage to stator (c) inserting resistance in series with motor leads (d) disconnecting ac power from motor leads and connecting the motor to a load resistor. dharm d:N-MachMac3-2.pm5 108
  • 126. Starters for Wound Rotor Induction Motors 4.1 INTRODUCTION The rotor of a wound rotor induction motor is wound with three phase windings. The windings are star connected, the three terminals are taken out and connected to slip rings mounted on the shaft. Connections are then tapped through brushes mounted on the slip rings. This motor is also commonly known as slip ring induction motor. The purpose of taking out the three rotor terminals is to connect extra resistance in the rotor circuit. Connection of resistance in the rotor circuit limits the current drawn by motor and also the torque speed characteristic of the motor changes. Extra resistance in the rotor circuit may be added to obtain high starting torque and also to control the speed of the motor. To see how variation of rotor circuit resistance effects the torque slip characteristic, let us assume that for a particular induction motor its rotor resistance is 1 ohm and rotor reactance is 10 ohm. Let us assume that the rotor resistance is made 1, 2, 6 and 10 ohm respectively. The rotor standstill reactance x20 = 10 ohm will remain constant since x20 is fixed by the design of rotor. The torque equation for an induction motor is given by : KSR2 T= 2 R2 + S 2 X 20 2 where K is a constant. We assume that value of K = 100 and find magnitude of torque at different values of slip for (R2 = 1, X20 = 10), (R2 = 2, X20 = 10), (R2 = 6, X20 = 10) and (R2 = 10, X20 = 10), the results are shown in Table 4.1. Torque slip characteristic for different values of rotor circuit resistance are plotted as per values shown in Table 4.1. Torque slip speed characteristic for four different values of rotor circuit resistance have been drawn together for the sake of comparison as shown in Fig. 4.1. 109
  • 127. 110 CONTROL OF MACHINES Table 4.1 Calculated values of torque at different slips having variable rotor resistance SLIP Torque for Torque for Torque for Torque for S R2 = 1, X20 = 10 R2 = 2, X20 = 10 R2 = 6, X20 = 10 R2 = 10, X20 = 10 0.01 0.99 0.49 0.16 0.09 0.02 1.92 0.99 0.33 0.199 0.05 4.0 2.35 0.82 0.49 0.1 5.0 4.0 1.62 0.99 0.15 4.6 4.8 2.35 1.46 0.2 4.0 5.0 3.0 1.92 0.3 3.0 4.61 4.0 2.75 0.4 2.35 4.0 4.61 3.45 0.5 1.92 3.45 4.92 4.0 0.6 1.62 3.0 5.0 4.41 0.7 1.40 2.64 4.94 4.69 0.8 1.23 2.35 4.8 4.87 0.9 1.09 2.11 4.61 4.97 1.0 0.99 1.92 4.41 5.0 R2 = 10, X20 = 10 5 D C R2 = 6, X20 = 10 4 B 3 R2 = 2, X20 = 10 A Torque 2 R2 = 1, X20 = 10 T1 Load torque 1 0 .1 .2 .3 .4 .5 .6 .7 .8 .9 1.0 N1 N2 N3 Slip (Standstill) Fig. 4.1 Effect of variation of rotor circuit resistance on torque slip characteristic of an induction motor Curve A, B, C and D are plotted by rotor resistance of 1, 2, 6 and 10 ohms. The dotted line shows the load torque required from the motor. This line intersects the characteristic A, B, C and D at four different points in the stable region of their characteristic. The following observations can be made from the above : (i) The starting torque for rotor resistance of 1 ohm is less than the torque requirement of the load connected on the motor. Therefore the motor will not be able to start from standstill (refer curve A). (ii) Starting torque increases with increase in value of rotor resistance. Refer curves B, C and D. dharm d:N-MachMac4-1.pm5 110
  • 128. STARTERS FOR WOUND ROTOR INDUCTION MOTORS 111 (iii) The slip at which maximum torque occurs varies with the variation of rotor resist- ance. For rotor resistance of 1 ohm maximum torque occurs near synchronous speed, while for R2 = 10 ohm i.e., R2 = X20 maximum torque occurs at standstill. (iv) The value of the maximum torque developed remains constant but only the slip at which it occurs varies with the variation of rotor circuit resistance. (v) Torque is maximum when the rotor resistance X2 = SX20 is equal to the rotor resist- ance R2. (In graph A for example, maximum torque occurs when S = 0.1 and for graph D, where R2 = 10 ohm and X20 = 10 ohm maximum torque occurs when S = 1. (vi) The motor can be run at different speed with a particular load connected on the motor shaft, say T1 as shown in Fig. 4.1. The motor will run at speed N1 if rotor resistance is 2 ohms, at speed N2 if rotor resistance is 6 ohm and at speed N3 if rotor resistance is 10 ohm. From the last observation, it is seen that if initially, 10 ohm resistance is connected in the rotor circuit, the motor will develop maximum torque at starting. If the load on the motor is T1, the motor will quickly accelerate to its final speed N3. If now it is desired to increase the speed to N2 rotor resistance is decreased to a value of 6 ohms. Further, higher speed N1 is possible if the rotor resistance is decreased to 2 ohms. Thus it is seen that variable speed is possible by changing the rotor circuit resistance. The value of resistance to be connected in the rotor circuit is selected depending upon how much starting torque is required, A starting torque of 1.5 to 2 times the connected load is generally acceptable for most drives for smooth acceleration. The resistance to be connected in the rotor circuit should be of continuous rating, if the motor is desired to be run at intermediate speeds for long duration. Resistance of short time rating can be used if the rotor resistance is to be used only for starting where the resistance is cut off rapidly. 4.2 MOTOR ACCELERATION To accelerate a slip ring induction motor from standstill to full speed with full load, resistance connected in the rotor circuit is cut out in steps. During acceleration it is required that current and torque peaks are restricted to reasonable limit. Limitation of current peaks is necessary to prevent excessive line voltage drop and also overstressing of the switching devices. Limitation of torque peaks is required to prevent overstressing of the mechanical parts of the driven machinery. Figure 4.2 shows connection of a slip-ring induction motor with extra resistance in the rotor circuit. To accelerate the motor smoothly, first the contacts 1 should close and energise the stator winding with whole of resistance in the rotor circuit. The total value of resistance should be such as to limit the torque and current to 1.5. to 2.00 times the full-load values. These values, however, would depend upon the type of load connected and the permissible current limit. The motor should accelerate according to the torque versus speed curves shown in Fig. 4.3. When the main contacts 1 close, starting torque equal to 1.5 times full load, equal to OA in Fig. 4.3 is developed. The motor will accelerate along curve AB. When motor torque balances the full load torque at point B the contacts 2 should close and thereby cutting off resistance R1 from the rotor circuit. As the resistance is cut off the motor should again develop higher torque with resistance (R3 – R1) in circuit and the accelerate along curve CD. At point D, contacts 3 should close to cut off resistance R2 from the rotor circuit. Motor will now accelerate along curve EF and reach about 80% of Synchronous speed at point F. At this instant contact 4 should close to cut-off the remaining resistance. Now, the whole of resistance R3 is cut-off. The motor will now develop torque equal to point G and then accelerate along curve GH. Now the dharm d:N-MachMac4-1.pm5 111
  • 129. 112 CONTROL OF MACHINES L1 L2 L3 1 R3 R2 R1 M 3~ 4 3 2 4 3 2 Fig. 4.2 Connection scheme for starting of wound rotor induction motor 1.5 TFL A C E G TFL B D F H Torque 0 20% 40% 60% 80% 100% Speed Fig. 4.3 Torque-speed curves during the period of acceleration of a slip-ring motor has fully accelerated and only rotor winding resistance is in the circuit. The motor runs at a speed near synchronous speed. The Motor can be made to run at any intermediate speed, say at point B, i.e., at 40% of the synchronous speed with resistance R1 cut off, resistance remaining in the circuit being equal to (R3 – R1). The acceleration of motor according to the curves in Fig. 4.3, may be obtained perfectly, by using an automatic magnetic controller. Achievement of acceleration with a drum switch or a face-plate starter should depend upon the judgement of the operator where the operator would cut off the resistance by judging the dharm d:N-MachMac4-1.pm5 112
  • 130. STARTERS FOR WOUND ROTOR INDUCTION MOTORS 113 speed of the motor. The torque or current versus time characteristic and speed versus time characteristics during acceleration are shown in Fig. 4.4. 1.5 Torque or current F.L A C E G F.L H B D F 0 t1 t2 t3 t4 (a) Speed 0 t1 t2 t3 t4 (b) Time Fig. 4.4 (a) Torque/current versus time characteristic during acceleration (b) Speed versus time characteristic during acceleration In Fig. 4.4 (a) the torque or current versus time characteristic has been shown. The motor reaches its final speed in time t4. The exact shape of the curve AB, CD etc. depend upon the type of load connected to the motor. In Fig. 4.4 (b) the rise of speed with respect to time has been shown. The speed rises exponentially with respect to time as shown. It must be noted from Fig. 4.4 that during acceleration, the motor takes comparatively less time to reach full- load torque from the instant of cutting of a resistance step. 4.3 MANUAL FACE PLATE STARTER This is the oldest and simplest type of wound rotor motor controller.The rotor resistance consists of three legs which are connected to each of the motor phase windings. The spider like contact arm, also consisting of three legs form the star point (see Fig. 4.5). Turning of the contact arm moves the star point along the resistor sections and thus varies the amount of resistance in each of the rotor phases. The extra rotor circuit resistance used may be of either short time rating or of continuous duty depending upon whether the controller is to be used as a starter only or also for speed control. In this scheme, the time allowed for the motor to accelerate and the resulting current peaks depends entirely upon the skill of the operator i.e., how he manipulates the controller. In this starter the stator winding is energised through a magnetic contactor and an over-load relay. The starter, thus combines the use of magnetic control and manual control. Wiring diagram for the starter has been shown in Fig. 4.5 (a) and the control diagram in schematic form in Fig. 4.5 (b). dharm d:N-MachMac4-1.pm5 113
  • 131. 114 CONTROL OF MACHINES Fig. 4.5 Manual face-plate starter (a) Power diagram (b) Schematic control diagram Interlocking provided in the starter permits the motor to be started only when whole of the controller resistance is in the circuit. This is obtained by using an auxiliary contact of controller in series with the ON-push button. When controller handle is in the position shown in Fig. 4.5 (a), the whole of controller resistance is in the rotor circuit. At this position the handle keeps the auxiliary contact closed. When the handle is moved in anti-clockwise direction, this contact opens. The operation of starter is explained as follows : When the ON-push button is pressed contactor M will get energised if the auxiliary contact ‘a’ of controller, which is in series with ON-push button, is closed i.e., if the whole of the controller resistance is in the rotor circuit. The contactor M remains energised through its auxiliary contact M1 bypassing the auxiliary contact interlocking [(see Fig. 4.5 (b)]. With the closing of contactor M, the motor starts with full controller resistance in the circuit. The controller resistance is now gradually cut out from the three rotor phases by moving the handle in anti-clockwise direction from step 1 to step 4. At step 4, the whole of the resistance is cut out and the motor runs at its final speed. The time for acceleration depends entirely upon the judgement of the operator. The motor stops when OFF-push button is pressed or the overload trips causing de-energisation of contactor M. When the motor is to be started again the controller handle has to be brought to initial position again as shown in Fig. 4.5 (a). Face plate starters are simple in construction and have low cost but they lack sturdiness and are unsatisfactory for frequent operations. This disadvantage is overcome by drun switches. The rotary sliding contact fingers are mounted on a drum shaft and they make contact with stationary contact fingers when the drum shaft is rotated. The springs of the moving contacts maintain better and more uniform contact force. In a drum switch controller the magnetic contactor for the starter can also be eliminated by having the main contacts on the drum controller itself. Drum switches may be designed for reversing the motor also. Drum switches, are however, often used in conjunction with a magnetic contactor which facilitates inclusion of overload protection or any other pilot device for the control of the motor. dharm d:N-MachMac4-1.pm5 114
  • 132. STARTERS FOR WOUND ROTOR INDUCTION MOTORS 115 4.4 MANUAL STARTER USING MASTER CONTROLLERS An important application of slip-ring induction motor controlled by a master controller is in over-head cranes. A master controller, as discussed earlier while dealing with control components, is a switch which has got plastic cams on a rotating shaft. The control contacts are so mounted that cams can activate them. When the shaft containing the cams is rotated by a lever, either in left or right direction particular set of contacts get actuated at different positions of the lever. Master controllers will have lever movement in one direction only if the motor is to be run in only one direction. Figure 4.6 shows in tabular form various positions of the lever (OFF, 1, 2, 3, 4) in the first column. The corresponding state of the control contacts (0, 1, 2, 3, 4) are shown by X and O. A X below a contact denotes that the contact is closed and O denotes that the contact its open. Lever Control contacts OFF 1 2 position 0 1 2 3 4 3 OFF X 0 0 0 0 4 1 0 X 0 0 0 2 0 X X 0 0 3 0 X X X 0 4 0 X X X X (a) (b) Fig. 4.6 Pictorial view of a master controller and table showing control contact position at various lever positions Now, we will examine how this master controller is used to run a slip ring induction motor at four different speeds. Control contacts 0, 1, 2, 3, 4 will be used to energise contactors which will ultimately cut off a resistance step from the rotor circuit. The power diagram for the motor to be controlled and associated control scheme have been shown in Fig. 4.7 (a) and 4.7 (b) respectively. As shown in Fig. 4.7 (b), the control relay CR can be energised by pressing ON-push button if the lever of the master controller is in OFF-position i.e., contact 0 is closed. In any other position of the lever this contact is open and therefore the control circuit cannot be switched ON. After switching on the control circuit when operator moves the lever to position 1 contact 0 opens and contact 1 closes thereby energising the main contactor M. The motor starts with all the resistance in the rotor circuit. A high starting torque is developed and the motor reaches a speed which depends upon the value of resistance in the circuit. When lever is moved further to position 2, contact 2 closes and energises contactor A. Contactor A cuts off resistance R1 from the rotor circuit and the motor accelerates to a higher speed. At position 3 of master controller, control contact 3 closes and energises contactor B. Closing of contactor B shorts another step of resistance resulting in resistance R2 out of the rotor circuit and the motor accelerating to a further higher speed. Finally at position 4 master controller contact 4 closes and energises contactor C when whole of the resistance is cut out from rotor circuit. The motor thus accelerates to its final speed. In actual circuits using Master Controllers, time delay relay contacts are also used in series with master controller contact so that even if the operator moves the handle directly from OFF-position to position 4 the resistance shorting contactor A, B and C would get energised after certain delay of time as set on the time delay relays. The actual control circuit using master controller and time delay relays for an over-head crane will be discussed in a subsequent chapter. dharm d:N-MachMac4-1.pm5 115
  • 133. 116 CONTROL OF MACHINES L1 L2 L3 P M R3 0 1 2 3 4 R2 ON CR1 M R1 3~ CR M A B C C B A N 0, 1, 2, 3, 4 are master C B A controller contacts (b) (a) Fig. 4.7 Manual starter for slip ring induction motor using master controller (a) Power circuit diagram (b) Control circuit diagram 4.5 AUTOMATIC CONTROL OF ACCELERATION In automatic control the resistance steps in the rotor circuit of a slip ring induction motor are cut off by energising number of contactors in proper sequence, after closing of the line contactor. As discussed earlier, the accelerating contactor should close when motor has accelerated on the preceding step to such a speed that closing of contactor does not cause resulting torque and current peaks to exceed the pre-determined limit. Refer to the curves in Fig. 4.4 (b). The accelerating contactors should close at time intervals of t1, t2, t3. There may be three types of magnetic controls depending upon the criterion used for closing of the accelerating contactors. They are : (i) Definite time control: The closing of acceleration contactors takes place after defi- nite time period in sequence. The timings are adjusted to restrict current peaks within limits. (ii) Current limit control: The accelerating contactors close when the current peak falls back to a pre set lower limit with the help of current limit relays. (iii) Secondary frequency control: Frequency response relays are used to close the actuating contactors as the motor reaches pre-determined speeds. 4.5.1 Definite Time Limit Starter In definite time limit starters, the accelerating contactors close after pre-set delays determined by the timers. The time periods are so adjusted that when a resistance step is cut off, the resulting current peaks remain within limits. The time delay between energisation of successive accelerating contactors can be obtained by using any of the following types of time delay elements : (i) Individual timers, either pneumatic or electronic for each step; (ii) Motor driven cam timer; (iii) Timer heads mounted on contactors; and (iv) Flux decay relays. dharm d:N-MachMac4-1.pm5 116
  • 134. STARTERS FOR WOUND ROTOR INDUCTION MOTORS 117 Control circuits for all the above are discussed one by one as follows. The power diagram, however, would remain the same for all these control circuits. While studying all these control circuits it would be essential to refer back to the power diagram shown in Fig. 4.8. L1 L2 L3 M R4 R3 R2 M R1 3~ D C B A D C B A Fig. 4.8 Power diagram for automatic control of acceleration of a slip ring induction motor 4.5.1.1 Control Circuit Using Individual Time for Each Step Explanation of the control circuit: Pressing of ON-push button energises control relay CR. Contactor M and timer 1T also get energised as contact CR2 closes. Contactor M starts CR2 P D2 D1 4T OFF ON CR1 1T 2T 3T D1 CR M 1T A 2T B 3T C 4T D N Fig. 4.9 Control circuit for a slip-ring induction motor starter using individual timers dharm d:N-MachMac4-1.pm5 117
  • 135. 118 CONTROL OF MACHINES the motor with full resistance in the rotor circuit. When timer 1T times out its delayed contact 1T closes to energise contactor A and timer 2T. Energisation of contactor A causes cutting off of resistance R1 from the three rotor phases. When timer 2T times out its contact 2T closes to energise contactor B which shorts second step of resistance i.e., R2 and the motor accelerates further. Along with contactor B timer 3T also gets energised which after its pre-set delay energises contactor C. Contactor C shorts resistance R3. Timer 4T gets energised along with contactor C and when it operates, it energises contactor D which shorts the remaining resistance of the rotor circuit i.e., now, the whole of the resistance R4 is cut off from the circuit. When contactor D energises it gets hold through its contact D3 while its contact D2 opens and de- energises contactor A, B and C and timer 1T, 2T, 3T, 4T. 4.5.1.2 Control Circuit Using a Motor Driven Cam Timer Explanation of the control circuit: A double element start push button is used to energise the main contactor M and cam timer motor C. Main contactor gets hold through its contact M1 and contact M2 connects control supply to the accelerating contactor circuit as shown in Fig. 4.10 (a). The starting position of cam timer is as shown in Fig. 4.10 (b). In this position contact ‘0’ of cam timer is in actuated position. As normally closed (NC) contact of ‘0’ has been used, in starting position contact ‘0’ is open. When START-push button is pressed, the cam timer motor gets energised and it rotates the cam shaft in the direction shown in Fig. 4.10 (b). First of all contact ‘0’ gets de-actuated. Supply to cam motor gets hold through’ closed contact ‘0’ and therefore push button can now be released. When motor shaft rotates further, cams 1, 2, 3, 4 actuate the respective contacts after fixed time intervals set by protruding portions on the cams. Resistance shorting contactors A, B, C and D are energised through the closing of contact 1, 2, 3 and 4. Last of all contactor D is energised through closing of timer contact 4 and Fig. 4.10 (a) Control circuit for a slip-ring induction motor starter using a motor driven cam timer (b) Schematic representation of a motor driven cam timer dharm d:N-MachMac4-1.pm5 118
  • 136. STARTERS FOR WOUND ROTOR INDUCTION MOTORS 119 gets hold through its own contact D1. At the same time opening of contact D2 de-energises, contactors A, B and C. Cam timer motor also gets de-energised when after a full rotation contact ‘0’ is actuated. Contact ‘0’ opens and supply to cam timer motor is cut off. Cam timer rests in this position till the START-push button is pressed again. 4.5.1.3 Control Circuit Using Contactor with Timer Head Explanation of the control circuit: In this circuit, timer heads (Pneumatically operated) are mounted on the contactors. When a contactor is energised, the plunger of the timer is also attracted along with contactor plunger. Contactor contacts close immediately while timer head mounted on contactors closes its contact after the pre-set time delay, set on the timer head. Variation in operating time obtained is, however, small by using the timer heads. In the above control circuit the motor starts with full resistances, when the ON-push button is pressed. Timer head of contactor M operates after pre-set delay and its contact M1 closes to energise the accelerating contactor A. Contactor A shorts a set of resistance of the rotor circuit. Timer head A closes after some delay and energises contactor B. This goes on till the last contactor D is energised. Fig. 4.11 Control circuit for a slip-ring induction motor starter using contactors with timer heads 4.5.1.4 Control Circuit Using Flux Delay Relays Explanation of the control circuit: When switch S is closed the control transformer is energised. The secondary voltage is rectified by a bridge rectifier. D.C. supply so obtained is given to flux-delay relays AX, BX, CX and DX. In these relays flux decays slowly when their coils are de-energised. The relay contacts come to their normal de-energised condition with a delay of time which depends on the rate of decay of flux. In this circuit, initially all the relays AX, BX, CX, DX are in energised condition through normally closed (NC) contact of contactor M,A, B, C and D. The contacts of these relays AX2, BX2, CX2, DX2 are therefore open. When motor is started by pressing the ON-push button contactor M gets hold through its contact M2 while its NC contact M1 opens and de-energises relay AX. Relay AX gets de-energised instantly but its contact AX2 closes, when flux becomes zero after some time delay. Closing of contact AX2 energises accelerating contactor A. Thus first step of resistance gets cut off from the rotor circuit due to closing of contactor A. Its contact A1 opens and de-energises relay BX. Also contact A2 closes in the coil circuit of contactor B, After pre-set delay of relay BX, its contact dharm d:N-MachMac4-1.pm5 119
  • 137. 120 CONTROL OF MACHINES BX2 closes and energises contactor B. Thus second step of resistances is also cut off from rotor circuit. The same sequence of operations follows for energisation of contactor C and D. P S OFF M1 A1 B1 C1 ON M2 AX2 A2 B2 C2 BX2 CX2 DX2 AX BX CX DX M A B C D N Fig. 4.12 Control circuit for a slip-ring induction motor starter using flux-delay relays 4.5.2 Current Limit Acceleration Starter In this type of starter, the accelerating contactor closes depending upon the amount of stator/ rotor current. Accelerating contactors are energised when current peak falls to a pre-determined value equal to full-load current. Refer to Fig. 4.4 (a) at points B, D, F and H the acclerating contactors are energised and they cut off resistance in steps. A current limit acceleration starter uses a special relay known as current limit relay. This relay has two coil viz. a potential coil and a current coil. The current coil restrains the relay from operating when current through the coil is more than the pre-set value. As the current through the current coil drops to the pre-set value, the relay operates provided, however, the potential coil is also energised.If the potential coil is not energised, the relay would not function. The current coil of the current limit relay is energised by a current transformer provided on one phase of the stator line connections. The control diagram is shown in Fig. 4.13. From Current Transformer (C.T) P X(C) X(V) Y(C) Y(V) C2 D2 X1 A2 Y1 B2 OFF ON M1 M2 A3 B3 C3 A1 B1 C1 D1 M A B C D N Fig. 4.13 Control circuit for a current limit acceleration starter dharm d:N-MachMac4-1.pm5 120
  • 138. STARTERS FOR WOUND ROTOR INDUCTION MOTORS 121 One point to be understood before studying this control circuit is that, the auxiliary contacts of contactors are so adjusted that normally open (NO) contact closes before the normally closed (NC) contact opens. This provision is necessary for functinoning of the above control circuit: The motor is energised when the ON-push button is pressed and contactor M closes. Voltage coil X(V) of relay X is energised through closed contact A1 and M2. Coil of contactor A and X(V) are in series. Contactor A does not pick up as its coil impedance is high and the current flowing through the coil circuit is not sufficient for the contactor to pick up. Relay X would operate provided the required amount of current through the current coil X(C) flows. Initially when the motor is energised, high inrush current flows and therefore the current coil X (C) restrains the relay from operating. The relay operates when the current falls to a pre- determined lower value. When the relay operates its contact X1 closes and short the voltage coil X(V) while direct supply to contactor coil A gets applied. Contactor A closes and gets hold through its contact A2. Little later its contact A1 opens. Opening of A1 de-energises the voltage coil of relay X. Its contact X1 also opens. When contactor A closes, some resistance from rotor circuit gets cut off, now again an inrush of current takes place. Current coil Y(C) of relay Y restrains the relay Y from operating. Due to closing of contact A3 voltage coil Y(V) which is in series with coil of contactor B gets energised. Contactor B does not pick up as the voltage coil Y(V) is in series. When the motor accelerates, and current through current coil Y(C) comes to a lower pre-set value, relay Y operates and closes its contact Y1. Closure of contact Y1 energises contactor B which then gets hold through its own contact B2. Contact B1 opens and keeps the relay Y inoperative due to de-energisation of voltage coil Y(V). Contactor B shorts another set of resistance from the rotor circuit. Again there is a current peak. Relay X again comes into action, as its voltage coil X(V) gets energised through closing of contact B3. The contactor C will close when the relay operates as a result of current falling to a lower pre-set value. As contactor C closes, relay Y comes into operation due to closing of contact C3. When relay Y operates, accelerating contactor D is energised. These two relays X and Y may be used to energise any number of accelerating contactors. 4.5.3 Secondary Frequency Acceleration Starter When a wound rotor induction motor accelerates from standstill to final speed the rotor voltage drops from a maximum value at standstill to nearly zero value at final speed. The frequency of the rotor voltage also drops from line frequency at standstill to nearly zero at the final speed. Frequency of rotor induced emf, fr at any speed is a function of slip s, of the motor and is expressed as: fr = sf If line frequency is 50 Hz. then frequency of rotor voltage at a slip of 0.02 is, fr = 0.02 × 50 = 1 Hz. From the above, it is seen that the accelerating contactors may be made to close as a function of motor speed by using some relays which would respond to the rotor voltage and rotor frequency conditions. Frequency responsive relays 1F, 2F, 3F as shown in Fig. 4.14 (a), are connected in the secondary circuit. Each relay coil is connected through a capacitor to a potentiometer resistor, which in turn is connected across one leg of the starting resistor. The inductance of each relay coil in combination with the capacitor forms a series resonant circuit, allowing a high current flow within a certain frequency range, width of the frequency range being determined by the adjustment of the resistor. Frequency control relays 1F, 2F and 3F are tuned so that they would drop at a desired frequency below their series resonant frequency. For example relay 1F is resonant (minimum impedance) at 50 Hz but drops out at 45 Hz, relay 2F is resonant at 45 Hz but drops out at 30 Hz and relay 3F is resonance at 30 Hz but drops out at 15 Hz. The starter shown in Fig. 4.14 will operate in the following manner: dharm d:N-MachMac4-1.pm5 121
  • 139. 122 CONTROL OF MACHINES M 3~ C B A C B A 1F 50-45 Hz C1 2F 45-30 Hz C2 3F 30-15 Hz C3 P Stop M2 2F1 3F1 Start 1F1 M1 A1 B1 M A B C N Fig. 4.14 Control circuit for a rotor frequency acceleration starter (i) When the START-push button is pressed, the contactor M energises the stator and motor starts with full resistance in rotor circuit. At starting, relay 1F will pick up as its resonant frequency is 50 Hz. Its contact 1F1 opens. As the motor accelerates the rotor frequency drops. When the frequency falls to 45 Hz, the relay 1F drops, its contact 1F1 closes and energises contactor A. (ii) Energisation of contactor A cuts off one set of resistance from rotor circuit and the motor accelerates further. (iii) As the motor gains speed its rotor frequency falls. At 30 Hz the relay 2F drops and relay 3F picks up. As relay 2F drops its contact 2F1 closes and energises contactor B dharm d:N-MachMac4-1.pm5 122
  • 140. STARTERS FOR WOUND ROTOR INDUCTION MOTORS 123 which shorts another set of resistance. At the same time relay 3F picks up at 30 Hz and its (NC) contact 3F1 opens. (iv) The motor further gains speed and its frequency decreases to 15 Hz. At this fre- quency relay 3F drops. Its NC contact 3F1 closes and energises contactor C through already closed contact B1. Energisation of contactor C cuts off all the resistance from the rotor circuit and the motor accelerates to its final speed. In this scheme, the resistance steps get cut off quickly if the motor is lightly loaded i.e., if the motor gains speed quickly and thus its rotor frequency falls quickly, the respective relays would drop and the resistance steps would be cut off similarly. When the motor is heavily loaded it would gain speed slowly and the rotor frequency also would fall slowly and therefore the resistance steps would get cut off slowly. REVIEW QUESTIONS 1. Show the effect of variation of rotor circuit resistance on torque slip characteristic of a wound rotor induction motor. 2. Draw torque speed characteristic during the period of acceleration of a slip ring induction motor. 3. Explain whether wound rotor motors with secondary control or squirrel cage motors with pri- mary reduced voltage starting gives the higher starting torque. 4. Discuss Manual face plate starters for a slip ring induction motor. 5. Discuss working of definite time limit starter using (a) Individual timer (b) Motor driven cam timer. 6. What are flux delay relays ? How are they used for automatic acceleration of wound rotor motors ? 7. Discuss the working of current limit acceleration starter for slip ring induction motor. 8. Discuss rotor frequency acceleration starter for slip ring induction motor. 9. The rotor windings of a wound rotor induction motor are: (a) Star connected and three terminals taken out (b) Delta connected and three terminals taken out (c) Not connected inside and all the six terminals are taken out 10. In wound rotor induction motors, when rotor reistance is increased, the starting torque: (a) decreases (b) increases (c) remains same 11. If rotor resistance of a wound rotor motor is 6 ohms and rotor resistance is 12 ohms, the maxi- mum torque will occur at: (a) starting (b) rated speed (c) half the rated speed (d) one fourth the rated speed 12. In wound rotor motors as the motor accelerates the rotor frequency: (a) decreases (b) increases (c) remains same 13. The starting current of wound rotor induction motor is in the range of: (a) 2.5 to 3 (b) 2.5 to 4 (c) 5 to 6 (d) 1 to 2 times the rated current. dharm d:N-MachMac4-1.pm5 123
  • 141. 5 Starters for Direct Current Motors In this chapter brief description of different types of dc motors and their fields of applications have been given. Principles of motor acceleration have been first discussed before dealing with different types of manual and automatic starters. 5.1 TYPES OF DC MOTORS AND THEIR APPLICATIONS DC motors are classified into three types depending on the way their field windings are excited. Field winding connections for the three types of dc motors have been shown in Fig. 5.1. V V V Shunt field Series stablising Series field field field M M M Shunt motor Series motor Compound motor (a) (b) (c) Fig. 5.1 Connections of field windings for different types of dc motors Brief description of different types of dc motors are given as follows: 5.1.1 Shunt Motor In this type of motor, the field winding is connected in parallel with armature as shown in Fig. 5.1(a). There are as many number of field coils as there are poles. When connected to supply, constant voltage appears across the field windings (as they are connected in parallel with armature). The field current is therefore constant and is independent of the load current. Shunt field winding usually are designed to have large number of turns of fine wire. Its resistance, therefore, is high enough to limit the shunt field current to about 1 to 4 percent of the rated motor current. A shunt motor operates at nearly constant speed over its normal load range. It has a definite stable no-load speed. The motor is adaptable to large speed variations. The disadvantage of the motor is that it has low starting torque and over-load torque capability. 5.1.2 Series Motor A series motor receives its excitation from a winding which is connected in series with the armature and carries load current. As the series field has to carry high load current, it is made 124
  • 142. STARTERS FOR DIRECT CURRENT MOTORS 125 of a thick wire and a few turns. As the resistance is low, the voltage drop across the series winding is small. This motor has excellent starting and over-load torque characteristics. The disadvantages are that the motor attains dangerously high speed at no-load. Speed adjustment of the motor is somewhat difficult. 5.1.3 Compound Motor In compound motors excitation results from combined action of both shunt field winding and series field winding. Fig. 5.1(c) shows the winding connections with the series field of the compound motor carrying the armature current(the long-shunt connection). In the short-shunt connection, which is sometimes used, the shunt field is directly connected in parallel with the armature, in which case, the series field current is the same as the line current. Excitation of a compound motor is a combination of series and shunt excitation. The motor, therefore, has mixed characteristic between that of a series motor and a shunt motor. This motor behaves somewhat better than a shunt motor from the point of view of starting and overload torque; and has definite stable no-load speed like a shunt motor. Speed of this motor is adjustable as easily as that of a shunt motor. It’s speed, however, tends to change as much as 25 percent between full-load and no-load due to the effect of series winding. A brief description of some special field windings used in modern motors for corrective influence upon the operation of the motor under load is given as follows. These field windings are called corrective fields. Their purpose is to reduce the effects of armature reaction such as poor commutation, instability at high speeds, and commutator flashover under conditions of suddenly applied overloads. Interpole windings are most widely used corrective field windings. Interpole windings are connected permanently in series with the armature circuit. This field maintains the magnetic neutral axis in the same position under all load conditions and thereby permits the motor to commutate well i.e., without sparking at the brushes. Stabilising field winding is used only in shunt motors that are made to operate at high speeds by shunt-field weakening. This a series field winding placed directly over the shunt winding whose moderate flux tends to prevent run away operation or instability that may result from the demagnetising effect of armature reaction. Compensating winding is placed in slots or holes in the main pole faces. This winding is also connected in series with the armature circuit. This winding creates a magnetic field that tends to offset the armature reaction which acts to distort the flux-density distribution under the pole faces. If this flux distortion is left uncorrected, it would increase the probability of flashover between brushes under conditions of suddenly applied overloads. 5.2 PRINCIPLES OF DC MOTOR ACCELERATION In any motor, whether ac or dc both motor and generator action takes place simultaneously. This would become clear when we examine how torque is produced and how the armature current gets regulated automatically depending upon varying load requirements of the motor. In a dc motor when supply voltage is impressed at the motor terminals current flows through the armature conductors placed in the magnetic field. Interaction of magnetic field and armature conductors carrying current results in development of a force on the armature conductors. As a result the armature starts revolving (motor action). When the armature starts revolving its conductors cuts the magnetic field and an emf is generated in these conductors (generator action). This generated emf is also called counter emf as its polarity is opposite to dharm d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5 125
  • 143. 126 CONTROL OF MACHINES the polarity of the applied voltage. This generated counter emf exercises a limiting effect upon the armature current and causes the motor to adjust its speed automatically to meet the varying demands of the load. Armature current in a dc motor is directly proportional to the difference between the impressed armature voltage V and the counter emf E and inversely proportional to the armature circuit resistance Ra. The equation for armature current can, therefore, be written as V–E IA = ...(1) Ra At the instant when motor is switched on by application of voltage to motor terminals the armature is at rest and therefore the counter emf generated in armature is zero. The expression for counter emf E E = K φ ZN (2) where φ = Field flux Z = number of conductors N = speed in rpm From equation (1) and (2) it can be seen that when the armature is at rest i.e., when N is equal to zero, the armature current, also called inrush current, is V I A in rush = Ra This inrush current will normally be very high as armature resistance of dc machine is generally very small. For example a 230 V, 10 hp, 500 rpm motor with full load current of 37 A has an armature resistance of about 0.4 ohms. The starting current or the inrush current for this motor is therefore equal to 230 I inrush = = 575 A 0.4 As the horse-power rating of motor increases, the values of armature resistance decreases resulting in very high inrush currents. A 75 hp motor, having armature resitance of the order of 0.06 ohm will have inrush current of 3833 Amps. Actually, however, inrush current would be somewhat less than the above calculated values because the armature inductance would somewhat delay the current built up and during this time the armature would start rotating and developing some counter emf. Such high currents during starting are undesirable as they may cause damage to the commutator and result in high line voltage drops. Repeated starting and stopping of a motor may also damage the armature winding which is designed for full-load currents. If high inrush currents during starting are to be avoided an external resistance should be connected in the armature circuit of the motor. As the motor accelerates this external resistance also called as accelerating resistance may be cut out (or short-circuited) in steps. When the whole of resistance is cut off, armature of the motor gets directly connected across the line and runs at full speed. Fig. 5.2 (a, b) shows how external resistance can be cut off manually in steps in a manual starter and shorted by contactors in an automatic starter. As seen from Fig. 5.2 the accelerating resistance is cut out (or short circuited) in several steps, each of which is so chosen that the maximum current or the torque peaks during acceleration are adjusted on the basis of good commutation and torque requirements of the driven mechanical load. The value of the total accelerating resistance is so selected as to permit dharm d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5 126
  • 144. STARTERS FOR DIRECT CURRENT MOTORS 127 the armature take about 125 to 175 per cent of the rated current so that the motor is capable of starting on load. Shunt field c b d a e M – L2 L1 + (a) Shunt field A B C D M L1 + – L2 (b) Fig. 5.2 Cutting off of armature resistance of dc shunt motor (a) Manually (b) Automatically To further understand the behaviour of a motor during the accelerating period, it would be useful to consider the operating characteristic of a shunt motor. Fig. 5.2 (a) has shown a five-step manual starter (with four accelerating resistors). Assume that accelerating resistance steps have been selected such that the inrush current peaks would be limited to 1.5 IA where IA is the full load armature current and also that a resistance step would be cut out when current drops to IA as the motor accelerates. At the instant the starter arm is moved to position a, (refer to Fig. 5.2 (a)) there will be an initial current inrush of 1.5IA , the motor will then accelerate along the line aa as shown in Fig. 5.3 (a) and would theoretically continue to attain 100 per cent speed provided the mechanical load on the motor is zero. However as the motor accelerates due to the opposing induced emf in the armature, currents would drop. When current drops to IA and the arm is moved to point b on the starter, the armature current will again rise to 1.5 IA and mortor would be accelerating along curve bb′. At point b′ when motor current again falls to IA starter arm is moved to point C, another step of resistance is cut off and the motor would continue to accelrate along curve cc′. Finally when the arm has reached the last position and all the accelerating resitance are cut off, the motor would reach its final speed and draw the normal full load current IA. Since in a manual starter the movement of the starter handle from one position to another depends upon the skill of the operator, it would be difficult to maintain the operation according to the curve of Fig. 5.3 (a). However, this sequence and manner of current change and motor acceleration can be maintained in an automatic starter using four contactors A, B, C and D and suitable control circuit associated with these contactors. Several types of control schemes may be designed for this operation. The nature of dharm d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5 127
  • 145. 128 CONTROL OF MACHINES variation of armature current with time during acceleration has been shown in Fig. 5.3 (b) which assumes that the motor would develop rated torque after each accelerating period i.e., when its current falls to IA at points ta , tb , tc , td , and te. The motor will, however, develop more than rated torque while it is accelerating between two consecutive time periods. It is seen from the graph that the time periods decrease gradually i.e., tb – ta tc – tb td – tc te – td . The speed time graph of Fig. 5.3 (c) shows how the motor accelerated smoothy from zero to final speed without any sudden and violent jerks. This kind of smooth acceleration is particularly desirable on certain installations. In other installations where rapid speed-up is either desirable or permissible and where high current inrushes are not objectionable, comparatively few accelerating setps may be used. Small dc motors up to 2 to 3 hp ratings and in certain special installations motors having ratings as high as 7.5 hp can be started directly from the lines without having any external resistance as high initial current in such installations are of short duration and the coupled loads are capable of withstanding sudden shock due to high torques developed. 1.5IA a b c d e Armature current IA a¢ b¢ c¢ d¢ 0 Percent of Non-load R.P.M. 100 (a) Current vs speed curves 1.5IA IA 0 ta tb tc td te Time (b) Current vs time curves c¢ R.P.M. b¢ a¢ Time (c) Speed vs time curves Fig. 5.3 Shunt motor acceleration dharm d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5 128
  • 146. STARTERS FOR DIRECT CURRENT MOTORS 129 5.3 MANUAL STARTERS FOR DC MOTORS Various types of manual face plate dc motor commonly known as two-point, three-point, four- point starters are available. These types of starters are described as follows: A degree of similarity exists among these starters. All have a face plate rotary switch with a connected group of current limiting resistors. The differences lie in the form of protection they contain. 5.3.1 Two-point Starter A two-point starter is used for starting a dc motor which has the problem of over-speeding due to loss of load from its shaft. Such a starter is shown in Fig. 5.4. Starting Series resistance field OFF Soft iron ON F M Control arm L Spring Hold on D.C. Supply electromagnet Fig. 5.4 Two-point starter for a dc series motor Here for starting the motor, the control arm is moved clock-wise from its OFF position to the ON position against the spring tension. The control arm is held in the ON position by an electromagnet. The hold-on electromagnet is connected in series with the armature circuit. If the motor loses its load, current decreases and hence the strength of the electromagnet also decreases. The control arm returns to the OFF position due to spring tension, thus preventing the motor from overspeeding. The starter arm also returns to the OFF-position when the supply voltage decrease appreciably. L and F are the two points of the starter which are connected with the supply and motor terminals. 5.3.2 Three-point Starter A three-point starter is used for starting a dc shunt or compound motor. The coil of the hold-on electromagnet is connected in series with the shunt-field coil. Such a starter is shown in Fig. 5.5. A F OFF ON M D.C. L Supply Fig. 5.5 Three-point starter for a dc shunt or compound motor In case of disconnection in the field circuit due to internal failure or field-rheostat failure, the control arm will return to its OFF position due to spring tension. This is necessary because the shunt motor will overspeed in the same manner as the series motor if it loses its field excitation. The starter also returns to the OFF position in case of low supply voltage or complete failure of supply voltage. This protection is therefore called No Volt Release (NVR). Over-load protection for the motor can be incorporated by connecting another electromagnetic coil in dharm d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5 129
  • 147. 130 CONTROL OF MACHINES series with the armature. When the motor is overloaded it draws a heavy current. This heavy current also flows through the electromagnetic coil. The electromagnet then pulls an iron piece upwards which short-circuits the coils of the hold-on electomagnet (NVR coil, see Fig. 5.6). The hold-on electromagnet gets de-energised and therfore the starter arm returns to the OFF position, thus, protecting the motor against overload. The complete circuit connection for a three-point starter with NVR and Over Load Release (OLR) is shown in Fig. 5.6. It is to be noted that points L, A, and F are the three terminals of a three-point starter. Use of a brass arc, as shown in the figure, enables connection of the field circuit directly with the supply instead of via the starter resistance. OFF ON A1 Brass arc A NVR M L OLR F F1 D.C. Moving F2 A2 Supply iron Fig. 5.6 A three-point starter with No Volt Release (NVR) and Over Load Release (OLR) arrangement A three-point starter may not be suitable where a large field current adjustment by using a field regulator is needed. This may cause weaking of the field current to such an extent that the hold-on electromagnet may not be able to keep the starter arm in the ON position. This may therfore disconnect the motor from the supply when it is not desired. Such a problem is overcome by using a four-point starter. 5.3.3 Four-point Starter The disadvantage of a three-point starter as mentioned above is overcome in a four-point starter by connecting the hold-on coil across the line instead of in series with the shunt-field circuit. This makes a wide range of field adjustments possible. The connection diagram for a four-point starter is shown in Fig. 5.7. In a four-point starter, therefore, when the starter arm touches the starting resistance, current from the supply is divided into three paths. One through the starting resistance and armature, one through the field circuit, and one through the NVR coil. A protective resistance is connected in series with the NVR coil. Since in a four-point starter the NVR coil is independent of the field-circuit connection, the dc motor may overspeed if for some reason there should be a break in the field circuit. It is, therefore, recommended that before starting a dc motor the field circuit be checked against an open circuit. A dc motor should be stopped by opening the main switch rather than by throwing back manually the starting arm to the OFF position. If the starting arm is thrown back manually, the field circuit suddenly gets opened. The electromagnetic energy stored in the field gets discharged through the OFF contact button of the starter in the form of an arc, thereby gradually burning the contact. On the other hand if the motor is stopped by opening the main switch, the electormagnetic energy of the field circuit gets slowly discharged through the armature. The starting resistance used in various types of starters is cut out of the circuit in steps while starting a motor. The steps of the starting resistance are so designed that the armature current dharm d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5 130
  • 148. STARTERS FOR DIRECT CURRENT MOTORS 131 will remain within certain limits and will not change the torque developed by the motor to great extent. ON A OFF NVR F L M OLR L D.C. Protective Supply resistance Fig. 5.7 A four-point starter with NVR and OLR arrangement So far, face plate starters have been discussed. The same type of control as achieved with a face-plate starter can be obtained with a drum-rotary-switch starter. The durm switch has the advantage of being able to handle a large current and therefore is suitable for motors with high ratings. Current-limiting starting resistors are not part of the drum switch and they may be made as large as possible which are rated to carry current continuously. (In a conventinoal starter, the starting resistors are rated to carry current for small durations of time. This reduces the size of the resistances). As a result, the drum switch is able to control the motor continoulsy at intermediate or even at the lowest speed. Drum-rotary-switch starters are suitable for tram car-motor controls and for large crane-motor controls. Nowadays automatic motor-control starters are also available which can be operated by pressing push-buttons. The working of such automatic starters is as follows: Upon pressing an ON push-button, current-limiting starting resistors get connected in series with the armature circuit. Then some form of automatic control progressively disconnects these resistors unit full line-voltage is available to the armature circuit. On pressing an OFF push-button the system should get back to its original position. Protective devices, such as OLR, NVR, etc. are usually the same as that of a manual starter. Automatic starter circuits are designed using electromagnetic contactors and time-delay relays. 5.4 TYPES OF STARTERS FOR AUTOMATIC ACCELERATION From the discussions made in the earlier section it is clear that except for very small motors resistance must be connected in the armature circuit during starting period and then be cut- out (or short-circuited) progressively as the motor accelerates to the rated speed. The connection of accelerating resistors becomes necessary due to the following reasons: (i) to limit the inrush current (since high current would produce arcing at the brush sliding contacts and thus damage the commutator surface). (ii) to minimise line voltage drop due to excessive inrush of current; and (iii) to cause smooth acceleration of the driven machinery by avoiding undue mechanical stresses due to sudden application of high torques. There are many types of automatic starters for dc motors. They can be classified under the heading of three general methods of motor acceleration namely dharm d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5 131
  • 149. 132 CONTROL OF MACHINES (i) Direct-on-line acceleration (ii) Current limit acceleration (iii) Definite time acceleration Starters designed on the above three methods are discussed as follows: 5.4.1 Direct-on-line Starter Small dc motors can be started directly by connecting them across the lines as the magnitude of starting current drawn is not very high. Direct-on-line starting of dc motors is similar to ac two wire or three wire control. Some dc contactors have dual windings. These two windings are known as starting winding and holding winding. During closing of a contactor when a large magnetic pull is required, both the windings are energised. When the contactor is closed a small magnetic pull is sufficient to hold the contactor closed and therefore the starting winding is disconnected and only the holding winding drawing a small amount of current is kept energised. This type of design gives a longer life to the contactor as unnecessary overheating of coils is avoided. A direct-on-line starter with dual winding contactor coils has been shown in Fig. 5.8. Fig. 5.8 Direct on line starter for a dc motor which uses a dual winding contactor The armature has been shown connected directly across the lines i.e., without introducing any resistance in the armature circuit. When the START-push button is pressed, both the starting coil (1) and the holding coil (2) of contactor M get energised by getting supply through the START-push button and the normally NC contacts M2 of contactor M. As soon as the contactor closes, normally closed contact M2 will open and disconnect the starting coil 1 while the holding coil will remain enrgised by getting supply through holding contact M1 which has been connected in parallel with the START-push button. It may be understood that in this type of arrangement setting of NC contact M2 has to be so adjusted that it would open up when the contactor is almost in closed position. If due to some reason M2 fails to open the starting coil will aslo remain permanetly energised in which case the coil may get burnt due to over heating since this starting coil is not designed for continous rating. Another method used to start a dc motor is to connect a limiting resistor in series with the contactor coil when the contactor closes. This would avoid over-heating of the coil as the dharm d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5 132
  • 150. STARTERS FOR DIRECT CURRENT MOTORS 133 limiting resistor would allow only a small current sufficient to hold contactor closed. The control circuit for such a scheme has been shown in Fig. 5.9. + Stop Start M1 R1 M2 M – Fig. 5.9 Control circuit for direct on-line starting of a dc motor with a limiting resistor in contactor coil circuit When the START-push button is pressed, coil M receives maximum current required to close contacts through normally closed (NC) contact M2. When contactor is closed, M2 opens and M1 closes. Now coil remains energised through contact M1 and resistance R1. Thus the resistance limits the current to a value just sufficient to keep the contactor closed. 5.4.2 Current Limit Acceleration Starters In this type of starters the load (i.e., the current) will determine how rapidly a motor is to be brought to full speed. A lightly loaded motor may be brought to final speed more quickly than heavily loaded motor. This is made possible by utilizing the fact that rate of current change varies with the load. Inrush current drops faster with a lightly loaded motor and slower with a heavily loaded motor. In these starters, a set of series or current relays pick up and drop out on changing values of armature current which occurs as the motor accelerates and these relays in turn energise contactors to successively cut out (or short-circuit) resistors from the armature circuit. Current limit starters functioning on the basis of current change are of three types, viz (i) the series relay type (ii) the counter emf type and (iii) the lockout type. 5.4.2.1 Series Relay Starter This starter uses a dc series relay to sense changes in the armature current. The relay consists of a few turns of heavy wire and operates extremely fast as its armature is light in weight and is well balanced having a small air gap. A spring changes the contact position when current through the relay falls below the setting of the relay. Current setting of the relay can be adjusted by varying the spring tension. A series relay starter for a separately excited dc shunt motor has been shown in Fig. 5.10. In this starter the shunt winding has been shown separately excited and the interpole winding (I.W.) has been shown connected in series with the armature. Three resistances R1, R2 and R3 are also connected in series with the armature. Three series relays 1AR, 2AR and 3AR are also connected in the armature circuit. dharm d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5 133
  • 151. 134 CONTROL OF MACHINES L1 + M1 Stop Field coil M Start M2 I.W M3 R3 3A 1AR1 2AR1 3AR1 3AR R2 2A 2AR 1A1 2A1 R1 1A 1AR M 1A 2A 3A L2 – Fig. 5.10 Series relay starter circuit for separately excited dc shunt motor Before analysing the working of the control circuit of this starter two important points regarding the series relay and the main contactor should be throughly understood and kept in mind while reading the control diagram. (i) Auxiliary contacts (NO) of contactors M, 1A, 2A and 3A are set to close after some delay from the closing of their main contacts (i.e., power contacts) and (ii) Operation of series relay is much faster than contactors. Now we will discuss the working of the control circuit. When the START-push button is pressed, contactor M gets energised and first its main contact M1 closes. Motor starts with armature resistance R1, R2 and R3. The relay 1AR picks up and opens its normally closed (NC) contact 1AR1 in coil circuit of contactor 1A. After the contact 1AR1 has opened, auxiliary contacts M2 and M3 of contactor M would close and therefore contactor 1A cannot close. When the motor accelerates sufficiently and the motor current drops to normal value, relay 1AR drops, thus closing its contact 1AR1 and thereby energising contactor 1A. Main contacts of contactor 1A closes and shorts resistance R1. Now, second current inrush takes place as the motor accelerates with resistance R2 and R3 and series relay 2AR in circuit. Relay 2AR picks up and opens its contact 2AR1 before interlock contact 1A1 closes. As the motor accelerates further, again the armature current falls to normal and relay 2AR drops out and thus its contact 2AR1 closes and thereby energise contactor 2A. Main contacts of 2A shorts resistance R2. When resistance R2 gets shorted a third inrush of current takes place through R3 and relay 3AR. Relay 3AR picks up and opens its contact 3AR1 before contact 2A1 (interlock of contactor 2A) closes in the coil circuit of contactor 3A. Finally when the armature current falls again to normal value, relay 3AR drops out and closes its contact 3AR1 and therefore contactor 3A gets energised. Main contact of 3A shorts resistance R3. Now the armature gets connected directly to line and the motor accelerates to its final speed. dharm d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5 134
  • 152. STARTERS FOR DIRECT CURRENT MOTORS 135 5.4.2.2 Counter emf Starter These starters are economical and perform well for small motors up to 5 hp rating. These starters use voltage relays to cut off resistance from the armature circuit in steps. Voltage relays are voltage sensitive and they can be set to pick up at any desired voltage level. In this type of starter counter emf generated in armature is utilised to energise voltage accelerating relays. These relays are connected in parallel with the armature of the motor as shown in Fig. 5.11. L1 + M1 Stop M 1AR 2AR 3AR Start M2 I.W M3 1AR1 2AR1 3AR1 R1 1A1 R2 2A1 M 1A 2A 3A R3 3A1 L2 – Fig. 5.11 Circuit diagram for counter emf starter for a dc motor When motor just starts, counter emf in the armature is zero. As the motor accelerates, counter emf also starts building up. The accelerating voltage relays 1AR, 2AR and 3AR are set to pick up at different increasing values of emf and their contacts energise contactors 1A, 2A and 3A to cut off resistance R1, R2, R3 from armature circuit. In the four step starter shown in Fig. 5.11, the voltage accelerating relays may be set to pick up at 50, 75 and 90 percent rated speed. The working of the control is explained as under: When the START-push button is pressed, contacotor M is energised and it gets hold through its own contact M2. Its main contact M1 energises the armature with resistance R1, R2 and R3 in the circuit. The motor accelerates and when say 50% of the normal speed is reached, emf generated causes the relay 1AR to pick up. Contact of 1AR closes to energise contactor 1A which shorts resistance R1 through its main contact 1A1. Due to cutting of resistance R1, the motor accelerates further and at 75% of normal speed counter emf generated makes the relay 2AR to pick up. When 2AR picks up contact 2A1 of contactor 2A closes and shorts resistance R2. Thus the motor accelerates still further and at 90% of the normal speed, relay 3AR picks up and thus the third resistance R3 is short circuited by contactor 3A. Now the motor gets connected directly to the lines and reaches its final speed. 5.4.2.3 Lock-out Acceleration Starter In this starter a special type of contactor known as lock-out contactor is used. This has been explained in detail in the chapter on control components. The contactor has two coils, closing dharm d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5 135
  • 153. 136 CONTROL OF MACHINES coil and lock-out coil. These coils are connected in series. The magnetic circuit of these coils are so designed that during the inrush current, lock out coil has greater pull than closing coil while at normal current the closing coil has greater pull than the lock out coil. Lock out coil has the tendency to keep the main contact open while closing coil has the tendency to close it. The starter is shown in Fig. 5.12. L1 + M1 M2 STOP M START M3 3AH 3AS R3 3A 3AC R2 2A 2AH R1 2AC 1AH 1A 1AC M L2 – Fig. 5.12 Circuit for shunt motor starter using lock-out type contactor As seen from Fig. 5.12, the starter has three contactors 1A, 2A and 3A. Each of the contactors 1A and 2A have two coils i.e., 1AH and 1AC for contactor 1A and 2AH, 2AC for contactor 2A. Contactor 3A has three coils holding coil 3AH, closing coil 3AC and shunt coil 3AS. The shunt coil is also wound on the core of the closing coil. The shunt coil cannot close the contactor by itself but can hold the already closed contactor. The working of the starter is as follows: When the START-push button is pressed, main contactor is energised and it gets hold through its auxiliary contact M3 . Main contact M1 energises the armature of the motor. Current flows through R1, R2, R3 and the contactor coils 1AH, 1AC and 3AH. Lock-out coil 1AH keeps the contactor open during current inrush. When current drops to normal value, closing coil 1AC closes the contact 1A and thus shorts resistance R1 and lock-out coil 1AH. When contactor 1A closes another inrush current flows through R3, R2, 2AH, 2AC and 1AC. When this inrush current falls to the normal value, closing coil 2AC picks up and closes contact 2A which shorts resistance R2 and coil 2AH. At this instant, another inrush current flows through 3AH, R3, 3AC, 2AC and 1AC. Closing coil 3AC picks up when current falls to normal value and closes its contact 3A, which shorts resistance R3 along with 3AH, 3AC, 2AC and 1AC. Contactor 3A is held closed through shunt coil 3AS which is energised directly from the lines through contact dharm d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5 136
  • 154. STARTERS FOR DIRECT CURRENT MOTORS 137 M2. Now the armature gets connected directly to the lines and the motor accelerates to its final speed. 5.4.3 Definite Timer Acceleration Starters In definite time acceleration starters, resistances from the armature circuit are cut off at fixed intervals independent of the load (i.e., load current). Contacts across accelerating resistors are made to close at successively longer time intervals with the help of special solenoid or motor driven timer, dashpot relays, pneumatic timers, inductive time limit contactors and others. The preset timings of the relays and timer cause the motor to operate on a given acceleration time cycle independent of the load conditions. Definite time acceleration starters are more widely used than current limit starters. This is because timed acceleration is often useful when a driven machine must always repeat the same cycle of operation in manufacturing process or in situations where several motors in a system must perform in a given timed sequence. Several of the above mentioned schemed of definite time acceleration starters are discussed as follows. 5.4.3.1 Starters Using Timers In the conrol scheme shown in Fig. 5.13, any type of timers i.e., electronic, pneumatic, or a dasphot relay timer may be used for the starter. Three such timers 1T, 2T and 3T have been used as shown in Fig. 5.13. If we observe the contact connections across accelerating resistors, we will see that they differ from connections made in the earlier described starters. The advantage of using such connections is that when finally contactor 3A gets energised, it will short all the resistances along with R3 and thus the other contactors 1A, 2A and timers 1T, 2T, 3T can be de-energised. Thus unnecessary energisation of contactors and timers is eliminated. L1 + M1 Stop M Start M2 I.W Series winding 3A3 R1 1A1 3A1 1T1 2T1 3T1 R2 2A1 3A2 R3 M 1T 1A 2T 2A 3T 3A L2 – Fig. 5.13 Definite time acceleration starter using timers for a dc compound motor When the START-push button is pressed, contactor M and timer 1T are energised and they get hold through contact M2.Timer 1T gets energised with normally closed (NC) contact dharm d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5 137
  • 155. 138 CONTROL OF MACHINES 3A2 in series. When timer 1T operates after pre-set delay its delayed contact 1T1 closes and energies contactor 1A. Contact 1A1 of contactor 1A closes across resistance R1 and thereby shorts it. The motor now accelerates further with R2 and R3. As soon as contactor 1A is energised, timer 2T, which is connected in parallel with it, also gets energised. After its pre-set delay its contact 2T1 closes and energies contactor 2A and timer 3T. Contactor 2A closes its contact 2A1 across R2 and therfore the motor now accelerates further with only one resistane i.e., R3. When timer 3T operates after its pre-set delay it closes its contact 3T1 and energises contactor 3A which gets hold through its contact 3A3 connected across the timer contact 3T1. Contactor 3A shorts resistance R3 and bypasses R1, R2, and contacts 1A1 and 2A1. Now there is no need for keeping contactor 1A and 2A energised. This is made possible by using a normally closed contact 3A2 in series with the coil of timer 1T. When contactor 3A is energised contact 3A2 opens and de-energises timer 1T. This in turn de-energises 1A, 2T, 2A, 3T while contactor 3A remains energised through its own contact 3A3. Another control circuit using a synchronous motor (or cam timer) which rotates a shaft that closes a set of contacts in a definite and adjustable time sequence has been shown in Fig. 5.14. Working of this circuit is similar to the circuit given in Fig. 4.10 (a). The cam timer figure given in Fig. 4.10 (b) also applies to this circuit. The only difference is that the contactors 1A, 2A, 3A in this case get hold through their contacts 1A1, 2A1 and 3A1. L1 + M1 Stop M Start 0 CT1 IA1 CT2 2A1 CT3 3A1 IW M2 R1 1A R2 2A M CT 1A 2A 3A R3 3A L2 – Cam timer motor Fig. 5.14 Definite time acceleration starter using synchronous cam type timer 5.4.3.2 Starter Using Time-delay Contactors This starter uses special contactors which opens with a time delay when its coil is de-enrgised. During energisation of the coil the contactor behaves like a normal contactor and therefore closes instantly. Timer delay during opening is provided by a special copper sleeve which is slipped directly over the core before the exciting coils are installed. During energisation the copper sleeve is electrically idle but when the coil gets disconnected from supply the copper sleeve acts like a short circuited secondary of a transformer. During this period a current flow dharm d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5 138
  • 156. STARTERS FOR DIRECT CURRENT MOTORS 139 in the copper sleeve opposes decay of core magnetism. The armature of the contactors, therefore, is released after a time delay. Time delay of such contactors is however fixed and does not depend on any adjustment. The circuit diagram, as in Fig. 5.15, shows how time delay contactors are used for dc motor acceleration. Here the normally closed contacts of the contactors are used across the accelerating resistors. L1 + M1 Stop M Start M2 I.W R1 1A1 M3 1A2 2A2 3A2 M4 R2 2A1 1A 2A 3A M R3 3A1 L2 – Fig. 5.15 Circuit diagram for a dc motor acceleration starter using time delay contractors In this starter, during starting the START-push button has to be kept pressed till contactors 1A, 2A, 3A and M pick up. First, contactor 1A picks up through normally closed contact M3 and subsequently interlock contact of 1A, 2A and 3A energies respectively contactors 2A, 3A and contactor M. Contactor M gets hold through its contact M4 . Energisation of 1A, 2A and 3A causes opening of 1A1, 2A1 and 3A1 respectively which are connected across resistance R1, R2 and R3. When contactor M is energised, the motor starts with R1, R2 and R3 in its circuit. With the energisation of contactor M contact M3 opens and de-energises 1A. However, it drops only after a fixed time delay when it closes its contact 1A1 across R1 and shorts it. Motor accelerates further. As soon as 1A drops, its another contactor 1A2 opens and de-energises contactor 2A. Its contact 2A1 closes after a fixed delay and shorts resistance R2, and at the same time contactor 3A gets de-energised because of opening of contact 2A2. When contactor 3A drops it shorts resistors R3. Contactor M does not drop due to opening of contact 3A2, as it remains energised through its own contact M4. When the STOP-button is pressed contactor M gets de- energised and the motor comes to standstill due to opening of main contact M1. 5.4.3.3 Starters Using Inductive Time Limit Contactors An inductive time limit contactor is similar in construction to that of a lock-out contactor. It also has two coils whose mmfs simultaneously act on a pivoted armature. Holding coil tends to oppose pick up while the closing coil attempts to pull the armature. The holding coil, whose magnetic circuit is of iron, can prevent pick-up due to the closing coil, even when it is excited at about 1 per cent of the line voltage. As the holding coil is highly inductive its flux decays slowly when it is short circuited. Air gap between the coil plunger and armature is also extremely dharm d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5 139
  • 157. 140 CONTROL OF MACHINES small. The closing coil, on the other hand has a large air gap. With the line voltage applied across it, the closing coil cannot cause the contactor to pick up when the holding coil is carrying current. It picks up only when the holding coil is shorted and its flux decays to zero. Fig. 5.16 shows the circuit in which three inductive time-limit contactors have been used to provide time delays for short-circuiting the accelerating resistors. L1 + M1 1AH Stop M Start M2 2AH R1 1A r 3AH R2 2A R3 3A M 1AC 2AC 3AC L2 – Fig. 5.16 Circuit diagram for a dc motor acceleration starter using inductive time limit contactors When the line switch is closed, the holding coil 1AH is energised, its current being limited by a resistance r. Thus the closing coil of 1AC cannot pick up and therefore its contact 1A across R1 remains open. When the START-push button is pressed, contactor M gets energised and its contact M1 energises the motor armature with resistance R1, R2 and R3 in series. Voltage drop across R1 and R2 also sends current through holding coils 2AH and 3AH. Thus, contactors 2A and 3A cannot close even though full line voltage appears across their closing coil 2AC and 3AC through contact M2. It may be noticed that as soon as M2 closes, holding coil 1AH of contactor 1A gets short circuited. Its current decays to zero within a fixed time. When current in holding coil becomes zero, closing coil 1AC picks up to operate the relay contacts. Resistance R1 gets short circuited due to closing of contact 1A across R1. Simultaneously holding coil 2AH of contactor 2A gets short circuited. Its current decays to zero after some fixed time and therfore 2AC picks up and short resistance R2 and coil 3AH by closing contact 2A. When current through 3AH decays to zero closing coil 3AC of contactor 3A picks up and closes its contact 3A and short resistance R3. Armature of the motor now gets connected directly across the lines and the motor attains the final speed. 5.5 REVERSING OF DC MOTORS The direction of rotation of dc motor can be reversed in either of the two ways: (i) Reversing current through the armature and the interpole windings (if they exist) (ii) Reversing current through the field windings i.e., through shunt and or series windings but not through the interpole windings (if they exist). Reversing current through the armature is preferred because reversing current through the field windings involves breaking and making highly inductive current of the field windings. dharm d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5 140
  • 158. STARTERS FOR DIRECT CURRENT MOTORS 141 Also field reversal of compound motor requires connections of both shunt and series windings to be changed. In this section only the armature reversal method will be discussed. The basic motor connections for reversal of armature current has been shown in Fig. 5.17. L1 + F1 R1 a M b I.W R2 F2 Series Field R1 1A R2 2A R3 3A – L2 Fig. 5.17 Circuit diagram for reversal of direction of rotation of a dc motor by armature current reversal In this circuit when forward contactor contacts F1 and F2 close, current through the armature flows from a to b and the motor rotates in forward direction. When the motor is to be rotated in reverse direction, forward contactor should get de-energised while the reverse contactor should get energised so that contact R1 and R2 close and thereby current through the armature windings flow in the reverse direction i.e., from b to a. In both the above cases, however, current through the series field winding flows in the same direction. The forward and reverse contactor should not get energised simultaneously when the motor is running normally with all the armature resistance out of circuit, as it will cause dead short circuit of power lines and also of the counter emf generated in the armature winding. One method of avoiding this undesired possibility is to interlock both the contactors mechanically. However, more frequently electrical interlocks are provided in the control circuit thereby making it impossible for one contactor to pick up while the other is energised. For double safety sometimes both mechanical and electrical interlocking of contactors is done. A control circuit for direct reversing of dc motor has been shown in Fig. 5.18. Forward and Reverse-push buttons are shown to have back and front contacts. When the Forward-push button is pressed supply to forward contactor coil reaches through back contact of Reverse-push button and normally close (NC) contact of contactor R. If the motor is to be directly reversed, the Reverse-push button is pressed, its back contact opens and de-energises contactor F. De-energisation of contactor F leads to closing of contact F2 in dharm d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5 141
  • 159. 142 CONTROL OF MACHINES the coil circuit of contactor R. Contactor R thus gets energised through front contact of REV- push button and back contact of FOR-push button and normally closed (NC) contact F2. If the motor is to be brought to rest the STOP-bush button has to be pressed. L1 + STOP FOR F1 R1 REV REV FOR R2 F2 F R – L2 Fig. 5.18 Control circuit for direct reversing of dc motor In some applications it may be necessary to stop the motor first before it can be run in the reverse direction. This can be accomplished by using a timer relay and zero speed plugging switches. Here, control circuit using an OFF-delay timer for this purpose has been discussed. The control diagram has been shown in Fig. 5.19. L1 + Stop F3 R3 F1 TR1 R1 Accelerating relays and contactors For Rev R2 F2 F R TR L2 – OFF delay timer Fig. 5.19 Control circuit for forward-stop-reverse operation of a dc motor using OFF-delay timer dharm d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5 142
  • 160. STARTERS FOR DIRECT CURRENT MOTORS 143 When FOR-push button is pressed contactor F gets energised and the motor runs in the forward direction. Its contact F3 energises the OFF-delay timer TR which opens its contact TR1 immediately. At the same time contact F3 also energises the accelerating relays and timers which cut off acceleration resistors from the armature circuit of the motor (refer Fig. 5.19). Opening of contact TR1 makes both FOR and REV-push buttons inoperative thus making it impossible to change the direction of rotation of the motor. When the motor direction is to be reversed, first the STOP- push button is pressed, which de-energises contactor F. Timer TR is also de-energised due to opening of contact F3. After pre-set delay from de-energisation of timer TR its contact TR1 will close. This implies that REV-bush button becomes operative only after a pre-set delay from the instant of pressing the STOP-button. Thus forward to reverse operation becomes possible only when the motor comes to stop first. 5.6 JOGGING OPERATION OF MOTOR The common usage of the word ‘Jogging’ in our daily life is for slow running. ‘Jogging’ or ‘inching’ of a motor also implies the same i.e., to have small movements of the driven machine. In jogging, starting and stopping of a motor is under the direct control of the operator. The primary objective of jogging is generally, to move tools, equipment or processed material into position very slowly. A typical example of jogging is a small portable crane which is moved in small incremental steps to position certain material on a processing line in an industry. In jogging operation, motors are expected to run at slow speed. Therefore, the jogging control circuits are designed to prevent accelerating resistors from being cut out from the armature circuit. This means when the JOG-push button is pressed, the accelerating contactors do not pick up and therefore the whole of the accelerating resistance remains in the circuit. High resistance in the armature circuit limits the speed of the motor to a low value. A simple control circuit that provides for jogging in one direction only has been shown in Fig. 5.20. L1 + Stop CR3 A B Jog Accelerating relays and contactors CR2 Start CR1 CR M – L2 Fig. 5.20 Control circuit for jogging of a dc motor in one direction of rotation In the above control circuit, when JOG-push button is pressed, the contact A opens while contact B closes. Contactor M is energised due to closing of contact B and makes the motor run with all the accelerating resistors in the armature circuit (refer Fig. 5.20). Due to presence of high resistance in the armature circuit the motor runs at a slow speed. Accelerating dharm d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5 143
  • 161. 144 CONTROL OF MACHINES relays and the contactor circuit are not energised during this operation thus making the motor run at slow speed till such time the JOG-push button is held pressed. When normal operation of motor is required the START-push button is pressed. The control relay CR gets energised and is held through its own contact CR1. Contactor M also gets energised and is held through contact CR2 . Accelerating relays and contactor circuit also gets energised through closing contact CR3. Accelerating relays and contactors as discussed earlier will cut off the accelerating resistances in the armature circuit step by step and the motor would attain its final speed. The control circuit diagram, Fig. 5.21, shows how a dc motor can be jogged and also operated normally in both the directions of rotation. L1 + Stop CRF3 CRR3 Jog-Rev Jog-For CRF2 A B C D CRR2 Accelerating relays and For Rev contactors CRF1 CRR1 CRF F CRR R R1 F1 – L2 Fig. 5.21 Control circuit for jogging a dc motor in both the directions of rotation Operation of this circuit is similar to that of the circuit meant for jogging in one direction of rotation only. Forward and reverse contactors are interlocked both mechanically and electrically. When the JOG-FOR or JOG-REV button is pressed the corresponding contactor F or R is energised due to closing of contact B or D. Contactor F or R does not get hold as control relay CRF or CRR does not get energised. Accelerating relay and the contactor circuit also do not get energised causing the motor to run with all the accelerating resistors in the circuit at a slow speed. For normal running, push button FOR or REV is to be pressed. This will energise either the forward control relay, CRF or the reverse control relay CRR. The respective relays will remain energised by getting supply through their own contact CRF1 or CRR1. Forward or reverse contactor will also get held throuh contact CRF2 or CRR2. The accelerating relay and the contactor circuit would also get energised and will be held through either contact CRF3, or contact CRR3 . 5.7 DYNAMIC BREAKING OF MOTOR The principle of dynamic breaking involves utilization of generator action of a motor to bring it to rest quickly. In this method of breaking, the armature terminals are disconnected from the main supply and immediately transferred across a resistor while the field winding is kept energised. Quick stop through dynamic breaking may be explained in following two ways: (i) When the motor armature having counter emf induced in it is disconnected from the supply and is connected across a resistor the counter cemf sends reverse current through the armature. This causes the motor to slow down due to reverse torque dharm d:N-MachMac5-1.pm5 144
  • 162. STARTERS FOR DIRECT CURRENT MOTORS 145 developed. Reverse torque is developed due to interaction of field flux and the reverse current flowing through the armature. (ii) When the motor is disconnected from the supply and is connected across a resistor the counter emf sends current through the resistor which is converted into I2R heat loss. Thus mechanical energy of the rotor is dissipated as heat energy in the resist- ance. The rapidity with which this energy can be dissipated determines how quickly the motor can be stopped. If a low value resistor is used the motor comes to stop quickly. Control circuit for dynamic breaking of a dc shunt motor has been shown in Fig. 5.22. Fig. 5.22 Control circuit for dynamic breaking of dc shunt motor In this circuit dynamic breaking resistor R4 is connected across the armature through normally close (NC) conctact DB1 of the dynamic breaking contactor. This dynamic breaking contactor DB is a special contactor having two coils i.e., a retard coil and closing coil. The retard coil exerts an opposite pull on the armature to that exerted by the closing coil. In this circuit the retard coil is kept permanently energised. When the closing coil is energised contactor DB closes after a time delay as there is a pull by the retarding coil in the opposite direction. It must be understood clearly here that this delay in closing of the contactor has no effect on the staring operation. However, when the closing coil of contactor DB is de-energised by pressing the STOP-push button it opens very fast due to the pull exerted by the retard coil DB, which is always energised. Thus the contact DB1 which is meant for breaking closes with a snap action thereby causing breaking action to start immediately. It is therefore seen that the function of providing retard coil is for achieving a quick stop and it has no specific function during starting of the motor. A brief description for the control circuit is as follows: When the START-push button is pressed the contactor DB is energised first and then the main contactor M gets energised through its contact DB2. Both the contactors are held through contact M2. Accelerating relays of contactor circuit are energised through closing of dharm d:N-MachMac5-2.pm5 145
  • 163. 146 CONTROL OF MACHINES contact M3. Resistances from the armature circuit are cut out in steps by contactors 1A, 2A and 3A. When the STOP-push button is pressed, closing coil of DB and contactor M are de-energised. Contactor DB opens very fast as the retard coil is already energised. Its contact DB1 closes with a snap action and the armature gets connected across resistances R4, R1, R2 and R3. The electrical energy of the armature is thus dissipated in resistor R4, R1, R2 and R3 and the motor comes to stop quickly. If the value of resistance R4 is decreased the motor can be brought to stop more quickly. 5.8 PLUGGING CIRCUIT FOR DC MOTOR Plugging or plug stopping of a motor means bringing the motor to standstill quickly by applying reverse torque on the armature. Plugging of a dc motor is done by reversing the supply to the armature while the motor is still running. This develops a counter-torque and motor slows down quickly. When the motor reaches zero speed and tends to reverse, supply to the motor is disconnected by a zero speed plugging switch which opens on zero speed. As during plugging the impressed supply voltage and counter emf in the armature adds up, a plugging resistance is inserted in the armature circuit to avoid excessive current flow. Plugging is not only used to bring a motor to stop but is also used in drives where quick reversal of drive is required, such as, in cranes and in rolling mills. In a crane plugging is done with the help of master controllers. This is done by moving the handle from full speed forward position to full-speed reverse position or vice-versa. Plugging circuit for a non-reversing shunt motor has been shown in Fig. 5.23. L1 + plugging switch Zero speed M1 P1 M3 M6 Start A B a b CR1 M4 P2 M2 CR2 Accelerating RP relays and Plugging contactors resistance Stop R1 1A M5 R2 2A R3 3A M P CR L2 – Fig. 5.23 Circuit for plugging to stop a non-reversing shunt motor with a zero speed plugging switch In this circuit, when the START-push button is pressed, its contact A closes and contact B opens. Contactor M thus gets energised and is held through its contact M3. When the START- push button is released, contact B closes and relay CR also gets energised through closed contact M4. Contactor P cannot get energised as M5 is open. As soon as contactor M gets energised its main contacts M1 and M2 energise the motor armature with accelrating resistors in the circuit. dharm d:N-MachMac5-2.pm5 146
  • 164. STARTERS FOR DIRECT CURRENT MOTORS 147 Contact M6 energises the accelerating relays and the contactor circuit. The motor comes to its final speed when all the resistances are successively cut out by accelerating contactors 1A, 2A and 3A respectively. The zero speed plugging switch closes as soon as the motor starts rotating. Control relay CR is held through the zero-speed switch and its already closed contact CR2. Another contact of CR, i.e., CR1 opens and makes the START-push button ineffective till the motor comes to rest. This interlocking prevents simultaneous energisation of contactors M and P. When the STOP-push button is pressed, contactor M is de-energised and therefore contacts M1, M2, M3, M4 and M6 open. The armature gets disconnected from the supply and the accelerating contactors 1A, 2A, 3A also open. Normally closed contact M5 closes and contactor P gets energised. The armature of the motor gets energised through contacts P1 and P2 with plugging resistance RP and accelerating resistors R1, R2 and R3 in the circuit. A reverse torque is developed and the motor comes to zero speed quickly. As the motor reaches zero speed and tends to rotate in the reverse direction, the zero speed switch opens and de-energises relay CR. Contactor P also gets de-energised due to opening of control contact CR2. Contacts P1 and P2 opens to disconnect the motor from the supply. Control circuit diagram for plugging a reversing motor from either direction of rotation has been shown in Fig. 5.24. In this circuit a zero speed plugging switch with two normally open (NO) contactors has been used. Both the contacts are open at zero speed. The FOR-contact closes when the motor rotates in forward direction while a REV-contact closes when the motor rotates in the reverse direction. Push button interlocking as also auxiliary contact interlocking have been provided between forward and reverse direction of rotation. A plugging resistance Rp which is connected in series with the armature remains shorted through contact P1 of contactor P during normal forward and reverse operation of the motor. This resistance comes into circuit only during plugging operation. L1 + Stop F1 P1 R1 CR4 FR3 RR3 F4 R4 M For A Rev CR3 RP R2 F2 C Zero Speed Accelerating Series field D B Plugging Rev relays and For Switch contactors CR1 CR2 R1 1A1 FR1 RR1 RR2 R2 2A1 FR2 R3 F3 R3 3A1 F R CR P FR RR L2 – Fig. 5.24 Circuit for plugging a reversing motor from either direction of rotation To study the operation of the circuit let us assume that the FOR-push button is pressed. Contactor P and relay CR are energised and gets hold through contact CR3. Then contactor F is also energised and is held through contacts CR3 and CR1. Closing of main contacts F1 and F2 causes the motor to run in forward direction while closing of contact F4 helps energise dharm d:N-MachMac5-2.pm5 147
  • 165. 148 CONTROL OF MACHINES accelerating relays and the contactor circuit and as a result the resistances are cut off in steps. Plugging resistance Rp remains bypassed through contact P1. When the motor accelerates in the forward direction, relay RR gets energised through contact CR4 and contact FOR of the plugging switch. Relay RR gets held through its contact RR3. Closing of contact RR2 of this relay prepared the circuit for plugging operation. Now let us see what happens when the STOP-push button is pressed. Contactor F, P and relay CR get de-energised. Due to de- energisation of F its contact F3 closes. Reverse contactor R gets energised through contacts RR3, for-plugging switch contact, and contacts RR2 and F3. Energisation of contactor R causes the motor to run in the reverse direction with plugging resistance Rp and the acceleration resistors in the armature circuit (as P1 is open). When the motor comes to standstill, FOR plugging switch contact open thus de-energising relay RR. Due to opening of contact RR2, the reverse contactor, R also gets de-energised. Now, the operation for reverse running and plugging of this circuit can be explained in a similar way as already done for forward running and plugging operation. REVIEW QUESTIONS 1. Discuss different types of corrective windings used in dc motors. 2. Discuss principle of acceleration of dc motors and draw armature current versus speed and time curves. Also draw speed versus time curves for a shunt motor. 3. Explain the working of four point manual face plate starter for dc shunt or compound motor. 4. Explain the meaning of current limit acceleration. Explain working of series relay starter. 5. Discuss counter emf starter for dc shunt motor. 6. Explain the working principle of lock out contactor with the help of a diagram. 7. Discuss the working of lock out contactor for a dc shunt motor. 8. Explain a definite time limit starter. 9. Explain the method of starting of dc shunt motor using inductive time limit contactors. 10. What is the basic requirement of a reversing starter? Draw fundamental power and control circuit for reversal of a dc shunt motor. 11. Draw control diagram for forward-stop-reverse operation of a dc motor using an OFF-delay timer. 12. Explain the meaning of jogging / inching operation of a motor. Draw control circuit for jogging a dc motor in both the directions of rotation. 13. How is dynamic braking achieved in dc motors? 14. What is plugging? Draw control diagram for plugging a non-reversing shunt motor using a zero speed plugging switch. 15. Can a timer be used for the plugging circuit of a dc motor? 16. Draw control circuit for plugging circuit of a dc compound motor from either direction of rotation. 17. Direction of a dc motor can be reversed by: (a) reversing the supply voltage (b) reversing current through field winding only (c) reversing current through armature winding only (d) reversing current through both field winding and armature winding. 18. Dynamic braking for a dc motor is accomplished by (a) connecting ac voltage to the armature (b) maintaining dc current flow through the armature and connecting a load resistor to the field (c) maintaining dc current flow through the field and connecting the armature to a load resistor (d) disconnecting dc power from the motor and reconnecting the armature to a load resistor. dharm d:N-MachMac5-2.pm5 148
  • 166. $ Control of Single Phase Motors 6.1 TYPES OF SINGLE PHASE MOTORS Single phase motors are manufactured in fractional kilowatt range to be operated on single phase supply and for use in numerous applications like ceiling fans, refrigerators, food mixers, hair driers, portable drills, vacuum cleaners, washing machines, sewing machines, electric shavers, office machinery etc. Single phase motors are manufactured in different types to meet the requirements of various applications. Single phase motors are classified on the basis of their construction and starting methods employed. The main types of single phase motors are : (a) Induction motors (b) Synchronous motors (c) Commutator motors The various types of motors under each class are shown as under: Single-phase motors Single-phase induction Single-phase Single-phase-commutator motors synchronous motors motors Split Shaded Reluctance Repulsion Repulsion AC series Universal phase Pole start motor induction motor motor type type type motor Reluctance Hysteresis motor motor It is assumed here that the reader has already studied the construction and working principle of all these motors. For review the reader may refer to any standard book on ‘Electrical machines’. Repulsion, repulsion induction and reluctance start motors are not used these days, they have been largely replaced by split phase motors with special capacitors which can be designed to perform equally well as repulsion types. In addition they offer such advantages as lower cost and trouble free service. 149
  • 167. 150 CONTROL OF MACHINES Shaded pole motors are extremely popular motors used in low-starting torque applications. Split phase motors are widely used and are designed in several ways to develop different values of starting torque. Universal series motor is another very popular type of motor which can operate on both ac and dc supply. They generally run at high speed and employ special design features to reduce commutation and armature reaction difficulties on ac supply. Synchronous motors such as reluctance motor and hysteresis motor operate at synchronous speed for all values of load. They are manufactured in very smal ratings. Practically all single phase motors are designed for line voltage starting and take inrush currents that may be little more than the rated values in some types and six or more times as much in others. Like polyphase motors they are also frequently jogged, plugged, reversed, dynamically braked and plug reversed. When the above mentioned operations are done, contactors of larger ratings than normal are used, as their frequent operations cause overheating and excessive wear of contacts. Control circuits of single phase motors are however simple as few contactors and relays are used. 6.2 UNIVERSAL SERIES MOTORS The construction and principle of working of a universal series motor are similar to a dc series motor. To enable the motor to work satisfactorily on ac supply also, some modifications are required in its construction. The important modification required are : (i) Field structure should be completely laminated to avoid losses due to eddy currents: (ii) To combat effects of armature reaction and resulting poor commutation the arma- ture is to be designed to have lower voltage gradient between adjacent commutator segments than in an equivalent dc motor; (iii) Poor commutation with ac (due to emf induced by the alternating main field flux in a coil undergoing commutation) is improved by using distributed field windings and compensating field windings that are placed in a slotted stator core. When a univer- sal motor is used with ac supply the armature reactance drop exerts a speed lower- ing effect with increased loading. At the same time at increased loading the effective flux per ac ampere is less than that produced per dc ampere. This condition tends the motor to run faster on ac supply. Out of the above two factors i.e., of armature reac- tance drop, and effective flux, the factor which pre-dominates determines the speed of the motor on ac supply. 6.2.1 Reversing Direction of Rotation of Universal Motor The direction of rotation of a universal motor can be changed by either: (i) Reversing the field connection with respect to those of armature; or (ii) By using two field windings wound on the core in opposite directions so that the one connected in series with armature gives clockwise rotation, while the other in series with the armature gives counterclockwise rotation. The second method, i.e., the two field method is used in applications such as motor operated rheostats and servo systems. This method has somewhat simpler connections than the first method. For simple applications like portable drills etc. manual switches are frequently used for reversing the direction of rotation of the motor. Fig. 6.1 (a and b) shows how a DPDT (Double Pole Double Throw) switch and a three position switch may be used for reversing the direction of rotation of single field and double field type of motors respectively. dharm d:N-MachMac6-1.pm5 150
  • 168. CONTROL OF SINGLE PHASE MOTORS 151 Series field A2 2 A 1 A1 AC/DC DPDT ARM Supply Switch B2 B1 B (a) 1 FORW Field 0 Three position 2 REV Field AC/DC switch Supply ARM (b) Fig. 6.1 Reversing of a universal motor (a) Armature reversing method using a reversing switch (b) Two-field method using a three-position switch In Fig. 6.1 (a), when the DPDT switch is in the position shown, the switch blade bridges the switch terminals A – A1 and B – B1, current through series field and armature flows in the direction as indicated by arrows. When direction of rotation of the motor is to be reversed the switch is thrown to position 2. Now, terminal A gets connected to terminal A2 and terminal B gets connected to B2. Current through the armature reverses while direction of current through the series field remains unchanged. This leads to reversal of direction of rotation of the motor. As shown in Fig. 6.1 (b) the direction of rotation of the motor is reversed by moving the selector switch in position 1 or 2. In position 1, the FORW-field runs the motor in one direction and in position 2, REV-field runs the motors in the reverse direction. Automatic control circuit for reversal of motor by armature-reversing method is similar to the circuit studied for dc motors in Chapter 5. Power and control circuit for a double field universal motor has been shown in Fig. 6.2. When the FOR-push button is pressed, the forward contactor F get energised and its contacts F1 and F2 close to energise the armature and the FORW-field winding. Similarly when the reverse contactor is energised the REV-field winding and the armature get energised by receiving supply through contacts R1 and R2. In the control circuit, push button interlocking, as also auxiliary contact interlocking have been provided to avoid simultaneous energisation of contactors F and R. dharm d:N-MachMac6-1.pm5 151
  • 169. 152 CONTROL OF MACHINES L1 + Stop F1 R1 F3 REV R3 FOR ARM REV FOR FORW REV R4 F4 field field F R F2 R2 L2 – Fig. 6.2 Power and control circuit for reversing of a two-field universal motor 6.2.2 Speed Control of Universal Motor There are various methods of controlling the speed of a universal motor. A wide range of speed control is possible by inserting a rheostat in the line circuit which causes variable voltage to appear across the motor terminals resulting in reduced motor speed. Another method of speed control, not very commonly used is by brush shifting mechanism. The speed of the motor increases when the brushes are moved backward relative to the direction of rotation. However, only a limited range of speed control is possible by this method. This is because when the brushes are moved further from the magnetic neutral, commutation worsens. Another speed control method makes use of a tapped field winding. Universal motors are always bipolar. The number of turns on the two poles need not always be the same as the air gap flux is created by series combination of mmfs of the two pole windings. As shown in Fig. 6.3 the field winding having larger number of turns is tapped at three points thus making possible a total of four operating speeds. For a given value of load, minimum speed will be obtained when the entire winding is used (this gives maximum mmf and flux). Maximum speed will result when the selector switch is on point H at which minimum flux is obtained. This method offers possibility of tapping the field winding at appropriate points to permit the motor to run at the same speed on direct current and also on alternating current for a particular input. This, however, does not mean that speeds will be the same on ac and dc supplies for some other values of input currents. Another popular method of speed control is the governor controlled speed adjusting method. In this method of speed adjustment of a series motor, a governor consisting of an assembly of a spring loaded contacts is mounted on the shaft of the motor. The current enters the governor contacts through carbon brush and slip-ring arrangement. When the motor is running, governor contacts open and close very rapidly depending upon the natural resonant frequency of the moving contacts. For a given spring tension setting, the contacts vibrate at a certain rate. Figure 6.4 shows how a governor is connected to a series motor for non-reversing as well as for two field reversing service. dharm d:N-MachMac6-1.pm5 152
  • 170. CONTROL OF SINGLE PHASE MOTORS 153 ARM 3 2 4 H(High) AC/D.C Selector Supply 1(Low) switch Fig. 6.3 Tapped field winding speed adjustment method for a universal motor Governor Governor R R ARM ARM AC/D.C AC/D.C Supply Supply FORW REV Series field field field Selector switch (a) Non-reversing (b) Reversing Fig. 6.4 Governor controlled speed adjustment method for a series motor For a given spring tension setting, contacts vibrate at a certain rate. When the speed rises above the particular value set by the spring tension, the contacts remain open for a relatively longer period of time, than the time the contacts take for closing. This keeps a line resistance R in the circuit a little longer and acts to reduce the speed. The reverse is true when speed falls below the adjusted value. Now the closing time of contact is longer than its opening time and hence the resistance remains in circuit for smaller duration of time and as a consequence the motor speed tends to rise. In this type of speed adjustment the motor does not run at a constant speed but runs in a narrow range above and below the set speed. A wide range of speed adjustment is thus possible by adjusting the spring tension of the contacts. A small capacitor is used across the contacts to prevent excessive arcing. 6.3 SHADED POLE MOTOR Shaded pole motors are induction motors manufactured for very small ratings and are used in applications where starting torque requirement of the load is very low. Some of the applications of shaded pole type induction motors are in blowers, fans used in heaters, slide and film projectors, advertising display devices etc. The outstanding features are the low initial cost, small size, and ruggedness. An advantageous feature of such small motors is that the starting dharm d:N-MachMac6-1.pm5 153
  • 171. 154 CONTROL OF MACHINES current is only slightly higher than the full-load current and therefore the stalled motor condition is not harmful to the motor windings. Cross sectional view of a shaded pole type motor has been shown in Fig. 6.5. The stator shown are projected type. Short circuited coils known as shading coils (rings) are fixed on one portion of each pole. A pole on which a shading ring is fixed is called a shaded pole. Shading coil can be of thick single turn in the form of a ring or have a number of short circuited turns. The rotor is of conventional squirrel cage type. Unshaded portion of the pole Shaded portion V~ Shading V~ ring Squirrel cage rotor (a) (b) Fig. 6.5 Shaded pole type induction motors of different design The magnetic field created by the field ampere-turns of a shaded pole motor varies in magnetic strength and merely shifts from one side of the salient pole to the other side for every half cycle of the supply voltage. The direction of rotation of shaded pole motors with a single set of field windings and shading coils can not be reversed. The motor would always rotate in a direction from the unshaded part to the shaded part of the pole. For enabling reversal of direction of rotation, the construction of the stator must be changed to include : (1) Two sets of shading coils that are normally open circuited and occupy different posi- tions with respect to the main field winding. (2) Two main windings that occupy different positions with respect to the shading coils. (3) A special distributed continuous winding that is placed in a slotted stator core and is tapped at appropriate points with respect to the shading coils. Fig. 6.6 (a) shows shading coils placed on both sides of each of the salient poles. With the help of short-circuiting switch either set of shading coils can be made effective. The coils which are short circuited determine the direction of rotation. When the selector switch [Fig. 6.6 (a)] is in position F, shaded coils A and A′ are shorted while shaded coils B and B′ are open. When the switch position is changed, coils B and B′ are shorted while A and A′ become open. In Fig. 6.6 (b) two distributed windings are placed 90° electrical degrees apart with respect to each other and 45° electrical degrees from the shading coils in a slotted stator. In Fig. 6.6 (c) a continuous distributed winding is used and tapped at 90° electrical degrees. Leads from these tappings are connected to a DPDT switch. With alternate position of DPDT switch, the main winding can have either positive or negative 90° electrical degrees relationship with respect to the shading coils. In one case the rotor will turn clockwise and in the other case the rotor will turn counter clockwise. dharm d:N-MachMac6-1.pm5 154
  • 172. CONTROL OF SINGLE PHASE MOTORS 155 Fig. 6.6 Method of changing the direction of rotation of a shaded pole type induction motor The speed of the shaded pole motor can be changed by changing the impressed voltage across the main winding. Three methods are generally employed to vary the winding voltage. They are : (i) by using an auto transformer that is tapped for several voltages. (ii) by using a tapped reactance coil that incurs a line voltage drop, and (iii) by using tapped exciting winding to enable supply voltage to be applied across the whole winding or across a part of it. Method of speed control illustrated through Fig. 6.7 (a) and Fig. 6.7 (b) are self explanatory. In the method of speed control illustrated through Fig. 6.7 (c), the highest speed results when the smallest portion of the winding is energised. Reactance coil 3H AC supply AC supply AC supply 2 OFF L H OFF M M M L (a) Auto transformer method (b) Reactance coil method (c) Tapped-winding method Fig. 6.7 Speed control methods of shaded pole motors This is because in such a case volts per turn increases resulting in increased speed. 6.4 SPLIT PHASE MOTORS Split phase induction motors are the most widely used type of single phase motors. They are made in larger sizes than shaded pole type motors. They are used in refrigerators, washing machines, portable hoists, many kinds of small machine tools, grinders, blowers and fans, wood working equipment, centrifugal pumps, etc. Two types of split phase motors are generally available. They are: (i) Standard split phase motor; and (ii) Capacitor split phase motors. 6.4.1 Standard Split Phase Motors The stator of a standard split phase motor has two windings viz., a main winding and an auxiliary winding. These two windings have different ratios of resistance to inductive reactance. The windings are connected in parallel across the single phase ac supply. The line current is dharm d:N-MachMac6-1.pm5 155
  • 173. 156 CONTROL OF MACHINES thus split into two parts; one part flowing through the main winding and the other part flowing through the auxiliary windings. Because of different ratio of resistance to inductive reactance of these two windings current flowing through them will have a time phase difference of 30 electrical degrees or more. In some motors, both the windings are energised continuously, while in most of them, the auxiliary winding is used only during the starting period along with the main winding to develop the required starting torque. When the motor reaches final speed the auxiliary winding is disconnected from the supply. The auxiliary windings can be disconnected by using a centrifugal switch in series with it. During starting, the centrifugal switch remains closed. When the motor reaches normal speed the centrifugal switch opens and disconnects the auxiliary winding. This has been shown in Fig. 6.8 (a). Centrifugal switch Disc Plunger Main winding Aux winding AC supply AC supply Aux winding Main winding (a) (b) Fig. 6.8 Use of (a) Centrifugal switch (b) Electro-magnetic relay for connecting an auxiliary winding in parallel with the main winding during starting Another method of disconnecting the auxiliary winding when the motor has picked up speed is by using an electromagnetic relay as has been shown in Fig. 6.8 (b). During starting the relay picks up due to high starting current and connects the auxiliary winding in the circuit. When the motor reaches normal speed, current drops to normal value and the electromagnetic relay is dropped and therefore the auxiliary winding gets disconnected from supply. Reversal of direction of rotation of a split phase motor is obtained by interchanging the auxiliary winding terminal connections with respect to the main winding. The motor must be brought to rest or the centrifugal switch must be closed before reversal is attempted. The basic Fig. 6.9 Reversing of split phase motor dharm d:N-MachMac6-1.pm5 156
  • 174. CONTROL OF SINGLE PHASE MOTORS 157 circuit for reversal of small split phase motor using a DPDT (Double Pole Double Throw) switch and contactors has been shown in Fig. 6.9 (a and b). Speed control of standard split phase motors is achieved with difficulty. The usual method is to use two or more windings designed to produce different number of poles. The complications arise as both the main and the auxiliary windings have to be arranged for pole changing. The capacitor type split phase motor which will now be discussed have better possibility of speed adjustments. 6.4.2 Capacitor Type Split Phase Motors Capacitor type split phase motors are generally similar to the standard split phase construction except for the addition of capacitor and a slightly modified switching arrangement for the two value capacitor type motors. The three types of capacitor split phase motors have been shown in Fig. 6.10. Main C.S winding C.S Capacitor AC supply AC supply AC supply Main Capacitor Aux winding Aux winding Aux (a) Capacitor-start (b) Permanent-split (c) Two-value capacitor capacitor Fig. 6.10 Three types of capacitor type split phase motors 6.4.2.1 Capacitor Start Split Phase Motors These motors are used where high starting torque is required. To accomplish this, capacitors of large values are to be used. Electrolytic capacitors designed for short duty service are available and used in these motors. The motor should come upto its speed quickly and disconnect the capacitor from the windings, otherwise the capacitor will get damaged. The centrifugal switch or the relay that function in auxiliary winding should be very reliable. 6.4.2.2 Permanent Split Capacitor Motors These motors are mainly used for low starting torque loads where they are generally shaft mounted. Their particular fields of applications are in air moving equipment such as fans, blowers, oil burners etc. where quiet operation is required. 6.4.2.3 Two Value Capacitor Motors This type of capacitor motors has the advantage that they develop extremely high locked rotor torque with one value of capacitance in the auxiliary winding circuit and gives quiet running performance of the motor with another capacitor. Electrolytic capacitors are used for starting. Their values are 10 to 15 times as much as the value of the running capacitor. 6.4.3 Starters for Capacitor Type Split Phase Motors We know that direction of a split phase motor can be reversed if the connection of one of the windings is reversed with respect to the other. In an automatic starter this can be achieved by using two contactors i.e., one for forward direction of rotation and the other for reverse direction of rotation. The connections for control circuit and the power circuit diagrams have been shown in Fig. 6.11. The circuit does not need any further explanation as it is a simple forward reverse starter scheme. dharm d:N-MachMac6-1.pm5 157
  • 175. 158 CONTROL OF MACHINES L1 Stop F R AC supply FOR F REV R F R Aux winding R F Main winding R F F R L2 Fig. 6.11 Forward/reverse starter for a permanent split capacitor motor 6.4.4 Starter for Two Value Capacitor Type Split-phase Motors This type of split phase motors have two capacitors of different values in the auxiliary winding. The motors develop a high starting torque with one capacitor of a higher value and gives a quite running performance with the other capacitor of comparatively lower value. The circuit for forward / reverse operation of a two value capacitor motor has been shown in Fig. 6.12. M2 Stop Aux winding Main winding Oil filled capacitor Start M1 AC supply Electrolytic capacitor R2 TR1 R3 R1 M3 M TR R Thermal timer Fig. 6.12 Forward/reverse starter for a two value capacitor motor In the circuit shown an electrolytic capacitor has been used for starting purpose and an oil filled capacitor has been used for continuous running operation. During starting both the capacitors are in the circuit. When the motor picks up speed the electrolytic capacitor gets disconnected due to opening of a relay contact. The circuit operation is as follows : dharm d:N-MachMac6-1.pm5 158
  • 176. CONTROL OF SINGLE PHASE MOTORS 159 When the START-push button is pressed the M contactor is energised which inturn energises both the main and the auxiliary windings (with both the capacitors in the auxiliary winding circuit) due to closing of contacts M2 and M3. A thermal timer TR is also energised along with the contactor. This thermal timer consists of a heater coil wound on a bimetallic strip. After a pre-set delay the bimetallic strips bends and closes contact TR1. Closing of contact TR1 causes energisation of relay R which then gets hold through its own contact R2. At the same time relay R disconnects the electrolytic capacitor from the auxiliary winding circuit due to opening of its normally closed (NC) contact R3. The thermal timer gets de-energised as soon as relay R is energised due to opening of its contact R1. 6.4.5 Starter for a Two Value Capacitor Motor Using a Current Relay and an Auto Transformer This type of starter uses a current relay in series with the main winding and an auto-transformer in the auxiliary winding to increase the effective value of the capacitors in the auxiliary winding circuit. The circuit has been shown in Fig. 6.13. Fig. 6.13 Starter for a two value capacitor motor using an overcurrent relay and an auto-transformer In this circuit, when contactor M is energised, a high inrush current flows through the main winding which energises relay R. Its contact R1 closes and contact R2 opens. Due to closing of contact R1, the auto transformer winding comes in circuit and the effective value of capacitor is increased. The current relay is designed to pick up at 3 times the full load current and to drop at twice the full-load value. The motor therefore develops high starting torque during starting due to high effective capacitance. When the motor picks up speed, the current drops and the relay R drops out. Due to opening of contact R1 and closing of contact R2, the auto-transformer gets open circuited. The auxiliary winding then gets connected through the capacitor only. The relay R can pick up again, if load on the motor causes current to rise to its pick up value and thus re-inserts the auto-transformer. Thus, this increased capacitance permits the motor to develop more torque and prevents stalling at heavier loads. dharm d:N-MachMac6-1.pm5 159
  • 177. 160 CONTROL OF MACHINES 6.4.6 Dynamic Breaking of Split Phase Motors The principle of dynamic breaking discussed earlier in connection with polyphase induction motors, also applies well to split phase motors. The procedure, as already explained, is to disconnect the stator windings from ac supply while the motor is running and instead, connect dc supply across the windings. Full wave rectifier is used to obtain dc supply from the available ac source. Precaution must be taken to avoid, simultaneous energisation of the stator windings from both ac as well as dc supply. This is taken care of by providing electrical and/or mechanical interlocking of the contactors. A rheostat is provided in the dc circuit to control the time required for the motor to stop. Less is the value of rehostatic value of resistance, more quickly will the rotational energy get converted to electrical energy and get dissipated as heat and hence less will be the time required for the motor to stop. The control diagram for dynamic breaking of a split phase motor is shown in Fig. 6.14. TR1 DB M3 Stop (Inst) DB Start M1 TR2 AC Supply DB M DB M2 R M DB TR M4 DB O.L Fig. 6.14 Control circuit for dynamic breaking of a split phase induction motor When the STOP-push button is pressed, contactor M gets de-energised and closes its contact M2. Contactor DB gets energised through the back contact of the STOP-push button, closed contact TR2 and contact M2. Timer TR also gets energised along with contactor DB. The instantaneous contact of relay TR, i.e.,TR1 closes and thus both contactor DB and relay TR remain energised. Contactor DB energises a bridge rectifier which feeds dc current into the stator winding of the motor. Current to be fed is adjustable through a rheostat, R. Due to feeding of dc current the motor slows down and comes to a quick stop. After a pre-set delay which would match with the time taken by the motor to stop, the timer TR operates and opens its delayed contact TR2 and thus de-energises contactor DB and gets reset. The time allowed to stop the motor, as explained earlier, can be varied by adjusting the rheostat R. 6.4.7 Plug Reversing of Capacitor Start Motors The capacitor start motors suffer from the disadvantage that they are not easily reversible due to the centrifugal switch connected in the auxiliary winding. The motor can not be instantaneously reversed by simple control as the auxiliary winding remains disconnected till the motor comes near to zero speed. However, by proper design of the control circuit the motor dharm d:N-MachMac6-1.pm5 160
  • 178. CONTROL OF SINGLE PHASE MOTORS 161 can be made instantly reversible. This is accomplished by using an electromagnetic relay along with a special two contact centrifugal switch as shown in Fig. 6.15. Stop U3 D3 U1 D1 Aux winding Up Down Main winding AC supply D2 U2 C LSU LSD B R U D R1 A R R2 Fig. 6.15 Control circuit for a small hoist using a capacitor start The circuit shown in Fig. 6.15 is for a small hoist using a capacitor start motor. The upper and lower limits of travel are controlled by two limit switches viz. LSU and LSD. When UP-push button is pressed, contactor U gets energised. Its contacts U1 and U2 energise the main winding. Closing of its contact U3 causes relay R to get energised through the centrifugal switch contacts A—B. After the energisation of relay R auxiliary winding gets energised through capacitor C, the centrifugal switch, and the closed contact R2 of relay R. When the motor reaches near normal speed, the centrifugal switch opens and the auxiliary winding gets connected to a high resistance R. Under this condition the auxiliary winding is effectively an open circuit and therefore the developed torque is only by the main winding (recall that this is what is required during normal operation of the motor). When the hoist will reach the upper limit the limit switch LSU will be actuated, U contactor will get de-energised, relay R also drops out due to opening of contact U3. If, to achieve instant reversal, the DOWN- push button is pressed, contactor D would pick-up energising the main and also the auxiliary winding through normally closed (NC) contact R1 (as relay R will not pick-up because of centrifugal switch being open). The centrifugal switch would close when speed becomes zero, the relay R would then get energised. The auxiliary winding would also get energised through the centrifugal switch contact B. In the downward direction when motor again reaches its final speed the centrifugal switch would open thus connecting the auxiliary winding to the high resistance R. 6.4.8 Speed Control of Split Phase Motors Speed control of split phase motors (without capacitors) is obtained by either pole changing method or by using special winding arrangements. These methods will, however, increase the size of the such motors and make them expensive. To obtain two speed operation of a split phase motor, the motor will have two main windings and two auxiliary windings, each set wound for different number of poles. However dharm d:N-MachMac6-1.pm5 161
  • 179. 162 CONTROL OF MACHINES by special design a single auxiliary winding may also be used. In two speed operation, the centrifugal switch is set to open at the lower of the two speeds. In case of fast speed operation, therefore, the rotor has to accelerate to full speed on the main winding only. No problem would arise on this account if the load on motor is moderate. Figure 6.16 shows the control circuit for a two speed motor with two main and two auxiliary windings. The control circuit permits starting of the motor at slow or fast speed depending upon the setting of the selector switch. During running condition, transfer can be made from one speed to the other speed. For the selector switch setting for slow speed, as shown in Fig. 6.16, the motor can be started by pressing the SLOW-push button. A relay CRS first gets energised through contact S3 and then gets hold through its contact CRS1. Contact CRS2 also closes and makes the circuit ready for fast operation. Whenever a change over is required for fast operation, the FAST-push button is to be pressed which would first release the slow contactor S and then energise the fast contactor F. A relay CRF would then get energised and get hold through its own contact. Contact CRF2 of this relay closes allowing transfer from fast speed to slow speed operation when required. Thus, it follows from the above that the motor can be started for a particular operation, fast or slow, depending upon the setting of the selector switch and then change over to the other operation by pressing the corresponding push button. 6.4.9 Speed Control of Permanent Split Capacitor Motors The speed of a permanently split capacitor motor can be adjusted by connecting it to a variable voltage source such as an auto-transformer. The limitation of this method is that the starting torque developed is very low, especially when the motor is started on low speed. Another limitation is that speed is sensitive to voltage changes on low speed connections. Further. speed varies considerably for different loading conditions of the motor. The motor can be started in three different ways using an auto-transformer as shown in Fig. 6.17. In Fig. 6.17 (a) the voltage across the main winding and the auxiliary winding are varied simultaneously resulting in low starting torque for low speed operation. This shortcoming, however, can be overcome by first starting the motor on high speed and then stepping it down to low speed as shown in Fig. 6.17 (a). Fig. 6.16 Control circuit for a two speed split phase induction motor having two main and two auxiliary windings dharm d:N-MachMac6-1.pm5 162
  • 180. CONTROL OF SINGLE PHASE MOTORS 163 Good starting torque at all speeds can be obtained if the auxiliary winding is connected across the mains supply and voltage adjustment is provided only for the main winding as shown in Fig. 6.17 (b). Selector H switch H 220V AC 220V AC M M H L L Off M 220V AC Off L Aux Main Aux Off Main Main Aux Cap Cap (a) (b) (c) Fig. 6.17 Voltage control method for speed adjustment of split capacitor motors In the third method of connections shown in Fig. 6.17 (c), the two windings are connected to a tapped auto transformer so that any voltage change across the main winding is accompanied by an inverse change across the auxiliary winding. This method with a properly designed motor can be applied to an installation whose speed should not be sensitive to variations of normal line voltage. In another design of split motor a special winding arrangement is made to eliminate the requirement of an auto tansformer. The motor in this case, in addition to the main and the auxiliary windings, is provided with a so called intermediate winding. The intermediate winding so provided is in space phase with the main winding. The main and the intermediate windings occupy the same slots, the later placed directly over the former. They need not have the same number of turns. The wire of the intermediate winding is invariably smaller in size than the main winding. Two different connections for this type of motor design are shown in Fig. 6.18 (a and b). Capacitor winding Main winding Main Auxiliary winding 110V 230V Auxiliary winding Intermediate H winding Intermediate H winding L L (a) (b) Fig. 6.18 Speed control of split capacitor motor with intermediate winding dharm d:N-MachMac6-1.pm5 163
  • 181. 164 CONTROL OF MACHINES The connection scheme shown in Fig. 6.18 (a) is generally used for 110 volt motors. The main and the intermediate winding are connected in series across the auxiliary winding and the capacitor. The terminal of SPDT (Single Pole Double Throw) switch H and L are wired to the intermediate winding as shown in Fig. 6.18 (a). Connections shown in Fig. 6.18 (b) are used for 230 voltage motors. REVIEW QUESTIONS 1. How are single phase motors classified ? Name different types of motors under each classifica- tion. 2. What modifications are required to use a dc series motor on ac supply ? 3. Draw connection scheme for armature reversing of a universal motor. 4. Discuss two field method of reversing the direction of rotation of a universal motor. 5. How can the speed of a universal motor be controlled ? 6. Draw power and control diagram for starting a two-value capacitor type split phase motor. 7. Explain with the help of diagram how a current relay and an auto transformer can be utilised for starting a capacitor split phase motor. 8. Discuss dynamic breaking of a split phase induction motor. 9. Discuss plug reversing of capacitor start motors using an electromagnetic relay and a special two contact centrifugal switch. 10. Draw power and control diagram for a two speed split phase induction motor having two main and two auxiliary windings. 11. Explain how you will obtain the speed control of a permanent split capacitor motor. dharm d:N-MachMac6-1.pm5 164
  • 182. % Control of Synchronous Motors 7.1 CONSTRUCTION AND OPERATION OF A SYNCHRONOUS MOTOR The stator winding of a synchronous motor is similar to that of a 3 phase induction motor. The rotor consists of salient poles excited by dc field windings like that of inward-projecting poles of a dc motor. The rotor field windings are energised by direct current passed through slip rings from an external source or from a dc generator, mounted on the same rotor shaft. When the stator winding is energised from a 3 phase supply, a revolving magnetic field, 120 f the speed of which is given by Ns = is produced. This speed is called synchronous speed. P To enable the synchronous motor to run at the above mentioned synchronous speed the rotor field winding is energised and at the same time brought near to the synchronous speed, by some other means. The rotor poles, which are always equal to that of the stator poles, are pulled to synchronous speed and the two set of poles lock with each other and the rotor starts rotating at synchronous speed. Thus, to run a synchronous motor, the rotor has to be brought near to synchronous speed first by some means, say by some external prime mover. This is a big disadvantage of this motor. However, a synchronous motor is made self starting by providing a squirrel cage winding (like that of an induction motor) along with the dc field winding on the rotor. In such a case when three phase supply is applied across the stator windings the rotor starts rotating as an induction motor and when it reaches near its final speed (near synchronous speed), dc field winding is energised and the rotor thus pulls into synchronism with the revolving field and continues to run at synchronous speed. At synchronous speed there will be no current in the squirrel cage winding since at synchronous speed slip is zero. The squirrel cage winding therefore is designed only for short duty services. During the starting period the dc field winding has to be kept shorted through a discharge resistance. This is done so as to avoid building up of an extremely high voltage in the winding. If field is left open circuited a high voltage will develop in the open field winding as it has large number of turns and the relative speed of stator flux to the windings of the poles is high during starting. But this induced high voltage will gradually decrease as the motor will be picking up speed. The induced emf in the field winding is kept to a safe value by shorting the winding. This would limit the demagnetising effect on the main flux otherwise caused due to current flowing in the dc field winding as a result of induced emf in it. This demagnetising effect, if allowed to happen will reduce the starting torque of the motor. If in some special applications a higher starting torque is required the field winding can be left open circuited, but should be sectionalised, to have reduced voltage induced across the separated portions. 165
  • 183. 166 CONTROL OF MACHINES From the above, it is seen that the primary purpose of the squirrel cage in this motor, is for starting the motor. As mentioned earlier this winding is designed for low thermal capacity. If, however, the motor picks up speed too slowly under some loading condition, it will run as induction motor for extended period of time and as a result the squirrel cage winding may get over heated and get damaged. To overcome this problem a certain protection must be provided which should disconnect the motor from the supply in the event of its failure to get synchronised properly within a certain prescribed time. A timing relay is used for this purpose to open the control circuit if the motor fails to synchronise within the set time. Synchronous motors, like the induction motors, can be started by applying line voltage, reduced voltage, or using part winding controllers depending upon the kind of load, frequency of starting, and power serivce restrictions. The starters for the motor can be manual, semi- automatic, or fully-automatic using a polarising frequency relay. From the above it follows that synchronous motor control has two basic functions: (i) To start the motor as an induction motor (the motor can be started by any schemes such as across the line, auto-transformer, primary resistor or any other method) ; (ii) To bring the motor up to synchronous speed by exciting the dc field. Different types of synchronous motor starters are discussed as follows. 7.2 MANUAL PUSH BUTTON SYNCHRONISING STARTER When the START-push button shown in Fig. 7.1 is pressed contactor M gets energised and the motor starts as induction motor. The field winding remains shorted through normally closed contact F1 and discharge resistance. When the motor has reached its maximum speed, the RUN-push button is closed which energises and holds contactor F contacts F2 and F3 closed and contact F1 open. The field winding is thus energised and the motor pulls into synchronism. An ammeter and a rheostat are connected in the field circuit to control the excitation current. L1 L2 L3 P Stop Stop M1 M2 M3 Start M4 Run F4 M5 M F F2 MS A N + (b) Discharge resistance DC F1 F3 – (a) Fig. 7.1 Power and control circuit for a manual push button synchronising starter dharm d:N-MachMac7-1.pm5 166
  • 184. CONTROL OF SYNCHRONOUS MOTORS 167 Unity power factor of the motor can be obtained by adjusting the rheostat. A leading power factor can also be obtained by increasing the excitation. The disadvantage of the starter is that synchronisation of the motor depends entirely upon the judgement of the operator. 7.3 TIMED SEMI-AUTOMATIC SYNCHRONISING In this method the synchronous motor may be brought up to synchronous speed by exciting the field winding with the help of a Definite Time relay instead of a push button. The control scheme is as shown in Fig. 7.2. P Stop TR1 M5 Start M4 M TR F N Fig. 7.2 Control scheme for timed semi-automatic synchronising In this circuit, timer TR is energised along with the main contactor. After a pre-set time delay the rotor accelerates to its maximum when the contact TR1 closes and further accelerates the rotor to synchronous speed by energising the field winding. The setting of the timer is adjusted to the maximum value ever required for the motor to accelerate. This method of starting, like the push button operated synchronising method, is also not satisfactory because of the reason that if the synchronism operation fails, it becomes necessary to depress the STOP-button and repeat the starting cycle. Rotor will however continue to rotate and only the timing cycle will start again. It thus follows that neither the push button nor the timer method of synchronising is a satifactory method of starting. 7.4 AUTOMATIC STARTER USING POLARISED FIELD FREQUENCY RELAY It is known that synchronous motor is started by first accelerating the rotor with the help of its squirrel cage winding upto near its synchronous speed and then synchronising by applying the dc field excitation. In an automatic starter using polarised field frequency relay, synchronisation is obtained automatically when about 92 to 97 percent synchronous speed is obtained with the help of a Polarised Field Frequency Relay (PFR). Such a PFR has two coils one for ac supply and the other for dc supply. This relay is used in the circuit along with a reactor as shown in Fig. 7.3. The working principle of a PFR will be discussed a little later. First we will discuss the functions of a PFR relay and an Out of Step Relay, TR used in the starter circuit shown in Fig. 7.3. dharm d:N-MachMac7-1.pm5 167
  • 185. 168 CONTROL OF MACHINES L1 + DC – L2 L3 P M5 CR1 Stop F1 F2 PFR1 M4 Start resistance Discharge M1 M2 M3 F3 F CR2 TR1 TR Polarised frequency relay MS Reactor AC To motor DC CR M field winding PFR N (a) (b) Fig. 7.3 Power and control circuit for an automatic starter for a synchronous motor using polarised field frequency relay When the START-push button is pressed, CR relay gets energised and consequently the main contactor M, is energised through its contact CR1. It gets hold through its contact CR2 and contact M4 of the main contactor. Normally closed (NC) contact of the overload relay and the Out of Step Relay TR are connected in series with AC coil of relay CR. At the instant of starting when contactor M closes and the motor starts on its squirrel cage winding, the polarised field frequency relay (PFR) opens its normally closed contact PFR1 and thus does not allow the field contactor F to get energised. When the motor reaches 92 to 97 percent of its synchronous speed, PFR relay closes its contact PFR1 which causes energisation of the field contactor F through already closed contact M5. A positive interlocking between the normally closed and the normally open contacts of contactor F causes the normally open contacts F1 and F2 to close earlier than the opening of the normally closed contact F3. This positive overlap is desired in contactor F so that the field winding does not remain open at any instant during starting or running of the motor. An open field winding can cause damage of insulation of the winding due to high voltage developed in it. From the circuit diagram it is clear that as long as contactor F is de-energised, the field winding remains shorted through the normally closed contact F3, the discharge resistance, the Out of Step Relay TR, and the reactor. Now, let us consider the instant when the contactor F closes. The closing of field contactor F applies dc excitation to the field winding and causes the motor to pull into synchronism. Now let us consider the function of Out of Step Relay TR which is connected in series with the field discharge circuit. It the motor fails to synchronise or re-synchronise after pulling out of synchronism within the pre-set time delay of TR relay and if the amount of current induced in field winding exceeds the value set on TR relay, the relay contact opens thereby de-energising the main contactor of the motor. Let us now discuss the working principle of the polarised field frequency relay and also the function of the reactor in the circuit. Polarised field frequency relay has a direct current coil (A), induced field current coil (B), and a pivoted armature with its contact PFR1 as shown in Fig. 7.4. Coil A is connected to the source of dc excitation and thus builds up constant magnetic flux in the relay core and polarises it. Alternating flux produced due to current flowing in coil B is superimposed on the constant flux of coil A. The flux through the armature, thus, dharm d:N-MachMac7-1.pm5 168
  • 186. CONTROL OF SYNCHRONOUS MOTORS 169 depends on the flux produced by both coils A and B. The resultant wave form of flux through the armature is shown in Fig. 7.4 (c). PFR1 A B A B DC AC DC AC (a) (b) DC polarising current Resultant magnetic AC induced in coil A flux in armature excita- field current in coil B tion applied in this direction E Motor synchronise D C D Relay Relay makes contact PFR1 opens to apply excitation to motor (c) Fig. 7.4 Polarised field frequency relay As seen from Fig. 7.4 (c) coil B produces alternating flux of equal positive and negative magnitude. The combined flux through armature will be much larger when coil B flux is opposing the dc coil (coil A) flux as shown in Fig. 7.4 (a). This is so because coil B opposes the flux from dc coil A and causes it to take a longer path through the armature of the relay. This condition has been shown through darker loops (lower loops) of Fig. 7.4 (c). When flux due to coil B is in the other direction as shown in Fig. 7.4 (b), it does not force much flux from coil B to take longer path through the armature. This condition has been shown by darker loops (upper loops) in Fig. 7.4 (b). The armature will open when current level falls to a certain low level as shown by point C in Fig. 7.4. When armature drops, relay contact PFR1 closes which energises the field contactor F. Contact F1 and F2 closes and the rotor field winding is excited by dc supply. F3 opens and removes the short across the field winding. Excitation is applied in a direction opposite in polarity to that of the induced field current at the point of application to compensate for the time required to build up excitation due to magnetic inertia of the motor winding. The inertia is however such that dc excitation does not become appreciably effective until induced current has reversed (Point D on the curve) to the same polarity as the direct current. Excitation then continues to build up until the motor synchronises as shown by point E on the curve. Now we come to the function of the reactor across the rotor field winding and AC coil of PFR relay. When the motor is accelerating the slip frequency is high and therefore the current induced in the field winding will have higher frequency. Thus the reactor would offer a high impedance, the induced current would be diverted to AC coil of PFR relay and the relay would pick up. When the rotor would gain speed, the frequency of induced current would get reduced and therefore reactor impedance would decrease. At 92 to 97 percent of the synchronous speed, reactor impedance will be quite low and thereby allowing more current. Current flow through AC coil B or PFR relay will be reduced. The relay thus would drop precisely at the right moment when rotor speed frequency and polarity of induced current are most favourable for synchronisation. As already explained, when the relay drops, its contact PFR1 closes and completes the control circuit for field contactor F. dharm d:N-MachMac7-1.pm5 169
  • 187. 170 CONTROL OF MACHINES During running of the motor, if an overload or a voltage dip causes the motor to lose synchronism, slip frequency currents are immediately induced in the field winding which flows in the AC coil of PFR relay. Relay armature gets attracted and opens the PFR1 contact. This leads to de-energisation of contact F and thus dc field excitation to rotor is cut off. If the normal conditions of line and load are restored within the preset time of the Out of Step Relay, and if the motor has enough pull-in-torque, the motor will automatically re-synchronise. If, however, the abnormal conditions continue, either the over load relay will operate or the motor will get disconnected from the supply by the Out of Step Relay. REVIEW QUESTIONS 1. Explain in brief the construction and working of a synchronous motor. 2. Discuss Manual push button synchronising circuit for a synchronous motor. 3. Draw the control scheme for timed semi-automatic synchronising. 4. Explain the construction and working of a polarised field frequency relay. 5. Discuss starting of synchronous motor using a polarised field frequency relay. 6. The speed of a synchronous motor is fixed by (a) Stator supply voltage (b) Rotor supply voltage (c) Frequency of power supply and number of poles in stator (d) Starting winding 7. To make the synchronous motor self starting a winding is placed. (a) in the stator pole faces (b) in the rotor pole faces 8. A synchronous motor can be used to increase the power factor of an electrical system by: (a) increasing the speed (b) over exciting the rotor field (c) under exciting the rotor field (d) applying dc to the rotor field 9. Mention the disadvantage of a manual push button operated synchronising starter. Show and explain with the help of a schematic diagram how this is overcome in an automatic starter. dharm d:N-MachMac7-1.pm5 170
  • 188. Protection of Motors 8.1 PROTECTION OF AC MOTORS Contactors, fuses and over-load relays are used for control of motors upto 150 hp while for larger high voltage motors circuit breakers along with protective relaying are used. Moulded Case Circuit Breakers (MCCB) are used for LT (low tension i.e. low voltage) motors of high ratings. MCCBs are available for range settings upto 800 A. In general two basic protections are always provided for every motor ; (i) Over-load protection. (ii) Short-circuit protection. In addition to these, protection against unbalanced supply voltages, under voltage, reverse phase, over temperature, stalling, etc. are provided in motors used in special applications. 8.2 CO-ORDINATION OF FUSE, OVER-LOAD RELAY AND CONTACTOR/ CIRCUIT BREAKER OPERATING CHARACTERISTICS While studying starters for induction motors it has been seen that the fuses and the overload power contacts are connected in series with the motor supply lines. An over load protective device provides protection to a motor against carrying sustained over current which may be due to mechanical over-loading or under voltage supply. Fuses on the other hand, provide protection against any earth fault or short Fuse characteristic circuit in the motor winding or at its terminals. The characteristic of fuse should Margin to avoid be co-ordianted with the starting current of operation of the the motor. An induction motor draws 6 to 7 fuse during times the full load current during starting starting period and this current approximately Current remains at this high value upto about 80% of the rated speed. The fuse characteristic and the starting current characteristic of the Motor starting current characteristic motor should be matched as shown in Fig. 8.1. It is clear from Fig. 8.1 that sufficient margin should be there between the start- Time ing current characteristic and fuse charac- teristic to avoid blowing of the fuse during Fig. 8.1 Co-ordination of fuse and motor starting current characteristics 171
  • 189. 172 CONTROL OF MACHINES starting. When starting current of a motor is not known, the following approximations may be made : Type of Starting Motor starting current times the rated load current Direct-on-line 6 to 8 Star-delta 2.5 to 3 Auto-transformer 2.5 to 4 Slip-ring starter 1 to 2 In a starter the breaking capacity of contactor or circuit breaker should be fully exploited. For this purpose the overload characteristic, which is responsible for switching off the contactor/ circuit breaker, should be co-ordinated with fuse in such a way that for the value of fault current upto the breaking capacity of contactor/circuit breaker, the circuit breaker should operate and for current higher than rated value of contactor/circuit breaker, the fuse should blow. To obtain this co-ordination the characteristic of over-load relay should lie below the characteristic of the fuse as shown in Fig. 8.2. These characteristic should intersect at a point, preferably above the breaking current capacity of the contactor/ IB circuit breaker. As seen from Fig. 8.2 it is clear that for any fault current greater than IA Capacity of contactor IA, the operating time for fuse to blow is Current or circuit breaker smaller than the overload tripping time, and, for current lower than IA the over-load IC tripping time is less than the blowing time Fuse characteristic of the fuse. For currents smaller than IA, Over-load the fuse will however provide back-up characteristic protection, that is, it will blow if the over- t 1 t2 t3 t4 load fails to strip. Referring to Fig. 8.2 it is Time observed that for current IB I A fuse operating time t1 t2 i.e., of the overload Fig. 8.2 Matching of fuse and overload relay tripping time and for current IC IA fuse characteristic for motor protection operating time t4 t3 i.e., of the overload tripping time. 8.3 OVERLOAD, SHORT CIRCUIT, AND OVER-TEMPERATURE PROTECTION 8.3.1 Overload and Short Circuit Protection Motors are designed to operate under definite temperature rise limitation which depends upon the class of insulation used. The most serious effect of overload on motor is the temperature rise of the motor which tends to weaken the insulation and thus shorten its life. The expected life of insulation is halved for every 10°C rise in temperature above the recommended upper limit. Temperature rise depends on heating and heating is caused due to one or more of the following reasons: (i) Types of load (continuous or intermittent) (ii) Mechanical overloading (iii) Reduced line voltage dharm d:N-MachMac8-1.pm5 172
  • 190. PROTECTION OF MOTORS 173 (iv) Higher ambient temperature (v) Inability of the machine to cool itself. All the above reasons do not cause over current. For example, higher ambient temperature will not cause excessive current to be drawn by the motor but will cause over-heating. It is therefore clear that protective devices must be designed to trip the motor on the basis of temperature rather than on the basis of only over-load current. Operation of a circuit breaker is however an exception to this practice which operates to trip instantly to avoid damaging effects of a short circuit or a sudden current increase of extremely high value. Moulded Case Circuit Breakers, now being extensively used in L.T. installations, however, have both the over load and short circuit tripping facility. In MCCBs, currents greater than 10 times the rated current are broken instantly by magnetic release while currents less than 10 times are broken by thermal overload element having inverse time characteristic. Although many designs and constructions of overload relays are used in control circuits for motors, they can however be classified on the basis of two general principles of operation viz. (i) Thermal principle (ii) Electromagnetic principle In thermal overload relays (this has been explained in details earlier) the temperature sensitive element such as bimetallic strip of low melting point is used. The relay has inverse time characteristic i.e., it responds more rapidly to increased current and vice-versa. L1 L2 L3 Supply to control circuit Over-load C.T contact Star-Delta Control starter circuit M 120 H.P 3~ Fig. 8.3 Overload relay connection through CTs for overload protection of a motor of high rating dharm d:N-MachMac8-1.pm5 173
  • 191. 174 CONTROL OF MACHINES The electromagnetic type of relay operates instantly when over-current reaches some definite value. Time delay is obtained by using dashpot or magnetic varying assembly. Overload can be auto reset or hand reset. In hand reset, a knob has to be pressed to reset the relay. For larger motors upto 1500 hp, overload relays are connected indirectly through current transformers, as heat dissipation becomes a problem in higher rating of overload elements. For example, for a 120 hp motor having a rated current of 170 amps, current tansformer of 200/5 A are connected to an overload relay of 3-6 range. Connection of an overload relay through current transformers has been shown in Fig. 8.3 in block diagram form. 5 For full load of 170 amps the overload needs to be set at × 170 = 4.3 A. For this 200 overload setting at 4.3 A, the overload would protect the motor for rated current. For still larger LT motors, as already explained, MCCBs are used which are available with thermal settings up 800 A. For high voltage motors above 1200 hp, Circuit Breakers along with protective relays are used as shown in Fig. 8.4. L1 L2 L3 Circuit breaker Over current relay Earth fault C.T relay Over current relay M 3~ Fig. 8.4 Protection of H.T. motor using over current relays and earth fault relay In this circuit two over current relays and one earth fault relay have been connected. Over current relay has instantaneous element as well as inverse time element. Inverse time element is set at somewhat less than 4 times the rated current of the motor allowing sufficient time delay so that the motor does not trip during starting. Instantaneous element is set so as to pick up at little above the locked rotor current and provide short circuit protection. The earth fault relay also has instantaneous as well as inverse dharm d:N-MachMac8-1.pm5 174
  • 192. PROTECTION OF MOTORS 175 time delay elements. Its inverse-time delay element is adjusted to pick up at not more than about 20% of rated current or about 10% of the maximum available ground fault current whichever is smaller. The instantaneous element should pick up at current ranging from about 2.5 to 10 times the rated current. For larger motors, Percentage Differential Relaying is provided for short circuit protection. The advantage of this protection is that it provides faster and more sensitive protection than over current relaying and at the same time it does not operate on starting or on other transient over currents. For continuous rated motors without short time overload ratings, the protective relays or devices should be adjusted to trip at not more than about 115% of rated motor current. For motors with 115% short time overload rating, tripping should occur at not more than about 125% of rated motor current. The tripping current should not exceed 140% of rated motor current even if the motor has high short time overload ratings. 8.3.2 Over Temperature Protection For over temperature protection a special type of semiconductor device known as thermistor is used. It is also known as thermistor type overload relay. This makes use of a special semiconductor resistor, chemically similar to ceramic oxides. The unique property of the material is that the resistance is comparatively low at normal temperature, remains nearly constant upto some critical value, and has an extremely large positive temperature co-efficient of resistance within a narrow range above the critical temperature. Moreover, by varying the composition of doping of the ceramic disc which is about the size of a small tablet, the critical range can be controlled to permit selection of the temperature at which protection is required. Another good feature is that its power carrying capacity is self-limiting since the device has the tendency to increase its resistance as the temperature rises. Since the device is small enough to be placed in direct contact with the motor winding and has good thermal response, it eliminates the delay factor in transferring heat to the actual sensing elements. The element is encapsulated in an epoxy resin having compatable thermal, electrical and mechanical properties and is generally capable of carrying the coil current of industrial type relays. In the circuit diagram of Fig. 8.5 three thermistors are shown placed at the surfaces of three stator windings of a motor. During starting sufficient current will flow through the CR relay to actuate it as the temperature and resistance of the thermistors are low. When the START-push button is pressed the primary winding of control transformer T1 gets energised and therefore the secondary winding sends direct current to CR relay through diodes D1 and D2. With the closing of CR, contact CR1 closes and hence coil M gets energised. The three main contacts close and the motor is energised. Whenever there is excessive motor temperature due to some reason, the thermistor resistance increases and causes reduction in the current flowing through CR relay coil. Thus the CR relay drops, which in turn drops contactor M and therefore the motor stops. The motor can be started again only when temperature and hence resistance of the thermistors drop to low values. For this, the relay is adjusted such that its pick up current is more than twice its drop out current. dharm d:N-MachMac8-1.pm5 175
  • 193. 176 CONTROL OF MACHINES Stop Start M CR1 T1 D1 D2 Motor stator windings CR Thermistor Fig. 8.5 Three phase motor protected by thermistor overload relay 8.3.3 Under Voltage Protection If the starter of a motor is controlled by a maintained contact control device, the contactor will drop out when supply fails and will get energised L again when supply is restored. This type of control DIODE can be used where the operator is not required to be near the machine. If, however, an operator is CR2 there on the machine, such unpredictable re- starting of the motor may cause accident to the CR1 Start operator. Motors are mostly controlled by push but- tons and spring returned master switches which R provide under voltage protections. Contactors do not pick up when supply is restored. AC contactors have a short drop out time. A system disturbance Stop resulting in a voltage dip for a very short time Capacitor will shut off the motors. In continuous process industries it is desired that the plant should not CR M stop for such small duration of voltage dips. To achieve this, undervoltage protection as shown N in Fig. 8.6 is used. Fig. 8.6 Under voltage protection circuit dharm d:N-MachMac8-1.pm5 176
  • 194. PROTECTION OF MOTORS 177 Main contactor M is controlled through normally open contact of under voltage relay CR. Relay CR is a dc relay fed through a rectifier. A capacitor gets charged to supply voltage. When power supply fails, capacitor discharges through the CR coil and keeps the relay closed for some time. If during this period supply is restored contactor M will automatically get energised due to already closed contact CR2 of relay CR. Careful judgement has to be exercised while using this protection scheme. High switching transients may result in automatic starting of the motor due to the magnetic flux remaining entrapped, especially in larger motors. It may be understood that undervoltage protection may not be provided to all motors as simultaneous starting of all motors on restoration of power supply will result in drawing of high current from the mains which can cause large voltage drop in the system. 8.3.4 Phase Failure and Phase Reversal Protection If a fuse blows or a wire carrying supply to a motor breaks while the motor is running, the motor will continue to run on two healthy phases but will draw higher currents. This is known as single phasing of a 3-phase motor. The current in the two healthy phases would increase by 1.73 times. This would cause severe overheating of rotor due to negative phase sequence currents flowing as a result of unbalanced voltages. On the other hand, if two phases of supply to a three phase induction motor are interchanged the motor will reverse its direction of rotation. This action is called phase reversal and it can cause injury to people and damage to equipment in many applications. To protect a motor against these conditions, phase failure and phase reversal relays are used. Many types of design of phase failure and phase reversal relays are available. One type of relay which provides protection for both phase failure and phase reversal consists of four magnetic poles the coil of which are excited by the currents of the two stator phases of the motor. These coils set up a rotating flux which intersects a disc pivoted at the centre. A torque is produced due to interaction of flux and eddy currents induced in the disc. Torque is made of two components: A clockwise rotating torque is produced by the normal polyphase supply and a counter clockwise torque is produced due to the action of the shaded poles. When balanced three phase currents are flowing through the windings, clockwise torque is pre-dominant and it tends to turn the disc in clockwise direction. The turning of the disc, however, is prevented beyond a certain point when a projection on disc comes to rest against a stopper. If one line opens the polyphase clockwise torque disappears while counter clockwise torque due to pole shaders remains and rotates the disc in the counter clockwise direction. The projection on the disc actuates a contact which is connected in series with the contactor coil. In case of phase reversal, the polyphase torque helps the counter clockwise torque to turn the disc and actuate the contact disconnecting the motor from the line. Another very common type of relay being used nowadays is based on detecting negative phase sequence currents during single phasing and during unbalanced voltages. This relay has two built in current transformers which sense currents of the motor. The secondary of CTs feeds a negative sequence filter. The output of this filter is proportional to the negative sequence component of currents. This output is fed to a sensor which detects the level of negative sequence components of the currents and thus trips the motor starter by opening its control contactor. dharm d:N-MachMac8-1.pm5 177
  • 195. 178 CONTROL OF MACHINES 8.4 PROTECTION OF DC MOTORS Like ac motors, dc motors are also protected against short circuit and overload faults. For overload protection, the thermal relay used however will have only one element as against three elements connected in series with the three phases in ac motors. In addition to these basic protections, field failure protection in shunt motors is provided by a field failure relay. When a shunt motor is run on variable speed by inserting a rheostat in series with the shunt field winding, two more protections namely Field Acceleration and Field De-acceleration protections are also provided. All these three types of field protections are discussed as follows: 8.4.1 Field Failure Protection Circuit for dc Shunt Motors If the main field of a shunt motor or a compound motor is extremely weakened or if there is complete loss of main field excitation, a serious damage to motor can occur under certain conditions of operation. Since the speed of a dc motor is inversely proportional to flux, its speed tends to rise rapidly when the flux is decreased. If the field failure occurs on a motor which is coupled to a load, which can neither be removed nor be reduced to a very low value, the residual flux due to the open field will develop a torque which will not be able to sustain rotation. Thus the motor will stall, heavy current will be drawn from the mains and the overload relay will trip. On the other hand if field failure occurs on an unloaded motor or if the application is such that it permits the motor to be unloaded or overhauled as in the case of a hoist, the motor will not stall but instead its armature will accelerate quickly to a mechanically dangerous high speed or there will be destructive commutation. To prevent the above situation of over speeding, a field failure relay is used. This relay consists of a low voltage coil which is connected in series with the shunt field. The relay has a normally open (NO) contact which is connected in series with the main contactor coil circuit as shown in Fig. 8.7. + M3 Stop M1 Accelerating M2 relays and Start contactors M – FL1 R1 1A R2 2A FL M – Fig. 8.7 Circuit diagram for the field failure protection of dc shunt motor dharm d:N-MachMac8-1.pm5 178
  • 196. PROTECTION OF MOTORS 179 As seen from Fig. 8.7, the relay coil FL has been connected in series with the shunt winding. Normally, the relay remains picked up and its contact FL1 in series with the overload contact remains closed. Whenever the field opens, relay FL drops and its contact FL1 opens to de-energise main contactor M. Thus the FL relay prevents overload tripping or overspeeding of the motor, as the case may be. 8.4.2 Field Acceleration Protection Circuit This protection scheme is provided in shunt motors, where speeds higher than the base speed (rated speed) are desired to be achieved by inserting resistance in the field winding. For a motor which is to be operated at speeds higher than the base speed, two difficulties are faced which are as under: (i) If the resistance in field is inserted during starting, field current will be low and, therefore, the motor will draw heavy inrush current to produce the required torque (as torque developed depends upon fiux and armature current). To minimise the inrush current it is therefore desired that the motor should be operated on full field strength while it is accelerating i.e., while accelerating resistors are being cut out and the speed is increasing. This means, the field regulating resistance should be inserted only when the motor has reached the base speed. (ii) When the field regulating resistance is inserted, an extremely high armature cur- rent is drawn because motor must develop considerable additional torque to speed up. This excessive current peak can be avoided if resistance is inserted slowly or in multiple steps. Both of the above requirements that is (i) short circuiting the field rheostat until the motor reaches base speed, and (ii) weakening the field slowly above the base speeds are fulfilled by a field accelerating relay. This relay limits the armature current peaks, prevents tripping of overloading relay, prevents commutator flash over and makes the motor accelerate smoothly to the desired higher speed. Field acceleration relay FA is constructed with a series exciting coil having an intermediate tapping. Its contact is provided with magnetic blowout and an arc shield for efficient arc extinction. Pick-up value of relay is adjusted by varying the air gap between magnetic core and plunger by a slotted nut. The drop out value can be adjusted by varying the tension of a spring. The double coil design of the relay not only permits it to pick-up at higher currents when acceleration proceeds above the base speed but also at low currents when the motor is accelerating up to base speed with the accelerating resistances in circuit. Figure 8.8 shows the connection of a field accelerating relay in the control circuit. In the control diagram shown in Fig. 8.8 it is seen that the tapped exciting coil is connected in series with the armature circuit. When the motor is started, armature current flows through all the turns of the accelerating relay and the relay closes its NO contact FA1 across the field rheostat. Thus the field rheostat is short-circuited during the acceleration period. When contactor 3A gets energised it short circuits a portion of the field acceleration relay winding in addition to the accelerating resistance R3. Now FA relay has fewer ampere turns for a given value of armature current. When the motor reaches base speed and armature current falls to normal value, the relay will drop and its contact FA1 will open and resistance RA would come into the field winding circuit. Insertion of rheostat RA in the field winding will accelerate the motor further and in doing so armature current would rise sufficiently to acturate relay FA. The rheostat FA would be short circuited second time. The armature current will again decrease and same action of relay FA will be repeated. The relay may open and close its contact FA1 several times before the motor reaches its final speed. dharm d:N-MachMac8-1.pm5 179
  • 197. 180 CONTROL OF MACHINES + M1 Stop Accelerating relays and contactors M2 Start M I.W FA Rheostat Field circuit FA1 R3 3A RA R2 2A M R1 1A Fig. 8.8 Field accelerating protection circuit for a dc motor The above operation can also be obtained by another type of field acceleration relay which has a shunt coil of many turns and a series coil of a few turns of heavy copper. The polarities of coil are additive i.e., their mmfs produce fluxes in the same direction during acceleration. This relay is used in a circuit which uses delay type contactors for cutting out acceleration resistance. Connection of this type of relay when used in the starter with delay type contactors, has been shown in Fig. 8.9. In this circuit when the START-push button is pressed contactors 1A, 2A and 3A are energised, their contacts 1A1, 2A1 and 3A1 open and therefore resistances are inserted in the armature circuit. Contactor M closes after energisation of contactor 3A by its contact 3A2 and is held energised through its own contact M1. Energisation of contactor 3A in turn causes energisation of shunt winding of relay FA. Its contact FA1 opens to insert rheostat RA in the shunt winding of the motor. As soon as contactor M is energised its contact M3 opens and de- energises contactor 1A which drops after its pre-set delay. Its contact 1A1 closes and shorts resistance R1. Interlocking contact of 1A in the circuit of contactor 2A opens and thereby contactor 2A de-energises after the pre-set delay. When finally contactor 3A drops and cuts off resistance R3, it also de-energises shunt winding of relay FA due to opening of contact 3A3. Relay FA thus drops and its contact FA1 opens and rheostat RA gets inserted in the circuit. As already explained, inrush of current takes place which generates sufficient ampere turns in the series coil and this causes the relay to pick up and hence rheostat RA is shorted a second dharm d:N-MachMac8-1.pm5 180
  • 198. PROTECTION OF MOTORS 181 time. Thus relay FA closes and opens its contact several times before the motor reaches its final speed. Fig. 8.9 Protection for dc shunt motor using field acceleration relay having series and shunt coil 8.4.3 Field Deceleration Protection Circuit This protection is required when a shunt or a compound motor running at high speed is to be brought down to a low speed by cutting down field circuit rheostat resistance. When the field circuit resistance is suddenly cut out or decreased the flux would rise suddenly while the speed of motor will still remain high. It thus gives rise to high counter emf (cemf is proportional to flux and speed), induced in the armature which may exceed the impressed supply voltage. Under such conditions cemf will send back current into the mains and this increase in current will be so quick that flash over may occur at the commutators. This abnormal condition can be avoided by using a field deceleration relay which would automatically weaken the field during the slow down period. Field deceleration relay FD is similar in the construction to the field acceleration relay FA having shunt and series exciting coils. The shunt and series coils are so connected that the polarities of their mmfs are oppositely directed. The NC contact of the relay is connected across a separate field deceleration resistor RD as shown in Fig. 8.10. To understand the working of the circuit, let us assume that under normal conditions the motor is running at a higher speed with rheostat RA in series with field, winding. In this condition deceleration relay FD will get dropped out (as mmfs of two coils cancel each other) and its contact FD1 will short resistance RD. When the portion of Rheostat resistances RA is cut out of the circuit to decrease the motor speeds the counter emf becomes more than the dharm d:N-MachMac8-1.pm5 181
  • 199. 182 CONTROL OF MACHINES impressed supply voltage and thus armature current flowing through the series winding suddenly reverses. This causes the mmfs due to shunt and series coils to be additive and therefore the relay FD picks up and opens its contact FD1 across resistance RD. Insertion of RD in series with the field winding reduces the field flux and thus the counter emf is brought down quickly so that normal current flows through the armature. This normal current flow causes relay FD to drop. Its contact FD1 recloses across resistance RD and the motor settles down to its reduced speed setting. + M2 M3 Stop Accelerating M M1 relays and Start contactors FA FA1 FL1 RA 3A R3 2A R2 FD1 RD 1A R1 F.L M Series Shunt FD coil coil – Field deceleration relay Fig. 8.10 Circuit diagram showing field failure, field acceleration and field deceleration protection for a dc shunt motor REVIEW QUESTIONS 1. How will you match the fuse characteristic with the starting current characteristic of a motor ? Explain with the help of a diagram. 2. Explain how the contactor rating, fuse and overload relay characteristic are matched for motor protection. 3. What are the different possible causes of over heating of a motor ? 4. Show how an ordinary overload relay of 2-5 A range can be used for protection of a 150 hp motor. dharm d:N-MachMac8-1.pm5 182
  • 200. PROTECTION OF MOTORS 183 5. Draw protection circuit for a H.T. motor using current relay and earth fault relays. 6. What is a thermistor ? Show how it can be used for over-temperature protection of a motor. 7. Why under voltage protection is not provided for all motors in industries ? 8. Draw under voltage protection circuit for an induction motor. 9. Disuss field failure protection circuit of dc shunt motor. 10. Disuss field acceleration protection for dc shunt motor using field acceleration relay having two coils in series and intermediate tapping. 11. Discuss field acceleration protection for dc shunt motor using a relay having series and shunt coils. 12. When do we require field deceleration protection ? How is this achieved in dc shunt motors ? 13. Temperature rise of a motor depends on: (a) mechanical overloading (b) reduced line voltage (c) higher ambient temperature (d) all of these. 14. When the temperature of motor rises above the prescribed upper limit, the life of its insulation is halved for every: (a) 5°C rise in temperature (b) 10°C rise in temperature (c) 15°C rise in temperature (d) 20°C rise in temperature. 15. As the temperature rise above the critical temperature of a thermostat, its resistance; (a) decreases (b) increases (c) remains constant. 16. If one fuse of a motor gets blown during running, the current in the healthy phases will rise to ........ times the normal current. (a) 1.70 (b) 1.73 (c) 1.75 (d) 2.00. dharm d:N-MachMac8-1.pm5 183
  • 201. ' Industrial Control Circuits 9.1 INTRODUCTION In industry a control engineer is frequently called upon to design and modify control circuits as per specified requirements. He is also expected to slove unusual problems occurring in control circuits. Considerable amount of knowledge and experience is required to accomplish the above mentioned tasks. In modern industry very few machines operate from a single motor. Most of machines have a number of operations. These operations are controlled by different motors or by a number of cylinder piston assemblies powered by hydraulic (oil) or pneumatic (air) pressure. The specific sequence of operations are obtained through relay contacts, timer contacts or through actuation of sensing devices like limit switches, pressure switches, temperature switches etc. As the number of components used on a machine increase, the circuit becomes more and more complex. This chapter includes study of a number of industrial circuits of varying degrees of complexity. Most of the machines discussed here are general purpose machines found in most of the industries. For each circuit discussed, first a brief description about the machine operation has been given and then the working of its control circuit has been discussed in detail. Working of complex circuits has been explained in steps. Having thoroughly understood the working of all the circuits given in this chapter one should be able to read and analyse any industrial control circuits that he may encounter in practice. 9.2 PLANER MACHINE Planer machines (also called a shaper) is one of the basic machines used in all mechanical workshops. This machine is used for shaping a job/work piece to required dimensions by a cutting tool. This machine can be of two types, viz., (i) Where the job or the workpiece is fixed and the cutting tool moves to and fro to remove the extra material from the job. (ii) Where the cutting tool is fixed and the job or the workpiece moves to and fro. Here, we will study the second type of machine in which the cutting tool is stationary and the job fixed on a table (also known as bed) moves to and fro. The to and fro movement of the bed is achieved by forward and reverse rotation of the motor. Rotational motion of the motor is converted into longitudinal motion with the help of rack and pinion arrangement. Rotational motion of the motor is transmitted to the load with the help of an electrically operated clutch. When the dc coil of this clutch is energised the motor pulley gets coupled to the bed side pulley. When the coil is de-energised the motor pulley gets decoupled from the bed side pulley and the bed comes to standstill quickly. The clutch coil is energised along with the motor 184
  • 202. INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS 185 irrespective of whether the motor is to run in forward direction or in reverse direction. The limit of forward and reverse movement of the bed is determined by the positions of two limit switches as shown in Fig. 9.1. This figure also shows the rack and pinion arrangement for obtaining to and fro movement of the bed. Work piece Planing tool Table bed Rack LLS RLS Pinion Left limit switch Right limit switch Coupled to motor Motor Fig. 9.1 Planner machine arrangement When bed moves towards right side the work piece placed on table bed is worked upon by the cutting tool. Forward movement towards the right direction will be stopped due to actuation of a limit switch RLS. Actuation of this limit switch will also initiate bed movement in the reverse direction i.e., from right to left direction. Reverse motion of the bed would stop when the left side limit switch LLS gets actuated, and immediately will start another cycle of bed movement. It may be understood that the cutting tool works on the job only in forward movement of the bed. No material is cut from the job in the reverse direction. To start with, the cutting tool is given a fixed depth of cut. After one cycle of bed movement the tool gets horizontal feed (i.e., step movement perpendicular to the direction of bed movement) automatically through mechanical gear arrangment. The starting position for the machine is that the bed should be in the extreme left position with the limit switch LLS actuated. If the bed is stationed in between the two limit switches the machine can be started by pressing any of the Forward or Reverse-push buttons. The drive for the machine movement is a 3 phase squirrel cage induction motor which is controlled by a forward/reverse starter. The forward/reverse starter of this motor is controlled through two limit switches namely, the left side limit switch LLS and the right side limit switch RLS. These two limit switches restrict the movement of bed or the motor in either direction. The power circuit of the motor includes simple connections for forward reverse operation of the motor. In Fig. 9.2 only the control circuit has been shown. Working of the control circuit of Fig. 9.2 is explained as follows: (i) As discussed earlier, the pre-condition for starting the machine in Auto mode is that the bed should be in extreme left position actuating the limit switch LLS; (ii) When the bed is at extreme left position and the limit switch LLS is actuated, nor- mally open (NO) contact LLS1 will be closed and normally closed (NC) contact LLS2 will be open. In this position of the bed the right side limit switch RLS will be in unactuated condition, its contact RLS1 being open and RLS2 being closed. dharm d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5 185
  • 203. 186 CONTROL OF MACHINES S2 1 P Stop LLS1 F1 R1 RLS1 F3 R3 S1 Start RLS2 LLS2 R2 F2 Clutch coil S F R N Start relay Forward contactor Reverse contactor Clutch Fig. 9.2 Control diagram for planner machine (iii) Now, when the START-push button is pressed starting relay S gets energised and is held through its contact S1. Supply then reaches the control bus through contact S2. (iv) With the energisation of control bus contactor F which runs the motor in the right (forward) direction will get energised through closed contact LLS1 and normally closed contacts RLS2 and R2. Contactor F will now get hold through its own contact F1 since LLS1 will open as soon as the bed starts moving in right direction. (v) Electrically operated clutch will get engaged as soon as contactor F is energised (the clutch coil will get energised through Contact F3). Clutch coil will get energised again when the reverse contactor R will be energised, contacts F3 and R3 being connected in parallel. DC current is fed to the coil by a rectifier bridge to have a strong mag- netic action; (vi) When the bed reaches extreme right position limit switch RLS is actuated, its con- tact RLS1 closes while RLS2 opens and causes de-energisation of contactor F and thus supply to the motor is cut off and the clutch is also disengaged. The bed comes to stop quickly. (vii) Due to closing of limit switch RLS, contactor R will be energised when contactor F drops. Contactor R will get energised through closed contact RLS1 and normally closed contacts LLS2 and F2, and will be held through its own contact R1. Its contact R3 will energise the clutch coil. Closing of contactor R will therefore cause movement of the bed towards the left till left side limits LLS is actuated. (viii) When the limit switch LLS is actuated contactor R will get de-energised due to open- ing of contact LLS2 while contactor F again will get energised through closed contact LLS1 and normally closed contact RLS2 and R2. Thus it is seen that after completing one cycle of movement, the bed again starts automatically for the second cycle and so on without having any need to press the Cycle START-push button. This to and fro motion will continue till the STOP-push button is pressed to de-energise the start relay. (ix) If the bed stops in between due to power failure, the machine would not start in Auto mode when Cycle START-push button is pressed after the supply is restored. This is because when both the limit switches LLS and RLS are in de-actuated condition dharm d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5 186
  • 204. INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS 187 their contacts LLS1 and RLS1 are open. Thus neither contactor F nor contactor R picks up when the start relay is energised. In this condition to start the machine the bed has to be moved to the extreme left or to the extreme right by pressing the respective Reverse or Forward push buttons. These push buttons are connected in parallel with the limit switch contacts LLS1 and RLS1 as shown in the control dia- gram. 9.3 SKIP HOIST CONTROL Skip hoist is used in industry for shifting material from floor level to some higher altitude. Skip hoist consists of a trolley which moves on rails on an inclined plane. On reaching the top of the incline the trolley tilts and drops the material into a large container called silos. The material from silos is then utilised as per requirement. Tilting of trolley at the top is done by mechanical means. The trolley is tilted only upto a particular angle and it remains in that position for a preset time to allow all the material to fall into silos. After the preset halt at the top the trolley returns down the incline. See Fig. 9.3. Motor pulley Tilted trolley Up limit switch Wire rope Container Mechanical (Silos) stop Trolley Gate Down limit switch Fig. 9.3 Schematic representation of a skip hoist The hoist is operated by a rope wound on the drum attached to the shaft of an induction motor. Two limit switches are provided, one for stopping the trolley at bottom of the incline, and the other at the top of the incline. The motor is stopped quickly by an electromagnetic brake which is not shown in the figure. Normally, when power is off, the brake remains engaged and it opens when the motor is energised. The movement of trolley in the skip hoist is governed by a 3 phase, 415 volt induction motor. This induction motor is controlled by two contactors U and D. The power diagram is similar to Forward/Reverse starter. When contactor U is energised the motor runs in forward direction and the trolley is pulled up the incline. When contactor D is energised the motor runs in reverse direction and the trolley moves down in the incline. Thermal overload relay is provided for the protection of motor. The control circuit for the skip hoist has been connected between phase (P) and neutral (N), as shown in Fig. 9.4. When the START-push button for upward motion is pressed, contactor dharm d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5 187
  • 205. 188 CONTROL OF MACHINES U gets energised through normally closed contact D2 and LSU1 the upper limit switch. As the U contactor closes the motor runs in forward direction and the trolley is pulled up. When trolley reaches the top of the rail, its front wheel is stopped at the mechanical stop provided on the rail while the motor is still pulling the trolley. As a result, the trolley is tilted as shown through dotted lines in Fig. 9.3. The motor stops when UP limit switch LSU is actuated and its NC contact LSU1 opens and de-energises contactor U. At the same time normally open contact LSU2 of the upper limit switch closes and energises time delay relay T. The motor remains off and the trolley stays tilted for a period, as set on the time delay relay T. This delay is provided so as to allow all the material in the trolley fall into the silos. When the relay operates, its contact T1 closes and energises contactor D (responsible for downward motion) through normally closed contact U2 and normally closed contact LSD1 of the limit switch. As the contactor D closes, motor runs in the reverse direction and the trolley starts moving in downward direction. When the trolley reaches the down position, limit switch LSD is actuated and thus its normally closed contact LSD1 opens and de-energises contactor D. P Stop V1 Start up Ui Start T1 D1 U3 D3 down D2 U2 LSU1 LSU2 LSD1 U T D B N Up Time delay Down Brake Fig. 9.4 Control circuit for a skip hoist For the next cycle of hoist, the START-push button for up motion is pressed when the trolley has been filled with material to be taken up. For manual operation of the downward motion, the DOWN-start push button can be pressed. This push button is necessary for bringing the trolley to down position in case of power interruption during the downward motion of the hoist. The brake coils of the motor are controlled by contactor B. The brake opens when brake coils are energised through closing of contactor B. Contactor B is energised by the normally open contacts U3 and D3 of Up and Down motion contactors. The brake remains engaged when both the contactors are in de-energised condition. dharm d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5 188
  • 206. INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS 189 9.4 AUTOMATIC CONTROL FOR A WATER PUMP The control operations discussed in this section are of a water pump which pumps water from a storage tank into a pressure tank. The pump is allowed to run until the tank is full upto a certain level. To maintain sufficient pressure in the lines, air pressure is maintained into the overhead tank above the water level. The physical arrangement of the pump and the two tanks along with the control components have been shown in Fig. 9.5. Solenoid valve PS1 Air supply FS1 Pressure tank FS2 Discharge FS3 Storage tank Pump Fig. 9.5 Schematic arrangement of overhead pressure tank Various requirements for the proper functioning of the control circuit are as follows: (i) The control operation of pump should be possible either on Manual mode or on Auto mode. A three position selector switch may be used for this purpose. (ii) It should be possible to control the pump so as to maintain the water level in the pressure tank between a high and a low limit. (iii) The pump should be prevented from running in case the water level in the storage tank falls below a certain level. (iv) A certain amount of air pressure on the pressure tank be maintained whenever re- quired. Brief explanation of the functions of various control components has been provided before explaining the control circuit. Float switch FS1 will actuate when water of the tank would reach its upper most level H. Under such limiting position the float switch will stop the pump. Float switch FS2 would sense the lowest level (L) of water in the tank. When this float switch actuates, it would start the pump to raise the water level upto the upper limit. To let pressurised air enter the tank above the water level, a solenoid valve has been provided. When the coil is energised the valve opens and air enters the tank. When sufficient pressure is built up inside the tank, pressure switch PS1 actuates and supply to solenoid valve is cut off. Float switch FS3 in the storage tank has been provided to sense a very low level of water. If the water level in the storage tank would reach a very low level the switch would put off the pump, as otherwise, the pump would fail to lift water from such a low level. The control circuit using all these components has been shown in Fig. 9.6. dharm d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5 189
  • 207. 190 CONTROL OF MACHINES P 4 FS1 Manual OFF Auto 1 FS1 7 Stop 5 PS1 FS3 2 6 8 M1 FS2 M2 Start 3 Solenoil coil S M N Fig. 9.6 Control circuit for a pressurised overhead tank In this control circuit, lines have been marked as 1, 2, 3 and so on so as to help explaining the control circuit. Manual Operation The pump is run on manual mode when there is some fault in the circuit for automatic operation, otherwise the pump is normally run in auto mode. To run the pump in manual mode, the selector switch is put on manual position ‘M’ and line 1 is energised. Contactor M of the pump motor gets energised and is held through its own contact M1 when the START-push button is pressed. The operator has to watch and see that when the tank is nearly full, the pump is stopped by pressing the STOP push button. Auto Operation For automatic operation of the pump, the selector switch is put on Auto mode. On Auto mode of the selector switch, control supply reaches line 6 through normally closed contacts of upper level float switch of discharge tank FS1 and low level float switch FS3 of the storage tank. Supply reaches line 6, if contact FS1 and contact FS3 are not actuated i.e., if water is below the upper most level (H) in pressure tank and above the lowest level in storage tank. Contactor M gets energised when FS2 is actuated i.e., water level falls below the lowest level (L) in pressure tank. Contactor M gets energised through the close contact of FS2 and is held through its own contact. Float switch FS2 then loses control and the pump continues to run even when water rises above the lower limit (L). When the upper limit float switch FS1 is actuated and its normally closed NC contact opens to disconnect supply at line 5, contactor M will get de-energised and the pump would stop. Contactor M is also de-energised if FS3 actuates and opens its normally closed, NC contact when water level in the storage tank goes below the lowest level. From the circuit it is seen that the coil of the solenoid valve is energised when pressure in the tank is below a certain setting and the normally closed contact PS1 of the pressure dharm d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5 190
  • 208. INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS 191 switch is closed. Another condition for allowing the air to enter the tank is that water level should be above the upper level limit set by float switch FS1. When the water level will fall below this level, FS1 will open and air supply will be cut off. When the pressure of air inside the tank increases above the setting, contact PS1 opens to de-energise the solenoid S. 9.5 LIFTING MAGNET Lifting magnets have become an essential material handling equipment where iron and steel are processsed such as in steel mills, foundries, ship operations, scrap yards etc. Lifting magnets are used for handling every form of steel such as scrap, pellets, pig iron and various kinds of finished products such as castings and moulds in foundries, wheels, rails, tie plates, ingots, coiled sheet steel, pipes any type of machine parts. A lifting magnet is put to use with the help of over-head crane. A crane which has a lifting magnet hanging on the hook of its hoist rope is also called a raw material crane. This crane has got two hoist motors, one is for normal lifting and the other, called auxiliary hoist motor, is for moving the lifting magnet up and down. Figure 9.7 shows a lifting magnet in diagrammatic form. Hook of crane Magnet Chain cable Lifting magnet Fig. 9.7 Lifting magnet For lifting magnets circular construction is the most popular one as it permits the operator to handle most types of material without the necessity of positioning the unit accurately with respect to the load. Rectangular type of magnets on the other hand are particularly used for handling of regular shapes of iron and steel such as bars, billets, plates, pipes etc. Connections to the exciting coil of the magnet is done through a cable which runs along with the hoist rope. The cable also winds and rewinds over a durm on the crane depending upon whether the hook moves up or down. In the magnet, the exciting coil is placed over the central pole so that mmf producing flux penetrates into the work to be lifted. The control circuit for energising and de-energising the highly inductive coil circuit of lifting magnet is discussed as follows: For magnets of smaller sizes, Manual drop magnet controllers are used. These are designed with three position master controller having OFF, LIFT and DROP-points or with three push buttons. The circuit diagram for this type of a controller is shown in Fig. 9.8 (a). dharm d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5 191
  • 209. 192 CONTROL OF MACHINES + L1 D2 Lift Drop OFF M Magnet R D3 D1 L2 L D – Fig. 9.8 (a) Lifting magnet circuit using three position switch When the master controller is in OFF position, both contactors L and D are de-energised. When the lever is brought to LIFT position, contactor L gets energised and closes its contact L1 and L2 to energise the magnet coil. When magnet is to be demagnetised, Master controller lever is brought to DROP-position which energises contactor D and de-energises contactor L. Reverse current flows through the magnet coil through contacts D1 and D2 to demagnetise it. When the lever is brought to OFF position, magnet coil discharges through resistance R through normally closed contact, D3 of contactor D. Automatic Drop Magnet controllers are generally used with larger magnets. These have two position controllers. In the ON position the magnet is connected to the line and therefore exciting coil is energised. In the OFF position first the magnet discharges fully and then is demagnetised of its residual magnetism by a reverse current. The circuit diagram for this arrangement has been shown in Fig. 9.8 (b). + L1 R1 D1 ON OFF R3 D3 D L3 a b M Magnet D2 L2 L R2 – Fig. 9.8 (b) Control circuit for lifting magnet with atuo-drop using two position switch When the master switch is moved to the ON position and contactor L picks up, its two line contacts L1 and L2 close and a NC contact L3 opens. Current passes through the coil in the dharm d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5 192
  • 210. INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS 193 direction from a to b. When the load is to be dropped, master switch is moved to the OFF position, contactor L is de-energised and its contact L1 and L2 open. Opening of L1 and L2 disconnects power supply to the magnet. As soon as power gets disconnected a large voltage gets induced in the highly inductive circuit that retards current decay. This voltage energises the contactor D placed across it. Contact D1 and D2 close while D3 opens. The exciting coil of the magnet discharges its energy back to the mains and current gradually diminshes. Resistances R1 and R2 are provided in the circuit to limit the discharge current since the induced voltage in the coil would be very high. The direction of current through the exciting coil is from a to b. As the induced voltage falls, current will first become zero and then reverse. Current will flow from b to a and will demagnetise the magnet of its residual magnetism. When the induced emf of the coil falls sufficiently, the contactor D drops. Its line contacts D1 and D2 open while contact D3 closes. Now the exciting coil of the magnet will discharge its remaining energy in the resistance R3. 9.6 CONTROL OF ELECTRICAL OVEN Electrically heated ovens are used for a wide variety of purpose in industry, e.g., in heat treatment of metals like annealing and hardening, stoving of enamelled wire, drying and baking of cores in foundry, drying and baking of pottery etc. Ovens using wire resistance heating elements can be made to produce temperatures upto 1000°C. Temperatures upto 3000°C can be obtained by using graphite elements. However, such a high temperature is usually obtained by some other convenient methods. Oven enclosure is constructed by using insulating materials between two metal frames or by lining fire bricks inside a metal enclosure. The heating elements are mounted on the top or at the bottom or on the sides, according to the application. An oven can be of batch type or of continuous type. In a batch type oven, material to be heated is stacked inside the oven and then the doors are closed. The doors are opened when the heating time is complete. In a continuous type oven, material to be heated travels slowly through the oven. Continous loading of material into the oven is made. Material to be heated is placed on trolley which move on rails placed inside the oven. Trolleys containing material are loaded into oven at the entrance door while hot material on trolleys are taken out at the exit door. In ovens if heat transfer from heating elements takes place entirely by radiation then there would be a possibility of considerable temperature difference in various parts of the object being heated. To obtain uniform heating of the material, air inside the ovens is circulated by employing blowers. Blowers pass air over the heating elements and then over the object placed in the oven. In this way a certain degree of uniformity in heating is obtained. However, the side of the material which first comes in contact with air flow gets heated up slightly more than on the other sides. This is because heat is given up by air as it travels pass over the material. More uniform heating can be obtained by periodically reversing the direction of flow of air. It is difficult to make actual calculation of the watts or kilowatts electrical power required to heat an object to a desired temperature in a definite time period. The main problem lies in determining the heat losses. Various losses in a resistance over are A = Heat used in raising temperature of oven. B = Heat used in raising temperature of container or carrier. C = Conduction of heat through walls. D = Escape of heat due to opening of the door. dharm d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5 193
  • 211. 194 CONTROL OF MACHINES If W is the heat required to raise the object to required temperature, then the efficiency of the oven is given by W Efficiency = W + A+B+C+D Efficiency of most ovens lies between 60 to 80%. Resistance ovens are operated on low voltage network of 240 or 415 V supply and they are generally built upto a maximum of 100 kW rating. Temperature control in ovens is obtained by changing current through the heating elements. Current through the heating elements is changed by connecting them in different fashion. Some methods of control of current through the resistance elements are as follows: (i) Using variable number of resitance elements: This method tends to give uneven temperature in the oven if the elements not in use are not evenly distributed over the oven surface. Even distribution of such elements, however, leads to complicated wiring. (ii) Series parallel and star-delta connection of heater elements: This is the simplest and most widely used method of control of current. When this method is used in combi- nation with the method mentioned in (i) above, sufficient variations in temperature is obtained for most practical purposes. In smaller ovens where automatic control of temperature is not required the heater elements are switched ON and switched OFF with the help of drum switches. In ovens of higher ratings requiring automatic temperature control, contactors are used to switch ON or switch OFF the heater elements. Contactors are automatically de-energised by a thermostat switch when required set temperature is reached. The thermostat controls the temperature of the oven within a certain range which is determined by the differential setting of thermostat. For example, if temperature setting and differential setting are 250°C and 20°C respectively then the temperature of the oven will vary from 250°C to 230°C. The heater will be cut off at 250°C and will be energised again when temperature would fall to 230°C. Series-parallel and star-delta type of connections of heaters are discussed as follows: (a) Series parallel connection of heating elements. It is sometimes required to reduce the heat in an oven to a low level particularly during the weekend when normal production is stopped. We already know that heat produced in a resistance heating element is proportional to the square of the voltage applied. Therefore any reduction in applied voltage will greatly reduce the heat. For example, if voltage of heater element is reduced from 240 to 120 V, the heat reduction will be reduced to one fourth. Half the line voltage can be applied to resistance elements by reconnecting them in series from parallel connection. When two elements are to be in series they should be of equal kilowatt rating so that voltage is divided equally between them. Figure 9.9 shows a single phase circuit for series-parallel connection using a drum switch or a selector switch. In Fig. 9.9 two heater elements HE1 and HE2 are controlled through a drum switch. When the drum switch lever is on right hand side, the heater elements get connected in parallel due to closing of drum switch contacts A, B, and D. Full supply voltage of 240 V appears across each of the heater elements. For having a lower temperature, the drum switch lever is shifted towards the left hand side due to which contacts A and C get closed. The heater elements get connected in series across the supply voltage. The voltage appearing across each heater element is halved if they are of equal wattage rating, and heat produced is reduced to one fourth. dharm d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5 194
  • 212. INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS 195 L1 240 V N OFF Series Parallel A A B D C HE1 D B Drum switch contacts HE2 C Fig. 9.9 Series parallel connection using drum switch Series-parallel connection of heaters in 3 phase system has been shown in Fig. 9.10. In a 3 phase system connection of heater elements are controlled by contactors, if automatic control of temperature is desired. Where automatic temperature control is not desired, drum switches can be used. L1 L2 L3 C1 CR2 1 B 1 A A1 T Off HE HE 1 C B1 Control ON CR Low High B2 HE CR A B C A2 C2 (a) (b) Fig. 9.10 Series parallel connection of heaters in a 3-phase system (a) Control circuit (b) Power circuit As in the control diagram of Fig. 9.10 (a), when the control relay CR is ON, through a selector switch either contactor A or contactors B and C can be energised. When the selector switch is set for low heat, contactor A is energised through closed contact of thermostat (temperature controller). Contactor A when energised connects the two heater elements in dharm d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5 195
  • 213. 196 CONTROL OF MACHINES each phase in series. The line voltage thus gets divided across the two elements. When the selector switch is put on high heat contactor A is de-energised and contactors B and C are energised. Referring to power diagram it can be seen that closing of contactors B and C results in the two heater elements of each phase getting connected in parallel across full line voltage. When the selector switch is on high heat, the thermostat setting should also be made at the required higher temperature. Thermostat will control the temperature within a certain range depending upon the differential setting. (b) Star-delta connection of heating elements. Figure 9.11 shows a three phase connection where the full line voltage gets applied across each heating element connected in delta when contactor B closes. Heater elements can be switched over into star connection if instead of contactor B, contactor A gets closed. In star connection the voltage across a heater element will be V/ 3 times the voltage in delta connection, V being the line voltage. Thus in star connection the heat will be 33% of that in delta connection. A selector switch is to be used to energise contactor A when low heat is required, and contactor B when high heat is required. The thermostat contact connected in series with the selector switch has been used to get automatic switching off of contactors so as to maintain the required temperature. L1 L2 L3 CR2 T HE B3 A A2 1 Low High B1 CR1 HE A3 HE B2 CR A B Star Delta Fig. 9.11 Star-delta connection of heating elements 9.7 OVERHEAD CRANE Overhead cranes are used for shifting heavy weights within a limited area. The area is decided by the span of ‘long travel motion’ and ‘cross travel motion’ of the crane. The wheels of the crane structure move on rails mounted on concrete pillar or steel towers. Weights in the defined area of the crane are picked up and shifted to any desired position with the help of three motions. These motions are hoisting, lowering, long travel i.e., forward/reverse, and cross travel which is perpendicular to long travel. dharm d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5 196
  • 214. INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS 197 An over head crane has to handle heavy weights in terms of thousands of kilos requiring high starting torques in all the motions. This necessitates the use of slip ring induction motors for causing all the three motions. Figure 9.12 shows a crane in three views. Hoist motor Cross travel motor A Cross travel Long travel Crane Wheels Rail Rope Pillars (a) Front elevation (b) Side elevation Cross travel trolley Pillars top Crane Rail for cross travel of trolley Rail for long travel (c) Plan view Fig. 9.12 Overhead crane As shown in Fig. 9.12 (b), the whole of the crane structure denoted by letter A moves on the rails for long travel, driven by a slip ring induction motor known as long travel or LT motor. This motor is installed on the structure itself. The motor rotates the wheel shaft with the help of sprockets and chain arrangement. On the structure itself are mounted rails for cross travel (CT) trolley. The CT trolley moves on these rails as it is driven by a cross travel motor mounted on the trolley itself. The Hoisting motor is also installed on the trolley. Hoisting is done by a rope wound on the drum attached to the motor shaft. A hook hangs at the bottom of the rope which is engaged with the weight to be lifted. Winding of the rope on a drum results in raising of the weight, whereas rewinding of the rope results in its lowering. The operation of crane is done from a cabin on the crane. Cabin OFF is situated on the lower side of the crane in such a way as to allow clear 1 0 1 visibility of the shop floor to the operator. In the cabin are installed 2 2 three master controllers for hoist, long travel, and cross travel. 3 3 An outer view of a master controller has been shown in Fig. 9.13 The master controller has three or four steps on each side. At every step of the master controller, a contact actuates which is used in the control circuit. Positions 1, 2, 3 of the master controller in one direction gives three speeds of the motor in one direction. By moving Fig. 9.13 Pictorial the handle in the other direction the motor can be run in the reverse view of a master controller dharm d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5 197
  • 215. 198 CONTROL OF MACHINES direction at three different speeds. An important interlocking arrangement made in crane control is that the control can be switched ON only when all the master controllers are in the neutral or OFF position. If this interlocking is not provided accidents can occur due to abrupt starting of the motor. The motion of the crane either in long travel or in cross travel direction is restricted by mechanical stoppers, as well as by control limit switches and power limit switches. Hoist i.e., up down motion is restricted by use of control and power limit switches. In total six control limit swicthes, two for each type of motion are provided. Supply to the crane is given through overhead bus bars known as down shop leads or DSL. Four bus bars run along the whole length of the long travel below the crane. These bus bars are supported on pillars or steel towers with the help of porcelain insulators. Three bus bars are energised by three phases and the fourth is connected to earth. Current is collected from the bus bars by current collectors which are fitted on a channel on the crane. The arrangement has been shown in Fig. 9.14. Leads Current collectors Bus bars Frame moves along with the crane Fig. 9.14 Bus bar arrangement for an over-head travelling crane The current collectors slide on the bus bars when the crane moves in the long travel direction. Three leads of a cable are connected to three current collectors. Supply through the cable is taken to the control panel on the crane. Now, we will discuss the power diagram for the crane. Connections for hoist, LT and CT motors are basically of forward/reverse starter except for the hoist motor in which an extra contactor is used for single phasing of the motor for a few seconds during lowering operation. This is done so as to avoid a sudden jerk on the rope due to the weight when lowering operation has stared. Single phasing of motor during lowering results in development of less torque, and since the brake does not open fully, sudden jerk is avoided. The largest motor on the crane is the hoist motor. For example for a 10 Ton capacity overhead crane the hoist motor is of 30 hp, the LT motor is of 10 hp, and CT motor is of 5 hp. For the sake of simplicity power circuit and control circuit for only the hoist motor have been shown in Fig. 9.15 and 9.16 respectively. As shown in Fig. 9.15 contactors 1M and 2M are respectively for raising and lowering motion while 2M′ is for single phasing during lowering operation. Resistance in the rotor circuit is cut off in steps by contactors 1R, 2R and 3R. dharm d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5 198
  • 216. INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS 199 Fig. 9.15 Power circuit diagram for an overhead crane Before going into the working of the control circuit it is essential to become familiar with the operation of the master controller. Let us refer to the table for master controller given in Fig. 9.16. The master controller has got six contacts numbered 0, 1UP, 1DOWN, 2, 3, and 4. The 0 contact is normally closed (NC) while all other contacts are normally open (NO). Note the mark X placed in front of any contact denotes its operation. For example, contact 0 operates and becomes open for all the lever position from 1 to 4 on either side. Contact 1 UP operates and becomes closed for lever operation towards the right at position 1 of the lever and also remains operated for further movement of the lever. Contact 1 DOWN operates on position 1 to 4 on the left side. Contact 2 operates on second position of the lever on both sides and also remains operated for position 3 and 4 on both sides. Contact 3 operates on position 3 of the lever on both sides and also remains operated on position 4. Contact 4 operates when the lever is moved to position 4 on either side. In the control circuit start relay S gets energised and remains held only when the ‘0’ contacts of all the three Master controllers (Hoist, LT and CT) are in closed position i.e., levers are in neutral or OFF position. Energisation of relay S activates the control circuit through contact S2. Detailed working of control circuit has been explained in steps as follows: dharm d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5 199
  • 217. 200 CONTROL OF MACHINES Fig. 9.16 Control circuit for an overhead crane dharm d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5 200
  • 218. INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS 201 (1) On moving the controller handle to position 1 on the right for raise operation, contact 1UP closes. Closing of this contact energises contactor 1M provided the up limit switch contact is closed. When contacor 1M closes the motor starts to raise the weight up at slow speed as all the resistances R1, R2 and R3 are connected in the rotor circuit. (2) When 1M is energised, its auxiliary contact 1M3 closes and energises timer 1T. After the pre-set time, 1T operates and its delayed contact 1T1 closes in the coil circuit for resistance contactor 1R. Contactor 1R however gets energised when the controller is brought to position 2, towards right i.e., when the controller contact 2 closes. Energisation of 1R cuts off one set of resistance R1 from the rotor circuit and therefore the motor accelerates to a higher speed. (3) Auxiliary contact 1M1 and 1M2 also opens when contactor 1M gets energised. They provide interlocking so as to avoid simultaneous operation of lower motion contactors 2M and 2M′. (4) Energisation of contactor 1R, also leads to energisation of timer, 2T through the auxiliary contact 1R1. (5) When timer 2T operates, its contact 2T1 would close but contactor 2R will get ener- gised only when the controller is brought to position 3. Energisation of 2R cuts off another set of resistance R2 from the rotor circuit and therefore the motor acceler- ates to third higher speed. (6) Energisation of contactor 2R also leads to energisation of timer 3T through the aux- iliary contact 2R1. (7) When timer 3T operates and the lever of the controller is brought to position 4, the resistance contactor 3R gets energised which accelerates the motor to the final speed by cutting off the last step or resistance R3 from the motor circuit. (8) It may be understood that the timer contacts are used in series with the controller contacts to avoid the possibility of bringing the motor to a higher speed directly. Even if the operator moves the handle directly from OFF-position to fourth position the motor will accelerate to fourth speed in steps because timer 1T, 2T, and 3T will provide delays in energisation of contactor 1R, 2R and 3R. (9) At the same time it should also be clear that the timers provide only minimum delay required between the energisation of contactors 1R, 2R, 3R. The delay between their energisation can be increased by the operator. He can run the crane on any desired speed by keeping the controller lever on the corresponding position. (10) To prevent over hoisting of the motor, an UP-limit switch is provided which de- energises contactor 1M. The DOWN-limit switch would de-energise contactor 2M when the lower limit is reached. Power limit switch contacts are provided only for upper limit. These contacts are connected in two phase leads going to motor termi- nals. They work as back up protection and operate only if the control limit switch fails to operate. (11) For downword motion i.e., for lowering, when the lever of the master controller is moved towards the left side position 1, contact 1 DOWN is actuated which energises contactor 2M′ through normally closed contact of the DOWN-limit switch. This con- tactor connects only two phase supply to the motor. Thus due to single phasing effect less torque is developed by the motor and the brake also does not release fully. A timer T also gets energised in parallel with contactor 2M′. When the timer T oper- ates after a few seconds its contact T1 opens and de-energises contactor 2M′, whereas dharm d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5 201
  • 219. 202 CONTROL OF MACHINES contact T2 closes to energise contactor 2M. Energisation of contactor 2M supplies three phase power to the motor for lowering operation. This single phasing of motor during starting of lowering operation, as already described, prevents a sudden jerk on the rope due to the weight hanging on the hook. (12) The auxiliary contact 2M3 of contractor 2M starts cutting off the resistance in the same sequence as in the case of raising operation, already described. 9.8 BATTERY TROLLEY A battery trolley is operated by a small dc series traction motor energised from a 24 V battery placed on the trolley itself as shown in Fig. 9.17. The seat of the trolley can be lowered or raised with the help of a hydraulic motor pump and a manually operated hydraulic valve. The forward and reverse operation of trolley is done by two special push buttons which operate a set of five finger contacts. Hydraulic pump motor can be started by pressing an ordinary push button. Forward and reverse push buttons Battery Weight Fig. 9.17 Battery operated trolley A battery trolley is used in industry to shift any type of weight like finished products, motors, heavy tools etc., from one place to other in the shop floor. This trolley is, however, especially useful for transporting racks because its seat can be lowered or raised by hydraulic pressure. To transport racks the seat of the trolley is to be inserted below the standing rack and then the seat is to be raised by running the hydraulic motor and operating the hydraulic valve. When the seat is fully raised it would lift the rack from ground level. The traction motor can now be run to transport the rack to the desired place. At the destination the seat is lowered, and when the rack comes back to the ground level, the trolley can be taken out from below the rack. Before the control and power circuit for a battery trolley is discussed it is essential to get familiar with the special push buttons used for forward/reverse motion of the trolley. The operation of special push buttons is explained with the help of Fig. 9.18. The normal positions of the contacts, when neither of the push buttons is pressed have been shown in Fig. 9.18 (a). Figure 9.18 (b) shows the positions of the contacts when the Forward- push button is pressed. When the Forward-push button is pressed slightly, the strip containing contact 3 bends. As a result contacts 1′ and 3 get broken and contact 3 and 5 get closed. The arrangement is such that on further pressing the push button the strip containing contact 4, 5 and 6 bends in the direction shown by dotted lines and as a result contact 6 touches contact 7. On fully pressing the push button, the strip containing contact 7 also bends and contact 7 and dharm d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5 202
  • 220. INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS 203 1¢ 3 5 1¢ 3 5 1¢ 3 5 6 7 8 6 7 8 6 7 8 1 2 4 1 2 4 1 2 4 Normal contact Contact positions Contact positions position when forward push when forward push button is pressed button is pressed (a) (b) (c) Fig. 9.18 Operation of special push-buttons for battery trolley 8 touch each other. Thus when the push button is fully pressed, connection is made between contacts 3-5, 6-7 and 7-8 resulting in making continuity between contacts 3 and 8. It is to be noted that during pressing of Forward-push button, contacts 1 and 2 continues maintaining contact with each other. Actuation of finger contacts in three steps by gradually increasing pressure on the push button is used for obtaining two speeds of the trolley. Figure 9.18 (c) explains the sequence of contact actuation when the reverse-push button is pressed. When the Reverse-push button is pressed contact 2 breaks away from contact 1 and gets connected to contact 4. On further pressing of the push button, contacts 6 and 7 touch each other and when the push button is fully pressed contacts 7 and 8 also touch each other. Thus finally we have continuity between contacts 2 and 8. During the process of pressing the Reverse-push button, contact 1′ and 3 continue to touch each other. Forward/reverse push button control of the traction motor has been shown in Fig. 9.19 (a). Figures 9.19 (b) and (c) show the direction of current through armature and field windings of the traction motor respectively for forward and reverse motion. As shown in Fig. 9.19 (a) a 24 V battery has been used for traction and control. Contactors A and B have been used for obtaining two speeds of the motor. They are energised from contacts 7 and 8. Resistance R1 is connected in the armature circuit for obtaining a lower speed. When this resistance is bypassed by contactor B, higher and final speed is obtained. The hydraulic pump motor and also a dc series motor are controlled by contactor C. A toggle switch SW1 is used for switching supply to the control circuit. The explanation of control circuit is as follows: When the Forward-push button is pressed, strip containing contact 3 bends and touches contact 5 as shown in Fig. 9.19 (b). Due to the actuation of these contacts, current will flow in the series field and the armature winding as shown by arrows in the figure. Current starts from +ve terminal of the battery and flows in a clockwise direction through the series field winding and the armature winding. This current will, however, start flowing when the push button has sufficient pressure on it and contact 6 and 7 touch other, and contactor A is energised (refer Fig. 9.19). When contactor A closes its contact A1, the armature gets energised with a resistance R1 in the circuit. Let the motor run in say forward direction when the Forward-push button is fully pressed. Contacts 7 and 8 will make contact thus establishing continuity from 3 to 8. This will energise contactor B. Its contact B1, on closing, would short circuit resistance R1 in the armature circuit. The motor will therefore run on full speed. When the trolley is to be driven in the reverse direction the reverse push button is pressed. First, contact 2 will touch contact 4. On further pressing when contact 6 touches 7, contactor A is again energised. Now the current through the series field winding will flow in dharm d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5 203
  • 221. 204 CONTROL OF MACHINES anticlockwise direction while current through armature winding will continue to flow in the same direction as shown in Fig. 9.19 (c). The direction of rotation of the motor will thus get reversed. The sequence of operation of contactors A and B remains the same. When contactor B is energised the motor would attain final speed in the reverse direction. Battery C1 200 A HM HM = Hydraulic Contactor C Fuse pump motor A1 B1 TM TM = Trolley 3 motor Armature 1¢ 5 R Series field R1 7 8 6 4 1 2 B A (a) Fuse control on HM HM 3 5 3 5 1¢ 1¢ Series field Series field 7 8 7 8 6 6 1 1 2 4 2 4 + + (b) (c) Fig. 9.19 Control of battery trolley The hydraulic pump motor is controlled by a push button which when pressed energises contactor C. The pump would run as long as the push button is held pressed. The seat of the trolley is lowered or raised manually by operating the lever of a valve. The push button of the pump motor and the lever of the valve have to be pressed simultaneously. To ensure proper operation of the trolley the battery should be well maintained. With proper care and maintenance the life of the battery can be prolonged and trouble free services ensured. To have continuous working of a trolley for 24 hours, two batteries are sufficient. When one is being used the other should be kept on charging. At the end of each shift of the factory the batteries can be interchanged. A discharged battery should be topped with distilled water and then put on charging. A fully charged battery should give a specific gravity reading of 1.280 and should never be allowed to discharge below a specific gravity level of 1.140. dharm d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5 204
  • 222. INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS 205 For details on maintenance of battery the user may refer to the manufacturers handbook on battery maintenance. 9.9 BATTERY OPERATED TRUCK Battery operated truck is used in industry for shifting heavy weight from one place to another in the shop floor. It is also commonly known as fork lifter as the weight is lifted up on two forks. These forks can move up and down on an assembly of two vertical shafts and this total assembly of forks and vertical shafts can be tilted forward and backward as shown in Fig. 9.20 (a). Forks UP/DOWN and Driver¢ s forw/reverse levers seat Battery Pedal switch Weight to be lifted Weight Bricks or wooden blocks (a) (b) Fig. 9.20 Battery operated truck (a) Pictorial view (b) Weight placed on wooden blocks or bricks It may be understood that the forks can be utilised to lift a weight only when the weight has already been placed on some wooden blocks or bricks as shown in Fig. 9.20 (b). The forks are first lowered and inserted below the weight and then they are raised to lift the weight. After lifting the weight, the truck can be taken to desired position by running the traction motor. If a weight lying on the ground is to be transported with help of the truck the weight has to be lifted first by an overhead crane or chain pulley block for placing it on the forks. Two identical batteries of 36 V each are installed on the truck for control of the traction motor and the hydraulic pump motor. The truck is run either in the forward direction or in the reverse direction by a dc compound motor. Forward/reverse direction of rotation is selected through a selector switch provided on the control desk fixed in front of the driver. A control ON selector switch is provided on the control desk fixed in front of the driver. Forward/Reverse selector switch is also provided on this desk. The motor runs either in forward or in reverse direction when a pedal switch is pressed by the foot of the driver. This pedal switch looks similar to the accelerator pedal in a common four wheel automobiles. Five separate speeds are made possible as the pedal switch is gradually pressed down. The pedal switch has five micro-switches which operate in sequence when the pedal is pressed. The pedal switch is spring returned i.e., it comes back to its original position when the pressure on the pedal is released. Two batteries operate in parallel for the first three speeds and then in series for the fourth and the fifth speed of the traction motor. Raising/lowering or tilting of forks is done with the help of cylinder piston assemblies which operate on hydraulic oil pressure. Hydraulic oil pressure is generated by a pump driven by a dc series motor. Hydraulic oil from the pump flow to the cylinder piston assembly through a manually operated hydraulic valve. Two valves, one for UP/DOWN operation of the forks dharm d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5 205
  • 223. 206 CONTROL OF MACHINES and the other for forward/backward movement are provided. The levers for operating these valves are accessible on the control desk in front of the driver. When any of the levers is operated, it first actuates a micro switch which gives signal for running the hydraulic pump motor. The lever also operates the associated valve which allows pressurised oil to flow into the associated cylinder piston. In the control circuit an interlocking is provided which ensures that the hydraulic pump motor can only be run when the batteries are in parallel. This means that the forks cannot be operated when the truck is running on fourth and fifth steps of speed. The power circuit diagram for the truck and control circuit have been shown in Fig. 9.21 and 9.22 respectively. An explanation of the truck control circuit has been given in steps as follows: (1) Pressing the control ON-push button energises control relay C. Through its auxil- iary contact, control circuit gets energised while its power contact C in the power circuit energises the shunt field winding of the traction motor. (2) Initially when the truck is at standstill and the pedal is not pressed, all the contacts viz S1 to S5 are in 0-1 position as shown by dotted lines in the control diagram. (3) As soon as the control relay C is energised contactor 7C and 9C get energised through the pedal switch contact S4. The power contacts of 7C and 9C connect the batteries in parallel. (4) Forward/Reverse operation of the truck is chosen by selecting For/Rev selector switch connected in series with the pedal switch contact S1. (5) When the pedal switch is slightly pressed with foot pressure, its contact S1 actuates and contact between its terminal 0-2 is made. Depending upon the selection of Forwad/ Reverse switch, either contactor 1C or contactor 2C gets energised. (6) Normally closed (NC) auxiliary contacts of 1C and 2C are used in the coil circuit of contactor 3C and 4C. Thus 1C-4C or 2C-3C get energised simultaneously. 1C and 4C contactors run the motor in the forward direction while contactors 2C and 3C run the motor in the reverse direction. These two alternate pairs of contactors reverse the current flow through the armature winding of the traction motor while the direc- tion of current through the series field winding Y1 and Y2 remains same in both the cases. The motor starts with resistance R1 and R2 in the armature circuit. (7) The purpose of providing contactor 3C and 4C along with 1C and 2C is to provide braking torque when the pedal switch is released. When the pedal switch is released both the contactors 1C and 2C are OFF while the contactors 3C and 4C are ON. Power contacts of 3C and 4C shorts the armature of the traction motor through a resistance R2. As the control circuit is ON, and the motor shunt field winding is energised, the armature of the motor will generate and dissipate energy in the re- sistance R2. This generating action would provide a braking torque. (8) When the pedal switch is further pressed to actuate its contact S2, contactor 5C gets energised. Energisation of 5C cuts off resistance R1, thus the motor accelerates to the second higher speed. (9) When the pedal switch is further pressed to actuate switch S3 contactor 6C gets energised and shorts resistance R2 in the armature circuit. The motor therefore at- tains a higher speed i.e., the third higher speed. dharm d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5 206
  • 224. INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS 207 O.L O.L Y2 C Series field 36 Volts Y1 Pump ARM motor R1 5C 10C 7C 1C 3C 8C 9C Shunt field ARM Traction motor 36 Volts R2 6C 2C 4C + Fig. 9.21 Power circuit for a battery operated truck C + Pedal switch contacts S4 R3 1 2 OFF S1 S2 S3 S5 2 1 2 2 1 1 1 2 C Micro Control on Forw OFF Rev switch 1C 2C contact C 1C 2C 3C 4C 5C 6C 7C 9C 10C 8C Control Forw Rev Rev Forw Resistance Batteries in Hydraulic Batteries in on cutting parallel pump motor series contactor Fig. 9.22 Control circuit for a battery operated truck dharm d:N-MachMac9-1.pm5 207
  • 225. 208 CONTROL OF MACHINES (10) When pedal switch contact S4 is actuated by increasing pressure on the pedal, its contact changes from 0-1 to 0-2. This de-energises contactors 6C, 7C and 9C but at the same time energises contactor 8C. De-energisation of contactor 7C and 9C opens parallel connections of the batteries while energisation of 8C connects them in se- ries. De-energisation of 6C inserts resistance R2 back in the armature circuit. The fourth higher speed is obtained as now a potential of 72 volts is connected across the armature terminals of the traction motor with resistance R2 in the circuit. (11) When the pedal switch is fully pressed and contact S5 gets actuated, it again ener- gises contactor 6C through closed contacts of S4 and S5. Energisation of 6C again cuts off resistance R2 from the armature circuit and the motor attains its final speed with both the batteries in series. (12) To avoid direct reversing i.e., to provide antiplugging on higher traction speed, re- duced voltage equal to hold on voltage is supplied to contactors 1C or 2C after the second microswitch operation. Resistance R3 sends the reduced voltage to 1C or 2C after the operation of microswitch S2. If at higher speed the selector switch for FOR/ REV operation is changed, contactor 1C and 2C would fail to pick up due to the availability of a reduced voltage. (13) The hydraulic pump motor can be started by operating the lever of the valve which actuates a micro-switch. When the micro-switch contact closes contactor 10C is ener- gised, which then connects the armature of the motor across the supply. Contactor 10C can be kept energised till contact S4 remains unactuated. This interlocking is provided, as described earlier, to avoid operation of the forks when the truck is run- ning on higher speeds. (14) Some of the protective devices which are otherwise provided in the control circuit of the truck but have not been shown in Fig. 9.22, are: (a) An under voltage relay will either cut off supply to control circuit or show an indication of low voltage when the battery voltage drops below a ceratin limit. (b) A rectifier provided across shunt field of the traction motor to suppress switch- ing surges. (c) Capacitors provided across the coils of the contactors to suppress switching surges. 9.10 AIR COMPRESSOR Air compressor is an equipment which one will find in almost all industries. An air compressor is used to build up air pressure in a big reservoir for use in the plant. Air pressure in an industry may be used for various purposes like for cleaning operations, as drive for pressure operated machines, in L.P.G. burning, in circuit breaker operation, etc. A compressor basically consists of a cylinder piston assembly in which reciprocating motion of the piston is used for building up air pressure. An electrical motor is used as drive for the compressor. Rotary motion of the motor is converted into reciprocating motion of the piston through crank-shaft arrangement. There are two valves provided in the compressor cylinder. They are called suction valve and exhaust valve. When the piston moves away from the suction valve, the valve opens and air from atmosphere is sucked into the cylinder. At this time the exhaust valve remains closed. When the piston moves towards the suction valve, this valve closes while the exhaust valve opens. The air in the cylinder is compressed by the piston movement and is forced into the reservoir. A non return valve and an unloading valve are provided in the pipe line connecting the exhaust valve and the reservoir. The non return valve dharm d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5 208
  • 226. INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS 209 allows passage of air only in one direction i.e., from the compressor cylinder to the reservoir. It blocks air flow in the reverse direction i.e., from the reservoir back to the cylinder. The unloading valve is used to unload the compressor i.e., to connect the cylinder exhaust to the atmosphere. Most about working of this valve is explained a little later. Constant movement of the piston inside the cylinder at high speed will generate a lot of heat due to friction. To minimise generation of excessive heat and to facilitate smooth movement of the piston, oil lubrication of the cylinder walls is done. This is accomplished with the help of an oil lubricating pump. This pump is also driven by the main compressor motor. The pump lifts oil from the oil pump and feeds it into the cylinder assembly. Oil lubrication is very essential as, in its absence, the piston will cease due to overheating and thus the compressor will get damaged. A protection is therefore required to ensure that oil lubrication takes place continuously. This is made sure by measuring the oil lubrication pressure. If the oil pressure falls below the set value the compressor motor will trip automatically. Heat generated due to movement of the piston is removed from the cylinder by surrounding it with a water jacket. Cold water is permanently circulated through this jacket to absorb heat from the cylinder walls. Cold water from a chilling plant is circulated through the water jacket with the help of a water pump. To ensure that proper cooling is being done a temperature switch is provided to measure the temperature of the outgoing cooling water. A flow switch is also provided to ensure that proper flow of cooling water is maintained. If cooling water flow stops or become slow, the flow switch immediately operates to stop the compressor motor. The motor also stops if the temperature of the outgoing cooling water rises above the set value of temperature of the temperature switch. Actuation of the temperature switch would indicate that either the cooling water from chilling plant is not sufficiently cold to produce efficient heat conduction from compressor or there is some defect in the compressor. In addition to use of an oil lubrication pressure switch, a cooling water flow switch, a temperature switch and a pressure switch can also be provided in the air reservoir for controlling the compressor motor. This pressure switch as described below, can be used in two ways to control the compressor motor : The Use of Pressure Switch (i) May be used to trip the compressor motor when air pressure in the reservoir reaches a preset high value. When pressure again falls below the set value, the motor does not start automatically but has to be started manually by pressing the ON-push button. This is the disadvantage of using this type of control. (ii) The pressure switch may also be used to control the motor by unloading the com- pressor when pressure in the reservoir reaches the preset high value. When the compressor is unloaded, the motor runs on almost no-load drawing a low value of current. The compressor can be unloaded by using a solenoid operated valve. When pressure switch actuates and closes its contact the solenoid coil of the unloading valve is energised. Due to energisation of the coil the valve spool shifts and the ex- haust line of the compressor gets connected to atmosphere instead of the reservoir. This control, using solenoid operated valve has the advantage that the unloading valve can also be used to unload the compressor during the starting period of the compressor motor. This avoids high inrush of current which the motor will otherwise draw if it is started directly on load i.e., when the compressor exhaust is connected to the reservoir. This starting current will be automatically high when air pressure in the reservoir is high. The control circuit using a solenoid operated unloading valve is shown in Fig. 9.23. dharm d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5 209
  • 227. 210 CONTROL OF MACHINES P Stop 2P1 Start C1 1P T F 2P P1 ON 1P1 UL1 pressure switch pressure switch Cooling water Cooling water Oil lubrication Air reservoir temp switch flow switch T1 1P1 T2 F2 2P2 F1 C UL 1P T F 2P P N Compressor Unloading Unloading Relays for various Cooling Indication lamps motor relay solenoid switches water pump coil Fig. 9.23 Control circuit for a compressor motor Unloading and loading of the compressor can also be obtained by using a mechanical valve which operates due to air pressure only. This valve is also called high pressure valve. When air pressure in the reservoir reaches a high preset value this high pressure valve operates to unload the compressor. In this arrangement there is saving of one pressure switch. However, automatic unloading of the compressor during starting of the motor cannot be obtained by this valve. To unload the compressor during starting this valve has to be operated manually by the operator and when the motor reaches its final speed the valve is again operated to load the compressor. If the operator does not unload the compressor and the pressure in the reservoir is high, the compressor motor will start against load and its overload relay will trip due to high inrush current or the fuse may also blow. In addition to the protective devices which stops the compressor motor during any abnormal motion, ON and OFF-push buttons are also provided to manually start and stop the compressor. In the control circuit diagram of compressor motor in Fig. 9.23, for the sake of simplicity, the motor has been shown to the controlled by a direct on line starter. In actual practice the rating of a plant compressor is generally high, and as such star-delta starters are used. For better understanding, working of the control circuit has been explained in steps as follows: (1) When it is desired to start pump, first the water pump is to be switched on. This pump would draw water from the tank of the chilling plant and circulate through the water jacket of the compressor. The flow switch provided to detect the flow of cooling water will operate and close its normally open contact. Closing of this contact will energise relay F due to which its normally open contact F1 will close in the coil circuit of the contactor C, i.e., the contactor connecting supply to the motor of the compres- sor. (2) For maintaining flow of cooling water, normally closed contact of the cooling water temperature switch has been used in the circuit. This contact remains closed as long as the temperature of the outgoing water remains below the high preset tempera- ture. Through this contact a relay T remains energised and hence its contact T1, which is in the circuit of contactor coil C, remains closed. dharm d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5 210
  • 228. INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS 211 (3) Normally open contact of the pressure switch of the reservoir has been used in the circuit of relay 2P. When air pressure in the reservoir is less than the preset high value, this contact will remain open and therefore relay 2P will be in the de-ener- gised condition. A Normally open contact 2P1 of this relay has been used to energise the unloading solenoid coil. (4) Normally open contact of the coil lubricant pressure switch has been used to ener- gise relay 1P. When the compressor motor is at standstill having no oil pressure this contact will remain open. Relay 1P will thus be in the de-energised state and its contact 1P1 used in the holding circuit of contactor C will remain open. As the oil pump is coupled with the main compressor motor, initially the oil pressure is zero. When the motor is started and picks up speed, oil pressure also builds up. When the desired oil pressure as set on the pressure switch gets built up, the contact of the pressure switch closes and energises the relay 1P. Its normally open contact 1P1 has been used in parallel with the ON-push button. (5) When ON-push button is pressed, main contactor coil C gets energised through closed contacts T1 and F1 in series. When the motor picks up speed, oil pump coupled to it will also pick up and oil pressure will build up. When the required pressure gets built up, contact of the oil lubrication pressure switch closes and therefore relay 1P gets energised. Its contact 1P1 which has been connected in parallel with ON-push button and in series with holding contact C1 closes and therefore contactor C will remain energised through C1 and 1P1. From this it follows that the ON-push button is to be kept pressed till the oil pressure builds up to actuate the pressure switch. If due to some reason oil pressure does not build up or is not sufficiently high enough to actuate the pressure switch, the motor will stop when the ON-push button is re- leased. Oil pressure may fail to build up if there is any leakage or if the oil level in the sump is low. (6) When ON-push button is pressed another normally open contact used in parallel with the air reservoir pressure switch will also close. Thus relay UL will get energised and its contact UL1 will close to activate the solenoid coil of the unloading valve. Thus, during starting, as long as the ON-push button is kept pressed the solenoid coil will remain energised and will keep the compressor unloaded. When the push button is released, the compressor will get loaded to force air into the reservoir. (7) If during normal running, the temperature switch of the compressor cooling water operates due to increase in temperature of the outgoing cooling water, the relay T will get energised and its contact T1 will open to de-energise contactor C, thus stop- ping the motor. (8) Similarly if cooling water flow stops due to tripping of the water pump, or for any other reason, the flow switch contact will open and contactor F will get de-energised. Its contact F1 will open and the motor will stop due to de-energisation of contactor C. (9) When air pressure in the reservoir rises to the value set on the reservoir pressure switch, the switch will actuate and contact will close to energise relay UL. Energisation of the relay, as explained earlier, will energise the solenoid coil of the unloading valve. This would lead to unloading of the compressor. The compressor motor would run unloaded as long as pressure in the reservoir remains above the set value of the pressure switch. The motor in this condition will draw a low current which could be only a little higher than its no load current. Due to use of air in the plant, when dharm d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5 211
  • 229. 212 CONTROL OF MACHINES pressure of air would fall below the preset value, the pressure switch will get deactuated and the solenoid coil will also get de-energised. The spool of the unload- ing valve will shift again to load the compressor. Air will again be compressed and get forced into the reservoir. 9.11 WALKING BEAM A walking beam, with the help of hydraulic pressure, is made to move in directions in the following sequence: Upward-Forward-Downward-Reverse so as to return to its original position. A walking beam is operated in these four directions with the help of four cylinder-piston assemblies. The piston moves due to the pressurised oil fed into the cylinder by a hydraulic pump which lifts oil from an oil tank. Pressurised oil from the pump is fed to the cylinder piston assemblies by a two position single solenoid valve and a spring returned solenoid valve. Four solenoid valves, one for each motion have been provided. A loading solenoid valve is also provided to load the pump when required. The pump motor runs continuously, however the pump gets loaded only when the loading solenoid valve is energised. Normally, this solenoid valve remains off and keeps the pump unloaded by relieving the oil picked up by the pump back to the tank. When any operation is desired, the loading solenoid valve is energised along with solenoid valve for one of the motions and this diverts the pressured oil to the required cylinder through that particular solenoid valve. Walking beam is used in industry to transfer material on to a moving conveyor. The particular application that we will be discussing, is one where the beam is used to transfer automobile leaf springs to a conveyer. In this particular industry the conveyor takes a number of leaf springs into the annealing furnace. The conveyor belt is made of special metal and therefore does not get damaged due to heat of the furnace. The conveyor moves at a very low speed through the furnace thus annealing the leaf springs placed over it. The leaf springs are dropped into a quenching (cooling) medium on the other side of the conveyor. As the annealed springs are dropped into the quenching medium, new leaf springs are loaded on the front side of the conveyor continously by the walking beam. The benefit of loading leaf springs on to the conveyor with the help of a walking beam is that the operator remains at a distance from the direct heat of the furnace. Operation of the walking beam has been ilustrated in Fig. 9.24. In the top view of the walking beam as in Fig. 9.24 (a), the beam has been shown in fully down but in reversed position. Leaf springs are placed on the walls on either side of the beam by the operator. On being loaded the beam will move up therby lifting the leaf springs from the walls. When the up limit switch LS1 is actuated (refer Fig. 9.24 (c)) the beam then moves in the forward direction towards right as shown by the arrow. When the forward limit switch LS2 is actuated the beam will move down, and the limit switch LS3 will get actuated. While moving down the beam will place the leaf springs on to the conveyor. This is shown in Fig. 9.24 (b). A slot is specially cut in the conveyor to enable the beam to place the leaf springs on it. When the beam is fully down and the Down limit switch LS3 actuates, the beam moves in the reverse direction. It stops when the reverse limit switch LS4 gets actuated. The beam thus returns to its starting point. In automatic operation, the beam rests at this position for some time to enable the operator to place new leaf springs on the walls. The beam then again moves up to deliver the leaf springs on to the conveyor. Figure 9.24 (c) shows the side view of the beam movement and the location of the limit switches. dharm d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5 212
  • 230. INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS 213 Leaf spring Annealing Walking furnace beam Walking beam Conveyor (a) (b) LS1 Forward LS2 UP DOWN LS4 Beam LS3 Reverse (c) Fig. 9.24 Movement of a walking beam (a) and (b) Top view (c) Side view The control circuit for the walking beam has been shown in Fig. 9.25. This control circuit diagram has been represented as an actual drawing used in industry. At the top of the control circuit is shown the arrangement of the limit switches, push button legend, and legend of the solenoid valves. These have to be referred to while studying the control circuit drawing. Each vertical line in the control diagram is represented by a number at the top. At the bottom of each contactor, a table shows the line numbers in which the NO and NC contact of the contactor have been used. This information becomes useful in reading control circuit drawing, when a write up (explanation) for the circuit is not available Contactors U, F, D R are respectively meant for the upward, forward, downward and reverse motion of the walking beam. The solenoid valves SV1, SV2, SV3, SV4 respectively are energised through the normally open contacts U5, F5, D5 and R5. The loading solenoid valve SV5 also gets energised when any of the contactors, U, F, D or R is energised. Contactor A is for auto selection and contactor AS is for auto start. An ON-delay timer T has been used for allowing rest time for the beam at LS4 position in the auto cycle. Starter for the pump motor has not been shown in the diagram for sake of simplicity. The control circuit is energised through the starter contact M connected in series with the selection switch. The walking beam has three modes of operation viz Manual, Reset and Auto, selection for any mode is done by the selector switch SW. Selection on any mode energises the respective control bus designated as L-A (Auto) L-M (Manual) and L-R (Reset). The walking beam cycle can be started in auto or manual mode only if the beam is at any extreme end position and actuates a limit switch. To bring the beam from any in-between position to the extreme end positions, reset mode is provided. The operation of the walking beam in three different modes i.e. in Manual mode, Reset-mode and Auto-mode are discussed as follows: (a) Manual mode of operation of the walking beam (1) When the selector switch SW is turned to manual mode the control bus L-M is energised. If the beam is at its starting point and the limit switch LS4 is actuated, contactor B also gets energised through the close contact of LS4. Thus when the contactor B is closed, its contact B1 in line 2 gets closed and contact B2 in line 14 becomes open. dharm d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5 213
  • 231. 214 CONTROL OF MACHINES Fig. 9.25 Control circuit for a walking beam dharm d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5 214
  • 232. INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS 215 (2) When the beam UP-push button b1 is pressed, up contactor U is energised through closed contacts B1, b1, A1, D2 and LS1. Energisation of contactor U will cause opera- tion of loading solenoid valve SV5 and also up solenoid valve SV1 through contacts U5 and U6 and therefore the beam will start moving up. (3) Contactor U gets hold through its contact U1 before the opening of contact B1 as a result of de-energisation of contactor B. Contactor B gets de-energised due to open- ing of contact LS4 in line 20 when the beam moves in the upward direction. (4) When the beam reaches its upper limit, limit switch LS1 is actuated. Its NC contact opens and de-energises contactor U. De-energisation of contactor U stops movement of the beam in the upward direction due to de-energisation of solenoid valves. (5) Acutation of limit switch LS1 also closes its NO contact in line 5 and thus supply reaches the Forward-push button b2. (6) When Forward-push button b2 is pressed contactor F gets energised through close contacts LS1, b2, A2, R2, and LS2 in line No.5. Energisation of contactor F also helps energistaion of the respective solenoids through its contacts F5 and F6. The beam moves in the forward direction till limit swtich LS2 is actuated. (7) On actuation of LS2 forward contactor F is de-energised and the beam movement in forward direction stops while supply reaches Down-push button b3 through the closed contact of LS2 in line-8. (8) The beam can be run in down motion by pressing push button b3. When the limit switch LS3 is actuated, the beam can be run in reverse direction by pressing its push button b4. Limit switch LS4, when actuated stops the reverse motion of the beam. This way one cycle of beam movemnt is completed. In practice, the beam is not run in this fashion. It is run mostly in auto operation. The manual push button b1 to b4 are mostly utilized only to reset the beam if it stops inbetween due to power failure. (b) Reset mode of operation of walking beam. Reset mode is required to reset the beam since neither the manual nor the auto cycle can be started if the beam positon is such that no limit switch gets actuated. The beam will stop in any intermediate position during its travel cycle if there is power failure. On restoration of power the beam cannot be made to run in manual or auto mode from such intermediate position. For example let us examine the case when the beam has stopped while moving in forward direction due to power failure. In such a case, both the limit switches LS1 and LS2 are in deactuated condition. The beam cannot be run in forward direction as contact of LS1 in line 5 is open and hence supply does not reach upto push button b2. To make the push button effective the beam should be reversed to actuate LS1 or alternately the beam should be taken to fully forward condition to actuate LS2 so that operating cylcle can be started for downward motion. The beam is reset to actuate LS1 or LS2 with the help of reset-push button b6. When the beam is to be reset, first the selector switch SW is put on reset mode, This will energise the reset control bus L-R. Now b6 is pressed which energises contactor C. Its contact C5 closes and energises the manual control bus L-M. Also the control contacts C1,C2,C3 and C4 close to bypass the contact B1 and normally open contacts of LS1, LS2 and LS3.Thus supply reaches at all the push buttons from b1 to b4. The required push button can now be pressed along with b6 to complete the beam movement in a particular direction. Push button b6 is released when the beam reaches the required limit and the concerned limit switch has actuated. Then the selector switch is returned back to Manual or Auto mode as per requirements. dharm d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5 215
  • 233. 216 CONTROL OF MACHINES (c) Auto mode of operation of the walking beam (1) When selector switch is placed in Auto made, control bus L-A is energised and con- tactor A picks up. Its normally open contact A6 closes and energises the manual line L-M. Its NO contact A5 also closes to make the Auto start push button b5 effective. Its NC contacts A1 to A4 open to make the push button b1 to b4 ineffective during auto operation. (2) Let us start the walking beam in auto from the starting point i.e., when beam is down in fully reversed position. In this position limit switch LS4 will be actuated and its contact in line No. 20 will close to energise contactor B. (3) When auto start push button b5 is pressed, auto start contactor AS gets energised and closes its contact AS1. Contactor U gets energised through closed contacts B1, AS1, D2 and closed contact of LS1. Contactor U is held through its own contact U1. (4) In auto cycle, during starting, the push button b5 in line 13 has to be kept pressed till LS4 is de-actuated due to the movement of the beam in the upward direction. This is so desired because auto start contactor AS will hold only when contactor B is de- energised due to de-actuation of limit switch LS4. When B is de-energised contactor AS is held through contacts AS5 and B2. (5) When the beam reaches up and LS1 is actuated its NC contact opens and de-ener- gises contactor U. At the same time its NO contact closes in line 5 to energise forward contactor F. Contactor F gets energised through closed contactor LS1, AS2 and NC contact of LS2. (6) When the beam is fully forward, LS2 gets actuated, it de-energises contactor F and energises contactor D for downward motion in a simillar fashion. (7) When Down-limit switch LS3 gets actuated, it de-energises contactor D and ener- gises contactor R for reverse motion of the beam. At the same time a timer T is also energised through the contact R3. Timer T is held through the instantaneous con- tacts T2. The timer is of 3 minutes duration. (8) When the beam is fully reversed, limit switch LS4 gets actuated. Its NO contact closes in line 20 to energise contactor B. Contact B2 thus opens and de-energises auto start contactor AS. (9) The beam now does not start in upward direction due to opening of contact AS1, as AS is de-energised. (10) When timer T operates after the pre-set time delay, its delayed contact T1 closes and energises contactor AS. Timer T decides the time for which the beam should rest at the location of LS4 required for loading of leaf springs on the beam. (11) Energisation of AS through timer contact will again start the beam in upward direc- tion as contactor U will get energised through closed contacts B1, AS1, D2 and LS1. (12) As the beam moves up, LS4 is de-actuated and contactor B gets de-energised. The holding circuit for AS also gets completed through contacts AS5 and B2 in addition to the timer contact circuit. (13) Timer T resets when the beam starts moving in forward direction due to opening of contact F3. Its contact T1 will open but the contactor AS will continue to remain energised through its own holding circuit. dharm d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5 216
  • 234. INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS 217 9.12 CONVEYOR SYSTEM In large plants, materials are shifted from the place Belt of storage to near the machines for processing, through belt conveyors. Finished products from the Drive Tail machines are also carried away through conveyors. pulley pulley Infact, any heavy material can be transported by (Side view) conveyors. For example in airports, luggage of passengers is transferred through belt conveyors. The drive for such belt conveyors is an electric motor. A conveyor consists of a rubber belt about Belt Motor 3/4 to 1 metre wide tightly fitted over two pulleys conveyor Gear box as shown in Fig. 9.26. One pulley is coupled to the motor through a gear box as the belt is required to move at a slower (Top view) speed as compared to the motor speed. The pulley Fig. 9.26 Top and side view of a conveyor which is coupled with the motor is shown as drive pulley while the other pulley is called the tail pulley. As the belt is fitted tightly over the two pulleys, rotation of the drive pulley will cause movement of the belt over the two pulleys. A number of such conveyors may be used to shift material from one place to the other at different heights. The number of conveyors in a system can be very large depending upon the requirement. One example of a small conveyor system with 5 conveyors has been shown in Fig. 9.27. In this system the final product from plant is first stored in silos (large containers) with the help of conveyors. As shown in Fig. 9.27, conveyors 1 and 2 feed material into silos, 1 and 2. Diverters are provided on conveyor 2. When diverter 1 is down, material will fall in silos 1 and when diverter 1 is up and diverter 2 is down material will fall in silos 2. When both the silos are filled, proximity switches provided in silos will actuate and stop conveyors 1 and 2. Finished product from silos can be taken out through gates on to conveyor 2 and taken to packaging machine through conveyors 3, 4 and 5. Diverter 1 Diverter 2 Conv 1 Conv 2 Silo (1) Silo (2) Conv 3 Conv 4 Conv 5 Packaging machine Fig. 9.27 Schematic arrangement of a conveyor system dharm d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5 217
  • 235. 218 CONTROL OF MACHINES Conveyor motors are started in sequence one after the other. One major reason for sequence starting of conveyors is to avoid high inrush current during simultaneous starting of motors. If all the motors in a conveyor system are started simultaneously the current drawn from supply will be the sum of inrush current of all the individual motors. This current obviously will be very high as it is known that inrush current of an induction motor is 6 to 7 times its rated current. Another reason for sequence starting could be the process requirements. In some applications stopping of conveyors may also be required to take place in a particular sequence. For example in the conveyor system just discussed, it is desirable that conveyors 3, 4 and 5 should stop in sequence and further, conveyor 4 and 5 should stop after a successive gap of 30 seconds each. This is required to enable material lying on belts get emptied into the packaging machine before the conveyors stop. Conveyor motors can be started in sequence by using auxiliary contact interlocking, if no time gap is required between starting of two conveyors. However, if time gap is required between successive starting of motors then timers have to be used. Control circuit using auxiliary contact interlocking and timers for sequence starting of motors has been shown in Fig. 9.28. P Stop Start 1C1 1T 2C1 2T 3C1 cycle 2C2 3C2 1C 1T 2C 2T 3C N Conv 1 Conv 2 Conv 3 Fig. 9.28 Control circuit for sequence starting using timers In this control circuit, it is seen that to start three motors in sequence with a time gap, two timers are needed, thus if the number of motors to be started are more, say 10, then we will require nine timers. Such circuit will obviously be very costly. In practice there are many appliactions where the conveyor system consists of a large number of conveyors. To economise on expenditure for such control systems a special timer, known as cam timer, is used to start conveyors in sequence. Cam timers have already been discussed in chapter 2. In a cam timer, there is a small synchronous motor which rotates a shaft. On the shaft are mounted plastic cams which actuate there respective contacts at particular instant of time during the rotation of the shaft. A conveyor system which uses cam timers is discussed as follows: Sequence starting of three conveyors in manual and auto mode is explained. Only three conveyors have been taken for sake of simplicity although in practice the number may go upto fifteen or so. In this conveyor system there is provision to start the conveyor in auto cycle through cam timer or through manual operations. In manual operation there is a provision to start individual motors in sequence either from the control panel or with the help of push dharm d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5 218
  • 236. INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS 219 buttons provided by the side of the respective motors. It may be understood that control panels for conveyor systems are located at a suitable enclosed place preferably in a room away from the conveyor system where dust and dirt of plant can not enter the panel. This centralised control panel of a number of conveyor motors is also known as Motor Control Centre or MCC. A general safety precaution employed in all conveyor systems is that before starting of conveyors a hooter is sounded for about 60 secs or so to alarm the workers that the conveyor system is going to be started. This alarm is meant to inform that if any body is near the conveyor or working on them he should get aside. If somebody is working on the conveyor and conveyor is not in working condition or disassembled, the site emergency push button can be pressed which will not allow the conveyors to start. Control circuit having all the functions discussed above is shown in Fig. 9.29. An Auto/Manual selector switch is used to select conveyor system operation either in auto mode or in manual mode. (a) Manual mode of operation (1) When the selector switch is placed on manual mode, relay M will get energised. Its contact M1 will close and energise the manual bus. Normally closed contacts of con- tactor M i.e., M2 M3 and M4 will open and thus will isolate the cam-timer contacts from the circuit during manual operation. (2) In manual mode, conveyor 1 can be started by pressing panel ON-push button or site ON-push button which is provided near the motor. These push buttons are connected in parallel. When any of these ON-push buttons is pressed, contactor 1C will get energised and will remain energised through its auxiliary contact 1C1. Now supply to the coil of contactor 1C reaches through the contact of the OFF-push button of the panel, auxiliary contact A4, auxiliary contact 1C1, and the site OFF-push button on conveyor 1. (3) When contactor 1C is energised its auxiliary contact 1C2 in the coil circuit of contac- tor 2C also closes thus providing an interlocking, where conveyor 2 can only be started if conveyor 1 is running. (4) Now, conveyor 2 can also be similarly started by pressing its ON-push button. After starting of conveyor 2, conveyor 3 can also be started by pressing its ON-push but- ton. (5) Any conveyor can be stopped by pressing its panel or site OFF-push button. The following conveyor will also stop due to interlocking. Over-load tripping of any con- veyor will also result in stoppage of the conveyors following it. (b) Auto mode of operation. Before the working of the circuit in auto mode is dis- cussed it is essential to get familiar with the operation of cam timer used for this circuit. The cam timer used has four contacts as shown in Fig. 9.30. As shown in Fig. 9.30, normally open (NO) contacts of contact block CT1, CT2 and CT3 have been used while normally closed (NC) contact of CT4 has been used. The starting position of the cam timer will always be the same as shown in Fig. 9.30. Observe the protruding portions of the cams. In the starting position shown, it is clear that contact block CT4 is in actuated position as its knob is pressed by the protruding portion of cam 4. Thus it is clear that during starting, position of cam timer contact CT4, will be open as this contact block is actuated. This contact will remain open as long as the protruding portion of cam 4 pushes the knob of the contact block. For any other position of cam 4 i.e., throughout 360° of cam rotation, contact block CT4 will remain deactuated and thus its contact CT4 will remain closed. This point has to be kept in mind while studying the control circuit for auto operation. The other contacts CT1, dharm d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5 219
  • 237. 220 CONTROL OF MACHINES Fig. 9.29 Control circuit for a conveyor system dharm d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5 220
  • 238. INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS 221 CT2, CT3, will close when their contact blocks are actuated by protruding portions of their respective cams 1, 2 and 3 during rotation of the timer shaft in anticlockwise direction as shown in the figure. Fig. 9.30 A cam timer with four contacts The working of the control circuit is explained below in steps: (1) When selector switch is in Auto mode, Auto relay A will get energised on pressing the Auto ON-push button. Due to energisation of relay A, Auto bus is also energised through closing of contact A3. Normally closed (NC) contacts A4, A5, A6 will open to isolate manual ON and OFF push buttons from the circuit. (2) When the START cycle push button is pressed, its both contacts a and b will close. Closing of contact ‘a’ will energise timer T and also hooter H through delayed NC contact T2 of the timer. Timer T gets hold through its instantaneous contact T1. The setting of the timer is kept at about 60 secs to warn the workers that conveyors are going to be started. When timer operates after preset time, its contact T2 opens to de- energise the hooter while its contact T3 will close. (3) When contact T3 of timer closes, cam timer motor CT will get energised if contact ‘b’ of the START cycle push button is still closed. This means that START cycle push button has to be kept pressed during starting for more than the time setting of the timer, so that energisation of cam timer motor is possible. As the motor starts rotat- ing in the direction shown, immediately the contact block CT4 will deactuate and its contact CT4 will close i.e., it will come back to its normal position. As soon as this happens, START cycle push button can be released. Now cam timer motor CT will remain energised through its own contact CT4 till cam 4 rotates through 360° to again actuate contact CT4. (4) When cam timer shaft rotates by 90° from its initial position, contact block CT1 will be actuated by cam 1 and contact CT1 will close. Contactor 1C for conveyor 1 will get energised through this contact and will get hold through its own contact 1C1. As the protruding portion of cam 1 moves past contact block CT1, contact CT1 open but contactor 1C will remain energised by getting supply through its contact 1C1. (5) When timer shaft rotates by 180°, protruding portion of cam 2 will actuate contact block CT2. Its contact will close and energise contactor 2C. When protruding portion of cam 2 moves past the contact, contractor 2C will remain enrgised rotation its own contact 2C1. (6) Similarly contactor 3C for conveyor 3 will get energised when after 270° rotation, cam 3 actuates contact block CT3. dharm d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5 221
  • 239. 222 CONTROL OF MACHINES (7) When the shaft has rotated by full 360° i.e., when it comes back to its starting point, contact block CT4 will get actuated to open its normally closed (NC) contact CT4. This will de-energise cam timer motor CT and hence the cam timer will stop at this point. Cam timer motor CT will remain de-energised till it is again energised by pressing the START cycle push button. (8) If auto STOP-push button or Emergency STOP-push button of any conveyor is pressed, all the conveyors will stop immediately due to de-energisation of relay A. De- energisation of A will switch off the auto bus due to opening of relay contact A3. (9) When any site OFF-push button of a conveyor is pressed, then that particular conveyor and the conveyors following it will stop while the conveyor preceding it will continue to run. For example, if site OFF-push button of conveyor 2 is pressed, conveyor 2 and conveyor 3 will stop while conveyor 1 will continue to run. Similarly, tripping of over load relay of any of the conveyors will also trip the conveyors following it. 9.13 ELEVATOR Elevators or lifts are used in multistoried buildings for carrying passengers from one floor level to another at a fast speed. The cage in which passengers travel (also known as car) travels vertically, guided by four rails in the hoist-way. There are doors at each floor through which passangers can enter into or come out of the car. These doors are also referred to as hall gates. There is a gate in the car which should open only when the car is stationary in front of any of the hall gates. All these gates are of collapsable type. The gates may be hand operated or servo motor operated. A lift can not be operated if any of the hall gates or the car gate is open. The car is suspended in the hoist way by one end of a wire rope which is wound on a drum at the top of the hoist way. On the other end of the rope a counter weight, whose weight is generally 60% more than the weight of the empty car, is suspended. The wire wound drum is coupled to a motor through gears for achieving the required speed. Rotation of drum in one direction will lift the car up while the counter weight will go down. When the drum rotates in the reverse direction, the opposite will follow. Motor drum and control panel for the lift are situated at the top of the hoist way i.e., on the top most ceiling of the building. Motors, nowdays being used for lifts are 3 phase induction motors instead of dc motors used earlier. Lifts can be of a single speed type or double speed type. Double speed lifts are faster than single speed ones. Double speed lifts run at lower speeds near starting and stopping and at faster speeds during free running. In both the types of lifts, a set of electromechanical brakes are provided to stop the car exactly at the floor level. Normally, the brake remains engaged but opens when the motor gets the start command. The details of a single speed lift are discussed as follows: Control of a lift is obtained through a set of push buttons and limit switches. A set of push buttons (equal to the numbers of floor levels in the building) enable the operator to take the car to the required floor level. One push button is also provided near each hall gate for calling the lift to that particular floor. If the lift is idle at some floor level and its door is closed the lift can be brought to the required floor level by pressing the Hall gate-push button. When the lift gate is open, pressing of any one of the Hall-push buttons will sound a bell and also light an indicating lamp to inform the operator about the floor level at which the lift is required by the passenger. dharm d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5 222
  • 240. INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS 223 HK UD DOB T1 T2 T3 T4 T5 T6 U D Reverse power Ground I II III relay floor Floor Floor Floor U D (a) Up-down annunciation Rectifier Control supply M (b) Power circuit Reset HB1 HB2 HB3 HB4 switch BZ 1AN 2AN 3AN 4AN Latch 1AN 2AN 3AN 4AN relays Buzzer BZ Buzzer relay (c) Hall button annunciation in circuit Fig. 9.31 Power and annunciation circuit for a lift The bell is called ‘door open bell’ indicating that the door should be closed so that the lift can be brought to the required floor by the waiting passenger. The Hall-push buttons become inoperative when the lift is moving up or down. However, indication can be given to the operator about the floor level at which the lift is required. Main annunciation circuits (light indicators, buzzers, bells etc.,) provided in the lift are as follows: (1) A light indicator is provided at each floor level to show ‘up’ or ‘down’ movement of the car. (2) A target annuciation comprises indication showing the floor towards which the car is approaching. This is provided at each floor level and also in the car panel. (3) Hall-push button annuciation which comprises indication of floor level at which the lift is required by the passenger along with a buzzer in the car to attract operators attention. (4) A bell provided in the car which rings when the car door is open and the lift is wanted at some other floor by a passenger. In the case of failure of power supply during the travel period, the car will immediately stop. In such eventuality either an alternative supply arrangement from standby generator is to be made for bringing the car to the nearest floor opening, or a manual handle is to be used through which a drum is rotated to bring the car to the nearest opening so that the entrapped dharm d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5 223
  • 241. 224 CONTROL OF MACHINES passengers may come out. In case of rope failure, there is a provision of safety shoes with the car which will jam with the guide rails when the car would fall down at 150% of its rated speed. In case of phase reversal of supply the lift becomes inoperative due to energisation of a reverse phase relay, provided in the circuit. The control circuit which is being discussed here is based on the control circuit for a lift manufactured by a leading concern. The control circuit shown in Fig. 9.32 has been simplified to some extent from the original drawing for easy understanding. Lighting, fan, and alarm circuits have been omitted and the annunciation circuit has been simplified. Before explaining the working of the control circuit, some important devices, relays and selector switches used in the lift control are discussed as follows: (a) A retiring cam device is provided at the top of the car which mechanically locks the car at a particular floor so as to enable passengers to come in or go out without physically shifting the car. Retiring cam device consists of a coil and a plunger. When coil CM is energised it attracts the plunger against a spring pressure. Normally, when the lift is working, this coil remains energised. It has 1600 µF capacitor across it. When the lift remains 30 cms away from desired floor level, the level limit switch actuates and coil CM is de-energised. The condenser across CM discharges through the coil and makes the plunger drop softly into the hole provided in the hoist way at the top of the hall gate. If a condenser is not provided across the coil, the plunger would drop abruptly and make a lot of noise. A blocking diode is used in the circuit which does not allow the condenser discharge current to flow back into the rest of the circuit. (b) Another important relay used is the Hall time switch relay, NT. Function of this relay is to make the hall push button in-operative when the lift is in motion and also for 5 seconds after its stoppage. This delay in operation of hall buttons after stoppage is desired so as to allow the operator to open the car gate. Once the car gate opens, lift cannot be operated from hall gate. Thus if this delay is not there, the lift will not stop at the floor level where the operator desires, but will move to another floor level where a waiting passenger has pressed the hall button. (c) An annuciation cut out switch ‘ACS’ is used in the control circuit to cut-off the hall buttons permanently. (d) An inspection switch 1NS is provided in the car panel which also makes the Hall- push button in-operative enabling the lift to be operated only through the Car-push buttons. (e) At the top of the car, inspection switch TES is provided which allows inspection of the car carriage way. This switch makes both the car and Hall-push buttons in operative. The car can be operated by the person who is inspecting the carriage-way using Up and Down push buttons provided on the top of car. (f) Level sensing limit switches used to stop the lift at different floors are also of special construction. Their contact operation has to be thoroughly understood before read- ing the control circuit. The lowest level and the highest level limit switches i.e., GFS and 3FS are of ordinary type. There is only one contact which opens when the limit switch is actuated. However, the limit switches provided in the intermediate floors are of special construction. The contacts are of changeover type with three termi- nals. This type of a limit switch contact has been shown in Fig. 9.33 in three different positions. dharm d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5 224
  • 242. INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS 225 Fig. 9.32 Control circuit for a lift dharm d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5 225
  • 243. 226 CONTROL OF MACHINES (a) (b) (c) Fig. 9.33 Limit switch contact position (a) when lift actuates it at a particular floor (b) when lift moves to a higher floor level (c) when lift moves to lower floor level When this particular limit switch is actuated, the contact position will be as shown in Fig. 9.33 (a). When the lift moves to a higher floor the contact position will be as shown in Fig. 9.33 (b). If, however, the lift moves to a lower floor from its position the contact position will be as shown in Fig. 9.33 (c). The contact positions described here are with reference to the limit switch usage in the control circuit. In the particular example we are studying, the level sensing limit switches for floor 1 and 2 will be of the special construction described above while ground floor and top floor limit switches are of ordinary type. Also, the final Up and Down limit switches are of ordinary type. In Fig. 9.31 have been shown the power circuit and the annunciation circuit of the lift. In the power circuit it is seen that the motor is controlled by three contactors UD (main contactor), U (upward motion contactor) and D (downward motion contactor). The main contactor has been provided for the sake of saftey. In case one of the contactors U or D gets stuck or their contacts weld-during operation, accident is avoided due to opening of the main contactor, UD. Use of three contactors is justified here as public safety is directly involved. DC control supply is obtained through a rectifier and a control transformer as shown. The value of control supply is kept low i.e., 110 V for sake of saftey of the operator. A reverse phase relay is connected between the output terminals of the 3 phase control transformer T. There are two secondary windings of the control transformer. Three phase windings T4, T5, T6 have been used for main control. These three phases are connected to the rectifier. Single phase ac output between T7, T8 has been used for the annunciation circuits. Now let us refer to the control circuit in Fig. 9.32. Working of this circuit from the car push button is described as follows : Operation of the lift through Car-push buttons (1) The lift can be operated in Up or Down motion by pressing car push button if control supply reaches the upper coil terminal of contactor U and D. Supply reaches upto these points if the contacts of all components such as over load relay (OL), reverse power relay (RP) over speed switch (OS), car gate switch (GS), contact B of car inspection switch TCIS-1, upper and lower final limit switches ILS and 2LS, hall gate limit switches DS6 and DS1 to DS3 are closed. If the contact of any of the above mentioned components opens the lift will not operate. (2) The level sensing limit switch contact position shown in the control circuit of Fig. 9.32 indicates that the lift is on the first floor, as first floor limit switch 1FS has been shown actuated. Now let us examine how the control works when lift is to be taken to second floor. Car push button CB2 is to be pressed. Control, supply would reach coil of relay 2F through closed contact UD3, contact A of switch TCIS2 and push button CB2. Relay 2F will get energised and its contact 2F2 will close. This will lead to energisation of contactor U and UD. The circuit will complete through coil of contac- tor UD, contact D2, coil of contactor U, contact OB of second floor limit switch 2FS, contact 2F2 and coil of relay 2F. Thus the lift will move in upward direction. When it would reach second floor, limit switch 2FS will get actuated. dharm d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5 226
  • 244. INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS 227 (3) When the lift leaves the first floor for the second floor, contact position of limit switch 1FS will change. Its contact OA will be made. (4) From the control circuit it may be observed that, when contactor UD gets energised, supply to car buttons is cut off due to opening of contact UD3.This means that the car buttons become inoperative, once the lift starts moving. A command given while the car is stationary can not be overruled by pressing car buttons when the lift is moving. (5) If now the lift is moved to the third floor by pressing car button CB3, contactor U and UD get energised through closed contact of floor limit switch 3FS and coil of relay 3F and its contact 3F2. The lift stops when 3FS is actuated. (6) When the lift moves from second floor to third floor, second floor limit switch contact will change position. It moves from neutral to OA position. When the lift is at third floor i.e,... , at the top most floor (in this case). The contact position of the limit switches at all the floor levels will be as shown in Fig. 9.34. A B A B GFS 1FS 2FS 3FS Fig. 9.34 Various limit switch contact positions when lift car is at the third floor (7) Now let us see the downward motion of the lift from the third floor. To bring the lift to the second floor, car button CB2 will be pressed. This will energise relay 2F and hence its contact 2F2 will close. Down contactor D will get energised as the contact of 2FS is closed in OA position. Remember, this contact has changed over in (refer Fig. 9.34) this position during the movement of the lift from the second floor to the third floor. When the lift reaches second floor, 2FS is again actuated and both contacts OA and OB will be open. (8) When the lift is moved further down to first floor, contact position of limit switch 2FS will change and now contact would be made between O and B. (9) When the lift reaches the ground floor contact position of various limit switches will be as shown in Fig. 9.35. A B A B GFS 1FS 2FS 3FS Fig. 9.35 Various limit switch contact positions when the lift is at ground floor (10) The lift can be moved from ground floor to the top floor or any other floor directly without stopping at intermediate floors. For example, if the car button of third floor is pressed, the lift will move from ground floor to third floor directly without stop- ping in between at first and second floor. This can be verified by tracing control operation in the control circuit diagram. Operation of the lift through Hall-push-buttons (1) When the car gate is closed i.e., contact GS1 of car gate switch GS is closed and GS2 is open and the lift is stationary, lift movement can be controlled by Hall-push but- dharm d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5 227
  • 245. 228 CONTROL OF MACHINES tons also. When the lift is stationary, UD is de-energised and therefore its contact UD2 is open and thus NT is in de-energised condition. Supply to Hall-gate-buttons will reach through contact NT2. Pressing of any of the hall buttons will energise the respective floor relay and the lift will move to the desired floor level through energisation of contactor U or D and UD. (2) When the lift is moving in Up or Down motion, contactor UD is energised and there- fore its contact UD2 is closed. This will energise relay NT which has a 500 µF capaci- tor across it. When NT is energised its contact NT2 will open and supply at Hall- buttons is cut off. Thus the Hall-button contacts shown in Fig. 9.32 become inopera- tive. However, the other set of contacts of the hall buttons which have been used for the annunciation circuit remain operative. These contacts have been shown, in Fig. 9.31 (c). Referring to this circuit it may be seen that when any one of the Hall-buttons is pressed, a latch relay and buzzer relay BZ are energised. Closing of latch relay will energise an indicator through its contact and a buzzer will get energised through buzzer relay contact BZ. It may be recalled that the latch relay has got two coils. The relay will remain closed even when supply to its latch coil is disconnected. It will drop only when its other coil called unlatch coil is energised (refer chapter 2). For example, let us assume that button HB2 is pressed, then relay 2AN will get ener- gised and get latched. Its contact 2AN will close and energise the indicator on car control panel and a buzzer will also sound to draw operators attention. This indica- tion will go off only when the operator presses the Reset-push button to drop 2AN by energising its unlatch coil. This means that as long as the operator does not accept the information sent by the waiting passengers, the buzzer will continue to sound along with the floor indication signal of the floor at which the lift is required. (3) When the lift comes to a stop at any floor level, contactor UD will get de-energised and it will also cut off supply to relay NT due to opening of contact UD2. Relay NT, however, remains energised for about 5 seconds due to discharge current of con- denser C fitted across it. This delay is to keep the Hall-buttons inoperative for 5 seconds after stoppage of a lift so as to allow the operator to open the car gate. As described earlier, if this delay is not there, then the lift will not stop at the required floor but will move over to that floor where the Hall button has been kept pressed by the waiting passanger. (4) Once the lift car gate opens, relay NT is again energised through closed contact GS2 of the gate limit switch. Now supply reaches hall buttons through closed contact GS2, contact B of ACS switch, contact NT1 and through relay HK. When any of the Hall-buttons is pressed having the car gate open, the respective floor relay (GF, 1F, etc) is energised. However the lift does not operate as supply does not reach the upper coil terminal of contactor UD due to open gate contact GS1. Energisation of relay HK, in this case, will energise a bell called DOB i.e. Door open bell through its contact HK1 (refer annunciation circuit in Fig. 9.31 b). This bell rings to attract op- erators attention and demands that the door should be closed so that the waiting passenger can bring the lift to the desired floor level. dharm d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5 228
  • 246. INDUSTRIAL CONTROL CIRCUITS 229 Functions of Various Switches (1) Inspection Switch (INS): When the switch INS is put in ON position, supply at the upper terminal of relay HK and thus also to the Hall-push buttons is cut off. The lift can not therefore be operated when the switch INS is put on ‘ON’ position. (2) Top of Car Inspection Switch (TCIS) : Two contact block of this switch have been used, designated as TCIS1 and TCIS2. In the OFF position of the switch, contact B of TCIS1 is closed while contact A of TCIS2 is closed. When inspection of the car car- riage-way is to be done, this switch is put ON. The contacts will change over their position. Now contact A of TCIS1 and contact B of TCIS2 are closed. Due to closing of contact TCIS1 ON-push buttons CIB and OFF-push buttons UIB1 and DIB1 come into circuit. On the other hand closing of TCIS2 will bring ‘UP’ and ‘DOWN’ push buttons UIB2 and DIB2 in the circuit. All these push buttons CIB, UIB1, DIB2, UIB2 are on the top` of the car. When a person, who is on the top of the car for inspection of car carriage-way, pushes button CIB and DIB2, relay GF is energised and the lift moves towards the ground floor irrespective of where it is situated. (3) Annunciation Cutout Switch (ACS) : When this swtich is placed in ON position, its contact A will close and contact B will open. Closing of contact A will permanently energise relay NT. Energisation of NT will cut off the supply to relay HK and Hall- buttons and thus the door open bell annunciation circuit will be cut off. (4) Target Annunciation : This is provided in the car panel and at all floor levels towards which the car is approaching. As seen from the control circuit diagram these indication lamps glow along with the energisation of relay GF. 1F, 2F etc. For exam- ple, when the car button CB2 has been pressed, relay 2F will get energised, and in parallel with this relay, five indicating lamps provided one each at all the floor levels and one in the car panel will get enrgised. (5) Up and Down Indication : These are provided at all floor levels to indicate up and down movement of the lift. The indication lamp for up or down movement of the car at all floors gets lighted up through contacts of contactors U or D as shown in Fig. 9.31 (a). REVIEW QUESTIONS 1. In a planer machine, what will happen if the right hand side limit switch does not actuate? What back-up protection should be there to cover up such malfunctioning? 2. What is the purpose of pressurised air in an overhead tank? 3. In lifting magnets the material will drop when power supply fails. What precaution should be taken to avoid accidents due to such power failure? 4. What is the necessity of providing power limit switches in overhead cranes? 5. Why single phasing of hoist motor in overhead crane is done at the start of lowering motion? 6. Draw the control circuit for a Battery trolley by using a simple selector switch and push buttons. 7. How will you modify the control circuit of a battery truck so that it does not operate when the battery voltage is low. 8. What will happen if the unloading relay does not energise in an air compressor ? 9. What will happen if air reservoir pressure switch in an air compressor fails to actuate? dharm d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5 229
  • 247. 230 CONTROL OF MACHINES 10. In the control circuit of a walking beam, it may happen that sometimes beam may not stop at LS4 position but will stop at LS1 position. What could be the possible reason? 11. Design control circuit for following specification: (a) One push button should start conveyor motors in sequene; (b) An over load on any conveyor should stop all conveyors; (c) One stop button should stop all conveyor in sequence; (d) There should be 30 seconds delay between the stopping of each conveyor working in sequence. 12. Design and draw the control circuit for a lift to be used in a four storied building with the desired features. Also explain in brief its working. dharm d:N-MachMac9-2.pm5 230
  • 248. Troubleshooting in Control Circuits 10.1 INTRODUCTION Troubleshooting or fault finding in control circuits can take a few minutes, hours or days depending upon the complexity of the problem and the expertise of the troubleshooter. If the troubleshooter does not understand the control functions and is not familiar with control components and troubleshooting procedures, then, even a small fault in the electrical control circuit can baffle him. This may lead to unnecessary production loss in the plant. A technician engineer who may be skilled in wiring a control circuit from the given diagram may not necessarily be able to troubleshoot control circuits efficiently. For troubleshooting of control circuits the main asset is the possession of analytical mind trained in all aspects of control functions, knowledge of components and circuits. The secret to efficient and accurate trouble- shooting lies in determining the section of the control circuit that contains the trouble component and then selecting the proper component to be checked. This can however be accomplished by efficient and accurate circuit analysis and not by trial and error or by checking of components at random. Troubleshooting starts with the analysis of the problem. To analyse any problem it is helpful to first identify the type of problem. This limits the area in which troubleshooting is to be done. In identifying the type of fault the following areas might be considered: • Electrical • Mechanical • Hydraulic power system • Pneumatic system If the exact area of fault is not identified successfully then the troubleshooter will unnecessarily waste time. Sometimes what appears to be an electrical problem at first instance turns out be a mechanical one. Sometimes when electrical maintenance and mechanical maintenance of a plant are looked after by different persons this discrepancy in deciding the type of problem cause undue wastage of time. An employer therefore always prefer that his technician engineer should be responsible for both mechanical and electrical maintenance. In small industries almost always the same man is responsible for troubleshooting electrical and mechanical faults. In big industries an electrical engineer however will look after electrical maintenance while mechanical engineer will look after mechanical maintenance. In a plant, problem sometimes arises in the machines due to operators misunderstanding, lack of cooperation among the operators, or lack of knowledge of the machine. Whatever may be the reason of the problem it should be handled carefully so that the machine can be returned quickly to its trouble-free operation. 231
  • 249. 232 CONTROL OF MACHINES Before discussing the general troubleshooting procedure, it will be helpful to go through the possible trouble spots described in the following section. 10.2 TROUBLE SPOTS As it is impractical, if not impossible to list all the trouble spots, only those trouble spots have been discussed in which the troubles are quite frequent. The possible trouble spots are as follows. 10.2.1 Fuses It should be the first spot to be checked but very often this is overlooked. One of the trouble at this spot could be looseness of fuse carrier or its falling out due to looseness. Fuse carrier can become loose and come out due to vibrations of the machine. In such case the permanent solution is to insulate the control panel from vibration. Temporary solution is to adjust the male contacts of the fuse carrier so as to fit tightly into female contacts of fuse base. Alternatively the fuse carrier can be replaced with a new one. Another trouble at this spot could be the blowing of the fuse. As it is known, the fuse will blow only when there is some short circuit or grounding in the control circuits. One can try once or twice by replacing the fuse, as some times the fault is of transitory nature and may get cleared by itself. If replaced, the fuse should be exactly of the same voltage and current rating. If the fuse continues to blow out then further checking should be done to detect the fault. If the control circuit is very large then it is better to have sub control fuses for different sections of the control circuit. This way the faulty position of the control circuit is very easily segregated from the rest of control circuit. For example, a control circuit having relays and solenoid valves, can have separate fuses for relay circuit and solenoid valve coils. 10.2.2 Loose Connections The control circuit as we normally see on a drawing does not give a true picture of its complexity. In practice the control circuit is wired between three locations viz.: (1) Control panel, (2) Operators panel, and (3) The machine. Control relays are located in the control panel, pilot devices like push buttons and indication lamps are provided on operators panel while limit switches, pressure switches, float switches etc. are provided on the machine. Control wires from control panel get distributed to the operators panel and the machine through terminal blocks. In modern machines there are hundred of connections involved in wiring the control circuit. These connections are at relay contacts, coils, terminal blocks, pilot devices and sensing devices. All these connections are the possible trouble spots for loose connection. Advancement in the design of terminal block and the use of stranded conductors in place of solid round conductors have greatly reduced this problem. To avoid problems due to loose connections, the best course of action will be to follow a good programme of preventive maintenance in which connections are periodically checked and tightened. The problem of loose connection becomes serious in case of power circuits as the current handled is of higher magnitude. A loose connection in a power circuit generates local heat which spreads to other parts of the same component and also to adjoining components. Loose power connection finally damages the component due to insulation failure. Loose connection in thermally sensitive components may result in malfunctioning. dharm d:N-MachMac10-1.pm5 232
  • 250. TROUBLESHOOTING IN CONTROL CIRCUITS 233 For example, a thermal sensitive overload relay may trip due to conduction of heat to it. A regular check for loose connection is the best remedy for avoiding such troubles. Flexible control wires are preferred for wiring a control circuit. These wires are not connected directly in the terminal block or at the relay terminals but are connected after crimping a terminal end on the wire end. Different type of terminal ends are shown in Fig. 10.1. A B A B (a) (b) A B (c) (d) Fig. 10.1 Different types of terminal ends (a) Pin type (b) Ring type (c) Reducer type (d) Tubular type In Fig. 10.1 (a) is shown a control terminal end or a pin type terminal end. In the portion ‘A’ flexible control wire is inserted after applying a crimping paste on it, and then, this portion is crimped i.e. pressed and squeezed by a crimping plier. Terminal end is inserted in the terminal block, keeping portion ‘B’ on upper side and tightened with the help of terminal block screw. The terminal end shown in Fig. 10.1 (b) is for connecting wires at relay/contactor terminals. Flexible wires are inserted in portion ‘A’ and crimped after applying crimping paste. The other end ‘B’ of the lug is tightened at the relay contact terminals. Crimping paste is an inhibitor compound used so as to avoid oxidation. Power connection at the main switch, contactors, terminal blocks etc. are also done through reducer terminal ends and Tubular terminal ends, shown in Fig. 10.1 (c) and (d). Stranded cable conductors are used. Crimping of terminal ends is done by a hydraulic crimping machine. A pressure gauge is fitted on the crimping machine. Terminal ends are crimped upto a pressure as prescribed by the manufacturer. Terminal ends are available in different sizes and corresponding matching terminal blocks are available for connections. For proper crimping exact pressure should be applied during crimping. If a solid conductor is to be connected through a terminal end then the terminal end is to be soldered to the conductor. A soldering rod is melted and put in the portion A to hold the conductor. 10.2.3 Faulty Contacts This trouble occurs in such components as motor starters, contactors, relays, push buttons, and various types of switches. The most common problem appears with normally closed contacts. Although visible observation shows that such contacts are closed but in actual practice they may not be conducting current. Contacts may not be conducting due to dirt or formation of copper oxide films which is an insulator. Another reason could be improper spring pressure. Oxide film from the contact can be cleaned by drawing a piece of rough paper between the contacts. Care should however dharm d:N-MachMac10-1.pm5 233
  • 251. 234 CONTROL OF MACHINES be taken to use only a fine abrasive to clean contacts. Contacts should never be filed. Most of the contacts being used today have silver coating, the silver coating will get destroyed if filing is done. If the contacts are badly worn out and heavily pitted these should be replaced. Problem with silver coated contacts is that the silver oxide film formed becomes conducting. If this film is not cleaned at regular intervals, it may short circuit the adjacent contact terminals. It is therefore recommended that silver coated contacts should be cleaned with carbon tetrachloride at regular intervals to remove silver oxide film. Another problem with contacts is that they may get welded together during an overload or a short circuit fault. If the contacts get badly damaged they should be replaced. Sometimes the spring pressure on contacts is not sufficient, this should be adjusted, or springs should be replaced with new ones. In a newly wired control circuit, problem may be due to use of wrong contacts. Error is often made in wiring a control circuit, particularly when only one of the two available contacts of a component is used. The error consists of wiring the wrong contact, that is using a NO contact instead of a NC contact or vice-versa. This error is too frequent, it can be due to carelessness or lack of familiarity with the component being wired. To avoid such problems the person who is wiring should be completely familiar with components and he should double check his work. 10.2.4 Incorrect Wire Marking This problem will usually appear at the initial stage of control panel wiring or at the stage of assembly and erection of the machine in the plant. The error can also creep in during preventive maintenance or during any alteration done in the control circuit. This error becomes difficult to locate as control cables running from a control panel to the machine may have as large as 20 conductors. One common problem is the transposition of numbers. Another problem that may occur with numbering ferrules is during connecting conductors into a terminal block. With a long block and many conductors, it is a common error to connect a conductor either one block above or one block below the proper position. 10.2.5 Combination Problems As described earlier some of the problems in machines cannot be referred to as faults exclusively due to defective electrical or mechanical or hydraulic or pneumatic system. Mere observation does not give any positive clue to the area of trouble spot. The problem may be in one area or it may be simultaneously in two areas. Whenever such a discrepancy arises, it is better to first check the electrical circuit as it is faster to check an electrical circuit than a mechanical system. To quote an example, one very common combination problem is overload tripping of a motor. The motor may be tripping due to actual mechanical overload or due to malfunction of overload relay or due to defect in the motor itself. It is also possible that two abnormalities may be existing at the same time. An overload may malfunction due to heat generated by a loose power connection. A motor may take more current due to damaged bearing. If discrepancy arises in such cases the motor should be decoupled from mechanical load and thorough checking from electrical point of view should be done first. Another example of combination problem is burning of solenoid valve coils. Probably, over 90% of all troubles on valves develop from a faulty mechanical or pressure condition, which prevents the solenoid plunger from seating properly leading to drawing of excessive current by the coil. As a result either the fuse blows or the solenoid coil burns out. dharm d:N-MachMac10-1.pm5 234
  • 252. TROUBLESHOOTING IN CONTROL CIRCUITS 235 Electrical cum pressure could also be another combination problem. A particular operation of a machine may not happen due to fault in the control circuit or due to improper fluid or pneumatic pressure. An electrical cum temperature combination problem can occur in ovens and furnaces. Required temperature may not be obtained and the possible reason could be low voltage, damaged heaters, blown fuses or leakage of heat due to use of improper heat insulating material. A methodical approach should be made to analyse such problems instead of attempting a trial and error method. 10.2.6 Low Voltage If the system voltage becomes low, relays, contactors, timers etc. start dropping (getting de- energised) and as a result control circuit starts malfunctioning. Motors would trip at low voltage as they would draw more current from the supply. The system voltage may become low because of heavy loading or inadequate conductor size. A common source of such problem is the addition of new machines without properly checking the capacities of power supply line and the transformer. Low voltage will result in generation of inadequate heat in ovens. For example, if the voltage is dropped to one half the heating element’s rated voltage, the heat output will be reduced to one fourth. 10.2.7 Grounding We can have two types of control supply, one is with neutral grounded and the other without grounding. Each has its own merits. In the first case one terminal of control supply from control transformer is grounded. The other terminal of control power supply is protected by a fuse or a miniature circuit breaker. The advantage of this method is that it is easy to check supply at any point, as it is to be done with reference to ground. In this method when a ground fault occurs, the control fuse blows and the machine remains inoperative until the fault is located and removed. The second type of control supply with ungrounded neutral is preferred for large production shops. In this type of control supply the circuit continues to work even if a ground fault occurs. Control fuse will blow and the machine will stop only when a second ground fault occurs. The method thus has an advantage because production can continue with one ground fault leaving some time to locate the fault and remove it. In this type of control supply, some type of indication has to be provided which should convey that a ground fault has occurred. Two indication lamps are used to denote which one of the control lines has got grounded. This scheme is shown in the control circuit of Fig. 10.2. In this control circuit, ground detection indication lights are A and B. Wire no.10 between A and B is solidly grounded. When none of the line 1 and 0 are grounded, both the indication lights A and B will glow at half brilliance as two 220V bulbs are connected in series. If a ground fault occurs in the system, one of the lamps will go off, while the other one will glow at full brilliance. A bulb getting switched off in a particular side will indicate that control supply of that side has become grounded. If a ground fault occurs at wire no. 3 and also simultaneously at wire no. 8, control fuses will blow due to short circuiting of the secondary terminals of the control transformer. The advantage with ungrounded control supply is that even if any point of the control circuit gets grounded, it would not cause immediate trouble. Production can go on without interruption and ground can be detected and removed on the maintenance day. dharm d:N-MachMac10-1.pm5 235
  • 253. 236 CONTROL OF MACHINES L1 L2 440V 1 1 1 1 X1 220V X2 Rev For PB Lamp R1 F3 R3 PB LLS1 F1 RLS1 A 2 9 RLS2 LLS2 10 3 6 R2 F2 4 7 F R B B 8 O Forward Reverse Brake Ground detector lights Fig. 10.2 Control circuit having ground detector lights There are many locations on a machine where a ground can occur. However, there are a few spots in which grounds occur more often. These spots are discussed below: (1) Often ground fault occur in limit switches, pressure switches, temperature switches, float switches etc. Most of the time this is due to the compact design of many compo- nents allowing very small space for making connections. Due to lack of space, bare conductors at terminals of a component may come in contact with the case of the component. Many times the cables/wires going to a component may get pulled and cause breakage or grounding of the wires. Control wires in control panel can also get grounded in the panel itself or with an adjacent ground wire. (2) A ground may occur due to damaging of insulation while pulling control wires through a conduit, if proper care is not taken. Insulation damage may also occur when there are several bends in the conductors. (3) A ground fault may also occur due to improper use of a stranded conductor. Care must be taken while placing a stranded conductor into a connector. All strands must be used. One or two strands which have not been used may touch the case or a normally grounded conductor. Even if this does not happen, current carrying capacity of the conductor gets reduced due to less number of strands in use. 10.2.8 Momentary Faults Sometimes faults occur but do not persist for a long time. It becomes really difficult to locate the origin of such momentary faults. The operator of the machine needs to keep a close observation to find out at which part of the cycle of control circuit operation the fault occurs. When the part of the cycle at which the fault occurs is identified, the control circuit pertaining to that portion needs to be checked thoroughly. If the fault occurs at random during the cycle then those components which are common for the whole cycle operation should be checked. Loose connection or a broken conductor inside the insulation can also be the cause of momentary fault. Sometimes a control component may be malfunctioning. In case of doubt a component can be replaced by a new one. If the machine is new, fault may already exist in the control circuit due to improper connection. dharm d:N-MachMac10-1.pm5 236
  • 254. TROUBLESHOOTING IN CONTROL CIRCUITS 237 10.2.9 Poor Maintenance If regular maintenance of a machine is not done the frequency of occurrence of faults will increase. Regular maintenance also includes proper cleaning of machine and control panel. The control panel door should be properly sealed so as not to allow dust and dirt to enter the panel. Though manufacturers of components have improved their product design so as to prevent dust, dirt, and fluids entering inside the components, proper care should also be taken by the users. In large motor starters moving mechanical parts should be checked for loose pins and the bolts. Dust, dirt and grease should be removed from electrical parts, otherwise short circuit may develop. It is recommended that a regular maintenance schedule should be followed. History sheet of each individual machine should be maintained. In this history sheet details of all break-downs occurring on machines and also details of preventive maintenance done should be noted. History sheet can be very useful to a supervisor in detecting fault in the machine. 10.3 GENERAL PROCEDURE FOR TROUBLESHOOTING Firstly, we will consider a control circuit which has just been wired but is not working as per the design. The procedure for detecting fault in such a circuit is as follows: (1) The first step should be to analyse the control circuit and ascertain that it has been properly designed as per the control function requirements; (2) The next step is to run the machine and follow the operation through the expected sequence until one finds the section of control circuit which is not operating; (3) After locating the faulty section, wiring should be checked. If wiring is as per draw- ing then control components of this section should be checked thoroughly; (4) When trouble in the faulty section is located and removed, the machine should be started again to run successfully throughout the complete cycle. In case of fault ex- isting in any other section of the control circuit, one should now try to locate the fault of that section. Secondly, we will study the troubleshooting procedure for an already existing circuit which was working properly before the occurrence of a fault. The possibility of improper connection therefore is eliminated. The procedure for troubleshooting in such a circuit is as follows: (1) The first step is to understand the operation and control circuit of the machine. If the control circuit is very large and complex, help of the operator should be taken to find out how much of the circuit is operating. In this way one can directly start with the section of the circuit that does not function. (2) When the faulty circuit section has been identified, first a careful check of the circuit and components involved in that section should be done. A careful visual inspection may help to detect a faulty component or an open wiring. If nothing is found out in the visual inspection then the procedure may be as follows. (3) Find out which operation is not taking place and identify the contactor/solenoid valve coil which is responsible for this operation. Operate the machine and check whether there is voltage across the coil of relay or the contactor/solenoid valve coil. If proper voltage is available across the coil then trouble, most likely, is in the winding of the coil itself. Now, to check the continuity of coil, power is switched off and continuity of the coil is checked with an ohm meter. If the coil is alright, a low resistance is indicated. Working of the contactor or solenoid valve should be checked before replacing the burnt coil. If it is suspected that contactor closing mechanism or solenoid valve is defective, a new contactor or a new solenoid valve should be installed. dharm d:N-MachMac10-1.pm5 237
  • 255. 238 CONTROL OF MACHINES (4) Suppose that in the step discussed above voltage is found to be not reaching the contactor coil. This indicates that some contact is not closing when it should, thus disconnecting supply to the coil. In such a case control circuit drawing should be referred, to find out components whose contacts should close to energise the coil. These contacts may be of different relays, limit switches, pressure switches, tem- perature and float switches etc. Now the task will be to determine which of the com- ponents connected in series is not making contact. (5) To find out contact of which particular component is not making, supply should be checked at various points leading to the contactor coil. Here, note that difficulties may be faced in checking if limit switches, pressure switches etc. which are on the machine are wired directly in the control circuit. If, however, relays are energised through limit switches etc., and then contacts of these relays are used in control circuit, checking will become easier. This point has already been explained in Chap- ter 2 while discussing relays. Once the defective component is detected then the cause of malfunctioning can be found out. If the contact is not making due to a cop- per oxide film or dirt, cleaning should be done and if contact is not closing properly, adjustment can be done. If, contact is badly pitted it should be replaced. The other possibility during this checking can be detection of open circuit due to a broken or burnt wire. (6) Having eliminated the fault, the machine should be started again and if the machine does not operate successfully throughout the complete cycle of operation, the above procedure should again be applied to the next section of the control circuit which is faulty. (7) Quite frequently, grounding of a wire going from control panel to the machine may be the cause of trouble. A check should be made for detection of ground fault, by putting off the power supply. Resistance to ground of the wires should be checked with an ohm meter, or alternatively, a test lamp can be used to detect ground, where 230 V supply with neutral earth is available. To check ground, one side of test lamp is connected to phase wire while the other end is connected to the wire which is to be tested for ground. If the wire is grounded the lamp will glow, otherwise it will remain off. This is shown in Fig. 10.3. P Lamp glows in case of ground fault N Fig. 10.3 Detection of ground fault using a test lamp The above procedure of fault detection is based on the fact that control circuits are made up basically of only two things viz., contacts which make and break the circuit, and relay coils which operate these contacts. If the contacts open and close as they should, then proper voltage gets applied to the coils or the coils get de-energised, as desired. The fault can thus lie with the dharm d:N-MachMac10-1.pm5 238
  • 256. TROUBLESHOOTING IN CONTROL CIRCUITS 239 contacts, relay/contactor coils, or the associated wires which carry current through the contacts to the coil. One improtant rule to be observed while troubleshooting is to attend to only one thing at a time. If you suspect that a contact is malfunctioning, first correct this contact and then check machine operation. If fault persists then proceed to check other suspected possible trouble spots. It is very seldom that several parts of a machine would wear out at the same instant even though their condition may be poor. Tempering with more than one component at a time may introduce more trouble than original trouble. In order that the procedure outlined above for troubleshooting becomes clear, we will determine probable causes of some troubles which we will assume to have occurred in the circuit. The circuit is a simple control of an air compressor motor shown in Fig. 10.4. CR2 4 4 P 1 OFF 1P T F 9 2 5 6 7 8 Stop Control 10 ON CR1 3 1P1 Start 11 1M1 12 T1 4 13 F1 14 CR 1M 1P T F 2M N Control ON Cooling Comp motor water pump contactor Fig. 10.4 Control diagram for an air compressor motor In this circuit CR is control relay, 1M is cooling water pump motor contactor, 2M is compressor motor starter contactor. Oil lubrication pressure switches, cooling water temperature switch, and cooling water flow switch energise relays 1P, T, and F. Contacts of these relay are used in the starting circuit of the compressor motor contactor 2M. Brief description about working of circuit is that when control relay CR is energised by pressing control ON-push button, relay CR closes and is held through its contact CR1. Its contact CR2 also closes and energies terminal 4. Cooling water pump starts due to energisation of contactor 1M (Remember cooling water pump circulates cold water for cooling the compressor). Compressor motor contactor 2M can be energised by pressing START-push button. Contactor 2M gets energised if contact 1M1, T1 and F1 are in closed condition. When 2M is energised, dharm d:N-MachMac10-1.pm5 239
  • 257. 240 CONTROL OF MACHINES compressor motor starts and lubrication oil pressure also starts building up as the oil pump is coupled with the main compressor motor. If sufficient pressure builds up, oil lubrication pressure switch 1P closes and energises relay 1P. Contact 1P1 of this relay closes across the START- push button and contactor 2M is held through contact 1P1. START-push button has to be kept pressed till contact 1P1 closes. Having understood the working of the circuit, we will now discuss detection of some troubles assumed to have occurred in the circuit: (1) Suppose that the trouble reported by operator is that the control circuit is not func- tioning. This will also be indicated by non-glowing of ‘control ON’ indication lamp. First of all, by visual inspection check if the control relay CR is closed. If found closed, then check supply at terminal 4. If there is no supply then contact CR2 is not making contact. Take action to rectify defects in the contact. If on visual inspection, relay CR is found to be de-energised, then press control ON-push button and check supply across the coil. If full voltage is available then fault lies in the coil. Disconnect the coil and check its continuity. If the coil is found burnt replace it after checking the relay. In the previous check, with the ON-push button pressed, if no voltage is found avail- able across the coil i.e., at terminal 3 with respect to neutral 0, then proceed to check voltage at terminal 2. If voltage is available at terminal 2, it would mean that control ON-push button is not making contact on being pressed. Replace the contact block to rectify the fault. If, however, supply is not available at terminal 2, fault may be there in the OFF-push button, its NC contact may not be making contact. If during this checking no supply is detected upto terminal 1, then it would mean that the control fuse is blown. Check the control fuse. The control fuse may get blown due to fault in any part of the whole control circuit. Fuse can blow due to any coil getting shorted as a result of burning or due to grounding of any wire. If control fuse is blown, proceed as follows to detect the fault. To detect the trouble spot for fuse blowing, first one has to find out the section in which fault exists. If the fuse is getting blown before the compressor motor has started, the possibility of fault lying beyond terminal 11 is ruled out. Now remove all the wires marked number four (4) from the contactor strip and check with the help of an ohm meter or test lamp each individual wire for a ground. Suppose wire no. 4 going to cooling water temperature switch is showing ground then check for any physical damage to the wire going from panel to the switch. Also check the switch as wire may be getting ground by touching the case of the switch. (2) Another problem with control relay may be that it does not remain energised when the ON-push button is released. For this, check if any wire is open at contact CR1 of the relay. If wires are found connected properly then the problem, most probably, is with the contact CR1. This contact may not be making due to oxide film or dust and dirt etc. It may also need adjustment or replacement. (3) Another problem could be that the compressor motor fails to start when the START- push button is pressed. First step should be to check visually in the control panel the condition of relays T, F and 1M. 1M should be closed while T and F should be open. Suppose the relay T is found closed, it would mean that the cooling water tempera- ture switch is actuated. It should be found out whether the temperature switch is malfunctioning or whether the temperature of the cooling water has actually in- creased. If the temperature switch is defective it should be replaced. If cooling water temperature had increased find out the cause and remove it. Fault may be in the compressor itself, or perhaps the inlet water temperature is already high. dharm d:N-MachMac10-1.pm5 240
  • 258. TROUBLESHOOTING IN CONTROL CIRCUITS 241 If during visual inspection, the condition of the relay is found as desired, then pro- ceed to check voltage at various points, starting from the coil terminal 14 with the START-push button pressed. If voltage exists at terminal 14, then disconnect coil of contactor 2M and check its continuity. If no voltage exists at terminal 14 then pro- ceed backward to check voltage at terminal 13, 12, 11, 10, 9 till the terminal where supply is available is reached. Suppose supply voltage is found at terminal 9 and not at terminal 10, it would be clear that OFF-push button is not making contact. Re- move dust from this push button contact element, or if required replace the contact block. Suppose the supply was detected at terminal 12 while there was no supply at terminal 13 then fault lies in the contact T1 of relay T. Proper contact may not be making, or the wire may be open at the terminal of the relay. (4) Suppose the problem reported is that the compressor motor starts but does no hold i.e., trips as soon as START-push button is released. Since oil lubrication pressure switch contact 1P1 is used to hold the contactor 2M, immediately check is to be made whether oil pressure is being developed so as to actuate the pressure switch and relay 1P. The problem may be in the contact 1P1 or pressure switch itself or oil level in the sump may have fallen down due to leakage and thus oil pressure is not build- ing up. REVIEW QUESTIONS 1.What are the two main assets of a troubleshooter which help him in early detection of a fault ? 2.What are the possible troubles in the fusebase and carriers ? 3.What problems are caused by loose connections in control and power connection ? Draw different types of terminal ends used in solving the problem of loose connections ? 4. What type of contacts may cause trouble and yet they appear to be in good condition ? 5. Why should you never file a contact ? 6. What is a combination problem as applied to machine control ? 7. What conditions lead to a low-voltage problem in plants ? 8. Discuss the merits and demerits of using a control supply with grounded and ungrounded neu- tral. 9. Explain with the control diagram how indication lamps are used to denote which of the control line has got grounded in an ungrounded control supply scheme. 10. List a few spots where ground fault occur more often. 11. Explain the general procedure for troubleshooting. 12. Draw a sketch explaining detection of ground fault using a test lamp. dharm d:N-MachMac10-1.pm5 241
  • 259. Static Control of Machines 11.1 INTRODUCTION An industrial control system, whether it is magnetic control or static control can be divided into three distinct sections viz.: (i) Information gathering section or input section (ii) Decision making section or logic section (iii) Actuating device section or output section Relationship between the three sections is shown in Fig. 11.1. Push buttons Magnetic Limit switches relays Electric motor Temp switches solenoid Pressure switches valves OR Photo cells Information gathering Solid Actuating devices section state digitial devices Decision making section Fig. 11.1 Relationship between the three sections of an industrial control system It is clear from Fig. 11.1 that information gathering section components like push buttons, limit switches, pressure switches etc. and actuating devices like motors and solenoid valves are common in both types of control i.e., static or magnetic. The components in the decision- making section are, however, different. In magnetic control circuits, magnetic relay constitute the decision making elements. In static control, decision-making section consists of solid state/ digital devices. These devices have no moving parts and no contacts. Digital devices used in decision-making are: AND Gate Memory OR Gate Delay Elements or Timers NOT Gate Registers NAND Gate Counters NOR Gate 242
  • 260. STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES 243 It is known that in electromagnetic control, relay contacts have only two possibilities i.e., they can either be closed or open. Similarly in digital or static control there are two conditions or states. These two states are the two voltage levels, high or low. The two voltage levels are represented by binary digits 0 and 1. When 0 represents a low voltage and 1 represents a high voltage, it is known as positive logic. When 0 represents a high voltage and 1 represents a low voltage, it is known as negative logic. We will confine only to positive logic in the rest of the chapter. The above mentioned form of reasoning is derived from Boolean algebra which was developed by an Englishman named George Boole in the last century. It was used at that time as a way of expressing statements that could be either true or false. It thus follows from the above that the two states, high voltage and low voltage represented by digits 1 and 0 in solid state logic circuits correspond to closed and open condition of relay contacts. Digital devices were originally made using discrete combinations of diodes, transistors and resistors on a board. Now these are available as integrated circuits in a single chip of semi- conductor material. Digital devices were first fabricated using resistor transistor logic (RTL) followed by diode transitor logic (DTL). These logic elements are not much in use now. Now a days logic gates and devices are made using transistor logic, known as TTL logic. TTL logic elements operate on 5 volts. A voltage level of + 5 volts is considered as a high level voltage and that of 0 volts as a low level voltage. Another type of logic frequently used in industry is high transit logic (HTL). This is used because it ignores the voltage spikes and drops caused by starting and switching of induction devices. HTL generally operates on 15 volts. Another type of logic which has become very popular is CMOS which stands for complementary-symmetry metal oxide semi-conductor. The advantage of this logic is that it has a very high input impedance and it requires very less power to operate. This logic also has certain disadvantages. One major disadvantage is that it is very sensitive to voltage, sometimes even the static charge of a person’s body touching the IC can destroy it. People who work with CMOS logic often use a ground strap which straps around the wrist like a bracelet. This strap prevents static charge from building up on the body. Another limitation of this logic is that unused inputs can not be left open. Unused inputs must be connected to either a high state or a low state. A control engineer need not go into the internal structure of an IC but should be thoroughly familiar with their functions and use as components in control functions. The objective of this chapter is to enable the students to design control circuits using digital devices. To give an idea about the internal structure of digital devices only two devices, AND gate and OR gate will be discussed. Before various digital gates and their applications in building up control circuits are discussed, it will be worthwhile to compare the advantages and disadvantages of static control with respect to magnetic control. 11.2 ADVANTAGES OF STATIC CONTROL OVER MAGNETIC RELAY CONTROL (i) The first and very important advantage is the more reliable and maintenance free operation. Although nowdays with high quality materials available, relays can be designed for a longer trouble free operation yet their life expectancy is shorter as compared to static switches. This is because relays have moving mechanical link- ages and contacts which are subject to wear. Relay coils draw fairly high inrush currents to produce the necessary force to move the linkages. This puts stress on the coil wire and insulation. This limits the life expectancy of relay to a few million operations. Relay parts are exposed to atmosphere and therefore dirt particles inter- fere with proper movement of relay parts. Also, the chemicals in atmosphere can damage coil insulation and contacts. dharm d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5 243
  • 261. 244 CONTROL OF MACHINES Solid state gates on the other hand are completely independent of number of opera- tions performed and thus have unlimited life expectancy. They have no moving parts and no appreciable inrush current. They are impervious to atmosphere dusts or dirts as they come in sealed packages. Thus, if these devices are protected against ther- mal shocks and over currents, they will last almost forever and will require no main- tenance. (ii) Static switches provide much higher speed of operation which is often desirable in modern machines and processes. Relays operate in milli seconds whereas, most solid state devices operate in micro seconds or nano seconds. Thus a solid state gate is at least 1000 times as fast as a relay. (iii) Static switching provides comparatively simpler circuit design than relays for com- plicated processes, which must sense and evaluate many factors and conditions. This is due to the basic difference between a static switch and a magnetic relay. Static switch is a multiple input and single output device whereas a relay is a single input multiple output device. The above will become clear on studying various static switches. (iv) Static switches can be used in explosive environment as they switch ON and OFF without sparking. If relays have to be used in explosive environments they have to be housed in expensive airtight enclosures. (v) A solid state logic element is much more compact than a relay. Thus for extensive control circuits, which require hundreds of relays, use of solid state logic will require much less space as compared to relay logic circuit. (vi) Solid state logic is cheaper than an equivalent relay circuit for an extensive control circuit. A solid state logic circuit requires extra dc power supply, signal converter and output amplifier. However, the low ‘per gate cost’ over-rides the expenses due to the above mentioned equipments for extensive control circuits that contain hun- dreds of decision-making elements. (viii) Solid state logic gates consume very less power as compared to relays. Therefore, for extensive circuits there can be an appreciable saving of energy. 11.3 DISADVANTAGES OF STATIC CONTROL OVER MAGNETIC RELAY CONTROL (i) Static circuits can malfunction due to noise signals. Separate circuits are to be provided to safeguard against these. Relays on the other hand are not prone to noise pick up. (ii) A static circuit is not suitable for a small control circuit as it requires separate dc power supply, signal converters for interfacing information, sensing devices, and amplifiers for interfacing output devices. This increases the cost of the circuit. Relay circuits are cheaper and simpler for small control circuits. (iii) Solid state logic gates do not work well at high temperature. In an industrial envi- ronment, where temperature is generally high, some type of cooling, like fan cooling or air-conditioning, of the panel is required. This negates the advantage of energy conservation and reliability. In comparison to this, relays work well at high ambient temperatures. (iv) Alteration or modification in an existing static circuit is dificult to accomplish as compared to magnetic relay circuit. (v) Trouble shooting is difficult in static control circuits as compared to relay circuits. dharm d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5 244
  • 262. STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES 245 Two sets of symbols are used to represent logic gates. They are USASI symbols and NEMA symbols. USASI symbols, which are more common, will be used in this chapter. Control diagrams using logic gates have been drawn in the ladder form of diagram. In these, control supply is represented by two vertical lines spaced apart. Control circuit is built between these two lines in form of horizontal rungs. These rungs resemble the rungs of a ladder and therefore these diagrams are known as ladder type diagrams. This is the universal procedure for making diagram using logic gates. For the sake of symmetry, in this chapter, relay circuits have also been drawn in ladder form. (Although in previous chapters the relay circuits have been drawn in the other form). In earlier chapters the control supply was represented by two horizontal lines and the circuit was built up in rungs from left to right. Some of the magnetic control symbols used in this chapter are different from that used in previous chapters as they are more suitable in ladder form of diagram. Another purpose of using different symbols is to familiarise the student with these symbols as these symbols are also widely used in Indian Industries. Various magnetic components which have been shown different in this chapter are tabulated in Table 11.1. Static switch symbols will be discussed as we proceed to study various switches. Table 11.1 USASI symbols for some common control components S.No. Component Conventional Symbol USASI Symbol 1. Relay/Contactor coil 2. Normally Open (NO) Relay/Contactor contact 3. Normally Closed (NC) Relay/Contactor contact 4. Time Delay relay coil 5. Limit Switch (NO) contact 6. Limit Switch (NC) contact 11.4 EXPLANATION OF DIFFERENT GATES 11.4.1 AND Gate The symbol for AND Gate is shown in Fig. 11.2 (a), it has two or more inputs but only one output. In an AND Gate output signal is obtained when all the input signals are present. Thus, output Y will be high i.e., 1 when both input A and B are high i.e.,1, if any of the input is low dharm d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5 245
  • 263. 246 CONTROL OF MACHINES i.e.,0, output will also be low i.e., 0. This relationship between inputs and output for a two input gate is tabulated in truth table shown in Fig. 11.2 (b). A B Y 0 0 0 A A Y 0 1 0 B B 1 0 0 A B (a) Y 1 1 1 (b) (c) Fig.11.2 (a) Symbol (b) Truth table (c) Equivalent relay circuit for an AND gate The equivalent relay circuit for AND Gate as shown in Fig. 11.2 (c), consists of two normally open contacts of relay A and B connected in series. In this circuit when both the relays A and B are de-energised there will be no supply at point Y. If any of the relays A or B is energised, even then, there will be no supply at point Y. When both the relays are energised only then there will be supply at point Y, as both relay contacts in series are closed. These conditions are analogous to the conditions shown in truth table of AND Gate, if it is assumed that an energised relay corresponds to high input i.e., 1 and a de-energised relay corresponds to low input i.e., 0. 11.4.2 OR Gate OR gate symbol for two inputs is shown in Fig. 11.3 (a) In OR gate output is obtained if there is signal at any one of the inputs. This means, output Y is high if any of the input A and B is high. This relationship between inputs and outputs are tabulated in truth table of Fig. 11.3 (b). The equivalent relay circuit for OR gate shown in Fig. 11.3 (c) consists of two normally open contacts of relay A and B connected in parallel. When both the relays are de-energised output Y will be zero. When any one of the relays is energised there will be output Y due to closing of either contact A or B. When both the relays are energised, again there will be supply at Y. Assuming that energised relay corresponds to high input i.e., 1, de-energised relay corresponds to low input i.e., 0, these conditions of relays and output Y are found analogous to conditions in the truth table. A A B Y 0 0 0 B A A Y 0 1 1 B 1 0 1 B Y (a) 1 1 1 (b) (c) Fig.11.3 (a) Symbol (b) Truth table (c) Equivalent relay circuit for an OR Gate Some students may be interested to know the internal circuitry of these gates. To give an idea how transistors are used to build gates, only AND and OR gates will be discussed. Internal circuitry for these gates have been shown in Figs. 11.4 (a) and (b). In Fig.11.4, dc supply is used for operating these circuits. High voltage here refers to + 5 V while low voltage is 0 volts. dharm d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5 246
  • 264. STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES 247 In the AND gate circuitry when any of inputs A, B or C is low the voltage at the base of transistor Q1 is low (0) as most of the + 5 volts drops across resistance R1. Transistor Q1 is therefore in cut off state. Thus voltage at collector of transistor Q1 i.e., at point X is high and this voltage is coupled to the base of transistor Q2. Thus base of transistor Q2 is at higher voltage with respect to its emitter. Transistor Q2 therefore conducts and is in saturation state. Voltage at point Y on the collector side of transistor Q2 is therefore low. When all the inputs A, B and C are + 5 V high i.e., + 5 volts, the voltage at the base of transistor Q1 is also high and therefore transistor Q1 conducts, and the voltage at point X or at the base of transistor Q2 is low, thus it does not conduct. If Q2 is cut off then voltage at point Y is high (+ 5 V). Thus it is clear that output Y will be high (+ 5 V) only when all the inputs are also high. Now, referring to the OR gate circuitry, when any of the input is high, the base of transistor Q1 is also high with respect to its emitter, as a result the transistor conducts. This leads to low voltage at point X and thus transistor Q2 remains cut off. As Q2 is cut off, the voltage level at point Y is high. If all the inputs are low then Q1 will be cut off and Q2 will conduct. This gives low voltage at Y. Thus we see that this circuit fulfills the conditions described for an OR gate. + 5V R1 R2 R3 X A Y B Q1 Q2 C (a) + 5V R1 R2 X A Y B C Q1 Q2 (b) Fig.11.4 (a) AND gate circuitry (b) OR gate circuitry In practice the high and low values for static devices are not rigidly fixed at + 5 V or 0 volts. For example with 7400 series TTL devices any input voltage between 0 and 0.8 V is considered low and any input voltage between 2 and 5 V is considered a high input. This is so, dharm d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5 247
  • 265. 248 CONTROL OF MACHINES because voltage within these ranges can force the output to change states. Similarly low output from a 7400 series device may be from 0 to 0.4 V and in the high output value may be from 2.4 to 5 V. In other words, output voltage, as small as 2.5 V, is considered high as this voltage can drive the other TTL circuits. 11.4.3 NOT Gate or Inverter This is the simplest of all gates. It has one input and one output. The output is inverted or becomes opposite of the input. If input is high (1) then output is low (0) and if input is low (0) then output is high (1). The symbols, truth table, and equivalent relay circuits are shown in Fig. 11.5. A Y A 0 1 A Y A 1 0 Y (a) (b) (c) Fig.11.5 (a) Symbol (b) Truth table (c) Equivalent relay circuit for a NOT Gate Equivalent relay circuit is a single normally closed (NC) contact of relay A. When relay A is in de-energised state there will be output at Y, whereas when it is energised, there is no output at Y. If we compare these conditions with the truth table it will be found that the conditions are analogous. 11.4.4 NOR Gate NOR gate is equivalent to connecting a NOT gate to the output of an OR Gate. This is depicted in Fig. 11.6 (a). The symbol for NOR gate is obtained by connecting a bubble to the OR gate symbol as shown in Fig. 11.6 (b). Comparing the truth table of a NOR gate with the truth table of an OR gate it will be observed that for the same inputs, the output of NOR gate is the inverse of the output of OR gate. The equivalent relay circuit for NOR gate consists of two normally closed (NC) contacts of relay A and B connected in series as shown in Fig.11.6 (d). When both relays A and B are de-energised, there is an output at Y. If any or both the relays are energised, there is no output at Y. These conditions are analogous to the conditions shown in truth table. If an energised relay corresponds to a high input, a de-energised relay corresponds to a low input. A A Y B B (a) (b) A B Y A 0 0 1 0 1 0 B 1 0 0 Y 1 1 0 A B (c) (d) Fig. 11.6 (a) and (b) Symbols (c) Truth table (d) Equivalent relay circuit for NOR gate dharm d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5 248
  • 266. STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES 249 11.4.5 NAND Gate NAND gate is equivalent to an AND gate followed by a NOT gate. This is depicted in Fig. 11.7 (a). The symbol for NAND gate is obtained by connecting a bubble to the AND gate symbol as shown in Fig.11.7 (b). On comparing the truth table of NAND gate shown in Fig.11.7 (c) and the truth table of AND gate, it is found that for same input conditions the output for NAND gate is inverse of the output of AND gate. The equivalent relay circuit for NAND gate consists of two normally closed contacts (NC) of relays A and B connected in parallel as shown in Fig. 11.7 (d). When both relays A and B are de-energised or any one of them is de-energised there will be output at terminal Y. When both the relays are energised there will be no output at terminal Y. These conditions are analogous to the truth table conditions where an energised relay corresponds to high input and a de-energised relay corresponds to a low input. A A Y Y B B (a) (b) A A B Y 0 0 1 B 0 1 1 A 1 0 1 Y 1 1 0 B (c) (d) Fig. 11.7 (a) and (b) Symbols (c) Truth table (d) Equivalent relay circuit for NAND gate 11.4.6 Exclusive OR gate This gate gives an output only when either of its input is high (not when all the inputs are high). Symbol, truth table, and equivalent relay circuit for this gate are shown in Fig. 11.8. A A B Y B 0 0 0 0 1 1 A A A Y Y 1 0 1 B 1 1 0 B B (a) (b) (c) Fig. 11.8 Symbol, truth table, and equivalent relay circuit for an Exclusive OR gate On comparing truth table of an Exclusive OR gate with an OR gate it is found that first three conditions are same while the fourth is different. Equivalent relay circuit consists of two normally open (NC) contacts of relay A and B connected in parallel followed by normally closed (NC) contacts of same relays connected in parallel. On comparing the conditions of relay circuits with truth table of logic gate it is found that they are analogous. dharm d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5 249
  • 267. 250 CONTROL OF MACHINES 11.5 SOLID STATE TIMER Solid state timers are built using transistors and resistor-capacitor charging circuit. A standard solid state timer symbol shown in Fig. 11.9 (a) is analogous to an ON delay type timer with a normally open delayed contact. The standard timer can be modified as shown in Fig. 11.9 (b), (c) and (d) to give functions which are analogous to the function of ON and OFF delay timer relays. Input output waveforms, shown besides each timer, describe the operation of a timer. While comparing action of a solid state timer with an analogous relay contact it is to be kept in mind that a high output corresponds to closed condition of relay contact, while a low output corresponds to an open contact condition. Equivalent Waveform time delay Symbol Vin relay contact t Input Vin Output Vout T Time delay Vout (a) t Vin t Vin Vout td T Vout (b) t Vin t Vin Vout td T Vout (c) t Vin Vin Vout td Vout (d) Fig.11.9 Solid state timer and their input-output waveforms along with analogous time delay relay contacts In the waveform for the standard timer shown in Fig.11.9 (a) the output voltage Vout becomes high after a pre-set delay td from the instant the input voltage Vin becomes high. Vout becomes low immediately as Vin becomes low. Equivalent relay contact for this timer is the normally open (NO) delayed contact of ON delay type time delay relay. In Fig. 11.9 (b) timer duplicates the action of normally closed (NC) delayed contact of an ON delay type time delay relay. This is done by adding a NOT gate in the output of the standard timer circuit. The action of timer is also represented in the waveform. In Fig. 11.9 (b) when Vin is low, Vout is high because of NOT gate. When Vin becomes high, timer output will become high after a pre-set delay of time td , while Vout will become low. When Vin returns to low value, Vout will return to high value. This action of timer is analogous to normally closed (NC) delayed contact of ON- delay type time delay relay. dharm d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5 250
  • 268. STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES 251 Modified timer shown in Fig. 11.9 (c) is analogous to a normally open (NO) delayed contact of an OFF-delay type time delay relay. Recollect that in off-delay timer when timer coil is initially energised, its normally open contact closes immediately. The contact opens after a pre-set delay from the instant when timer coil is de-energised. It is to be observed that the waveform depicting the action of solid state timer in Fig. 11.9 (c) is analogous to the above mentioned action of normally open contact of an OFF-delay timer. When Vin is high, timer input is low, therefore timer output is also low thus giving a high Vout. When Vin goes low due to input NOT gate, the timer input goes high. Vout remains high as timer output is still low. After a pre-set delay of time td, when timer output goes high the Vout goes low due to the NOT gate. This is analogous to the action of normally open contact of an OFF delay timer. Similarly, the modified timer circuit and its associated waveforms can be shown analogous to normally closed (NC) delayed of an OFF-delay time relay. 11.6 MEMORY ELEMENTS (OFF-RETURN TYPE) The well known flip-flop circuits can be used as memory elements in the control circuits. Flip flop memory is an off-return memory i.e. memory is washed away when control supply fails. Its equivalent relay circuit is the widely used holding circuit or sealing three wire control circuit. The simplest off-return memory element used is the RS flip flop. Circuit for an RS flip is shown in Fig.11.10. In this circuit when control input S is made high, transistor T1 is saturated, while T2 is cut off. Thus output at terminal Q is high while at Q is low. + 5V 5 KW 5 KW – Q Q T1 T2 100 KW 100 KW S 100 KW R 100 KW Fig. 11.10 Circuit for RS Flip-flop using discrete components Output at Q and Q remains the same even when S goes low. When control input R is made high, it will saturate transistor T2 while T1 will be cut off. The output will thus change states. The output becomes low at Q and high at Q . This output condition is retained even when R goes to low. Applying a high input to S is called the setting mode, and applying a high input to R is called the resetting mode. When both S and R are low, there is no change in the dharm d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5 251
  • 269. 252 CONTROL OF MACHINES output, as transistors remain in their previous states. This condition is called inactive mode because there is no change. when both S and R are high, the output is unpredictable and this condition is called a race condition. This input condition is forbidden. The general symbol, truth table and equivalent relay circuit for an RS flip-flop are shown in Fig. 11.11. The asterisk mark in the truth table denotes the race condition or forbidden input. R S Q Comments 0 0 NC No change S Q 0 1 1 Set – R Q 1 0 0 Reset Race 1 1 * (Forbidden) (a) (b) S R CR CR CR Q – Q CR (c) Fig. 11.11 (a) Symbol (b) Truth table (c) Equivalent relay circuit for a RS flip flop RS flips are no longer manufactured using discrete components as shown in Fig. 11.10. Instead, they are manufactured using NOR or NAND gates as shown in Fig. 11.12. R R Q Q – Q – S S Q R S Q Comment R S Q Comments No change 0 Race 0 0 NC 0 * (Forbidden) 0 1 1 Set 0 1 1 Set 1 0 0 Reset 1 0 0 Reset 1 1 * Race 1 1 NC No change (Forbidden) Fig. 11.12 RS flip-flops using NOR gates and NAND gates dharm d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5 252
  • 270. STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES 253 On comparing the truth tables of both types of flip flops it is found that inactive and race conditions for the two types are exactly opposite. Therefore to avoid using the forbidden inputs, it is essential to know the type of flip flop being used. 11.6.1 Clocked RS Flip Flop Clocked RS flip flop has an extra terminal called clock terminal. This provision helps to pervent the flip flop from changing state until the right time is determined by the clock pulse. Whenever it is required to change the state of flip flop according to the state of inputs (S, R) a square wave is sent to the clock terminal. Flip flop responds to its S and R inputs only when clock pulse switches a transition from high to low or vice-versa. A positive edge triggered flip flop responds to its static inputs (S, R) when the clock line makes a transition from low to high i.e., during the rising edge of a square pulse. A negative edge triggered flop flop responds to its static inputs S and R when its clock line makes a transition from high to low i.e., during the falling edge of a square wave. Edge triggering is used to prevent oscillations in the flip flop. In this chapter all flip flops are assumend to be negative edge triggered. The symbol and truth table for this flip flop is shown in Fig. 11.13. CK S R Q Comment × × Last 0 No change state S Q Last 1 × × No change state CK 1 0 1 Set – 0 1 0 Reset R Q * 1 1 Race Forbidden (a) (b) Fig. 11.13 Schematic symbol for a negative edge triggered clocked RS Flip flop The small circle outside the box in front of clock terminal CK is the general digital symbol used for distinguishing a negative edge triggered clocked device from a positive edge triggered clocked device. In the truth table, a downward pointing arrow ↓ denotes a negative going transition from high to low, (×) denotes any state, high or low. 11.6.2 JK Flip Flop The most widely used flip flop is the JK flip flop. It has two inputs just like the RS flip flop, but the inputs are referred to as J and K. The action of JK flip flop is quite similar to RS flip flop, the only difference being that JK flip flop has what is called a toggling mode. CK J K Q Comment Last 0 × × No change state J Q × × Last 1 No change state CK 1 0 1 Set – 0 1 0 Reset K Q Changed Toggle (a) 1 1 states (b) Fig. 11.14 Schematic symbol and truth table for a negative edge triggered JK flip flop dharm d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5 253
  • 271. 254 CONTROL OF MACHINES Toggles means switching opposite state. The schematic symbol and truth table for a negative edge triggered JK flip flop is shown in Fig. 11.14. The inactive, set mode and reset mode are similar to RS flip flop except that input terminals are designated as J and K. Flip flop is in toggling mode when J and K are both high and it is possible to set or reset the flip flop depending on the current state of the output. If Q is high, the lower gate passes a reset trigger on the next negative clock edge. On the other hand when Q is low, the upper gate passes a set trigger on the next negative clock edge. Either way, Q changes to the compliment of the last state. Therefore, J = 1 and K = 1 means that flip flop will toggle on the next clock edge. Many JK flip flops have preset (PR) and clear (CL) static inputs which override the clocked inputs J and K i.e., they have the first priority. Preset and clear have active low states. This means that the signal at preset and clear terminals are normally high, and taken low temporarily to preset or clear the circuit. When preset goes low the Q output goes high and stays there, no matter what the J and K and clock (CLK) inputs are doing. The output will remain high as long as preset is low. Therefore, the normal procedure in presetting is to take the preset low temporarily, then return it to high. Similarly for clear function, clear signal is made low to reset the flip flop, then taken back to high to allow the circuit to operate. The schematic symbol and truth table for JK flip flop with preset and clear function are shown in Fig. 11.15. Preset Clear CK J K Q Comment 0 0 × × × * Forbidden Race 0 1 × × × 1 Set J PR Q 0 × × × 0 Reset 1 × × Last No change CK 1 1 0 state – Last K CL Q 1 1 1 × × No change state 1 1 1 0 1 Set 1 1 0 1 0 Reset (a) (b) Fig. 11.15 Schematic symbol and truth table for a JK flip flop with preset and clear function There are other types of flip flops also, like D flip flop, T flip flop, etc. In this chapter only the RS and JK flip flops have been used for developing the control circuit. 11.7 RETENTIVE MEMORY ELEMENT Retentive memory element retains the conditions of output corresponding to the input last provided, irrespective of whether control power is maintained or not. These memory elements are built using tiny toroidal magnetic core. Nowadays, Charge Coupled Devices (CCD) and Magentic Bubble Memory (MBM) techniques are also used for building retentive memory elements. Retentive memory is also known as non-volatile memory. The schematic symbol and equivalent relay circuit for retentive memory element is shown in Fig. 11.16. dharm d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5 254
  • 272. STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES 255 A Latch coil LC B Unlatch coil ULC A X LC X B Y Y (a) (b) Fig. 11.16 Symbol and Equivalent relay circuit for a retentive memory element Relay equivalent for retentive memory is the mechanically held or permanent magnet latch type relay. In the memory element when input A = 1 (high) and B = 0 (Low), the output X is high (1) and Y is low (0). This output state is maintained even when control supply is restored after a failure. When input states change i.e., A = 0 and B = 1, then output X becomes low (0) and Y becomes high (1). Considering the relay circuit for analogous operation it is observed that closing of contact A (equivalent to A = 1) will energise latch coil (LC), giving output at X through closing of its normally open (NO) contact. Once the latch coil is energised, it remains latched even when control supply fails. Supply at X can be cut off by dropping the relay. Relay drops when its mechanical latch is disengaged or the core is demagnetised by energising another coil i.e., ULC. It is clear from Fig. 11.16 that coil ULC is energised when contact B closes. This is equivalent to A = 0 and B = 1 for the static element. Both A and B cannot be high as it is the forbidden input and leads to unpredictable output (Race condition). 11.8 DEVELOPMENT OF LOGIC CIRCUITS Digital logic elements and their circuitry can be understood better by comparing them with their equivalent relay circuits. However, once the fundamentals of logic design are understood, one should try to design the circuit directly using digital elements, instead of first developing the circuit with relays and then converting it into digital circuitry. Developing circuit directly in digital logic will avoid wastage of time and labour. No universal theory can be given on how to approach the circuit design as circuit details vary considerably from job to job. Inspection and common sense are the most important tools for designing the control circuits. However, a few suggestions are given here on how to approach the design of logic circuit for a specific application. Design work is greatly simplified if the following steps are followed: (1) Study the various machine operations and write them in their proper sequence. (2) Identify the control devices used for controling each operation. Write down the relation between control devices and resulting operation in simple English logic statements. (3) Draw logic diagram of each statement by translating the word picture of statement into logic element block diagram. (4) Combine the individual logic sequence to form a complete control circuit. (5) Inspect the diagram, minimise circuits and save devices by simplifying circuits. dharm d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5 255
  • 273. 256 CONTROL OF MACHINES To start with the three wire holding sealing control circuit which has so frequently been used in the study of magnetic controls is taken. This circuit is shown in Fig. 11.17 (a). Equivalent digital logic circuit for holding/sealing function are shown in Figs. 11.17 (b), (c) and (d). The same function is designed in three different ways by using different logic elements like OR gate, AND gate, and MEMORY element. At this stage there is no need of explaining the first circuit as the reader is already familiar with relay circuits. 1 2 Start M Stop M (a) OA Start AND M Stop (b) OA S Q M – R Q (c) OR AND (d) Fig. 11.17 Development of a simple logic circuit for holding funtion Now refer to the logic diagram in Fig.11.17 (b), one input is always provided to the AND gate through STOP-button. When START-button is pressed, the second and final input to AND element is provided and output is obtained. Once an output is obtained, the internal feed back loop maintains the input even though the START-button is released. This is equivalent to holding or sealing function of Fig.11.17 (a). When the STOP-button is pressed, AND gate loses one input and so, the output goes to the low (O) value and the contactor M is de-energised. Observe that an amplifier (OA) is used in between output of the AND gate and contactor M. dharm d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5 256
  • 274. STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES 257 This amplifier has been used because output of AND gate is a low voltage dc and can not directly energise the output devices like contactor, solenoid, etc. In Fig. 11.17 (c) an RS flip flop has been used for obtaining a holding circuit. As STOP- button is always closed, there is always a low input at terminal R of flip flop due to a NOT gate in series with the STOP-button. When START-button is pressed, input at terminal S becomes high and flip flop is set. A high output appears at terminal Q which energises contactor M. Output Q remains high even when input S goes to low value due to release of START-button. When contactor M is to be de-energised or sealing of the circuit is to be broken, the STOP- button is pressed. This applies a high input at terminal R of the flip flop and it gets reset. Output Q becomes low and contact M gets de-energised. Another holding circuit can be built using OR gate and AND gate as shown in Fig. 11.7 (d). An important difference between a relay circuit shown in Fig.11.17 (a) and a digital logic circuit shown in Figs. 11.17 (b), (c) and (d) is that in a relay circuit, current flow can be traced from line 1, through the control devices, contactor coil and back to line 2 and is easy to understand. On the other hand, a digital logic circuit is only a block diagram of the control functions of the circuit. In the logic circuit actual wiring is omitted and only symbolic representation is done. The logic diagram, therefore, does not represent the actual circuit. The common bus to which all input and output voltages are referred to is also omitted so as to avoid unnecessary cluttering of circuit. Also, it adds nothing to the information given by the logic diagram. In the above discussed circuits, pilot devices like push buttons have been shown connected directly to the logic elements. However, in practice they are connected to the digital elements through signal converters as shown in Fig. 11.18. OA 110 V or AND M 220 V Signal converter Fig.11.18 Logic circuit with signal converters Logic elements are low voltage low power devices. They operate at say + 5 V dc (TTL). The control components may be even 500 metres away from the circuit. If the push buttons or limit switches in control ciruits are directly connected through logic elements, there will be appreciable voltage loss. Therefore, the practice is to feed high voltage i.e., 110 V and 220 V ac to the sensing device and then convert back to low dc voltage by signal converters for feeding to digital logic elements. On the output side, output devices also work on high voltage. Therefore, the output from logic elements is amplified and then fed to these devices. Before control circuits are discussed, it will be worthwhile to stydy an example on how the specifications for a control operation are first written in logic statments in English, and then converted into graphical logic diagrams. The specifications for a control circuit are as follows: A contactor coil M is to be energised whenever a normally open push button PB1 is pressed or whenever both limit switch LS1 and temperature switch T1 are closed and extreme limit switch LS2 and extreme temeperature switch T2 are open. dharm d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5 257
  • 275. 258 CONTROL OF MACHINES The first step in developing a logic circuit is to convert the above specifications into logic statements. The first statement is: Contactor M will be energised when PB1 or LS1 and T1 are closed. The above statement is translated into graphical picture as shown in Fig. 11.19 (a). The inputs from LS1 and T1 are ANDed and then ORed with inputs from PB1 in the diagram. PB1 OA Signal OR M converter LS1 AND T1 (a) LS2 OR T2 (b) PB1 OA OR M LS1 AND T1 LS2 OR T2 (c) PB1 OA OR M LS1 AND T1 LS2 NOR T2 (d) Fig. 11.19 Development of logic circuit dharm d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5 258
  • 276. STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES 259 The second statement is: Statement 1 will be true only if LS2 and T2 are open. The graphical picture for second statement is obtained by ORing inputs from LS2 and T2 followed by a NOT element as shown in Fig. 11.19 (b). The next step is to combine the circuits for the above two statements. This is done as shown in Fig. 11.19 (c). Further, next step is to simplify the circuit, if possible. In this case it is done by using a NOR gate instead of an OR gate followed by a NOT gate. The last step is to analyse the circuit whether it works according to the specifications. According to Fig.11.19 (d), when PB1 is pressed, it sends a signal to OR gate through its signal converter. There is an output from OR gate, which is fed through an amplifier for energisation of contactor M. If LS1 and T1 are both closed, there are two inputs at the AND gate. The third input is provided by the inputs from LS2 and T2. If these two are open, there is no input to the NOR element, and therefore it will have an output which is the third input to the AND gate. When all the three inputs are present at the AND element it will have an output. The output of AND gate provides an input to the OR element and thus there is an output for energising contactor M. 11.9 INPUT DEVICES FOR SOLID STATE LOGIC In addition to signal converters mentioned in last section, another input device used in series with pilot and sensing device is the bounceless switch. It is necessary to use this because mechanical switches never make a clean contact closing in a single action. Most of the contacts of pilot and sensing devices are snap action type i.e., they are spring loaded. When the movable contacts meet the stationary contact, there is often a fast bouncing action. This means, the movable contact may make and break the contact three or four times in succession before the switch finally closes. The action of contact bounce is shown in Fig. 11.20. V Input to DC digital element t t1 t2 Fig. 11.20 Illustrates the contact bounce problem As a result a series of pulses are generated till the final closure of contact takes place. Each of the pulse generated due to bounce can act as a command. As the digital elements are very fast acting, they will respond to these commands and control circuit will malfunction. An intermediate circuit is thus required which should not allow the bouncing action to affect the control circuit. Bouncing of contacts, however, does not pose any problem in relay circuits as relays are relatively slow acting devices as compared to digital logic elements. In digital circuits the bouncing action of contacts can be prevented from effecting the control circuit by using capacitive switch filters or Bounce eliminators. 11.9.1 Capacitive Switch Filters A capacitive switch filter is shown connected in between a limit switch contact and a logic gate in Fig. 11.21. dharm d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5 259
  • 277. 260 CONTROL OF MACHINES When the limit switch first closes, capacitor C starts getting charged through the venin resistance of R1 and R2. As the limit switch contact stays closed only for a very short time during the bouncing action, the capacitor does not get charged to such an appreciable value as to trigger the logic gates. When permanent closure occurs the capacitor will get charged to the full voltage required to turn on the digital element. This filter circuit also helps in arresting high speed noise pulses on the load coming from the switch. The final value of voltage appearing across the capacitor is less than the supply voltage due to the divider action of resistance R1 and R2. This, however, does not cause any problem, as digital elements can operate reliably with an input voltage less than the full supply voltage. For example, for a TTL gate although the high voltage signal is 5 V, it can operate with as low a voltage as 2.4 V. + 5V R1 Filter output R2 Capacitor Fig. 11.21 Capacitive switch filter to eliminate effects of contact bounce 11.9.2 BOUNCE ELIMINATORS Bounce eliminators are manufactured using gates as shown in Fig. 11.22. In bounce eliminators, the output appears at its terminal on the first contact bounce, instead of waiting for the final closure of limit switch contact as in capacitive filter circuits. The disadvantages of this circuit is that it requires a double throw switch instead of a single NO contact. When the limit switch contact is open as shown in Fig.11.22 (a), high input is applied to R2 and also to input 2 of NOR2. The output of NOR2 is thus low causing input 2 of NOR1 to be low. Input 1 of NOR1 is also low because contact of the limit switch is open. Output of NOR1 is thus high, as both its inputs are low. The output of NOR1 is then inverted to make the final output low. 1 + 5V NOR 1 R1 2 1 NOR 2 2 R2 Fig. 11.22 Bounce eliminator built with digital logic gates dharm d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5 260
  • 278. STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES 261 When the limit switch contact closes the following action takes place in the bounce eliminator switch: (i) The NC contact of limit switch opens first, causing the number 2 input of NOR2 to be low. NOR2 does not change state as its output 1 is still high. (ii) The NO contact of limit switch closes momentarily on the first closure. This puts a momentary high pulse on input 1 of NOR1 causing its output to go low. The inverter drives the final output high. The NOR1 output feeds input 1 of NOR2 and, therefore, NOR2 now has two inputs. Its output therefore goes high which is applied to input 2 NOR1. NOR1 now has two high inputs. (iii) When the NO contact of limit switch opens on first rebound, a low voltage appears at input 1 of NOR1, but its input 2 maintains its high voltage. Therefore NOR1 does not change states and the final output remains high. (iv) Several more bounces of limit switch contact takes place, which changes the voltage level of input of NOR1. However, NC contact of the limit switch does not close during bounces and a high input is maintained on input 2 of NOR1 from the output of NOR2. Thus the output of NOR1 remains steady at high value. (v) When the limit switch is released, the bounce eliminator reverses the above action resulting in one time transition of low level at the final output of the bounce elimina- tor switch. 11.9.3 Signal Converters The function of a signal converter, as described earlier, is to step down a high (110 or 220 V) ac or dc voltage fed to information gathering devices to a suitable low dc voltage for feeding to logic elements. Brief description of different types of signal converters is given below: In a dc to dc signal converter, high dc voltage (110 V) from the information gathering devices is given to a potential divider circuit. Low voltage (+ 5 or + 15 volts) is taken from the potential divider as shown in Fig. 11.23 (a). This simple circuit can be improved by adding a transistor circuit to the voltage divider network to make the output insensitive to electric noise and line disturbance. A simple ac signal converter is shown in Fig. 11.23 (b). In this signal converter, electric isolation is provided between high voltage input circuit and low voltage logic circuit due to magnetic coupling provided by transformer windings. A center tapped transformer is used to step down ac voltage from the sensing switch, a limit switch in this case. Step down voltage is rectified and applied to a potenitial divider. The output voltage from the potentiometer is fed to a logic element. Transistor circuit can be used so that the output is not affected due to noise and line disturbance. The signal converter shown in Fig. 11.23 (c) uses a reed relay, to switch on and off the output logic supply to the signal converter output line. When limit switch LS closes, rectified dc voltage will energise realy RR. Its contact will close and switch + 5 V to the logic gate. The reed relay, in this case can provide electric isolation between high voltage and low dc logic circuit supply. As the above two types of signal converters use a capacitor to smoothen the dc voltage from rectifier, no separate bounce eliminator is needed. The capacitor in the signal converter takes care of the bouncing of switches and line disturbance. dharm d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5 261
  • 279. 262 CONTROL OF MACHINES LS 110V dc Output To logic (a) ground LS 110V or Cap Output 220V ac To logic (b) ground + 5V RR RR 110V Cap + 5V or Output 220V ac To logic ground (c) Fig. 11.23 Different types of signal converters (a) dc to dc converter (b) ac signal converter (c) ac converter using reed relay In recent years, optically coupled signal converters have become very popular due to their light weight, low cost and more reliablility. The optically coupled signal converters work equally well on either ac or dc high voltage signals. They are therefore also referred to as the universal signal converters. In these converters no transformer or relay is required. One type of opto coupled signal converters, which is built using a light emitting diode and photo transistor, is shown in Fig. 11.24. When limit switch LS is open, LED does not conduct. Photo transistor is cut off, while transistor T1 is conducting as its base to emitter is forward biased due to voltage appearing across the photo transistor. As transistor T1 is conducting, a low voltage appears at terminal Vout. When limit switch closes, LED will conduct and emit light which would fall on the base of photo transistor and it would start conducting. Due to the conduction of photo transitor, the dharm d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5 262
  • 280. STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES 263 base to emitter bias for transistor T1 falls and it goes to cut off state. When T1 is cut off, a high voltage i.e., (+ 5 V) will appear at the output terminal Vout. + VCC(+ 5V) 100 KW 1KW Vout L.S (+ 5V) 220V T1 A.C LED Photo transistor Fig.11.24 Opto coupled signal converter 11.10 OUTPUT DEVICES FOR SOLID STATE LOGIC The actuating devices like solenoids, motor starter coils etc. can not be energised directly from gates as they are low voltage, low power devices. Thus, an output amplifier is required between the logic gate output and the actuating devices. The purpose of the output amplifier is to increase the low-voltage low current logic power to high voltage high current output power. Most of the output amplifiers are designed to drive 110 V or 220 V ac load, since most industrial solenoid valves and starter coils are designed for this voltage. An output amplifier using a reed relay is shown in Fig. 11.25. In this circuit, when the output from the logic circuit is high, transistor T1 will conduct and thus relay R will operate. Its contact R will close and energise the solenoid coil. This type of arragement provides electrical isolation between the logic circuit and the output circuit. + 5V or Solenoid 15V R R 220V ac T1 Output from logic circuit Fig. 11.25 Output amplifier using a relay contact to control current through output device Modern output amplifiers are built using an SCR, triggered by a UJT. A typical design of such output amplifier is shown in Fig. 11.26. Due to the closing of limit switch, when a high input appears at RC potential divider, a capacitor starts charging. At a particular value of capacitor voltage the UJT is turned on and capacitor gets discharged through it. A pulse thus dharm d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5 263
  • 281. 264 CONTROL OF MACHINES gets applied to the primary of a pulse transformer connected to the base of UJT. This pulse is transferred to the secondary side of the transformer and gets applied between gate and cathode of SCR. The SCR will trigger on and will start conducting if its anode is positive with respect to cathode. To achieve current flow through load on both half cycles of ac voltage, a bridge rectifier is used to provide a continuous dc supply to the SCR. + DC Input Logic from supply logic circuit R1 R2 SCR 220V ac UJT Capacitor Fig. 11.26 Logic output amplifier using a UJT and an SCR 11.11 SOLENOID VALVE OPERATED CYLINDER PISTON ASSEMBLY A cylinder piston assembly is used to get to and fro motion of a machine part. It is a very fundamental operation in any industry. Thus, before more complicated machine circuits are discussed, it will be worthwhile to study the control circuit for solenoid valve operated cylinder piston assembly, shown in Fig. 11.27. Position 1 Position 2 1 LS 2 LS Valve port connections shown with solenoid SOL de-energised Spring Tank Pressure Fig. 11.27 Cylinder piston assembly operated by a solenoid valve A single solenoid spring return valve is used to supply fluid power to this cylinder. Various control requirements for this cylinder piston assembly are as follows: Piston has to move between two extreme positions 1 and 2 determined by the locations of limit switches 1 LS and 2 LS. The initial or starting position of piston is position 1 in which limit switch 1 LS is actuated as shown in Fig. 11.27. On giving the starting command, the dharm d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5 264
  • 282. STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES 265 piston should move to the right until it actuates the limit switch 2LS. Thus, at position 2, on actuation of 2LS the piston should immediately move backward to position 1. There should also be provision to return the piston back from any point in its forward travel (from left to right). Control circuit shown in Fig. 11.28 fulfills all the control requirements listed above. Fig. 11.28 Logic circuit for piston movement In this control circuit normally open (NO) contact of limit switch 1LS and normally closed (NC) contact of limit switch 2 LS have been used. A Reverse push button is used to bring back the piston to position 1 from any point in its forward travel. Working of the control circuit is as follows: When piston is in position 1, limit switch 1LS is actuated, its normally open (NO) contact is closed, thus providing a high signal to input terminal 2 of AND1. On pressing the START-push button a high signal appears at terminal 1 of AND1. Its output therefore goes high which appears at input terminal 2 of OR1. Thus, output of OR1 goes high which is fed back to the terminal 1 of AND2. Terminals 2 and 3 of AND2 already have high signals as Reverse push button and contact of 2LS are closed. Thus when START-push button is pressed, all three inputs to AND2 become high and it gives a high output. This output is amplified and applied to the solenoid valve coil. Valve shifts its spool and piston starts moving in forward direction from left to right towards position 2. Signal from output of AND2 is fed back to terminal 1 of OR1 for sealing, as the input at terminal 2 of OR1 will disappear as soon as START-push button is released. Contact of limit switch 1LS will also open as soon as piston leaves the position 1. The output of AND2 is maintained till limit switch 2 LS operates and cuts off the input at its terminal 3. Loss of one input to AND2 brings its output low which leads to de- energisation of the solenoid. As the solenoid valve is spring controlled the spool will come back to its original position and the piston will move back to position 1. The piston can also be made to reverse at any point from its forward movement by pressing the Reverse-push button. When the Reverse-push button is pressed the high signal at terminal 2 of AND2 goes low which causes output of AND2 also to go low. As output of AND2 goes low, the solenoid valve is de-energised and sealing/holding of circuit is also broken. The piston thus moves back to position 1. 11.12 CONTROL OF THREE STAGE AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM A simple air conditioner system consists of a single compressor motor which gets switched off when temerature of the space being controlled falls below the setting on the thermostat. Thermostats are provided with differential setting to avoid frequent switching ON and OFF of the compressor motor. dharm d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5 265
  • 283. 266 CONTROL OF MACHINES A three stage air conditioning system is used for conservation of electrical energy and optimum utilisation of the installed capacity of the compressor. There are two compressor motors in this system. One motor is of smaller horsepower, and the second one is of higher horsepower rating. These motors are designated a comp. 1 and comp. 2 in this case. The system is installed in a cinema hall for maintaining the hall temperature between 20-24° C. Depending upon the number of viewers in the hall and the ambient atmospheric conditions, comp. 1 and comp. 2 motors can be run in three different combinations. The three combinations described below are also the control requirements of the air conditioning system. (1) Compressor 1 and compressor 2 should run when the temperature in the hall is above 28°C. (2) Only compressor 2 should run if temperature in the hall rises above 24°C but is below 28°C. (3) Only compressor 1 should run if temperature in the hall is above 20°C but below 24°C. A pre-condition for running any compressor is that chilling water flow switch FS1 should be closed. Chilling water flow is necessary to take away heat from the compressed cooling gas. Three thermostats with different settings are used for the control of compressor motors running in three different stages described above. The three thermostats T1, T2, T3 are set at 20°C, 24°C and 28°C respectively. The control of three stages with three thermostats and flow switch (FS 1) of air conditioning system can be understood from the control circuit shown in Fig. 11.29. The START- push button, STOP-push button, and over load contacts for compressor motors have not been shown in the circuit for sake of simplicity. Working of the control circuit is as follows: (1) When chilled water flow is maintained, flow switch FS1 will actuate and close its contacts. Closing of contact FS1 causes application of a high logic signal to terminal 2 of all AND gates. (2) When temperature in the cinema hall is above 28°C, contacts of all the three thermostats T1, T2, T3 close. Closed contacts of T1 will give a high input to terminal 1 of AND1 but closed contact of T2 will give low logic signal to terminal 3 of AND1 as there is a NOT gate in series. The output of AND1, therefore, becomes low. 1 OA 20°C 2 AND1 1 OR1 C1 T1 2 3 24°C T2 1 28°C AND2 T3 2 FS1 1 1 OA AND2 2 OR2 C2 2 Fig. 11.29 Control circuit for three stage air conditioning system dharm d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5 266
  • 284. STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES 267 (3) Closed contact of thermostat T3 will give a high signal to terminal 1 of AND2 while its other terminal 2 is already high due to closure of FS1. AND2 thus gives a high output which is applied to both OR1 and OR2. As one terminal each of OR1 and OR2 is now high, their outputs are also high. Output from OR1 leads to energisation of contactor C1 and output from OR2 leads to energisation of contactor C2 through their repsective amplifiers. Thus, compressors 1 and 2 will run when temperature in the hall is above 28°C. (4) When the hall temperature is below 28°C but more than 24°C, contact of thermostat T3 will be open while contacts of T1 and T2 are closed. Due to open contact of T3 there is low signal at terminal 1 of AND2 and therfore its output is low. Output of AND1 is also low as closed contact of T2 gives a low signal at terminal 3 due to a NOT gate in series. In this case AND3 will have high output as its input terminal 1 has high signal from the closed contact of thermostat T2. It is to be noted that supply to terminal 1 of AND3 is taken prior to the NOT gate. High output from AND3 goes to terminal 2 of OR2 which then gives a high output. This output energises contactor C2 through the amplifier. Thus compressor 2 will run only when the temperature is above 24°C but below 28°C. (5) When temperature falls below 24°C contact of thermostat T2 opens and output of AND3 will then go low due to a low signal at its input terminal. The open contact of T2 will however give a high signal to terminal 3 of AND1 (due to the NOT gate in series). It will get switched ON as its terminal 1 and 2 are already high. The high output from AND1 then goes to terminal 1 of OR1 which then gives a high output to energise contactor C1. Thus, one compressor will run when temperature is below 24°C but above 20°C. When temperature falls below 20° C, contact of thermostat T1 also opens and terminal 1 of AND1 goes low and it is switched off. Thus compressor 1 also stops when temperature falls below 20°C. Compressor 1 continues to run if temperature in the hall remains between 20-24°C. If due to more viewers in the hall, compressor 1 is unable to maintain temperature below 24°C, compressor 2 will be switched ON while compressor 1 will be switched off. If the load is still more and compressor 2 alone can not cope up and temperature goes above 28°C then compressor 1 will also start to bring down the temperature. 11.13 SPEED CONTROL OF WOUND ROTOR INDUCTION MOTOR Let us consider a wound rotor induction motor which is to run on three different speeds. Separate push buttons are used to select the speed of operation. The motor accelerates automatically to the selected speed. For example, if the second speed is selected, the motor first starts running on low speed and then accelerates to the second higher speed. If the third speed is selected, the motor must start in first speed, accelerate to second speed and then accelerate to third speed. The various control requirements for the control circuit are as follows: (1) One STOP-push button to stop the motor regardless of the speed of rotation of the motor. (2) An overload protection for the motor. (3) Three separate push buttons to select the first, second or third speed. (4) A 5 seconds time delay between acceleration from one speed to another. (5) If the motor is in operation and a higher speed is desired, it should be obtained by pushing the respective push button. On the other hand if the motor is running and a dharm d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5 267
  • 285. 268 CONTROL OF MACHINES lower speed is desired, the stop button should be pressed before pressing the required speed push button. Recall that speed control for a wound rotor motor is obtained by placing a resistance in the rotor circuit as shown in Fig. 11.30. L1 L2 L3 M 2S 1S R2 R1 Rotor Fig. 11.30 Power circuit for a three speed wound rotor induction motor In this starter contactor M is used to connect the stator windings of motor to the supply mains. When contactor M is energised the motor starts with all resistances in the rotor circuit, and accelerates to its first speed. For the second higher speed, contactor 1S closes and shorts resistance bank R1 from rotor circuit. Third speed can be obtained by closing contactor 2S which cuts R2 also from the rotor circuit. This shorts the rotor winding terminals and the motor operates as a squirrel cage motor at third speed. Control circuit for the above mentioned operation is shown in Fig. 11.31. Fig. 11.31 Control circuit for a three speed wound rotor induction motor dharm d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5 268
  • 286. STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES 269 Working of the circuit is as follows: (1) When push button for the lowest speed is pressed, memory element 1 goes into set mode, its output Q becomes high which appears at terminal 1 of OR1. Output of OR1 thus becomes high and contactor M is energised through the amplifiers. Motor starts with all resistances in rotor circuit at a slow speed. (2) When the motor is desired to run in next higher speed, the corresponding push button is pressed which brings the memory element 2 in set mode. Its output appears at input terminal 2 of OR1 and also at terminal 1 of OR2. Output of OR1 goes high and energises contactor M while OR2 output goes high and appears at input terminal 2 of AND1. Besides energising contactor M, output of OR1 also appears at terminal 1 of AND1. Now both the terminals of AND1 are high, thus output of AND1 becomes high and timer T1 is energised. After a pre set delay, timer output goes high and energises contactor 1S. Energisation of 1S shorts one bank of resistance R1 from the rotor circuit and thus motor accelerates to second higher speed. (3) When the third speed push button is pressed, memory element 3 goes into set mode and its output goes high and appears at terminal 3 of OR1 and energises contactor M. Then, as described earlier, contactor 2S gets energised after a fixed delay, set by timer T1. When T1 has timed out its output energises contactor 1S and also appears at input terminal 1 of AND2. Output of AND2 goes high as its terminal 2 is already high due to output from memory element 3. Output of AND2 energises timer T2 and its output goes high after a fixed delay. This energises contactor 2S, which shorts resistance R2 from the rotor circuit. The motor thus accelerates to the final i.e., the third speed. (4) When STOP-push button is pressed or over load relay trips the output of NOT1 goes high which appears at reset terminal R of all the three memory elements and resets them. This leads to the dropping of all the three contactors M, 1S and 2S. 11.14 CONTROL OF PLANER MACHINE The machine has already been discussed in the chapter on industrial applications of magnetic control. Here it will be shown how the same machine is controlled using digital logic elements. Schematic representation of a planer machine is shown in Fig. 11.32. Work piece Planing tool Table Rack 1LS 2LS Pinion Motor Fig. 11.32 Schematic diagram for a Planer machine dharm d:N-MachMac11-1.pm5 269
  • 287. 270 CONTROL OF MACHINES In this machine, the work piece or the job placed on the table moves to and fro by rack and pinion arrangement mounted on the shaft of a squirrel cage motor. The cutting tool is fixed while the job placed on the table is worked upon by movement of the table. Movement of the table is controlled between two limits on left and right by limit switches 1LS and 2LS. When table moves from left to right, tool works on the job while it remains ideal during right to left motion of the table. At the end of right to left motion, tool gets feed for the next cut on the job. Various control requirements for the machine are as follows: (1) The motor is to be started manually by pressing START-push button. Once the motor starts it is reversed automatically at the end of right or left stroke by limit switches 2LS and 1LS. (2) There should be provision for jogging the motor by a Jog-push button. (3) If the machine table is lying in between extreme positions, machine should fail to start. Selection of initial direction of travel should be possible through right and left traverse push button, PBR and PBL. (4) There should be a delay in starting the motor in left to right stroke so as to allow the tool to get the feed for a fresh cut on the job. (5) The machine should stop on pressing of STOP-push button or on over-load tripping of motor. (6) Interlocking of coolant pump motor (running) should be provided as a pre-condition for starting of the machine. Control circuit for the machine adhering to the above mentioned control requirements is shown in Fig. 11.33. Start 1 Stop 2 AND1 1 OR1 JOG 2 Coolant pump 1 2 AND2 3 PBR 1 OA A X 2 AND3 R T (Set) 1LS B (Reset) Retentive memory 1 OA PBL 2 AND4 L 2LS Fig. 11.33 Logic control circuit for a planer machine There are two major sectors of this control circuit. One is the control of the starting and stopping of the motor, and the other is the automatic reversing control. dharm d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5 270
  • 288. STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES 271 Working of the circuit is as follow: (1) When START-push button is pressed, input terminal 1 of AND1 becomes high. Its output also goes high as its input terminal 2 is already high due to closed contact of STOP-push button. Output is fed back to terminal 1 for holding the output high. (2) Output of AND1 appears at terminal 1 of OR1 making the output of OR1 high which appears at terminal 1 of AND2. If motor overload relay contact is closed and coolant pump motor is running, then terminals 2 and 3 of AND2 also have a high signal. Thus all the three input terminals of AND2 are high and so its output goes high. (3) Output of AND2 appears at terminal 1 of AND3 and AND4. Depending upon the condition of memory element i.e., whether it is in set mode or in reset, either AND3 or AND4 output will go high and will energise the respective contactor R or L. Desired direction of travel may however be selected by pressing the right or left traverse push buttons PBR or PBL before pressing the START-push button. (4) To understand the reversing action of circuit, it is assumed that initially the ma- chine table is in extreme left position so that the limit switch 1LS is in actuated condition and its normally open (NO) contact is closed. Thus, a high signal appears at terminal A of the retentive memory through closed contact of 1LS. Memory ele- ment gets set and its output terminal X goes high. (5) High output from terminal X appears at terminal 2 of AND3 after some delay set by the timer T while at terminal 2 of AND4, a low signal appears because of the NOT gate being in series with the output from X. (6) As both the terminals 1 and 2 of AND3 are now high, its output becomes high which energise motor contactor R through the amplifier. Machine table thus moves in right direction. (7) When extreme right position is reached, limit switch 2LS gets actuated. Its normally Open (NO) contact closes and resets the memory element. Output at terminal X goes low and thus terminal 2 of AND3 also becomes low. Output of AND3 therefore goes low and contactor R is de-energised. At the same time when memory element gets reset, terminal 2 of AND4 goes high due to a NOT gate inverting the low output from X. (8) Thus, due to actuation of limit switch 2LS terminal 2 and AND4 goes high while its terminal 1 is already high. Hence, a high output appears which energise motor con- tactor L through the amplifier. Motor now runs in reverse direction to move the table from right to left. (9) When the table reaches extreme left position, limit switch 1LS gets actuated and memory element is set and thus terminal 2 of AND4 goes low and its output becomes low. Contactor L is therefore de-energised. After a delay set on timer T, again con- tactor R is energised as output of AND3 becomes high. The to and fro motion, due to setting and resetting of memory elements by actuation of limit switches, continues till the STOP-push button is pressed or overload trips to make the terminal 1 of AND3 and AND4 low. (10) If the machine table is required to be moved slowly in steps for adjustment of the tool with respect to the job position then Jog-push button alongwith the required traverse push button PBR or PBL is used. As seen from the control circuit, Jog-push button output is connected to terminal 2 of OR1 and there is no feedback for holding the dharm d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5 271
  • 289. 272 CONTROL OF MACHINES output of OR1. Therefore, output of OR1 remains high as long as Jog-push button is kept pressed. Thus the table can be moved as desired in steps by the Jog-push button. Students are advised to trace out the energisation of contactor R and L when the Jog-push button is used. 11.15 CONTROL OF THREE CONVEYORS A conveyor system, discussed here, consists of three conveyors used to transfer sand from silos (large container) to the sand hopper of a mould making machine used in a foundary. The arrangement is as shown in Fig. 11.34. Silos Silos gate Conv 1 Conv 2 Sand hopper Conv 3 full limit switch Mould making machine Fig. 11.34 Schematic diagram for three conveyors Sand is fed to conveyor 1 by opening the gate of silos which is operated by a pneumatic cylinder. The gate opens only when all the three conveyors are running. Conveyor 1 dumps sand on to conveyor 2 which in turn dumps sand onto conveyor 3. Sand from conveyor 3 falls in the sand hopper. Conveyor can be started and stopped through the ON or OFF push button provided near the mould making machine. Conveyors stop automatically when the sand hopper is full. Various control requirements for this system are as follows: (1) ON-push button is to start all conveyor motors in sequence from 3 to 1, i.e., from the last to the first. (2) Sand gate of the silos should open automatically when all the three conveyors are running. (3) An over-load on any of the conveyors should stop all these conveyors. (4) When sand hopper of the machine is full, a limit switch should actuate and stop all the conveyors. (5) Stopping of the conveyors should follow the sequence 1, 2, 3 i.e., from first to last. (6) An additional requirement during stoppage is that there be a delay of 2 minutes between the stopping of subsequent conveyors, in order that the sand on the following conveyor might clear before it is stopped. (7) A STOP-push button near the mould making machine should also be able to stop the conveyors. dharm d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5 272
  • 290. STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES 273 Control circuit for the above requirements is shown in Fig. 11.35. Fig. 11.35 Control circuit for three conveyors In this control circuit, timer elements T1 and T2 have been prefixed and post fixed by NOT elements to make the timer action equivalent to an OFF-delay timer with a normally open delayed contact. Students are advised to clearly understand the operation of an OFF delay timer, if they have any doubt, before proceeding further. Operations of the control circuit is as follows: (1) The conveyors can be started if the contact of the sand hopper limit switch LS1 is closed (i.e., sand level is lower than the limit in the sand hopper) and all the over- load relay contacts are closed. If the above two conditions are true then there will be high signals at input terminal 2 and 3 of AND1. (2) On pressing the ON-push button, a high signal appears at input terminal 1 of AND1 and its output goes high. This output is fed back to terminal 1 for sealing. High output from AND1 appears at terminal 2 of AND2, AND3 and AND4. (3) Output of AND1 also appears at input terminal 1 of OR1. Its output therefore goes high and energises contactor 3 to run conveyor 3. Output of OR1 also appears at input terminal 1 of AND2 and its output becomes high and appears at terminal 1 of OR2. Output of OR2 thus also goes high and energises contactor 2 to run conveyor 2. (4) Output from OR2 appears at input terminal 1 of timer T1 and its output immediately goes high (off delay timer action) and appears at input terminal 2 of OR1. (5) Output from OR2 also appears at input terminal of AND3 and makes its output high to energise contactor 1. (6) Output from AND3 also appears at input terminal of timer T2 and its output immedi- ately goes high and appears at input terminal 2 of OR2. dharm d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5 273
  • 291. 274 CONTROL OF MACHINES (7) Output of AND3 also appears at input terminal 1 of AND4 after a small delay through timer T3. Output of AND4 therefore goes high and energises the solenoid to open the gate of the silos. Thus, sand from silos starts falling on conveyor 1 after a small delay from the starting of conveyor 1. (8) Now, when output of AND1 goes low either due to pressing of OFF-push button or tripping of some over-load relay or actuation of sand hopper limit switch, the input at terminal 1 or OR1 goes low, but its output remains high as its input terminal 2 is high (output from timer T1). Similarly, output of OR2 remains high due to a high signal at its input 2 although its terminal 1 goes low. Thus, conveyor 3 and 2 con- tinue to run. Conveyor 1, however, stops immediately when AND1 output goes low as input terminal 2 of AND3 goes low. Silos gate also closes immediately as output of AND4 goes low due to output of AND1 going low. (9) As output of AND3 goes low, input to timer T2 becomes low. Timer output goes low only after a delay of 2 minutes and makes the input terminal 2 of OR2 also low. The output of OR2 thus also becomes low. This leads to stopping of conveyor 2 after a delay of 2 minutes from the stopping of conveyor 1. (10) As output of OR2 goes low, input of T1 also becomes low, and therefore its output becomes low after 2 minutes. This makes the input terminal 2 of OR1 low and its output also becomes low. As a result contactor 3 gets de-energised. Conveyer 3 thus stops after a delay of 2 minutes from the stopping of conveyor 2. 11.16 SHIFT REGISTER Shift register consists of JK flip flops connected in series which transfer their contents from one to another. Schematic diagram of a shift register having four flip flops is shown in Fig. 11.36. Output of the first is connected to input of the second and so on. Clock and clear terminals of all are connected in parallel. Working: When a low clear signal is applied, all flip flops get reset i.e., Q1, Q2, Q3, Q4 becomes low while Q1, Q2 , Q3 , Q4 becomes high. The state of the register is Q1, Q2, Q3, Q4 = 0000. Now suppose a high signal is applied to J terminal of the first flip flop FF1 and is maintained. When clock pulses, also called shift commands are applied to the CK terminals of all flip flops, then on negative edge of first pulse, FF4, FF3, FF2 remain in reset mode as their J input terminal is low. Flip flop FF1, however gets into set mode and its output terminal Q1 becomes high. Thus state of the register after first pulse becomes 1000. When second negative edge appears, FF2 will go into set mode as it has a high at its J terminal. FF1 remains in set mode since a high is maintained at its input terminal J. FF4 and FF3 remain in reset mode as they have a low at their J terminal. Thus after the second pulse the state of register becomes 1100. If high input at J terminal of FF1 is maintained, then on application of third negative edge to CK terminals FF3 will also go into set mode and the state of register becomes 1110. Similarly on fourth negative edge the state of the register becomes 1111. On subsequent pulses the state of register remains unchanged as 1111, if constant high is maintained at J terminal of FF1. Registers continue to lose 1 from the extreme right flip flop while another 1 is added in the extreme left flip flop FF1. Hence, the information in the flip flops is shifted one place to the right whenever a shift command occurs, while an external circuit keeps feeding 1’s into the leading flip flop FF1. dharm d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5 274
  • 292. STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES 275 FF1 FF2 FF3 FF4 High J Q1 J Q2 J Q3 J Q4 CK CK CK CK K CL Q1 K CL Q2 K CL Q3 K CL Q4 Clear Fig. 11.36 Shift register built with JK Flip-flops The schematic diagram of flip flop represents how pre-packaged shift registers are internally built however, they are illustrated in a different way as shown in Fig. 11.37 (a). J PR1 PR2 PR3 PR4 CK K CL Q 1 Q1 Q 2 Q2 Q3 Q 3 Q4 Q 4 (a) J 4 bit J 4 bit CK register CK register K K CL Q4 Q4 CL (b) Fig. 11.37 (a) Symbol for prepackaged register (b) Cascade connection of two shift registers Most common length for pre-package shift registers are 4, 5 and 8 bits. If a longer shift register is required, two or more small ones can be cascaded as shown in Fig. 11.37 (b). There are many different types of shift registers but the basic function of all is to shift binary bits from one location to the next. To avoid confusion only the type discussed above will be used subsequently. 11.17 CONVEYOR SYSTEM USING A SHIFT REGISTER Shift registers are widely used in industrial applications involving conveyor systems. Each flip flop in shift register represents one zone on the conveyor system. The state of a particular flip flop, ON or OFF, stands for some characteristic of the piece in that zone. The most obvious dharm d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5 275
  • 293. 276 CONTROL OF MACHINES example which can be represented in binary 1 or 0 is pass or fail, i.e., either the piece passes inspection and is routed to the next zone or it fails inspection and is rejected. Let us discuss a practical application of shift register in control of a production set-up in which evenly spaced parts come down a conveyor for inspection. Schematic representation of the system is shown in Fig. 11.38. 1 2 3 4 Inspection Work Work zone zone zone Pusher Conveyor Bad parts Reject bin Fig. 11.38 Plan layout of a conveyor inspection system Assume that the conveyor is divided in four zones. Inspection of the piece is done in zone 1. In zones 2 and 3 some work is done on the piece if it passes inspection, while the piece which fails, is allowed to pass through unattended. For identification of the rejection piece, it is marked with paint by an inspector of zone 1 for the benefit of workers of zones 2 and 3. A reject push button is also pressed while the rejected piece is still in zone 1. When the piece reaches the fourth zone, a pneumatic pusher extends and pushes the rejected piece into the reject bin while the good parts move past the fourth zone. Control circuit for the above system is shown in Fig. 11.39. Shift register in the circuit has been used to keep track of the progress of a bad piece on the system and to operate the pusher when the bad piece reaches zone 4. + 15V Reject OA J Q J Q J Q J Q CK CK CK CK Pusher solenoid K Q K Q K Q K Q FF1 FF2 FF3 FF4 LS Fig. 11.39 Control circuit of conveyor inspection system using a shift register dharm d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5 276
  • 294. STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES 277 Working of the circuit is as follows: (1) If the Reject-button is pressed while the bad piece is in zone 1, the preset terminal of flip-flop FF1 becomes low and it goes into set mode (assuming that the flip flop responds to low preset signal). Its output Q1 becomes high and appears at input terminal J of FF2. (2) When the rejected piece leaves the zone 1 and enters zone 2, a limit switch is actuated. The limit switch gives a low signal to all CK terminals. Flip flop FF2 goes into set mode and its output Q2 becomes high while FF1, FF3 and FF4 get reset. FF1 gets reset due to its J terminal being grounded. Thus we see that as the rejected part moves into zone 2, the information about its non-acceptance enters flip flop 2. (3) When the rejected piece enters zone 3, limit switch is again actuated, by the piece following it i.e., by the one entering zone 2. Shift command thus appears at all the CK terminals. (4) On application of signal to CK terminals, FF3 gets in set mode as its input is high (Q2 = 1), the information of a bad piece in zone 3 enters flip flop FF3. Similarly, when a bad piece enters zone 4 the limit switch is again actuated and another shift command occurs, which turns on FF4. (5) When output Q4 of FF4 goes high it energises the solenoid which applies a push to the work piece. Pusher moves forward and the bad piece is thrown into the reject bin. (6) When the next piece enters zone 4, FF4 gets reset if the part is good and the pusher immediately moves backward before the part can run into it. 11.18 COUNTER A digital counter can count the number of pulses appearing at its input terminal. Counting, however, is done in Binary coded decimal number since the counter circuit is made of flip flops and logic gates. Schematic representation of a decade counter is shown in Fig. 11.40 (a). Input count pulses apear at terminal CK and the count number in binary code appears at terminal DCBA with corresponding numerical values of 8, 4, 2, 1. Input count pulse number versus the corresponding BCD output is given below: A B CK C D CL (a) C1 C2 C3 A A A B B B CK CK CK C C C Count D D D input Clear Hundred Tens Units (b) Fig. 11.40 (a) Symbol for counter (b) Cascading of counters for measurement in terms of tens and hundreds dharm d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5 277
  • 295. 278 CONTROL OF MACHINES CK DCBA 1 0001 2 0010 3 0011 4 0100 5 0101 6 0110 7 0111 8 1000 9 1001 When clear terminal CL goes to its active low, all four bits clear to 0. The counter output becomes 0000. From the above table, it is clear that a decade up-counter counts upto 9. However, counting pulses greater than 9 is done by cascading the counters as shown in Fig. 11.40 (b). At the tenth pulse all the bits DCBA of counter 1 clear to 0. As the terminal D of the unit counter is connected to CK terminal of counter 2, the negative going edge of D triggers the counter and its output becomes 0001. Thus second counter registers, tens, and similarly, third counter will register hundreds. For example, when 15 number of pulses have appeared the output of counter will be : Counter 3 Counter 2 Counter 1 (hundreds) (tens) (unit) BCD number 0000 0001 0101 Numerical number 0 1 5 i.e., 00010101 = 15 11.19 DECODER A counter records pulses in binary coded decimal numbers. But this information is not understood by a layman. A decoder is thus required which converts BCD number into decimal number. Schematic representation of a Decoder is shown in Fig. 11.41 (a). If the binary information represents the decimal digit 3 (DCBA = 0011), the decoder drives the output line No. 3 high. 0 0 1 1 2 2 A 3 A A 3 B 4 B B 4 C 5 C C 5 6 D D 6 D 7 7 8 Decade counter 8 9 9 Decoder (a) Decoder (b) Ten position selector switch Fig. 11.41 (a) Schematic representation of a decoder (b) Combination of a decade counter, decoder and a 10-position selector switch dharm d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5 278
  • 296. STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES 279 In many industrial applications, where a certain action has to be taken after a fixed, count, a ten position selector switch is connected to the output of decoder as shown in Fig. 11.41 (b). If it is desired to initiate some action after a count of say 5, selector switch is placed in position 5 as shown in Fig. 11.41. After 5 number of count pulses, DCBA of counter will be 0101, which would also appear at DCBA terminals of Decoder. Decoder terminal 5 will go high and a high output will appear at common terminal of the switch to initiate the desired action. Here, the BCD number has been referred to the decimal decoder. There are other types of decoders available such as BCD to seven segment, grey code to decimal, excess three code to decimal etc. In this text, the term decoder will refer to the BCD to decimal decoder. Interested students may refer to a text book on digital electronics for study of inbuilt structure of a decoder. 11.20 LOADING OF CASTINGS INTO ANNEALING FURNACE USING DECADE COUNTER AND DECODER The schematic arrangement for the system is shown in Fig. 11.42. Fig. 11.42 Plan layout of automatic loading of castings into Annealing furnace using conveyors In this system a number of castings are loaded on a metallic roller conveyor passing through the annealing furnace. On pressing the loading/unloading push button, annealing furnace door opens. When doors are fully open annealing furnace conveyor (conv. 2) and loading furnace conveyor (conv. 1) will start. As the conveyors start, annealed castings come out of the exit side, while fresh castings are loaded on to the annealing furance conveyor from loading conveyor. When the selected number of castings enter the annealing furnace, both the conveyors stop and furance doors close. Annealing of the castings can then be done for required time. The number of castings to be admitted in furnace can be changed depending upon their size. Selector switches are used to select the number of castings to be admitted. Number of castings entering the furance is counted with the help of a limit switch LS3 mounted on the end of the loading conveyor. Every time a casting de-actuates the limit switch while leaving conv 1 and entering conv 2, the CK terminal of units counter becomes zero. The negative going edge causes the counter to produce a pulse at its output in binary coded decimal form. Control circuit for the system is shown in Fig. 11.43. Explanation of the control circuit is as follows : (1) Suppose 12 castings are to be loaded into the furnace. This number being greater than 9, two decade counters are cascaded as shown in the diagram. Output D of the units counter is connected to the CK terminal of tens counter. Clear terminals of both the counters are connected to the output of AND3 through a NOT gate as shown in the control circuit. Units counters selector switch is set at 2 while Tens counter selector switch is set at 1 to get a total setting of 12. dharm d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5 279
  • 297. 280 CONTROL OF MACHINES Fig. 11.43 Control circuit for loading of castings in an annealing furnace dharm d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5 280
  • 298. STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES 281 (2) For loading, Start loading/unloading push-button is pressed. Output appears at AND1 gate as its input terminal 2 and 3 are already high. Terminal 3 is high as R-S flip-flop is in reset mode. Output is fed back to terminal 1 for sealing the circuit. (3) As soon as the AND1 output goes high, entry and exit door opens due to energisation of solenoids S1 and S2. (4) When both the doors are open, LS1 and LS2 get actuated and AND2 output goes high. This output runs the furnace conveyor and loading conveyor by energising contactor C1 and C2 respectively. (5) As the conveyors start, the castings placed on loading conveyor also move and are shifted over to the furnace conveyor. Number of casting loaded on the furnace conveyor is counted by de-actuation of limit switch LS3 installed on the end of the loading conveyor. Every time LS3 is deactuated, CK terminal of units counter goes low and registers the count at its output-binary coded decimal form. Decoder converts it into decimal form. At the second count the ouput of units selector switch will go high and appear at input terminal 1 of AND3 but no further action takes place as the other input terminal 2 of AND3 is low. (6) Units counter will count upto 9 and when 10th count pulse appears, its output resets to 0000 from 1001 (9). Negative going transition of terminal D causes the tens counter to register a count and its output becomes 0001. Thus a high signal appears at input terminal 2 of AND3 on the 10th, count, but now the input at terminal 1 of AND3 is absent as unit counter is reset. (7) From 11th count, units counter again starts counting from 1 onwards. At the 12th count pulse, common terminal of Decoder selector switch goes high. Now both the inputs of AND3 are high so its output becomes high. This brings the R-S flip-flop in set mode and its output becomes high. This causes the input terminal 3 of AND1 to go low due to the presence of a NOT gate in series. Thus AND1 output goes low. Conveyors 1 and 2 stop immediately and furnace door starts closing due to de- energisation of door solenoids. (8) As the output of AND3 goes high, a low signal appears at CL terminal of units and tens counter due to the presence of a NOT gate in series with output of AND3 gate. 11.21 MONO SHOT Mono shot is a very useful digital element used in industrial controls. Its formal name is monostable multivibrator. The symbol for a mono shot is shown in Fig. 11.44 (a). It has two outputs Q and Q similar to a flip-flop. In this text, it is assumed that mono shot are triggered by a negative edge at trigger terminal T. However, they can be triggered by a positive edge also. When one shot is triggered, the Q output goes high while the Q output goes low. After a preset period of time, called firing time tf , the output Q returns to low and Q returns to high. Triggering of the mono shot by a short pulse and the resulting output Q and Q are shown in Fig. 11.44 (b). This way, a mono shot may be used as a pulse stretcher, or for delaying the negative edge of a pulse by a firing time tf . dharm d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5 281
  • 299. 282 CONTROL OF MACHINES Mono shots are frequently used to reset a counter or a flip-flop in circuits where the conditions are such that a long term level change cannot be used to reset the counter or the flip-flop (since the counter is to resume counting again after a short duration). Long term level change as compared to a small time change by a mono shot, is shown in Fig. 11.44 (c). Suppose the counter is to reset at instant A when Vin changes to low, and has to resume counting at instant B. If Vin is used to clear the counter by negative going edge at instant A, then even at instant B, the counter will remain reset and hence cannot resume counting. Thus Vin cannot be used to clear the counter. Instead, if a mono shot is triggered by Vin and its Q output is used to clear the counter, then counters can be resumed at instant B, since by that time Q of the mono shot will be back to its high state after firing time tf (refer Fig. 11.44 (c)). The above will become more clear when a practical industrial circuit is discussed. B A Vin Vin Long term level change (T) (T) Q T T Q Q Trigger Q tf tf input Mono shot Q tf Q (a) tf Counter (b) starts Counter again resets (c) Fig. 11.44 Symbol and waveforms of a mono shot 11.22 CLOCK The formal name of a clock in digital text books is astable multivibrator or free-running multivibrator. A clock generates a continuous train of pulses which may be utilised to synchronise various digital devices in an industrial circuit. It may also be required to provide count pulse to an industrial system which does not generate count pulses naturally. Symbol of a clock is shown in Fig. 11.45. 5 khz Clock Clock Output Frequency divider (a) (b) Fig. 11.45 (a) Symbol for a clock (b) A clock combined with a frequency divider The frequency of the waveform is set by values of resistor, capacitor, and inductor which are internally connected to the circuit. A lower frequency can be obtained by connecting a frequency divider circuit as shown in Fig. 11.45 (b). A frequency divider divides the clock pulse by an integer and produces a lower frequency pulse train. Some systems require clock pulses of different frequency in order to synchronise various events properly. dharm d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5 282
  • 300. STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES 283 11.23 AUTOMATIC FILLING OF SILOS USING A CLOCK AND A MONO SHOT The schematic diagram for the system is shown in Fig. 11.46. Diverters Main silos operated by solenoid valves 1 3 (Down Gate 2 position) Conv Up limit switch Down limit switch Silos gate Machine 1 Machine 2 Machine 3 Fig. 11.46 Schematic diagram for an automatic machine filling a number of silos In this system, certain material is to be distributed in three small silos 1, 2, 3 which feed individual machines 1, 2, and 3. Material is fed to silos from the main silos through a belt conveyor and diverters. Level of material in small silos is sensed by a lower level and an upper level limit switch as shown in the figure. Filling of any of the silos starts when the level of material in it falls below certain level as determined by the position of the lower level limit switch. When material in all the silos is above the upper level, conveyor is at standstill and diverters are in up position. Gate of main silos is also closed. When level of material in any of the silos falls below the lower limit, the conveyor starts moving and gate of the main silos opens. Diverter above the particular silos falls down so that material is diverted into that silos from the conveyor. When level rises to the upper limit, up limit switch gets actuated which causes the conveyor to stop, gate of the main silos to close, and the diverter to go up. In the diagram, diverter 2 is shown in down position and material is shown falling in to silos No. 2. In the diagram, the diverters are shown connected in series, so that only one silos may be filled at a particular time. Gate of main silos and diverter 1, 2, 3 are operated by solenoid valves. Special limit switches are used for sensing low and high level in silos. Material for processing in machines can be taken out from the silos by manual operation of the gate of a silos by the operator of a particular machine. dharm d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5 283
  • 301. 284 CONTROL OF MACHINES Control circuit for the above system is shown in Fig. 11.47, and the explanation for the circuit is as follows: (1) If the level in all the silos 1, 2 and 3 are above the upper limit, FF4 remains OFF. Its Q output is high, and so, input 1 of AND4 is high. At its terminal 2, clock is delivering square-wave pulses and, therefore, the output from AND4 is also a square-wave of same frequency as the clock. These pulses appear at CK terminal of decade counter and it starts counting. The counted number appears in BCD form at its output which is given to the decoder. Thus, terminal 1 of decoder goes high first and then 2, 3 and 4. When 4th output goes high it appears as a negative going edge at trigger terminal T of OS4 due to a NOT gate in series. OS4 fires for a few microseconds, applying a low signal to CL terminal of the counter, and counter immediately resets to zero. Counter again starts counting from 1. This is because when count pulse appears through AND4, the clear pulse has long departed from counter terminal CL. This is the example of a mono shot resetting the counter and then removing the clear signal in time for the counter to resume counting again. Thus the counter continuously counts from 1 to 3. Main silo gate OA OR1 Low Conveyor 1 FF1 OA 2 AND1 S Q Diverter 1 R Q T Up FF2 Q 1 OS1 OA Low 2 AND2 S Q Q Diverter 2 Q T Up FF3 Q 1 OA OS2 Low 2 AND3 S Q Diverter 3 Q 1 R Q 2 T OR2 S Q Q 3 OS3 R Q Up FF4 1 2 OR3 3 1 1 D D 2 C C CK AND4 3 B B 4 A A CL 2 Decoder Counter Q Clock T Q OS4 Fig. 11.47 Control circuit for an automatic machine filler dharm d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5 284
  • 302. STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES 285 (2) In case the output, 1 to 3 of the decoder goes high in succession, AND1, AND2 and AND3 are enabled partially in succession, as their terminal 1 goes high in succession. If low level limit switch of any of the silos is closed, then the corresponding AND gate will be fully enabled. Let us assume in this case that lower limit switch of silos 2 is actuated and thus AND2 is enabled. Its output therefore goes high and brings FF2 in set mode. Now due to output Q of FF2 going high, three actions take place. (i) Gate of main silos opens and conveyor also starts running with material falling from main silos on it. (ii) Diverter 2 falls down so as to divert material from conveyor into silos 2 due to energisation of diverter 2 solenoid. (iii) Q output of FF2 also appears at terminal 2 of OR2 and its output goes high which brings FF4 in set mode. Thus Q of FF4 goes low and AND4 is disabled and coun- ter does not receive count pulses. The counter therefore freezes in its present state. (3) When the level in silos 2 rises, lower limit switch opens, thus disabling AND2 but FF2 remains in set mode due to its memory ability. Thus filling of material continues till upper level limit switch is actuated which resets FF2. FF2 output Q goes low which disables OR1 and OR2 and de-energises the solenoid of Diverter 2. Disabling of OR1 stops the conveyor and main silos gate also closes. Disabling of OR2 removes high state from the S terminal of FF4. (4) Also, when Q of FF2 goes low, it delivers a negative edge to the trigger terminal of OS2 causing it to fire. Its output goes high for a few microseconds enabling OR3. The output of OR3 goes high and resets FF4 thus high state appears at terminal 1 of AND4 and thus clock pulses again appear at CK terminal of the counter. The counter starts counting from where it had stopped. In the above circuit, observe the utility of using mono shots, 1 to 3 for resetting FF4. Suppose, if FF4 is reset by the output Q of flip-flops from FF1 to FF3 then if FF4 is reset due to Q of FF2 going high it will remain in reset mode even if Q of FF1 or FF3 goes low as Q of FF2 will hold in reset mode. Thus it is necessary to temporarily apply a high to the terminal R of FF4 when any of the flip flops, FF1 to FF3 goes into reset mode. 11.24 DOWN COUNTER In a down counter every time a count pulse is delivered the number stored in the counter decreases by one. This type of counter is especially required in circuits where an output signal after a preset number of counts, and another signal earlier to a fixed number of counts, is desired. Symbol and table showing states of down counter after each input pulse are shown in Fig. 11.48. Down counters have input terminals DCBA, in addition to the output terminals, so as to preset a number into the counter in BCD form. When the load terminal of the counter goes low, BCD number at input is loaded into the counter and it appears at output terminals DCBA. Assuming that number 9(1001) is present at input terminals when load terminal goes low, the output is preset to 1001 as shown in the table of Fig. 11.48 (b). When the first pulse appears at CK terminal, output becomes 1000(8). At 9th pulse the output becomes 0000. At 10th pulse the counter again resets to 1001(9). dharm d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5 285
  • 303. 286 CONTROL OF MACHINES Initial Preset BCD Decimal pulse number number at CK 1 0 0 1 9 1 1 0 0 0 8 CK 2 0 1 1 1 7 D D 3 0 1 1 0 6 4 0 1 0 1 5 Inputs C C Outputs 5 0 1 0 0 4 B B 6 0 0 1 1 3 A A 7 0 0 1 0 2 Load 8 0 0 0 1 1 9 0 0 0 0 0 (a) 10 1 0 0 1 Preset (b) Fig. 11.48 (a) Symbol for decade down counter (b) Truth table 11.25 ENCODER An encoder is the inverse of a decoder. In this, input is in the decimal form and output appears in a binary equivalent number. There are various types of encoders, but in this text only 1-of- 10 decimal input to BCD output type is discussed. Symbols for Encoders with active low inputs is shown in Fig. 11.49 (a). Input Output terminal 0 D C B A low ¯ 1 2 0 0 0 0 0 3 D 1 0 0 0 1 Input 4 C 2 0 0 1 0 Outputs 5 B 3 0 0 1 1 6 A 4 0 1 0 0 7 8 5 0 1 0 1 9 6 0 1 1 0 7 0 1 1 1 BCD encoder 8 1 0 0 0 (a) 9 1 0 0 1 (b) Fig. 11.49 (a) Symbol for 1-of-10 decimal encoder (b) Truth table for encoder In an active low input encoder any one of the lines 0, 1, 2, 3 etc. going low is considered to be the desired input number. When input 0 is low while all others are high, output of the encoder is 0000, and when 1 becomes low while others are high, output becomes 0001. Truth table shown in Fig. 11.49 (b) indicates the output states for various inputs. Generally, the encoders receive their input from a 10-position selector switch. Selector switch can be set at any desired number by the operator and equivalent BCD number will appear at the output. This output is then loaded into a down counter when its load terminal goes low. Arrangement of selector switch, encoder and decade down counter is shown in Fig. 11.50. The encoder discussed here is supposed to belong to the logic family which interprets a floating input as High i.e., when all terminals from 0 to 9 except 3 appear as high to the dharm d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5 286
  • 304. STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES 287 encoder (terminal 3 being connected to a low). Active high input encoders may also be used from logic families which interpret floating input as low. 0 CK 1 2 3 D D D 4 C C C Counter Low Com 5 outputs B B B 6 A A A 7 8 9 Load Selector switch Encoder Decade down counter Fig. 11.50 Combination of a 10-position selector switch, a decimal-to-BCD encoder and a decade down counter In this text, active low convention has been followed. 11.26 PRODUCT DISPERSION CONVEYOR SYSTEM USING A DOWN-COUNTER, AN ENCODER, A MONO-SHOT AND A TIMER The conveyor system, used for dispensing a product to any desired zone is illustrated in Fig. 11.51. Zone Zone Zone Zone Zone 1 2 3 4 5 Loading zone Conveyor run by A Product two speed motor Fig. 11.51 Plan view of a product dispersion system In this system, a product is loaded on the conveyor in the loading zone by the operator. Depending upon the zone in which this product is desired, operator selects the zone number on the selector switch. After selecting the zone, operator presses the conveyor START-push button. First, the conveyor runs in slow speed for a small time as set by a timer. Then it runs in fast speed, and again it becomes slow when it reaches a zone prior to the zone set on the selector dharm d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5 287
  • 305. 288 CONTROL OF MACHINES switch. In each zone, limit switches are provided for sensing the product in that particular zone. As seen from Fig. 11.51 there are five zones and LS1 to LS5 are provided in these zones. There is an interlocking in the system due to which the conveyor cannot be started if a product is lying in any of the zones and has not been picked by the workers of that zone. Another provision in the control circuit is that if the product is desired in zone 1 then conveyor does not shift to fast speed but continues to run in slow speed. Control circuit for the above system is shown in Fig. 11.52. Explanation of the circuit is as follows : (1) Suppose it is desired to take the product to zone 5. First of all, the operator will set the selector switch to position 5. Terminal 5 of encoder thus goes low and binary coded decimal number 0101 appears at the output terminal of the encoder. This number also appears at the input of decade down counter. (2) When operator presses the conveyor START-push button, terminal 1 of AND1 goes high. If all the limit switches from LS1 to LS5 are in de-actuated condition, a high state appears at terminal 2 of AND1. Its output goes high. This causes terminal T of OS1 to go low. Its output Q , which is connected to load terminal of decade down counter, also goes low. Decade-down counter thus gets loaded to 0101 (5) which is present at its input terminals. Output of the down counter gets connected to the decoder. Thus, decoder’s terminal 5 will be high. (3) As soon as AND1 output goes high it also turns on FF1. Its output Q goes high and energises the main contactor of conveyor motor. A high also appears at terminal 2 of NAND gate but its terminal 1 is low so its output will be high and appear at terminal 1 of OR1 causing its output to go high. Slow contactor gets energised through the amplifier and thus the conveyor motor runs in slow speed. After some time delay, the timer T output goes high and appears at terminal 1 of NAND gate. As both the inputs of the NAND gate are now high, its output goes low. OR1 is disabled as its terminal 2 is already low. Slow contactor of the motor is de-energised while the fast contactor gets energised and the conveyor runs at fast speed with the product loaded on it. (4) When LS1 is actuated a low appears at CK terminal of the down counter and its output decreases from 0101(5) to 0100(4). Now the decoder output terminal 4 goes high. As the product on the conveyor proceeds further, limits switches LS2, LS3 and LS4 are actuated in succession. The decoder output terminals 3, 2 and 1 become high in succession. When terminal 1 of decoder becomes high, it appears at terminal 2 of OR1 and thus its output goes high. Fast contactor is de-energised and slow contactor is energised. Conveyor again shifts to slow speed. When limit switch LS5 is actuated, fifth count pulse is delivered to the down counter and its output becomes 0000 and decoder terminal 0 becomes high. Immediately trigger terminal T of OS2 goes low and its output Q becomes high which resets flip-flop FF1. When FF1 resets, its Q goes low and conveyor main contactor M is de-energised. Conveyor thus stops. Now the product can be lifted from the conveyor for further work on it in zone 5. (5) Similarly the product can be taken to any zone by selecting the required position on the selector switch. dharm d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5 288
  • 306. dharm Start 1 FF1 OA AND1 S 2 Q M d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5 Q Q R T T 289 Q Q OS 2 STATIC CONTROL OF MACHINES OS1 Selector switch Encoder 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 T 2 2 CK 2 NAND 2 3 3 D D D 3 4 4 C C C 4 5 5 B B B 5 6 6 A A A 6 1 OA 7 7 Load 7 OR1 2 8 8 Decade 8 Slow 9 9 down 9 counter Decoder OA LS1 NOT Fast LS6 Fig. 11.52 Control circuit for a product dispersion system 289
  • 307. 290 CONTROL OF MACHINES REVIEW QUESTIONS 1. Enumerate various advantages and disadvantages of static control as compared to magnetic relay control. 2. In what way the static control differs as compared to magnetic relay control. 3. List the logic gates used in building control circuits. Draw their symbols and explain their work- ing in brief. 4. Draw the USAI symbols for Relay coil, Relay contact, Time delay relay, and Limit switch, 5. Draw the internal circuitry of AND and OR gate using TTL logic and also explain its working. 6. Discuss solid state timer and its various modifications which are analogous to ON and OFF delay time delay relays. 7. Discuss OFF-return memory. Draw the internal circuitry and explain its working. 8. Explain how RS flip-flop can be built by using NAND gates and NOR gates only. 9. How does a clocked RS flip-flop differ from an ordinary RS flip-flop. What is negative edge trig- gering and positive edge triggering as aplicable to clocked flip-flop. 10. Discuss in detail the working of JK flip-flop. 11. What is Retentive memory ? How is it built ? Draw its symbol and equivalent relay circuit. 12. Enumerate various steps which are useful in designing a control circuit.Develop holding circuit using AND gate, RS flip and using both AND gate and OR gate. 13. What is the necessity of signal converters in static control ? Discuss different types of signal converters. 14. What is a Bounce Eliminator ? Discuss Bounce Eliminator circuit using NOR gates. 15. Discuss the working of a modern output amplifier using a UJT and SCR. 16. Draw schematic arrangement of a solenoid value operated cylinder piston assembly. Discuss the motion of piston between two extreme positions by drawing the control circuit. 17. Explain how the speed of a wound rotor induction motor can be controlled using logic elements. 18. Draw control circuit for Planer machine and discuss its working. 19. Explain working of a shift register using JK flip-flops. 20. If it is desired to build a 10-bit shift register, how many packaged 4 bit shift registers are needed ? Draw a schematic diagram showing all the interconnections between the packages. 21. Explain the action of a BCD-to-decimal decoder. 22. What is the formal name of a mono-shot ? Explain what a mono-shot does. 23. What is the function of clock generator in industrial circuits ? 24. Draw symbols for down-counter and Encoder and explain their working. dharm d:N-MachMac11-2.pm5 290
  • 308. Programmable Logic Controller 12.1 INTRODUCTION The control requirements of industry were served well for many generations by relays, drum switches, mechanical (physical) timers and counter etc. The relay control circuits had a disadvantage that when the control requirements change, relays had to be added or removed and rewiring was required to be done. This was time consuming and tedious process. In extreme cases, such as in Auto industry with the change in the model of the automobile being manufactured, complete panels had to be replaced, since it was not economically feasible to rewire the old panels. Also some control functions required could not be easily achieved using relay circuits. Also the increasing sophistication and complexity of the control systems in industry required more faster acting control elements. The electronic industry responded to this need of the industry and developed modular solid state electronic devices. These devices were faster, had low power consumption and eliminated much of the hand-wiring, but brought with them a new language. The language consisted to AND gates, OR gates, NOR gates, OFF return memory, J-K flip flops, and so on. Static control circuit using logic gates and other solid state devices also had some disadvantages. Although the circuits were faster but reliability was not as expected. Noise signals could cause the control circuit to malfunction. Solid state devices did not work well at high temperatures encountered in industry. Also static control was economically not feasible for small control requirements. Alteration or modification in an existing circuit was not easy. It required the change in copper track connections and addition or removal of solid state devices. Trouble shooting was difficult as compared to the relay circuits. The above mentioned disadvantages and the reluctance of the technicians to learn a new language comprising AND, OR gates etc. and the advent of microprocessor gave industry what is now known as Programmable Logic Controller (PLC). Internally there are still AND gates, OR gates, and so forth in the processor but the design engineers have preprogrammed the PLC so that program can be entered using RELAY LADDER LOGIC. The first PLC was invented in 1969 by Richard Dick E. Morley, who was the founder of the Modicon Corporation. The PLC consists of a programming device (Keyboard), processor unit, power supply and input/output interface. At this point you will wonder, “is PLC a computer ?”. The answer to this is ‘Yes’ PLC is a computer but designed for specific application. There are thus similarities and also some major differences between a PLC and a computer. Some differences between PLC and computer are: 291
  • 309. 292 CONTROL OF MACHINES 1. PLCs are designed to be operated in industrial environment with wide range of ambient temperature, vibration and humidity conditions. It is not effected by the electrical noise present in the industrial environment. 2. In computer, the inputs are floppy drives and CD Roms and output is a printer, but in PLC the inputs are signals from control elements like push-buttons, limit switches, temperature switches, pressure switch and transducer etc., installed on the machines to be controlled. Also the output are final control elements like contactors, solenoids, positioning valves, indication lights, an so forth. 3. The PLC is not a disc based system like PC. With a disc based system there is a continuous checking of what to do next. With a PLC the answer of what to do next is inherent, there is no consulting. The PLC program is stored in battery backed RAM or EPROM. 4. Another important difference between PLC and PC is that the PLC contains the operating systems and application programs in ROM memory. The operating system does not have to load an application program, as it is already in ROM. It is difficult to differentiate between PLCs, ‘BIOS’, operating system and application program. 5. PLCs are designed to be operated in industrial environment with wide range of ambient temperature, vibration and humidity conditions. It is not effected by the electrical noise present in the industrial environment. 6. Another major difference between PLC and computer is the programming language. PLC is not programmed in one of the high language used for programming a computer. As PLC is designed to be operated by plant engineers and maintenance personnel with limited knowledge of computers, it is designed to be programmed using RELAY LADDER LOGIC. However some PLCs are available which can be programmed using FORTRAN and BASIC, but relay ladder logic programming is the most popular. Some PLCs are also programmed using, Boolean Algebra, Satement lists and Control system flow chart languages. 7. Another major difference is that troubleshooting is simplified in most PLCs because they include fault indicators, blown-fuse indicators, input and output status indicator, and written fault information that can be displayed on the programmer. From the above discussion, the programmable logic controller (PLC) can thus be defined as follow: It is a solid state system, with a programmable memory for storing instructions to implement specific functions such as logic, sequencing, timing, counting and arithmetic to control machine and processes. A typical PLC can be divided into five components. These components consist of the processor unit, memory, power supply, input/output section (interface) and the programming device. Some manufacturers refer to the processor as a C.P.U. or central processing unit. The components are shown in Fig. 12.1. The power supply is required to convert 240 volts AC voltage to the low voltage DC required for the logic circuits of the processor and the internal circuits of the input and output modules. DC power for the input and output devices, if required is generally provided from a separate source. dharm d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5 292
  • 310. PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER 293 220 V AC Power supply DC(Low Voltage) Input devices Output devices O I U N M T P Processor P U Limit switch U T T M M O O D D U Memory U L L E E Programming device Printer Fig. 12.1 Components of a programmable logic controller The input module and output modules are referred to a I/O section (I for input and O for output). The real word input devices like push buttons, limit switches, analog sensors are wired to input module and real word output devices like contactors, solenoid valves indicator lights, positioning valves etc., are wired to the output modules. Real word input and output devices are of two types: discrete and analog. Discrete I/O devices are either ON or OFF (open or closed), while analog devices have infinite number of possible values. Examples of discrete input devices are pushbutton and limit switch while analog input device are temperature probes, Pressure transducers etc. which gives varying voltage and current. The input from the analog input device is converted by the analog module called Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) into a proportional binary number and stored in memory of the PLC for further use by the processor. Discrete output devices like contactors, solenoid valve coils, indication lamps are either energised or de-energized, but Analog output devices require varying current or voltage to control the output. Example of analog output device is the positioning valve, which gives variable opening of the valve depending upon the variable voltages/current applied to the valve which is obtained using the Digital-to Analog Converter (DCA) as the output module. The processor unit operates on low DC voltage of 5 volts. Input modules thus contains circuitry that converts input voltages of 120-240 V AC or 0-24 DC, etc., from discrete input devices to low level DC voltage typically 5 V DC. Analog input modules converts the 4-20 millampere signals from sensors to low-level DC voltages for the processor unit. Similarly, the output modules change low level DC signals from the processor to 120-240 AC or low level DC voltages or give output currents in range 4-20 millampere. The programming device for a PLC can be a Hand-held programmer, Dedicated programmer or Personal computer. The program is entered using Relay Ladder Logic, Statement Lists or Control System flow charts but the most popular method of programming is the Relay Ladder logic. dharm d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5 293
  • 311. 294 CONTROL OF MACHINES The hand-held programmer uses either LED (light emitting diode) or LCD (liquid crystal display). The hand-held programmers are small, light weight and convenient to use in the field. They just look like a small calculator with small display windows. The small display capabilities limits its use for reviewing the program and trouble shooting. Dedicated programmers use a standard video display terminal (VDT) and keyboard for entering and displaying the program. Large video screen makes the viewing, and trouble shooting of program easier. They however are even more expensive than the personal computer, as they are designed-to operate in the industrial environment. Personal computers have become the most popular programming device today due to its lower cost and more versatility than the dedicated programmers. A personal computer can be used to program a PLC using a special software installed on it. Some PLCs require only a software to communicate with PC while others require a special hardware communication card also in addition to the software installed on PC. Nowdays these software are windows based and are very user friendly. Using a PC for programming offer other advantages also as number of programs can be stored in the hard disk of the PC and other softwares like spread sheets, word and graphics can also be used. 12.2 INPUT/OUTPUT SECTION The processor in PLC operates at a control voltage of 5 V DC. It is thus essential that input signals to the processor from input devices be of 5 V DC. We however cannot energies the input devices at 5 V DC because, the input devices may be at a appreciable distance from PLC. Thus there would be a voltage drop. Thus input devices are energized generally at higher DC or AC voltage. The input signals from the devices thus are required to be stepped down to 5 V DC. This is accomplished by using input modules. The output devices to be energised like solenoid coils, indicator lights etc. are to be energized generally at 110V/220V A.C. The output signals from processor however will be 5VDC. Thus to interface the processor with output devices, output modules are required. Output modules will convert the low voltage signals from processor to proper voltage level required to energise the output devices. Thus all the different types and levels of signals (voltage and currents) used in the control process are interfaced in the I/O section. The I/O section generally can be divided into two categories; fixed I/O and modular I/O. 12.2.1 Fixed I/O PLCs with fixed I/O come in a complete unit that contains the processor, I/O section and the power supply. The I/O section contains a fixed number of inputs and outputs, all of which have the same voltage level (120V AC, 24V DC, or 230V AC). For example the Allen Bradley SLC 150, PLC shown in the Fig. 12.2 has 10 discrete inputs and 12 discrete outputs of 24 V DC. As mentioned earlier discrete type I/O signals are ON or OFF and do not vary in level. When a limit switch connected to 24 V DC is ON, the signal to the input section will be 24 V and when the switch is open it will be OV. Discrete I/O is sometimes also referred to as Digital I/O as digital signals also have two levels, high and low. Once digital signal is high, its level remains constant and it does not change. An analog type signal on the other hand will vary in magnitude and will be constantly changing based on control variables in the process. A pressure transducer that sends a 20 milliampere signal at 500 psi or a 10 milliampere signal at 250 psi is an example. Many manufacturers offer analog expansion units that can be added to their fixed I/O, PLCs. The cost of PLCs are nowadays so competitive that any control process which uses a small number of relay and timers can now be controlled using a small PLC. Fixed I/O PLCs are dharm d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5 294
  • 312. PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER 295 also referred as “Shoebox” or “brick” by manufacturers due to their shape and size. The SLC 150 PLC shown in Fig. 12.2 also has the provision for adding a analog module. Fig. 12.2 Photographic view of a PLC with fixed input/outputs 12.2.2 Modular I/O In modular type of I/O, different types of module, discrete, analog or special are housed in a Rack or chasis having a number of slots. Each module is inserted in a slot. Rack or chasis come in many size for example 4, 8, 12 slots. Generally the first slot contains the power supply and is numbered 0, the second slot contains the PLC and in the rest of the slots, different types of input and output modules are inserted. The back panel of the I/O rack contain a printed circuit board having connectors for each slot, into which the individual I/O modules are inserted. The proper alignment while the modules are inserted is provided by guides in the slots on both upper lower side. Racks that contain I/O module and the processor are referred to as local I/O. Racks that contain I/O modules, power supplies, remote I/O communication cards and located away from the local I/O are refered to as remote I/O. The number of remote I/O racks that a DC Resident Supply PLC Input Output rack Remote I/O racks Leo Indicators DC DC DC Supply Supply Supply Fig. 12.3 Local Rack with processor and three Remote I/O racks dharm d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5 295
  • 313. 296 CONTROL OF MACHINES processor can control varies with each manufacturer. The communication between the remote rack and the processor is accomplished using several different types of communication methods like co-axial cable, twin axial cable, shielded-twisted pair or by fibre optical cable if distance is more and electrical noise is also a consideration. Fig. 12.3 shows a local rack and three remote I/O racks. An Allen Bradleys modular type of PLC is shown in Fig. 12.4. The first slot contains the power supply, second one contains the SLC 500 PLC, third one contains discrete input module, fourth slot contains discrete output module, fifth and sixth slots contain analog input and analog output module while slot number 8 is empty. Fig. 12.4 Photographic view of Allen Bradleys Modular type PLC and Input/Output modules. Input and output devices connected to input and output modules must have a address so that the processor knows where which input and output device is located. Within each rack individual input and output device connections must have a distinct address. Allen Bradley for example uses the rack number, location of a module in the rack (i.e., slot number) whether input or output device is connected, to determine the device address. Racks normally have jumpers or switches that have to be set or configured in order for rack to communicate with the processor. A common type of switch used for rack configuration is called DIP switch (Dual- in-line package), which are intended for use on printed circuit boards. These switches are either ON or OFF. These switches when set in proper sequence, are used to assign an address to a rack, such as Rack 1, Rack 2. etc. DIP switches are used for other processor functions also. For example a Analog current input module can be configured as Analog voltage input module by changing the DIP switch positions provided on the printed circuit board of the module. DIP switch settings are specified in the installation manual supplied by the PLC manufactures. 12.3 DISCRETE INPUT MODULES Discrete input modules are available in wide range of voltages for various applications. Some more common voltage modules are 120V AC, 240V AC, 24VDC. The cost of a input module depends upon the number of input terminals available for connecting the real word input devices like push-buttons, Limit switches etc. Common sizes available are 8, 16 and 32 point. Nowadays, optically coupled input and output modules are used as they provide isolation of dharm d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5 296
  • 314. PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER 297 processor circuit from the real word input and output devices which may be energized on higher level voltages. 12.3.1 AC Discrete Input Module A typical AC input module for 8 inputs is shown in Fig. 12.5. L1 is the hot terminal of AC supply and L2 is the neutral. L1 L2 Input module 220 V AC Com IN1 IN2 IN3 IN4 IN5 IN6 IN7 IN8 Fig. 12.5 Connection for an 8 input AC discrete input module The enclosure of the input module shown contains a printed circuit board on which eight number of circuits shown in Fig. 12.6 are there for each of the eight individual inputs. Vcc ( + 5V) Input indicator led R (Status light) L1 1KW 100 K Input Vout ( + 5V) device R T1 L2 R2 D Photo transistor Fig. 12.6 Simplified AC input module circuit with indication light for on input terminal The input module has a common connection for the neutral or grounded potential (L2) for AC modules and the negative (–) for DC modules. To wire the input devices to AC input dharm d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5 297
  • 315. 298 CONTROL OF MACHINES module one terminal of all the input devices are connected to hot terminal (L1) of the ac supply and the other terminal of each input device is connected to the input terminal on the module. Resistors are used to drop the incoming voltage, then a bridge rectifier is used to convert the AC input voltage of DC. Next a filtering circuit is used to condition the DC and also to provide a delay in sending the signal forward. The delay is required to safeguard against electrical noise signals generated due to bouncing action of limit switch. When the input device closes, LED emits light which falls on the photo transistor and turns it ON. Turning ON of photo transistors will switch OFF the transistor T1, thus + 5V appears at the Vout terminal of logic circuit, which is communicated to the processor and the information is stored as binary 1 in the memory location assigned for the status of input device. By employing this type of optical coupling, or isolation, there is no actual connection between the input device and the processor. This eliminates any possibility of the 240V input voltage from coming in contact with and damaging the low-volage DC section of the processor. Optical isolation also protects the processor from electrical noise, voltage transients or spikes. Status indication, whether the input device is ON or OFF is provided by another LED used in the optically coupled circuit. All the eight LED for this purpose are provided on the top of the input module (see Fig. 12.6). The status light is lit, when the input device is closed and is OFF when the input device is open. Status lights are very helpful for troubleshooting, as just looking at the status lights, technicians know the status of all input devices. 12.3.2 DC Discrete Input Module A typical DC input module wired to input devices is shown Fig. 12.7(a). + – Com IN1 IN2 Input Devices IN3 IN4 IN5 IN6 IN7 IN8 Fig. 12.7 (a) Connections for a discrete DC input module dharm d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5 298
  • 316. PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER 299 + VCC (+ 5V) 1 KW Input indicator LED 100 KW Vout (Status light) (+ 5V) to PLC R + Limit Switch L E D D R – Photo transistor Fig. 12.7 (b) Simplified circuit for one terminal of a DC discrete input module The enclosure shown in the Fig. 12.7 will contain eight number of electronic circuits as shown in Fig. 12.7(b), which are similar to the circuit shown in Fig. 12.6 except that there is no bridge rectifier required, as the voltage used to energize the input device is DC. 12.4 DISCRETE OUTPUT MODULES Discrete output module can be AC or DC type. Both types are available in a wide range of voltages. The function of discrete output module is to energies the output device such as motor starter coil, pilot lights, solenoids valve etc., connected at its terminal, when the processor places a binary 1 in the memory location assigned for that particular device. The cost of a output module is proportional to the number of terminals provided for connecting output devices. The standard terminals available are 8, 16 and 32. Output module has a continuous current rating for each terminal as well as continuous overall rating for the module. A surge rating is also specified, indicating the maximum current that can be allowed to flow for a specific time. A typical current rating of a 240 V AC output module would be 1 amp maximum, continuous duty with a surge current rating of 3 ampers. The output module are provided with fuse to protect against over current, short circuits and ground faults. The number of fuse used vary with each manufacturer. In some modules only one fuse is provided for all the outputs while in others individual fuses are provided for each output. Some manufacturers do not provide any fuse, so external fuses must be connected. Blown fuse indication is also provided on most PLCs. Some PLCs have only one blown-fuse indicator while others have blown-fuse indicator for each individual output thus simplifying the troubleshooting. Status lights are also provided in the modules to indicate the status of any particular output. Some modules have two status lights for each output point. One is referred to as the logic light, and the other as the output light. When the logic lamp is lit, it indicates that logic to turn on the output device has been sent from the processor. When the output light is on, it indicates that current is actually flowing to the output device. Status lights are thus very important tools in troubleshooting, but it should be ascertained what the status lights indicate. 12.4.1 AC Output Module AC output module standard voltages are 120 V or 240 V as most industrial solenoid valves and starter coils are designed for this voltage. A 8 circuit AC output module for 240 volts is shown in Fig. 12.8. One wire of each output device is connected to the neutral (L2) of the AC supply. dharm d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5 299
  • 317. 300 CONTROL OF MACHINES The other terminals of output devices are connected to the output terminals of the module. The hot wire (L1) of the AC supply is connected to the common terminal available on output module. L1 L2 220V AC COM OUT1 OUT2 M OUT3 B OUT4 OUT5 H OUT6 OUT7 CR OUT8 Fig. 12.8 Connection of output devices to a output module The internal circuit for one terminal of the output module is shown in Fig. 12.9. In a 8-Point module, there will be 8 such type of circuits mounted on a printed circuit board. Either a SCR or a TRIAC is used as the switching device. A circuit using SCR is shown in Fig. 12.9, when a signal from processor appears for energisation of a solenoids coil, the RC potential divider is energized and capacitor will start charging. At a particular value of capacitor voltage, V, T is turned on and capacitor gets discharged through it. A pulse thus gets applied to the primary of a pulse transformer connected to the base of UJT. This pulse is transferred to the secondary side of the transformer and gets applied between gate and cathode of SCR. The SCR will trigger on and will start conducting if its anode is positive with respect to cathode. To achieve current flow through load on both half cycles of ac voltage, a bridge rectifier is used to provide a continuous dc supply to the SCR. Instead of a pulse transformer an optically coupled photo transister can also be used to energies a TRIAC for switching on the supply to output device. + DC logic Input supply from processor R1 R2 SCR 220 V AC UJT CAP Fig. 12.9 Simplified circuit for one terminal of an output module dharm d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5 300
  • 318. PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER 301 12.4.2 DC Output Modules DC output modules are available in ranges from 12-240VDC. Suitable voltage current range has to be selected by the consumer according to the load requirements. The operation of a DC output module is similar to that of an AC module, except that instead of SCR or TRIAC, power transistor will be used to switch on power to the output device. When connecting the output device to the output module, one terminal of all the output devices are connected to the negative of the DC supply and +ve terminal is connected to the common terminal on the module. A typical DC output circuit for each terminal of the output module will be as shown in Fig. 12.10. + DC Fuse Power From transistor processor Output indicator led Photo R LED transistor – DC Load Fig. 12.10 Simplified DC output module circuit The power transister has a quicker switching capability than the SCR and TRIAC used in AC output modules; therefore the response time of DC modules is faster than the AC modules. 12.4.3 Rating of Output Modules Output modules have limited current ratings. Thus, when larger loads are to be energized, a interposing relay is used, which is a standard control relay, having small inrush and continuous current value. The contacts of the control relay are generally rated at 10 amp. The contacts of the relay are used to energise a larger size contactor used for motor starter or heating loads. The connection for energising a large motor using interposing relay is shown in Fig. 12.11. L1 220V AC L2 CR OL M Size 4 contactor 1 CR 2 3 4 Interposing 5 relay 6 7 8 Output module Fig. 12.11 Interposing relay connections dharm d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5 301
  • 319. 302 CONTROL OF MACHINES 12.5 ANALOG I/O MODULES Analog input and output modules are used in process control where variables such as tempera- ture, light intensity, speed, pressure, position and flow measuring instruments etc have to be read and output devices like positioning valves, strip chart recorders, actuators, displays and variable drive systems have to be energized. Most of the todays analog I/O modules are avail- able in three ranges: (1) 0 to 10 volts (DC) also called unipolar (2) –10 to +10 volts (DC), also called bipolar and (3) 4 to 20 milliampers (mA DC), also refered to as current. The last version can, many times be expressed as 1 to 5 volts (DC) with a simple reconfiguration of the module. Input modules are available in configuration of two, four and eight channels. Output modules are available in configuration of four or two channels. Newer analog I/O modules provide the mixing of analog input and output on one module. In analog input module, the analog signal from the sensing device is converted to 8 bit or 16 bit binary values for storage in the PLC processor memory with the help of a analog to digital (ADC) converter. The analog output module changes the 8 bit or 16 bit binary from the PLC memory to analog value using the Digital to Analog (DAC) converter. A typical mixed type of analog I/O module having two input and two output channels is shown in Fig. 12.12. Output status Input status LED LED Output Input Power Power status LED Analog (1) IN 0± (2) IN 0± (3) ANL COM Door label (4) IN 1+ Terminal block (5) IN 1± (6) ANL COM (7) OUT 0 (8) ANL COM Door (9) OUT 1 (10) ANL COM Fig. 12.12 Analog input/output module The module shown contains a openable door exposing the terminal block to provide connection for the analog input and output channels. It is specifically designed to interface with analog current and voltage input signals. The channels can be wired as either single- ended or differential inputs. There are DIP switches on the circuit board of the module for selecting voltage or current input. Analog modules are generally classed by their resolution, which is their ability to convert the analog information to digital form in the case of an input, the reverse for an output. This dharm d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5 302
  • 320. PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER 303 resolution is expressed in bits: for examples 16 bit or 8 bit resolution. It should be clear that higher the resolution, the more accurately an analog value can be represented digitally. Here we have discussed some basic input/output modules for a basic understanding only. Each PLC manufacturer however has a long list of modules they market for common or specialized applications. An example of specialized module is high speed counting and position sensing module, A PLC manufacturer representative should be contacted for a full and complete list of modules that are available. 12.6 SAFETY CIRCUIT PLCs of today are though very rugged and dependable, but where safety is concerned, it is recommended by the manufacturing associations not to solely depend on the solid-state devices or PLC program for removal of power to output devices on emergency stop. It is thus recommended, that a hard-wire emergency Stop push button should de-energies the power to output module. Thus safety circuit as shown in Fig. 12.13 is recommended. A control relay designated as master control relay (MCR) is used to de-energies the output devices when emergency stop push button is pressed. The contact of MCR relay in the neutral will de-energise all the output device on emergency stop and MCR contact in line will de-energise all inputs and power supply to output module. The MCR contact in line is however optional as normally the inputs are kept energized for ease in troubleshooting. Emergency Neutral Line stop fuse Start MCR MCR Optional MCR contact Input module MCR Output module C Fig. 12.13 Safety circuit using physical master control relay 12.7 PROCESSOR UNIT The processor consists of a microprocessor, memory chips, circuits necessary to store and retrieve information from the memory, and communication circuits required for the processor to interface with the programmer, printer and other peripheral devices. Block diagram for Processor unit is shown in Fig. 12.14. Memory of the Processor has been shown divided into subsections for easy understanding. Microprocessor and its associated circuits have been referred to as Central Processing Unit (CPU). dharm d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5 303
  • 321. 304 CONTROL OF MACHINES From input Input image Output image To output module table table module CPU (Memory) (Memory) User program Variable data memory memory Processor Fig. 12.14 Block diagram representation of a processor unit The processor may be part of the self-contained unit housing processor, input and output modules and power supply. A Allen Bradley make SLC 150, is a self-contained PLC (refer Fig. 12.2). The porcessor may be modular in design and plug directly into the I/O rack (refer Fig. 12.3). In the extreme left is the dc power supply. The processor is inserted into the first slot of the rack. The Fig. 12.3 shows a SLC 5/02 CPU in the first slot. In other slots modular input and output modules are installed. This whole assembly of power supply, processor and input/output module comprise the programmable logic controller. The processor is the brain of programmable logic controller. It is the decision maker and controls the operation of the machine to which it is connected. The processor controls the output devices connected to output modules based on the status of the input devices and the program that has been entered into the PLC memory. The processor is also referred to as central processing unit or CPU by some authors. Here the sub-section of the processor which actually performs program execution is called CPU. The microprocessor used in the processor depends upon the number of inputs to be monitored and number of outputs to be controlled. Larger the number of inputs and outputs, and more complicated the control functions to be performed, the more powerful the microprocessor required. Various functions of micro processor are: 1. Monitors the status (ON or OFF) of the input devices. 2. Solves the logic of the user program stored in the memory. 3. Controls the output devices (ON or OFF) based on status of input devices and user program. 4. Communicates with other devices like hand held programmer, personal computers etc. 5. Manages memory and update timers, counters and internal registers. When the micro processor executes the above task in sequence given above it is called the processor scan. When a PLC is powered up, the processor runs an internal self-diagnostic or self-check, prior to entering the mode, it was left in, when power was last shut down. During the diagnostic test, if it is detected that any part of processor is not functioning such as faulty memory, improper communication with I/O section etc., then a message is displayed on the display window of Hand-held programmer or VDT screen of programming terminal. dharm d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5 304
  • 322. PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER 305 PLC can be put in various modes of operation. Some typical PLC modes of operation are: 1. CLEAR program memory Mode 2. PROGRAMMING Mode 3. RUN Mode 4. TESTING program mode 5. DIAGNOSTIC test mode 6. Enter/Change Access Code. When PLC is put in CLEAR memory mode, the user program stored in PLC memory can be cleard. Now all the memory is free for entering a new program. A new program can now be entered by bringing the PLC into PROGRAMMING mode and then program instructions are entered one by one in sequence. After entering the program, the program execution can be checked by putting PLC in TEST program mode. In test mode, PLC executes the user program but does not energise the outputs, only LED displays for outputs are energised. Thus program working can be checked without actually energising the outputs. This avoids a prospective damage to machinery on account of incorrect program. The machine can be run continuously by bringing the PLC in RUN mode. In RUN mode, the PLC first reads the status of input devices and store them in the memory. Then it executes the user program instructions one by one and if any outputs are to be energized, the memory location for that output device is updated by storing binary 1 at that memory location. When whole of the program is executed, the output devices are energised. After this the PLC will communicate with any connected devices like hand-held programmer, personal computer, and will also perform any necessary memory management (housekeeping). Memory management will include updating timers, counters and internal registers etc. This four-step process called processor scan is repeated over and over. The scan time of PLC is in milliseconds. The scan time can vary from a fraction of a millisecond to 100+ milliseconds depending upon the size of the program. Each manufacturer lists the scan time based on the use of 1K (1024 words) of program memory. A typical scan time is 3-5 msecs per 1K (1024 words) of memory used. A typical processor scan is shown in Fig. 12.15. Communication and housekeeping 1 Input scan 4 2 3 Program Output scan execution Fig. 12.15 Typical processor scan It must be noted that output devices are energized all together during the output scan rather than energizing them while the program is being executed. This is because, in general the load devices themselves are hopelessly slow compared to the scan cycle of the PLC. For example a real solenoid might require 30 to 50 milliseconds to get magnetically flushed and pull in its armature. This much time is enough for the PLC to scan its whole cycle several times. Thus, if during program scan, a solenoid is to be energized the signal has to be sent to dharm d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5 305
  • 323. 306 CONTROL OF MACHINES the above said duration and program execution is halted. Thus under these circumstances, instead of delaying the program execution, the outputs are energized together in output scan after the whole of program is executed. Waiting for the output scan to energies outputs is soon enough in most of the industrial control applications. In some rare applications, it may be necessary to energies an output immediately during user-program execution. To facilitate this, advanced PLCs have a instruction called immediate output instruction. This instruction temporarily suspends the normal business of the program, and energise the required output device. After the energisation of the output device, the normal execution of the user program is restored. This type of processor scan is shown in Fig. 12.16. Input scan Output module Immediate output One output One location energised instruction in output Transfer to image table output module changed Return to normal program execution Fig. 12.16 Processor scan with a immediate output instruction Similarly advanced PLCs also provide a special instruction called immediate input instruction, which can be used to update the status of a particular input device in the input image table, during the execution of the user program, just prior to the user program instruction which uses the status of that input. The use of this instruction is necessitated in a control situation, where it really matters if the input has changed during the few milliseconds that may have elapsed between the last input scan and the point in the user program, where the critical instruction is encountered. The input immediate capability during a processor scan is shown in the Fig. 12.17. Input scan Input module Immediate One input Output input read scan instruction One location in input image Transfer table to input Interrupt image table program execution to read one input Return to normal program execution Fig. 12.17 Processor scan with a immediate input instruction dharm d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5 306
  • 324. PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER 307 12.7.1 Internal Self Diagnostic System During normal operation, the processor scan is completed and started again in an orderly predictable cycle. The processor should not stuck while scanning the user-program or for some other reason is unable to complete the current scan. Being unable to complete the scan means that the processor has no control over the real-word outputs. Real word outputs without control might be left running when they were to be stopped. This could spell disaster. A watch dog timer is used to insure that the processor complete each scan in a timely manner. The watchdog timer is preset to an amount of time that is slightly longer than the scan time would be under normal conditions. At the start of each scan, the watch dog timer is turned ON and starts to accumulate time. If the program is correct, the program scan will be complete prior to the time set on the watchdog timer, and at the end of each scan, the watch dog timer is reset to 0 (zero). If for some reason the program scan is not completed in the allotted time, indicating that there is a problem with the program, the watchdog timer will time out, which puts the processor into a faulted condition and all outputs will be turned OFF. The range of the timer is software selectable (adjustable) on many PLCs. A program that faults due to watchdog timer timing out may have become caught in an endless loop within the porgram. This could be the result of programming problems such as the use of too many uncontrolled backward jumps where there is no defined jump out of the loop. Using subroutines where too much time is spent within one or multiple subroutines, could also result in the program scan time exceeding the watchdog timer time value. In some instance, lengthening the watchdog timer preset value can solve the problem. In addition to the scan time problem detected by watchdog timer, other processor errors that are detected by the internal diagnostic system are: processor hardware problem, processor memory problem, communication problem, expansion unit problem, EEPROM module problem. The problems related to programmer and programming are also detected by the internal diagnostic system which are as follows. Incomplete rung (no output instruction), invalid address for instruction, user memory exceeded, branch error (short circuit), branch error (incomplete branch), invalid access code (password). 12.7.2 Memory Types Memory types will be discussed here in a generalized way for basic understanding. Memory chips used in the processor can be separated into two distinct groups: volatile and non volatile. A volatile memory is one that loses its stored information when power is removed. Even momentary loss of power erases any information stored or programmed on a volatile memory chip. A non volatile memory has the ability to retain stored information when power is removed accidentlly or intentionally. The most common type of volatile memory is Random Access Memory (RAM) also refered to as read/write memory, as information can be written into, or read from this memory. Random access means, any memory location can be accessed or used easily. RAM is used for both, as user memory for storing the program and as storage memory for storing of status of input and outputs and other data required for execution of the program. As RAM is volatile, it must be backed up with a battery to retain or protect the stored program. Various forms of RAM are MOS, HMOS and CMOS-RAM (complimentary Metal Oxide Semiconductor) is one of the most popular type of RAM. CMOS-RAM is popular as it has a very low current drain when not being accessed (15 micro amperes) and the information stored in memory can be retained by as little as 2V DC. Back-up power for CMOS-RAM is provided by a replaceable battery assembly. The lithium battery provides back-up power for approximately 2-3 years. However in the absence of battery, there is a provision of a standard back-up power provided by a capacitor which can hold or protect the program for 1-2 weeks. dharm d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5 307
  • 325. 308 CONTROL OF MACHINES Non-volatile memories are memories that retain their information or program when power is lost, and they do not require battery backup. A common type of non-volatile memory is Read Only Memory (ROM). Read only means that information can be written only once and subsequently, that information can only be read but cannot be changed. In PLC processor, the ROM used contains the program for internal use, of the PLC. It is this program, which makes the PLC different from the ordinary personal computer. This programme cannot be changed. ROM chips can however be changed to upgrade the PLC. Other types of non-volatile memory are PROM, UVPROM, EPROM, EAROM and EEPROM. EEPROM i.e. Electrically Erasable Programmable Read only Memory is also used with PLC to upload program from the RAM of PLC or for loading a program into the PLC. A special Pin Socket is available on the PLC for the EEPROM module. EEPROM is thus used as a nonvolatile backup for the user program RAM. If the user program in RAM is lost or erased a copy of the program stored on an EEPROM, chip can be downloaded into RAM. It is common in some PLCs for the processor to load the program from EEPROM chip into RAM memory each time the processor is powered up or after a power failure. EEPROM is a chip that can be programmed using a standard programming device and can be erased by the proper signal being applied to the erase pin. Memory in PLC can be subdivided into sub-section for easy understanding. The subsections are input image table, output image table, user-program memory and variable data memory (refer block diagram for processor unit Fig. 12.14). 12.7.3 Input Image Table It is a portion of the processor memory, where the status of input devices whether open or close is stored. Every single input terminal of a input module is assigned a particular location (address) in the portion of memory called input image table. This particular location is dedicated solely to the task of keeping track of the latest condition of its input terminal. If a particular input terminal has 220 volts fed to it, due to closing of input device connected to it, a binary (01) is stored in that memory location allotted to that particular input module. If there is no voltage at the input terminal then binary (0) is stored in that particular location. Thus only one bit is required to store the status of discrete inputs. In case the input module is a analog module then the memory assigned to each input is 8 bits or 16 bits depending upon the PLC. The memory locations in the input image table thus store the image of the input devices, that is why it is named as input image table. The image of status of input devices is created in the input image table before the processor starts executing the user program, as the status of input devices are the deciding factors in the execution of user program. 12.7.4 Output Image Table This is another portion of the processor memory, where the each output terminal of the output module is assigned a particular memory location (address). When the processor executes the user program and a particular output is required to be energized a binary (1) is stored in the memory location alloted to that particular output. Thus when the user program execution is complete the output image table updating is also complete. Now all the outputs which have binary (1) stored in their assigned memory locations are energized simultaneously after the last instruction of user-program is executed. This period of the processor cycle in which outputs are energized is called the output scan. It may be noted that the processor can write to and also read from the output image table as the status of any output being energized may affect the user program in subsequent instructions of user program. However, the processor only reads from the input image table during the execution of the user program. dharm d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5 308
  • 326. PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER 309 12.7.5 User Program Memory This is the portion of the processor memory which is used for storing the program in the form of coded instruction which represents the logic of the functions to be carried out. This programming is done through a key board and the program can be seen on a VDU (Visual Display Unit). As the instructions are entered through a key board, they are automatically stored as sequential location within the user-program memory. The total number of instructions can range from a dozen or so, for controlling a simple machine, to several hundreds, for controlling a complex machine or a process. Central processing unit executes the User-program instructions step by step. During execution, if the instruction execution calls for a change at any of the output image table locations, it immediately updates the output image table. The CPU executes subsequent instructions by taking into account the output conditions, since these often effect later instructions in the program. It thus becomes clear that the output image table has two functions. Its first function is to receive immediate information from the CPU and pass it on to the output module. The second function is to pass on information backwards to the CPU when any instruction calls for the state (high or low) of a particular output, for its execution. On the other hand, the input image table has only to acquire information from the input module of I/O section and pass on that information to CPU when the instruction execution calls for any input information. The dual nature of information flow for the output image table is shown by an arrow in the block diagram in Fig. 12.14. 12.7.6 Variable Data Memory User program instruction can have time settings, counter settings, numeric comparison instruction (greater than, less than etc.). These types of instructions will require storage of data like setting of timers, counters, down counters, etc. The memory which keeps track of these variable data is called variable-data memory. There are five types of numeric data that can be present in the variable-data memory. • Preset value of a timer—This is the number of seconds for which the timer must remain energized. • Instant value of a timer—This is the number of seconds that elapses after the timer is energized. • Preset value of a counter—This is the number that an Up counter must count or the starting number from which the Down counter starts counting down. • Instant value of a counter—This is the number of counts recorded by an Up counter or the number of counts remaining for the Down-counter. • Value of a physical variable in the controlled process—This value can be temperature, pressure, flow etc. Such a value is obtained by making measurement with the help of a transducer and converting the transducer’s analog output voltage into digital form using Analog to Digital (ADC) converter. When the CPU is executing an instruction for which a certain data must be known, it fetches that data from the variable data memory. Also, when CPU executes an instruction which produces a numeric value, it is stored in the variable data memory. This two way flow of information is shown by arrows in the block diagram of Fig. 12.14. dharm d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5 309
  • 327. 310 CONTROL OF MACHINES 12.8 PROGRAMMING DEVICE Programming device is the control console for the PLC. PLC is operated in different modes like Programming mode, Run mode, Test mode etc., through the programming device. It is through the programming device, that a program is entered into the PLC memory. Editing and troubleshooting of an existing program in PLC memory is also done through programming device. Once the program has been entered into the PLC memory and PLC is brought into Run mode, the programming device may be disconnected. It is not necessary for the programming device to be connected for the PLC to operate, but it can be used to monitor the PLC program while the program is running. Programming device or also called programmer can be of Hand held type, Dedicated desktop type or a computer can be used as programming device. Each of the above type of programmer has its own advantages and disadvantages. 12.8.1 Dedicated Desktop Programmers A typical dedicated programmer consists of a keyboard, VDT (Video display terminal) and necessary electronic circuits and memory for developing, editing and loading program into the PLC processor memory. In appearance, the dedicated programmers resembles the personal computer but not in their capabilities. They are not capable of computer functions like running software programs for word processing and spreadsheets. They are however rugged in construction and can withstand the mechanical shock associated with moving the programmer from machine to machine. They can function in the industrial environment under high humidity, high temperature, dust dirt and electromagnetic interference. The keyboard of the dedicated programmer can be like the keyboard of a computer with raised keys or have sealed touchpad type keyboard suited for the industrial environment. Most dedicated programmer keyboards have electrical symbol keys for normally open normally closed contacts, timer contacts, output symbol, Relay, timer, counter etc. These dedicated keys pertaining to ladder logic program development make programming easier for the technician who are not much familiar with computers. The keyboard also has special function keys that are used for program development and numeric and alpha keys for addressing and labeling the program. Video display terminals can have screen sizes from 5 to 12 inches, measured diagonally. They are also referred to as CRTs (Cathode ray tubes). When the PLC is put in program mode; and program is entered through the programmer keyboard, the program appears on the VDTs screen as it is entered. The video screen allows to display multiple lines or rungs of the program. This makes the entering and editing of program easy. After the completion of program, it is down loaded from the programmer memory to PLC processor memory. Once the program has been into user memory the PLC is placed in the RUN mode, and thus the program is activated. The programmers VDT now gives the visual display of the program execution. The program instructions which are true are highlighted either by making them brighter of by using reverse video. No matter which method is used this feature of dedicated desktop programmer is a powerful troubleshooting aid. The above discussed advantages of dedicated desktop programmer are however obtained at a relative high cost. The other disadvantage is that limited models of PLC can be programmed with a particular programmer. It also has limited documentation and graphic capabilities. The physical size of the programmer makes it unsuitable for portability; which is very much required in an industry as PLCs installed on various machines are supposed to be programmed using a single programmer. dharm d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5 310
  • 328. PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER 311 12.8.2 Hand-held Programmers Hand-held programmers resemble a calculator in appearance and is only a slightly bigger. A Hand-held programmer for Allen Bradleys SLC is shown in Fig. 12.18. Hand-held programmers are thus smaller, cheaper, and more portable than dedicated desktop programmer. They are most suitable for installations, where control functions have to be changed frequently. It is also much easier to connect the hand- held programmer to the processor for changing program parameters or for troubleshooting than to bring the heavier desktop programmer. The main limitation of the hand held programmer is that, it has a limited display capability. Some hand-held programmer display a Rung of logic with up to four horizontal line, while others display only one line and some do not display any rung at all. The location of cursor in the program in such a programmer is made out from the LED glow for the type of instruction and liquid crystal display of its address and Rung number. The hand- held programmer takes more time to go through the program one contact or one rung at a time and also more keystones are required to enter the program. Fewer functions are possible and it works with only specific PLC model. It has limited access to Fig. 12.18 A hand held memory and also has limited or no documentation capabilities. programmer 12.8.3 Computer Programmers A PLC can be programmed using a Personal Computer with the help of a special programming software loaded on the PC and a special card installed on the PC for communicating between PLC and PC. However some PLCs may not require communication card to communicate with PC. PLC programming software have been developed by PLC manufactureres themselves and also by other companies. The software’s developed by a company other than the manufacturer of PLC are referred as “third party software”. With softwares available for all major brands of PLCs, the personal computer has now become the most common programming device. These software programs can generally be used with most personal computers in either DOS or Window environment. For example Rockwell Automation, has developed a windows based program called RS logix 500 which can be used to program the Allen Bradleys PLC-5, SLC 500 and Micrologic 1000 and 1500 PLCs. Fig. 12.19 shows a PC with RS logix 500 program installed. Programming using a Personal Computer provide many of the advantages of the dedicated desk-top programmer, but also provides features not available on most dedicated desktop programmers. The personal computer usually has a colour monitor (VDT), and the monitor shows multiple rungs of program logic, as well as highlighting the circuit elements to indicate status, just like the dedicated desktop programmer. When the program is first developed, it is done in the program mode or also called off line mode. Off line mode means program is being developed in the RAM of the computer memory and it has not yet been loaded into the processor memory. Once the program is developed it is downloaded into the processor memory for testing and verification. For testing, the PLC is put in test mode, in which the dharm d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5 311
  • 329. 312 CONTROL OF MACHINES Fig. 12.19 Programming software on personal computer program is executed but the output devices are not energized. After verifying the proper functioning of program, the PLC is put in RUN mode. If any changes to the program is done while PLC is in RUN mode, it is called ON-line programming. Making changes to the program while the program is running and the driven equipment is operational (ON line programming) must only be done by trained personnel who not only understand the PLC program, but also thoroughly understand the driven machinery or process. To prevent unauthorized access to the software, most of the softwares requires activation key, when the software is turned on. Activation key can be in the form of a hardware key, which is usually connected to one of the printer ports or it can also be in the form of a floppy disk or a password may be required when the software is first started. Some manufactures however do no copy-protect their software and encourage copying and widespread use of their software. 12.8.4 Advantages of Using Personal Computers for Programming 1. The foremost advantage of using personal computer for programming is that the program can be stored in its hard disc or in a floppy disc. If the program in PLC processor memory is lost due to any reason, the program can be restored easily from the hard disc or floppy disc of personal computer. 2. PLC programming software for personal computers provide more documentation capabilities than desktop programmers. Graphic capabilities of the software, provide for developing a flow diagram of the controlled equipment or process, and provide operator alarms and messages from the process information. 3. The software updating can be easily accomplished by loading the new software into the computer hard disk through floppy/CD disk drive. On the other hand a Dedi- cated desktop programmer requires changes in ROM chips to accomplish updates. 4. The computer has the added ability to interface the PLC software program with other software programs for “cut and paste” program development and editing. 5. PLC programming software used on personal computer have the feature of being able to display Rungs of logic in any order that may be helpful for troubleshooting. This feature though also available on few dedicated programmers but is a standard feature on all computer based software’s. 6. Computer provides more flexibility and networking capabilities than the Dedicated Programmers for networking multiple PLCs. dharm d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5 312
  • 330. PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER 313 7. Availability of small laptop computers provide an added flexibility in the use of com- puter for programming PLCs. 8. Low cost when compared to dedicated desktop programming. 12.8.5 Disadvantages of Using Personal Computer for Programming a PLC 1. The programming learning curve for programming using a computer based software is longer than the Dedicated programmer programming, as the keys using control component symbols are not used as in the case of a Dedicated programmer keyboard. 2. The computer is not designed for the industrial environment. It is affected by electri- cal noise, high temperature and humidity conditions in the industrial environment. To overcome the shortcoming of personal computer in its use in the industrial environment has led to the development of Industrial-rated computer programmers. It is a mix of the Dedicated programmer and the personal computer. Allen Bradley, Siemens, Modicon and GE-Fanuc are several of the companies that offer these highbred programmers. This type of programmer, however, is more expensive than the Dedicated desktop programmer or a personal computer, but one gets the best features of both. 12.9 FUNDAMENTAL PLC PROGRAMMING 12.9.1 Introduction The fundamental level, ladder logic programs for PLC are very similar to the relay control circuits, we have studied in this book. In this book, we have drawn the relay control circuits between two horizontal lines representing a phase and neutral of the control supply. If the same control diagram is drawn between two vertical lines, it is called ladder logic diagram, as the two vertical lines representing phase and neutral resemble two poles of a ladder and the control circuits drawn between the two vertical lines resemble the rungs of a ladder. A control circuit for starting two motors in a sequence is shown drawn in two different types of control circuit representation Line Line Neutral Stop A2 B1 Rung 1 A Motor 1 OL1 OL2 contactor (Overload relay A1 A2 contacts) Start Rung 2 B Motor 2 A2 contactor OL1 B1 OL2 Rung 3 Indication lamp A B N (a) (b) Fig. 12.20 Logic of sequence starting of two motors using relay ladder logic diagram Ladder logic diagram is a graphical language that is based on relay ladder logic and is the most widely used language to program the current generation PLCs. The first PLC was programmed with ladder logic. This decision to use the relay logic was a strategic one. This eliminated the need to teach the electricians, technician and engineers dharm d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5 313
  • 331. 314 CONTROL OF MACHINES how to program. The ability of PLCs to accept programming in ladder diagram format is one of the reasons for the success of PLCs in industry. The many similarities between the ladder diagrams used to program PLCs and the relay ladder logic used to control industrial systems, eased the transition from hardwired relay system to PLC based systems for many people in the electrical industry. Also the ability to monitor PLC logic in ladder diagram format also made troubelshooting easier for those already familiar with relay based control systems. Although there are many higher-level languages now available for PLC programming, the majority of systems are still programmed in ladder diagram format because of these advantages. Ladder logic diagram is quite flexible and it is best used for • Boolean operations • Computer logical operations • Message and communication processing • Interlocks • Troubleshoot a machine and process When a PLC is to be used primarily to replace relays, timers and counters, it’s hard to beat the simplicity and usefulness to ladder diagram programming. However it has a number of deficiencies also. The basic ladder diagram instructions are fine for performing many simple tasks, but sometimes things get more complicated for example when a shift register, stack is to be programmed. Although these complex tasks can be programmed with combinations of the standard ladder logic instructions but PLC manufacturers have used function blocks to make programming some of the more common tasks easier. Many PLC manufacturers have now converted timing, counting and arithmetic instructions to the more use-friendly functions in the block format. Function block diagram is another form of graphical language. The main concept is that the data flow start from inputs and passes in block(s) and generate output. Thus the program elements appear (i.e., reusable software elements) as Functions blocks, which are connected together with lines that represent wires in a way, that look much like a circuit diagram. The ladder logic diagram shown in Fig. 12.21 shows the use of a function block. Switch T ON IN 1 Timer ON Timer T1 DN Time Base 1.0 Preset 5 EN Accum 0 T1 OUT 1 TT Indicator lamp Fig. 12.21 PLC program using a function block RS logix 500 a software for programming of Allen Bradly PLC-5, SLC 500 and micrologix family of PLSs use the combine of ladder logic and function block as the programming language. dharm d:N-MachMac12-1.pm5 314
  • 332. PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER 315 12.9.2 Physical Components Versus Program Components One of the most difficult concepts to grasp while learning PLC programming is the difference between physical components and program components. The physical components like switches, push-buttons, pressure switches, relays, solenoids are connected to the input/output terminals of the PLC. When the PLC is programmed, then the physical components connected to PLC are programmed as program components. The program component corresponding to a physical components will not have the same symbol as the physical component but will have the same name. All input physical components which have only two positions ON or OFF are represented by normally open and normally closed contacts. Similarly all output devices are represented by one symbol i.e., a relay or output symbol. The logic for the control is built using the internal program components like relays, latch relays, timers, counters, sequences and shift registers etc. It should be understood here that there are no such physical components in the PLC but the microprocessor simulates the function of a physical component which is programmed as a program component in the program. Now, we take a simple relay circuit having two pushbuttons PB1 and PB2 connected in series to operate a lamp. The circuit is shown in Fig. 12.22. Line Push buttons Neutral PB1 PB2 Rung 1 Indication lamp Fig. 12.22 A simple relay circuit using two pushbuttons When we convert this circuit to run through PLC, we will remove the components from the circuit and wire them to the PLC as shown in Fig. 12.23. Line Neutral Line Neutral 220V AC PLC 220V AC COM COM IN1 OUT1 IN2 OUT2 IN3 OUT3 IN4 OUT4 IN5 OUT5 IN6 OUT6 IN7 OUT7 IN8 OUT8 Fig. 12.23 Wiring of push buttons and indication lamp to input and output module One major difference in this circuit is that the two switches are no longer wired in series. Instead, each one is wired to a separate input on the PLC. By providing each push button as a separate input to PLC, we gain the maximum amount of flexibility i.e., we can program them in any fashion in the ladder logic program. dharm d:N-MachMac12-2.pm5 315
  • 333. 316 CONTROL OF MACHINES Now we will see, how the logic is programmed in the PLC to get the same operation as is obtained by the hard wire circuit shown in Fig. 12.22. The push-buttons in the program will be designated by the input addresses to which they are connected on the PLC. The output in the program will be designated by the output address to which the output (indication lamp) is connected. Since push-button PB1 is connected to input address IN1, it will be designated as IN1 in the program and will be represented by a normally open contact. Likewise push-buttons PB2 will be designated IN2 in the program. Indication lamp will be represented in the program by the output symbol ( ) and will be designated by OUT1, i.e., the output address to which it is connected. The program to control lamp is shown in the Fig. 12.24. PB1 PB2 Indication IN 1 IN 2 OUT 1 Rung 1 Fig. 12.24 PLC program for a simple control circuit There is a provision in the PLC software to label the Program component with symbol (PB1) and discription as Push-button as shown in Fig. 12.24. All input devices are represented by the same programming instruction i.e., (Examine ON instruction), if they are wired with normally open contact. After entering the program of Fig. 12.24 into PLC, when the PLC is put in RUN mode, the PLC will first update the input image table (a portion of memory) by storing the values of the inputs on terminals IN1 and IN2 (it stores a 1 if an input is ON and a 0 if it is OFF). Then it solves the ladder diagram accordingly based on the contents of the input image table. For this program if there is supply at IN1 and IN2, then both instructions IN1 and IN2 are true and the output instruction will be made true i.e., address allotted to OUT 1, in the output image table is made true (1 is stored at OUT 1 location in output image table). Note : it does not turn on the output terminal yet ! When PLC has scanned the entire program, it performs another update. This update transfers the contents of the output image table to the output terminals. This brings supply of 220 V at terminal OUT1, which turns on the lamp. This whole cycle is repeated again and again. For a simple circuit like the one we have discussed, it would be very uneconomical to implement this circuit on PLC. However, for extensive circuits requiring a lot of relays and timers, PLC can economise not only on wiring but on the complexity and cost of external components. In the previous section, we discussed how physical control components connected to the input and output terminals of PLC are represented by various symbols in the programme. Now, we will study some of the the basic instructions, for writing the ladder logic program. 12.9.3 Examine ON Instruction This instruction is represented by the symbol of a normally open contact -| |-. This instruction in a program instructs the processor to examine supply at the input address designated on the instruction. If there is supply at the designated address the instruction is read as true otherwise as false. dharm d:N-MachMac12-2.pm5 316
  • 334. PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER 317 12.9.4 Examine OFF Instruction This instruction is represented by the symbol of a normally closed contact – –. This instruction |/| in a program instructs the processors to examine the supply at the designated address and if there is no supply, the instruction is read as true. If there is supply at the designated address the instruction is read as false. 12.9.5 Internal Relay Instruction Most important and a valuable programming instruction in a PLC is the internal relay. Internal relays are general purpose relays which can have any number of normally open and normally closed contacts for use in the program. It must be understood that they are not “real” relays in a physical sense, but instead are a digital bit of memory in an internal image register. For programming, a relay is represented by a symbol consisting of two paranthesis–( )- and a designator address, which corresponds to internal memory address allotted to this relay. The relay contacts are represented by normally open and normally closed contacts having the same address as that of the relay coil (– –, – –). || |/| All PLCs provide this programming instruction, however the internal addressing scheme and the maximum number of relays that can be used in a program depends on the PLC brand and model. Therefore the programmer must refer to the technical manual for the PLC in order to determine how to reference them in a program and the maximum allowable number that is available. In some PLC brands, the internal relays are also reffered to a Flag or bit. NOTE: The same symbols of normally open contact (– –) and normally closed contact || (– –) are used for Examine ON and Examine OFF instruction and also for the contacts of a |/| internal relay. The golden rule to differentiate whether the normally open or normally closed contact in a program represents a Examine ON or Examine OFF instruction is to see its address. If the contacts bears the address of a input terminal of PLC, they are Examine ON or OFF instruction and if the address is of a relay, they are the contacts of that particular relay. The internal relay instruction allows the programmer to perform more complex internal operations without needlessly using costly output relay. In the programming examples in this text all internal relays will be designated with a “CR” prefix followed by a number i.e., CR1, CR2 etc. 12.9.6 Latching Instruction Latch and Unlatch instructions like their physical real-world counterparts are retentive during a power failure. When the PLC processor loses power or is switched to either the TEST or PROGRAM modes, or detects a major fault, outputs are turned OFF. However the state of latch instruction is retained in memory. Latch and unlatch instruction can be used as an internal relay, if the address designated to this instruction is of the relay. If the Latch instruction is designated with an output terminal address, then the supply at that particular address is latched. When the supply to processor is restored after a power failure or processor is brought back to RUN mode after switching out to TEST or PROGRAM mode, the supply at the latched output terminal will be restored automatically. The symbol for programming a Latch and Unlatch coil is same as ordinary coil with letter L and U inserted between the parentheses. -(L)-, -(U)- dharm d:N-MachMac12-2.pm5 317
  • 335. 318 CONTROL OF MACHINES 12.9.7 Output Instruction Output instruction is used to program the real word physical control components connected to the output terminal of the PLC. Irrespective of the type of physical output component connected, the output instruction is programmed by a symbol consisting of two parentheses and designated by the address of the output terminal at which the physical output is connected. The information of a particular output whether it is energized or not can be used in the subsequent rungs of the ladder program by using normally open or normally closed contacts having the same address as that of the output. 12.9.8 Programming Stop Push-buttons Now we discuss the programming of a simple program for the direct on line starting of a motor as shown in Fig. 12.25(a). In the early days of programmable controllers it was common for the L N Stop Start 1 M M1 (a) Line Neutral Line Neutral 220V AC Inputs PLC Outputs 220V AC Start COM COM IN1 OUT1 M Stop IN2 OUT2 IN3 OUT3 (b) IN 2 IN 1 OUT 1 Rung 1 OUT 1 (c) Fig. 12.25 (a) Standard STOP/START circuit (b) Wiring of input and output devices (c) PLC programmed STOP/START circuit dharm d:N-MachMac12-2.pm5 318
  • 336. PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER 319 salespeople to use a demonstrator model that had the STOP push button wired normally open (N.O) to the input terminal of the PLC as shown in the Fig. 12.25(b). This resulted in the program very similar to the actual wiring circuit of the Start Stop circuit as shown in Fig. 12.25(c). By using a normally open contact of STOP push-button, the Examine OFF instruction is true as normally there will be no supply at terminal IN1 and the circuit will energies when start push-button is pressed. The output OUT 1 will hold due to relay contact instruction having address OUT1 getting true once OUT1 is energized. The only way to de- energies the output now is to push the STOP button. This will make the Examine OFF instruction IN1 false and the output OUT1 will be de-energized. While this circuit will work, there is a built in danger that must be considered. If a STOP button is wired in a normally open (NO) position, and a wire opens from the terminal of the STOP button, it will be impossible to de-energise the circuit. With the wire broken, change in the status of the STOP button cannot be conveyed to the processor and the circuit or equipment cannot be de-energised. The desirable way to connect a STOP button is as shown in Fig. 12.26(a) by using the normally close contact of the pushbutton. The program now will be as shown in Fig. 12.26(b). We will have to program a Examine ON instruction for STOP push-button. L N L N 220V START COM COM IN1 OUT1 M IN2 OUT2 STOP IN3 OUT3 IN4 OUT4 IN5 IN6 IN7 IN8 (a) IN1 IN2 OUT2 Rung 1 OUT1 (b) Fig. 12.26 (a) Desirable input device connections (b) Resulting program dharm d:N-MachMac12-2.pm5 319
  • 337. 320 CONTROL OF MACHINES Note: For safety reasons, all STOP buttons must be wired so that a failure of the switch or a broken wire will automatically break logic continuity and turn the circuit OFF. A good programmer should always wire the devices and program the circuit so that if the real-world device fail, it creates a safe condition, not a safety hazard. 12.9.9 Logical Holding Instructions Versus Discrete Holding Contacts In the stop, start program for motor discussed in the previous section, we have used the address of the output for the holding instruction across the start instruction. The output instruction will be held true once it is turned true due to start instruction getting true but there is no guarantee however that the actual motor starter connected to the output module has been energized. The only way to guarantee, that the actual motor contactor has energized is to actually wire the holding contacts of the motor starter to an input module point, and use that address when programming the holding contacts. This is shown in Fig. 12.27. L N L N 220V Inputs Outputs 220V COM PLC COM OL IN1 OUT1 M IN2 M1 IN3 (a) IN1 IN2 OUT1 IN3 (b) Fig. 12.27 (a) Use of discrete holding contact. (b) Program using discrete holding contact 12.9.10 Overload Contacts It is common practice to wire the overload contact, in series with the contactor coil as shown in Fig. 12.27(a). When the over load contact opens, it will de-energies the motor contactor M. The holding contact M1, connected to the input module and programmed in the PLC program as IN3 will break logic, which turn off the supply at OUT1, where the contactor coil is connected. This type of overload only works, if the holding contacts are wired to an input module and programmed into the PLC program. dharm d:N-MachMac12-2.pm5 320
  • 338. PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER 321 If the holding contact is not wired to an input module but instead the output address is used for holding logic, then the tripping of overload relay will de-energise the contactor coil but PLC program logic is not broken and output address supply will remain ON. This can cause a safety hazard, that the motor will start automatically if the overload is reset. This type of wiring can also cause problems in sequential motor circuit or other automated circuits. If the address of the output is used for logic continuity (holding circuit), then the actual overload contacts must be wired to an input module and referenced in the PLC program as shown in Fig. 12.28. L N L N 220V Inputs Outputs 220V COM PLC COM Start IN1 OUT1 M Stop IN2 OL IN3 IN1 IN2 IN3 OUT1 OUT1 Fig. 12.28 Wiring of overload contact to an input module Wiring of overload contact to input module has an added advantage in troubleshooting. As any address used in PLC program can be viewed for its ON or OFF status by viewing the LEDs meant for them or on the PLC or the input module. 12.9.11 Master Control Relay Instruction In relay circuits, a relay is often used to control power to the entire control circuit or to a portion of control circuit. This relay is also referred to as start relay, control relay or Master control relay. Fig. 12.29 shows a typical hardwired master control relay that controls power for the whole control circuit. When the relay switches off power to the whole circuit, it is also referred as Emergency stop release. dharm d:N-MachMac12-2.pm5 321
  • 339. 322 CONTROL OF MACHINES Line N Switch MCR MCR MCR Stop Start O.L M M2 M2 Green lamp M3 Red lamp Fig. 12.29 Hardwired master control relay All PLCs also provide Master Control Relay (MCR) instruction to control an entire program or selected rungs of a program. When the MCR instruction is programmed as shown in the Fig. 12.30, the portion of the program which is in between two MCR instructions is enabled only when the first MCR instruction is true. It means rungs 2 to 4 are enabled only when the instruction IN1 is true. Two MCR instructions are used to create a zone. In the circuit shown rung 5 is outside the areas of MCR zone created by two MCR instructions and thus works independently of the MCR instruction. IN1 Rung 1 MCR IN2 IN3 Rung 2 CR1 CR1 CR1 OUT1 Rung 3 Rung 4 MCR IN4 OUT2 IN5 Rung 5 IN6 Fig. 12.30 Two MCR instructions used to create two different zones dharm d:N-MachMac12-2.pm5 322
  • 340. PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER 323 Any number of zones can be created in a program but an MCR zone cannot be nested within another MCR zone. Note : A programmed MCR must never be used to replace a hard wired master control relay that provides emergency shutdown. It is recommended that a hard wired emergency STOP push-button should remove power to the output devices. This is achieved by using the normally open contact of a physical MCR relay in the neutral to cut off power to the output module of the PLC as shown in the Fig. 12.31. Another contact of MCR can be used in the line, but it is optional, as it is advantageous to keep the inputs energized for troubleshooting. Emergency L stop Start N MCR MCR Input module MCR COM MCR Output module COM M Fig. 12.31 Safety circuit using a physical MCR relay 12.9.12 Branch Open and Branch Close Instructions Whenever two instructions are to be programmed in parallel (for example the holding circuit) Branch open Branch close instructions are required to program the circuit into PLC memory. The circuit shown in Fig. 12.32 will be programmed using a branch open instruction (L) and branch close instruction by entering the instructions as follows with the help of a hand held programmer in the Allen Bradleys “SLC 150” PLC. Start Stop IN 1 IN2 CR1 CR 1 Fig. 12.32 A simple PLC program Program Entry : Press symbol L(Branch open) Press symbol – – (Examine ON) and give it address IN1 || dharm d:N-MachMac12-2.pm5 323
  • 341. 324 CONTROL OF MACHINES Rung 1 (a) A B Rung 1 Cursor (b) Cursor A B Rung 1 (c) A IN1 B Rung 1 (d) A IN1 B Rung1 (e) A IN1 B Rung1 CR1 (f) A IN1 Rung1 B CR1 (g) IN1 IN2 CR1 Rung1 CR1 Rung2 (h) Fig. 12.33 Programming of a parallel branch using computer software dharm d:N-MachMac12-2.pm5 324
  • 342. PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER 325 Press symbol L again (Branch Open) Press Symbol – – (Examine ON) and give it address CR1 || Press Symbol (Branch close) Press Symbol – – (Examine OFF) and give it address IN2 || Press Symbol –( )– (Relay) and give it address CR1 Press Enter If window based Personal computer software is used to program a PLC through Keyboard/ Mouse of the PC, then a single instruction called Branch instruction is available in the software to program the instructions connected in parallel. The symbol used for branch instruction in RS logix 500 software for programming Allen Bradley make PLC is , which is available on the tool bar of the window. When the software is opened for programming a dotted line (rung) will appear in the working window where Ladder program is to be entered as shown in Fig. 12.33(a). When branch instruction available on the toolbar of the window based software is called by left click of the mouse, the rung 1 will be modified and the branch will appear on the rung as shown in Fig. 12.33(b) and the cursor is shown by a rectangle. To enter the instruction in the top branch, mouse is clicked at junction A as shown in the diagram. This will move the cursor to point A as shown in Fig. 12.33(c). Now clicking an Examine ON instruction on the tool bar will modify the circuit as shown in Fig. 12.33(d). After entering the address IN1 for this instruction, mouse will be clicked at the starting of bottom branch, which will shift the cursor shown by rectangle as shown in Fig. 12.33(e). Now clicking again on Examine ON Instruction on the toolbar will add the instruction in parallel with the first instruction as shown in Fig. 12.33(f). This instruction is given address CR1. Now again clicking the mouse at point B in the program, the rectangle will appear as shown in Fig. 12.33(g). Now the Examine OFF instruction can be added to the circuit by clicking its symbol on the toolbar and then its address is entered. Finally the rung can be completed by clicking the relay instruction -( )- on the toolbar and entering its address CR1 from the keyboard. The complete rung 1 will be as shown in Fig. 12.33 (h) and clicking a new rung instruction on the toolbar will enter a new rung as shown in the diagram. 12.9.13 Timer Instruction Timer instruction is used to perform timing operations based on a precise internal clock, generally 0.1 or 0.01 seconds per clock pulse. In many PLCs, the time increment is user selectable, with the 0.1 sec incrementing the timer is called standard timer and the 0.01 sec incrementing timers are called high-speed timers. Timers generally fall into two different categories depending on the PLC manufacturers. These are retentive and non-retentive. Further the timer can be of two types, On-delay timer and OFF delay timer. Defference in working of ON and OFF delay timers has already been discussed in chapter on control components. Review it, if you cannot recollect. Most of the PLC manufacturers only provide ON-delay timer instruction. Thus we will discuss here the ON-delay timer only. A non-retentive timer is the one, which has got only one control line as shown in Fig. 12.34. Timer is represented by a coil symbol or by a box symbol as shown in Fig. 12.34(a) and (b) respectively. dharm d:N-MachMac12-2.pm5 325
  • 343. 326 CONTROL OF MACHINES Start switch Timer on-delay IN1 T1 Rung 1 RTO Timer Preset : 50 T1 OUT1 Rung 2 T1 OUT2 Rung 3 (a) IN1 EN Timer on Rung 1 Timer T1 Time Base 0.1 DN Preset 50 Accum 0 T1 OUT1 Rung 2 DN T1 OUT2 Rung 3 EN (b) Fig.12.34 (a) Timer representation in ladder logic (b) Timer representation in functional block language In the timer circuit, of Fig.12.34(a) when the Examine ON instruction IN1 is true, timer starts counting the time in intervals of 0.1 or 0.01 depending upon the time base. A preset of 50 for time base 0.1 sec means timer setting is 5 seconds. After 5 secs, the timer contacts, T1 will changeover their positions. Timer instruction in functional block language is more interactive. Time base selection is possible and time counted at a particular instant is shown against ACCUMULATED VALUE. Two coils EN and DN are shown. EN coil will remain energised as long as timer is ON. Thus contact T1/EN will changeover as soon as Timer is energised due to IN1 instruction getting true. The DN coil will energised/becomes true when the timer has timed out, that is when the ACCUMULATED VALUE = PRESET VALUE. Thus the timer contacts T1/DN will changeover. If the IN1 instruction goes false or supply fails at any time when timer is counting or has already timed out the ACCUMULATED VALUE will be reset to zero (0) and all timer contacts will come to their original condition. On restoration of power supply or closing of IN1 contact, timer will again start counting from zero towards the PRESET value. Retentive type of timers have two control lines as shown in Fig. 12.35. In this type of timer, the accumulated time at any instant is retained, if the power goes off or Examine ON instruction IN1 becomes false. Timer resumes counting from the accumulated value, when power is restored or when Examine ON instruction again becomes true. Once the dharm d:N-MachMac12-2.pm5 326
  • 344. PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER 327 PRESET VALUE = ACCUMULATED VALUE, the timer contacts will changeover and remain so until the reset instruction for the timer becomes true due to Examine ON instructing IN2 becoming true. This will reset the timer contacts to their original position and accumulated value will be reset to zero. IN1 T1 RTF Preset : 50 IN2 T1 RES Raccum : 0 (a) IN1 EN Retentive on-delay Timer T1 Timebase 0-1 Preset : 50 DN Accum 0 IN2 TM1 RES (b) Fig.12.35 (a) Retentive timer representation in ladder logic language (b) Retentive timer representation in functional block diagram language Note : As long as the reset instruction is true, timer instruction will not work. In some PLCs, Reset instruction can be programmed to have the initial accumulated value called reset accumulated value other than zero (0). If the reset instruction is programmed to have a non-zero intial accumulated value, the time required to change the timer contacts will be equal to PRESET VALUE—RESET ACCUMULATED VALUE. 12.9.14 Counter Instruction Counter instruction is similar to timer instruction, the only difference being that timer counts the internal pulses generated, by an internal clock while the counter counts internal pulses. A very common example of internal pulse generation is the counting of products moving on a conveyor system. A limit switch installed on the conveyor is actuated each time a product passes across the limit switch arm. Normally open, contact of limit switch, will close and open when a product actuates and deactuates the limit switch arm while passing through where the limit switch is installed. This closing and opening of contact is used to give a pulse to counter for counting the number of products passed. Counters are always of retentive type. Some manufacturers have counter instructions using one coil instructions each in two rungs as shown in Fig. 12.36. In one rung, there is Up counter instruction (CTU) and in the other rung is the reset instruction -(RST)-. A preset value is given to counter instruction, which corresponds to the maximum count. The reset instruction by default has a reset dharm d:N-MachMac12-2.pm5 327
  • 345. 328 CONTROL OF MACHINES accumulated value of zero (0). Reset instruction can however be programmed to have any Reset value upto the preset value of the counter in case of a Up-counter. In the program shown in Fig. 12.36, note that the IN1 instruction going true and then false will increase the accumulated value of counter C1 by one. When the accumulated value becomes equal to the preset value of 5, the counter contact C1, will close energizing the OUT1. If however the RAC value of counter C1, is programmed to say 2, then the counting will start from 2. The counter contact C1, will become true (close) after three counts i.e., (5 – 2 = 3). Some manufacturers represent the counter instruction in a box with two inputs and two coil in its output as shown in Fig. 12.36 (b), CTU at the top of the box represents that it is a Up- counter. The CU relay is true, when the IN1 instruction is true. Thus for each count, the relay becomes true and its contact C1/CU will close and then open for each count. When the Accumulated value = Preset value, the DN relay will become true and its contacts C1/DN will change their positions. IN1 C1 CTU Preset : 5 C1 OUT 1 IN2 C1 RST RAC = 0000 (a) IN1 CTU CU Counter C1 Preset : 5 Accum : 0 IN2 Reset DN C1 OUT1 DN (b) Fig. 12.36 (a) Counter representation in ladder logic diagram (b) Counter representation in functional block diagram In down counter, the counter instruction will be represented by CTD. In case of down counter the Reset accumulated value will be programmed equal to the preset value dharm d:N-MachMac12-2.pm5 328
  • 346. PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER 329 (counts required) and the preset value will be programmed to zero. When the IN1 instruction will go true, the accumulated value will decrement by one. When the accumulated value becomes equal to the preset value the down counter contact will changeover. In some cases, it is convenient to have a counter that can count in either of the two directions, called a bi-directional counter or UP-Down counter. One example of UP-Down counter can be to keep a tally of number of vehicles in the parking lot and to give indication when the parking is full. In this situation, entry of a car into the parking lot will be sensed and will be used to increase the count of bi-directional counter and when a vehicle exits from the exit gate, a sensor will provide pulse to decrement the count in the bi-directional counter. The accumulated value of the counter at any time can be displayed to know the number of vehicles parked at any time in the parking lot. Program using a Up-Down counter is shown in Fig. 12.37. Note that in this program the counter up instruction -(CTU)- and the Down-counter instruction -(CTD)- have been given the same address as C1. This indicates that both the instructions constitute the Up-Down counter. When the accumulated value is equal to the Preset value of the Counter Up instruction, the contact C1 will close and light the indication lamp connected to OUT1 of the output module to indicate that the vehicle in the parking lot are equal to 100. Sensor 1 IN1 C1 CTU Preset : 100 Sensor 2 IN2 C1 CTU Preset : 100 Lamp C1 Out1 IN3 C1 RES Fig. 12.37. Program using a up-down counter for counting the number of vehicles parked 12.9.15 Sequencer Instruction In some control applications, it is required that a particular sequence of events occur. Mechanical sequencers have been used for such applications. In automatic washing machines, a timer motor rotates one or more cams mounted on its shaft, which in turn causes switches to open or close to activate the next process in the wash cycles e.g., the machine advance from the main wash to the rinse cycle involving switching OFF of heaters, switching on pumps etc. A cam can consist of an eccentric circle of metal or plastic that rotates on a shaft. As it rotates, it pushes a switch or switches are closed to produce a sequence of steps. Sequencer is also referred to as cam timer. This has already been discussed on the chapter of control components and its application for conveyor system has been discussed in the chapter on industrial control circuits. The speed of the sequencer motor and the shape of the cams determine the time allowed for each operation. The relation of the cams to each other determine the sequences of steps. These electro-mechanical sequential controllers are called Drum sequencers. dharm d:N-MachMac12-2.pm5 329
  • 347. 330 CONTROL OF MACHINES The main disadvantage of these sequencers is that they were time driven only i.e., each sequence was allowed a certain amount of time depending upon the speed of the motor. In modern control systems it is necessary for the sequencer to be advanced in response to an event. For example, consider the control of a small oven. If the oven is not up to the desired temperature, despite the heater being on for the allowed amount of time, then the processor should not advance the sequencer to the next step. The sequencer should only be advanced in response to an event, in this case a thermal switch closing of which indicates that the oven is up to temperature. PLCs also have sequencers but they are not physical device but exist only as software instructions. They can be visualized as a drum that rotates in steps. At each step a series of pegs along the drum can activate switches which then initiates a control action. This electro-mechanical drum switch is shown in Fig. 12.38 (a). The presence of Peg indicate a logic 1 and the absence as logic 0. If the drum were unwound and laid flat then it would appear as shown in Fig. 12.38(b). PEGS 0 5 1 Rotation 4 Drum cylinder 2 3 (a) Switches Steps S5 S4 S3 S2 S1 0 ON OFF ON ON OFF 1 OFF OFF ON ON ON Motor rotates drum. Speed 2 ON OFF ON OFF ON determines time 3 ON ON OFF ON OFF for each step 4 ON OFF ON ON ON 5 ON ON ON OFF OFF (b) Fig. 12.38 (a) A electro-mechanical drum sequencer (b) Alternate representation of drum sequencer in the chart form OFF may be represented by logic 0 ON may be represented by logic 1 after step 5, the cycle repeats with step 0. Unlike the mechanical Sequencer, the PLC Sequencer can be either EVENT or TIME driven. Also PLC Sequencer can be a output sequencer or a input sequencer. A output Sequencer sets up the outputs ON or OFF for each step while input Sequencer examines inputs to determine their ON and OFF status for each step. dharm d:N-MachMac12-2.pm5 330
  • 348. PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER 331 12.9.16 Basic Operation of Time Driven Output Sequencer Instruction The operation of a time driven Sequencer can be explained with the help of the program and table shown in Fig. 12.39. IN1 S1 SQO Step Output addresses Time per step OUT1 OUT2 OUT3 OUT4 0 0 0 0 0 5 sec. 1 0 1 0 1 20 sec. 2 1 0 1 0 60 sec. 3 1 1 1 1 25 sec. Fig. 12.39 Operation of a time driven output sequencer The data shown in the table has to be programmed for the Sequencer instruction S1 shown in the program. When the PLC will be put in the run mode after entering the program and data. The Sequencer rung goes true when the examine ON instruction IN1 becomes true. This starts the Sequencer action and the step 0 occurs for 5 secs, and all output from OUT1 to OUT4 will be off. After 5 secs the Sequencer will advance to step 1 and the status of OUT1 to OUT 4 will be as shown in the table and it will remain in step 1 for 20 secs. After 20 secs, Sequencer will go to step 2 and then to step 3, remain there for the programmed time and change the status of outputs as programmed which is shown in the table. After the step 3, Sequencer will again come back to step 0. The same operation is repeated as long as the IN1 instruction remains true. If IN1 goes false anytime during the Sequencer operation or the supply fails, the Sequencer operation will stop but the changes already made are retained and the Sequencer operation will resume from the same point when the instruction IN1 goes true or supply is restored. Similarly we have a Event Driven Output Sequencer in which the Sequencer shifts to the next step when an external pulse is given to the Sequencer instead of a preset time for each step. In Time Driven Input Sequencers, the Sequencer stays at the predefined steps for the programmed times and monitor the status of specified inputs. If during its stay on a particular step for particular time the input status match the programmed status for the specified inputs, a sequencer contact is made true. This action is repeated at each step. Similarly we have a Event Driven Input Sequencer, in which the Sequencer shifts to the next step in response to an external pulse given to the Sequencer. There are many more instructions available in PLCs like Math functions, Data manipulation functions, Word and File move functions. For example in the Allen Bradleys ‘SLC 500’ PLC having 5/02 processor the number of functions available are seventy one (71). dharm d:N-MachMac12-2.pm5 331
  • 349. 332 CONTROL OF MACHINES 12.10 A SIMPLE PROGRAMMING EXAMPLE 12.10.1 Sand Mixing Machine A simple machine for preparation of a resin bonded sand is shown in Fig.12.40. Resin bonded sand is required in foundries for making cores which are used in the sand moulds for the making of metal castings. The sand and resin are mixed at a particular temperature to prepare the sand. Sand and resin are added in a predetermined proportion by adjusting the time of opening of ON-OFF type resin solenoid valve and the sand hopper gate. Sand hopper gate is operated by a pneumatic operated cylinder piston as shown in the diagram. Another Pneumatic operated gate is the mixer gate to throw out the mixed sand. Mixing is done by blades which rotate inside the mixer through the gear box connected to the shaft of a three phase squirrel cage induction motor. A limit switch is actuated when the mixer gate opens to throw out the sand. Sand is automatically thrown out due to the rotating mixer blades. This application requires the use of retentive timers as fixed quantities of resin and sand are to be mixed. The operation required from the machine is explained in steps given below: Sand hopper Sand hopper gate Solenoid valve Door Blades Gear Motor box Fig. 12.40 Diagram of a sand mixing machine 1. On pressing the Start push-button, the heaters installed inside the mixer should get ON. 2. When the required temperature of 100 centigrade is achieved, the mixer motor should start, and the resin solenoid valve should get energised to add resin into the mixer for 20 secs. 3. After the resin addition, the sand hopper gate should open for 30 secs to add the required quantity of sand into the mixer. 4. The mixing of the sand and resin should continue for 300 secs. 5. The mixer gate should now open for 60 secs to throw the mixed sand out of the mixer. 6. When the mixer gate closes, all the timers should be reset and the heaters should be switched off. 12.10.2 Relay Ladder Logic Diagram The Relay ladder diagram for the sand mixer machine will be as shown in Fig.12.41. It is left as an exercise for you to study this diagram thoroughly before you go to the next section to see how the same machine can be controlled by a PLC. dharm d:N-MachMac12-2.pm5 332
  • 350. PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER 333 Stop Start 4T2 Rung 1 C Heater On C1 C2 C3 Temp switch Rung 2 H Heaters T H1 OL Rung 3 M Mixer motor H2 Rung 4 1T Resin addition timer